From ca3770496deb9ecf7e63bd684f4d82dbdd185d83 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: William Joye Date: Sun, 4 Aug 2019 13:04:24 -0400 Subject: update tkblt --- tkblt/.gitignore | 30 - tkblt/LICENSE | 24 - tkblt/Makefile.in | 466 -- tkblt/README.md | 28 - tkblt/aclocal.m4 | 9 - tkblt/configure | 10270 -------------------------------- tkblt/configure.ac | 246 - tkblt/doc/BLT.html | 74 - tkblt/doc/BLT.n | 76 - tkblt/doc/barchart.html | 1640 ----- tkblt/doc/barchart.n | 2239 ------- tkblt/doc/graph.html | 1759 ------ tkblt/doc/graph.n | 2408 -------- tkblt/doc/vector.html | 704 --- tkblt/doc/vector.n | 1134 ---- tkblt/generic/tkblt.decls | 92 - tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.C | 194 - tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.h | 91 - tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.C | 218 - tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.h | 43 - tkblt/generic/tkbltDecls.h | 152 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.C | 1984 ------ tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.h | 266 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.C | 676 --- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.h | 60 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.C | 264 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.h | 41 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.C | 227 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.h | 72 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrDef.h | 45 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.C | 284 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.h | 202 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.C | 1315 ---- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.h | 132 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.C | 2477 -------- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.h | 184 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C | 1086 ---- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.C | 652 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.h | 41 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.C | 396 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.h | 41 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.C | 145 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.h | 78 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.C | 164 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.h | 42 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.C | 1070 ---- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.h | 178 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.C | 496 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.h | 40 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.C | 177 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.h | 103 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.C | 298 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.h | 82 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.C | 495 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.h | 39 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.C | 209 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.h | 39 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C | 298 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h | 84 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.C | 276 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.h | 82 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.C | 335 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.h | 118 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.C | 931 --- tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.h | 90 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.C | 62 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.h | 79 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.C | 174 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.h | 73 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.C | 243 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.h | 88 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.C | 217 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.h | 42 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOption.C | 89 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.C | 84 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.h | 73 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C | 183 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h | 41 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.C | 233 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.h | 79 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.C | 222 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.h | 39 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.C | 1458 ----- tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.h | 256 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.C | 516 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.h | 119 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.C | 267 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.h | 76 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.C | 462 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.h | 44 - tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphSup.C | 686 --- tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.C | 74 - tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.h | 58 - tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.C | 129 - tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.h | 64 - tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.C | 171 - tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.h | 67 - tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.C | 388 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.h | 55 - tkblt/generic/tkbltStubInit.c | 30 - tkblt/generic/tkbltStubLib.C | 15 - tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.C | 407 -- tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.h | 129 - tkblt/generic/tkbltVecCmd.C | 1821 ------ tkblt/generic/tkbltVecInt.h | 202 - tkblt/generic/tkbltVecMath.C | 1612 ----- tkblt/generic/tkbltVecOp.C | 56 - tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.C | 1875 ------ tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.h | 140 - tkblt/library/graph.tcl | 554 -- tkblt/pkgIndex.tcl.in | 5 - tkblt/tclconfig/ChangeLog | 1003 ---- tkblt/tclconfig/README.txt | 26 - tkblt/tclconfig/install-sh | 528 -- tkblt/tclconfig/tcl.m4 | 4176 ------------- tkblt/tests/all.tcl | 11 - tkblt/tests/axis.tcl | 105 - tkblt/tests/barelement.tcl | 97 - tkblt/tests/bargraph.tcl | 80 - tkblt/tests/barpen.tcl | 51 - tkblt/tests/base.tcl | 142 - tkblt/tests/crosshairs.tcl | 26 - tkblt/tests/legend.tcl | 101 - tkblt/tests/lineelement.tcl | 105 - tkblt/tests/linegraph.tcl | 75 - tkblt/tests/linemarker.tcl | 34 - tkblt/tests/linepen.tcl | 55 - tkblt/tests/marker.tcl | 33 - tkblt/tests/markers.tcl | 4 - tkblt/tests/polygonmarker.tcl | 30 - tkblt/tests/ps.tcl | 29 - tkblt/tests/test.tcl | 10 - tkblt/tests/textmarker.tcl | 44 - tkblt/tkbltConfig.sh.in | 45 - tkblt/tools/genStubs.tcl | 1179 ---- 135 files changed, 59957 deletions(-) delete mode 100644 tkblt/.gitignore delete mode 100644 tkblt/LICENSE delete mode 100644 tkblt/Makefile.in delete mode 100644 tkblt/README.md delete mode 100644 tkblt/aclocal.m4 delete mode 100755 tkblt/configure delete mode 100644 tkblt/configure.ac delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/BLT.html delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/BLT.n delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/barchart.html delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/barchart.n delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/graph.html delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/graph.n delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/vector.html delete mode 100644 tkblt/doc/vector.n delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkblt.decls delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltDecls.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrDef.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOption.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphSup.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltStubInit.c delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltStubLib.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVecCmd.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVecInt.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVecMath.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVecOp.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.C delete mode 100644 tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.h delete mode 100644 tkblt/library/graph.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/pkgIndex.tcl.in delete mode 100644 tkblt/tclconfig/ChangeLog delete mode 100644 tkblt/tclconfig/README.txt delete mode 100755 tkblt/tclconfig/install-sh delete mode 100644 tkblt/tclconfig/tcl.m4 delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/all.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/axis.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/barelement.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/bargraph.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/barpen.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/base.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/crosshairs.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/legend.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/lineelement.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/linegraph.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/linemarker.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/linepen.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/marker.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/markers.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/polygonmarker.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/ps.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/test.tcl delete mode 100644 tkblt/tests/textmarker.tcl delete mode 100755 tkblt/tkbltConfig.sh.in delete mode 100644 tkblt/tools/genStubs.tcl diff --git a/tkblt/.gitignore b/tkblt/.gitignore deleted file mode 100644 index c8694d4..0000000 --- a/tkblt/.gitignore +++ /dev/null @@ -1,30 +0,0 @@ -# Compiled Object files -*.slo -*.lo -*.o -*.obj - -# Precompiled Headers -*.gch -*.pch - -# Compiled Dynamic libraries -*.so -*.dylib -*.dll - -# Fortran module files -*.mod - -# Compiled Static libraries -*.lai -*.la -*.a -*.lib - -# Executables -*.exe -*.out -*.app - -*~ diff --git a/tkblt/LICENSE b/tkblt/LICENSE deleted file mode 100644 index ffe507e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/LICENSE +++ /dev/null @@ -1,24 +0,0 @@ -Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA -This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made -available under the same terms. - -Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - -Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining -a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the -"Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including -without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, -distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to -permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to -the following conditions: - -The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be -included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - -THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, -EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF -MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND -NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE -LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION -OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION -WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. diff --git a/tkblt/Makefile.in b/tkblt/Makefile.in deleted file mode 100644 index d36c879..0000000 --- a/tkblt/Makefile.in +++ /dev/null @@ -1,466 +0,0 @@ -# Makefile.in -- -# -# This file is a Makefile for Sample TEA Extension. If it has the name -# "Makefile.in" then it is a template for a Makefile; to generate the -# actual Makefile, run "./configure", which is a configuration script -# generated by the "autoconf" program (constructs like "@foo@" will get -# replaced in the actual Makefile. -# -# Copyright (c) 1999 Scriptics Corporation. -# Copyright (c) 2002-2005 ActiveState Corporation. -# -# See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution -# of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. - -#======================================================================== -# Add additional lines to handle any additional AC_SUBST cases that -# have been added in a customized configure script. -#======================================================================== - -#SAMPLE_NEW_VAR = @SAMPLE_NEW_VAR@ - -#======================================================================== -# Nothing of the variables below this line should need to be changed. -# Please check the TARGETS section below to make sure the make targets -# are correct. -#======================================================================== - -#======================================================================== -# The names of the source files is defined in the configure script. -# The object files are used for linking into the final library. -# This will be used when a dist target is added to the Makefile. -# It is not important to specify the directory, as long as it is the -# $(srcdir) or in the generic, win or unix subdirectory. -#======================================================================== - -PKG_SOURCES = @PKG_SOURCES@ -PKG_OBJECTS = @PKG_OBJECTS@ - -PKG_STUB_SOURCES = @PKG_STUB_SOURCES@ -PKG_STUB_OBJECTS = @PKG_STUB_OBJECTS@ - -#======================================================================== -# PKG_TCL_SOURCES identifies Tcl runtime files that are associated with -# this package that need to be installed, if any. -#======================================================================== - -PKG_TCL_SOURCES = @PKG_TCL_SOURCES@ - -#======================================================================== -# This is a list of public header files to be installed, if any. -#======================================================================== - -PKG_HEADERS = @PKG_HEADERS@ - -#======================================================================== -# "PKG_LIB_FILE" refers to the library (dynamic or static as per -# configuration options) composed of the named objects. -#======================================================================== - -PKG_LIB_FILE = @PKG_LIB_FILE@ -PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE = @PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE@ - -#lib_BINARIES = $(PKG_LIB_FILE) -lib_BINARIES = $(PKG_LIB_FILE) $(PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE) -BINARIES = $(lib_BINARIES) - -SHELL = @SHELL@ - -srcdir = @srcdir@ -prefix = @prefix@ -exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@ - -bindir = @bindir@ -libdir = @libdir@ -includedir = @includedir@ -datarootdir = @datarootdir@ -datadir = @datadir@ -mandir = @mandir@ - -DESTDIR = - -PKG_DIR = $(PACKAGE_NAME)$(PACKAGE_VERSION) -pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/$(PKG_DIR) -pkglibdir = $(libdir)/$(PKG_DIR) -pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/$(PKG_DIR) - -top_builddir = @abs_top_builddir@ - -INSTALL_OPTIONS = -INSTALL = @INSTALL@ $(INSTALL_OPTIONS) -INSTALL_DATA_DIR = ${INSTALL} -d -m 755 -INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@ -INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@ -INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@ -INSTALL_LIBRARY = ${INSTALL_DATA} - -PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@ -PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@ -CC = @CC@ -CFLAGS_DEFAULT = @CFLAGS_DEFAULT@ -CFLAGS_WARNING = @CFLAGS_WARNING@ -EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@ -LDFLAGS_DEFAULT = @LDFLAGS_DEFAULT@ -MAKE_LIB = @MAKE_LIB@ -MAKE_SHARED_LIB = @MAKE_SHARED_LIB@ -MAKE_STATIC_LIB = @MAKE_STATIC_LIB@ -MAKE_STUB_LIB = @MAKE_STUB_LIB@ -OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@ -RANLIB = @RANLIB@ -RANLIB_STUB = @RANLIB_STUB@ -SHLIB_CFLAGS = @SHLIB_CFLAGS@ -SHLIB_LD = @SHLIB_LD@ -SHLIB_LD_LIBS = @SHLIB_LD_LIBS@ -STLIB_LD = @STLIB_LD@ -#TCL_DEFS = @TCL_DEFS@ -TCL_BIN_DIR = @TCL_BIN_DIR@ -TCL_SRC_DIR = @TCL_SRC_DIR@ -#TK_BIN_DIR = @TK_BIN_DIR@ -#TK_SRC_DIR = @TK_SRC_DIR@ - -# Not used, but retained for reference of what libs Tcl required -#TCL_LIBS = @TCL_LIBS@ - -#======================================================================== -# TCLLIBPATH seeds the auto_path in Tcl's init.tcl so we can test our -# package without installing. The other environment variables allow us -# to test against an uninstalled Tcl. Add special env vars that you -# require for testing here (like TCLX_LIBRARY). -#======================================================================== - -EXTRA_PATH = $(top_builddir):$(TCL_BIN_DIR) -#EXTRA_PATH = $(top_builddir):$(TCL_BIN_DIR):$(TK_BIN_DIR) -TCLLIBPATH = $(top_builddir) -TCLSH_ENV = TCL_LIBRARY=`@CYGPATH@ $(TCL_SRC_DIR)/library` -PKG_ENV = @LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR@="$(EXTRA_PATH):$(@LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR@)" \ - PATH="$(EXTRA_PATH):$(PATH)" \ - TCLLIBPATH="$(TCLLIBPATH)" - -TCLSH_PROG = @TCLSH_PROG@ -TCLSH = $(TCLSH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(TCLSH_PROG) - -#WISH_ENV = TK_LIBRARY=`@CYGPATH@ $(TK_SRC_DIR)/library` -#WISH_PROG = @WISH_PROG@ -#WISH = $(TCLSH_ENV) $(WISH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(WISH_PROG) - -SHARED_BUILD = @SHARED_BUILD@ - -#INCLUDES = @PKG_INCLUDES@ @TCL_INCLUDES@ -INCLUDES = @PKG_INCLUDES@ @TCL_INCLUDES@ @TK_INCLUDES@ @TK_XINCLUDES@ - -PKG_CFLAGS = @PKG_CFLAGS@ - -# TCL_DEFS is not strictly need here, but if you remove it, then you -# must make sure that configure.ac checks for the necessary components -# that your library may use. TCL_DEFS can actually be a problem if -# you do not compile with a similar machine setup as the Tcl core was -# compiled with. -#DEFS = $(TCL_DEFS) @DEFS@ $(PKG_CFLAGS) -DEFS = @DEFS@ $(PKG_CFLAGS) - -# Move pkgIndex.tcl to 'BINARIES' var if it is generated in the Makefile -CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES = Makefile pkgIndex.tcl -CLEANFILES = @CLEANFILES@ - -CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@ -LIBS = @PKG_LIBS@ @LIBS@ -AR = @AR@ -CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@ -COMPILE = $(CC) $(DEFS) $(INCLUDES) $(AM_CPPFLAGS) $(CPPFLAGS) $(AM_CFLAGS) \ - $(CFLAGS_DEFAULT) $(CFLAGS_WARNING) $(SHLIB_CFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) - -GDB = gdb -VALGRIND = valgrind -VALGRINDARGS = --tool=memcheck --num-callers=8 --leak-resolution=high \ - --leak-check=yes --show-reachable=yes -v - -.SUFFIXES: .c .C .$(OBJEXT) - -#======================================================================== -# Start of user-definable TARGETS section -#======================================================================== - -#======================================================================== -# TEA TARGETS. Please note that the "libraries:" target refers to platform -# independent files, and the "binaries:" target includes executable programs and -# platform-dependent libraries. Modify these targets so that they install -# the various pieces of your package. The make and install rules -# for the BINARIES that you specified above have already been done. -#======================================================================== - -all: binaries libraries doc - -#======================================================================== -# The binaries target builds executable programs, Windows .dll's, unix -# shared/static libraries, and any other platform-dependent files. -# The list of targets to build for "binaries:" is specified at the top -# of the Makefile, in the "BINARIES" variable. -#======================================================================== - -binaries: $(BINARIES) - -libraries: - -#======================================================================== -# Your doc target should differentiate from doc builds (by the developer) -# and doc installs (see install-doc), which just install the docs on the -# end user machine when building from source. -#======================================================================== - -doc: - @echo "If you have documentation to create, place the commands to" - @echo "build the docs in the 'doc:' target. For example:" - @echo " xml2nroff sample.xml > sample.n" - @echo " xml2html sample.xml > sample.html" - -install: all install-binaries install-libraries install-doc - -install-binaries: binaries install-lib-binaries install-bin-binaries - -#======================================================================== -# This rule installs platform-independent files, such as header files. -# The list=...; for p in $$list handles the empty list case x-platform. -#======================================================================== - -install-libraries: libraries - @$(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DESTDIR)$(includedir) - @echo "Installing header files in $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)" - @list='$(PKG_HEADERS)'; for i in $$list; do \ - echo "Installing $(srcdir)/$$i" ; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$i $(DESTDIR)$(includedir) ; \ - done; - -#======================================================================== -# Install documentation. Unix manpages should go in the $(mandir) -# directory. -#======================================================================== - -install-doc: doc - @$(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DESTDIR)$(mandir)/mann - @echo "Installing documentation in $(DESTDIR)$(mandir)" - @list='$(srcdir)/doc/*.n'; for i in $$list; do \ - echo "Installing $$i"; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) $$i $(DESTDIR)$(mandir)/mann ; \ - done - -test: binaries libraries - $(TCLSH) `@CYGPATH@ $(srcdir)/tests/all.tcl` $(TESTFLAGS) \ - -load "package ifneeded $(PACKAGE_NAME) $(PACKAGE_VERSION) \ - [list load `@CYGPATH@ $(PKG_LIB_FILE)` $(PACKAGE_NAME)]" - -genstubs: $(srcdir)/tools/genStubs.tcl $(srcdir)/src/tkblt.decls - @echo $(TCLSH) $(srcdir)/tools/genStubs.tcl $(srcdir)/src $(srcdir)/src/tkblt.decls - @$(TCLSH) $(srcdir)/tools/genStubs.tcl $(srcdir)/src $(srcdir)/src/tkblt.decls -shell: binaries libraries - @$(TCLSH) $(SCRIPT) - -gdb: - $(TCLSH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(GDB) $(TCLSH_PROG) $(SCRIPT) - -gdb-test: binaries libraries - $(TCLSH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(GDB) \ - --args $(TCLSH_PROG) `@CYGPATH@ $(srcdir)/tests/all.tcl` \ - $(TESTFLAGS) -singleproc 1 \ - -load "package ifneeded $(PACKAGE_NAME) $(PACKAGE_VERSION) \ - [list load `@CYGPATH@ $(PKG_LIB_FILE)` $(PACKAGE_NAME)]" - -valgrind: binaries libraries - $(TCLSH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(VALGRIND) $(VALGRINDARGS) $(TCLSH_PROG) \ - `@CYGPATH@ $(srcdir)/tests/all.tcl` $(TESTFLAGS) - -valgrindshell: binaries libraries - $(TCLSH_ENV) $(PKG_ENV) $(VALGRIND) $(VALGRINDARGS) $(TCLSH_PROG) $(SCRIPT) - -depend: - -#======================================================================== -# $(PKG_LIB_FILE) should be listed as part of the BINARIES variable -# mentioned above. That will ensure that this target is built when you -# run "make binaries". -# -# The $(PKG_OBJECTS) objects are created and linked into the final -# library. In most cases these object files will correspond to the -# source files above. -#======================================================================== - -$(PKG_LIB_FILE): $(PKG_OBJECTS) - -rm -f $(PKG_LIB_FILE) - ${MAKE_LIB} - $(RANLIB) $(PKG_LIB_FILE) - -$(PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE): $(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS) - -rm -f $(PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE) - ${MAKE_STUB_LIB} - $(RANLIB_STUB) $(PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE) - -#======================================================================== -# We need to enumerate the list of .c to .o lines here. -# -# In the following lines, $(srcdir) refers to the toplevel directory -# containing your extension. If your sources are in a subdirectory, -# you will have to modify the paths to reflect this: -# -# sample.$(OBJEXT): $(srcdir)/generic/sample.c -# $(COMPILE) -c `@CYGPATH@ $(srcdir)/generic/sample.c` -o $@ -# -# Setting the VPATH variable to a list of paths will cause the makefile -# to look into these paths when resolving .c to .obj dependencies. -# As necessary, add $(srcdir):$(srcdir)/compat:.... -#======================================================================== - -VPATH = $(srcdir):$(srcdir)/generic:$(srcdir)/unix:$(srcdir)/win:$(srcdir)/macosx - -.c.@OBJEXT@: - $(COMPILE) -c `@CYGPATH@ $<` -o $@ - -.C.@OBJEXT@: - $(COMPILE) -c `@CYGPATH@ $<` -o $@ - -#======================================================================== -# Distribution creation -# You may need to tweak this target to make it work correctly. -#======================================================================== - -#COMPRESS = tar cvf $(PKG_DIR).tar $(PKG_DIR); compress $(PKG_DIR).tar -COMPRESS = tar zcvf $(PKG_DIR).tar.gz $(PKG_DIR) -DIST_ROOT = /tmp/dist -DIST_DIR = $(DIST_ROOT)/$(PKG_DIR) - -DIST_INSTALL_DATA = CPPROG='cp -p' $(INSTALL) -m 644 -DIST_INSTALL_SCRIPT = CPPROG='cp -p' $(INSTALL) -m 755 - -dist-clean: - rm -rf $(DIST_DIR) $(DIST_ROOT)/$(PKG_DIR).tar.* - -dist: dist-clean - $(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DIST_DIR) - - # TEA files - $(DIST_INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/Makefile.in \ - $(srcdir)/aclocal.m4 $(srcdir)/configure.ac \ - $(DIST_DIR)/ - $(DIST_INSTALL_SCRIPT) $(srcdir)/configure $(DIST_DIR)/ - - $(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DIST_DIR)/tclconfig - $(DIST_INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/tclconfig/README.txt \ - $(srcdir)/tclconfig/tcl.m4 $(srcdir)/tclconfig/install-sh \ - $(DIST_DIR)/tclconfig/ - - # Extension files - $(DIST_INSTALL_DATA) \ - $(srcdir)/ChangeLog \ - $(srcdir)/README.sha \ - $(srcdir)/license.terms \ - $(srcdir)/README \ - $(srcdir)/pkgIndex.tcl.in \ - $(DIST_DIR)/ - - list='demos doc generic library mac tests unix win'; \ - for p in $$list; do \ - if test -d $(srcdir)/$$p ; then \ - $(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DIST_DIR)/$$p; \ - $(DIST_INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$p/* $(DIST_DIR)/$$p/; \ - fi; \ - done - - (cd $(DIST_ROOT); $(COMPRESS);) - -#======================================================================== -# End of user-definable section -#======================================================================== - -#======================================================================== -# Don't modify the file to clean here. Instead, set the "CLEANFILES" -# variable in configure.ac -#======================================================================== - -clean: - -test -z "$(BINARIES)" || rm -f $(BINARIES) - -rm -f $(PKG_OBJECTS) *.$(OBJEXT) core *.core - -test -z "$(CLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(CLEANFILES) - -distclean: clean - -rm -f *.tab.c - -rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES) - -rm -f config.cache config.log config.status - -#======================================================================== -# Install binary object libraries. On Windows this includes both .dll and -# .lib files. Because the .lib files are not explicitly listed anywhere, -# we need to deduce their existence from the .dll file of the same name. -# Library files go into the lib directory. -# In addition, this will generate the pkgIndex.tcl -# file in the install location (assuming it can find a usable tclsh shell) -# -# You should not have to modify this target. -#======================================================================== - -install-lib-binaries: binaries - @$(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir) - @list='$(lib_BINARIES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - if test -f $$p; then \ - echo " $(INSTALL_LIBRARY) $$p $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$p"; \ - $(INSTALL_LIBRARY) $$p $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$p; \ - ext=`echo $$p|sed -e "s/.*\.//"`; \ - if test "x$$ext" = "xdll"; then \ - lib=`basename $$p|sed -e 's/.[^.]*$$//'`.lib; \ - if test -f $$lib; then \ - echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$lib $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$lib"; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) $$lib $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$lib; \ - fi; \ - fi; \ - fi; \ - done - @list='$(PKG_TCL_SOURCES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - if test -f $(srcdir)/$$p; then \ - destp=`basename $$p`; \ - echo " Install $$destp $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$destp"; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$p $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$destp; \ - fi; \ - done - @if test "x$(SHARED_BUILD)" = "x1"; then \ - echo " Install pkgIndex.tcl $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)"; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) pkgIndex.tcl $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir); \ - fi - $(INSTALL_DATA) tkbltConfig.sh $(DESTDIR)$(libdir) - -#======================================================================== -# Install binary executables (e.g. .exe files and dependent .dll files) -# This is for files that must go in the bin directory (located next to -# wish and tclsh), like dependent .dll files on Windows. -# -# You should not have to modify this target, except to define bin_BINARIES -# above if necessary. -#======================================================================== - -install-bin-binaries: binaries - @$(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) $(DESTDIR)$(bindir) - @list='$(bin_BINARIES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - if test -f $$p; then \ - echo " $(INSTALL_PROGRAM) $$p $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/$$p"; \ - $(INSTALL_PROGRAM) $$p $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/$$p; \ - fi; \ - done - -Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status - cd $(top_builddir) \ - && CONFIG_FILES=$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status - -uninstall-binaries: - list='$(lib_BINARIES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$p; \ - done - list='$(PKG_TCL_SOURCES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - p=`basename $$p`; \ - rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(pkglibdir)/$$p; \ - done - list='$(bin_BINARIES)'; for p in $$list; do \ - rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/$$p; \ - done - -.PHONY: all binaries clean depend distclean doc install libraries test -.PHONY: gdb gdb-test valgrind valgrindshell - -# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables. -# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded. -.NOEXPORT: diff --git a/tkblt/README.md b/tkblt/README.md deleted file mode 100644 index c5a5b74..0000000 --- a/tkblt/README.md +++ /dev/null @@ -1,28 +0,0 @@ -[![DOI](https://zenodo.org/badge/DOI/10.5281/zenodo.1041783.svg)](https://doi.org/10.5281/zenodo.1041783) -# tkblt -Introduction to the TkBLT library - -TkBLT is a library of extensions to the Tk library. It adds new -commands and variables to the application's interpreter. - -TkBLT is a derived version of the BLT Toolkit by George A. Howlett, -for Tcl/Tk 8.5/8.6, is TEA compatible, with full support for MacOSX and -Windows, and is fully compatible with the Tk API. TkBLT is released -under the original BSD license. TkBLT includes only the Graph and -Barchart Tk widgets, and the Tcl Vector command. - -The following commands are added to the interpreter from the TkBLT library: - -Graph: A 2D plotting widget. Plots two variable data in a window with an optional -legend and annotations. It has of several components; coordinate axes, -crosshairs, a legend, and a collection of elements and tags. - -Barchart: A barchart widget. Plots two-variable data as rectangular bars in a -window. The x-coordinate values designate the position of the bar along -the x-axis, while the y-coordinate values designate the magnitude. -The barchart widget has of several components; coordinate axes, -crosshairs, a legend, and a collection of elements and tags. - -Vector: Creates a vector of floating point values. The vector's components -can be manipulated in three ways: through a Tcl array variable, a Tcl -command, or the C API. diff --git a/tkblt/aclocal.m4 b/tkblt/aclocal.m4 deleted file mode 100644 index 0b05739..0000000 --- a/tkblt/aclocal.m4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,9 +0,0 @@ -# -# Include the TEA standard macro set -# - -builtin(include,tclconfig/tcl.m4) - -# -# Add here whatever m4 macros you want to define for your package -# diff --git a/tkblt/configure b/tkblt/configure deleted file mode 100755 index 0a1414a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/configure +++ /dev/null @@ -1,10270 +0,0 @@ -#! /bin/sh -# Guess values for system-dependent variables and create Makefiles. -# Generated by GNU Autoconf 2.69 for tkblt 3.2. -# -# -# Copyright (C) 1992-1996, 1998-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# -# -# This configure script is free software; the Free Software Foundation -# gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it. -## -------------------- ## -## M4sh Initialization. ## -## -------------------- ## - -# Be more Bourne compatible -DUALCASE=1; export DUALCASE # for MKS sh -if test -n "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - emulate sh - NULLCMD=: - # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on ${1+"$@"}, which - # is contrary to our usage. Disable this feature. - alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"' - setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST -else - case `(set -o) 2>/dev/null` in #( - *posix*) : - set -o posix ;; #( - *) : - ;; -esac -fi - - -as_nl=' -' -export as_nl -# Printing a long string crashes Solaris 7 /usr/bin/printf. -as_echo='\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\' -as_echo=$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo -as_echo=$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo -# Prefer a ksh shell builtin over an external printf program on Solaris, -# but without wasting forks for bash or zsh. -if test -z "$BASH_VERSION$ZSH_VERSION" \ - && (test "X`print -r -- $as_echo`" = "X$as_echo") 2>/dev/null; then - as_echo='print -r --' - as_echo_n='print -rn --' -elif (test "X`printf %s $as_echo`" = "X$as_echo") 2>/dev/null; then - as_echo='printf %s\n' - as_echo_n='printf %s' -else - if test "X`(/usr/ucb/echo -n -n $as_echo) 2>/dev/null`" = "X-n $as_echo"; then - as_echo_body='eval /usr/ucb/echo -n "$1$as_nl"' - as_echo_n='/usr/ucb/echo -n' - else - as_echo_body='eval expr "X$1" : "X\\(.*\\)"' - as_echo_n_body='eval - arg=$1; - case $arg in #( - *"$as_nl"*) - expr "X$arg" : "X\\(.*\\)$as_nl"; - arg=`expr "X$arg" : ".*$as_nl\\(.*\\)"`;; - esac; - expr "X$arg" : "X\\(.*\\)" | tr -d "$as_nl" - ' - export as_echo_n_body - as_echo_n='sh -c $as_echo_n_body as_echo' - fi - export as_echo_body - as_echo='sh -c $as_echo_body as_echo' -fi - -# The user is always right. -if test "${PATH_SEPARATOR+set}" != set; then - PATH_SEPARATOR=: - (PATH='/bin;/bin'; FPATH=$PATH; sh -c :) >/dev/null 2>&1 && { - (PATH='/bin:/bin'; FPATH=$PATH; sh -c :) >/dev/null 2>&1 || - PATH_SEPARATOR=';' - } -fi - - -# IFS -# We need space, tab and new line, in precisely that order. Quoting is -# there to prevent editors from complaining about space-tab. -# (If _AS_PATH_WALK were called with IFS unset, it would disable word -# splitting by setting IFS to empty value.) -IFS=" "" $as_nl" - -# Find who we are. Look in the path if we contain no directory separator. -as_myself= -case $0 in #(( - *[\\/]* ) as_myself=$0 ;; - *) as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - test -r "$as_dir/$0" && as_myself=$as_dir/$0 && break - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - - ;; -esac -# We did not find ourselves, most probably we were run as `sh COMMAND' -# in which case we are not to be found in the path. -if test "x$as_myself" = x; then - as_myself=$0 -fi -if test ! -f "$as_myself"; then - $as_echo "$as_myself: error: cannot find myself; rerun with an absolute file name" >&2 - exit 1 -fi - -# Unset variables that we do not need and which cause bugs (e.g. in -# pre-3.0 UWIN ksh). But do not cause bugs in bash 2.01; the "|| exit 1" -# suppresses any "Segmentation fault" message there. '((' could -# trigger a bug in pdksh 5.2.14. -for as_var in BASH_ENV ENV MAIL MAILPATH -do eval test x\${$as_var+set} = xset \ - && ( (unset $as_var) || exit 1) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset $as_var || : -done -PS1='$ ' -PS2='> ' -PS4='+ ' - -# NLS nuisances. -LC_ALL=C -export LC_ALL -LANGUAGE=C -export LANGUAGE - -# CDPATH. -(unset CDPATH) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset CDPATH - -# Use a proper internal environment variable to ensure we don't fall - # into an infinite loop, continuously re-executing ourselves. - if test x"${_as_can_reexec}" != xno && test "x$CONFIG_SHELL" != x; then - _as_can_reexec=no; export _as_can_reexec; - # We cannot yet assume a decent shell, so we have to provide a -# neutralization value for shells without unset; and this also -# works around shells that cannot unset nonexistent variables. -# Preserve -v and -x to the replacement shell. -BASH_ENV=/dev/null -ENV=/dev/null -(unset BASH_ENV) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset BASH_ENV ENV -case $- in # (((( - *v*x* | *x*v* ) as_opts=-vx ;; - *v* ) as_opts=-v ;; - *x* ) as_opts=-x ;; - * ) as_opts= ;; -esac -exec $CONFIG_SHELL $as_opts "$as_myself" ${1+"$@"} -# Admittedly, this is quite paranoid, since all the known shells bail -# out after a failed `exec'. -$as_echo "$0: could not re-execute with $CONFIG_SHELL" >&2 -as_fn_exit 255 - fi - # We don't want this to propagate to other subprocesses. - { _as_can_reexec=; unset _as_can_reexec;} -if test "x$CONFIG_SHELL" = x; then - as_bourne_compatible="if test -n \"\${ZSH_VERSION+set}\" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - emulate sh - NULLCMD=: - # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on \${1+\"\$@\"}, which - # is contrary to our usage. Disable this feature. - alias -g '\${1+\"\$@\"}'='\"\$@\"' - setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST -else - case \`(set -o) 2>/dev/null\` in #( - *posix*) : - set -o posix ;; #( - *) : - ;; -esac -fi -" - as_required="as_fn_return () { (exit \$1); } -as_fn_success () { as_fn_return 0; } -as_fn_failure () { as_fn_return 1; } -as_fn_ret_success () { return 0; } -as_fn_ret_failure () { return 1; } - -exitcode=0 -as_fn_success || { exitcode=1; echo as_fn_success failed.; } -as_fn_failure && { exitcode=1; echo as_fn_failure succeeded.; } -as_fn_ret_success || { exitcode=1; echo as_fn_ret_success failed.; } -as_fn_ret_failure && { exitcode=1; echo as_fn_ret_failure succeeded.; } -if ( set x; as_fn_ret_success y && test x = \"\$1\" ); then : - -else - exitcode=1; echo positional parameters were not saved. -fi -test x\$exitcode = x0 || exit 1 -test -x / || exit 1" - as_suggested=" as_lineno_1=";as_suggested=$as_suggested$LINENO;as_suggested=$as_suggested" as_lineno_1a=\$LINENO - as_lineno_2=";as_suggested=$as_suggested$LINENO;as_suggested=$as_suggested" as_lineno_2a=\$LINENO - eval 'test \"x\$as_lineno_1'\$as_run'\" != \"x\$as_lineno_2'\$as_run'\" && - test \"x\`expr \$as_lineno_1'\$as_run' + 1\`\" = \"x\$as_lineno_2'\$as_run'\"' || exit 1 -test \$(( 1 + 1 )) = 2 || exit 1" - if (eval "$as_required") 2>/dev/null; then : - as_have_required=yes -else - as_have_required=no -fi - if test x$as_have_required = xyes && (eval "$as_suggested") 2>/dev/null; then : - -else - as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -as_found=false -for as_dir in /bin$PATH_SEPARATOR/usr/bin$PATH_SEPARATOR$PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - as_found=: - case $as_dir in #( - /*) - for as_base in sh bash ksh sh5; do - # Try only shells that exist, to save several forks. - as_shell=$as_dir/$as_base - if { test -f "$as_shell" || test -f "$as_shell.exe"; } && - { $as_echo "$as_bourne_compatible""$as_required" | as_run=a "$as_shell"; } 2>/dev/null; then : - CONFIG_SHELL=$as_shell as_have_required=yes - if { $as_echo "$as_bourne_compatible""$as_suggested" | as_run=a "$as_shell"; } 2>/dev/null; then : - break 2 -fi -fi - done;; - esac - as_found=false -done -$as_found || { if { test -f "$SHELL" || test -f "$SHELL.exe"; } && - { $as_echo "$as_bourne_compatible""$as_required" | as_run=a "$SHELL"; } 2>/dev/null; then : - CONFIG_SHELL=$SHELL as_have_required=yes -fi; } -IFS=$as_save_IFS - - - if test "x$CONFIG_SHELL" != x; then : - export CONFIG_SHELL - # We cannot yet assume a decent shell, so we have to provide a -# neutralization value for shells without unset; and this also -# works around shells that cannot unset nonexistent variables. -# Preserve -v and -x to the replacement shell. -BASH_ENV=/dev/null -ENV=/dev/null -(unset BASH_ENV) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset BASH_ENV ENV -case $- in # (((( - *v*x* | *x*v* ) as_opts=-vx ;; - *v* ) as_opts=-v ;; - *x* ) as_opts=-x ;; - * ) as_opts= ;; -esac -exec $CONFIG_SHELL $as_opts "$as_myself" ${1+"$@"} -# Admittedly, this is quite paranoid, since all the known shells bail -# out after a failed `exec'. -$as_echo "$0: could not re-execute with $CONFIG_SHELL" >&2 -exit 255 -fi - - if test x$as_have_required = xno; then : - $as_echo "$0: This script requires a shell more modern than all" - $as_echo "$0: the shells that I found on your system." - if test x${ZSH_VERSION+set} = xset ; then - $as_echo "$0: In particular, zsh $ZSH_VERSION has bugs and should" - $as_echo "$0: be upgraded to zsh 4.3.4 or later." - else - $as_echo "$0: Please tell bug-autoconf@gnu.org about your system, -$0: including any error possibly output before this -$0: message. Then install a modern shell, or manually run -$0: the script under such a shell if you do have one." - fi - exit 1 -fi -fi -fi -SHELL=${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} -export SHELL -# Unset more variables known to interfere with behavior of common tools. -CLICOLOR_FORCE= GREP_OPTIONS= -unset CLICOLOR_FORCE GREP_OPTIONS - -## --------------------- ## -## M4sh Shell Functions. ## -## --------------------- ## -# as_fn_unset VAR -# --------------- -# Portably unset VAR. -as_fn_unset () -{ - { eval $1=; unset $1;} -} -as_unset=as_fn_unset - -# as_fn_set_status STATUS -# ----------------------- -# Set $? to STATUS, without forking. -as_fn_set_status () -{ - return $1 -} # as_fn_set_status - -# as_fn_exit STATUS -# ----------------- -# Exit the shell with STATUS, even in a "trap 0" or "set -e" context. -as_fn_exit () -{ - set +e - as_fn_set_status $1 - exit $1 -} # as_fn_exit - -# as_fn_mkdir_p -# ------------- -# Create "$as_dir" as a directory, including parents if necessary. -as_fn_mkdir_p () -{ - - case $as_dir in #( - -*) as_dir=./$as_dir;; - esac - test -d "$as_dir" || eval $as_mkdir_p || { - as_dirs= - while :; do - case $as_dir in #( - *\'*) as_qdir=`$as_echo "$as_dir" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;; #'( - *) as_qdir=$as_dir;; - esac - as_dirs="'$as_qdir' $as_dirs" - as_dir=`$as_dirname -- "$as_dir" || -$as_expr X"$as_dir" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X"$as_dir" | - sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - test -d "$as_dir" && break - done - test -z "$as_dirs" || eval "mkdir $as_dirs" - } || test -d "$as_dir" || as_fn_error $? "cannot create directory $as_dir" - - -} # as_fn_mkdir_p - -# as_fn_executable_p FILE -# ----------------------- -# Test if FILE is an executable regular file. -as_fn_executable_p () -{ - test -f "$1" && test -x "$1" -} # as_fn_executable_p -# as_fn_append VAR VALUE -# ---------------------- -# Append the text in VALUE to the end of the definition contained in VAR. Take -# advantage of any shell optimizations that allow amortized linear growth over -# repeated appends, instead of the typical quadratic growth present in naive -# implementations. -if (eval "as_var=1; as_var+=2; test x\$as_var = x12") 2>/dev/null; then : - eval 'as_fn_append () - { - eval $1+=\$2 - }' -else - as_fn_append () - { - eval $1=\$$1\$2 - } -fi # as_fn_append - -# as_fn_arith ARG... -# ------------------ -# Perform arithmetic evaluation on the ARGs, and store the result in the -# global $as_val. Take advantage of shells that can avoid forks. The arguments -# must be portable across $(()) and expr. -if (eval "test \$(( 1 + 1 )) = 2") 2>/dev/null; then : - eval 'as_fn_arith () - { - as_val=$(( $* )) - }' -else - as_fn_arith () - { - as_val=`expr "$@" || test $? -eq 1` - } -fi # as_fn_arith - - -# as_fn_error STATUS ERROR [LINENO LOG_FD] -# ---------------------------------------- -# Output "`basename $0`: error: ERROR" to stderr. If LINENO and LOG_FD are -# provided, also output the error to LOG_FD, referencing LINENO. Then exit the -# script with STATUS, using 1 if that was 0. -as_fn_error () -{ - as_status=$1; test $as_status -eq 0 && as_status=1 - if test "$4"; then - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$3"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: $2" >&$4 - fi - $as_echo "$as_me: error: $2" >&2 - as_fn_exit $as_status -} # as_fn_error - -if expr a : '\(a\)' >/dev/null 2>&1 && - test "X`expr 00001 : '.*\(...\)'`" = X001; then - as_expr=expr -else - as_expr=false -fi - -if (basename -- /) >/dev/null 2>&1 && test "X`basename -- / 2>&1`" = "X/"; then - as_basename=basename -else - as_basename=false -fi - -if (as_dir=`dirname -- /` && test "X$as_dir" = X/) >/dev/null 2>&1; then - as_dirname=dirname -else - as_dirname=false -fi - -as_me=`$as_basename -- "$0" || -$as_expr X/"$0" : '.*/\([^/][^/]*\)/*$' \| \ - X"$0" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$0" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X/"$0" | - sed '/^.*\/\([^/][^/]*\)\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\/\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\/\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - -# Avoid depending upon Character Ranges. -as_cr_letters='abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' -as_cr_LETTERS='ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' -as_cr_Letters=$as_cr_letters$as_cr_LETTERS -as_cr_digits='0123456789' -as_cr_alnum=$as_cr_Letters$as_cr_digits - - - as_lineno_1=$LINENO as_lineno_1a=$LINENO - as_lineno_2=$LINENO as_lineno_2a=$LINENO - eval 'test "x$as_lineno_1'$as_run'" != "x$as_lineno_2'$as_run'" && - test "x`expr $as_lineno_1'$as_run' + 1`" = "x$as_lineno_2'$as_run'"' || { - # Blame Lee E. McMahon (1931-1989) for sed's syntax. :-) - sed -n ' - p - /[$]LINENO/= - ' <$as_myself | - sed ' - s/[$]LINENO.*/&-/ - t lineno - b - :lineno - N - :loop - s/[$]LINENO\([^'$as_cr_alnum'_].*\n\)\(.*\)/\2\1\2/ - t loop - s/-\n.*// - ' >$as_me.lineno && - chmod +x "$as_me.lineno" || - { $as_echo "$as_me: error: cannot create $as_me.lineno; rerun with a POSIX shell" >&2; as_fn_exit 1; } - - # If we had to re-execute with $CONFIG_SHELL, we're ensured to have - # already done that, so ensure we don't try to do so again and fall - # in an infinite loop. This has already happened in practice. - _as_can_reexec=no; export _as_can_reexec - # Don't try to exec as it changes $[0], causing all sort of problems - # (the dirname of $[0] is not the place where we might find the - # original and so on. Autoconf is especially sensitive to this). - . "./$as_me.lineno" - # Exit status is that of the last command. - exit -} - -ECHO_C= ECHO_N= ECHO_T= -case `echo -n x` in #((((( --n*) - case `echo 'xy\c'` in - *c*) ECHO_T=' ';; # ECHO_T is single tab character. - xy) ECHO_C='\c';; - *) echo `echo ksh88 bug on AIX 6.1` > /dev/null - ECHO_T=' ';; - esac;; -*) - ECHO_N='-n';; -esac - -rm -f conf$$ conf$$.exe conf$$.file -if test -d conf$$.dir; then - rm -f conf$$.dir/conf$$.file -else - rm -f conf$$.dir - mkdir conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null -fi -if (echo >conf$$.file) 2>/dev/null; then - if ln -s conf$$.file conf$$ 2>/dev/null; then - as_ln_s='ln -s' - # ... but there are two gotchas: - # 1) On MSYS, both `ln -s file dir' and `ln file dir' fail. - # 2) DJGPP < 2.04 has no symlinks; `ln -s' creates a wrapper executable. - # In both cases, we have to default to `cp -pR'. - ln -s conf$$.file conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null && test ! -f conf$$.exe || - as_ln_s='cp -pR' - elif ln conf$$.file conf$$ 2>/dev/null; then - as_ln_s=ln - else - as_ln_s='cp -pR' - fi -else - as_ln_s='cp -pR' -fi -rm -f conf$$ conf$$.exe conf$$.dir/conf$$.file conf$$.file -rmdir conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null - -if mkdir -p . 2>/dev/null; then - as_mkdir_p='mkdir -p "$as_dir"' -else - test -d ./-p && rmdir ./-p - as_mkdir_p=false -fi - -as_test_x='test -x' -as_executable_p=as_fn_executable_p - -# Sed expression to map a string onto a valid CPP name. -as_tr_cpp="eval sed 'y%*$as_cr_letters%P$as_cr_LETTERS%;s%[^_$as_cr_alnum]%_%g'" - -# Sed expression to map a string onto a valid variable name. -as_tr_sh="eval sed 'y%*+%pp%;s%[^_$as_cr_alnum]%_%g'" - - -test -n "$DJDIR" || exec 7<&0 &1 - -# Name of the host. -# hostname on some systems (SVR3.2, old GNU/Linux) returns a bogus exit status, -# so uname gets run too. -ac_hostname=`(hostname || uname -n) 2>/dev/null | sed 1q` - -# -# Initializations. -# -ac_default_prefix=/usr/local -ac_clean_files= -ac_config_libobj_dir=. -LIBOBJS= -cross_compiling=no -subdirs= -MFLAGS= -MAKEFLAGS= - -# Identity of this package. -PACKAGE_NAME='tkblt' -PACKAGE_TARNAME='tkblt' -PACKAGE_VERSION='3.2' -PACKAGE_STRING='tkblt 3.2' -PACKAGE_BUGREPORT='' -PACKAGE_URL='' - -# Factoring default headers for most tests. -ac_includes_default="\ -#include -#ifdef HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H -# include -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_SYS_STAT_H -# include -#endif -#ifdef STDC_HEADERS -# include -# include -#else -# ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H -# include -# endif -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_STRING_H -# if !defined STDC_HEADERS && defined HAVE_MEMORY_H -# include -# endif -# include -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_STRINGS_H -# include -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_INTTYPES_H -# include -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_STDINT_H -# include -#endif -#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H -# include -#endif" - -ac_subst_vars='LTLIBOBJS -LIBOBJS -PATCHLEVEL -MINOR_VERSION -MAJOR_VERSION -tkblt_STUB_LIB_PATH -tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH -tkblt_STUB_LIB_SPEC -tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC -tkblt_LIB_SPEC -tkblt_BUILD_LIB_SPEC -WISH_PROG -TCLSH_PROG -VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE -VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL -RANLIB_STUB -MAKE_STUB_LIB -MAKE_STATIC_LIB -MAKE_SHARED_LIB -MAKE_LIB -TCL_DBGX -LDFLAGS_DEFAULT -CFLAGS_DEFAULT -LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR -SHLIB_CFLAGS -SHLIB_LD_LIBS -SHLIB_LD -STLIB_LD -CFLAGS_WARNING -CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE -CFLAGS_DEBUG -RC -CELIB_DIR -AR -STUBS_BUILD -SHARED_BUILD -TCL_THREADS -XMKMF -TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE -TK_TOP_DIR_NATIVE -TK_INCLUDES -TCL_TOP_DIR_NATIVE -TCL_INCLUDES -PKG_OBJECTS -PKG_SOURCES -EGREP -GREP -RANLIB -SET_MAKE -CPP -TK_XINCLUDES -TK_LIBS -TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC -TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG -TK_STUB_LIB_FILE -TK_LIB_SPEC -TK_LIB_FLAG -TK_LIB_FILE -TK_SRC_DIR -TK_BIN_DIR -TK_VERSION -TCL_SHLIB_LD_LIBS -TCL_LD_FLAGS -TCL_EXTRA_CFLAGS -TCL_DEFS -TCL_LIBS -CLEANFILES -OBJEXT -ac_ct_CC -CPPFLAGS -LDFLAGS -CFLAGS -CC -TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC -TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG -TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE -TCL_LIB_SPEC -TCL_LIB_FLAG -TCL_LIB_FILE -TCL_SRC_DIR -TCL_BIN_DIR -TCL_PATCH_LEVEL -TCL_VERSION -INSTALL_LIBRARY -INSTALL_SCRIPT -INSTALL_PROGRAM -INSTALL_DATA -INSTALL_DATA_DIR -INSTALL -PKG_CFLAGS -PKG_LIBS -PKG_INCLUDES -PKG_HEADERS -PKG_TCL_SOURCES -PKG_STUB_OBJECTS -PKG_STUB_SOURCES -PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE -PKG_LIB_FILE -EXEEXT -CYGPATH -target_alias -host_alias -build_alias -LIBS -ECHO_T -ECHO_N -ECHO_C -DEFS -mandir -localedir -libdir -psdir -pdfdir -dvidir -htmldir -infodir -docdir -oldincludedir -includedir -localstatedir -sharedstatedir -sysconfdir -datadir -datarootdir -libexecdir -sbindir -bindir -program_transform_name -prefix -exec_prefix -PACKAGE_URL -PACKAGE_BUGREPORT -PACKAGE_STRING -PACKAGE_VERSION -PACKAGE_TARNAME -PACKAGE_NAME -PATH_SEPARATOR -SHELL' -ac_subst_files='' -ac_user_opts=' -enable_option_checking -with_tcl -with_tk -with_tclinclude -with_tkinclude -with_x -enable_threads -enable_shared -enable_stubs -enable_64bit -enable_64bit_vis -enable_rpath -enable_wince -with_celib -enable_symbols -' - ac_precious_vars='build_alias -host_alias -target_alias -CC -CFLAGS -LDFLAGS -LIBS -CPPFLAGS -CPP -XMKMF' - - -# Initialize some variables set by options. -ac_init_help= -ac_init_version=false -ac_unrecognized_opts= -ac_unrecognized_sep= -# The variables have the same names as the options, with -# dashes changed to underlines. -cache_file=/dev/null -exec_prefix=NONE -no_create= -no_recursion= -prefix=NONE -program_prefix=NONE -program_suffix=NONE -program_transform_name=s,x,x, -silent= -site= -srcdir= -verbose= -x_includes=NONE -x_libraries=NONE - -# Installation directory options. -# These are left unexpanded so users can "make install exec_prefix=/foo" -# and all the variables that are supposed to be based on exec_prefix -# by default will actually change. -# Use braces instead of parens because sh, perl, etc. also accept them. -# (The list follows the same order as the GNU Coding Standards.) -bindir='${exec_prefix}/bin' -sbindir='${exec_prefix}/sbin' -libexecdir='${exec_prefix}/libexec' -datarootdir='${prefix}/share' -datadir='${datarootdir}' -sysconfdir='${prefix}/etc' -sharedstatedir='${prefix}/com' -localstatedir='${prefix}/var' -includedir='${prefix}/include' -oldincludedir='/usr/include' -docdir='${datarootdir}/doc/${PACKAGE_TARNAME}' -infodir='${datarootdir}/info' -htmldir='${docdir}' -dvidir='${docdir}' -pdfdir='${docdir}' -psdir='${docdir}' -libdir='${exec_prefix}/lib' -localedir='${datarootdir}/locale' -mandir='${datarootdir}/man' - -ac_prev= -ac_dashdash= -for ac_option -do - # If the previous option needs an argument, assign it. - if test -n "$ac_prev"; then - eval $ac_prev=\$ac_option - ac_prev= - continue - fi - - case $ac_option in - *=?*) ac_optarg=`expr "X$ac_option" : '[^=]*=\(.*\)'` ;; - *=) ac_optarg= ;; - *) ac_optarg=yes ;; - esac - - # Accept the important Cygnus configure options, so we can diagnose typos. - - case $ac_dashdash$ac_option in - --) - ac_dashdash=yes ;; - - -bindir | --bindir | --bindi | --bind | --bin | --bi) - ac_prev=bindir ;; - -bindir=* | --bindir=* | --bindi=* | --bind=* | --bin=* | --bi=*) - bindir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -build | --build | --buil | --bui | --bu) - ac_prev=build_alias ;; - -build=* | --build=* | --buil=* | --bui=* | --bu=*) - build_alias=$ac_optarg ;; - - -cache-file | --cache-file | --cache-fil | --cache-fi \ - | --cache-f | --cache- | --cache | --cach | --cac | --ca | --c) - ac_prev=cache_file ;; - -cache-file=* | --cache-file=* | --cache-fil=* | --cache-fi=* \ - | --cache-f=* | --cache-=* | --cache=* | --cach=* | --cac=* | --ca=* | --c=*) - cache_file=$ac_optarg ;; - - --config-cache | -C) - cache_file=config.cache ;; - - -datadir | --datadir | --datadi | --datad) - ac_prev=datadir ;; - -datadir=* | --datadir=* | --datadi=* | --datad=*) - datadir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -datarootdir | --datarootdir | --datarootdi | --datarootd | --dataroot \ - | --dataroo | --dataro | --datar) - ac_prev=datarootdir ;; - -datarootdir=* | --datarootdir=* | --datarootdi=* | --datarootd=* \ - | --dataroot=* | --dataroo=* | --dataro=* | --datar=*) - datarootdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -disable-* | --disable-*) - ac_useropt=`expr "x$ac_option" : 'x-*disable-\(.*\)'` - # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names. - expr "x$ac_useropt" : ".*[^-+._$as_cr_alnum]" >/dev/null && - as_fn_error $? "invalid feature name: $ac_useropt" - ac_useropt_orig=$ac_useropt - ac_useropt=`$as_echo "$ac_useropt" | sed 's/[-+.]/_/g'` - case $ac_user_opts in - *" -"enable_$ac_useropt" -"*) ;; - *) ac_unrecognized_opts="$ac_unrecognized_opts$ac_unrecognized_sep--disable-$ac_useropt_orig" - ac_unrecognized_sep=', ';; - esac - eval enable_$ac_useropt=no ;; - - -docdir | --docdir | --docdi | --doc | --do) - ac_prev=docdir ;; - -docdir=* | --docdir=* | --docdi=* | --doc=* | --do=*) - docdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -dvidir | --dvidir | --dvidi | --dvid | --dvi | --dv) - ac_prev=dvidir ;; - -dvidir=* | --dvidir=* | --dvidi=* | --dvid=* | --dvi=* | --dv=*) - dvidir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -enable-* | --enable-*) - ac_useropt=`expr "x$ac_option" : 'x-*enable-\([^=]*\)'` - # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names. - expr "x$ac_useropt" : ".*[^-+._$as_cr_alnum]" >/dev/null && - as_fn_error $? "invalid feature name: $ac_useropt" - ac_useropt_orig=$ac_useropt - ac_useropt=`$as_echo "$ac_useropt" | sed 's/[-+.]/_/g'` - case $ac_user_opts in - *" -"enable_$ac_useropt" -"*) ;; - *) ac_unrecognized_opts="$ac_unrecognized_opts$ac_unrecognized_sep--enable-$ac_useropt_orig" - ac_unrecognized_sep=', ';; - esac - eval enable_$ac_useropt=\$ac_optarg ;; - - -exec-prefix | --exec_prefix | --exec-prefix | --exec-prefi \ - | --exec-pref | --exec-pre | --exec-pr | --exec-p | --exec- \ - | --exec | --exe | --ex) - ac_prev=exec_prefix ;; - -exec-prefix=* | --exec_prefix=* | --exec-prefix=* | --exec-prefi=* \ - | --exec-pref=* | --exec-pre=* | --exec-pr=* | --exec-p=* | --exec-=* \ - | --exec=* | --exe=* | --ex=*) - exec_prefix=$ac_optarg ;; - - -gas | --gas | --ga | --g) - # Obsolete; use --with-gas. - with_gas=yes ;; - - -help | --help | --hel | --he | -h) - ac_init_help=long ;; - -help=r* | --help=r* | --hel=r* | --he=r* | -hr*) - ac_init_help=recursive ;; - -help=s* | --help=s* | --hel=s* | --he=s* | -hs*) - ac_init_help=short ;; - - -host | --host | --hos | --ho) - ac_prev=host_alias ;; - -host=* | --host=* | --hos=* | --ho=*) - host_alias=$ac_optarg ;; - - -htmldir | --htmldir | --htmldi | --htmld | --html | --htm | --ht) - ac_prev=htmldir ;; - -htmldir=* | --htmldir=* | --htmldi=* | --htmld=* | --html=* | --htm=* \ - | --ht=*) - htmldir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -includedir | --includedir | --includedi | --included | --include \ - | --includ | --inclu | --incl | --inc) - ac_prev=includedir ;; - -includedir=* | --includedir=* | --includedi=* | --included=* | --include=* \ - | --includ=* | --inclu=* | --incl=* | --inc=*) - includedir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -infodir | --infodir | --infodi | --infod | --info | --inf) - ac_prev=infodir ;; - -infodir=* | --infodir=* | --infodi=* | --infod=* | --info=* | --inf=*) - infodir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -libdir | --libdir | --libdi | --libd) - ac_prev=libdir ;; - -libdir=* | --libdir=* | --libdi=* | --libd=*) - libdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -libexecdir | --libexecdir | --libexecdi | --libexecd | --libexec \ - | --libexe | --libex | --libe) - ac_prev=libexecdir ;; - -libexecdir=* | --libexecdir=* | --libexecdi=* | --libexecd=* | --libexec=* \ - | --libexe=* | --libex=* | --libe=*) - libexecdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -localedir | --localedir | --localedi | --localed | --locale) - ac_prev=localedir ;; - -localedir=* | --localedir=* | --localedi=* | --localed=* | --locale=*) - localedir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -localstatedir | --localstatedir | --localstatedi | --localstated \ - | --localstate | --localstat | --localsta | --localst | --locals) - ac_prev=localstatedir ;; - -localstatedir=* | --localstatedir=* | --localstatedi=* | --localstated=* \ - | --localstate=* | --localstat=* | --localsta=* | --localst=* | --locals=*) - localstatedir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -mandir | --mandir | --mandi | --mand | --man | --ma | --m) - ac_prev=mandir ;; - -mandir=* | --mandir=* | --mandi=* | --mand=* | --man=* | --ma=* | --m=*) - mandir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -nfp | --nfp | --nf) - # Obsolete; use --without-fp. - with_fp=no ;; - - -no-create | --no-create | --no-creat | --no-crea | --no-cre \ - | --no-cr | --no-c | -n) - no_create=yes ;; - - -no-recursion | --no-recursion | --no-recursio | --no-recursi \ - | --no-recurs | --no-recur | --no-recu | --no-rec | --no-re | --no-r) - no_recursion=yes ;; - - -oldincludedir | --oldincludedir | --oldincludedi | --oldincluded \ - | --oldinclude | --oldinclud | --oldinclu | --oldincl | --oldinc \ - | --oldin | --oldi | --old | --ol | --o) - ac_prev=oldincludedir ;; - -oldincludedir=* | --oldincludedir=* | --oldincludedi=* | --oldincluded=* \ - | --oldinclude=* | --oldinclud=* | --oldinclu=* | --oldincl=* | --oldinc=* \ - | --oldin=* | --oldi=* | --old=* | --ol=* | --o=*) - oldincludedir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -prefix | --prefix | --prefi | --pref | --pre | --pr | --p) - ac_prev=prefix ;; - -prefix=* | --prefix=* | --prefi=* | --pref=* | --pre=* | --pr=* | --p=*) - prefix=$ac_optarg ;; - - -program-prefix | --program-prefix | --program-prefi | --program-pref \ - | --program-pre | --program-pr | --program-p) - ac_prev=program_prefix ;; - -program-prefix=* | --program-prefix=* | --program-prefi=* \ - | --program-pref=* | --program-pre=* | --program-pr=* | --program-p=*) - program_prefix=$ac_optarg ;; - - -program-suffix | --program-suffix | --program-suffi | --program-suff \ - | --program-suf | --program-su | --program-s) - ac_prev=program_suffix ;; - -program-suffix=* | --program-suffix=* | --program-suffi=* \ - | --program-suff=* | --program-suf=* | --program-su=* | --program-s=*) - program_suffix=$ac_optarg ;; - - -program-transform-name | --program-transform-name \ - | --program-transform-nam | --program-transform-na \ - | --program-transform-n | --program-transform- \ - | --program-transform | --program-transfor \ - | --program-transfo | --program-transf \ - | --program-trans | --program-tran \ - | --progr-tra | --program-tr | --program-t) - ac_prev=program_transform_name ;; - -program-transform-name=* | --program-transform-name=* \ - | --program-transform-nam=* | --program-transform-na=* \ - | --program-transform-n=* | --program-transform-=* \ - | --program-transform=* | --program-transfor=* \ - | --program-transfo=* | --program-transf=* \ - | --program-trans=* | --program-tran=* \ - | --progr-tra=* | --program-tr=* | --program-t=*) - program_transform_name=$ac_optarg ;; - - -pdfdir | --pdfdir | --pdfdi | --pdfd | --pdf | --pd) - ac_prev=pdfdir ;; - -pdfdir=* | --pdfdir=* | --pdfdi=* | --pdfd=* | --pdf=* | --pd=*) - pdfdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -psdir | --psdir | --psdi | --psd | --ps) - ac_prev=psdir ;; - -psdir=* | --psdir=* | --psdi=* | --psd=* | --ps=*) - psdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -q | -quiet | --quiet | --quie | --qui | --qu | --q \ - | -silent | --silent | --silen | --sile | --sil) - silent=yes ;; - - -sbindir | --sbindir | --sbindi | --sbind | --sbin | --sbi | --sb) - ac_prev=sbindir ;; - -sbindir=* | --sbindir=* | --sbindi=* | --sbind=* | --sbin=* \ - | --sbi=* | --sb=*) - sbindir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -sharedstatedir | --sharedstatedir | --sharedstatedi \ - | --sharedstated | --sharedstate | --sharedstat | --sharedsta \ - | --sharedst | --shareds | --shared | --share | --shar \ - | --sha | --sh) - ac_prev=sharedstatedir ;; - -sharedstatedir=* | --sharedstatedir=* | --sharedstatedi=* \ - | --sharedstated=* | --sharedstate=* | --sharedstat=* | --sharedsta=* \ - | --sharedst=* | --shareds=* | --shared=* | --share=* | --shar=* \ - | --sha=* | --sh=*) - sharedstatedir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -site | --site | --sit) - ac_prev=site ;; - -site=* | --site=* | --sit=*) - site=$ac_optarg ;; - - -srcdir | --srcdir | --srcdi | --srcd | --src | --sr) - ac_prev=srcdir ;; - -srcdir=* | --srcdir=* | --srcdi=* | --srcd=* | --src=* | --sr=*) - srcdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -sysconfdir | --sysconfdir | --sysconfdi | --sysconfd | --sysconf \ - | --syscon | --sysco | --sysc | --sys | --sy) - ac_prev=sysconfdir ;; - -sysconfdir=* | --sysconfdir=* | --sysconfdi=* | --sysconfd=* | --sysconf=* \ - | --syscon=* | --sysco=* | --sysc=* | --sys=* | --sy=*) - sysconfdir=$ac_optarg ;; - - -target | --target | --targe | --targ | --tar | --ta | --t) - ac_prev=target_alias ;; - -target=* | --target=* | --targe=* | --targ=* | --tar=* | --ta=* | --t=*) - target_alias=$ac_optarg ;; - - -v | -verbose | --verbose | --verbos | --verbo | --verb) - verbose=yes ;; - - -version | --version | --versio | --versi | --vers | -V) - ac_init_version=: ;; - - -with-* | --with-*) - ac_useropt=`expr "x$ac_option" : 'x-*with-\([^=]*\)'` - # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names. - expr "x$ac_useropt" : ".*[^-+._$as_cr_alnum]" >/dev/null && - as_fn_error $? "invalid package name: $ac_useropt" - ac_useropt_orig=$ac_useropt - ac_useropt=`$as_echo "$ac_useropt" | sed 's/[-+.]/_/g'` - case $ac_user_opts in - *" -"with_$ac_useropt" -"*) ;; - *) ac_unrecognized_opts="$ac_unrecognized_opts$ac_unrecognized_sep--with-$ac_useropt_orig" - ac_unrecognized_sep=', ';; - esac - eval with_$ac_useropt=\$ac_optarg ;; - - -without-* | --without-*) - ac_useropt=`expr "x$ac_option" : 'x-*without-\(.*\)'` - # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names. - expr "x$ac_useropt" : ".*[^-+._$as_cr_alnum]" >/dev/null && - as_fn_error $? "invalid package name: $ac_useropt" - ac_useropt_orig=$ac_useropt - ac_useropt=`$as_echo "$ac_useropt" | sed 's/[-+.]/_/g'` - case $ac_user_opts in - *" -"with_$ac_useropt" -"*) ;; - *) ac_unrecognized_opts="$ac_unrecognized_opts$ac_unrecognized_sep--without-$ac_useropt_orig" - ac_unrecognized_sep=', ';; - esac - eval with_$ac_useropt=no ;; - - --x) - # Obsolete; use --with-x. - with_x=yes ;; - - -x-includes | --x-includes | --x-include | --x-includ | --x-inclu \ - | --x-incl | --x-inc | --x-in | --x-i) - ac_prev=x_includes ;; - -x-includes=* | --x-includes=* | --x-include=* | --x-includ=* | --x-inclu=* \ - | --x-incl=* | --x-inc=* | --x-in=* | --x-i=*) - x_includes=$ac_optarg ;; - - -x-libraries | --x-libraries | --x-librarie | --x-librari \ - | --x-librar | --x-libra | --x-libr | --x-lib | --x-li | --x-l) - ac_prev=x_libraries ;; - -x-libraries=* | --x-libraries=* | --x-librarie=* | --x-librari=* \ - | --x-librar=* | --x-libra=* | --x-libr=* | --x-lib=* | --x-li=* | --x-l=*) - x_libraries=$ac_optarg ;; - - -*) as_fn_error $? "unrecognized option: \`$ac_option' -Try \`$0 --help' for more information" - ;; - - *=*) - ac_envvar=`expr "x$ac_option" : 'x\([^=]*\)='` - # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names. - case $ac_envvar in #( - '' | [0-9]* | *[!_$as_cr_alnum]* ) - as_fn_error $? "invalid variable name: \`$ac_envvar'" ;; - esac - eval $ac_envvar=\$ac_optarg - export $ac_envvar ;; - - *) - # FIXME: should be removed in autoconf 3.0. - $as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: you should use --build, --host, --target" >&2 - expr "x$ac_option" : ".*[^-._$as_cr_alnum]" >/dev/null && - $as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: invalid host type: $ac_option" >&2 - : "${build_alias=$ac_option} ${host_alias=$ac_option} ${target_alias=$ac_option}" - ;; - - esac -done - -if test -n "$ac_prev"; then - ac_option=--`echo $ac_prev | sed 's/_/-/g'` - as_fn_error $? "missing argument to $ac_option" -fi - -if test -n "$ac_unrecognized_opts"; then - case $enable_option_checking in - no) ;; - fatal) as_fn_error $? "unrecognized options: $ac_unrecognized_opts" ;; - *) $as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: unrecognized options: $ac_unrecognized_opts" >&2 ;; - esac -fi - -# Check all directory arguments for consistency. -for ac_var in exec_prefix prefix bindir sbindir libexecdir datarootdir \ - datadir sysconfdir sharedstatedir localstatedir includedir \ - oldincludedir docdir infodir htmldir dvidir pdfdir psdir \ - libdir localedir mandir -do - eval ac_val=\$$ac_var - # Remove trailing slashes. - case $ac_val in - */ ) - ac_val=`expr "X$ac_val" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)' \| "X$ac_val" : 'X\(.*\)'` - eval $ac_var=\$ac_val;; - esac - # Be sure to have absolute directory names. - case $ac_val in - [\\/$]* | ?:[\\/]* ) continue;; - NONE | '' ) case $ac_var in *prefix ) continue;; esac;; - esac - as_fn_error $? "expected an absolute directory name for --$ac_var: $ac_val" -done - -# There might be people who depend on the old broken behavior: `$host' -# used to hold the argument of --host etc. -# FIXME: To remove some day. -build=$build_alias -host=$host_alias -target=$target_alias - -# FIXME: To remove some day. -if test "x$host_alias" != x; then - if test "x$build_alias" = x; then - cross_compiling=maybe - elif test "x$build_alias" != "x$host_alias"; then - cross_compiling=yes - fi -fi - -ac_tool_prefix= -test -n "$host_alias" && ac_tool_prefix=$host_alias- - -test "$silent" = yes && exec 6>/dev/null - - -ac_pwd=`pwd` && test -n "$ac_pwd" && -ac_ls_di=`ls -di .` && -ac_pwd_ls_di=`cd "$ac_pwd" && ls -di .` || - as_fn_error $? "working directory cannot be determined" -test "X$ac_ls_di" = "X$ac_pwd_ls_di" || - as_fn_error $? "pwd does not report name of working directory" - - -# Find the source files, if location was not specified. -if test -z "$srcdir"; then - ac_srcdir_defaulted=yes - # Try the directory containing this script, then the parent directory. - ac_confdir=`$as_dirname -- "$as_myself" || -$as_expr X"$as_myself" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \ - X"$as_myself" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \ - X"$as_myself" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$as_myself" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X"$as_myself" | - sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - srcdir=$ac_confdir - if test ! -r "$srcdir/$ac_unique_file"; then - srcdir=.. - fi -else - ac_srcdir_defaulted=no -fi -if test ! -r "$srcdir/$ac_unique_file"; then - test "$ac_srcdir_defaulted" = yes && srcdir="$ac_confdir or .." - as_fn_error $? "cannot find sources ($ac_unique_file) in $srcdir" -fi -ac_msg="sources are in $srcdir, but \`cd $srcdir' does not work" -ac_abs_confdir=`( - cd "$srcdir" && test -r "./$ac_unique_file" || as_fn_error $? "$ac_msg" - pwd)` -# When building in place, set srcdir=. -if test "$ac_abs_confdir" = "$ac_pwd"; then - srcdir=. -fi -# Remove unnecessary trailing slashes from srcdir. -# Double slashes in file names in object file debugging info -# mess up M-x gdb in Emacs. -case $srcdir in -*/) srcdir=`expr "X$srcdir" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)' \| "X$srcdir" : 'X\(.*\)'`;; -esac -for ac_var in $ac_precious_vars; do - eval ac_env_${ac_var}_set=\${${ac_var}+set} - eval ac_env_${ac_var}_value=\$${ac_var} - eval ac_cv_env_${ac_var}_set=\${${ac_var}+set} - eval ac_cv_env_${ac_var}_value=\$${ac_var} -done - -# -# Report the --help message. -# -if test "$ac_init_help" = "long"; then - # Omit some internal or obsolete options to make the list less imposing. - # This message is too long to be a string in the A/UX 3.1 sh. - cat <<_ACEOF -\`configure' configures tkblt 3.2 to adapt to many kinds of systems. - -Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [VAR=VALUE]... - -To assign environment variables (e.g., CC, CFLAGS...), specify them as -VAR=VALUE. See below for descriptions of some of the useful variables. - -Defaults for the options are specified in brackets. - -Configuration: - -h, --help display this help and exit - --help=short display options specific to this package - --help=recursive display the short help of all the included packages - -V, --version display version information and exit - -q, --quiet, --silent do not print \`checking ...' messages - --cache-file=FILE cache test results in FILE [disabled] - -C, --config-cache alias for \`--cache-file=config.cache' - -n, --no-create do not create output files - --srcdir=DIR find the sources in DIR [configure dir or \`..'] - -Installation directories: - --prefix=PREFIX install architecture-independent files in PREFIX - [$ac_default_prefix] - --exec-prefix=EPREFIX install architecture-dependent files in EPREFIX - [PREFIX] - -By default, \`make install' will install all the files in -\`$ac_default_prefix/bin', \`$ac_default_prefix/lib' etc. You can specify -an installation prefix other than \`$ac_default_prefix' using \`--prefix', -for instance \`--prefix=\$HOME'. - -For better control, use the options below. - -Fine tuning of the installation directories: - --bindir=DIR user executables [EPREFIX/bin] - --sbindir=DIR system admin executables [EPREFIX/sbin] - --libexecdir=DIR program executables [EPREFIX/libexec] - --sysconfdir=DIR read-only single-machine data [PREFIX/etc] - --sharedstatedir=DIR modifiable architecture-independent data [PREFIX/com] - --localstatedir=DIR modifiable single-machine data [PREFIX/var] - --libdir=DIR object code libraries [EPREFIX/lib] - --includedir=DIR C header files [PREFIX/include] - --oldincludedir=DIR C header files for non-gcc [/usr/include] - --datarootdir=DIR read-only arch.-independent data root [PREFIX/share] - --datadir=DIR read-only architecture-independent data [DATAROOTDIR] - --infodir=DIR info documentation [DATAROOTDIR/info] - --localedir=DIR locale-dependent data [DATAROOTDIR/locale] - --mandir=DIR man documentation [DATAROOTDIR/man] - --docdir=DIR documentation root [DATAROOTDIR/doc/tkblt] - --htmldir=DIR html documentation [DOCDIR] - --dvidir=DIR dvi documentation [DOCDIR] - --pdfdir=DIR pdf documentation [DOCDIR] - --psdir=DIR ps documentation [DOCDIR] -_ACEOF - - cat <<\_ACEOF - -X features: - --x-includes=DIR X include files are in DIR - --x-libraries=DIR X library files are in DIR -_ACEOF -fi - -if test -n "$ac_init_help"; then - case $ac_init_help in - short | recursive ) echo "Configuration of tkblt 3.2:";; - esac - cat <<\_ACEOF - -Optional Features: - --disable-option-checking ignore unrecognized --enable/--with options - --disable-FEATURE do not include FEATURE (same as --enable-FEATURE=no) - --enable-FEATURE[=ARG] include FEATURE [ARG=yes] - --enable-threads build with threads (default: on) - --enable-shared build and link with shared libraries (default: on) - --enable-stubs build and link with stub libraries. Always true for - shared builds (default: on) - --enable-64bit enable 64bit support (default: off) - --enable-64bit-vis enable 64bit Sparc VIS support (default: off) - --disable-rpath disable rpath support (default: on) - --enable-wince enable Win/CE support (where applicable) - --enable-symbols build with debugging symbols (default: off) - -Optional Packages: - --with-PACKAGE[=ARG] use PACKAGE [ARG=yes] - --without-PACKAGE do not use PACKAGE (same as --with-PACKAGE=no) - --with-tcl directory containing tcl configuration - (tclConfig.sh) - --with-tk directory containing tk configuration (tkConfig.sh) - --with-tclinclude directory containing the public Tcl header files - --with-tkinclude directory containing the public Tk header files - --with-x use the X Window System - --with-celib=DIR use Windows/CE support library from DIR - -Some influential environment variables: - CC C compiler command - CFLAGS C compiler flags - LDFLAGS linker flags, e.g. -L if you have libraries in a - nonstandard directory - LIBS libraries to pass to the linker, e.g. -l - CPPFLAGS (Objective) C/C++ preprocessor flags, e.g. -I if - you have headers in a nonstandard directory - CPP C preprocessor - XMKMF Path to xmkmf, Makefile generator for X Window System - -Use these variables to override the choices made by `configure' or to help -it to find libraries and programs with nonstandard names/locations. - -Report bugs to the package provider. -_ACEOF -ac_status=$? -fi - -if test "$ac_init_help" = "recursive"; then - # If there are subdirs, report their specific --help. - for ac_dir in : $ac_subdirs_all; do test "x$ac_dir" = x: && continue - test -d "$ac_dir" || - { cd "$srcdir" && ac_pwd=`pwd` && srcdir=. && test -d "$ac_dir"; } || - continue - ac_builddir=. - -case "$ac_dir" in -.) ac_dir_suffix= ac_top_builddir_sub=. ac_top_build_prefix= ;; -*) - ac_dir_suffix=/`$as_echo "$ac_dir" | sed 's|^\.[\\/]||'` - # A ".." for each directory in $ac_dir_suffix. - ac_top_builddir_sub=`$as_echo "$ac_dir_suffix" | sed 's|/[^\\/]*|/..|g;s|/||'` - case $ac_top_builddir_sub in - "") ac_top_builddir_sub=. ac_top_build_prefix= ;; - *) ac_top_build_prefix=$ac_top_builddir_sub/ ;; - esac ;; -esac -ac_abs_top_builddir=$ac_pwd -ac_abs_builddir=$ac_pwd$ac_dir_suffix -# for backward compatibility: -ac_top_builddir=$ac_top_build_prefix - -case $srcdir in - .) # We are building in place. - ac_srcdir=. - ac_top_srcdir=$ac_top_builddir_sub - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$ac_pwd ;; - [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]* ) # Absolute name. - ac_srcdir=$srcdir$ac_dir_suffix; - ac_top_srcdir=$srcdir - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$srcdir ;; - *) # Relative name. - ac_srcdir=$ac_top_build_prefix$srcdir$ac_dir_suffix - ac_top_srcdir=$ac_top_build_prefix$srcdir - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$ac_pwd/$srcdir ;; -esac -ac_abs_srcdir=$ac_abs_top_srcdir$ac_dir_suffix - - cd "$ac_dir" || { ac_status=$?; continue; } - # Check for guested configure. - if test -f "$ac_srcdir/configure.gnu"; then - echo && - $SHELL "$ac_srcdir/configure.gnu" --help=recursive - elif test -f "$ac_srcdir/configure"; then - echo && - $SHELL "$ac_srcdir/configure" --help=recursive - else - $as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: no configuration information is in $ac_dir" >&2 - fi || ac_status=$? - cd "$ac_pwd" || { ac_status=$?; break; } - done -fi - -test -n "$ac_init_help" && exit $ac_status -if $ac_init_version; then - cat <<\_ACEOF -tkblt configure 3.2 -generated by GNU Autoconf 2.69 - -Copyright (C) 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -This configure script is free software; the Free Software Foundation -gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it. -_ACEOF - exit -fi - -## ------------------------ ## -## Autoconf initialization. ## -## ------------------------ ## - -# ac_fn_c_try_compile LINENO -# -------------------------- -# Try to compile conftest.$ac_ext, and return whether this succeeded. -ac_fn_c_try_compile () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - rm -f conftest.$ac_objext - if { { ac_try="$ac_compile" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_compile") 2>conftest.err - ac_status=$? - if test -s conftest.err; then - grep -v '^ *+' conftest.err >conftest.er1 - cat conftest.er1 >&5 - mv -f conftest.er1 conftest.err - fi - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } && { - test -z "$ac_c_werror_flag" || - test ! -s conftest.err - } && test -s conftest.$ac_objext; then : - ac_retval=0 -else - $as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - - ac_retval=1 -fi - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - as_fn_set_status $ac_retval - -} # ac_fn_c_try_compile - -# ac_fn_c_try_cpp LINENO -# ---------------------- -# Try to preprocess conftest.$ac_ext, and return whether this succeeded. -ac_fn_c_try_cpp () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - if { { ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>conftest.err - ac_status=$? - if test -s conftest.err; then - grep -v '^ *+' conftest.err >conftest.er1 - cat conftest.er1 >&5 - mv -f conftest.er1 conftest.err - fi - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } > conftest.i && { - test -z "$ac_c_preproc_warn_flag$ac_c_werror_flag" || - test ! -s conftest.err - }; then : - ac_retval=0 -else - $as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - - ac_retval=1 -fi - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - as_fn_set_status $ac_retval - -} # ac_fn_c_try_cpp - -# ac_fn_c_try_run LINENO -# ---------------------- -# Try to link conftest.$ac_ext, and return whether this succeeded. Assumes -# that executables *can* be run. -ac_fn_c_try_run () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - if { { ac_try="$ac_link" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_link") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } && { ac_try='./conftest$ac_exeext' - { { case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_try") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; }; }; then : - ac_retval=0 -else - $as_echo "$as_me: program exited with status $ac_status" >&5 - $as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - - ac_retval=$ac_status -fi - rm -rf conftest.dSYM conftest_ipa8_conftest.oo - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - as_fn_set_status $ac_retval - -} # ac_fn_c_try_run - -# ac_fn_c_check_header_compile LINENO HEADER VAR INCLUDES -# ------------------------------------------------------- -# Tests whether HEADER exists and can be compiled using the include files in -# INCLUDES, setting the cache variable VAR accordingly. -ac_fn_c_check_header_compile () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $2" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $2... " >&6; } -if eval \${$3+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -$4 -#include <$2> -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - eval "$3=yes" -else - eval "$3=no" -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -eval ac_res=\$$3 - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_res" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_res" >&6; } - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - -} # ac_fn_c_check_header_compile - -# ac_fn_c_try_link LINENO -# ----------------------- -# Try to link conftest.$ac_ext, and return whether this succeeded. -ac_fn_c_try_link () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - rm -f conftest.$ac_objext conftest$ac_exeext - if { { ac_try="$ac_link" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_link") 2>conftest.err - ac_status=$? - if test -s conftest.err; then - grep -v '^ *+' conftest.err >conftest.er1 - cat conftest.er1 >&5 - mv -f conftest.er1 conftest.err - fi - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } && { - test -z "$ac_c_werror_flag" || - test ! -s conftest.err - } && test -s conftest$ac_exeext && { - test "$cross_compiling" = yes || - test -x conftest$ac_exeext - }; then : - ac_retval=0 -else - $as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - - ac_retval=1 -fi - # Delete the IPA/IPO (Inter Procedural Analysis/Optimization) information - # created by the PGI compiler (conftest_ipa8_conftest.oo), as it would - # interfere with the next link command; also delete a directory that is - # left behind by Apple's compiler. We do this before executing the actions. - rm -rf conftest.dSYM conftest_ipa8_conftest.oo - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - as_fn_set_status $ac_retval - -} # ac_fn_c_try_link - -# ac_fn_c_check_func LINENO FUNC VAR -# ---------------------------------- -# Tests whether FUNC exists, setting the cache variable VAR accordingly -ac_fn_c_check_func () -{ - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$1"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $2" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $2... " >&6; } -if eval \${$3+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -/* Define $2 to an innocuous variant, in case declares $2. - For example, HP-UX 11i declares gettimeofday. */ -#define $2 innocuous_$2 - -/* System header to define __stub macros and hopefully few prototypes, - which can conflict with char $2 (); below. - Prefer to if __STDC__ is defined, since - exists even on freestanding compilers. */ - -#ifdef __STDC__ -# include -#else -# include -#endif - -#undef $2 - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char $2 (); -/* The GNU C library defines this for functions which it implements - to always fail with ENOSYS. Some functions are actually named - something starting with __ and the normal name is an alias. */ -#if defined __stub_$2 || defined __stub___$2 -choke me -#endif - -int -main () -{ -return $2 (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - eval "$3=yes" -else - eval "$3=no" -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -eval ac_res=\$$3 - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_res" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_res" >&6; } - eval $as_lineno_stack; ${as_lineno_stack:+:} unset as_lineno - -} # ac_fn_c_check_func -cat >config.log <<_ACEOF -This file contains any messages produced by compilers while -running configure, to aid debugging if configure makes a mistake. - -It was created by tkblt $as_me 3.2, which was -generated by GNU Autoconf 2.69. Invocation command line was - - $ $0 $@ - -_ACEOF -exec 5>>config.log -{ -cat <<_ASUNAME -## --------- ## -## Platform. ## -## --------- ## - -hostname = `(hostname || uname -n) 2>/dev/null | sed 1q` -uname -m = `(uname -m) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -uname -r = `(uname -r) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -uname -s = `(uname -s) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -uname -v = `(uname -v) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` - -/usr/bin/uname -p = `(/usr/bin/uname -p) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/bin/uname -X = `(/bin/uname -X) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` - -/bin/arch = `(/bin/arch) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/usr/bin/arch -k = `(/usr/bin/arch -k) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/usr/convex/getsysinfo = `(/usr/convex/getsysinfo) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/usr/bin/hostinfo = `(/usr/bin/hostinfo) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/bin/machine = `(/bin/machine) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/usr/bin/oslevel = `(/usr/bin/oslevel) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` -/bin/universe = `(/bin/universe) 2>/dev/null || echo unknown` - -_ASUNAME - -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - $as_echo "PATH: $as_dir" - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -} >&5 - -cat >&5 <<_ACEOF - - -## ----------- ## -## Core tests. ## -## ----------- ## - -_ACEOF - - -# Keep a trace of the command line. -# Strip out --no-create and --no-recursion so they do not pile up. -# Strip out --silent because we don't want to record it for future runs. -# Also quote any args containing shell meta-characters. -# Make two passes to allow for proper duplicate-argument suppression. -ac_configure_args= -ac_configure_args0= -ac_configure_args1= -ac_must_keep_next=false -for ac_pass in 1 2 -do - for ac_arg - do - case $ac_arg in - -no-create | --no-c* | -n | -no-recursion | --no-r*) continue ;; - -q | -quiet | --quiet | --quie | --qui | --qu | --q \ - | -silent | --silent | --silen | --sile | --sil) - continue ;; - *\'*) - ac_arg=`$as_echo "$ac_arg" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"` ;; - esac - case $ac_pass in - 1) as_fn_append ac_configure_args0 " '$ac_arg'" ;; - 2) - as_fn_append ac_configure_args1 " '$ac_arg'" - if test $ac_must_keep_next = true; then - ac_must_keep_next=false # Got value, back to normal. - else - case $ac_arg in - *=* | --config-cache | -C | -disable-* | --disable-* \ - | -enable-* | --enable-* | -gas | --g* | -nfp | --nf* \ - | -q | -quiet | --q* | -silent | --sil* | -v | -verb* \ - | -with-* | --with-* | -without-* | --without-* | --x) - case "$ac_configure_args0 " in - "$ac_configure_args1"*" '$ac_arg' "* ) continue ;; - esac - ;; - -* ) ac_must_keep_next=true ;; - esac - fi - as_fn_append ac_configure_args " '$ac_arg'" - ;; - esac - done -done -{ ac_configure_args0=; unset ac_configure_args0;} -{ ac_configure_args1=; unset ac_configure_args1;} - -# When interrupted or exit'd, cleanup temporary files, and complete -# config.log. We remove comments because anyway the quotes in there -# would cause problems or look ugly. -# WARNING: Use '\'' to represent an apostrophe within the trap. -# WARNING: Do not start the trap code with a newline, due to a FreeBSD 4.0 bug. -trap 'exit_status=$? - # Save into config.log some information that might help in debugging. - { - echo - - $as_echo "## ---------------- ## -## Cache variables. ## -## ---------------- ##" - echo - # The following way of writing the cache mishandles newlines in values, -( - for ac_var in `(set) 2>&1 | sed -n '\''s/^\([a-zA-Z_][a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)=.*/\1/p'\''`; do - eval ac_val=\$$ac_var - case $ac_val in #( - *${as_nl}*) - case $ac_var in #( - *_cv_*) { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: cache variable $ac_var contains a newline" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: cache variable $ac_var contains a newline" >&2;} ;; - esac - case $ac_var in #( - _ | IFS | as_nl) ;; #( - BASH_ARGV | BASH_SOURCE) eval $ac_var= ;; #( - *) { eval $ac_var=; unset $ac_var;} ;; - esac ;; - esac - done - (set) 2>&1 | - case $as_nl`(ac_space='\'' '\''; set) 2>&1` in #( - *${as_nl}ac_space=\ *) - sed -n \ - "s/'\''/'\''\\\\'\'''\''/g; - s/^\\([_$as_cr_alnum]*_cv_[_$as_cr_alnum]*\\)=\\(.*\\)/\\1='\''\\2'\''/p" - ;; #( - *) - sed -n "/^[_$as_cr_alnum]*_cv_[_$as_cr_alnum]*=/p" - ;; - esac | - sort -) - echo - - $as_echo "## ----------------- ## -## Output variables. ## -## ----------------- ##" - echo - for ac_var in $ac_subst_vars - do - eval ac_val=\$$ac_var - case $ac_val in - *\'\''*) ac_val=`$as_echo "$ac_val" | sed "s/'\''/'\''\\\\\\\\'\'''\''/g"`;; - esac - $as_echo "$ac_var='\''$ac_val'\''" - done | sort - echo - - if test -n "$ac_subst_files"; then - $as_echo "## ------------------- ## -## File substitutions. ## -## ------------------- ##" - echo - for ac_var in $ac_subst_files - do - eval ac_val=\$$ac_var - case $ac_val in - *\'\''*) ac_val=`$as_echo "$ac_val" | sed "s/'\''/'\''\\\\\\\\'\'''\''/g"`;; - esac - $as_echo "$ac_var='\''$ac_val'\''" - done | sort - echo - fi - - if test -s confdefs.h; then - $as_echo "## ----------- ## -## confdefs.h. ## -## ----------- ##" - echo - cat confdefs.h - echo - fi - test "$ac_signal" != 0 && - $as_echo "$as_me: caught signal $ac_signal" - $as_echo "$as_me: exit $exit_status" - } >&5 - rm -f core *.core core.conftest.* && - rm -f -r conftest* confdefs* conf$$* $ac_clean_files && - exit $exit_status -' 0 -for ac_signal in 1 2 13 15; do - trap 'ac_signal='$ac_signal'; as_fn_exit 1' $ac_signal -done -ac_signal=0 - -# confdefs.h avoids OS command line length limits that DEFS can exceed. -rm -f -r conftest* confdefs.h - -$as_echo "/* confdefs.h */" > confdefs.h - -# Predefined preprocessor variables. - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_NAME "$PACKAGE_NAME" -_ACEOF - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_TARNAME "$PACKAGE_TARNAME" -_ACEOF - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_VERSION "$PACKAGE_VERSION" -_ACEOF - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_STRING "$PACKAGE_STRING" -_ACEOF - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_BUGREPORT "$PACKAGE_BUGREPORT" -_ACEOF - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define PACKAGE_URL "$PACKAGE_URL" -_ACEOF - - -# Let the site file select an alternate cache file if it wants to. -# Prefer an explicitly selected file to automatically selected ones. -ac_site_file1=NONE -ac_site_file2=NONE -if test -n "$CONFIG_SITE"; then - # We do not want a PATH search for config.site. - case $CONFIG_SITE in #(( - -*) ac_site_file1=./$CONFIG_SITE;; - */*) ac_site_file1=$CONFIG_SITE;; - *) ac_site_file1=./$CONFIG_SITE;; - esac -elif test "x$prefix" != xNONE; then - ac_site_file1=$prefix/share/config.site - ac_site_file2=$prefix/etc/config.site -else - ac_site_file1=$ac_default_prefix/share/config.site - ac_site_file2=$ac_default_prefix/etc/config.site -fi -for ac_site_file in "$ac_site_file1" "$ac_site_file2" -do - test "x$ac_site_file" = xNONE && continue - if test /dev/null != "$ac_site_file" && test -r "$ac_site_file"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: loading site script $ac_site_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: loading site script $ac_site_file" >&6;} - sed 's/^/| /' "$ac_site_file" >&5 - . "$ac_site_file" \ - || { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "failed to load site script $ac_site_file -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } - fi -done - -if test -r "$cache_file"; then - # Some versions of bash will fail to source /dev/null (special files - # actually), so we avoid doing that. DJGPP emulates it as a regular file. - if test /dev/null != "$cache_file" && test -f "$cache_file"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: loading cache $cache_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: loading cache $cache_file" >&6;} - case $cache_file in - [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]* ) . "$cache_file";; - *) . "./$cache_file";; - esac - fi -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: creating cache $cache_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: creating cache $cache_file" >&6;} - >$cache_file -fi - -# Check that the precious variables saved in the cache have kept the same -# value. -ac_cache_corrupted=false -for ac_var in $ac_precious_vars; do - eval ac_old_set=\$ac_cv_env_${ac_var}_set - eval ac_new_set=\$ac_env_${ac_var}_set - eval ac_old_val=\$ac_cv_env_${ac_var}_value - eval ac_new_val=\$ac_env_${ac_var}_value - case $ac_old_set,$ac_new_set in - set,) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: \`$ac_var' was set to \`$ac_old_val' in the previous run" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: \`$ac_var' was set to \`$ac_old_val' in the previous run" >&2;} - ac_cache_corrupted=: ;; - ,set) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: \`$ac_var' was not set in the previous run" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: \`$ac_var' was not set in the previous run" >&2;} - ac_cache_corrupted=: ;; - ,);; - *) - if test "x$ac_old_val" != "x$ac_new_val"; then - # differences in whitespace do not lead to failure. - ac_old_val_w=`echo x $ac_old_val` - ac_new_val_w=`echo x $ac_new_val` - if test "$ac_old_val_w" != "$ac_new_val_w"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: \`$ac_var' has changed since the previous run:" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: \`$ac_var' has changed since the previous run:" >&2;} - ac_cache_corrupted=: - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: warning: ignoring whitespace changes in \`$ac_var' since the previous run:" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: warning: ignoring whitespace changes in \`$ac_var' since the previous run:" >&2;} - eval $ac_var=\$ac_old_val - fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: former value: \`$ac_old_val'" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: former value: \`$ac_old_val'" >&2;} - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: current value: \`$ac_new_val'" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: current value: \`$ac_new_val'" >&2;} - fi;; - esac - # Pass precious variables to config.status. - if test "$ac_new_set" = set; then - case $ac_new_val in - *\'*) ac_arg=$ac_var=`$as_echo "$ac_new_val" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"` ;; - *) ac_arg=$ac_var=$ac_new_val ;; - esac - case " $ac_configure_args " in - *" '$ac_arg' "*) ;; # Avoid dups. Use of quotes ensures accuracy. - *) as_fn_append ac_configure_args " '$ac_arg'" ;; - esac - fi -done -if $ac_cache_corrupted; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: changes in the environment can compromise the build" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: changes in the environment can compromise the build" >&2;} - as_fn_error $? "run \`make distclean' and/or \`rm $cache_file' and start over" "$LINENO" 5 -fi -## -------------------- ## -## Main body of script. ## -## -------------------- ## - -ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Call TEA_INIT as the first TEA_ macro to set up initial vars. -# This will define a ${TEA_PLATFORM} variable == "unix" or "windows" -# as well as PKG_LIB_FILE and PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - TEA_VERSION="3.13" - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking TEA configuration" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking TEA configuration... " >&6; } - if test x"${PACKAGE_NAME}" = x ; then - as_fn_error $? " -The PACKAGE_NAME variable must be defined by your TEA configure.ac" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ok (TEA ${TEA_VERSION})" >&5 -$as_echo "ok (TEA ${TEA_VERSION})" >&6; } - - # If the user did not set CFLAGS, set it now to keep macros - # like AC_PROG_CC and AC_TRY_COMPILE from adding "-g -O2". - if test "${CFLAGS+set}" != "set" ; then - CFLAGS="" - fi - - case "`uname -s`" in - *win32*|*WIN32*|*MINGW32_*|*MINGW64_*) - # Extract the first word of "cygpath", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy cygpath; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CYGPATH"; then - ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="$CYGPATH" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="cygpath -m" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - - test -z "$ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH" && ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="echo" -fi -fi -CYGPATH=$ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH -if test -n "$CYGPATH"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CYGPATH" >&5 -$as_echo "$CYGPATH" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - EXEEXT=".exe" - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - ;; - *CYGWIN_*) - EXEEXT=".exe" - # CYGPATH and TEA_PLATFORM are determined later in LOAD_TCLCONFIG - ;; - *) - CYGPATH=echo - # Maybe we are cross-compiling.... - case ${host_alias} in - *mingw32*) - EXEEXT=".exe" - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - ;; - *) - EXEEXT="" - TEA_PLATFORM="unix" - ;; - esac - ;; - esac - - # Check if exec_prefix is set. If not use fall back to prefix. - # Note when adjusted, so that TEA_PREFIX can correct for this. - # This is needed for recursive configures, since autoconf propagates - # $prefix, but not $exec_prefix (doh!). - if test x$exec_prefix = xNONE ; then - exec_prefix_default=yes - exec_prefix=$prefix - fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: configuring ${PACKAGE_NAME} ${PACKAGE_VERSION}" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: configuring ${PACKAGE_NAME} ${PACKAGE_VERSION}" >&6;} - - - - - # This package name must be replaced statically for AC_SUBST to work - - # Substitute STUB_LIB_FILE in case package creates a stub library too. - - - # We AC_SUBST these here to ensure they are subst'ed, - # in case the user doesn't call TEA_ADD_... - - - - - - - - - # Configure the installer. - - INSTALL='$(SHELL) $(srcdir)/tclconfig/install-sh -c' - INSTALL_DATA_DIR='${INSTALL} -d -m 755' - INSTALL_DATA='${INSTALL} -m 644' - INSTALL_PROGRAM='${INSTALL} -m 755' - INSTALL_SCRIPT='${INSTALL} -m 755' - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking system version" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking system version... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_sys_version+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - # TEA specific: - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=windows - else - tcl_cv_sys_version=`uname -s`-`uname -r` - if test "$?" -ne 0 ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: can't find uname command" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: can't find uname command" >&2;} - tcl_cv_sys_version=unknown - else - if test "`uname -s`" = "AIX" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=AIX-`uname -v`.`uname -r` - fi - fi - fi - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_sys_version" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_sys_version" >&6; } - system=$tcl_cv_sys_version - - case $system in - HP-UX-*) INSTALL_LIBRARY='${INSTALL} -m 755' ;; - *) INSTALL_LIBRARY='${INSTALL} -m 644' ;; - esac - - - - - - - - - - -ac_aux_dir= -for ac_dir in tclconfig "$srcdir"/tclconfig; do - if test -f "$ac_dir/install-sh"; then - ac_aux_dir=$ac_dir - ac_install_sh="$ac_aux_dir/install-sh -c" - break - elif test -f "$ac_dir/install.sh"; then - ac_aux_dir=$ac_dir - ac_install_sh="$ac_aux_dir/install.sh -c" - break - elif test -f "$ac_dir/shtool"; then - ac_aux_dir=$ac_dir - ac_install_sh="$ac_aux_dir/shtool install -c" - break - fi -done -if test -z "$ac_aux_dir"; then - as_fn_error $? "cannot find install-sh, install.sh, or shtool in tclconfig \"$srcdir\"/tclconfig" "$LINENO" 5 -fi - -# These three variables are undocumented and unsupported, -# and are intended to be withdrawn in a future Autoconf release. -# They can cause serious problems if a builder's source tree is in a directory -# whose full name contains unusual characters. -ac_config_guess="$SHELL $ac_aux_dir/config.guess" # Please don't use this var. -ac_config_sub="$SHELL $ac_aux_dir/config.sub" # Please don't use this var. -ac_configure="$SHELL $ac_aux_dir/configure" # Please don't use this var. - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Load the tclConfig.sh file -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - - # - # Ok, lets find the tcl configuration - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tcl - # - - if test x"${no_tcl}" = x ; then - # we reset no_tcl in case something fails here - no_tcl=true - -# Check whether --with-tcl was given. -if test "${with_tcl+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_tcl; with_tclconfig="${withval}" -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tcl configuration" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tcl configuration... " >&6; } - if ${ac_cv_c_tclconfig+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - - # First check to see if --with-tcl was specified. - if test x"${with_tclconfig}" != x ; then - case "${with_tclconfig}" in - */tclConfig.sh ) - if test -f "${with_tclconfig}"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: --with-tcl argument should refer to directory containing tclConfig.sh, not to tclConfig.sh itself" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: --with-tcl argument should refer to directory containing tclConfig.sh, not to tclConfig.sh itself" >&2;} - with_tclconfig="`echo "${with_tclconfig}" | sed 's!/tclConfig\.sh$!!'`" - fi ;; - esac - if test -f "${with_tclconfig}/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd "${with_tclconfig}"; pwd)`" - else - as_fn_error $? "${with_tclconfig} directory doesn't contain tclConfig.sh" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - fi - - # then check for a private Tcl installation - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # on Darwin, check in Framework installation locations - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin" -a x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ~/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Network/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /System/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Network/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/System/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/Tcl.framework/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/Tcl.framework; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # TEA specific: on Windows, check in common installation locations - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d C:/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d C:/Progra~1/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few common install locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${exec_prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/pkg/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few other private locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ${srcdir}/../tcl \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - -fi - - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - TCL_BIN_DIR="# no Tcl configs found" - as_fn_error $? "Can't find Tcl configuration definitions. Use --with-tcl to specify a directory containing tclConfig.sh" "$LINENO" 5 - else - no_tcl= - TCL_BIN_DIR="${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: found ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo "found ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" >&6; } - fi - fi - -ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu -if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}gcc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}gcc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="${ac_tool_prefix}gcc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_CC"; then - ac_ct_CC=$CC - # Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_ct_CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="gcc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_CC=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC -if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_CC" = x; then - CC="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - CC=$ac_ct_CC - fi -else - CC="$ac_cv_prog_CC" -fi - -if test -z "$CC"; then - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}cc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}cc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="${ac_tool_prefix}cc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - fi -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - # Extract the first word of "cc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy cc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else - ac_prog_rejected=no -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - if test "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" = "/usr/ucb/cc"; then - ac_prog_rejected=yes - continue - fi - ac_cv_prog_CC="cc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -if test $ac_prog_rejected = yes; then - # We found a bogon in the path, so make sure we never use it. - set dummy $ac_cv_prog_CC - shift - if test $# != 0; then - # We chose a different compiler from the bogus one. - # However, it has the same basename, so the bogon will be chosen - # first if we set CC to just the basename; use the full file name. - shift - ac_cv_prog_CC="$as_dir/$ac_word${1+' '}$@" - fi -fi -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - for ac_prog in cl.exe - do - # Extract the first word of "$ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy $ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - test -n "$CC" && break - done -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - ac_ct_CC=$CC - for ac_prog in cl.exe -do - # Extract the first word of "$ac_prog", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy $ac_prog; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_ct_CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_prog" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_CC=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC -if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - test -n "$ac_ct_CC" && break -done - - if test "x$ac_ct_CC" = x; then - CC="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - CC=$ac_ct_CC - fi -fi - -fi - - -test -z "$CC" && { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "no acceptable C compiler found in \$PATH -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } - -# Provide some information about the compiler. -$as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for C compiler version" >&5 -set X $ac_compile -ac_compiler=$2 -for ac_option in --version -v -V -qversion; do - { { ac_try="$ac_compiler $ac_option >&5" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_compiler $ac_option >&5") 2>conftest.err - ac_status=$? - if test -s conftest.err; then - sed '10a\ -... rest of stderr output deleted ... - 10q' conftest.err >conftest.er1 - cat conftest.er1 >&5 - fi - rm -f conftest.er1 conftest.err - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } -done - -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -ac_clean_files_save=$ac_clean_files -ac_clean_files="$ac_clean_files a.out a.out.dSYM a.exe b.out" -# Try to create an executable without -o first, disregard a.out. -# It will help us diagnose broken compilers, and finding out an intuition -# of exeext. -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether the C compiler works" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether the C compiler works... " >&6; } -ac_link_default=`$as_echo "$ac_link" | sed 's/ -o *conftest[^ ]*//'` - -# The possible output files: -ac_files="a.out conftest.exe conftest a.exe a_out.exe b.out conftest.*" - -ac_rmfiles= -for ac_file in $ac_files -do - case $ac_file in - *.$ac_ext | *.xcoff | *.tds | *.d | *.pdb | *.xSYM | *.bb | *.bbg | *.map | *.inf | *.dSYM | *.o | *.obj ) ;; - * ) ac_rmfiles="$ac_rmfiles $ac_file";; - esac -done -rm -f $ac_rmfiles - -if { { ac_try="$ac_link_default" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_link_default") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; }; then : - # Autoconf-2.13 could set the ac_cv_exeext variable to `no'. -# So ignore a value of `no', otherwise this would lead to `EXEEXT = no' -# in a Makefile. We should not override ac_cv_exeext if it was cached, -# so that the user can short-circuit this test for compilers unknown to -# Autoconf. -for ac_file in $ac_files '' -do - test -f "$ac_file" || continue - case $ac_file in - *.$ac_ext | *.xcoff | *.tds | *.d | *.pdb | *.xSYM | *.bb | *.bbg | *.map | *.inf | *.dSYM | *.o | *.obj ) - ;; - [ab].out ) - # We found the default executable, but exeext='' is most - # certainly right. - break;; - *.* ) - if test "${ac_cv_exeext+set}" = set && test "$ac_cv_exeext" != no; - then :; else - ac_cv_exeext=`expr "$ac_file" : '[^.]*\(\..*\)'` - fi - # We set ac_cv_exeext here because the later test for it is not - # safe: cross compilers may not add the suffix if given an `-o' - # argument, so we may need to know it at that point already. - # Even if this section looks crufty: it has the advantage of - # actually working. - break;; - * ) - break;; - esac -done -test "$ac_cv_exeext" = no && ac_cv_exeext= - -else - ac_file='' -fi -if test -z "$ac_file"; then : - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -$as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - -{ { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error 77 "C compiler cannot create executables -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: yes" >&5 -$as_echo "yes" >&6; } -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for C compiler default output file name" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for C compiler default output file name... " >&6; } -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_file" >&6; } -ac_exeext=$ac_cv_exeext - -rm -f -r a.out a.out.dSYM a.exe conftest$ac_cv_exeext b.out -ac_clean_files=$ac_clean_files_save -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for suffix of executables" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for suffix of executables... " >&6; } -if { { ac_try="$ac_link" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_link") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; }; then : - # If both `conftest.exe' and `conftest' are `present' (well, observable) -# catch `conftest.exe'. For instance with Cygwin, `ls conftest' will -# work properly (i.e., refer to `conftest.exe'), while it won't with -# `rm'. -for ac_file in conftest.exe conftest conftest.*; do - test -f "$ac_file" || continue - case $ac_file in - *.$ac_ext | *.xcoff | *.tds | *.d | *.pdb | *.xSYM | *.bb | *.bbg | *.map | *.inf | *.dSYM | *.o | *.obj ) ;; - *.* ) ac_cv_exeext=`expr "$ac_file" : '[^.]*\(\..*\)'` - break;; - * ) break;; - esac -done -else - { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "cannot compute suffix of executables: cannot compile and link -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } -fi -rm -f conftest conftest$ac_cv_exeext -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_exeext" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_exeext" >&6; } - -rm -f conftest.$ac_ext -EXEEXT=$ac_cv_exeext -ac_exeext=$EXEEXT -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -FILE *f = fopen ("conftest.out", "w"); - return ferror (f) || fclose (f) != 0; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -ac_clean_files="$ac_clean_files conftest.out" -# Check that the compiler produces executables we can run. If not, either -# the compiler is broken, or we cross compile. -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether we are cross compiling" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether we are cross compiling... " >&6; } -if test "$cross_compiling" != yes; then - { { ac_try="$ac_link" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_link") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } - if { ac_try='./conftest$ac_cv_exeext' - { { case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_try") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; }; }; then - cross_compiling=no - else - if test "$cross_compiling" = maybe; then - cross_compiling=yes - else - { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "cannot run C compiled programs. -If you meant to cross compile, use \`--host'. -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } - fi - fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $cross_compiling" >&5 -$as_echo "$cross_compiling" >&6; } - -rm -f conftest.$ac_ext conftest$ac_cv_exeext conftest.out -ac_clean_files=$ac_clean_files_save -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for suffix of object files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for suffix of object files... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_objext+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -rm -f conftest.o conftest.obj -if { { ac_try="$ac_compile" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_compile") 2>&5 - ac_status=$? - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; }; then : - for ac_file in conftest.o conftest.obj conftest.*; do - test -f "$ac_file" || continue; - case $ac_file in - *.$ac_ext | *.xcoff | *.tds | *.d | *.pdb | *.xSYM | *.bb | *.bbg | *.map | *.inf | *.dSYM ) ;; - *) ac_cv_objext=`expr "$ac_file" : '.*\.\(.*\)'` - break;; - esac -done -else - $as_echo "$as_me: failed program was:" >&5 -sed 's/^/| /' conftest.$ac_ext >&5 - -{ { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "cannot compute suffix of object files: cannot compile -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } -fi -rm -f conftest.$ac_cv_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_objext" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_objext" >&6; } -OBJEXT=$ac_cv_objext -ac_objext=$OBJEXT -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether we are using the GNU C compiler" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether we are using the GNU C compiler... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -#ifndef __GNUC__ - choke me -#endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_compiler_gnu=yes -else - ac_compiler_gnu=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu=$ac_compiler_gnu - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu" >&6; } -if test $ac_compiler_gnu = yes; then - GCC=yes -else - GCC= -fi -ac_test_CFLAGS=${CFLAGS+set} -ac_save_CFLAGS=$CFLAGS -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether $CC accepts -g" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether $CC accepts -g... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_cc_g+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_save_c_werror_flag=$ac_c_werror_flag - ac_c_werror_flag=yes - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=no - CFLAGS="-g" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=yes -else - CFLAGS="" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - -else - ac_c_werror_flag=$ac_save_c_werror_flag - CFLAGS="-g" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=yes -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - ac_c_werror_flag=$ac_save_c_werror_flag -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_prog_cc_g" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_prog_cc_g" >&6; } -if test "$ac_test_CFLAGS" = set; then - CFLAGS=$ac_save_CFLAGS -elif test $ac_cv_prog_cc_g = yes; then - if test "$GCC" = yes; then - CFLAGS="-g -O2" - else - CFLAGS="-g" - fi -else - if test "$GCC" = yes; then - CFLAGS="-O2" - else - CFLAGS= - fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $CC option to accept ISO C89" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $CC option to accept ISO C89... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_cc_c89+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_cv_prog_cc_c89=no -ac_save_CC=$CC -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -#include -struct stat; -/* Most of the following tests are stolen from RCS 5.7's src/conf.sh. */ -struct buf { int x; }; -FILE * (*rcsopen) (struct buf *, struct stat *, int); -static char *e (p, i) - char **p; - int i; -{ - return p[i]; -} -static char *f (char * (*g) (char **, int), char **p, ...) -{ - char *s; - va_list v; - va_start (v,p); - s = g (p, va_arg (v,int)); - va_end (v); - return s; -} - -/* OSF 4.0 Compaq cc is some sort of almost-ANSI by default. It has - function prototypes and stuff, but not '\xHH' hex character constants. - These don't provoke an error unfortunately, instead are silently treated - as 'x'. The following induces an error, until -std is added to get - proper ANSI mode. Curiously '\x00'!='x' always comes out true, for an - array size at least. It's necessary to write '\x00'==0 to get something - that's true only with -std. */ -int osf4_cc_array ['\x00' == 0 ? 1 : -1]; - -/* IBM C 6 for AIX is almost-ANSI by default, but it replaces macro parameters - inside strings and character constants. */ -#define FOO(x) 'x' -int xlc6_cc_array[FOO(a) == 'x' ? 1 : -1]; - -int test (int i, double x); -struct s1 {int (*f) (int a);}; -struct s2 {int (*f) (double a);}; -int pairnames (int, char **, FILE *(*)(struct buf *, struct stat *, int), int, int); -int argc; -char **argv; -int -main () -{ -return f (e, argv, 0) != argv[0] || f (e, argv, 1) != argv[1]; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -for ac_arg in '' -qlanglvl=extc89 -qlanglvl=ansi -std \ - -Ae "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE" "-Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__" -do - CC="$ac_save_CC $ac_arg" - if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_c89=$ac_arg -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext - test "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" != "xno" && break -done -rm -f conftest.$ac_ext -CC=$ac_save_CC - -fi -# AC_CACHE_VAL -case "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" in - x) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: none needed" >&5 -$as_echo "none needed" >&6; } ;; - xno) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: unsupported" >&5 -$as_echo "unsupported" >&6; } ;; - *) - CC="$CC $ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" >&6; } ;; -esac -if test "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" != xno; then : - -fi - -ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for existence of ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for existence of ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh... " >&6; } - - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: loading" >&5 -$as_echo "loading" >&6; } - . "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: could not find ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo "could not find ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" >&6; } - fi - - # eval is required to do the TCL_DBGX substitution - eval "TCL_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_LIB_FILE}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}\"" - - # If the TCL_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), - # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. - # For example, the variable TCL_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value - # of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of TCL_LIB_SPEC - # instead of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an - # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - TCL_LIB_SPEC="${TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC="${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH}" - elif test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use the libraries - # from the framework at the given location so that linking works - # against Tcl.framework installed in an arbitrary location. - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_LIB_FILE}"; then - for i in "`cd "${TCL_BIN_DIR}"; pwd`" \ - "`cd "${TCL_BIN_DIR}"/../..; pwd`"; do - if test "`basename "$i"`" = "${TCL_LIB_FILE}.framework"; then - TCL_LIB_SPEC="-F`dirname "$i" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` -framework ${TCL_LIB_FILE}" - break - fi - done - fi - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}"; then - TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`echo "${TCL_BIN_DIR}" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` ${TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - fi - ;; - esac - fi - - # eval is required to do the TCL_DBGX substitution - eval "TCL_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TCL_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_LIB_SPEC}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC}\"" - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking platform" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking platform... " >&6; } - hold_cc=$CC; CC="$TCL_CC" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - #ifdef _WIN32 - #error win32 - #endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - - TEA_PLATFORM="unix" - CYGPATH=echo - -else - - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - # Extract the first word of "cygpath", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy cygpath; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CYGPATH"; then - ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="$CYGPATH" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="cygpath -m" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - - test -z "$ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH" && ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH="echo" -fi -fi -CYGPATH=$ac_cv_prog_CYGPATH -if test -n "$CYGPATH"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CYGPATH" >&5 -$as_echo "$CYGPATH" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - CC=$hold_cc - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $TEA_PLATFORM" >&5 -$as_echo "$TEA_PLATFORM" >&6; } - - # The BUILD_$pkg is to define the correct extern storage class - # handling when making this package - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define BUILD_${PACKAGE_NAME} /**/ -_ACEOF - - # Do this here as we have fully defined TEA_PLATFORM now - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - EXEEXT=".exe" - CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES *.lib *.dll *.pdb *.exp" - fi - - # TEA specific: - - - - - - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Load the tkConfig.sh file if necessary (Tk extension) -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - # - # Ok, lets find the tk configuration - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tk - # - - if test x"${no_tk}" = x ; then - # we reset no_tk in case something fails here - no_tk=true - -# Check whether --with-tk was given. -if test "${with_tk+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_tk; with_tkconfig="${withval}" -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tk configuration" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tk configuration... " >&6; } - if ${ac_cv_c_tkconfig+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - - # First check to see if --with-tkconfig was specified. - if test x"${with_tkconfig}" != x ; then - case "${with_tkconfig}" in - */tkConfig.sh ) - if test -f "${with_tkconfig}"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: --with-tk argument should refer to directory containing tkConfig.sh, not to tkConfig.sh itself" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: --with-tk argument should refer to directory containing tkConfig.sh, not to tkConfig.sh itself" >&2;} - with_tkconfig="`echo "${with_tkconfig}" | sed 's!/tkConfig\.sh$!!'`" - fi ;; - esac - if test -f "${with_tkconfig}/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd "${with_tkconfig}"; pwd)`" - else - as_fn_error $? "${with_tkconfig} directory doesn't contain tkConfig.sh" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - fi - - # then check for a private Tk library - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../tk \ - `ls -dr ../tk[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tk[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tk[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../tk \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../../tk \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # on Darwin, check in Framework installation locations - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin" -a x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ~/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Network/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /System/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Network/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/System/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/Tk.framework/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/Tk.framework; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few common install locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${exec_prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/pkg/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # TEA specific: on Windows, check in common installation locations - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d C:/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d C:/Progra~1/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few other private locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ${srcdir}/../tk \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[8-9].[0-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[8-9].[0-9] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[8-9].[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - -fi - - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - TK_BIN_DIR="# no Tk configs found" - as_fn_error $? "Can't find Tk configuration definitions. Use --with-tk to specify a directory containing tkConfig.sh" "$LINENO" 5 - else - no_tk= - TK_BIN_DIR="${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: found ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo "found ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" >&6; } - fi - fi - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for existence of ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for existence of ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh... " >&6; } - - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: loading" >&5 -$as_echo "loading" >&6; } - . "${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: could not find ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" >&5 -$as_echo "could not find ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" >&6; } - fi - - # eval is required to do the TK_DBGX substitution - eval "TK_LIB_FILE=\"${TK_LIB_FILE}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_FILE=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}\"" - - # If the TK_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), - # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. - # For example, the variable TK_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value - # of TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of TK_LIB_SPEC - # instead of TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an - # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - TK_LIB_SPEC="${TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC}" - TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC="${TK_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - TK_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TK_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH}" - elif test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use the libraries - # from the framework at the given location so that linking works - # against Tk.framework installed in an arbitrary location. - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_LIB_FILE}"; then - for i in "`cd "${TK_BIN_DIR}"; pwd`" \ - "`cd "${TK_BIN_DIR}"/../..; pwd`"; do - if test "`basename "$i"`" = "${TK_LIB_FILE}.framework"; then - TK_LIB_SPEC="-F`dirname "$i" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` -framework ${TK_LIB_FILE}" - break - fi - done - fi - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}"; then - TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L` echo "${TK_BIN_DIR}" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` ${TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - TK_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - fi - ;; - esac - fi - - # eval is required to do the TK_DBGX substitution - eval "TK_LIB_FLAG=\"${TK_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TK_LIB_SPEC=\"${TK_LIB_SPEC}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}\"" - - # TEA specific: Ensure windowingsystem is defined - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" ; then - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *MAC_OSX_TK*) - -$as_echo "#define MAC_OSX_TK 1" >>confdefs.h - - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="aqua" - ;; - *) - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="x11" - ;; - esac - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="win32" - fi - - - - - - - - - - - - - - # TEA specific: - - - - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Handle the --prefix=... option by defaulting to what Tcl gave. -# Must be called after TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG and before TEA_SETUP_COMPILER. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - if test "${prefix}" = "NONE"; then - prefix_default=yes - if test x"${TCL_PREFIX}" != x; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: --prefix defaulting to TCL_PREFIX ${TCL_PREFIX}" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: --prefix defaulting to TCL_PREFIX ${TCL_PREFIX}" >&6;} - prefix=${TCL_PREFIX} - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: --prefix defaulting to /usr/local" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: --prefix defaulting to /usr/local" >&6;} - prefix=/usr/local - fi - fi - if test "${exec_prefix}" = "NONE" -a x"${prefix_default}" = x"yes" \ - -o x"${exec_prefix_default}" = x"yes" ; then - if test x"${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX}" != x; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: --exec-prefix defaulting to TCL_EXEC_PREFIX ${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX}" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: --exec-prefix defaulting to TCL_EXEC_PREFIX ${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX}" >&6;} - exec_prefix=${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX} - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: --exec-prefix defaulting to ${prefix}" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: --exec-prefix defaulting to ${prefix}" >&6;} - exec_prefix=$prefix - fi - fi - - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Standard compiler checks. -# This sets up CC by using the CC env var, or looks for gcc otherwise. -# This also calls AC_PROG_CC and a few others to create the basic setup -# necessary to compile executables. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - # Don't put any macros that use the compiler (e.g. AC_TRY_COMPILE) - # in this macro, they need to go into TEA_SETUP_COMPILER instead. - - ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu -if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}gcc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}gcc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="${ac_tool_prefix}gcc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_CC"; then - ac_ct_CC=$CC - # Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_ct_CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="gcc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_CC=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC -if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_CC" = x; then - CC="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - CC=$ac_ct_CC - fi -else - CC="$ac_cv_prog_CC" -fi - -if test -z "$CC"; then - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}cc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}cc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="${ac_tool_prefix}cc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - fi -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - # Extract the first word of "cc", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy cc; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else - ac_prog_rejected=no -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - if test "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" = "/usr/ucb/cc"; then - ac_prog_rejected=yes - continue - fi - ac_cv_prog_CC="cc" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -if test $ac_prog_rejected = yes; then - # We found a bogon in the path, so make sure we never use it. - set dummy $ac_cv_prog_CC - shift - if test $# != 0; then - # We chose a different compiler from the bogus one. - # However, it has the same basename, so the bogon will be chosen - # first if we set CC to just the basename; use the full file name. - shift - ac_cv_prog_CC="$as_dir/$ac_word${1+' '}$@" - fi -fi -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - for ac_prog in cl.exe - do - # Extract the first word of "$ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy $ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_CC="$ac_tool_prefix$ac_prog" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -CC=$ac_cv_prog_CC -if test -n "$CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - test -n "$CC" && break - done -fi -if test -z "$CC"; then - ac_ct_CC=$CC - for ac_prog in cl.exe -do - # Extract the first word of "$ac_prog", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy $ac_prog; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_ct_CC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC="$ac_prog" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_CC=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_CC -if test -n "$ac_ct_CC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_CC" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_CC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - - test -n "$ac_ct_CC" && break -done - - if test "x$ac_ct_CC" = x; then - CC="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - CC=$ac_ct_CC - fi -fi - -fi - - -test -z "$CC" && { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "no acceptable C compiler found in \$PATH -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } - -# Provide some information about the compiler. -$as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for C compiler version" >&5 -set X $ac_compile -ac_compiler=$2 -for ac_option in --version -v -V -qversion; do - { { ac_try="$ac_compiler $ac_option >&5" -case "(($ac_try" in - *\"* | *\`* | *\\*) ac_try_echo=\$ac_try;; - *) ac_try_echo=$ac_try;; -esac -eval ac_try_echo="\"\$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: $ac_try_echo\"" -$as_echo "$ac_try_echo"; } >&5 - (eval "$ac_compiler $ac_option >&5") 2>conftest.err - ac_status=$? - if test -s conftest.err; then - sed '10a\ -... rest of stderr output deleted ... - 10q' conftest.err >conftest.er1 - cat conftest.er1 >&5 - fi - rm -f conftest.er1 conftest.err - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: \$? = $ac_status" >&5 - test $ac_status = 0; } -done - -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether we are using the GNU C compiler" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether we are using the GNU C compiler... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -#ifndef __GNUC__ - choke me -#endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_compiler_gnu=yes -else - ac_compiler_gnu=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu=$ac_compiler_gnu - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu" >&6; } -if test $ac_compiler_gnu = yes; then - GCC=yes -else - GCC= -fi -ac_test_CFLAGS=${CFLAGS+set} -ac_save_CFLAGS=$CFLAGS -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether $CC accepts -g" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether $CC accepts -g... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_cc_g+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_save_c_werror_flag=$ac_c_werror_flag - ac_c_werror_flag=yes - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=no - CFLAGS="-g" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=yes -else - CFLAGS="" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - -else - ac_c_werror_flag=$ac_save_c_werror_flag - CFLAGS="-g" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_g=yes -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - ac_c_werror_flag=$ac_save_c_werror_flag -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_prog_cc_g" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_prog_cc_g" >&6; } -if test "$ac_test_CFLAGS" = set; then - CFLAGS=$ac_save_CFLAGS -elif test $ac_cv_prog_cc_g = yes; then - if test "$GCC" = yes; then - CFLAGS="-g -O2" - else - CFLAGS="-g" - fi -else - if test "$GCC" = yes; then - CFLAGS="-O2" - else - CFLAGS= - fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $CC option to accept ISO C89" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $CC option to accept ISO C89... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_cc_c89+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_cv_prog_cc_c89=no -ac_save_CC=$CC -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -#include -struct stat; -/* Most of the following tests are stolen from RCS 5.7's src/conf.sh. */ -struct buf { int x; }; -FILE * (*rcsopen) (struct buf *, struct stat *, int); -static char *e (p, i) - char **p; - int i; -{ - return p[i]; -} -static char *f (char * (*g) (char **, int), char **p, ...) -{ - char *s; - va_list v; - va_start (v,p); - s = g (p, va_arg (v,int)); - va_end (v); - return s; -} - -/* OSF 4.0 Compaq cc is some sort of almost-ANSI by default. It has - function prototypes and stuff, but not '\xHH' hex character constants. - These don't provoke an error unfortunately, instead are silently treated - as 'x'. The following induces an error, until -std is added to get - proper ANSI mode. Curiously '\x00'!='x' always comes out true, for an - array size at least. It's necessary to write '\x00'==0 to get something - that's true only with -std. */ -int osf4_cc_array ['\x00' == 0 ? 1 : -1]; - -/* IBM C 6 for AIX is almost-ANSI by default, but it replaces macro parameters - inside strings and character constants. */ -#define FOO(x) 'x' -int xlc6_cc_array[FOO(a) == 'x' ? 1 : -1]; - -int test (int i, double x); -struct s1 {int (*f) (int a);}; -struct s2 {int (*f) (double a);}; -int pairnames (int, char **, FILE *(*)(struct buf *, struct stat *, int), int, int); -int argc; -char **argv; -int -main () -{ -return f (e, argv, 0) != argv[0] || f (e, argv, 1) != argv[1]; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -for ac_arg in '' -qlanglvl=extc89 -qlanglvl=ansi -std \ - -Ae "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE" "-Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__" -do - CC="$ac_save_CC $ac_arg" - if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_prog_cc_c89=$ac_arg -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext - test "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" != "xno" && break -done -rm -f conftest.$ac_ext -CC=$ac_save_CC - -fi -# AC_CACHE_VAL -case "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" in - x) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: none needed" >&5 -$as_echo "none needed" >&6; } ;; - xno) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: unsupported" >&5 -$as_echo "unsupported" >&6; } ;; - *) - CC="$CC $ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" >&6; } ;; -esac -if test "x$ac_cv_prog_cc_c89" != xno; then : - -fi - -ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu - - ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking how to run the C preprocessor" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking how to run the C preprocessor... " >&6; } -# On Suns, sometimes $CPP names a directory. -if test -n "$CPP" && test -d "$CPP"; then - CPP= -fi -if test -z "$CPP"; then - if ${ac_cv_prog_CPP+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - # Double quotes because CPP needs to be expanded - for CPP in "$CC -E" "$CC -E -traditional-cpp" "/lib/cpp" - do - ac_preproc_ok=false -for ac_c_preproc_warn_flag in '' yes -do - # Use a header file that comes with gcc, so configuring glibc - # with a fresh cross-compiler works. - # Prefer to if __STDC__ is defined, since - # exists even on freestanding compilers. - # On the NeXT, cc -E runs the code through the compiler's parser, - # not just through cpp. "Syntax error" is here to catch this case. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#ifdef __STDC__ -# include -#else -# include -#endif - Syntax error -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - -else - # Broken: fails on valid input. -continue -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - - # OK, works on sane cases. Now check whether nonexistent headers - # can be detected and how. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - # Broken: success on invalid input. -continue -else - # Passes both tests. -ac_preproc_ok=: -break -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - -done -# Because of `break', _AC_PREPROC_IFELSE's cleaning code was skipped. -rm -f conftest.i conftest.err conftest.$ac_ext -if $ac_preproc_ok; then : - break -fi - - done - ac_cv_prog_CPP=$CPP - -fi - CPP=$ac_cv_prog_CPP -else - ac_cv_prog_CPP=$CPP -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $CPP" >&5 -$as_echo "$CPP" >&6; } -ac_preproc_ok=false -for ac_c_preproc_warn_flag in '' yes -do - # Use a header file that comes with gcc, so configuring glibc - # with a fresh cross-compiler works. - # Prefer to if __STDC__ is defined, since - # exists even on freestanding compilers. - # On the NeXT, cc -E runs the code through the compiler's parser, - # not just through cpp. "Syntax error" is here to catch this case. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#ifdef __STDC__ -# include -#else -# include -#endif - Syntax error -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - -else - # Broken: fails on valid input. -continue -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - - # OK, works on sane cases. Now check whether nonexistent headers - # can be detected and how. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - # Broken: success on invalid input. -continue -else - # Passes both tests. -ac_preproc_ok=: -break -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - -done -# Because of `break', _AC_PREPROC_IFELSE's cleaning code was skipped. -rm -f conftest.i conftest.err conftest.$ac_ext -if $ac_preproc_ok; then : - -else - { { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: error: in \`$ac_pwd':" >&2;} -as_fn_error $? "C preprocessor \"$CPP\" fails sanity check -See \`config.log' for more details" "$LINENO" 5; } -fi - -ac_ext=c -ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS' -ac_compile='$CC -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext >&5' -ac_link='$CC -o conftest$ac_exeext $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS >&5' -ac_compiler_gnu=$ac_cv_c_compiler_gnu - - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Checks to see if the make program sets the $MAKE variable. - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether ${MAKE-make} sets \$(MAKE)" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether ${MAKE-make} sets \$(MAKE)... " >&6; } -set x ${MAKE-make} -ac_make=`$as_echo "$2" | sed 's/+/p/g; s/[^a-zA-Z0-9_]/_/g'` -if eval \${ac_cv_prog_make_${ac_make}_set+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat >conftest.make <<\_ACEOF -SHELL = /bin/sh -all: - @echo '@@@%%%=$(MAKE)=@@@%%%' -_ACEOF -# GNU make sometimes prints "make[1]: Entering ...", which would confuse us. -case `${MAKE-make} -f conftest.make 2>/dev/null` in - *@@@%%%=?*=@@@%%%*) - eval ac_cv_prog_make_${ac_make}_set=yes;; - *) - eval ac_cv_prog_make_${ac_make}_set=no;; -esac -rm -f conftest.make -fi -if eval test \$ac_cv_prog_make_${ac_make}_set = yes; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: yes" >&5 -$as_echo "yes" >&6; } - SET_MAKE= -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } - SET_MAKE="MAKE=${MAKE-make}" -fi - - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Find ranlib - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_RANLIB+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$RANLIB"; then - ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="$RANLIB" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -RANLIB=$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB -if test -n "$RANLIB"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $RANLIB" >&5 -$as_echo "$RANLIB" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB"; then - ac_ct_RANLIB=$RANLIB - # Extract the first word of "ranlib", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ranlib; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_RANLIB"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB="$ac_ct_RANLIB" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB="ranlib" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_RANLIB=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB -if test -n "$ac_ct_RANLIB"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_RANLIB" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_RANLIB" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_RANLIB" = x; then - RANLIB="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - RANLIB=$ac_ct_RANLIB - fi -else - RANLIB="$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB" -fi - - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Determines the correct binary file extension (.o, .obj, .exe etc.) - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - - - -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for grep that handles long lines and -e" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for grep that handles long lines and -e... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_path_GREP+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -z "$GREP"; then - ac_path_GREP_found=false - # Loop through the user's path and test for each of PROGNAME-LIST - as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH$PATH_SEPARATOR/usr/xpg4/bin -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_prog in grep ggrep; do - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - ac_path_GREP="$as_dir/$ac_prog$ac_exec_ext" - as_fn_executable_p "$ac_path_GREP" || continue -# Check for GNU ac_path_GREP and select it if it is found. - # Check for GNU $ac_path_GREP -case `"$ac_path_GREP" --version 2>&1` in -*GNU*) - ac_cv_path_GREP="$ac_path_GREP" ac_path_GREP_found=:;; -*) - ac_count=0 - $as_echo_n 0123456789 >"conftest.in" - while : - do - cat "conftest.in" "conftest.in" >"conftest.tmp" - mv "conftest.tmp" "conftest.in" - cp "conftest.in" "conftest.nl" - $as_echo 'GREP' >> "conftest.nl" - "$ac_path_GREP" -e 'GREP$' -e '-(cannot match)-' < "conftest.nl" >"conftest.out" 2>/dev/null || break - diff "conftest.out" "conftest.nl" >/dev/null 2>&1 || break - as_fn_arith $ac_count + 1 && ac_count=$as_val - if test $ac_count -gt ${ac_path_GREP_max-0}; then - # Best one so far, save it but keep looking for a better one - ac_cv_path_GREP="$ac_path_GREP" - ac_path_GREP_max=$ac_count - fi - # 10*(2^10) chars as input seems more than enough - test $ac_count -gt 10 && break - done - rm -f conftest.in conftest.tmp conftest.nl conftest.out;; -esac - - $ac_path_GREP_found && break 3 - done - done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - if test -z "$ac_cv_path_GREP"; then - as_fn_error $? "no acceptable grep could be found in $PATH$PATH_SEPARATOR/usr/xpg4/bin" "$LINENO" 5 - fi -else - ac_cv_path_GREP=$GREP -fi - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_path_GREP" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_path_GREP" >&6; } - GREP="$ac_cv_path_GREP" - - -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for egrep" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for egrep... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_path_EGREP+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if echo a | $GREP -E '(a|b)' >/dev/null 2>&1 - then ac_cv_path_EGREP="$GREP -E" - else - if test -z "$EGREP"; then - ac_path_EGREP_found=false - # Loop through the user's path and test for each of PROGNAME-LIST - as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH$PATH_SEPARATOR/usr/xpg4/bin -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_prog in egrep; do - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - ac_path_EGREP="$as_dir/$ac_prog$ac_exec_ext" - as_fn_executable_p "$ac_path_EGREP" || continue -# Check for GNU ac_path_EGREP and select it if it is found. - # Check for GNU $ac_path_EGREP -case `"$ac_path_EGREP" --version 2>&1` in -*GNU*) - ac_cv_path_EGREP="$ac_path_EGREP" ac_path_EGREP_found=:;; -*) - ac_count=0 - $as_echo_n 0123456789 >"conftest.in" - while : - do - cat "conftest.in" "conftest.in" >"conftest.tmp" - mv "conftest.tmp" "conftest.in" - cp "conftest.in" "conftest.nl" - $as_echo 'EGREP' >> "conftest.nl" - "$ac_path_EGREP" 'EGREP$' < "conftest.nl" >"conftest.out" 2>/dev/null || break - diff "conftest.out" "conftest.nl" >/dev/null 2>&1 || break - as_fn_arith $ac_count + 1 && ac_count=$as_val - if test $ac_count -gt ${ac_path_EGREP_max-0}; then - # Best one so far, save it but keep looking for a better one - ac_cv_path_EGREP="$ac_path_EGREP" - ac_path_EGREP_max=$ac_count - fi - # 10*(2^10) chars as input seems more than enough - test $ac_count -gt 10 && break - done - rm -f conftest.in conftest.tmp conftest.nl conftest.out;; -esac - - $ac_path_EGREP_found && break 3 - done - done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - if test -z "$ac_cv_path_EGREP"; then - as_fn_error $? "no acceptable egrep could be found in $PATH$PATH_SEPARATOR/usr/xpg4/bin" "$LINENO" 5 - fi -else - ac_cv_path_EGREP=$EGREP -fi - - fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_path_EGREP" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_path_EGREP" >&6; } - EGREP="$ac_cv_path_EGREP" - - -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for ANSI C header files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for ANSI C header files... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_header_stdc+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -#include -#include -#include - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_header_stdc=yes -else - ac_cv_header_stdc=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - -if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then - # SunOS 4.x string.h does not declare mem*, contrary to ANSI. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - -_ACEOF -if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 | - $EGREP "memchr" >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - -else - ac_cv_header_stdc=no -fi -rm -f conftest* - -fi - -if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then - # ISC 2.0.2 stdlib.h does not declare free, contrary to ANSI. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - -_ACEOF -if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 | - $EGREP "free" >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - -else - ac_cv_header_stdc=no -fi -rm -f conftest* - -fi - -if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then - # /bin/cc in Irix-4.0.5 gets non-ANSI ctype macros unless using -ansi. - if test "$cross_compiling" = yes; then : - : -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -#include -#if ((' ' & 0x0FF) == 0x020) -# define ISLOWER(c) ('a' <= (c) && (c) <= 'z') -# define TOUPPER(c) (ISLOWER(c) ? 'A' + ((c) - 'a') : (c)) -#else -# define ISLOWER(c) \ - (('a' <= (c) && (c) <= 'i') \ - || ('j' <= (c) && (c) <= 'r') \ - || ('s' <= (c) && (c) <= 'z')) -# define TOUPPER(c) (ISLOWER(c) ? ((c) | 0x40) : (c)) -#endif - -#define XOR(e, f) (((e) && !(f)) || (!(e) && (f))) -int -main () -{ - int i; - for (i = 0; i < 256; i++) - if (XOR (islower (i), ISLOWER (i)) - || toupper (i) != TOUPPER (i)) - return 2; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_run "$LINENO"; then : - -else - ac_cv_header_stdc=no -fi -rm -f core *.core core.conftest.* gmon.out bb.out conftest$ac_exeext \ - conftest.$ac_objext conftest.beam conftest.$ac_ext -fi - -fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_header_stdc" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_header_stdc" >&6; } -if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then - -$as_echo "#define STDC_HEADERS 1" >>confdefs.h - -fi - -# On IRIX 5.3, sys/types and inttypes.h are conflicting. -for ac_header in sys/types.h sys/stat.h stdlib.h string.h memory.h strings.h \ - inttypes.h stdint.h unistd.h -do : - as_ac_Header=`$as_echo "ac_cv_header_$ac_header" | $as_tr_sh` -ac_fn_c_check_header_compile "$LINENO" "$ac_header" "$as_ac_Header" "$ac_includes_default -" -if eval test \"x\$"$as_ac_Header"\" = x"yes"; then : - cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define `$as_echo "HAVE_$ac_header" | $as_tr_cpp` 1 -_ACEOF - -fi - -done - - - - # Any macros that use the compiler (e.g. AC_TRY_COMPILE) have to go here. - - - #------------------------------------------------------------------------ - # If we're using GCC, see if the compiler understands -pipe. If so, use it. - # It makes compiling go faster. (This is only a performance feature.) - #------------------------------------------------------------------------ - - if test -z "$no_pipe" -a -n "$GCC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if the compiler understands -pipe" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if the compiler understands -pipe... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cc_pipe+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS; CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pipe" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cc_pipe=yes -else - tcl_cv_cc_pipe=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cc_pipe" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cc_pipe" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_cc_pipe = yes; then - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pipe" - fi - fi - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Common compiler flag setup - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking whether byte ordering is bigendian" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking whether byte ordering is bigendian... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_c_bigendian+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_cv_c_bigendian=unknown - # See if we're dealing with a universal compiler. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#ifndef __APPLE_CC__ - not a universal capable compiler - #endif - typedef int dummy; - -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - - # Check for potential -arch flags. It is not universal unless - # there are at least two -arch flags with different values. - ac_arch= - ac_prev= - for ac_word in $CC $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS; do - if test -n "$ac_prev"; then - case $ac_word in - i?86 | x86_64 | ppc | ppc64) - if test -z "$ac_arch" || test "$ac_arch" = "$ac_word"; then - ac_arch=$ac_word - else - ac_cv_c_bigendian=universal - break - fi - ;; - esac - ac_prev= - elif test "x$ac_word" = "x-arch"; then - ac_prev=arch - fi - done -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - if test $ac_cv_c_bigendian = unknown; then - # See if sys/param.h defines the BYTE_ORDER macro. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - #include - -int -main () -{ -#if ! (defined BYTE_ORDER && defined BIG_ENDIAN \ - && defined LITTLE_ENDIAN && BYTE_ORDER && BIG_ENDIAN \ - && LITTLE_ENDIAN) - bogus endian macros - #endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - # It does; now see whether it defined to BIG_ENDIAN or not. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - #include - -int -main () -{ -#if BYTE_ORDER != BIG_ENDIAN - not big endian - #endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_c_bigendian=yes -else - ac_cv_c_bigendian=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - fi - if test $ac_cv_c_bigendian = unknown; then - # See if defines _LITTLE_ENDIAN or _BIG_ENDIAN (e.g., Solaris). - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - -int -main () -{ -#if ! (defined _LITTLE_ENDIAN || defined _BIG_ENDIAN) - bogus endian macros - #endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - # It does; now see whether it defined to _BIG_ENDIAN or not. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include - -int -main () -{ -#ifndef _BIG_ENDIAN - not big endian - #endif - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_c_bigendian=yes -else - ac_cv_c_bigendian=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - fi - if test $ac_cv_c_bigendian = unknown; then - # Compile a test program. - if test "$cross_compiling" = yes; then : - # Try to guess by grepping values from an object file. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -short int ascii_mm[] = - { 0x4249, 0x4765, 0x6E44, 0x6961, 0x6E53, 0x7953, 0 }; - short int ascii_ii[] = - { 0x694C, 0x5454, 0x656C, 0x6E45, 0x6944, 0x6E61, 0 }; - int use_ascii (int i) { - return ascii_mm[i] + ascii_ii[i]; - } - short int ebcdic_ii[] = - { 0x89D3, 0xE3E3, 0x8593, 0x95C5, 0x89C4, 0x9581, 0 }; - short int ebcdic_mm[] = - { 0xC2C9, 0xC785, 0x95C4, 0x8981, 0x95E2, 0xA8E2, 0 }; - int use_ebcdic (int i) { - return ebcdic_mm[i] + ebcdic_ii[i]; - } - extern int foo; - -int -main () -{ -return use_ascii (foo) == use_ebcdic (foo); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - if grep BIGenDianSyS conftest.$ac_objext >/dev/null; then - ac_cv_c_bigendian=yes - fi - if grep LiTTleEnDian conftest.$ac_objext >/dev/null ; then - if test "$ac_cv_c_bigendian" = unknown; then - ac_cv_c_bigendian=no - else - # finding both strings is unlikely to happen, but who knows? - ac_cv_c_bigendian=unknown - fi - fi -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -$ac_includes_default -int -main () -{ - - /* Are we little or big endian? From Harbison&Steele. */ - union - { - long int l; - char c[sizeof (long int)]; - } u; - u.l = 1; - return u.c[sizeof (long int) - 1] == 1; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_run "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_c_bigendian=no -else - ac_cv_c_bigendian=yes -fi -rm -f core *.core core.conftest.* gmon.out bb.out conftest$ac_exeext \ - conftest.$ac_objext conftest.beam conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - fi -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_c_bigendian" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_c_bigendian" >&6; } - case $ac_cv_c_bigendian in #( - yes) - $as_echo "#define WORDS_BIGENDIAN 1" >>confdefs.h -;; #( - no) - ;; #( - universal) - -$as_echo "#define AC_APPLE_UNIVERSAL_BUILD 1" >>confdefs.h - - ;; #( - *) - as_fn_error $? "unknown endianness - presetting ac_cv_c_bigendian=no (or yes) will help" "$LINENO" 5 ;; - esac - - - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# Specify the C source files to compile in TEA_ADD_SOURCES, -# public headers that need to be installed in TEA_ADD_HEADERS, -# stub library C source files to compile in TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES, -# and runtime Tcl library files in TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES. -# This defines PKG(_STUB)_SOURCES, PKG(_STUB)_OBJECTS, PKG_HEADERS -# and PKG_TCL_SOURCES. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - vars=" -tkbltChain.C -tkbltConfig.C -tkbltGrAxis.C -tkbltGrAxisOp.C -tkbltGrAxisOption.C -tkbltGrBind.C -tkbltGrElemOp.C -tkbltGrElemOption.C -tkbltGrElem.C -tkbltGrElemBar.C -tkbltGrElemLine.C -tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C -tkbltGrHairs.C -tkbltGrHairsOp.C -tkbltGrLegd.C -tkbltGrLegdOp.C -tkbltGrMarkerOp.C -tkbltGrMarkerOption.C -tkbltGrMarker.C -tkbltGrMarkerLine.C -tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C -tkbltGrMarkerText.C -tkbltGrMisc.C -tkbltGrPenOp.C -tkbltGrPenOption.C -tkbltGrPen.C -tkbltGrPenBar.C -tkbltGrPenLine.C -tkbltGrPostscript.C -tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C -tkbltGrPSOutput.C -tkbltGrText.C -tkbltGrXAxisOp.C -tkbltGraph.C -tkbltGraphBar.C -tkbltGraphLine.C -tkbltGraphOp.C -tkbltGraphSup.C -tkbltInt.C -tkbltNsUtil.C -tkbltParse.C -tkbltOp.C -tkbltStubInit.c -tkbltStubLib.C -tkbltSwitch.C -tkbltVecCmd.C -tkbltVecOp.C -tkbltVecMath.C -tkbltVector.C -" - for i in $vars; do - case $i in - \$*) - # allow $-var names - PKG_SOURCES="$PKG_SOURCES $i" - PKG_OBJECTS="$PKG_OBJECTS $i" - ;; - *) - # check for existence - allows for generic/win/unix VPATH - # To add more dirs here (like 'src'), you have to update VPATH - # in Makefile.in as well - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/generic/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/win/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/unix/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/macosx/$i" \ - ; then - as_fn_error $? "could not find source file '$i'" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - PKG_SOURCES="$PKG_SOURCES $i" - # this assumes it is in a VPATH dir - i=`basename $i` - # handle user calling this before or after TEA_SETUP_COMPILER - if test x"${OBJEXT}" != x ; then - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$//'`.${OBJEXT}" - else - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$//'`.\${OBJEXT}" - fi - PKG_OBJECTS="$PKG_OBJECTS $j" - ;; - esac - done - - - - - vars=" -generic/tkbltVector.h -generic/tkbltDecls.h -" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence, be strict because it is installed - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" ; then - as_fn_error $? "could not find header file '${srcdir}/$i'" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - PKG_HEADERS="$PKG_HEADERS $i" - done - - - - vars="" - for i in $vars; do - PKG_INCLUDES="$PKG_INCLUDES $i" - done - - - - vars="-lstdc++" - for i in $vars; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - # Convert foo.lib to -lfoo for GCC. No-op if not *.lib - i=`echo "$i" | sed -e 's/^\([^-].*\)\.lib$/-l\1/i'` - fi - PKG_LIBS="$PKG_LIBS $i" - done - - -if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" != "yes"; then - - PKG_CFLAGS="$PKG_CFLAGS -TP -EHsc -D_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS -D_USE_MATH_DEFINES" - - -fi - - vars="tkbltStubLib.C" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence - allows for generic/win/unix VPATH - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/generic/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/win/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/unix/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/macosx/$i" \ - ; then - as_fn_error $? "could not find stub source file '$i'" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - PKG_STUB_SOURCES="$PKG_STUB_SOURCES $i" - # this assumes it is in a VPATH dir - i=`basename $i` - # handle user calling this before or after TEA_SETUP_COMPILER - if test x"${OBJEXT}" != x ; then - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$//'`.${OBJEXT}" - else - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[^.]*$//'`.\${OBJEXT}" - fi - PKG_STUB_OBJECTS="$PKG_STUB_OBJECTS $j" - done - - - - - vars="library/graph.tcl" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence, be strict because it is installed - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" ; then - as_fn_error $? "could not find tcl source file '${srcdir}/$i'" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - PKG_TCL_SOURCES="$PKG_TCL_SOURCES $i" - done - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# -# You can add more files to clean if your extension creates any extra -# files by extending CLEANFILES. -# Add pkgIndex.tcl if it is generated in the Makefile instead of ./configure -# and change Makefile.in to move it from CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES to BINARIES var. -# -# A few miscellaneous platform-specific items: -# TEA_ADD_* any platform specific compiler/build info here. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES pkgIndex.tcl" -if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - # Ensure no empty if clauses - : - #TEA_ADD_SOURCES([win/winFile.c]) - #TEA_ADD_INCLUDES([-I\"$(${CYGPATH} ${srcdir}/win)\"]) -else - # Ensure no empty else clauses - : - #TEA_ADD_SOURCES([unix/unixFile.c]) - #TEA_ADD_LIBS([-lsuperfly]) -fi - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# Choose which headers you need. Extension authors should try very -# hard to only rely on the Tcl public header files. Internal headers -# contain private data structures and are subject to change without -# notice. -# This MUST be called after TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG / TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tcl public headers" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tcl public headers... " >&6; } - - -# Check whether --with-tclinclude was given. -if test "${with_tclinclude+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_tclinclude; with_tclinclude=${withval} -fi - - - if ${ac_cv_c_tclh+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - # Use the value from --with-tclinclude, if it was given - - if test x"${with_tclinclude}" != x ; then - if test -f "${with_tclinclude}/tcl.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclh=${with_tclinclude} - else - as_fn_error $? "${with_tclinclude} directory does not contain tcl.h" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - else - list="" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers directory - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - list="`ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers 2>/dev/null`" - ;; - esac - fi - - # Look in the source dir only if Tcl is not installed, - # and in that situation, look there before installed locations. - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - list="$list `ls -d ${TCL_SRC_DIR}/generic 2>/dev/null`" - fi - - # Check order: pkg --prefix location, Tcl's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tclConfig.sh. - - eval "temp_includedir=${includedir}" - list="$list \ - `ls -d ${temp_includedir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null`" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" -o "$GCC" = "yes"; then - list="$list /usr/local/include /usr/include" - if test x"${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" != x ; then - d=`echo "${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/^-I//'` - list="$list `ls -d ${d} 2>/dev/null`" - fi - fi - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/tcl.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclh=$i - break - fi - done - fi - -fi - - - # Print a message based on how we determined the include path - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclh}" = x ; then - as_fn_error $? "tcl.h not found. Please specify its location with --with-tclinclude" "$LINENO" 5 - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${ac_cv_c_tclh}" >&5 -$as_echo "${ac_cv_c_tclh}" >&6; } - fi - - # Convert to a native path and substitute into the output files. - - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${ac_cv_c_tclh}` - - TCL_INCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - - - - # Allow for --with-tclinclude to take effect and define ${ac_cv_c_tclh} - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tcl private include files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tcl private include files... " >&6; } - - TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${TCL_SRC_DIR}` - TCL_TOP_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - # Check to see if tclPort.h isn't already with the public headers - # Don't look for tclInt.h because that resides with tcl.h in the core - # sources, but the Port headers are in a different directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tclh}/tclWinPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tclh}/tclUnixPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - else - TCL_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic\" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/win\" - else - TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/unix\" - fi - # Overwrite the previous TCL_INCLUDES as this should capture both - # public and private headers in the same set. - # We want to ensure these are substituted so as not to require - # any *_NATIVE vars be defined in the Makefile - TCL_INCLUDES="-I${TCL_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE} -I${TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE}" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers and PrivateHeaders directories - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -d "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers" -a \ - -d "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders"; then - TCL_INCLUDES="-I\"${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers\" -I\"${TCL_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders\" ${TCL_INCLUDES}" - else - TCL_INCLUDES="${TCL_INCLUDES} ${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC} `echo "${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/Headers/PrivateHeaders/'`" - fi - ;; - esac - result="Using ${TCL_INCLUDES}" - else - if test ! -f "${TCL_SRC_DIR}/generic/tclInt.h" ; then - as_fn_error $? "Cannot find private header tclInt.h in ${TCL_SRC_DIR}" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - result="Using srcdir found in tclConfig.sh: ${TCL_SRC_DIR}" - fi - fi - - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${result}" >&5 -$as_echo "${result}" >&6; } - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tk public headers" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tk public headers... " >&6; } - - -# Check whether --with-tkinclude was given. -if test "${with_tkinclude+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_tkinclude; with_tkinclude=${withval} -fi - - - if ${ac_cv_c_tkh+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - # Use the value from --with-tkinclude, if it was given - - if test x"${with_tkinclude}" != x ; then - if test -f "${with_tkinclude}/tk.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkh=${with_tkinclude} - else - as_fn_error $? "${with_tkinclude} directory does not contain tk.h" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - else - list="" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers directory. - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - list="`ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers 2>/dev/null`" - ;; - esac - fi - - # Look in the source dir only if Tk is not installed, - # and in that situation, look there before installed locations. - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - list="$list `ls -d ${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic 2>/dev/null`" - fi - - # Check order: pkg --prefix location, Tk's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tkConfig.sh, Tcl's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tclConfig.sh. - - eval "temp_includedir=${includedir}" - list="$list \ - `ls -d ${temp_includedir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null`" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" -o "$GCC" = "yes"; then - list="$list /usr/local/include /usr/include" - if test x"${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" != x ; then - d=`echo "${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/^-I//'` - list="$list `ls -d ${d} 2>/dev/null`" - fi - fi - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/tk.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkh=$i - break - fi - done - fi - -fi - - - # Print a message based on how we determined the include path - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkh}" = x ; then - as_fn_error $? "tk.h not found. Please specify its location with --with-tkinclude" "$LINENO" 5 - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${ac_cv_c_tkh}" >&5 -$as_echo "${ac_cv_c_tkh}" >&6; } - fi - - # Convert to a native path and substitute into the output files. - - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${ac_cv_c_tkh}` - - TK_INCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - - - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != "x11"; then - # On Windows and Aqua, we need the X compat headers - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for X11 header files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for X11 header files... " >&6; } - if test ! -r "${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}/X11/Xlib.h"; then - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE="`${CYGPATH} ${TK_SRC_DIR}/xlib`" - TK_XINCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}" >&5 -$as_echo "${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}" >&6; } - fi - - - # Allow for --with-tkinclude to take effect and define ${ac_cv_c_tkh} - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Tk private include files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Tk private include files... " >&6; } - - TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${TK_SRC_DIR}` - TK_TOP_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - # Check to see if tkPort.h isn't already with the public headers - # Don't look for tkInt.h because that resides with tk.h in the core - # sources, but the Port headers are in a different directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tkh}/tkWinPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tkh}/tkUnixPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - else - TK_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic\" - TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/xlib\" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/win\" - else - TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/unix\" - fi - # Overwrite the previous TK_INCLUDES as this should capture both - # public and private headers in the same set. - # We want to ensure these are substituted so as not to require - # any *_NATIVE vars be defined in the Makefile - TK_INCLUDES="-I${TK_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE} -I${TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE}" - # Detect and add ttk subdir - if test -d "${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic/ttk"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic/ttk\"" - fi - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != "x11"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE}\"" - fi - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = "aqua"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/macosx\"" - fi - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers and PrivateHeaders directories - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -d "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers" -a \ - -d "${TK_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders"; then - TK_INCLUDES="-I\"${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers\" -I\"${TK_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders\" ${TK_INCLUDES}" - else - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} ${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC} `echo "${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/Headers/PrivateHeaders/'`" - fi - ;; - esac - result="Using ${TK_INCLUDES}" - else - if test ! -f "${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic/tkInt.h" ; then - as_fn_error $? "Cannot find private header tkInt.h in ${TK_SRC_DIR}" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - result="Using srcdir found in tkConfig.sh: ${TK_SRC_DIR}" - fi - fi - - - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${result}" >&5 -$as_echo "${result}" >&6; } - - - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = "x11" ; then - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for X" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for X... " >&6; } - - -# Check whether --with-x was given. -if test "${with_x+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_x; -fi - -# $have_x is `yes', `no', `disabled', or empty when we do not yet know. -if test "x$with_x" = xno; then - # The user explicitly disabled X. - have_x=disabled -else - case $x_includes,$x_libraries in #( - *\'*) as_fn_error $? "cannot use X directory names containing '" "$LINENO" 5;; #( - *,NONE | NONE,*) if ${ac_cv_have_x+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - # One or both of the vars are not set, and there is no cached value. -ac_x_includes=no ac_x_libraries=no -rm -f -r conftest.dir -if mkdir conftest.dir; then - cd conftest.dir - cat >Imakefile <<'_ACEOF' -incroot: - @echo incroot='${INCROOT}' -usrlibdir: - @echo usrlibdir='${USRLIBDIR}' -libdir: - @echo libdir='${LIBDIR}' -_ACEOF - if (export CC; ${XMKMF-xmkmf}) >/dev/null 2>/dev/null && test -f Makefile; then - # GNU make sometimes prints "make[1]: Entering ...", which would confuse us. - for ac_var in incroot usrlibdir libdir; do - eval "ac_im_$ac_var=\`\${MAKE-make} $ac_var 2>/dev/null | sed -n 's/^$ac_var=//p'\`" - done - # Open Windows xmkmf reportedly sets LIBDIR instead of USRLIBDIR. - for ac_extension in a so sl dylib la dll; do - if test ! -f "$ac_im_usrlibdir/libX11.$ac_extension" && - test -f "$ac_im_libdir/libX11.$ac_extension"; then - ac_im_usrlibdir=$ac_im_libdir; break - fi - done - # Screen out bogus values from the imake configuration. They are - # bogus both because they are the default anyway, and because - # using them would break gcc on systems where it needs fixed includes. - case $ac_im_incroot in - /usr/include) ac_x_includes= ;; - *) test -f "$ac_im_incroot/X11/Xos.h" && ac_x_includes=$ac_im_incroot;; - esac - case $ac_im_usrlibdir in - /usr/lib | /usr/lib64 | /lib | /lib64) ;; - *) test -d "$ac_im_usrlibdir" && ac_x_libraries=$ac_im_usrlibdir ;; - esac - fi - cd .. - rm -f -r conftest.dir -fi - -# Standard set of common directories for X headers. -# Check X11 before X11Rn because it is often a symlink to the current release. -ac_x_header_dirs=' -/usr/X11/include -/usr/X11R7/include -/usr/X11R6/include -/usr/X11R5/include -/usr/X11R4/include - -/usr/include/X11 -/usr/include/X11R7 -/usr/include/X11R6 -/usr/include/X11R5 -/usr/include/X11R4 - -/usr/local/X11/include -/usr/local/X11R7/include -/usr/local/X11R6/include -/usr/local/X11R5/include -/usr/local/X11R4/include - -/usr/local/include/X11 -/usr/local/include/X11R7 -/usr/local/include/X11R6 -/usr/local/include/X11R5 -/usr/local/include/X11R4 - -/usr/X386/include -/usr/x386/include -/usr/XFree86/include/X11 - -/usr/include -/usr/local/include -/usr/unsupported/include -/usr/athena/include -/usr/local/x11r5/include -/usr/lpp/Xamples/include - -/usr/openwin/include -/usr/openwin/share/include' - -if test "$ac_x_includes" = no; then - # Guess where to find include files, by looking for Xlib.h. - # First, try using that file with no special directory specified. - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - # We can compile using X headers with no special include directory. -ac_x_includes= -else - for ac_dir in $ac_x_header_dirs; do - if test -r "$ac_dir/X11/Xlib.h"; then - ac_x_includes=$ac_dir - break - fi -done -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext -fi # $ac_x_includes = no - -if test "$ac_x_libraries" = no; then - # Check for the libraries. - # See if we find them without any special options. - # Don't add to $LIBS permanently. - ac_save_LIBS=$LIBS - LIBS="-lX11 $LIBS" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -XrmInitialize () - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - LIBS=$ac_save_LIBS -# We can link X programs with no special library path. -ac_x_libraries= -else - LIBS=$ac_save_LIBS -for ac_dir in `$as_echo "$ac_x_includes $ac_x_header_dirs" | sed s/include/lib/g` -do - # Don't even attempt the hair of trying to link an X program! - for ac_extension in a so sl dylib la dll; do - if test -r "$ac_dir/libX11.$ac_extension"; then - ac_x_libraries=$ac_dir - break 2 - fi - done -done -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -fi # $ac_x_libraries = no - -case $ac_x_includes,$ac_x_libraries in #( - no,* | *,no | *\'*) - # Didn't find X, or a directory has "'" in its name. - ac_cv_have_x="have_x=no";; #( - *) - # Record where we found X for the cache. - ac_cv_have_x="have_x=yes\ - ac_x_includes='$ac_x_includes'\ - ac_x_libraries='$ac_x_libraries'" -esac -fi -;; #( - *) have_x=yes;; - esac - eval "$ac_cv_have_x" -fi # $with_x != no - -if test "$have_x" != yes; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $have_x" >&5 -$as_echo "$have_x" >&6; } - no_x=yes -else - # If each of the values was on the command line, it overrides each guess. - test "x$x_includes" = xNONE && x_includes=$ac_x_includes - test "x$x_libraries" = xNONE && x_libraries=$ac_x_libraries - # Update the cache value to reflect the command line values. - ac_cv_have_x="have_x=yes\ - ac_x_includes='$x_includes'\ - ac_x_libraries='$x_libraries'" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: libraries $x_libraries, headers $x_includes" >&5 -$as_echo "libraries $x_libraries, headers $x_includes" >&6; } -fi - - not_really_there="" - if test "$no_x" = ""; then - if test "$x_includes" = ""; then - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - -else - not_really_there="yes" -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - else - if test ! -r $x_includes/X11/Xlib.h; then - not_really_there="yes" - fi - fi - fi - if test "$no_x" = "yes" -o "$not_really_there" = "yes"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for X11 header files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for X11 header files... " >&6; } - found_xincludes="no" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_cpp "$LINENO"; then : - found_xincludes="yes" -else - found_xincludes="no" -fi -rm -f conftest.err conftest.i conftest.$ac_ext - if test "$found_xincludes" = "no"; then - dirs="/usr/unsupported/include /usr/local/include /usr/X386/include /usr/X11R6/include /usr/X11R5/include /usr/include/X11R5 /usr/include/X11R4 /usr/openwin/include /usr/X11/include /usr/sww/include" - for i in $dirs ; do - if test -r $i/X11/Xlib.h; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $i" >&5 -$as_echo "$i" >&6; } - XINCLUDES=" -I$i" - found_xincludes="yes" - break - fi - done - fi - else - if test "$x_includes" != ""; then - XINCLUDES="-I$x_includes" - found_xincludes="yes" - fi - fi - if test "$found_xincludes" = "no"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: couldn't find any!" >&5 -$as_echo "couldn't find any!" >&6; } - fi - - if test "$no_x" = yes; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for X11 libraries" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for X11 libraries... " >&6; } - XLIBSW=nope - dirs="/usr/unsupported/lib /usr/local/lib /usr/X386/lib /usr/X11R6/lib /usr/X11R5/lib /usr/lib/X11R5 /usr/lib/X11R4 /usr/openwin/lib /usr/X11/lib /usr/sww/X11/lib" - for i in $dirs ; do - if test -r $i/libX11.a -o -r $i/libX11.so -o -r $i/libX11.sl -o -r $i/libX11.dylib; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $i" >&5 -$as_echo "$i" >&6; } - XLIBSW="-L$i -lX11" - x_libraries="$i" - break - fi - done - else - if test "$x_libraries" = ""; then - XLIBSW=-lX11 - else - XLIBSW="-L$x_libraries -lX11" - fi - fi - if test "$XLIBSW" = nope ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for XCreateWindow in -lXwindow" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for XCreateWindow in -lXwindow... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lXwindow $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char XCreateWindow (); -int -main () -{ -return XCreateWindow (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_Xwindow_XCreateWindow" = xyes; then : - XLIBSW=-lXwindow -fi - - fi - if test "$XLIBSW" = nope ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: could not find any! Using -lX11." >&5 -$as_echo "could not find any! Using -lX11." >&6; } - XLIBSW=-lX11 - fi - # TEA specific: - if test x"${XLIBSW}" != x ; then - PKG_LIBS="${PKG_LIBS} ${XLIBSW}" - fi - - fi - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Check whether --enable-threads or --disable-threads was given. -# This auto-enables if Tcl was compiled threaded. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - # Check whether --enable-threads was given. -if test "${enable_threads+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_threads; tcl_ok=$enableval -else - tcl_ok=yes -fi - - - if test "${enable_threads+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_threads" - tcl_ok=$enableval - else - tcl_ok=yes - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes" -o "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1; then - TCL_THREADS=1 - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" ; then - # We are always OK on Windows, so check what this platform wants: - - # USE_THREAD_ALLOC tells us to try the special thread-based - # allocator that significantly reduces lock contention - -$as_echo "#define USE_THREAD_ALLOC 1" >>confdefs.h - - -$as_echo "#define _REENTRANT 1" >>confdefs.h - - if test "`uname -s`" = "SunOS" ; then - -$as_echo "#define _POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - -$as_echo "#define _THREAD_SAFE 1" >>confdefs.h - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lpthread" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lpthread... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lpthread $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char pthread_mutex_init (); -int -main () -{ -return pthread_mutex_init (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_pthread_pthread_mutex_init" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - # Check a little harder for __pthread_mutex_init in the same - # library, as some systems hide it there until pthread.h is - # defined. We could alternatively do an AC_TRY_COMPILE with - # pthread.h, but that will work with libpthread really doesn't - # exist, like AIX 4.2. [Bug: 4359] - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for __pthread_mutex_init in -lpthread" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for __pthread_mutex_init in -lpthread... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lpthread $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char __pthread_mutex_init (); -int -main () -{ -return __pthread_mutex_init (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_pthread___pthread_mutex_init" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -lpthread" - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lpthreads" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lpthreads... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lpthreads $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char pthread_mutex_init (); -int -main () -{ -return pthread_mutex_init (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_pthreads_pthread_mutex_init" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -lpthreads" - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lc" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lc... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lc $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char pthread_mutex_init (); -int -main () -{ -return pthread_mutex_init (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_c_pthread_mutex_init" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lc_r" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for pthread_mutex_init in -lc_r... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lc_r $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char pthread_mutex_init (); -int -main () -{ -return pthread_mutex_init (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_c_r_pthread_mutex_init" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -pthread" - else - TCL_THREADS=0 - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: Do not know how to find pthread lib on your system - thread support disabled" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: Do not know how to find pthread lib on your system - thread support disabled" >&2;} - fi - fi - fi - fi - fi - else - TCL_THREADS=0 - fi - # Do checking message here to not mess up interleaved configure output - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for building with threads" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for building with threads... " >&6; } - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1; then - -$as_echo "#define TCL_THREADS 1" >>confdefs.h - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: yes (default)" >&5 -$as_echo "yes (default)" >&6; } - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } - fi - # TCL_THREADS sanity checking. See if our request for building with - # threads is the same as the way Tcl was built. If not, warn the user. - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *THREADS=1*) - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "0"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: - Building ${PACKAGE_NAME} without threads enabled, but building against Tcl - that IS thread-enabled. It is recommended to use --enable-threads." >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: - Building ${PACKAGE_NAME} without threads enabled, but building against Tcl - that IS thread-enabled. It is recommended to use --enable-threads." >&2;} - fi - ;; - esac - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# The statement below defines a collection of symbols related to -# building as a shared library instead of a static library. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking how to build libraries" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking how to build libraries... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-shared was given. -if test "${enable_shared+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_shared; shared_ok=$enableval -else - shared_ok=yes -fi - - - if test "${enable_shared+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_shared" - shared_ok=$enableval - else - shared_ok=yes - fi - - # Check whether --enable-stubs was given. -if test "${enable_stubs+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_stubs; stubs_ok=$enableval -else - stubs_ok=yes -fi - - - if test "${enable_stubs+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_stubs" - stubs_ok=$enableval - else - stubs_ok=yes - fi - - # Stubs are always enabled for shared builds - if test "$shared_ok" = "yes" ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: shared" >&5 -$as_echo "shared" >&6; } - SHARED_BUILD=1 - STUBS_BUILD=1 - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: static" >&5 -$as_echo "static" >&6; } - SHARED_BUILD=0 - -$as_echo "#define STATIC_BUILD 1" >>confdefs.h - - if test "$stubs_ok" = "yes" ; then - STUBS_BUILD=1 - else - STUBS_BUILD=0 - fi - fi - if test "${STUBS_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - -$as_echo "#define USE_TCL_STUBS 1" >>confdefs.h - - -$as_echo "#define USE_TCLOO_STUBS 1" >>confdefs.h - - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != ""; then - -$as_echo "#define USE_TK_STUBS 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - fi - - - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# This macro figures out what flags to use with the compiler/linker -# when building shared/static debug/optimized objects. This information -# can be taken from the tclConfig.sh file, but this figures it all out. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_RANLIB+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$RANLIB"; then - ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="$RANLIB" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="${ac_tool_prefix}ranlib" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -RANLIB=$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB -if test -n "$RANLIB"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $RANLIB" >&5 -$as_echo "$RANLIB" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB"; then - ac_ct_RANLIB=$RANLIB - # Extract the first word of "ranlib", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ranlib; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_RANLIB"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB="$ac_ct_RANLIB" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB="ranlib" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_RANLIB=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RANLIB -if test -n "$ac_ct_RANLIB"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_RANLIB" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_RANLIB" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_RANLIB" = x; then - RANLIB=":" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - RANLIB=$ac_ct_RANLIB - fi -else - RANLIB="$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB" -fi - - - - - # Step 0.a: Enable 64 bit support? - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if 64bit support is requested" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if 64bit support is requested... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-64bit was given. -if test "${enable_64bit+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_64bit; do64bit=$enableval -else - do64bit=no -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $do64bit" >&5 -$as_echo "$do64bit" >&6; } - - # Step 0.b: Enable Solaris 64 bit VIS support? - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if 64bit Sparc VIS support is requested" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if 64bit Sparc VIS support is requested... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-64bit-vis was given. -if test "${enable_64bit_vis+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_64bit_vis; do64bitVIS=$enableval -else - do64bitVIS=no -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $do64bitVIS" >&5 -$as_echo "$do64bitVIS" >&6; } - # Force 64bit on with VIS - if test "$do64bitVIS" = "yes"; then : - do64bit=yes -fi - - # Step 0.c: Check if visibility support is available. Do this here so - # that platform specific alternatives can be used below if this fails. - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if compiler supports visibility \"hidden\"" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if compiler supports visibility \"hidden\"... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS; CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -Werror" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - - extern __attribute__((__visibility__("hidden"))) void f(void); - void f(void) {} -int -main () -{ -f(); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=yes -else - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden = yes; then : - - -$as_echo "#define MODULE_SCOPE extern __attribute__((__visibility__(\"hidden\")))" >>confdefs.h - - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_HIDDEN 1" >>confdefs.h - - -fi - - # Step 0.d: Disable -rpath support? - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if rpath support is requested" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if rpath support is requested... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-rpath was given. -if test "${enable_rpath+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_rpath; doRpath=$enableval -else - doRpath=yes -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $doRpath" >&5 -$as_echo "$doRpath" >&6; } - - # TEA specific: Cross-compiling options for Windows/CE builds? - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = windows; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if Windows/CE build is requested" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if Windows/CE build is requested... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-wince was given. -if test "${enable_wince+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_wince; doWince=$enableval -else - doWince=no -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $doWince" >&5 -$as_echo "$doWince" >&6; } - -fi - - # Set the variable "system" to hold the name and version number - # for the system. - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking system version" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking system version... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_sys_version+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - # TEA specific: - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=windows - else - tcl_cv_sys_version=`uname -s`-`uname -r` - if test "$?" -ne 0 ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: can't find uname command" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: can't find uname command" >&2;} - tcl_cv_sys_version=unknown - else - if test "`uname -s`" = "AIX" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=AIX-`uname -v`.`uname -r` - fi - fi - fi - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_sys_version" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_sys_version" >&6; } - system=$tcl_cv_sys_version - - - # Require ranlib early so we can override it in special cases below. - - - - # Set configuration options based on system name and version. - # This is similar to Tcl's unix/tcl.m4 except that we've added a - # "windows" case and removed some core-only vars. - - do64bit_ok=no - # default to '{$LIBS}' and set to "" on per-platform necessary basis - SHLIB_LD_LIBS='${LIBS}' - # When ld needs options to work in 64-bit mode, put them in - # LDFLAGS_ARCH so they eventually end up in LDFLAGS even if [load] - # is disabled by the user. [Bug 1016796] - LDFLAGS_ARCH="" - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX="" - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - TCL_TRIM_DOTS='`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`' - ECHO_VERSION='`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION}`' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=ok - CFLAGS_DEBUG=-g - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-O2 - CFLAGS_WARNING="-Wall" - -else - - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-O - CFLAGS_WARNING="" - -fi - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}ar", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}ar; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_AR+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$AR"; then - ac_cv_prog_AR="$AR" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_AR="${ac_tool_prefix}ar" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -AR=$ac_cv_prog_AR -if test -n "$AR"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $AR" >&5 -$as_echo "$AR" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_AR"; then - ac_ct_AR=$AR - # Extract the first word of "ar", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ar; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_AR+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_AR"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_AR="$ac_ct_AR" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_AR="ar" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_AR=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_AR -if test -n "$ac_ct_AR"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_AR" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_AR" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_AR" = x; then - AR="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - AR=$ac_ct_AR - fi -else - AR="$ac_cv_prog_AR" -fi - - STLIB_LD='${AR} cr' - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LD_LIBRARY_PATH" - if test "x$SHLIB_VERSION" = x; then : - SHLIB_VERSION="" -else - SHLIB_VERSION=".$SHLIB_VERSION" -fi - case $system in - # TEA specific: - windows) - # This is a 2-stage check to make sure we have the 64-bit SDK - # We have to know where the SDK is installed. - # This magic is based on MS Platform SDK for Win2003 SP1 - hobbs - # MACHINE is IX86 for LINK, but this is used by the manifest, - # which requires x86|amd64|ia64. - MACHINE="X86" - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - if test "x${MSSDK}x" = "xx" ; then - MSSDK="C:/Progra~1/Microsoft Platform SDK" - fi - MSSDK=`echo "$MSSDK" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - PATH64="" - case "$do64bit" in - amd64|x64|yes) - MACHINE="AMD64" ; # default to AMD64 64-bit build - PATH64="${MSSDK}/Bin/Win64/x86/AMD64" - ;; - ia64) - MACHINE="IA64" - PATH64="${MSSDK}/Bin/Win64" - ;; - esac - if test "$GCC" != "yes" -a ! -d "${PATH64}" ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: Could not find 64-bit $MACHINE SDK to enable 64bit mode" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: Could not find 64-bit $MACHINE SDK to enable 64bit mode" >&2;} - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: Ensure latest Platform SDK is installed" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: Ensure latest Platform SDK is installed" >&2;} - do64bit="no" - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: Using 64-bit $MACHINE mode" >&5 -$as_echo " Using 64-bit $MACHINE mode" >&6; } - do64bit_ok="yes" - fi - fi - - if test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - as_fn_error $? "Windows/CE and 64-bit builds incompatible" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - if test "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - as_fn_error $? "Windows/CE and GCC builds incompatible" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-celib - - if test x"${no_celib}" = x ; then - # we reset no_celib in case something fails here - no_celib=true - -# Check whether --with-celib was given. -if test "${with_celib+set}" = set; then : - withval=$with_celib; with_celibconfig=${withval} -fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for Windows/CE celib directory" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for Windows/CE celib directory... " >&6; } - if ${ac_cv_c_celibconfig+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - # First check to see if --with-celibconfig was specified. - if test x"${with_celibconfig}" != x ; then - if test -d "${with_celibconfig}/inc" ; then - ac_cv_c_celibconfig=`(cd ${with_celibconfig}; pwd)` - else - as_fn_error $? "${with_celibconfig} directory doesn't contain inc directory" "$LINENO" 5 - fi - fi - - # then check for a celib library - if test x"${ac_cv_c_celibconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ../celib \ - ../../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ../../celib \ - `ls -dr ../celib-*3.[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ${srcdir}/../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ${srcdir}/../celib \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../celib-*3.[0-9]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -d "$i/inc" ; then - ac_cv_c_celibconfig=`(cd $i; pwd)` - break - fi - done - fi - -fi - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_celibconfig}" = x ; then - as_fn_error $? "Cannot find celib support library directory" "$LINENO" 5 - else - no_celib= - CELIB_DIR=${ac_cv_c_celibconfig} - CELIB_DIR=`echo "$CELIB_DIR" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: found $CELIB_DIR" >&5 -$as_echo "found $CELIB_DIR" >&6; } - fi - fi - - # Set defaults for common evc4/PPC2003 setup - # Currently Tcl requires 300+, possibly 420+ for sockets - CEVERSION=420; # could be 211 300 301 400 420 ... - TARGETCPU=ARMV4; # could be ARMV4 ARM MIPS SH3 X86 ... - ARCH=ARM; # could be ARM MIPS X86EM ... - PLATFORM="Pocket PC 2003"; # or "Pocket PC 2002" - if test "$doWince" != "yes"; then - # If !yes then the user specified something - # Reset ARCH to allow user to skip specifying it - ARCH= - eval `echo $doWince | awk -F, '{ \ - if (length($1)) { printf "CEVERSION=\"%s\"\n", $1; \ - if ($1 < 400) { printf "PLATFORM=\"Pocket PC 2002\"\n" } }; \ - if (length($2)) { printf "TARGETCPU=\"%s\"\n", toupper($2) }; \ - if (length($3)) { printf "ARCH=\"%s\"\n", toupper($3) }; \ - if (length($4)) { printf "PLATFORM=\"%s\"\n", $4 }; \ - }'` - if test "x${ARCH}" = "x" ; then - ARCH=$TARGETCPU; - fi - fi - OSVERSION=WCE$CEVERSION; - if test "x${WCEROOT}" = "x" ; then - WCEROOT="C:/Program Files/Microsoft eMbedded C++ 4.0" - if test ! -d "${WCEROOT}" ; then - WCEROOT="C:/Program Files/Microsoft eMbedded Tools" - fi - fi - if test "x${SDKROOT}" = "x" ; then - SDKROOT="C:/Program Files/Windows CE Tools" - if test ! -d "${SDKROOT}" ; then - SDKROOT="C:/Windows CE Tools" - fi - fi - WCEROOT=`echo "$WCEROOT" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - SDKROOT=`echo "$SDKROOT" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - if test ! -d "${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/Lib/${TARGETCPU}" \ - -o ! -d "${WCEROOT}/EVC/${OSVERSION}/bin"; then - as_fn_error $? "could not find PocketPC SDK or target compiler to enable WinCE mode $CEVERSION,$TARGETCPU,$ARCH,$PLATFORM" "$LINENO" 5 - doWince="no" - else - # We could PATH_NOSPACE these, but that's not important, - # as long as we quote them when used. - CEINCLUDE="${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/include" - if test -d "${CEINCLUDE}/${TARGETCPU}" ; then - CEINCLUDE="${CEINCLUDE}/${TARGETCPU}" - fi - CELIBPATH="${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/Lib/${TARGETCPU}" - fi - fi - - if test "$GCC" != "yes" ; then - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "0" ; then - runtime=-MT - else - runtime=-MD - fi - case "x`echo \${VisualStudioVersion}`" in - x1[4-9]*) - lflags="${lflags} -nodefaultlib:libucrt.lib" - - vars="ucrt.lib" - for i in $vars; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - # Convert foo.lib to -lfoo for GCC. No-op if not *.lib - i=`echo "$i" | sed -e 's/^\([^-].*\)\.lib$/-l\1/i'` - fi - PKG_LIBS="$PKG_LIBS $i" - done - - - ;; - *) - ;; - esac - - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - # All this magic is necessary for the Win64 SDK RC1 - hobbs - CC="\"${PATH64}/cl.exe\"" - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} -I\"${MSSDK}/Include\" -I\"${MSSDK}/Include/crt\" -I\"${MSSDK}/Include/crt/sys\"" - RC="\"${MSSDK}/bin/rc.exe\"" - lflags="${lflags} -nologo -MACHINE:${MACHINE} -LIBPATH:\"${MSSDK}/Lib/${MACHINE}\"" - LINKBIN="\"${PATH64}/link.exe\"" - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Zi -Od -W3 ${runtime}d" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -O2 -W2 ${runtime}" - # Avoid 'unresolved external symbol __security_cookie' - # errors, c.f. http://support.microsoft.com/?id=894573 - - vars="bufferoverflowU.lib" - for i in $vars; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - # Convert foo.lib to -lfoo for GCC. No-op if not *.lib - i=`echo "$i" | sed -e 's/^\([^-].*\)\.lib$/-l\1/i'` - fi - PKG_LIBS="$PKG_LIBS $i" - done - - - elif test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - CEBINROOT="${WCEROOT}/EVC/${OSVERSION}/bin" - if test "${TARGETCPU}" = "X86"; then - CC="\"${CEBINROOT}/cl.exe\"" - else - CC="\"${CEBINROOT}/cl${ARCH}.exe\"" - fi - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -I\"${CELIB_DIR}/inc\" -I\"${CEINCLUDE}\"" - RC="\"${WCEROOT}/Common/EVC/bin/rc.exe\"" - arch=`echo ${ARCH} | awk '{print tolower($0)}'` - defs="${ARCH} _${ARCH}_ ${arch} PALM_SIZE _MT _WINDOWS" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - # Static CE builds require static celib as well - defs="${defs} _DLL" - fi - for i in $defs ; do - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define $i 1 -_ACEOF - - done - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define _WIN32_WCE $CEVERSION -_ACEOF - - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define UNDER_CE $CEVERSION -_ACEOF - - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Zi -Od" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -Ox" - lversion=`echo ${CEVERSION} | sed -e 's/\(.\)\(..\)/\1\.\2/'` - lflags="${lflags} -MACHINE:${ARCH} -LIBPATH:\"${CELIBPATH}\" -subsystem:windowsce,${lversion} -nologo" - LINKBIN="\"${CEBINROOT}/link.exe\"" - - else - RC="rc" - lflags="${lflags} -nologo" - LINKBIN="link" - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Z7 -Od -W3 -WX ${runtime}d" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -O2 -W2 ${runtime}" - fi - fi - - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - # mingw gcc mode - if test -n "$ac_tool_prefix"; then - # Extract the first word of "${ac_tool_prefix}windres", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy ${ac_tool_prefix}windres; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_RC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$RC"; then - ac_cv_prog_RC="$RC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_RC="${ac_tool_prefix}windres" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -RC=$ac_cv_prog_RC -if test -n "$RC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $RC" >&5 -$as_echo "$RC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - -fi -if test -z "$ac_cv_prog_RC"; then - ac_ct_RC=$RC - # Extract the first word of "windres", so it can be a program name with args. -set dummy windres; ac_word=$2 -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for $ac_word" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for $ac_word... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RC+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test -n "$ac_ct_RC"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RC="$ac_ct_RC" # Let the user override the test. -else -as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do - if as_fn_executable_p "$as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then - ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RC="windres" - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: found $as_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext" >&5 - break 2 - fi -done - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - -fi -fi -ac_ct_RC=$ac_cv_prog_ac_ct_RC -if test -n "$ac_ct_RC"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_ct_RC" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_ct_RC" >&6; } -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } -fi - - if test "x$ac_ct_RC" = x; then - RC="" - else - case $cross_compiling:$ac_tool_warned in -yes:) -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: using cross tools not prefixed with host triplet" >&2;} -ac_tool_warned=yes ;; -esac - RC=$ac_ct_RC - fi -else - RC="$ac_cv_prog_RC" -fi - - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-g" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2 -fomit-frame-pointer" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-wl,--subsystem,console ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW="-wl,--subsystem,windows ${lflags}" - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for cross-compile version of gcc" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for cross-compile version of gcc... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_cross+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - - #ifdef _WIN32 - #error cross-compiler - #endif - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_cross=yes -else - ac_cv_cross=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_cross" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_cross" >&6; } - if test "$ac_cv_cross" = "yes"; then - case "$do64bit" in - amd64|x64|yes) - CC="x86_64-w64-mingw32-gcc" - LD="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ld" - AR="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ar" - RANLIB="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ranlib" - RC="x86_64-w64-mingw32-windres" - ;; - *) - CC="i686-w64-mingw32-gcc" - LD="i686-w64-mingw32-ld" - AR="i686-w64-mingw32-ar" - RANLIB="i686-w64-mingw32-ranlib" - RC="i686-w64-mingw32-windres" - ;; - esac - fi - - else - SHLIB_LD="${LINKBIN} -dll ${lflags}" - # link -lib only works when -lib is the first arg - STLIB_LD="${LINKBIN} -lib ${lflags}" - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.lib' - PATHTYPE=-w - # For information on what debugtype is most useful, see: - # http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/dnvc60/html/gendepdebug.asp - # and also - # http://msdn2.microsoft.com/en-us/library/y0zzbyt4%28VS.80%29.aspx - # This essentially turns it all on. - LDFLAGS_DEBUG="-debug -debugtype:cv" - LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-release" - if test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-link ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW=${LDFLAGS_CONSOLE} - else - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-link -subsystem:console ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW="-link -subsystem:windows ${lflags}" - fi - fi - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dll" - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.dll' - - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - AIX-*) - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1" -a "$GCC" != "yes"; then : - - # AIX requires the _r compiler when gcc isn't being used - case "${CC}" in - *_r|*_r\ *) - # ok ... - ;; - *) - # Make sure only first arg gets _r - CC=`echo "$CC" | sed -e 's/^\([^ ]*\)/\1_r/'` - ;; - esac - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: Using $CC for compiling with threads" >&5 -$as_echo "Using $CC for compiling with threads" >&6; } - -fi - LIBS="$LIBS -lc" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LIBPATH" - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - if test "$do64bit" = yes; then : - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&2;} - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -q64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-q64" - RANLIB="${RANLIB} -X64" - AR="${AR} -X64" - SHLIB_LD_FLAGS="-b64" - -fi - -fi - - if test "`uname -m`" = ia64; then : - - # AIX-5 uses ELF style dynamic libraries on IA-64, but not PPC - SHLIB_LD="/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text" - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - -else - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - -fi - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - -else - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared -Wl,-bexpall' - -else - - SHLIB_LD="/bin/ld -bhalt:4 -bM:SRE -bexpall -H512 -T512 -bnoentry" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -brtl" - -fi - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} ${SHLIB_LD_FLAGS}" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-L${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - -fi - ;; - BeOS*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -nostart' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - #----------------------------------------------------------- - # Check for inet_ntoa in -lbind, for BeOS (which also needs - # -lsocket, even if the network functions are in -lnet which - # is always linked to, for compatibility. - #----------------------------------------------------------- - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for inet_ntoa in -lbind" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for inet_ntoa in -lbind... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lbind $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char inet_ntoa (); -int -main () -{ -return inet_ntoa (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_bind_inet_ntoa" = xyes; then : - LIBS="$LIBS -lbind -lsocket" -fi - - ;; - BSD/OS-4.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-export-dynamic -fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -export-dynamic" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - CYGWIN_*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -Wl,--out-implib,\$@.a" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dll" - EXEEXT=".exe" - do64bit_ok=yes - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - Haiku*) - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,--export-dynamic" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS} -shared' - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for inet_ntoa in -lnetwork" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for inet_ntoa in -lnetwork... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-lnetwork $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char inet_ntoa (); -int -main () -{ -return inet_ntoa (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_network_inet_ntoa" = xyes; then : - LIBS="$LIBS -lnetwork" -fi - - ;; - HP-UX-*.11.*) - # Use updated header definitions where possible - -$as_echo "#define _XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED 1" >>confdefs.h - - # TEA specific: Needed by Tcl, but not most extensions - #AC_DEFINE(_XOPEN_SOURCE, 1, [Do we want to use the XOPEN network library?]) - #LIBS="$LIBS -lxnet" # Use the XOPEN network library - - if test "`uname -m`" = ia64; then : - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - # Use newer C++ library for C++ extensions - #if test "$GCC" != "yes" ; then - # CPPFLAGS="-AA" - #fi - -else - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".sl" - -fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for shl_load in -ldld" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for shl_load in -ldld... " >&6; } -if ${ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - ac_check_lib_save_LIBS=$LIBS -LIBS="-ldld $LIBS" -cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -/* Override any GCC internal prototype to avoid an error. - Use char because int might match the return type of a GCC - builtin and then its argument prototype would still apply. */ -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" -#endif -char shl_load (); -int -main () -{ -return shl_load (); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load=yes -else - ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext -LIBS=$ac_check_lib_save_LIBS -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load" >&5 -$as_echo "$ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load" >&6; } -if test "x$ac_cv_lib_dld_shl_load" = xyes; then : - tcl_ok=yes -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = yes; then : - - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-E" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,+s,+b,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}:.' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='+s +b ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}:.' - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="SHLIB_PATH" - -fi - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - -else - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -z" - # Users may want PA-RISC 1.1/2.0 portable code - needs HP cc - #CFLAGS="$CFLAGS +DAportable" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="+z" - SHLIB_LD="ld -b" - -fi - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - if test "$do64bit" = "yes"; then : - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - case `${CC} -dumpmachine` in - hppa64*) - # 64-bit gcc in use. Fix flags for GNU ld. - do64bit_ok=yes - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ;; - *) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&2;} - ;; - esac - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS +DD64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="+DD64" - -fi - -fi ;; - IRIX-6.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD="ld -n32 -shared -rdata_shared" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mabi=n32" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -mabi=n32" - -else - - case $system in - IRIX-6.3) - # Use to build 6.2 compatible binaries on 6.3. - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -n32 -D_OLD_TERMIOS" - ;; - *) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -n32" - ;; - esac - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -n32" - -fi - ;; - IRIX64-6.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD="ld -n32 -shared -rdata_shared" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - - if test "$do64bit" = yes; then : - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported by gcc" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported by gcc" >&2;} - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - SHLIB_LD="ld -64 -shared -rdata_shared" - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-64" - -fi - -fi - ;; - Linux*|GNU*|NetBSD-Debian) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - # TEA specific: - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2 -fomit-frame-pointer" - - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT} -shared' - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,--export-dynamic" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - if test "`uname -m`" = "alpha"; then : - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mieee" -fi - if test $do64bit = yes; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if compiler accepts -m64 flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if compiler accepts -m64 flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cc_m64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cc_m64=yes -else - tcl_cv_cc_m64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cc_m64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cc_m64" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_cc_m64 = yes; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - do64bit_ok=yes - -fi - -fi - - # The combo of gcc + glibc has a bug related to inlining of - # functions like strtod(). The -fno-builtin flag should address - # this problem but it does not work. The -fno-inline flag is kind - # of overkill but it works. Disable inlining only when one of the - # files in compat/*.c is being linked in. - - if test x"${USE_COMPAT}" != x; then : - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -fno-inline" -fi - ;; - Lynx*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-02 - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - LD_FLAGS="-Wl,--export-dynamic" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - ;; - OpenBSD-*) - arch=`arch -s` - case "$arch" in - alpha|sparc64) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - ;; - *) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fpic" - ;; - esac - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${SHLIB_CFLAGS} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.so${SHLIB_VERSION}' - LDFLAGS="-Wl,-export-dynamic" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2" - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"; then : - - # On OpenBSD: Compile with -pthread - # Don't link with -lpthread - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-lpthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - -fi - # OpenBSD doesn't do version numbers with dots. - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - NetBSD-*) - # NetBSD has ELF and can use 'cc -shared' to build shared libs - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${SHLIB_CFLAGS} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -export-dynamic" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"; then : - - # The -pthread needs to go in the CFLAGS, not LIBS - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-pthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -pthread" - -fi - ;; - DragonFly-*|FreeBSD-*) - # This configuration from FreeBSD Ports. - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD="${CC} -shared" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -Wl,-soname,\$@" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"; then : - - # The -pthread needs to go in the LDFLAGS, not LIBS - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-pthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS $PTHREAD_CFLAGS" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS $PTHREAD_LIBS" -fi - case $system in - FreeBSD-3.*) - # Version numbers are dot-stripped by system policy. - TCL_TRIM_DOTS=`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .` - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}\$\{DBGX\}.so.1' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - esac - ;; - Darwin-*) - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-Os" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fno-common" - # To avoid discrepancies between what headers configure sees during - # preprocessing tests and compiling tests, move any -isysroot and - # -mmacosx-version-min flags from CFLAGS to CPPFLAGS: - CPPFLAGS="${CPPFLAGS} `echo " ${CFLAGS}" | \ - awk 'BEGIN {FS=" +-";ORS=" "}; {for (i=2;i<=NF;i++) \ - if ($i~/^(isysroot|mmacosx-version-min)/) print "-"$i}'`" - CFLAGS="`echo " ${CFLAGS}" | \ - awk 'BEGIN {FS=" +-";ORS=" "}; {for (i=2;i<=NF;i++) \ - if (!($i~/^(isysroot|mmacosx-version-min)/)) print "-"$i}'`" - if test $do64bit = yes; then : - - case `arch` in - ppc) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if compiler accepts -arch ppc64 flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if compiler accepts -arch ppc64 flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch ppc64 -mpowerpc64 -mcpu=G5" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64=yes -else - tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64 = yes; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch ppc64 -mpowerpc64 -mcpu=G5" - do64bit_ok=yes - -fi;; - i386) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if compiler accepts -arch x86_64 flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if compiler accepts -arch x86_64 flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch x86_64" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64=yes -else - tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64 = yes; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch x86_64" - do64bit_ok=yes - -fi;; - *) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: Don't know how enable 64-bit on architecture \`arch\`" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: Don't know how enable 64-bit on architecture \`arch\`" >&2;};; - esac - -else - - # Check for combined 32-bit and 64-bit fat build - if echo "$CFLAGS " |grep -E -q -- '-arch (ppc64|x86_64) ' \ - && echo "$CFLAGS " |grep -E -q -- '-arch (ppc|i386) '; then : - - fat_32_64=yes -fi - -fi - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -dynamiclib ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT}' - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if ld accepts -single_module flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if ld accepts -single_module flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_ld_single_module+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -dynamiclib -Wl,-single_module" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -int i; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_ld_single_module=yes -else - tcl_cv_ld_single_module=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_ld_single_module" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_ld_single_module" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_ld_single_module = yes; then : - - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} -Wl,-single_module" - -fi - # TEA specific: link shlib with current and compatibility version flags - vers=`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | sed -e 's/^\([0-9]\{1,5\}\)\(\(\.[0-9]\{1,3\}\)\{0,2\}\).*$/\1\2/p' -e d` - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} -current_version ${vers:-0} -compatibility_version ${vers:-0}" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dylib" - # Don't use -prebind when building for Mac OS X 10.4 or later only: - if test "`echo "${MACOSX_DEPLOYMENT_TARGET}" | awk -F '10\\.' '{print int($2)}'`" -lt 4 -a \ - "`echo "${CPPFLAGS}" | awk -F '-mmacosx-version-min=10\\.' '{print int($2)}'`" -lt 4; then : - - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -prebind" -fi - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -headerpad_max_install_names" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking if ld accepts -search_paths_first flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking if ld accepts -search_paths_first flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-search_paths_first" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -int i; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first=yes -else - tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first = yes; then : - - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-search_paths_first" - -fi - if test "$tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" != yes; then : - - -$as_echo "#define MODULE_SCOPE __private_extern__" >>confdefs.h - - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=yes - -fi - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="DYLD_LIBRARY_PATH" - # TEA specific: for combined 32 & 64 bit fat builds of Tk - # extensions, verify that 64-bit build is possible. - if test "$fat_32_64" = yes && test -n "${TK_BIN_DIR}"; then : - - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = x11; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for 64-bit X11" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for 64-bit X11... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_lib_x11_64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval 'hold_'$v'="$'$v'";'$v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc / /g" -e "s/-arch i386 / /g"`"' - done - CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS -I/usr/X11R6/include" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -L/usr/X11R6/lib -lX11" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -XrmInitialize(); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_lib_x11_64=yes -else - tcl_cv_lib_x11_64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="$hold_'$v'"' - done -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_lib_x11_64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_lib_x11_64" >&6; } - -fi - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = aqua; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for 64-bit Tk" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for 64-bit Tk... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_lib_tk_64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval 'hold_'$v'="$'$v'";'$v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc / /g" -e "s/-arch i386 / /g"`"' - done - CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS -DUSE_TCL_STUBS=1 -DUSE_TK_STUBS=1 ${TCL_INCLUDES} ${TK_INCLUDES}" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS ${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC} ${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -Tk_InitStubs(NULL, "", 0); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_lib_tk_64=yes -else - tcl_cv_lib_tk_64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="$hold_'$v'"' - done -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_lib_tk_64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_lib_tk_64" >&6; } - -fi - # remove 64-bit arch flags from CFLAGS et al. if configuration - # does not support 64-bit. - if test "$tcl_cv_lib_tk_64" = no -o "$tcl_cv_lib_x11_64" = no; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: Removing 64-bit architectures from compiler & linker flags" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: Removing 64-bit architectures from compiler & linker flags" >&6;} - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc64 / /g" -e "s/-arch x86_64 / /g"`"' - done -fi - -fi - ;; - OS/390-*) - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="" # Optimizer is buggy - -$as_echo "#define _OE_SOCKETS 1" >>confdefs.h - - ;; - OSF1-V*) - # Digital OSF/1 - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - if test "$SHARED_BUILD" = 1; then : - - SHLIB_LD='ld -shared -expect_unresolved "*"' - -else - - SHLIB_LD='ld -non_shared -expect_unresolved "*"' - -fi - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test $doRpath = yes; then : - - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' -fi - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mieee" -else - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DHAVE_TZSET -std1 -ieee" -fi - # see pthread_intro(3) for pthread support on osf1, k.furukawa - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DHAVE_PTHREAD_ATTR_SETSTACKSIZE" - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DTCL_THREAD_STACK_MIN=PTHREAD_STACK_MIN*64" - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-lpthreads//` - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - LIBS="$LIBS -lpthread -lmach -lexc" - -else - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -pthread" - -fi - -fi - ;; - QNX-6*) - # QNX RTP - # This may work for all QNX, but it was only reported for v6. - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD="ld -Bshareable -x" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - SCO_SV-3.2*) - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC -melf" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -melf -Wl,-Bexport" - -else - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-Kpic -belf" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -belf -Wl,-Bexport" - -fi - SHLIB_LD="ld -G" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - SunOS-5.[0-6]) - # Careful to not let 5.10+ fall into this case - - # Note: If _REENTRANT isn't defined, then Solaris - # won't define thread-safe library routines. - - -$as_echo "#define _REENTRANT 1" >>confdefs.h - - -$as_echo "#define _POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS 1" >>confdefs.h - - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - -else - - SHLIB_LD="/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - -fi - ;; - SunOS-5*) - # Note: If _REENTRANT isn't defined, then Solaris - # won't define thread-safe library routines. - - -$as_echo "#define _REENTRANT 1" >>confdefs.h - - -$as_echo "#define _POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS 1" >>confdefs.h - - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - if test "$do64bit" = yes; then : - - arch=`isainfo` - if test "$arch" = "sparcv9 sparc"; then : - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - if test "`${CC} -dumpversion | awk -F. '{print $1}'`" -lt 3; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC < 3.2 on $system" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC < 3.2 on $system" >&2;} - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64 -mcpu=v9" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64 -mcpu=v9" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - -fi - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - if test "$do64bitVIS" = yes; then : - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=v9a" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-xarch=v9a" - -else - - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=v9" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-xarch=v9" - -fi - # Solaris 64 uses this as well - #LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LD_LIBRARY_PATH_64" - -fi - -else - if test "$arch" = "amd64 i386"; then : - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - case $system in - SunOS-5.1[1-9]*|SunOS-5.[2-9][0-9]*) - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64";; - *) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system" >&2;};; - esac - -else - - do64bit_ok=yes - case $system in - SunOS-5.1[1-9]*|SunOS-5.[2-9][0-9]*) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64";; - *) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=amd64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -xarch=amd64";; - esac - -fi - -else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported for $arch" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit mode not supported for $arch" >&2;} -fi -fi - -fi - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - if test "$do64bit_ok" = yes; then : - - if test "$arch" = "sparcv9 sparc"; then : - - # We need to specify -static-libgcc or we need to - # add the path to the sparv9 libgcc. - # JH: static-libgcc is necessary for core Tcl, but may - # not be necessary for extensions. - SHLIB_LD="$SHLIB_LD -m64 -mcpu=v9 -static-libgcc" - # for finding sparcv9 libgcc, get the regular libgcc - # path, remove so name and append 'sparcv9' - #v9gcclibdir="`gcc -print-file-name=libgcc_s.so` | ..." - #CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS},-R,$v9gcclibdir" - -else - if test "$arch" = "amd64 i386"; then : - - # JH: static-libgcc is necessary for core Tcl, but may - # not be necessary for extensions. - SHLIB_LD="$SHLIB_LD -m64 -static-libgcc" - -fi -fi - -fi - -else - - case $system in - SunOS-5.[1-9][0-9]*) - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -G -z text ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT}';; - *) - SHLIB_LD='/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text';; - esac - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - -fi - ;; - UNIX_SV* | UnixWare-5*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -G' - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - # Some UNIX_SV* systems (unixware 1.1.2 for example) have linkers - # that don't grok the -Bexport option. Test that it does. - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for ld accepts -Bexport flag" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for ld accepts -Bexport flag... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_ld_Bexport+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-Bexport" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -int i; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_link "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_ld_Bexport=yes -else - tcl_cv_ld_Bexport=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext \ - conftest$ac_exeext conftest.$ac_ext - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_ld_Bexport" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_ld_Bexport" >&6; } - if test $tcl_cv_ld_Bexport = yes; then : - - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-Bexport" - -fi - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - esac - - if test "$do64bit" = yes -a "$do64bit_ok" = no; then : - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: 64bit support being disabled -- don't know magic for this platform" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: 64bit support being disabled -- don't know magic for this platform" >&2;} - -fi - - - - # Add in the arch flags late to ensure it wasn't removed. - # Not necessary in TEA, but this is aligned with core - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS $LDFLAGS_ARCH" - - # If we're running gcc, then change the C flags for compiling shared - # libraries to the right flags for gcc, instead of those for the - # standard manufacturer compiler. - - if test "$GCC" = yes; then : - - case $system in - AIX-*) ;; - BSD/OS*) ;; - CYGWIN_*|MINGW32_*|MINGW64_*) ;; - IRIX*) ;; - NetBSD-*|DragonFly-*|FreeBSD-*|OpenBSD-*) ;; - Darwin-*) ;; - SCO_SV-3.2*) ;; - windows) ;; - *) SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" ;; - esac -fi - - if test "$tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" != yes; then : - - -$as_echo "#define MODULE_SCOPE extern" >>confdefs.h - - -fi - - if test "$SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX" = ""; then : - - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${PACKAGE_VERSION}${SHLIB_SUFFIX}' -fi - if test "$UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX" = ""; then : - - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${PACKAGE_VERSION}.a' -fi - - if test "${GCC}" = "yes" -a ${SHLIB_SUFFIX} = ".dll"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for SEH support in compiler" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for SEH support in compiler... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_seh+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - if test "$cross_compiling" = yes; then : - tcl_cv_seh=no -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#include -#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - - int main(int argc, char** argv) { - int a, b = 0; - __try { - a = 666 / b; - } - __except (EXCEPTION_EXECUTE_HANDLER) { - return 0; - } - return 1; - } - -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_run "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_seh=yes -else - tcl_cv_seh=no -fi -rm -f core *.core core.conftest.* gmon.out bb.out conftest$ac_exeext \ - conftest.$ac_objext conftest.beam conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_seh" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_seh" >&6; } - if test "$tcl_cv_seh" = "no" ; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_NO_SEH 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - # - # Check to see if the excpt.h include file provided contains the - # definition for EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION; if not, which is the case - # with Cygwin's version as of 2002-04-10, define it to be int, - # sufficient for getting the current code to work. - # - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION support in include files" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION support in include files... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_eh_disposition+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -# include -# undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - -int -main () -{ - - EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION x; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_eh_disposition=yes -else - tcl_cv_eh_disposition=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_eh_disposition" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_eh_disposition" >&6; } - if test "$tcl_cv_eh_disposition" = "no" ; then - -$as_echo "#define EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION int" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - # Check to see if winnt.h defines CHAR, SHORT, and LONG - # even if VOID has already been #defined. The win32api - # used by mingw and cygwin is known to do this. - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for winnt.h that ignores VOID define" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for winnt.h that ignores VOID define... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -#define VOID void -#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#include -#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - -int -main () -{ - - CHAR c; - SHORT s; - LONG l; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void=yes -else - tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void" >&6; } - if test "$tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void" = "yes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_WINNT_IGNORE_VOID 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - fi - - # See if the compiler supports casting to a union type. - # This is used to stop gcc from printing a compiler - # warning when initializing a union member. - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for cast to union support" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for cast to union support... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_cast_to_union+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ - - union foo { int i; double d; }; - union foo f = (union foo) (int) 0; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_cast_to_union=yes -else - tcl_cv_cast_to_union=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_cast_to_union" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_cast_to_union" >&6; } - if test "$tcl_cv_cast_to_union" = "yes"; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_CAST_TO_UNION 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - - - - - - - - - - - - - # These must be called after we do the basic CFLAGS checks and - # verify any possible 64-bit or similar switches are necessary - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for required early compiler flags" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for required early compiler flags... " >&6; } - tcl_flags="" - - if ${tcl_cv_flag__isoc99_source+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -char *p = (char *)strtoll; char *q = (char *)strtoull; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__isoc99_source=no -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#define _ISOC99_SOURCE 1 -#include -int -main () -{ -char *p = (char *)strtoll; char *q = (char *)strtoull; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__isoc99_source=yes -else - tcl_cv_flag__isoc99_source=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - if test "x${tcl_cv_flag__isoc99_source}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define _ISOC99_SOURCE 1" >>confdefs.h - - tcl_flags="$tcl_flags _ISOC99_SOURCE" - fi - - - if ${tcl_cv_flag__largefile64_source+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -struct stat64 buf; int i = stat64("/", &buf); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__largefile64_source=no -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#define _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE 1 -#include -int -main () -{ -struct stat64 buf; int i = stat64("/", &buf); - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__largefile64_source=yes -else - tcl_cv_flag__largefile64_source=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - if test "x${tcl_cv_flag__largefile64_source}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE 1" >>confdefs.h - - tcl_flags="$tcl_flags _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE" - fi - - - if ${tcl_cv_flag__largefile_source64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -char *p = (char *)open64; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__largefile_source64=no -else - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE64 1 -#include -int -main () -{ -char *p = (char *)open64; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_flag__largefile_source64=yes -else - tcl_cv_flag__largefile_source64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - if test "x${tcl_cv_flag__largefile_source64}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE64 1" >>confdefs.h - - tcl_flags="$tcl_flags _LARGEFILE_SOURCE64" - fi - - if test "x${tcl_flags}" = "x" ; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: none" >&5 -$as_echo "none" >&6; } - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${tcl_flags}" >&5 -$as_echo "${tcl_flags}" >&6; } - fi - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for 64-bit integer type" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for 64-bit integer type... " >&6; } - if ${tcl_cv_type_64bit+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - tcl_cv_type_64bit=none - # See if the compiler knows natively about __int64 - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -__int64 value = (__int64) 0; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_type_64bit=__int64 -else - tcl_type_64bit="long long" -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext - # See if we should use long anyway Note that we substitute in the - # type that is our current guess for a 64-bit type inside this check - # program, so it should be modified only carefully... - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -int -main () -{ -switch (0) { - case 1: case (sizeof(${tcl_type_64bit})==sizeof(long)): ; - } - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_type_64bit=${tcl_type_64bit} -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - if test "${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" = none ; then - -$as_echo "#define TCL_WIDE_INT_IS_LONG 1" >>confdefs.h - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: using long" >&5 -$as_echo "using long" >&6; } - elif test "${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" = "__int64" \ - -a "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - # TEA specific: We actually want to use the default tcl.h checks in - # this case to handle both TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE and TCL_LL_MODIFIER* - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: using Tcl header defaults" >&5 -$as_echo "using Tcl header defaults" >&6; } - else - -cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE ${tcl_cv_type_64bit} -_ACEOF - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" >&5 -$as_echo "${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" >&6; } - - # Now check for auxiliary declarations - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for struct dirent64" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for struct dirent64... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_struct_dirent64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -#include -int -main () -{ -struct dirent64 p; - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_struct_dirent64=yes -else - tcl_cv_struct_dirent64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_struct_dirent64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_struct_dirent64" >&6; } - if test "x${tcl_cv_struct_dirent64}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT64 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for struct stat64" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for struct stat64... " >&6; } -if ${tcl_cv_struct_stat64+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -struct stat64 p; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_struct_stat64=yes -else - tcl_cv_struct_stat64=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: $tcl_cv_struct_stat64" >&5 -$as_echo "$tcl_cv_struct_stat64" >&6; } - if test "x${tcl_cv_struct_stat64}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_STRUCT_STAT64 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - for ac_func in open64 lseek64 -do : - as_ac_var=`$as_echo "ac_cv_func_$ac_func" | $as_tr_sh` -ac_fn_c_check_func "$LINENO" "$ac_func" "$as_ac_var" -if eval test \"x\$"$as_ac_var"\" = x"yes"; then : - cat >>confdefs.h <<_ACEOF -#define `$as_echo "HAVE_$ac_func" | $as_tr_cpp` 1 -_ACEOF - -fi -done - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for off64_t" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for off64_t... " >&6; } - if ${tcl_cv_type_off64_t+:} false; then : - $as_echo_n "(cached) " >&6 -else - - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ -#include -int -main () -{ -off64_t offset; - - ; - return 0; -} -_ACEOF -if ac_fn_c_try_compile "$LINENO"; then : - tcl_cv_type_off64_t=yes -else - tcl_cv_type_off64_t=no -fi -rm -f core conftest.err conftest.$ac_objext conftest.$ac_ext -fi - - if test "x${tcl_cv_type_off64_t}" = "xyes" && \ - test "x${ac_cv_func_lseek64}" = "xyes" && \ - test "x${ac_cv_func_open64}" = "xyes" ; then - -$as_echo "#define HAVE_TYPE_OFF64_T 1" >>confdefs.h - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: yes" >&5 -$as_echo "yes" >&6; } - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } - fi - fi - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Set the default compiler switches based on the --enable-symbols option. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for build with symbols" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for build with symbols... " >&6; } - # Check whether --enable-symbols was given. -if test "${enable_symbols+set}" = set; then : - enableval=$enable_symbols; tcl_ok=$enableval -else - tcl_ok=no -fi - - DBGX="" - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - CFLAGS_DEFAULT="${CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE} -DNDEBUG" - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE}" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: no" >&5 -$as_echo "no" >&6; } - else - CFLAGS_DEFAULT="${CFLAGS_DEBUG}" - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS_DEBUG}" - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: yes (standard debugging)" >&5 -$as_echo "yes (standard debugging)" >&6; } - fi - fi - # TEA specific: - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" ; then - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS}" - fi - - - - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "mem" -o "$tcl_ok" = "all"; then - -$as_echo "#define TCL_MEM_DEBUG 1" >>confdefs.h - - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" != "yes" -a "$tcl_ok" != "no"; then - if test "$tcl_ok" = "all"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: enabled symbols mem debugging" >&5 -$as_echo "enabled symbols mem debugging" >&6; } - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: enabled $tcl_ok debugging" >&5 -$as_echo "enabled $tcl_ok debugging" >&6; } - fi - fi - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# This macro generates a line to use when building a library. It -# depends on values set by the TEA_ENABLE_SHARED, TEA_ENABLE_SYMBOLS, -# and TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG macros above. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" != "yes"; then - MAKE_STATIC_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} -out:\$@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="\${SHLIB_LD} \${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT} -out:\$@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - cat confdefs.h - <<_ACEOF >conftest.$ac_ext -/* end confdefs.h. */ - -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1400 -print("manifest needed") -#endif - -_ACEOF -if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 | - $EGREP "manifest needed" >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - - # Could do a CHECK_PROG for mt, but should always be with MSVC8+ - VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL="if test -f \$@.manifest ; then mt.exe -nologo -manifest \$@.manifest -outputresource:\$@\;2 ; fi" - VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE="if test -f \$@.manifest ; then mt.exe -nologo -manifest \$@.manifest -outputresource:\$@\;1 ; fi" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="${MAKE_SHARED_LIB} ; ${VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL}" - - CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES *.manifest" - - -fi -rm -f conftest* - - MAKE_STUB_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} -nodefaultlib -out:\$@ \$(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS)" - else - MAKE_STATIC_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} \$@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="\${SHLIB_LD} -o \$@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS) \${SHLIB_LD_LIBS}" - MAKE_STUB_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} \$@ \$(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS)" - fi - - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - MAKE_LIB="${MAKE_SHARED_LIB} " - else - MAKE_LIB="${MAKE_STATIC_LIB} " - fi - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Shared libraries and static libraries have different names. - # Use the double eval to make sure any variables in the suffix is - # substituted. (@@@ Might not be necessary anymore) - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - # We force the unresolved linking of symbols that are really in - # the private libraries of Tcl and Tk. - if test x"${TK_BIN_DIR}" != x ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \"`${CYGPATH} ${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}`\"" - fi - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \"`${CYGPATH} ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}`\"" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -static-libgcc" - fi - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - else - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PKG_LIB_FILE} - fi - fi - # Some packages build their own stubs libraries - eval eval "PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}stub${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=lib${PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE} - fi - # These aren't needed on Windows (either MSVC or gcc) - RANLIB=: - RANLIB_STUB=: - else - RANLIB_STUB="${RANLIB}" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} ${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - if test x"${TK_BIN_DIR}" != x ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} ${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - fi - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - RANLIB=: - else - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - fi - # Some packages build their own stubs libraries - eval eval "PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}stub${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - fi - - # These are escaped so that only CFLAGS is picked up at configure time. - # The other values will be substituted at make time. - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} \${CFLAGS_DEFAULT} \${CFLAGS_WARNING}" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} \${SHLIB_CFLAGS}" - fi - - - - - - - - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Determine the name of the tclsh and/or wish executables in the -# Tcl and Tk build directories or the location they were installed -# into. These paths are used to support running test cases only, -# the Makefile should not be making use of these paths to generate -# a pkgIndex.tcl file or anything else at extension build time. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for tclsh" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for tclsh... " >&6; } - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - # tclConfig.sh is in Tcl build directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" - fi - else - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh" - fi - else - # tclConfig.sh is in install location - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TCLSH_PROG="tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - else - TCLSH_PROG="tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}.${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}" - fi - list="`ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../bin 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/.. 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/bin 2>/dev/null`" - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/${TCLSH_PROG}" ; then - REAL_TCL_BIN_DIR="`cd "$i"; pwd`/" - break - fi - done - TCLSH_PROG="${REAL_TCL_BIN_DIR}${TCLSH_PROG}" - fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${TCLSH_PROG}" >&5 -$as_echo "${TCLSH_PROG}" >&6; } - - - - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: checking for wish" >&5 -$as_echo_n "checking for wish... " >&6; } - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - # tkConfig.sh is in Tk build directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}$s{EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" - fi - else - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish" - fi - else - # tkConfig.sh is in install location - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - WISH_PROG="wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - else - WISH_PROG="wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}.${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}" - fi - list="`ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/../bin 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/.. 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_PREFIX}/bin 2>/dev/null`" - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/${WISH_PROG}" ; then - REAL_TK_BIN_DIR="`cd "$i"; pwd`/" - break - fi - done - WISH_PROG="${REAL_TK_BIN_DIR}${WISH_PROG}" - fi - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: result: ${WISH_PROG}" >&5 -$as_echo "${WISH_PROG}" >&6; } - - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Setup a *Config.sh.in configuration file. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # These are for tkbltConfig.sh - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - # pkglibdir must be a fully qualified path and (not ${exec_prefix}/lib) - eval pkglibdir="${libdir}/tkblt${PACKAGE_VERSION}" - if test "${TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK}" = "ok"; then - eval tkblt_LIB_FLAG="-ltkblt${PACKAGE_VERSION}${DBGX}" - eval tkblt_STUB_LIB_FLAG="-ltkbltstub${PACKAGE_VERSION}${DBGX}" - else - eval tkblt_LIB_FLAG="-ltkblt`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`${DBGX}" - eval tkblt_STUB_LIB_FLAG="-ltkbltstub`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`${DBGX}" - fi - tkblt_BUILD_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH $(pwd)` ${tkblt_LIB_FLAG}" - tkblt_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}` ${tkblt_LIB_FLAG}" - tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH $(pwd)` ${tkblt_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - tkblt_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}` ${tkblt_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH="`$CYGPATH $(pwd)`/${PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - tkblt_STUB_LIB_PATH="`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}`/${PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - - - - - - - - - - - - -#AC_SUBST(SAMPLE_VAR) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Specify files to substitute AC variables in. You may alternatively -# have a special pkgIndex.tcl.in or other files which require -# substituting the AC variables in. Include these here. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ac_config_files="$ac_config_files Makefile pkgIndex.tcl" - -ac_config_files="$ac_config_files tkbltConfig.sh" - - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Finally, substitute all of the various values into the files -# specified with AC_CONFIG_FILES. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -cat >confcache <<\_ACEOF -# This file is a shell script that caches the results of configure -# tests run on this system so they can be shared between configure -# scripts and configure runs, see configure's option --config-cache. -# It is not useful on other systems. If it contains results you don't -# want to keep, you may remove or edit it. -# -# config.status only pays attention to the cache file if you give it -# the --recheck option to rerun configure. -# -# `ac_cv_env_foo' variables (set or unset) will be overridden when -# loading this file, other *unset* `ac_cv_foo' will be assigned the -# following values. - -_ACEOF - -# The following way of writing the cache mishandles newlines in values, -# but we know of no workaround that is simple, portable, and efficient. -# So, we kill variables containing newlines. -# Ultrix sh set writes to stderr and can't be redirected directly, -# and sets the high bit in the cache file unless we assign to the vars. -( - for ac_var in `(set) 2>&1 | sed -n 's/^\([a-zA-Z_][a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)=.*/\1/p'`; do - eval ac_val=\$$ac_var - case $ac_val in #( - *${as_nl}*) - case $ac_var in #( - *_cv_*) { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: cache variable $ac_var contains a newline" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: cache variable $ac_var contains a newline" >&2;} ;; - esac - case $ac_var in #( - _ | IFS | as_nl) ;; #( - BASH_ARGV | BASH_SOURCE) eval $ac_var= ;; #( - *) { eval $ac_var=; unset $ac_var;} ;; - esac ;; - esac - done - - (set) 2>&1 | - case $as_nl`(ac_space=' '; set) 2>&1` in #( - *${as_nl}ac_space=\ *) - # `set' does not quote correctly, so add quotes: double-quote - # substitution turns \\\\ into \\, and sed turns \\ into \. - sed -n \ - "s/'/'\\\\''/g; - s/^\\([_$as_cr_alnum]*_cv_[_$as_cr_alnum]*\\)=\\(.*\\)/\\1='\\2'/p" - ;; #( - *) - # `set' quotes correctly as required by POSIX, so do not add quotes. - sed -n "/^[_$as_cr_alnum]*_cv_[_$as_cr_alnum]*=/p" - ;; - esac | - sort -) | - sed ' - /^ac_cv_env_/b end - t clear - :clear - s/^\([^=]*\)=\(.*[{}].*\)$/test "${\1+set}" = set || &/ - t end - s/^\([^=]*\)=\(.*\)$/\1=${\1=\2}/ - :end' >>confcache -if diff "$cache_file" confcache >/dev/null 2>&1; then :; else - if test -w "$cache_file"; then - if test "x$cache_file" != "x/dev/null"; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: updating cache $cache_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: updating cache $cache_file" >&6;} - if test ! -f "$cache_file" || test -h "$cache_file"; then - cat confcache >"$cache_file" - else - case $cache_file in #( - */* | ?:*) - mv -f confcache "$cache_file"$$ && - mv -f "$cache_file"$$ "$cache_file" ;; #( - *) - mv -f confcache "$cache_file" ;; - esac - fi - fi - else - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: not updating unwritable cache $cache_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: not updating unwritable cache $cache_file" >&6;} - fi -fi -rm -f confcache - -test "x$prefix" = xNONE && prefix=$ac_default_prefix -# Let make expand exec_prefix. -test "x$exec_prefix" = xNONE && exec_prefix='${prefix}' - -# Transform confdefs.h into DEFS. -# Protect against shell expansion while executing Makefile rules. -# Protect against Makefile macro expansion. -# -# If the first sed substitution is executed (which looks for macros that -# take arguments), then branch to the quote section. Otherwise, -# look for a macro that doesn't take arguments. -ac_script=' -:mline -/\\$/{ - N - s,\\\n,, - b mline -} -t clear -:clear -s/^[ ]*#[ ]*define[ ][ ]*\([^ (][^ (]*([^)]*)\)[ ]*\(.*\)/-D\1=\2/g -t quote -s/^[ ]*#[ ]*define[ ][ ]*\([^ ][^ ]*\)[ ]*\(.*\)/-D\1=\2/g -t quote -b any -:quote -s/[ `~#$^&*(){}\\|;'\''"<>?]/\\&/g -s/\[/\\&/g -s/\]/\\&/g -s/\$/$$/g -H -:any -${ - g - s/^\n// - s/\n/ /g - p -} -' -DEFS=`sed -n "$ac_script" confdefs.h` - - -ac_libobjs= -ac_ltlibobjs= -U= -for ac_i in : $LIBOBJS; do test "x$ac_i" = x: && continue - # 1. Remove the extension, and $U if already installed. - ac_script='s/\$U\././;s/\.o$//;s/\.obj$//' - ac_i=`$as_echo "$ac_i" | sed "$ac_script"` - # 2. Prepend LIBOBJDIR. When used with automake>=1.10 LIBOBJDIR - # will be set to the directory where LIBOBJS objects are built. - as_fn_append ac_libobjs " \${LIBOBJDIR}$ac_i\$U.$ac_objext" - as_fn_append ac_ltlibobjs " \${LIBOBJDIR}$ac_i"'$U.lo' -done -LIBOBJS=$ac_libobjs - -LTLIBOBJS=$ac_ltlibobjs - - - -CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} ${CPPFLAGS}"; CPPFLAGS="" - -: "${CONFIG_STATUS=./config.status}" -ac_write_fail=0 -ac_clean_files_save=$ac_clean_files -ac_clean_files="$ac_clean_files $CONFIG_STATUS" -{ $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: creating $CONFIG_STATUS" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: creating $CONFIG_STATUS" >&6;} -as_write_fail=0 -cat >$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ASEOF || as_write_fail=1 -#! $SHELL -# Generated by $as_me. -# Run this file to recreate the current configuration. -# Compiler output produced by configure, useful for debugging -# configure, is in config.log if it exists. - -debug=false -ac_cs_recheck=false -ac_cs_silent=false - -SHELL=\${CONFIG_SHELL-$SHELL} -export SHELL -_ASEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ASEOF || as_write_fail=1 -## -------------------- ## -## M4sh Initialization. ## -## -------------------- ## - -# Be more Bourne compatible -DUALCASE=1; export DUALCASE # for MKS sh -if test -n "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then : - emulate sh - NULLCMD=: - # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on ${1+"$@"}, which - # is contrary to our usage. Disable this feature. - alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"' - setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST -else - case `(set -o) 2>/dev/null` in #( - *posix*) : - set -o posix ;; #( - *) : - ;; -esac -fi - - -as_nl=' -' -export as_nl -# Printing a long string crashes Solaris 7 /usr/bin/printf. -as_echo='\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\' -as_echo=$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo -as_echo=$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo$as_echo -# Prefer a ksh shell builtin over an external printf program on Solaris, -# but without wasting forks for bash or zsh. -if test -z "$BASH_VERSION$ZSH_VERSION" \ - && (test "X`print -r -- $as_echo`" = "X$as_echo") 2>/dev/null; then - as_echo='print -r --' - as_echo_n='print -rn --' -elif (test "X`printf %s $as_echo`" = "X$as_echo") 2>/dev/null; then - as_echo='printf %s\n' - as_echo_n='printf %s' -else - if test "X`(/usr/ucb/echo -n -n $as_echo) 2>/dev/null`" = "X-n $as_echo"; then - as_echo_body='eval /usr/ucb/echo -n "$1$as_nl"' - as_echo_n='/usr/ucb/echo -n' - else - as_echo_body='eval expr "X$1" : "X\\(.*\\)"' - as_echo_n_body='eval - arg=$1; - case $arg in #( - *"$as_nl"*) - expr "X$arg" : "X\\(.*\\)$as_nl"; - arg=`expr "X$arg" : ".*$as_nl\\(.*\\)"`;; - esac; - expr "X$arg" : "X\\(.*\\)" | tr -d "$as_nl" - ' - export as_echo_n_body - as_echo_n='sh -c $as_echo_n_body as_echo' - fi - export as_echo_body - as_echo='sh -c $as_echo_body as_echo' -fi - -# The user is always right. -if test "${PATH_SEPARATOR+set}" != set; then - PATH_SEPARATOR=: - (PATH='/bin;/bin'; FPATH=$PATH; sh -c :) >/dev/null 2>&1 && { - (PATH='/bin:/bin'; FPATH=$PATH; sh -c :) >/dev/null 2>&1 || - PATH_SEPARATOR=';' - } -fi - - -# IFS -# We need space, tab and new line, in precisely that order. Quoting is -# there to prevent editors from complaining about space-tab. -# (If _AS_PATH_WALK were called with IFS unset, it would disable word -# splitting by setting IFS to empty value.) -IFS=" "" $as_nl" - -# Find who we are. Look in the path if we contain no directory separator. -as_myself= -case $0 in #(( - *[\\/]* ) as_myself=$0 ;; - *) as_save_IFS=$IFS; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR -for as_dir in $PATH -do - IFS=$as_save_IFS - test -z "$as_dir" && as_dir=. - test -r "$as_dir/$0" && as_myself=$as_dir/$0 && break - done -IFS=$as_save_IFS - - ;; -esac -# We did not find ourselves, most probably we were run as `sh COMMAND' -# in which case we are not to be found in the path. -if test "x$as_myself" = x; then - as_myself=$0 -fi -if test ! -f "$as_myself"; then - $as_echo "$as_myself: error: cannot find myself; rerun with an absolute file name" >&2 - exit 1 -fi - -# Unset variables that we do not need and which cause bugs (e.g. in -# pre-3.0 UWIN ksh). But do not cause bugs in bash 2.01; the "|| exit 1" -# suppresses any "Segmentation fault" message there. '((' could -# trigger a bug in pdksh 5.2.14. -for as_var in BASH_ENV ENV MAIL MAILPATH -do eval test x\${$as_var+set} = xset \ - && ( (unset $as_var) || exit 1) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset $as_var || : -done -PS1='$ ' -PS2='> ' -PS4='+ ' - -# NLS nuisances. -LC_ALL=C -export LC_ALL -LANGUAGE=C -export LANGUAGE - -# CDPATH. -(unset CDPATH) >/dev/null 2>&1 && unset CDPATH - - -# as_fn_error STATUS ERROR [LINENO LOG_FD] -# ---------------------------------------- -# Output "`basename $0`: error: ERROR" to stderr. If LINENO and LOG_FD are -# provided, also output the error to LOG_FD, referencing LINENO. Then exit the -# script with STATUS, using 1 if that was 0. -as_fn_error () -{ - as_status=$1; test $as_status -eq 0 && as_status=1 - if test "$4"; then - as_lineno=${as_lineno-"$3"} as_lineno_stack=as_lineno_stack=$as_lineno_stack - $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: error: $2" >&$4 - fi - $as_echo "$as_me: error: $2" >&2 - as_fn_exit $as_status -} # as_fn_error - - -# as_fn_set_status STATUS -# ----------------------- -# Set $? to STATUS, without forking. -as_fn_set_status () -{ - return $1 -} # as_fn_set_status - -# as_fn_exit STATUS -# ----------------- -# Exit the shell with STATUS, even in a "trap 0" or "set -e" context. -as_fn_exit () -{ - set +e - as_fn_set_status $1 - exit $1 -} # as_fn_exit - -# as_fn_unset VAR -# --------------- -# Portably unset VAR. -as_fn_unset () -{ - { eval $1=; unset $1;} -} -as_unset=as_fn_unset -# as_fn_append VAR VALUE -# ---------------------- -# Append the text in VALUE to the end of the definition contained in VAR. Take -# advantage of any shell optimizations that allow amortized linear growth over -# repeated appends, instead of the typical quadratic growth present in naive -# implementations. -if (eval "as_var=1; as_var+=2; test x\$as_var = x12") 2>/dev/null; then : - eval 'as_fn_append () - { - eval $1+=\$2 - }' -else - as_fn_append () - { - eval $1=\$$1\$2 - } -fi # as_fn_append - -# as_fn_arith ARG... -# ------------------ -# Perform arithmetic evaluation on the ARGs, and store the result in the -# global $as_val. Take advantage of shells that can avoid forks. The arguments -# must be portable across $(()) and expr. -if (eval "test \$(( 1 + 1 )) = 2") 2>/dev/null; then : - eval 'as_fn_arith () - { - as_val=$(( $* )) - }' -else - as_fn_arith () - { - as_val=`expr "$@" || test $? -eq 1` - } -fi # as_fn_arith - - -if expr a : '\(a\)' >/dev/null 2>&1 && - test "X`expr 00001 : '.*\(...\)'`" = X001; then - as_expr=expr -else - as_expr=false -fi - -if (basename -- /) >/dev/null 2>&1 && test "X`basename -- / 2>&1`" = "X/"; then - as_basename=basename -else - as_basename=false -fi - -if (as_dir=`dirname -- /` && test "X$as_dir" = X/) >/dev/null 2>&1; then - as_dirname=dirname -else - as_dirname=false -fi - -as_me=`$as_basename -- "$0" || -$as_expr X/"$0" : '.*/\([^/][^/]*\)/*$' \| \ - X"$0" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$0" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X/"$0" | - sed '/^.*\/\([^/][^/]*\)\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\/\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\/\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - -# Avoid depending upon Character Ranges. -as_cr_letters='abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz' -as_cr_LETTERS='ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ' -as_cr_Letters=$as_cr_letters$as_cr_LETTERS -as_cr_digits='0123456789' -as_cr_alnum=$as_cr_Letters$as_cr_digits - -ECHO_C= ECHO_N= ECHO_T= -case `echo -n x` in #((((( --n*) - case `echo 'xy\c'` in - *c*) ECHO_T=' ';; # ECHO_T is single tab character. - xy) ECHO_C='\c';; - *) echo `echo ksh88 bug on AIX 6.1` > /dev/null - ECHO_T=' ';; - esac;; -*) - ECHO_N='-n';; -esac - -rm -f conf$$ conf$$.exe conf$$.file -if test -d conf$$.dir; then - rm -f conf$$.dir/conf$$.file -else - rm -f conf$$.dir - mkdir conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null -fi -if (echo >conf$$.file) 2>/dev/null; then - if ln -s conf$$.file conf$$ 2>/dev/null; then - as_ln_s='ln -s' - # ... but there are two gotchas: - # 1) On MSYS, both `ln -s file dir' and `ln file dir' fail. - # 2) DJGPP < 2.04 has no symlinks; `ln -s' creates a wrapper executable. - # In both cases, we have to default to `cp -pR'. - ln -s conf$$.file conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null && test ! -f conf$$.exe || - as_ln_s='cp -pR' - elif ln conf$$.file conf$$ 2>/dev/null; then - as_ln_s=ln - else - as_ln_s='cp -pR' - fi -else - as_ln_s='cp -pR' -fi -rm -f conf$$ conf$$.exe conf$$.dir/conf$$.file conf$$.file -rmdir conf$$.dir 2>/dev/null - - -# as_fn_mkdir_p -# ------------- -# Create "$as_dir" as a directory, including parents if necessary. -as_fn_mkdir_p () -{ - - case $as_dir in #( - -*) as_dir=./$as_dir;; - esac - test -d "$as_dir" || eval $as_mkdir_p || { - as_dirs= - while :; do - case $as_dir in #( - *\'*) as_qdir=`$as_echo "$as_dir" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;; #'( - *) as_qdir=$as_dir;; - esac - as_dirs="'$as_qdir' $as_dirs" - as_dir=`$as_dirname -- "$as_dir" || -$as_expr X"$as_dir" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$as_dir" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X"$as_dir" | - sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - test -d "$as_dir" && break - done - test -z "$as_dirs" || eval "mkdir $as_dirs" - } || test -d "$as_dir" || as_fn_error $? "cannot create directory $as_dir" - - -} # as_fn_mkdir_p -if mkdir -p . 2>/dev/null; then - as_mkdir_p='mkdir -p "$as_dir"' -else - test -d ./-p && rmdir ./-p - as_mkdir_p=false -fi - - -# as_fn_executable_p FILE -# ----------------------- -# Test if FILE is an executable regular file. -as_fn_executable_p () -{ - test -f "$1" && test -x "$1" -} # as_fn_executable_p -as_test_x='test -x' -as_executable_p=as_fn_executable_p - -# Sed expression to map a string onto a valid CPP name. -as_tr_cpp="eval sed 'y%*$as_cr_letters%P$as_cr_LETTERS%;s%[^_$as_cr_alnum]%_%g'" - -# Sed expression to map a string onto a valid variable name. -as_tr_sh="eval sed 'y%*+%pp%;s%[^_$as_cr_alnum]%_%g'" - - -exec 6>&1 -## ----------------------------------- ## -## Main body of $CONFIG_STATUS script. ## -## ----------------------------------- ## -_ASEOF -test $as_write_fail = 0 && chmod +x $CONFIG_STATUS || ac_write_fail=1 - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -# Save the log message, to keep $0 and so on meaningful, and to -# report actual input values of CONFIG_FILES etc. instead of their -# values after options handling. -ac_log=" -This file was extended by tkblt $as_me 3.2, which was -generated by GNU Autoconf 2.69. Invocation command line was - - CONFIG_FILES = $CONFIG_FILES - CONFIG_HEADERS = $CONFIG_HEADERS - CONFIG_LINKS = $CONFIG_LINKS - CONFIG_COMMANDS = $CONFIG_COMMANDS - $ $0 $@ - -on `(hostname || uname -n) 2>/dev/null | sed 1q` -" - -_ACEOF - -case $ac_config_files in *" -"*) set x $ac_config_files; shift; ac_config_files=$*;; -esac - - - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -# Files that config.status was made for. -config_files="$ac_config_files" - -_ACEOF - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -ac_cs_usage="\ -\`$as_me' instantiates files and other configuration actions -from templates according to the current configuration. Unless the files -and actions are specified as TAGs, all are instantiated by default. - -Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [TAG]... - - -h, --help print this help, then exit - -V, --version print version number and configuration settings, then exit - --config print configuration, then exit - -q, --quiet, --silent - do not print progress messages - -d, --debug don't remove temporary files - --recheck update $as_me by reconfiguring in the same conditions - --file=FILE[:TEMPLATE] - instantiate the configuration file FILE - -Configuration files: -$config_files - -Report bugs to the package provider." - -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -ac_cs_config="`$as_echo "$ac_configure_args" | sed 's/^ //; s/[\\""\`\$]/\\\\&/g'`" -ac_cs_version="\\ -tkblt config.status 3.2 -configured by $0, generated by GNU Autoconf 2.69, - with options \\"\$ac_cs_config\\" - -Copyright (C) 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -This config.status script is free software; the Free Software Foundation -gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it." - -ac_pwd='$ac_pwd' -srcdir='$srcdir' -test -n "\$AWK" || AWK=awk -_ACEOF - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -# The default lists apply if the user does not specify any file. -ac_need_defaults=: -while test $# != 0 -do - case $1 in - --*=?*) - ac_option=`expr "X$1" : 'X\([^=]*\)='` - ac_optarg=`expr "X$1" : 'X[^=]*=\(.*\)'` - ac_shift=: - ;; - --*=) - ac_option=`expr "X$1" : 'X\([^=]*\)='` - ac_optarg= - ac_shift=: - ;; - *) - ac_option=$1 - ac_optarg=$2 - ac_shift=shift - ;; - esac - - case $ac_option in - # Handling of the options. - -recheck | --recheck | --rechec | --reche | --rech | --rec | --re | --r) - ac_cs_recheck=: ;; - --version | --versio | --versi | --vers | --ver | --ve | --v | -V ) - $as_echo "$ac_cs_version"; exit ;; - --config | --confi | --conf | --con | --co | --c ) - $as_echo "$ac_cs_config"; exit ;; - --debug | --debu | --deb | --de | --d | -d ) - debug=: ;; - --file | --fil | --fi | --f ) - $ac_shift - case $ac_optarg in - *\'*) ac_optarg=`$as_echo "$ac_optarg" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"` ;; - '') as_fn_error $? "missing file argument" ;; - esac - as_fn_append CONFIG_FILES " '$ac_optarg'" - ac_need_defaults=false;; - --he | --h | --help | --hel | -h ) - $as_echo "$ac_cs_usage"; exit ;; - -q | -quiet | --quiet | --quie | --qui | --qu | --q \ - | -silent | --silent | --silen | --sile | --sil | --si | --s) - ac_cs_silent=: ;; - - # This is an error. - -*) as_fn_error $? "unrecognized option: \`$1' -Try \`$0 --help' for more information." ;; - - *) as_fn_append ac_config_targets " $1" - ac_need_defaults=false ;; - - esac - shift -done - -ac_configure_extra_args= - -if $ac_cs_silent; then - exec 6>/dev/null - ac_configure_extra_args="$ac_configure_extra_args --silent" -fi - -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -if \$ac_cs_recheck; then - set X $SHELL '$0' $ac_configure_args \$ac_configure_extra_args --no-create --no-recursion - shift - \$as_echo "running CONFIG_SHELL=$SHELL \$*" >&6 - CONFIG_SHELL='$SHELL' - export CONFIG_SHELL - exec "\$@" -fi - -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -exec 5>>config.log -{ - echo - sed 'h;s/./-/g;s/^.../## /;s/...$/ ##/;p;x;p;x' <<_ASBOX -## Running $as_me. ## -_ASBOX - $as_echo "$ac_log" -} >&5 - -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -_ACEOF - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 - -# Handling of arguments. -for ac_config_target in $ac_config_targets -do - case $ac_config_target in - "Makefile") CONFIG_FILES="$CONFIG_FILES Makefile" ;; - "pkgIndex.tcl") CONFIG_FILES="$CONFIG_FILES pkgIndex.tcl" ;; - "tkbltConfig.sh") CONFIG_FILES="$CONFIG_FILES tkbltConfig.sh" ;; - - *) as_fn_error $? "invalid argument: \`$ac_config_target'" "$LINENO" 5;; - esac -done - - -# If the user did not use the arguments to specify the items to instantiate, -# then the envvar interface is used. Set only those that are not. -# We use the long form for the default assignment because of an extremely -# bizarre bug on SunOS 4.1.3. -if $ac_need_defaults; then - test "${CONFIG_FILES+set}" = set || CONFIG_FILES=$config_files -fi - -# Have a temporary directory for convenience. Make it in the build tree -# simply because there is no reason against having it here, and in addition, -# creating and moving files from /tmp can sometimes cause problems. -# Hook for its removal unless debugging. -# Note that there is a small window in which the directory will not be cleaned: -# after its creation but before its name has been assigned to `$tmp'. -$debug || -{ - tmp= ac_tmp= - trap 'exit_status=$? - : "${ac_tmp:=$tmp}" - { test ! -d "$ac_tmp" || rm -fr "$ac_tmp"; } && exit $exit_status -' 0 - trap 'as_fn_exit 1' 1 2 13 15 -} -# Create a (secure) tmp directory for tmp files. - -{ - tmp=`(umask 077 && mktemp -d "./confXXXXXX") 2>/dev/null` && - test -d "$tmp" -} || -{ - tmp=./conf$$-$RANDOM - (umask 077 && mkdir "$tmp") -} || as_fn_error $? "cannot create a temporary directory in ." "$LINENO" 5 -ac_tmp=$tmp - -# Set up the scripts for CONFIG_FILES section. -# No need to generate them if there are no CONFIG_FILES. -# This happens for instance with `./config.status config.h'. -if test -n "$CONFIG_FILES"; then - - -ac_cr=`echo X | tr X '\015'` -# On cygwin, bash can eat \r inside `` if the user requested igncr. -# But we know of no other shell where ac_cr would be empty at this -# point, so we can use a bashism as a fallback. -if test "x$ac_cr" = x; then - eval ac_cr=\$\'\\r\' -fi -ac_cs_awk_cr=`$AWK 'BEGIN { print "a\rb" }' /dev/null` -if test "$ac_cs_awk_cr" = "a${ac_cr}b"; then - ac_cs_awk_cr='\\r' -else - ac_cs_awk_cr=$ac_cr -fi - -echo 'BEGIN {' >"$ac_tmp/subs1.awk" && -_ACEOF - - -{ - echo "cat >conf$$subs.awk <<_ACEOF" && - echo "$ac_subst_vars" | sed 's/.*/&!$&$ac_delim/' && - echo "_ACEOF" -} >conf$$subs.sh || - as_fn_error $? "could not make $CONFIG_STATUS" "$LINENO" 5 -ac_delim_num=`echo "$ac_subst_vars" | grep -c '^'` -ac_delim='%!_!# ' -for ac_last_try in false false false false false :; do - . ./conf$$subs.sh || - as_fn_error $? "could not make $CONFIG_STATUS" "$LINENO" 5 - - ac_delim_n=`sed -n "s/.*$ac_delim\$/X/p" conf$$subs.awk | grep -c X` - if test $ac_delim_n = $ac_delim_num; then - break - elif $ac_last_try; then - as_fn_error $? "could not make $CONFIG_STATUS" "$LINENO" 5 - else - ac_delim="$ac_delim!$ac_delim _$ac_delim!! " - fi -done -rm -f conf$$subs.sh - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -cat >>"\$ac_tmp/subs1.awk" <<\\_ACAWK && -_ACEOF -sed -n ' -h -s/^/S["/; s/!.*/"]=/ -p -g -s/^[^!]*!// -:repl -t repl -s/'"$ac_delim"'$// -t delim -:nl -h -s/\(.\{148\}\)..*/\1/ -t more1 -s/["\\]/\\&/g; s/^/"/; s/$/\\n"\\/ -p -n -b repl -:more1 -s/["\\]/\\&/g; s/^/"/; s/$/"\\/ -p -g -s/.\{148\}// -t nl -:delim -h -s/\(.\{148\}\)..*/\1/ -t more2 -s/["\\]/\\&/g; s/^/"/; s/$/"/ -p -b -:more2 -s/["\\]/\\&/g; s/^/"/; s/$/"\\/ -p -g -s/.\{148\}// -t delim -' >$CONFIG_STATUS || ac_write_fail=1 -rm -f conf$$subs.awk -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -_ACAWK -cat >>"\$ac_tmp/subs1.awk" <<_ACAWK && - for (key in S) S_is_set[key] = 1 - FS = "" - -} -{ - line = $ 0 - nfields = split(line, field, "@") - substed = 0 - len = length(field[1]) - for (i = 2; i < nfields; i++) { - key = field[i] - keylen = length(key) - if (S_is_set[key]) { - value = S[key] - line = substr(line, 1, len) "" value "" substr(line, len + keylen + 3) - len += length(value) + length(field[++i]) - substed = 1 - } else - len += 1 + keylen - } - - print line -} - -_ACAWK -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -if sed "s/$ac_cr//" < /dev/null > /dev/null 2>&1; then - sed "s/$ac_cr\$//; s/$ac_cr/$ac_cs_awk_cr/g" -else - cat -fi < "$ac_tmp/subs1.awk" > "$ac_tmp/subs.awk" \ - || as_fn_error $? "could not setup config files machinery" "$LINENO" 5 -_ACEOF - -# VPATH may cause trouble with some makes, so we remove sole $(srcdir), -# ${srcdir} and @srcdir@ entries from VPATH if srcdir is ".", strip leading and -# trailing colons and then remove the whole line if VPATH becomes empty -# (actually we leave an empty line to preserve line numbers). -if test "x$srcdir" = x.; then - ac_vpsub='/^[ ]*VPATH[ ]*=[ ]*/{ -h -s/// -s/^/:/ -s/[ ]*$/:/ -s/:\$(srcdir):/:/g -s/:\${srcdir}:/:/g -s/:@srcdir@:/:/g -s/^:*// -s/:*$// -x -s/\(=[ ]*\).*/\1/ -G -s/\n// -s/^[^=]*=[ ]*$// -}' -fi - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -fi # test -n "$CONFIG_FILES" - - -eval set X " :F $CONFIG_FILES " -shift -for ac_tag -do - case $ac_tag in - :[FHLC]) ac_mode=$ac_tag; continue;; - esac - case $ac_mode$ac_tag in - :[FHL]*:*);; - :L* | :C*:*) as_fn_error $? "invalid tag \`$ac_tag'" "$LINENO" 5;; - :[FH]-) ac_tag=-:-;; - :[FH]*) ac_tag=$ac_tag:$ac_tag.in;; - esac - ac_save_IFS=$IFS - IFS=: - set x $ac_tag - IFS=$ac_save_IFS - shift - ac_file=$1 - shift - - case $ac_mode in - :L) ac_source=$1;; - :[FH]) - ac_file_inputs= - for ac_f - do - case $ac_f in - -) ac_f="$ac_tmp/stdin";; - *) # Look for the file first in the build tree, then in the source tree - # (if the path is not absolute). The absolute path cannot be DOS-style, - # because $ac_f cannot contain `:'. - test -f "$ac_f" || - case $ac_f in - [\\/$]*) false;; - *) test -f "$srcdir/$ac_f" && ac_f="$srcdir/$ac_f";; - esac || - as_fn_error 1 "cannot find input file: \`$ac_f'" "$LINENO" 5;; - esac - case $ac_f in *\'*) ac_f=`$as_echo "$ac_f" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;; esac - as_fn_append ac_file_inputs " '$ac_f'" - done - - # Let's still pretend it is `configure' which instantiates (i.e., don't - # use $as_me), people would be surprised to read: - # /* config.h. Generated by config.status. */ - configure_input='Generated from '` - $as_echo "$*" | sed 's|^[^:]*/||;s|:[^:]*/|, |g' - `' by configure.' - if test x"$ac_file" != x-; then - configure_input="$ac_file. $configure_input" - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: creating $ac_file" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: creating $ac_file" >&6;} - fi - # Neutralize special characters interpreted by sed in replacement strings. - case $configure_input in #( - *\&* | *\|* | *\\* ) - ac_sed_conf_input=`$as_echo "$configure_input" | - sed 's/[\\\\&|]/\\\\&/g'`;; #( - *) ac_sed_conf_input=$configure_input;; - esac - - case $ac_tag in - *:-:* | *:-) cat >"$ac_tmp/stdin" \ - || as_fn_error $? "could not create $ac_file" "$LINENO" 5 ;; - esac - ;; - esac - - ac_dir=`$as_dirname -- "$ac_file" || -$as_expr X"$ac_file" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \ - X"$ac_file" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \ - X"$ac_file" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$ac_file" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || -$as_echo X"$ac_file" | - sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q'` - as_dir="$ac_dir"; as_fn_mkdir_p - ac_builddir=. - -case "$ac_dir" in -.) ac_dir_suffix= ac_top_builddir_sub=. ac_top_build_prefix= ;; -*) - ac_dir_suffix=/`$as_echo "$ac_dir" | sed 's|^\.[\\/]||'` - # A ".." for each directory in $ac_dir_suffix. - ac_top_builddir_sub=`$as_echo "$ac_dir_suffix" | sed 's|/[^\\/]*|/..|g;s|/||'` - case $ac_top_builddir_sub in - "") ac_top_builddir_sub=. ac_top_build_prefix= ;; - *) ac_top_build_prefix=$ac_top_builddir_sub/ ;; - esac ;; -esac -ac_abs_top_builddir=$ac_pwd -ac_abs_builddir=$ac_pwd$ac_dir_suffix -# for backward compatibility: -ac_top_builddir=$ac_top_build_prefix - -case $srcdir in - .) # We are building in place. - ac_srcdir=. - ac_top_srcdir=$ac_top_builddir_sub - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$ac_pwd ;; - [\\/]* | ?:[\\/]* ) # Absolute name. - ac_srcdir=$srcdir$ac_dir_suffix; - ac_top_srcdir=$srcdir - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$srcdir ;; - *) # Relative name. - ac_srcdir=$ac_top_build_prefix$srcdir$ac_dir_suffix - ac_top_srcdir=$ac_top_build_prefix$srcdir - ac_abs_top_srcdir=$ac_pwd/$srcdir ;; -esac -ac_abs_srcdir=$ac_abs_top_srcdir$ac_dir_suffix - - - case $ac_mode in - :F) - # - # CONFIG_FILE - # - -_ACEOF - -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -# If the template does not know about datarootdir, expand it. -# FIXME: This hack should be removed a few years after 2.60. -ac_datarootdir_hack=; ac_datarootdir_seen= -ac_sed_dataroot=' -/datarootdir/ { - p - q -} -/@datadir@/p -/@docdir@/p -/@infodir@/p -/@localedir@/p -/@mandir@/p' -case `eval "sed -n \"\$ac_sed_dataroot\" $ac_file_inputs"` in -*datarootdir*) ac_datarootdir_seen=yes;; -*@datadir@*|*@docdir@*|*@infodir@*|*@localedir@*|*@mandir@*) - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: $ac_file_inputs seems to ignore the --datarootdir setting" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: $ac_file_inputs seems to ignore the --datarootdir setting" >&2;} -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 - ac_datarootdir_hack=' - s&@datadir@&$datadir&g - s&@docdir@&$docdir&g - s&@infodir@&$infodir&g - s&@localedir@&$localedir&g - s&@mandir@&$mandir&g - s&\\\${datarootdir}&$datarootdir&g' ;; -esac -_ACEOF - -# Neutralize VPATH when `$srcdir' = `.'. -# Shell code in configure.ac might set extrasub. -# FIXME: do we really want to maintain this feature? -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -ac_sed_extra="$ac_vpsub -$extrasub -_ACEOF -cat >>$CONFIG_STATUS <<\_ACEOF || ac_write_fail=1 -:t -/@[a-zA-Z_][a-zA-Z_0-9]*@/!b -s|@configure_input@|$ac_sed_conf_input|;t t -s&@top_builddir@&$ac_top_builddir_sub&;t t -s&@top_build_prefix@&$ac_top_build_prefix&;t t -s&@srcdir@&$ac_srcdir&;t t -s&@abs_srcdir@&$ac_abs_srcdir&;t t -s&@top_srcdir@&$ac_top_srcdir&;t t -s&@abs_top_srcdir@&$ac_abs_top_srcdir&;t t -s&@builddir@&$ac_builddir&;t t -s&@abs_builddir@&$ac_abs_builddir&;t t -s&@abs_top_builddir@&$ac_abs_top_builddir&;t t -$ac_datarootdir_hack -" -eval sed \"\$ac_sed_extra\" "$ac_file_inputs" | $AWK -f "$ac_tmp/subs.awk" \ - >$ac_tmp/out || as_fn_error $? "could not create $ac_file" "$LINENO" 5 - -test -z "$ac_datarootdir_hack$ac_datarootdir_seen" && - { ac_out=`sed -n '/\${datarootdir}/p' "$ac_tmp/out"`; test -n "$ac_out"; } && - { ac_out=`sed -n '/^[ ]*datarootdir[ ]*:*=/p' \ - "$ac_tmp/out"`; test -z "$ac_out"; } && - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: $ac_file contains a reference to the variable \`datarootdir' -which seems to be undefined. Please make sure it is defined" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: $ac_file contains a reference to the variable \`datarootdir' -which seems to be undefined. Please make sure it is defined" >&2;} - - rm -f "$ac_tmp/stdin" - case $ac_file in - -) cat "$ac_tmp/out" && rm -f "$ac_tmp/out";; - *) rm -f "$ac_file" && mv "$ac_tmp/out" "$ac_file";; - esac \ - || as_fn_error $? "could not create $ac_file" "$LINENO" 5 - ;; - - - - esac - -done # for ac_tag - - -as_fn_exit 0 -_ACEOF -ac_clean_files=$ac_clean_files_save - -test $ac_write_fail = 0 || - as_fn_error $? "write failure creating $CONFIG_STATUS" "$LINENO" 5 - - -# configure is writing to config.log, and then calls config.status. -# config.status does its own redirection, appending to config.log. -# Unfortunately, on DOS this fails, as config.log is still kept open -# by configure, so config.status won't be able to write to it; its -# output is simply discarded. So we exec the FD to /dev/null, -# effectively closing config.log, so it can be properly (re)opened and -# appended to by config.status. When coming back to configure, we -# need to make the FD available again. -if test "$no_create" != yes; then - ac_cs_success=: - ac_config_status_args= - test "$silent" = yes && - ac_config_status_args="$ac_config_status_args --quiet" - exec 5>/dev/null - $SHELL $CONFIG_STATUS $ac_config_status_args || ac_cs_success=false - exec 5>>config.log - # Use ||, not &&, to avoid exiting from the if with $? = 1, which - # would make configure fail if this is the last instruction. - $ac_cs_success || as_fn_exit 1 -fi -if test -n "$ac_unrecognized_opts" && test "$enable_option_checking" != no; then - { $as_echo "$as_me:${as_lineno-$LINENO}: WARNING: unrecognized options: $ac_unrecognized_opts" >&5 -$as_echo "$as_me: WARNING: unrecognized options: $ac_unrecognized_opts" >&2;} -fi - diff --git a/tkblt/configure.ac b/tkblt/configure.ac deleted file mode 100644 index 5bbfab0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/configure.ac +++ /dev/null @@ -1,246 +0,0 @@ -#!/bin/bash -norc -dnl This file is an input file used by the GNU "autoconf" program to -dnl generate the file "configure", which is run during Tcl installation -dnl to configure the system for the local environment. - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Sample configure.ac for Tcl Extensions. The only places you should -# need to modify this file are marked by the string __CHANGE__ -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# Set your package name and version numbers here. -# -# This initializes the environment with PACKAGE_NAME and PACKAGE_VERSION -# set as provided. These will also be added as -D defs in your Makefile -# so you can encode the package version directly into the source files. -# This will also define a special symbol for Windows (BUILD_ -# so that we create the export library with the dll. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_INIT([tkblt], [3.2]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Call TEA_INIT as the first TEA_ macro to set up initial vars. -# This will define a ${TEA_PLATFORM} variable == "unix" or "windows" -# as well as PKG_LIB_FILE and PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_INIT() - -AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR(tclconfig) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Load the tclConfig.sh file -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG -TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Load the tkConfig.sh file if necessary (Tk extension) -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG -TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Handle the --prefix=... option by defaulting to what Tcl gave. -# Must be called after TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG and before TEA_SETUP_COMPILER. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_PREFIX - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Standard compiler checks. -# This sets up CC by using the CC env var, or looks for gcc otherwise. -# This also calls AC_PROG_CC and a few others to create the basic setup -# necessary to compile executables. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_SETUP_COMPILER - -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# Specify the C source files to compile in TEA_ADD_SOURCES, -# public headers that need to be installed in TEA_ADD_HEADERS, -# stub library C source files to compile in TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES, -# and runtime Tcl library files in TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES. -# This defines PKG(_STUB)_SOURCES, PKG(_STUB)_OBJECTS, PKG_HEADERS -# and PKG_TCL_SOURCES. -#----------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_ADD_SOURCES([ -tkbltChain.C -tkbltConfig.C -tkbltGrAxis.C -tkbltGrAxisOp.C -tkbltGrAxisOption.C -tkbltGrBind.C -tkbltGrElemOp.C -tkbltGrElemOption.C -tkbltGrElem.C -tkbltGrElemBar.C -tkbltGrElemLine.C -tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C -tkbltGrHairs.C -tkbltGrHairsOp.C -tkbltGrLegd.C -tkbltGrLegdOp.C -tkbltGrMarkerOp.C -tkbltGrMarkerOption.C -tkbltGrMarker.C -tkbltGrMarkerLine.C -tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C -tkbltGrMarkerText.C -tkbltGrMisc.C -tkbltGrPenOp.C -tkbltGrPenOption.C -tkbltGrPen.C -tkbltGrPenBar.C -tkbltGrPenLine.C -tkbltGrPostscript.C -tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C -tkbltGrPSOutput.C -tkbltGrText.C -tkbltGrXAxisOp.C -tkbltGraph.C -tkbltGraphBar.C -tkbltGraphLine.C -tkbltGraphOp.C -tkbltGraphSup.C -tkbltInt.C -tkbltNsUtil.C -tkbltParse.C -tkbltOp.C -tkbltStubInit.c -tkbltStubLib.C -tkbltSwitch.C -tkbltVecCmd.C -tkbltVecOp.C -tkbltVecMath.C -tkbltVector.C -]) -TEA_ADD_HEADERS([ -generic/tkbltVector.h -generic/tkbltDecls.h -]) -TEA_ADD_INCLUDES([]) -TEA_ADD_LIBS([-lstdc++]) -if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" != "yes"; then -TEA_ADD_CFLAGS([-TP -EHsc -D_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS -D_USE_MATH_DEFINES]) -fi -TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES([tkbltStubLib.C]) -TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES([library/graph.tcl]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# -# You can add more files to clean if your extension creates any extra -# files by extending CLEANFILES. -# Add pkgIndex.tcl if it is generated in the Makefile instead of ./configure -# and change Makefile.in to move it from CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES to BINARIES var. -# -# A few miscellaneous platform-specific items: -# TEA_ADD_* any platform specific compiler/build info here. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES pkgIndex.tcl" -if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - # Ensure no empty if clauses - : - #TEA_ADD_SOURCES([win/winFile.c]) - #TEA_ADD_INCLUDES([-I\"$(${CYGPATH} ${srcdir}/win)\"]) -else - # Ensure no empty else clauses - : - #TEA_ADD_SOURCES([unix/unixFile.c]) - #TEA_ADD_LIBS([-lsuperfly]) -fi - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# __CHANGE__ -# Choose which headers you need. Extension authors should try very -# hard to only rely on the Tcl public header files. Internal headers -# contain private data structures and are subject to change without -# notice. -# This MUST be called after TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG / TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_PUBLIC_TCL_HEADERS -TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS - -TEA_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS -TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS -TEA_PATH_X - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Check whether --enable-threads or --disable-threads was given. -# This auto-enables if Tcl was compiled threaded. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_ENABLE_THREADS - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# The statement below defines a collection of symbols related to -# building as a shared library instead of a static library. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_ENABLE_SHARED - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# This macro figures out what flags to use with the compiler/linker -# when building shared/static debug/optimized objects. This information -# can be taken from the tclConfig.sh file, but this figures it all out. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Set the default compiler switches based on the --enable-symbols option. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_ENABLE_SYMBOLS - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# This macro generates a line to use when building a library. It -# depends on values set by the TEA_ENABLE_SHARED, TEA_ENABLE_SYMBOLS, -# and TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG macros above. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_MAKE_LIB - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Determine the name of the tclsh and/or wish executables in the -# Tcl and Tk build directories or the location they were installed -# into. These paths are used to support running test cases only, -# the Makefile should not be making use of these paths to generate -# a pkgIndex.tcl file or anything else at extension build time. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_PROG_TCLSH -TEA_PROG_WISH - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Setup a *Config.sh.in configuration file. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -TEA_EXPORT_CONFIG([tkblt]) -#AC_SUBST(SAMPLE_VAR) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Specify files to substitute AC variables in. You may alternatively -# have a special pkgIndex.tcl.in or other files which require -# substituting the AC variables in. Include these here. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_CONFIG_FILES([Makefile pkgIndex.tcl]) -AC_CONFIG_FILES([tkbltConfig.sh]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# Finally, substitute all of the various values into the files -# specified with AC_CONFIG_FILES. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_OUTPUT() diff --git a/tkblt/doc/BLT.html b/tkblt/doc/BLT.html deleted file mode 100644 index 55e4e38..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/BLT.html +++ /dev/null @@ -1,74 +0,0 @@ - - -
-
-
-
-

DESCRIPTION

-       BLT is a library of extensions to the Tk library.  It adds new commands
-       and variables to the application's interpreter.
-
-
-
-
-

COMMANDS

-       The following commands are  added  to  the  interpreter  from  the  BLT
-       library:
-
-       graph          A 2D plotting widget.  Plots two variable data in a win-
-                      dow with an optional legend and annotations.   It has of
-                      several  components; coordinate axes, crosshairs, a leg-
-                      end, and a collection of elements and tags.
-
-       barchart       A barchart widget.  Plots two-variable data as rectangu-
-                      lar bars in a window.  The x-coordinate values designate
-                      the position of the bar along the x-axis, while  the  y-
-                      coordinate values designate the magnitude.  The barchart
-                      widget  has  of  several  components;  coordinate  axes,
-                      crosshairs,  a  legend, and a collection of elements and
-                      tags.
-
-       vector         Creates a vector of floating point values.  The vector's
-                      components  can  be manipulated in three ways: through a
-                      Tcl array variable, a Tcl command, or the C API.
-
-
-
-

ADDING BLT TO YOUR APPLICATIONS

-       It's easy to add BLT to an existing Tk application.   BLT  requires  no
-       patches  or  edits  to the Tcl or Tk libraries.  To add BLT, simply add
-       the following code snippet to your application's tkAppInit.c file.
-
-       if (Tkblt_Init(interp) != TCL_OK) {
-
-           return TCL_ERROR;
-
-       }
-
-       Recompile and link with the tkblt library and that's it.
-
-       Alternately, you can dynamically load tkblt,  simply  by  invoking  the
-       command
-
-       % package require tkblt
-
-       from your Tcl script.
-
-
-
-

BUGS

-       Send bug reports, requests, suggestions, etc. to wjoye@cfa.harvard.edu
-
-
-
-

KEYWORDS

-       BLT
-
-
-
-
-Man(1) output converted with -man2html -
- - diff --git a/tkblt/doc/BLT.n b/tkblt/doc/BLT.n deleted file mode 100644 index 6f63aa8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/BLT.n +++ /dev/null @@ -1,76 +0,0 @@ -'\" -'\" Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA -'\" This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made -'\" available under the same terms. -'\" -'\" Copyright 1991-1997 by Bell Labs Innovations for Lucent Technologies. -'\" -'\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its -'\" documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided -'\" that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that the -'\" copyright notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting documentation, -'\" and that the names of Lucent Technologies any of their entities not be used -'\" in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software -'\" without specific, written prior permission. -'\" -'\" Lucent Technologies disclaims all warranties with regard to this software, -'\" including all implied warranties of merchantability and fitness. In no event -'\" shall Lucent Technologies be liable for any special, indirect or -'\" consequential damages or any damages whatsoever resulting from loss of use, -'\" data or profits, whether in an action of contract, negligence or other -'\" tortuous action, arising out of or in connection with the use or performance -'\" of this software. -'\" -.TH intro n BLT_VERSION BLT "BLT Built-In Commands" -.BS -'\" Note: do not modify the .SH NAME line immediately below! -.SH NAME -BLT \- Introduction to the BLT library -.BE -.SH DESCRIPTION -BLT is a library of extensions to the Tk library. It adds new -commands and variables to the application's interpreter. -.LP -.SH COMMANDS -The following commands are added to the interpreter from the BLT library: -.TP 15 -\fBgraph\fR -A 2D plotting widget. Plots two variable data in a window with an optional -legend and annotations. It has of several components; coordinate axes, -crosshairs, a legend, and a collection of elements and tags. -.TP 15 -\fBbarchart\fR -A barchart widget. Plots two-variable data as rectangular bars in a -window. The x-coordinate values designate the position of the bar along -the x-axis, while the y-coordinate values designate the magnitude. -The \fBbarchart\fR widget has of several components; coordinate axes, -crosshairs, a legend, and a collection of elements and tags. -.TP 15 -\fBvector\fR -Creates a vector of floating point values. The vector's components -can be manipulated in three ways: through a Tcl array variable, a Tcl -command, or the C API. -.SH ADDING BLT TO YOUR APPLICATIONS -It's easy to add BLT to an existing Tk application. BLT requires no -patches or edits to the Tcl or Tk libraries. To add BLT, simply add the -following code snippet to your application's tkAppInit.c file. -.PP -if (Tkblt_Init(interp) != TCL_OK) { -.PP - return TCL_ERROR; -.PP -} -.TP 15 -Recompile and link with the tkblt library and that's it. -.PP -Alternately, you can dynamically load tkblt, simply by invoking the -command -.PP -% package require tkblt -.PP -from your Tcl script. -.SH BUGS -Send bug reports, requests, suggestions, etc. to -wjoye@cfa.harvard.edu -.SH KEYWORDS -BLT diff --git a/tkblt/doc/barchart.html b/tkblt/doc/barchart.html deleted file mode 100644 index 7f04d25..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/barchart.html +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1640 +0,0 @@ - - -
-
-
-
-

SYNOPSIS

-       barchart pathName ?option value?...
-
-
-
-

DESCRIPTION

-       The  barchart  command creates a bar chart for plotting two-dimensional
-       data (X-Y coordinates). A bar chart is a  graphic  means  of  comparing
-       numbers by displaying bars of lengths proportional to the y-coordinates
-       of the points they represented.  The bar chart  has  many  configurable
-       components: coordinate axes, elements, legend, grid lines, cross hairs,
-       etc.  They allow you to customize the look and feel of the graph.
-
-
-
-

INTRODUCTION

-       The barchart command creates a new window for plotting  two-dimensional
-       data  (X-Y coordinates), using bars of various lengths to represent the
-       data points.  The bars are drawn in a rectangular area displayed in the
-       center  of  the new window.  This is the plotting area.  The coordinate
-       axes are drawn in  the  margins  surrounding  the  plotting  area.   By
-       default,  the  legend  is drawn in the right margin.  The title is dis-
-       played in top margin.
-
-       A barchart widget has several configurable components: coordinate axes,
-       data elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, pens, postscript, and annota-
-       tion markers.  Each component can be queried or modified.
-
-       axis       Up to four coordinate axes (two X-coordinate and two Y-coor-
-                 dinate axes) can be displayed, but you can create and use any
-                 number of axes. Axes control what region of data is displayed
-                 and  how  the  data is scaled. Each axis consists of the axis
-                 line, title, major and minor ticks,  and  tick  labels.  Tick
-                 labels display the value at each major tick.
-
-       crosshairs
-                 Cross  hairs  are used to position the mouse pointer relative
-                 to the X and Y  coordinate  axes.  Two  perpendicular  lines,
-                 intersecting  at  the  current  location of the mouse, extend
-                 across the plotting area to the coordinate axes.
-
-       element   An element represents a set of data to be plotted.   It  con-
-                 tains  an  x  and  y  vector  of values representing the data
-                 points.  Each data point is displayed  as  a  bar  where  the
-                 length  of the bar is proportional to the ordinate (Y-coordi-
-                 nate) of the data point.  The appearance of the bar, such  as
-                 its color, stipple, or relief is configurable.
-
-                 A  special  case exists when two or more data points have the
-                 same abscissa (X-coordinate).  By default, the bars are over-
-                 layed,  one  on  top of the other.  The bars are drawn in the
-                 order of the element display list.  But you can also  config-
-                 ure  the bars to be displayed in two other ways.  They may be
-                 displayed as a stack, where each bar (with the same abscissa)
-                 is  stacked  on  the previous.  Or they can be drawn side-by-
-                 side as thin bars.  The width of each bar is  a  function  of
-
-       pen       Pens define attributes for elements.  Data elements use  pens
-                 to  specify how they should be drawn.  A data element may use
-                 many pens at once.  Here the particular pen used for  a  data
-                 point  is  determined  from each element's weight vector (see
-                 the element's -weight and -style options).
-
-       postscript
-                 The widget can generate encapsulated PostScript output.  This
-                 component has several options to configure how the PostScript
-                 is generated.
-
-
-
-

SYNTAX

-       barchart pathName ?option value?...  The barchart command creates a new
-       window  pathName and makes it into a barchart widget.  At the time this
-       command is invoked, there must not exist a window named  pathName,  but
-       pathName's  parent  must exist.  Additional options may be specified on
-       the command line or in the option database to configure aspects of  the
-       graph  such  as its colors and font.  See the configure operation below
-       for the exact details about what option and value pairs are valid.
-
-       If successful, barchart returns the path name of the widget.   It  also
-       creates  a  new Tcl command by the same name.  You can use this command
-       to invoke various operations that query or modify the graph.  The  gen-
-       eral form is: pathName operation ?arg?...  Both operation and its argu-
-       ments determine the exact behavior  of  the  command.   The  operations
-       available  for  the graph are described in the BARCHART OPERATIONS sec-
-       tion.
-
-       The command can also be used to access components of the graph.   path-
-       Name component operation ?arg?...  The operation, now located after the
-       name of the component, is the function to be performed on  that  compo-
-       nent. Each component has its own set of operations that manipulate that
-       component.  They will be described below in their own sections.
-
-
-
-

EXAMPLE

-       The barchart command creates a new bar  chart.   #  Create  a  new  bar
-       chart.   Plotting  area  is black.  barchart .b -plotbackground black A
-       new Tcl command .b is created.  This command can be used to  query  and
-       modify the bar chart.  For example, to change the title of the graph to
-       "My Plot", you use the new command  and  the  configure  operation.   #
-       Change  the title.  .b configure -title "My Plot" To add data elements,
-       you use the command and the element component.  # Create a new  element
-       named  "e1" .b element create e1 \      -xdata { 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 }
-       \       -ydata  {  26.18  50.46  72.85  93.31  111.86   128.47   143.14
-                 155.85  166.60  175.38  }  The  element's X-Y coordinates are
-       specified using lists of numbers.  Alternately, BLT  vectors  could  be
-       used to hold the X-Y coordinates.  # Create two vectors and add them to
-       the barchart.  vector xVector yVector xVector set { 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  8  9
-       10  } yVector set { 26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 155.85
-            166.60 175.38 } n.b element create e1 -xdata xVector -ydata  yVec-
-       tor  The  advantage  of  using vectors is that when you modify one, the
-       sure we change the bar width  too.   .b  configure  -barwidth  0.2  The
-       height  of  each  bar is proportional to the ordinate (Y-coordinate) of
-       the data point.
-
-       If two or more data points have the same abscissa (X-coordinate value),
-       the  bars  representing those data points may be drawn in various ways.
-       The default is to overlay the bars, one  on  top  of  the  other.   The
-       ordering  is  determined  from  the  of  element  display list.  If the
-       stacked mode is selected (using the -barmode configuration option), the
-       bars  are stacked, each bar above the previous.  # Display the elements
-       as stacked.  .b configure -barmode  stacked  If  the  aligned  mode  is
-       selected,  the bars having the same x-coordinates are displayed side by
-       side.  The width of each bar is a fraction of its normal  width,  based
-       upon the number of bars with the same x-coordinate.  # Display the ele-
-       ments side-by-side.  .b configure -barmode aligned By default, the ele-
-       ment's  label in the legend will be also e1.  You can change the label,
-       or specify no legend entry, again using the element's configure  opera-
-       tion.   #  Don't  display  "e1" in the legend.  .b element configure e1
-       -label "" You can configure more than just  the  element's  label.   An
-       element  has many attributes such as stipple, foreground and background
-       colors, relief, etc.  .b element  configure  e1  -fg  red  -bg  pink  \
-            -stipple gray50 Four coordinate axes are automatically created: x,
-       x2, y, and y2.  And by default, elements are mapped onto the axes x and
-       y.   This  can be changed with the -mapx and -mapy options.  # Map "e1"
-       on the alternate y axis "y2".  .b element configure e1  -mapy  y2  Axes
-       can  be configured in many ways too.  For example, you change the scale
-       of the Y-axis from linear to log using the axis component.  # Y-axis is
-       log  scale.   .b  axis configure y -logscale yes One important way axes
-       are used is to zoom in on a particular data region.  Zooming is done by
-       simply specifying new axis limits using the -min and -max configuration
-       options.  .b axis configure x -min 1.0 -max 1.5  .b  axis  configure  y
-       -min  12.0 -max 55.15 To zoom interactively, you link theaxis configure
-       operations with some user interaction (such as pressing the mouse  but-
-       ton),  using  the  bind  command.   To convert between screen and graph
-       coordinates, use the invtransform operation.  # Click the button to set
-       a new minimum bind .b <ButtonPress-1> {
-           %W axis configure x -min [%W axis invtransform x %x]
-           %W  axis configure x -min [%W axis invtransform x %y] } By default,
-       the limits of the axis are determined from data values.  To reset  back
-       to  the  default  limits,  set  the  -min and -max options to the empty
-       value.  # Reset the axes to autoscale again.  .b axis configure x  -min
-       {}  -max  {} .b axis configure y -min {} -max {} By default, the legend
-       is drawn in the right margin.  You can change this or any  legend  con-
-       figuration  options using the legend component.  # Configure the legend
-       font, color, and relief .b  legend  configure  -position  left  -relief
-       raised  \       -font  fixed  -fg blue To prevent the legend from being
-       displayed, turn on the -hide option.  # Don't display the  legend.   .b
-       legend  configure  -hide yes The barchart has simple drawing procedures
-       called markers.  They can be used to highlight or annotate data in  the
-       graph.  The types of markers available are bitmaps, polygons, lines, or
-       windows.  Markers can be used, for example, to mark  or  brush  points.
-       For  example  there may be a line marker which indicates some low-water
-       chart into file "file.ps" .b postscript  output  file.ps  -maxpect  yes
-       -decorations  no  This generates a file file.ps containing the encapsu-
-       lated PostScript of the graph.  The option -maxpect says to  scale  the
-       plot  to  the  size  of  the page.  Turning off the -decorations option
-       denotes that no borders or color backgrounds should be drawn (i.e.  the
-       background of the margins, legend, and plotting area will be white).
-
-
-
-

SYNTAX

-       barchart pathName ?option value?...  The barchart command creates a new
-       window pathName and makes it into a barchart widget.  At the time  this
-       command  is  invoked, there must not exist a window named pathName, but
-       pathName's parent must exist.  Additional options may may be  specified
-       on  the  command line or in the option database to configure aspects of
-       the bar chart such as its colors and font.  See the configure operation
-       below  for  the  exact  details  as  to what option and value pairs are
-       valid.
-
-       If successful, barchart returns pathName. It also  creates  a  new  Tcl
-       command  pathName.   This  command may be used to invoke various opera-
-       tions to query or modify the bar chart.  It has the general form: path-
-       Name operation ?arg?...  Both operation and its arguments determine the
-       exact behavior of the command.  The operations available  for  the  bar
-       chart are described in the following section.
-
-
-
-

BARCHART OPERATIONS

-       pathName bar elemName ?option value?...
-              Creates  a  new  barchart element elemName.  It's an error if an
-              element elemName already exists.  See the  manual  for  barchart
-              for details about what option and value pairs are valid.
-
-       pathName cget option
-              Returns  the  current value of the configuration option given by
-              option.  Option may be any option described below for  the  con-
-              figure operation.
-
-       pathName configure ?option value?...
-              Queries  or modifies the configuration options of the graph.  If
-              option isn't specified, a list describing  the  current  options
-              for  pathName  is  returned.   If  option  is specified, but not
-              value, then a list describing option is  returned.   If  one  or
-              more  option  and value pairs are specified, then for each pair,
-              the option option is set to value.  The  following  options  are
-              valid.
-
-              -background color
-                     Sets  the background color. This includes the margins and
-                     legend, but not the plotting area.
-
-              -barmode mode
-                     Indicates  how  related  bar  elements  will  be   drawn.
-                     Related elements have data points with the same abscissas
-                     (X-coordinates). Mode indicates how those segments should
-
-              -barwidth value
-                     Specifies the width of the bars.  This value can be over-
-                     rided  by  the  individual elements using their -barwidth
-                     configuration option.  Value is the  width  in  terms  of
-                     graph-coordinates.  The default width is 1.0.
-
-              -borderwidth pixels
-                     Sets  the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge
-                     of the widget.  The -relief option determines if the bor-
-                     der is to be drawn.  The default is 2.
-
-              -bottommargin pixels
-                     Specifies  the  size of the margin below the X-coordinate
-                     axis.  If pixels is 0, the size of the margin is selected
-                     automatically.  The default is 0.
-
-              -bufferelements boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  an internal pixmap to buffer the dis-
-                     play of data elements should  be  used.   If  boolean  is
-                     true,  data  elements  are  drawn  to an internal pixmap.
-                     This option  is  especially  useful  when  the  graph  is
-                     redrawn  frequently while the remains data unchanged (for
-                     example, moving a marker across the plot).  See the SPEED
-                     TIPS section.  The default is 1.
-
-              -cursor cursor
-                     Specifies  the  widget's  cursor.   The default cursor is
-                     crosshair.
-
-              -font fontName
-                     Specifies the font of the graph  title.  The  default  is
-                     *-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-18-180-*.
-
-              -halo pixels
-                     Specifies  a  maximum distance to consider when searching
-                     for the closest data point  (see  the  element's  closest
-                     operation  below).   Data points further than pixels away
-                     are ignored.  The default is 0.5i.
-
-              -height pixels
-                     Specifies the requested height of widget.  The default is
-                     4i.
-
-              -invertxy boolean
-                     Indicates  whether the placement X-axis and Y-axis should
-                     be inverted.  If boolean is true, the X and  Y  axes  are
-                     swapped.  The default is 0.
-
-              -justify justify
-                     Specifies  how  the title should be justified.  This mat-
-                     ters only when the title contains more than one  line  of
-                     area.  The -plotrelief option determines if a  border  is
-                     drawn.  The default is 2.
-
-              -plotpadx pad
-                     Sets  the  amount  of padding to be added to the left and
-                     right sides of the plotting area.  Pad can be a  list  of
-                     one  or  two  screen distances.  If pad has two elements,
-                     the left side of the plotting area entry is padded by the
-                     first  distance and the right side by the second.  If pad
-                     is just one distance, both the left and right  sides  are
-                     padded evenly.  The default is 8.
-
-              -plotpady pad
-                     Sets  the  amount  of  padding to be added to the top and
-                     bottom of the plotting area.  Pad can be a list of one or
-                     two  screen  distances.  If pad has two elements, the top
-                     of the plotting area is padded by the first distance  and
-                     the  bottom  by the second.  If pad is just one distance,
-                     both the top and bottom are padded evenly.   The  default
-                     is 8.
-
-              -plotrelief relief
-                     Specifies  the  3-D effect for the plotting area.  Relief
-                     specifies how the interior of the  plotting  area  should
-                     appear relative to rest of the graph; for example, raised
-                     means the plot should appear to protrude from the  graph,
-                     relative  to  the  surface  of the graph.  The default is
-                     sunken.
-
-              -relief relief
-                     Specifies the 3-D effect for the barchart widget.  Relief
-                     specifies  how the graph should appear relative to widget
-                     it is packed into; for example, raised  means  the  graph
-                     should appear to protrude.  The default is flat.
-
-              -rightmargin pixels
-                     Sets  the  size  of  margin from the plotting area to the
-                     right edge of the window.   By  default,  the  legend  is
-                     drawn  in  this  margin.  If pixels is than 1, the margin
-                     size is selected automatically.
-
-              -takefocus focus
-                     Provides information used when moving the focus from win-
-                     dow  to  window  via  keyboard  traversal  (e.g., Tab and
-                     Shift-Tab).  If focus is 0, this means that  this  window
-                     should  be skipped entirely during keyboard traversal.  1
-                     means that the this  window  should  always  receive  the
-                     input  focus.   An  empty  value means that the traversal
-                     scripts make the decision whether to focus on the window.
-                     The default is "".
-
-              -tile image
-              -width pixels
-                     Specifies the requested width of the widget.  The default
-                     is 5i.
-
-       pathName crosshairs operation ?arg?
-              See the CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName element operation ?arg?...
-              See the ELEMENT COMPONENTS section.
-
-       pathName extents item
-              Returns  the  size of a particular item in the graph.  Item must
-              be  either  leftmargin,  rightmargin,  topmargin,  bottommargin,
-              plotwidth, or plotheight.
-
-       pathName grid operation ?arg?...
-              See the GRID COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName invtransform winX winY
-              Performs  an  inverse  coordinate transformation, mapping window
-              coordinates back to graph-coordinates, using the standard X-axis
-              and  Y-axis.  Returns a list of containing the X-Y graph-coordi-
-              nates.
-
-       pathName inside x y
-              Returns 1 is the  designated  screen-coordinate  (x  and  y)  is
-              inside the plotting area and 0 otherwise.
-
-       pathName legend operation ?arg?...
-              See the LEGEND COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName line operation arg...
-              The operation is the same as element.
-
-       pathName marker operation ?arg?...
-              See the MARKER COMPONENTS section.
-
-       pathName metafile ?fileName?
-              This  operation is for Window platforms only.  Creates a Windows
-              enhanced metafile of the barchart.  If present, fileName is  the
-              file name of the new metafile.  Otherwise, the metafile is auto-
-              matically added to the clipboard.
-
-       pathName postscript operation ?arg?...
-              See the POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName snap photoName
-              Takes a snapshot of the graph and stores  the  contents  in  the
-              photo  image  photoName.   PhotoName  is  the name of a Tk photo
-              image that must already exist.
-
-       pathName transform x y
-       A graph is composed of several components: coordinate axes,  data  ele-
-       ments,  legend,  grid, cross hairs, postscript, and annotation markers.
-       Instead of one big set of configuration  options  and  operations,  the
-       graph  is  partitioned,  where each component has its own configuration
-       options and operations that specifically control that aspect or part of
-       the graph.
-
-   AXIS COMPONENTS
-       Four  coordinate  axes are automatically created: two X-coordinate axes
-       (x and x2) and two Y-coordinate axes (y, and y2).  By default, the axis
-       x  is located in the bottom margin, y in the left margin, x2 in the top
-       margin, and y2 in the right margin.
-
-       An axis consists of the axis line, title, major and  minor  ticks,  and
-       tick  labels.   Major  ticks  are  drawn at uniform intervals along the
-       axis.  Each tick is labeled with its coordinate value.  Minor ticks are
-       drawn at uniform intervals within major ticks.
-
-       The  range  of  the axis controls what region of data is plotted.  Data
-       points outside the minimum and maximum limits of the axis are not plot-
-       ted.   By  default,  the minimum and maximum limits are determined from
-       the data, but you can reset either limit.
-
-       You can create and use several axes. To create an axis, invoke the axis
-       component  and  its create operation.  # Create a new axis called "tem-
-       perature" .b axis create temperature You map data elements to  an  axis
-       using the element's -mapy and -mapx configuration options. They specify
-       the coordinate axes an element is mapped onto.  # Now map the  tempera-
-       ture  data  to  this  axis.   .b element create "temp" -xdata $x -ydata
-       $tempData \
-           -mapy temperature While you can have many axes, only four axes  can
-       be  displayed  simultaneously.   They  are drawn in each of the margins
-       surrounding the plotting area.  The axes x and y are drawn in the  bot-
-       tom  and  left  margins.  The axes x2 and y2 are drawn in top and right
-       margins.  Only x and y are shown by default. Note  that  the  axes  can
-       have different scales.
-
-       To  display  a  different  axis, you invoke one of the following compo-
-       nents: xaxis, yaxis, x2axis, and y2axis.  The use operation  designates
-       the  axis to be drawn in the corresponding margin: xaxis in the bottom,
-       yaxis in the left, x2axis in the top, and y2axis in the right.  #  Dis-
-       play the axis temperature in the left margin.  .b yaxis use temperature
-
-       You can configure axes in many ways. The axis scale can  be  linear  or
-       logarithmic.   The  values  along  the  axis  can  either monotonically
-       increase or decrease.  If you need custom tick labels, you can  specify
-       a  Tcl procedure to format the label any way you wish.  You can control
-       how ticks are drawn, by changing the major tick interval or the  number
-       of minor ticks.  You can define non-uniform tick intervals, such as for
-       time-series plots.
-
-
-              -autorange range
-                     Sets the range of values for the axis to range.  The axis
-                     limits are automatically reset to display the most recent
-                     data points in this range.  If range is 0.0, the range is
-                     determined  from the limits of the data.  If -min or -max
-                     are specified, they override this option.  The default is
-                     0.0.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets  the color of the axis and tick labels.  The default
-                     is black.
-
-              -command prefix
-                     Specifies a Tcl command to be invoked when formatting the
-                     axis  tick labels. Prefix is a string containing the name
-                     of a Tcl proc and any extra arguments for the  procedure.
-                     This  command is invoked for each major tick on the axis.
-                     Two additional arguments are passed to the procedure: the
-                     pathname  of the widget and the current the numeric value
-                     of the tick.  The procedure returns  the  formatted  tick
-                     label.   If  "" is returned, no label will appear next to
-                     the tick.  You can get the standard tick labels again  by
-                     setting prefix to "".  The default is "".
-
-                     Please  note that this procedure is invoked while the bar
-                     chart is redrawn.  You may query the widget's  configura-
-                     tion options.  But do not reset options, because this can
-                     have unexpected results.
-
-              -descending boolean
-                     Indicates whether the values along the axis are monotoni-
-                     cally  increasing or decreasing.  If boolean is true, the
-                     axis values will be decreasing.  The default is 0.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the axis is displayed.
-
-              -justify justify
-                     Specifies how the axis title should be  justified.   This
-                     matters  only  when the axis title contains more than one
-                     line of text. Justify must be  left,  right,  or  center.
-                     The default is center.
-
-              -limits formatStr
-                     Specifies a printf-like description to format the minimum
-                     and maximum limits of the axis.  The limits are displayed
-                     at  the  top/bottom  or  left/right sides of the plotting
-                     area.  FormatStr is a list of one or two format  descrip-
-                     tions.   If one description is supplied, both the minimum
-                     and maximum limits are formatted in  the  same  way.   If
-                     two,  the  first  designates  the  format for the minimum
-                     limit, the second for the maximum.  If  ""  is  given  as
-                     data points tightly, at the  outermost  data  points,  or
-                     loosely,  at  the outer tick intervals.  This is relevant
-                     only when the axis limit is automatically calculated.  If
-                     boolean  is true, the axis range is "loose".  The default
-                     is 0.
-
-              -majorticks majorList
-                     Specifies where to display major axis ticks.  You can use
-                     this  option  to  display ticks at non-uniform intervals.
-                     MajorList is a list of axis coordinates  designating  the
-                     location  of  major ticks.  No minor ticks are drawn.  If
-                     majorList is "", major ticks will be  automatically  com-
-                     puted. The default is "".
-
-              -max value
-                     Sets  the  maximum  limit  of  axisName.   Any data point
-                     greater than value is not displayed.  If value is "", the
-                     maximum limit is calculated using the largest data value.
-                     The default is "".
-
-              -min value
-                     Sets the minimum limit of axisName. Any data  point  less
-                     than value is not displayed.  If value is "", the minimum
-                     limit is calculated using the smallest data  value.   The
-                     default is "".
-
-              -minorticks minorList
-                     Specifies where to display minor axis ticks.  You can use
-                     this option to display minor ticks at non-uniform  inter-
-                     vals.  MinorList  is  a list of real values, ranging from
-                     0.0 to 1.0, designating the placement of  a  minor  tick.
-                     No minor ticks are drawn if the -majortick option is also
-                     set.  If minorList is "", minor ticks will  be  automati-
-                     cally computed. The default is "".
-
-              -rotate theta
-                     Specifies  the  how  many degrees to rotate the axis tick
-                     labels.  Theta is a real value representing the number of
-                     degrees  to  rotate  the tick labels.  The default is 0.0
-                     degrees.
-
-              -shiftby value
-                     Specifies how much to automatically shift  the  range  of
-                     the  axis.   When  the  new data exceeds the current axis
-                     maximum, the maximum is increased in increments of value.
-                     You  can  use this option to prevent the axis limits from
-                     being recomputed at each new time point. If value is 0.0,
-                     then no automatic shifting is down. The default is 0.0.
-
-              -showticks boolean
-                     Indicates  whether axis ticks should be drawn. If boolean
-                     is true, ticks are drawn.  If false, only the  axis  line
-
-              -tickfont fontName
-                     Specifies  the  font for axis tick labels. The default is
-                     *-Courier-Bold-R-Normal-*-100-*.
-
-              -ticklength pixels
-                     Sets the length of major and minor ticks (minor ticks are
-                     half  the  length of major ticks). If pixels is less than
-                     zero, the axis will be inverted with ticks drawn pointing
-                     towards the plot.  The default is 0.1i.
-
-              -title text
-                     Sets  the title of the axis. If text is "", no axis title
-                     will be displayed.
-
-              -titlecolor color
-                     Sets the color of the axis title. The default is black.
-
-              -titlefont fontName
-                     Specifies the font for axis title. The default is  *-Hel-
-                     vetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-14-140-*.
-
-              Axis configuration options may be also be set by the option com-
-              mand.  The resource class is Axis.  The resource names  are  the
-              names  of  the  axes  (such  as  x  or  x2).   option  add *Bar-
-              chart.Axis.Color  blue  option  add  *Barchart.x.LogScale   true
-              option add *Barchart.x2.LogScale false
-
-       pathName axis create axisName ?option value?...
-              Creates  a  new  axis by the name axisName.  No axis by the same
-              name can already exist. Option and value are described in  above
-              in the axis configure operation.
-
-       pathName axis delete ?axisName?...
-              Deletes  the  named axes. An axis is not really deleted until it
-              is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete axes mapped to ele-
-              ments.
-
-       pathName axis invtransform axisName value
-              Performs the inverse transformation, changing the screen-coordi-
-              nate value to a graph-coordinate, mapping the  value  mapped  to
-              axisName.  Returns the graph-coordinate.
-
-       pathName axis limits axisName
-              Returns  a  list of the minimum and maximum limits for axisName.
-              The order of the list is min max.
-
-       pathName axis names ?pattern?...
-              Returns a list of axes matching zero or more  patterns.   If  no
-              pattern argument is give, the names of all axes are returned.
-
-       pathName axis transform axisName value
-              Transforms  the  coordinate value to a screen-coordinate by map-
-
-       right Y-axis.
-
-       They implicitly control the axis that is currently using to that  loca-
-       tion.  By default, xaxis uses the x axis, yaxis uses y, x2axis uses x2,
-       and y2axis uses y2.  These components can be  more  convenient  to  use
-       than  always  determining  what axes are current being displayed by the
-       graph.
-
-       The following operations are available for axes.  They  mirror  exactly
-       the operations of the axis component.  The axis argument must be xaxis,
-       x2axis, yaxis, or y2axis.
-
-       pathName axis cget option
-
-       pathName axis configure ?option value?...
-
-       pathName axis invtransform value
-
-       pathName axis limits
-
-       pathName axis transform value
-
-       pathName axis use ?axisName?
-              Designates the axis axisName is to be displayed  at  this  loca-
-              tion.   AxisName  can not be already in use at another location.
-              This command returns the name of the axis currently  using  this
-              location.
-
-   CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT
-       Cross  hairs  consist  of  two intersecting lines (one vertical and one
-       horizontal) drawn completely across the plotting area.  They  are  used
-       to  position the mouse in relation to the coordinate axes.  Cross hairs
-       differ from line markers in that they are implemented using XOR drawing
-       primitives.  This means that they can be quickly drawn and erased with-
-       out redrawing the entire widget.
-
-       The following operations are available for cross hairs:
-
-       pathName crosshairs cget option
-              Returns the current  value  of  the  cross  hairs  configuration
-              option  given  by  option.   Option  may be any option described
-              below for the cross hairs configure operation.
-
-       pathName crosshairs configure ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies  the  configuration  options  of  the  cross
-              hairs.   If  option  isn't  specified, a list describing all the
-              current options for the cross hairs is returned.  If  option  is
-              specified,  but  not  value,  then  a  list describing option is
-              returned.  If one or more option and value pairs are  specified,
-              then  for  each  pair,  the  cross hairs option option is set to
-              value.  The following options are available for cross hairs.
-
-              -linewidth pixels
-                     Set the width of the cross hair lines.  The default is 1.
-
-              -position pos
-                     Specifies  the  screen  position  where  the  cross hairs
-                     intersect.  Pos must be in the form "@x,y", where x and y
-                     are the window coordinates of the intersection.
-
-              Cross  hairs  configuration  options  may  be also be set by the
-              option command.  The resource name and class are crosshairs  and
-              Crosshairs       respectively.        option      add      *Bar-
-              chart.Crosshairs.LineWidth     2      option      add      *Bar-
-              chart.Crosshairs.Color     red
-
-       pathName crosshairs off
-              Turns off the cross hairs.
-
-       pathName crosshairs on
-              Turns on the display of the cross hairs.
-
-       pathName crosshairs toggle
-              Toggles  the  current state of the cross hairs, alternately map-
-              ping and unmapping the cross hairs.
-
-
-
-

ELEMENTS

-       A data element represents a set of data.  It contains x and  y  vectors
-       which  are  the coordinates of the data points.  Elements are displayed
-       as bars where the length of the bar is proportional to the ordinate  of
-       the data point.  Elements also control the appearance of the data, such
-       as the color, stipple, relief, etc.
-
-       When new data elements are created, they are automatically added  to  a
-       list  of  displayed elements.   The display list controls what elements
-       are drawn and in what order.
-
-       The following operations are available for elements.
-
-       pathName element activate elemName ?index?...
-              Specifies the data points of element elemName to be drawn  using
-              active  foreground  and background colors.  ElemName is the name
-              of the element and index is a number representing the  index  of
-              the  data  point. If no indices are present then all data points
-              become active.
-
-       pathName element bind tagName ?sequence?  ?command?
-              Associates command with tagName such  that  whenever  the  event
-              sequence  given by sequence occurs for an element with this tag,
-              command will be invoked.  The syntax is similar to the bind com-
-              mand except that it operates on graph elements, rather than wid-
-              gets. See the bind manual entry for complete details on sequence
-              and the substitutions performed on command before invoking it.
-
-
-       pathName element closest x y ?option value?... ?elemName?...
-              Finds  the data point representing the bar closest to the window
-              coordinates x and y in the element elemName.   ElemName  is  the
-              name  of  an  element, which must be currently displayed.  If no
-              elements  are  specified,  then  all  displayed   elements   are
-              searched.   It  returns  a key-value list containing the name of
-              the closest element, the index of its  closest  point,  and  the
-              graph-coordinates  of  the  point.  If  no data point within the
-              threshold distance can be found, "" is returned.  The  following
-              option-value pairs are available.
-
-              -halo pixels
-                     Specifies a threshold distance where selected data points
-                     are ignored.  Pixels is a valid screen distance, such  as
-                     2  or  1.2i.   If  this  option  isn't specified, then it
-                     defaults to the value of the barchart's -halo option.
-
-       pathName element configure elemName ?elemName... ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies  the  configuration  options  for  elements.
-              Several  elements  can  be  modified at the same time. If option
-              isn't specified, a list describing all the current  options  for
-              elemName  is  returned.   If option is specified, but not value,
-              then a list describing the option option is returned.  If one or
-              more  option  and value pairs are specified, then for each pair,
-              the element option  option  is  set  to  value.   The  following
-              options are valid for elements.
-
-              -activepen penName
-                     Specifies  pen to use to draw active element.  If penName
-                     is "", no active elements will be drawn.  The default  is
-                     activeLine.
-
-              -bindtags tagList
-                     Specifies the binding tags for the element.  TagList is a
-                     list of binding tag names.  The tags and their order will
-                     determine  how events for elements.  Each tag in the list
-                     matching the current event sequence  will  have  its  Tcl
-                     command  executed.  Implicitly the name of the element is
-                     always the first tag in the list.  The default  value  is
-                     all.
-
-              -background color
-                     Sets  the  the  color of the border around each bar.  The
-                     default is white.
-
-              -barwidth value
-                     Specifies the width  the  bars  drawn  for  the  element.
-                     Value  is  the  width  in  X-coordinates.  If this option
-                     isn't specified, the width of each bar is  the  value  of
-                     the widget's -barwidth option.
-
-                     a list of numeric expressions representing the X-Y  coor-
-                     dinate pairs of each data point.
-
-              -foreground color
-                     Sets the color of the interior of the bars.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates  whether the element is displayed.  The default
-                     is no.
-
-              -label text
-                     Sets the element's label in the legend.  If text  is  "",
-                     the  element  will  have  no  entry  in  the legend.  The
-                     default label is the element's name.
-
-              -mapx xAxis
-                     Selects the X-axis to  map  the  element's  X-coordinates
-                     onto.  XAxis must be the name of an axis.  The default is
-                     x.
-
-              -mapy yAxis
-                     Selects the Y-axis to  map  the  element's  Y-coordinates
-                     onto.   YAxis must be the name of an axis. The default is
-                     y.
-
-              -relief string
-                     Specifies the 3-D effect desired for bars.  Relief  indi-
-                     cates  how the interior of the bar should appear relative
-                     to the surface of the chart; for  example,  raised  means
-                     the bar should appear to protrude from the surface of the
-                     plotting area.  The default is raised.
-
-              -stipple bitmap
-                     Specifies a stipple pattern with which to draw the  bars.
-                     If  bitmap  is "", then the bar is drawn in a solid fash-
-                     ion.
-
-              -xdata xVector
-                     Specifies the x-coordinate vector of the  data.   XVector
-                     is  the name of a BLT vector or a list of numeric expres-
-                     sions.
-
-              -ydata yVector
-                     Specifies the y-coordinate vector of the  data.   YVector
-                     is  the name of a BLT vector or a list of numeric expres-
-                     sions.
-
-              Element configuration options may also be set by the option com-
-              mand.   The  resource names  in the option database are prefixed
-              by elem.  option add *Barchart.Element.background blue
-
-       pathName element create elemName ?option value?...
-
-       pathName element exists elemName
-              Returns  1  if an element elemName currently exists and 0 other-
-              wise.
-
-       pathName element names ?pattern?...
-              Returns the elements matching one or more pattern.  If  no  pat-
-              tern is given, the names of all elements is returned.
-
-       pathName element show ?nameList?
-              Queries  or modifies the element display list.  The element dis-
-              play list designates the  elements  drawn  and  in  what  order.
-              NameList is a list of elements to be displayed in the order they
-              are named.  If there is no nameList argument, the  current  dis-
-              play list is returned.
-
-       pathName element type elemName
-              Returns  the type of elemName.  If the element is a bar element,
-              the commands returns the  string  "bar",  otherwise  it  returns
-              "line".
-
-   GRID COMPONENT
-       Grid  lines extend from the major and minor ticks of each axis horizon-
-       tally or vertically across the plotting area.  The following operations
-       are available for grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid cget option
-              Returns  the current value of the grid line configuration option
-              given by option.  Option may be any option described  below  for
-              the grid configure operation.
-
-       pathName grid configure ?option value?...
-              Queries  or  modifies  the configuration options for grid lines.
-              If option isn't specified, a list  describing  all  the  current
-              grid  options for pathName is returned.  If option is specified,
-              but not value, then a list describing option  is  returned.   If
-              one  or more option and value pairs are specified, then for each
-              pair, the grid line option option is set to value.  The  follow-
-              ing options are valid for grid lines.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets  the color of the grid lines.  The default is black.
-
-              -dashes dashList
-                     Sets the dash style of the grid lines. DashList is a list
-                     of  up  to  11  numbers  that  alternately  represent the
-                     lengths of the dashes and gaps on the grid  lines.   Each
-                     number must be between 1 and 255.  If dashList is "", the
-                     grid will be solid lines.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the grid should be drawn. If boolean is
-
-              -minor boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  the  grid  lines  should be drawn for
-                     minor ticks.  If boolean is true, the lines  will  appear
-                     at minor tick intervals.  The default is 1.
-
-              Grid  configuration  options  may also be set by the option com-
-              mand.  The resource name and class are  grid  and  Grid  respec-
-              tively.   option add *Barchart.grid.LineWidth 2 option add *Bar-
-              chart.Grid.Color     black
-
-       pathName grid off
-              Turns off the display the grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid on
-              Turns on the display the grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid toggle
-              Toggles the display of the grid.
-
-   LEGEND COMPONENT
-       The legend displays a list of the data elements.  Each  entry  consists
-       of the element's symbol and label.  The legend can appear in any margin
-       (the default location is in the right margin).  It can  also  be  posi-
-       tioned anywhere within the plotting area.
-
-       The following operations are valid for the legend.
-
-       pathName legend activate pattern...
-              Selects  legend entries to be drawn using the active legend col-
-              ors and relief.  All entries whose element names  match  pattern
-              are  selected.  To be selected, the element name must match only
-              one pattern.
-
-       pathName legend bind tagName ?sequence?  ?command?
-              Associates command with tagName such  that  whenever  the  event
-              sequence  given  by sequence occurs for a legend entry with this
-              tag, command will be invoked.  Implicitly the element  names  in
-              the  entry  are tags.  The syntax is similar to the bind command
-              except that it operates on legend entries, rather than  widgets.
-              See  the  bind manual entry for complete details on sequence and
-              the substitutions performed on command before invoking it.
-
-              If all arguments are specified then a new  binding  is  created,
-              replacing  any  existing  binding for the same sequence and tag-
-              Name.  If the first character of command is + then command  aug-
-              ments  an existing binding rather than replacing it.  If no com-
-              mand argument is provided then the command currently  associated
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-              -activebackground color
-                     Sets the background color for active legend entries.  All
-                     legend  entries  marked  active  (see the legend activate
-                     operation) are drawn using this background color.
-
-              -activeborderwidth pixels
-                     Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside  edge
-                     of the active legend entries.  The default is 2.
-
-              -activeforeground color
-                     Sets the foreground color for active legend entries.  All
-                     legend entries marked as active (see the legend  activate
-                     operation) are drawn using this foreground color.
-
-              -activerelief relief
-                     Specifies  the  3-D  effect  desired  for  active  legend
-                     entries.  Relief denotes how the interior  of  the  entry
-                     should appear relative to the legend; for example, raised
-                     means the entry should appear to protrude from  the  leg-
-                     end,  relative to the surface of the legend.  The default
-                     is flat.
-
-              -anchor anchor
-                     Tells how to position the legend relative  to  the  posi-
-                     tioning  point  for the legend.  This is dependent on the
-                     value of the -position option.  The default is center.
-
-                     left or right
-                                 The anchor describes how to position the leg-
-                                 end vertically.
-
-                     top or bottom
-                                 The anchor describes how to position the leg-
-                                 end horizontally.
-
-                     @x,y        The anchor specifies how to position the leg-
-                                 end  relative  to  the positioning point. For
-                                 example, if anchor is center then the  legend
-                                 is centered on the point; if anchor is n then
-                                 the legend will be drawn such  that  the  top
-                                 center  point of the rectangular region occu-
-                                 pied by the legend will be at the positioning
-                                 point.
-
-                     plotarea    The anchor specifies how to position the leg-
-                                 end relative to the plotting area. For  exam-
-                                 ple,  if  anchor is center then the legend is
-                                 centered in the plotting area; if  anchor  is
-                                 ne  then  the  legend will be drawn such that
-                                 occupies the upper right corner of the  plot-
-                                 ting area.
-
-                     of  the legend (if such border is being drawn; the relief
-                     option determines this).  The default is 2 pixels.
-
-              -font fontName
-                     FontName specifies a font to use when drawing the  labels
-                     of  each  element into the legend.  The default is *-Hel-
-                     vetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-12-120-*.
-
-              -foreground color
-                     Sets the foreground color of the text drawn for the  ele-
-                     ment's label.  The default is black.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  the  legend  should  be displayed. If
-                     boolean is true,  the  legend  will  not  be  draw.   The
-                     default is no.
-
-              -ipadx pad
-                     Sets  the  amount  of internal padding to be added to the
-                     width of each legend entry.  Pad can be a list of one  or
-                     two  screen distances.  If pad has two elements, the left
-                     side of the legend entry is padded by the first  distance
-                     and  the  right  side  by the second.  If pad is just one
-                     distance, both  the  left  and  right  sides  are  padded
-                     evenly.  The default is 2.
-
-              -ipady pad
-                     Sets  an  amount  of  internal padding to be added to the
-                     height of each legend entry.  Pad can be a list of one or
-                     two  screen  distances.  If pad has two elements, the top
-                     of the entry is padded by the first distance and the bot-
-                     tom by the second.  If pad is just one distance, both the
-                     top and bottom of  the  entry  are  padded  evenly.   The
-                     default is 2.
-
-              -padx pad
-                     Sets  the  padding to the left and right exteriors of the
-                     legend.  Pad can be a list of  one  or  two  screen  dis-
-                     tances.   If  pad  has two elements, the left side of the
-                     legend is padded by the first distance and the right side
-                     by  the  second.   If pad has just one distance, both the
-                     left and right sides are padded evenly.  The  default  is
-                     4.
-
-              -pady pad
-                     Sets  the padding above and below the legend.  Pad can be
-                     a list of one or two screen distances.  If  pad  has  two
-                     elements,  the  area  above  the  legend is padded by the
-                     first distance and the area below by the second.  If  pad
-                     is  just  one distance, both the top and bottom areas are
-                     padded evenly.  The default is 0.
-
-                     drawn on top of any elements that  may  overlap  it.  The
-                     default is no.
-
-              -relief relief
-                     Specifies  the  3-D effect for the border around the leg-
-                     end.  Relief specifies how the  interior  of  the  legend
-                     should  appear  relative  to  the bar chart; for example,
-                     raised means the legend should appear  to  protrude  from
-                     the  bar chart, relative to the surface of the bar chart.
-                     The default is sunken.
-
-              Legend configuration options may also be set by the option  com-
-              mand.  The resource name and class are legend and Legend respec-
-              tively.  option add *Barchart.legend.Foreground blue option  add
-              *Barchart.Legend.Relief     raised
-
-       pathName legend deactivate pattern...
-              Selects  legend entries to be drawn using the normal legend col-
-              ors and relief.  All entries whose element names  match  pattern
-              are  selected.  To be selected, the element name must match only
-              one pattern.
-
-       pathName legend get pos
-              Returns the name of the element whose entry  is  at  the  screen
-              position  pos  in  the  legend.  Pos must be in the form "@x,y",
-              where x and y are window coordinates.  If the given  coordinates
-              do not lie over a legend entry, "" is returned.
-
-   PEN COMPONENTS
-       Pens  define  attributes  for  elements.  Pens mirror the configuration
-       options of data elements that pertain to  how  symbols  and  lines  are
-       drawn.  Data elements use pens to determine how they are drawn.  A data
-       element may use several pens at once.  In this case, the pen used for a
-       particular  data  point is determined from each element's weight vector
-       (see the element's -weight and -style options).
-
-       One pen, called activeBar, is automatically created.  It's used as  the
-       default  active  pen  for  elements.  So  you  can  change  the  active
-       attributes for all elements by simply reconfiguring this pen.   .g  pen
-       configure  "activeBar" -fg green -bg green4 You can create and use sev-
-       eral pens. To create a pen, invoke the pen  component  and  its  create
-       operation.   .g  pen  create myPen You map pens to a data element using
-       either the element's -pen or -activepen  options.   .g  element  create
-       "e1" -xdata $x -ydata $tempData \
-           -pen myPen An element can use several pens at once. This is done by
-       specifying the name of the pen in the element's  style  list  (see  the
-       -styles  option).   .g element configure "e1" -styles { myPen 2.0 3.0 }
-       This says that any data point with a weight between 2.0 and 3.0  is  to
-       be drawn using the pen myPen.  All other points are drawn with the ele-
-       ment's default attributes.
-
-       The following operations are available for pen components.
-              value.  The following options are valid for pens.
-
-              -background color
-                     Sets the the color of the border around  each  bar.   The
-                     default is white.
-
-              -borderwidth pixels
-                     Sets  the border width of the 3-D border drawn around the
-                     outside of each bar.  The -relief  option  determines  if
-                     such  a  border  is drawn.  Pixels must be a valid screen
-                     distance like 2 or 0.25i. The default is 2.
-
-              -foreground color
-                     Sets the color of the interior of the bars.
-
-              -relief string
-                     Specifies the 3-D effect desired for bars.  Relief  indi-
-                     cates  how the interior of the bar should appear relative
-                     to the surface of the chart; for  example,  raised  means
-                     the  bar  should  appear  to protrude from the bar chart,
-                     relative to  the  surface  of  the  plotting  area.   The
-                     default is raised.
-
-              -stipple bitmap
-                     Specifies  a stipple pattern with which to draw the bars.
-                     If bitmap is "", then the bar is drawn in a  solid  fash-
-                     ion.
-
-              -type elemType
-                     Specifies the type of element the pen is to be used with.
-                     This option should only be  employed  when  creating  the
-                     pen.   This is for those that wish to mix different types
-                     of elements (bars and lines)  on  the  same  graph.   The
-                     default type is "bar".
-
-              Pen  configuration options may be also be set by the option com-
-              mand.  The resource class is Pen.  The resource  names  are  the
-              names  of  the  pens.   option add *Barchart.Pen.Foreground
-              blue option add *Barchart.activeBar.foreground  green
-
-       pathName pen create penName ?option value?...
-              Creates a new pen by the name penName.  No pen by the same  name
-              can  already  exist.  Option and value are described in above in
-              the pen configure operation.
-
-       pathName pen delete ?penName?...
-              Deletes the named pens. A pen is not really deleted until it  is
-              not  longer  in  use, so it's safe to delete pens mapped to ele-
-              ments.
-
-       pathName pen names ?pattern?...
-              Returns a list of pens matching zero or more  patterns.   If  no
-              option.   Option may be any option described below for the post-
-              script configure operation.
-
-       pathName postscript configure ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies the  configuration  options  for  PostScript
-              generation.   If  option  isn't specified, a list describing the
-              current postscript options for pathName is returned.  If  option
-              is  specified,  but  not value, then a list describing option is
-              returned.  If one or more option and value pairs are  specified,
-              then  for  each  pair,  the  postscript  option option is set to
-              value.  The following postscript options are available.
-
-              -center boolean
-                     Indicates whether the plot  should  be  centered  on  the
-                     PostScript  page.   If boolean is false, the plot will be
-                     placed in the upper left corner of the page.  The default
-                     is 1.
-
-              -colormap varName
-                     VarName  must be the name of a global array variable that
-                     specifies a color mapping from the X color name to  Post-
-                     Script.   Each  element  of varName must consist of Post-
-                     Script code to set a particular color value  (e.g.  ``1.0
-                     1.0  0.0  setrgbcolor'').  When generating color informa-
-                     tion in PostScript, the array variable varName is checked
-                     if  an element of the name as the color exists. If so, it
-                     uses its value as  the  PostScript  command  to  set  the
-                     color.  If this option hasn't been specified, or if there
-                     isn't an entry in varName for a given color, then it uses
-                     the red, green, and blue intensities from the X color.
-
-              -colormode mode
-                     Specifies  how to output color information.  Mode must be
-                     either color (for full color output), gray  (convert  all
-                     colors  to their gray-scale equivalents) or mono (convert
-                     foreground colors  to  black  and  background  colors  to
-                     white).  The default mode is color.
-
-              -fontmap varName
-                     VarName  must be the name of a global array variable that
-                     specifies a font mapping from the X font  name  to  Post-
-                     Script.   Each  element  of varName must consist of a Tcl
-                     list with one or two elements; the name and point size of
-                     a  PostScript  font.  When outputting PostScript commands
-                     for a particular font,  the  array  variable  varName  is
-                     checked  to  see  if  an  element  by  the specified font
-                     exists.  If there is  such  an  element,  then  the  font
-                     information  contained  in  that  element  is used in the
-                     PostScript output.  (If the point size  is  omitted  from
-                     the  list, the point size of the X font is used).  Other-
-                     wise the X font is examined in an attempt to  guess  what
-                     PostScript  font to use.  This works only for fonts whose
-                     widget's height.  The default is 0.
-
-              -landscape boolean
-                     If boolean is true, this specifies the printed area is to
-                     be  rotated 90 degrees.  In non-rotated output the X-axis
-                     of the printed area runs along the short dimension of the
-                     page  (``portrait''  orientation);  in rotated output the
-                     X-axis runs along the long dimension of the page (``land-
-                     scape'' orientation).  Defaults to 0.
-
-              -maxpect boolean
-                     Indicates  to  scale  the plot so that it fills the Post-
-                     Script page.  The aspect ratio of the barchart  is  still
-                     retained.  The default is 0.
-
-              -padx pad
-                     Sets  the  horizontal padding for the left and right page
-                     borders.  The borders are exterior to the plot.  Pad  can
-                     be a list of one or two screen distances.  If pad has two
-                     elements, the left border is padded by the first distance
-                     and  the right border by the second.  If pad has just one
-                     distance, both the left  and  right  borders  are  padded
-                     evenly.  The default is 1i.
-
-              -pady pad
-                     Sets  the  vertical  padding  for the top and bottom page
-                     borders. The borders are exterior to the plot.   Pad  can
-                     be a list of one or two screen distances.  If pad has two
-                     elements, the top border is padded by the first  distance
-                     and the bottom border by the second.  If pad has just one
-                     distance, both the top  and  bottom  borders  are  padded
-                     evenly.  The default is 1i.
-
-              -paperheight pixels
-                     Sets the height of the postscript page.  This can be used
-                     to select between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc).
-                     The default height is 11.0i.
-
-              -paperwidth pixels
-                     Sets  the width of the postscript page.  This can be used
-                     to select between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc).
-                     The default width is 8.5i.
-
-              -width pixels
-                     Sets  the  width  of  the plot.  This lets you generate a
-                     plot of a width different from that of  the  widget.   If
-                     pixels is 0, the width is the same as the widget's width.
-                     The default is 0.
-
-              Postscript configuration options may  be  also  be  set  by  the
-              option  command.  The resource name and class are postscript and
-              Postscript respectively.  option add  *Barchart.postscript.Deco-
-
-       with  a  particular  element, so that when the element is hidden or un-
-       hidden, so is the marker.  By  default,  markers  are  the  last  items
-       drawn,  so  that  data  elements  will  appear in behind them.  You can
-       change this by configuring the -under option.
-
-       Markers, in contrast to elements, don't affect the scaling of the coor-
-       dinate axes.  They can also have elastic coordinates (specified by -Inf
-       and Inf respectively) that translate into the minimum or maximum  limit
-       of  the axis.  For example, you can place a marker so it always remains
-       in the lower left corner of the plotting area, by using the coordinates
-       -Inf,-Inf.
-
-       The following operations are available for markers.
-
-       pathName marker after markerId ?afterId?
-              Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first marker after
-              the second.  If no second afterId  argument  is  specified,  the
-              marker  is  placed at the end of the display list.  This command
-              can be used to control how markers are displayed  since  markers
-              are drawn in the order of this display list.
-
-       pathName marker before markerId ?beforeId?
-              Changes  the  order  of  the  markers,  drawing the first marker
-              before the second.  If no second beforeId argument is specified,
-              the marker is placed at the beginning of the display list.  This
-              command can be used to control how markers are  displayed  since
-              markers are drawn in the order of this display list.
-
-       pathName marker bind tagName ?sequence?  ?command?
-              Associates  command  with  tagName  such that whenever the event
-              sequence given by sequence occurs for a marker  with  this  tag,
-              command will be invoked.  The syntax is similar to the bind com-
-              mand except that it operates on graph markers, rather than  wid-
-              gets. See the bind manual entry for complete details on sequence
-              and the substitutions performed on command before invoking it.
-
-              If all arguments are specified then a new  binding  is  created,
-              replacing  any  existing  binding for the same sequence and tag-
-              Name.  If the first character of command is + then command  aug-
-              ments  an existing binding rather than replacing it.  If no com-
-              mand argument is provided then the command currently  associated
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-       pathName marker cget option
-              Returns the current value of  the  marker  configuration  option
-              given  by  option.   Option may be any option described below in
-              the configure operation.
-
-       pathName marker configure markerId ?option value?...
-                     determine  how  events for markers are handled.  Each tag
-                     in the list matching the current event sequence will have
-                     its  Tcl  command  executed.   Implicitly the name of the
-                     marker is always the first tag in the list.  The  default
-                     value is all.
-
-              -coords coordList
-                     Specifies  the coordinates of the marker.  CoordList is a
-                     list of graph-coordinates.   The  number  of  coordinates
-                     required  is  dependent  on  the  type  of marker.  Text,
-                     image, and window markers need only two  coordinates  (an
-                     X-Y  coordinate).   Bitmap markers can take either two or
-                     four coordinates (if four, they represent the corners  of
-                     the bitmap). Line markers need at least four coordinates,
-                     polygons at least six.  If coordList is  "",  the  marker
-                     will not be displayed.  The default is "".
-
-              -element elemName
-                     Links  the  marker with the element elemName.  The marker
-                     is drawn only if the element is also currently  displayed
-                     (see  the  element's show operation).  If elemName is "",
-                     the marker is always drawn.  The default is "".
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the marker  is  drawn.  If  boolean  is
-                     true, the marker is not drawn.  The default is no.
-
-              -mapx xAxis
-                     Specifies  the  X-axis  to map the marker's X-coordinates
-                     onto.  XAxis must the name of an axis.  The default is x.
-
-              -mapy yAxis
-                     Specifies  the  Y-axis  to map the marker's Y-coordinates
-                     onto.  YAxis must the name of an axis.  The default is y.
-
-              -name markerId
-                     Changes  the  identifier  for the marker.  The identifier
-                     markerId can not already be used by another  marker.   If
-                     this   option  isn't  specified,  the  marker's  name  is
-                     uniquely generated.
-
-              -under boolean
-                     Indicates whether the marker is  drawn  below/above  data
-                     elements.   If  boolean  is  true, the marker is be drawn
-                     underneath the data elements.  Otherwise, the  marker  is
-                     drawn on top of the element.  The default is 0.
-
-              -xoffset pixels
-                     Specifies a screen distance to offset the marker horizon-
-                     tally.  Pixels is a valid screen distance, such as  2  or
-                     1.2i.  The default is 0.
-
-              Creates  a marker of the selected type. Type may be either text,
-              line, bitmap, image, polygon, or window.  This  command  returns
-              the  marker  identifier,  used  as  the markerId argument in the
-              other marker-related commands.  If the  -name  option  is  used,
-              this  overrides  the normal marker identifier.  If the name pro-
-              vided is already used for another marker, the  new  marker  will
-              replace the old.
-
-       pathName marker delete ?name?...
-              Removes  one  of  more markers.  The graph will automatically be
-              redrawn without the marker..
-
-       pathName marker exists markerId
-              Returns 1 if the marker markerId exists and 0 otherwise.
-
-       pathName marker names ?pattern?
-              Returns the names of all the markers that currently  exist.   If
-              pattern  is  supplied,  only  those markers whose names match it
-              will be returned.
-
-       pathName marker type markerId
-              Returns the type of the marker given by markerId, such  as  line
-              or  text.  If markerId is not a valid a marker identifier, "" is
-              returned.
-
-   BITMAP MARKERS
-       A bitmap marker displays a bitmap.  The size  of  the  bitmap  is  con-
-       trolled  by  the  number of coordinates specified.  If two coordinates,
-       they specify the position of the top-left corner of  the  bitmap.   The
-       bitmap  retains  its normal width and height.  If four coordinates, the
-       first and second pairs of coordinates represent the corners of the bit-
-       map.   The bitmap will be stretched or reduced as necessary to fit into
-       the bounding rectangle.
-
-       Bitmap markers are created with the marker's create  operation  in  the
-       form:  pathName  marker  create  bitmap ?option value?...  There may be
-       many option-value pairs, each sets  a  configuration  options  for  the
-       marker.   These  same  option-value pairs may be used with the marker's
-       configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to bitmap markers:
-
-       -background color
-              Same as the -fill option.
-
-       -bitmap bitmap
-              Specifies the bitmap to be displayed.   If  bitmap  is  "",  the
-              marker will not be displayed.  The default is "".
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets  the background color of the bitmap.  If color is the empty
-              string, no background will be transparent.   The  default  back-
-
-       -rotate theta
-              Sets  the rotation of the bitmap.  Theta is a real number repre-
-              senting the angle of rotation in degrees.  The marker  is  first
-              rotated  and  then placed according to its anchor position.  The
-              default rotation is 0.0.
-
-   IMAGE MARKERS
-       A image marker displays an image.  Image markers are created  with  the
-       marker's  create  operation  in  the form: pathName marker create image
-       ?option value?...  There may be many option-value pairs,  each  sets  a
-       configuration option for the marker.  These same option-value pairs may
-       be used with the marker's configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to image markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor tells how to position the image relative to the position-
-              ing  point  for the image. For example, if anchor is center then
-              the image is centered on the point;  if anchor  is  n  then  the
-              image  will be drawn such that the top center point of the rect-
-              angular region occupied by the image will be at the  positioning
-              point.  This option defaults to center.
-
-       -image image
-              Specifies  the  image  to  be drawn.  If image is "", the marker
-              will not be drawn.  The default is "".
-
-   LINE MARKERS
-       A line marker displays one or more connected line segments.  Line mark-
-       ers  are  created  with marker's create operation in the form: pathName
-       marker create line ?option value?...  There may  be  many  option-value
-       pairs,  each  sets  a  configuration option for the marker.  These same
-       option-value pairs may be used with the marker's configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to line markers:
-
-       -dashes dashList
-              Sets the dash style of the line. DashList is a list of up to  11
-              numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes and
-              gaps on the line.  Each number must be between 1  and  255.   If
-              dashList is "", the marker line will be solid.
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets  the background color of the line.  This color is used with
-              striped lines (see the -dashes option). If color  is  the  empty
-              string,  no  background color is drawn (the line will be dashed,
-              not striped).  The default background color is "".
-
-       -linewidth pixels
-              Sets the width of the lines.  The default width is 0.
-
-       in  the  form:  pathName marker create polygon ?option value?...  There
-       may be many option-value pairs, each sets a  configuration  option  for
-       the  marker.  These same option-value pairs may be used with the marker
-       configure command to change the marker's configuration.  The  following
-       options are supported for polygon markers:
-
-       -dashes dashList
-              Sets the dash style of the outline of the polygon. DashList is a
-              list of up to 11 numbers that alternately represent the  lengths
-              of  the  dashes  and  gaps  on the outline.  Each number must be
-              between 1 and 255. If dashList is "",  the  outline  will  be  a
-              solid line.
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets  the  fill  color of the polygon.  If color is "", then the
-              interior of the polygon is transparent.  The default is white.
-
-       -linewidth pixels
-              Sets the width of the outline of the polygon. If pixels is zero,
-              no outline is drawn. The default is 0.
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets the color of the outline of the polygon.  If the polygon is
-              stippled (see the -stipple option),  then  this  represents  the
-              foreground color of the stipple.  The default is black.
-
-       -stipple bitmap
-              Specifies  that the polygon should be drawn with a stippled pat-
-              tern rather than a solid color. Bitmap specifies a bitmap to use
-              as  the  stipple  pattern.  If bitmap is "", then the polygon is
-              filled with a solid color (if the -fill  option  is  set).   The
-              default is "".
-
-   TEXT MARKERS
-       A  text  marker displays a string of characters on one or more lines of
-       text.  Embedded newlines cause line breaks.  They may be used to  anno-
-       tate  regions  of  the graph.  Text markers are created with the create
-       operation in the form: pathName marker create  text  ?option  value?...
-       There  may be many option-value pairs, each sets a configuration option
-       for the text marker.  These same option-value pairs may  be  used  with
-       the marker's configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to text markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor  tells how to position the text relative to the position-
-              ing point for the text. For example, if anchor  is  center  then
-              the  text is centered on the point; if anchor is n then the text
-              will be drawn such that the top center point of the  rectangular
-              region  occupied  by  the text will be at the positioning point.
-              This default is center.
-
-
-       -justify justify
-              Specifies  how  the text should be justified.  This matters only
-              when the marker contains more than one  line  of  text.  Justify
-              must be left, right, or center.  The default is center.
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets the color of the text. The default value is black.
-
-       -padx pad
-              Sets  the  padding  to the left and right exteriors of the text.
-              Pad can be a list of one or two screen distances.   If  pad  has
-              two  elements,  the left side of the text is padded by the first
-              distance and the right side by the second.  If pad has just  one
-              distance,  both the left and right sides are padded evenly.  The
-              default is 4.
-
-       -pady pad
-              Sets the padding above and below the text.  Pad can be a list of
-              one  or two screen distances.  If pad has two elements, the area
-              above the text is padded by the  first  distance  and  the  area
-              below  by the second.  If pad is just one distance, both the top
-              and bottom areas are padded evenly.  The default is 4.
-
-       -rotate theta
-              Specifies the number of degrees to rotate the text.  Theta is  a
-              real  number  representing the angle of rotation.  The marker is
-              first rotated along its center and is then  drawn  according  to
-              its anchor position. The default is 0.0.
-
-       -text text
-              Specifies  the  text  of  the marker.  The exact way the text is
-              displayed may be affected by other options such  as  -anchor  or
-              -rotate.
-
-   WINDOW MARKERS
-       A  window marker displays a widget at a given position.  Window markers
-       are created with the marker's create operation in  the  form:  pathName
-       marker  create window ?option value?...  There may be many option-value
-       pairs, each sets a configuration option for  the  marker.   These  same
-       option-value pairs may be used with the marker's configure command.
-
-       The following options are specific to window markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor  tells  how  to position the widget relative to the posi-
-              tioning point for the widget. For example, if anchor  is  center
-              then  the  widget  is centered on the point; if anchor is n then
-              the widget will be displayed such that the top center  point  of
-              the  rectangular  region  occupied  by the widget will be at the
-              positioning point.  This option defaults to center.
-
-
-
-

GRAPH COMPONENT BINDINGS

-       Specific barchart components, such  as  elements,  markers  and  legend
-       entries,  can  have  a  command trigger when event occurs in them, much
-       like canvas items in Tk's canvas widget.  Not all event  sequences  are
-       valid.  The only binding events that may be specified are those related
-       to the mouse and keyboard (such as Enter, Leave,  ButtonPress,  Motion,
-       and KeyPress).
-
-       Only  one element or marker can be picked during an event.  This means,
-       that if the mouse is directly over both an element and a  marker,  only
-       the  uppermost  component  is  selected.   This  isn't  true for legend
-       entries.  Both a legend entry and an element (or marker)  binding  com-
-       mands will be invoked if both items are picked.
-
-       It is possible for multiple bindings to match a particular event.  This
-       could occur, for example, if one binding is associated with the element
-       name  and another is associated with one of the element's tags (see the
-       -bindtags option).  When this occurs, all of the matching bindings  are
-       invoked.   A binding associated with the element name is invoked first,
-       followed by one binding for each of the element's bindtags.   If  there
-       are  multiple  matching  bindings  for a single tag, then only the most
-       specific binding is invoked.  A continue command in  a  binding  script
-       terminates  that script, and a break command terminates that script and
-       skips any remaining scripts for the event, just as for  the  bind  com-
-       mand.
-
-       The  -bindtags  option for these components controls addition tag names
-       which can be matched.  Implicitly elements and markers always have tags
-       matching  their  names.   Setting  the  value  of  the -bindtags option
-       doesn't change this.
-
-
-
-

C LANGUAGE API

-       You can manipulate data elements from the C  language.   There  may  be
-       situations  where it is too expensive to translate the data values from
-       ASCII strings.  Or you might want to read data in a special  file  for-
-       mat.
-
-       Data  can manipulated from the C language using BLT vectors.  You spec-
-       ify the X-Y data coordinates of an element as  vectors  and  manipulate
-       the  vector  from  C.  The barchart will be redrawn automatically after
-       the vectors are updated.
-
-       From Tcl, create the vectors and configure the  element  to  use  them.
-       vector  X  Y  .g  element configure line1 -xdata X -ydata Y To set data
-       points from C, you pass the values  as  arrays  of  doubles  using  the
-       Blt_ResetVector call.  The vector is reset with the new data and at the
-       next idle point (when Tk re-enters its event loop), the graph  will  be
-       redrawn automatically.  #include <tcl.h> #include <blt.h>
-
-       register int i; Blt_Vector *xVec, *yVec; double x[50], y[50];
-
-       /*  Get  the  BLT  vectors  "X"  and "Y" (created above from Tcl) */ if
-       There may be cases where the bar chart needs to be drawn and updated as
-       quickly as possible.  If drawing speed becomes a big problem, here  are
-       a few tips to speed up displays.
-
-       o Try  to  minimize  the  number  of data points.  The more data points
-         looked at, the more work the bar chart must do.
-
-       o If your data is generated as floating point values, the time required
-         to  convert the data values to and from ASCII strings can be signifi-
-         cant, especially when there any many data points.  You can avoid  the
-         redundant  string-to-decimal  conversions using the C API to BLT vec-
-         tors.
-
-       o Don't stipple or dash the element.  Solid bars are much faster.
-
-       o If you update data elements frequently, try turning off the  widget's
-         -bufferelements  option.   When  the bar chart is first displayed, it
-         draws data elements into an internal pixmap.  The pixmap  acts  as  a
-         cache,  so that when the bar chart needs to be redrawn again, and the
-         data elements or coordinate axes haven't changed, the pixmap is  sim-
-         ply  copied  to  the  screen.  This is especially useful when you are
-         using markers to highlight points and regions on the bar chart.   But
-         if  the  bar chart is updated frequently, changing either the element
-         data or coordinate axes, the buffering becomes redundant.
-
-
-
-

LIMITATIONS

-       Auto-scale routines do not use requested min/max limits  as  boundaries
-       when the axis is logarithmically scaled.
-
-       The PostScript output generated for polygons with more than 1500 points
-       may exceed the limits of some printers (See PostScript Language  Refer-
-       ence  Manual,  page 568).  The work-around is to break the polygon into
-       separate pieces.
-
-
-
-

KEYWORDS

-       bar chart, widget
-
-
-
-BLT                               BLT_VERSION                      barchart(n)
-
-
-
-Man(1) output converted with -man2html -
- - diff --git a/tkblt/doc/barchart.n b/tkblt/doc/barchart.n deleted file mode 100644 index 7a9dac8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/barchart.n +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2239 +0,0 @@ -'\" -'\" Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA -'\" This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made -'\" available under the same terms. -'\" -'\" Copyright 1991-1998 by Bell Labs Innovations for Lucent Technologies. -'\" -'\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its -'\" documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided -'\" that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that the -'\" copyright notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting documentation, -'\" and that the names of Lucent Technologies any of their entities not be used -'\" in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software -'\" without specific, written prior permission. -'\" -'\" Lucent Technologies disclaims all warranties with regard to this software, -'\" including all implied warranties of merchantability and fitness. In no event -'\" shall Lucent Technologies be liable for any special, indirect or -'\" consequential damages or any damages whatsoever resulting from loss of use, -'\" data or profits, whether in an action of contract, negligence or other -'\" tortuous action, arising out of or in connection with the use or performance -'\" of this software. -'\" -'\" Barchart widget created by Sani Nassif and George Howlett. -'\" -.TH barchart n BLT_VERSION BLT "BLT Built-In Commands" -.BS -'\" Note: do not modify the .SH NAME line immediately below! -.SH NAME -barchart \- Bar chart for plotting X-Y coordinate data. -.SH SYNOPSIS -\fBbarchart\fI \fIpathName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.BE -.SH DESCRIPTION -The \fBbarchart\fR command creates a bar chart for plotting -two-dimensional data (X-Y coordinates). A bar chart is a graphic means -of comparing numbers by displaying bars of lengths proportional to the -y-coordinates of the points they represented. The bar chart has many -configurable components: coordinate axes, elements, legend, grid -lines, cross hairs, etc. They allow you to customize the look and -feel of the graph. -.SH INTRODUCTION -The \fBbarchart\fR command creates a new window for plotting -two-dimensional data (X-Y coordinates), using bars of -various lengths to represent the data points. The bars are drawn in a -rectangular area displayed in the center of the new window. This is the -\fIplotting area\fR. The coordinate axes are drawn in -the margins surrounding the plotting area. By default, the legend is -drawn in the right margin. The title is displayed in top margin. -.PP -A \fBbarchart\fR widget has several configurable components: -coordinate axes, data elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, pens, -postscript, and annotation markers. Each component can be queried or -modified. -.TP 1i -\f(CWaxis\fR - -Up to four coordinate axes (two X\-coordinate and two Y\-coordinate -axes) can be displayed, but you can create and use any number of -axes. Axes control what region of data is displayed and how the data -is scaled. Each axis consists of the axis line, title, major and minor -ticks, and tick labels. Tick labels display the value at each major -tick. -.TP 1i -\f(CWcrosshairs\fR -Cross hairs are used to position the mouse pointer relative to the X -and Y coordinate axes. Two perpendicular lines, intersecting at the -current location of the mouse, extend across the plotting area to the -coordinate axes. -.TP 1i -\f(CWelement\fR -An element represents a set of data to be plotted. It contains an x -and y vector of values representing the data points. Each -data point is displayed as a bar where the length of the bar is -proportional to the ordinate (Y-coordinate) of the data point. -The appearance of the bar, such as its color, stipple, or relief -is configurable. -.sp -A special case exists when two or more data points have the same -abscissa (X-coordinate). By default, the bars are overlayed, one on -top of the other. The bars are drawn in the order of the element -display list. But you can also configure the bars to be displayed in -two other ways. They may be displayed as a stack, where each bar -(with the same abscissa) is stacked on the previous. Or they can be -drawn side-by-side as thin bars. The width of each bar is a function -of the number of data points with the same abscissa. -.TP 1i -\f(CWgrid\fR -Extends the major and minor ticks of the X\-axis and/or Y\-axis across the -plotting area. -.TP 1i -\f(CWlegend\fR -The legend displays the name and symbol of each data element. -The legend can be drawn in any margin or in the plotting area. -.TP 1i -\f(CWmarker\fR -Markers are used annotate or highlight areas of the graph. For -example, you could use a text marker to label a particular data -point. Markers come in various forms: text strings, bitmaps, connected -line segments, images, polygons, or embedded widgets. -.TP 1i -\f(CWpen\fR -Pens define attributes for elements. Data elements use pens to -specify how they should be drawn. A data element may use many pens at -once. Here the particular pen used for a data point is determined -from each element's weight vector (see the element's \fB\-weight\fR -and \fB\-style\fR options). -.TP 1i -\f(CWpostscript\fR -The widget can generate encapsulated PostScript output. This component -has several options to configure how the PostScript is generated. -.SH SYNTAX -.DS -\fBbarchart \fIpathName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -The \fBbarchart\fR command creates a new window \fIpathName\fR and makes -it into a \fBbarchart\fR widget. At the time this command is invoked, there -must not exist a window named \fIpathName\fR, but \fIpathName\fR's -parent must exist. Additional options may be specified on the -command line or in the option database to configure aspects of the -graph such as its colors and font. See the \fBconfigure\fR operation -below for the exact details about what \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are valid. -.PP -If successful, \fBbarchart\fR returns the path name of the widget. It -also creates a new Tcl command by the same name. You can use this -command to invoke various operations that query or modify the graph. -The general form is: -.DS -\fIpathName \fIoperation\fR \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -Both \fIoperation\fR and its arguments determine the exact behavior of -the command. The operations available for the graph are described in -the -.SB "BARCHART OPERATIONS" -section. -.PP -The command can also be used to access components of the graph. -.DS -\fIpathName component operation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -The operation, now located after the name of the component, is the -function to be performed on that component. Each component has its own -set of operations that manipulate that component. They will be -described below in their own sections. -.SH EXAMPLE -The \fBbarchart\fR command creates a new bar chart. -.CS -# Create a new bar chart. Plotting area is black. -barchart .b -plotbackground black -.CE -A new Tcl command \f(CW.b\fR is created. This command can be used -to query and modify the bar chart. For -example, to change the title of the graph to "My Plot", you use the -new command and the \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.CS -# Change the title. -\&.b configure -title "My Plot" -.CE -To add data elements, you use the command and the \fBelement\fR component. -.CS -# Create a new element named "e1" -\&.b element create e1 \\ - -xdata { 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 } \\ - -ydata { 26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 - 155.85 166.60 175.38 } -.CE -The element's X-Y coordinates are specified using lists of -numbers. Alternately, BLT vectors could be used to hold the X-Y -coordinates. -.CS -# Create two vectors and add them to the barchart. -vector xVector yVector -xVector set { 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 } -yVector set { 26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 155.85 - 166.60 175.38 } -\&n.b element create e1 -xdata xVector -ydata yVector -.CE -The advantage of using vectors is that when you modify one, the graph -is automatically redrawn to reflect the new values. -.CS -# Change the y coordinate of the first point. -set yVector(0) 25.18 -.CE -An element named \f(CWe1\fR is now created in \f(CW.b\fR. It -is automatically added to the display list of elements. You can -use this list to control in what order elements are displayed. -To query or reset the element display list, you use the element's -\fBshow\fR operation. -.CS -# Get the current display list -set elemList [.b element show] -# Remove the first element so it won't be displayed. -\&.b element show [lrange $elemList 0 end] -.CE -The element will be displayed by as many bars as there are data points -(in this case there are ten). The bars will be drawn centered at the -x-coordinate of the data point. All the bars will have the same -attributes (colors, stipple, etc). The width of each bar is by -default one unit. You can change this with using the \fB\-barwidth\fR -option. -.CS -# Change the scale of the x-coordinate data -xVector set { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 } -# Make sure we change the bar width too. -\&.b configure -barwidth 0.2 -.CE -The height of each bar is proportional to the ordinate (Y-coordinate) -of the data point. -.PP -If two or more data points have the same abscissa (X-coordinate -value), the bars representing those data points may be drawn in -various ways. -The default is to overlay the bars, one on top of the other. -The ordering is determined from the of element display list. If -the stacked mode is selected (using the \fB\-barmode\fR configuration -option), the bars are stacked, each bar above the previous. -.CS -# Display the elements as stacked. -\&.b configure -barmode stacked -.CE -If the aligned mode is selected, the bars having the same -x-coordinates are displayed side by side. The width of each bar is a -fraction of its normal width, based upon the number of bars with the -same x-coordinate. -.CS -# Display the elements side-by-side. -\&.b configure -barmode aligned -.CE -By default, the element's label in the legend will be also -\f(CWe1\fR. You can change the label, or specify no legend entry, -again using the element's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.CS -# Don't display "e1" in the legend. -\&.b element configure e1 -label "" -.CE -You can configure more than just the element's label. An element has -many attributes such as stipple, foreground and background colors, -relief, etc. -.CS -\&.b element configure e1 -fg red -bg pink \\ - -stipple gray50 -.CE -Four coordinate axes are automatically created: \f(CWx\fR, \f(CWx2\fR, -\f(CWy\fR, and \f(CWy2\fR. And by default, elements are mapped onto the -axes \f(CWx\fR and \f(CWy\fR. This can be changed with the \fB\-mapx\fR -and \fB\-mapy\fR options. -.CS -# Map "e1" on the alternate y axis "y2". -\&.b element configure e1 -mapy y2 -.CE -Axes can be configured in many ways too. For example, you change the -scale of the Y\-axis from linear to log using the \fBaxis\fR component. -.CS -# Y-axis is log scale. -\&.b axis configure y -logscale yes -.CE -One important way axes are used is to zoom in on a particular data -region. Zooming is done by simply specifying new axis limits using -the \fB\-min\fR and \fB\-max\fR configuration options. -.CS -\&.b axis configure x \-min 1.0 \-max 1.5 -\&.b axis configure y \-min 12.0 \-max 55.15 -.CE -To zoom interactively, you link the\fBaxis configure\fR operations with -some user interaction (such as pressing the mouse button), using the -\fBbind\fR command. To convert between screen and graph coordinates, -use the \fBinvtransform\fR operation. -.CS -# Click the button to set a new minimum -bind .b { - %W axis configure x \-min [%W axis invtransform x %x] - %W axis configure x \-min [%W axis invtransform x %y] -} -.CE -By default, the limits of the axis are determined from data values. -To reset back to the default limits, set the \fB\-min\fR and -\fB\-max\fR options to the empty value. -.CS -# Reset the axes to autoscale again. -\&.b axis configure x \-min {} \-max {} -\&.b axis configure y \-min {} \-max {} -.CE -By default, the legend is drawn in the right margin. You can -change this or any legend configuration options using the -\fBlegend\fR component. -.CS -# Configure the legend font, color, and relief -\&.b legend configure -position left -relief raised \\ - -font fixed -fg blue -.CE -To prevent the legend from being displayed, turn on the \fB\-hide\fR -option. -.CS -# Don't display the legend. -\&.b legend configure \-hide yes\fR -.CE -The \fBbarchart\fR has simple drawing procedures called markers. They can be -used to highlight or annotate data in the graph. The types of markers -available are bitmaps, polygons, lines, or windows. Markers can be -used, for example, to mark or brush points. For example there may be -a line marker which indicates some low-water value. Markers are created -using the \fBmarker\fR operation. -.CS -# Create a line represent the low water mark at 10.0 -\&.b marker create line -name "low_water" \\ - -coords { -Inf 10.0 Inf 10.0 } \\ - -dashes { 2 4 2 } -fg red -bg blue -.CE -This creates a line marker named \f(CWlow_water\fR. It will display a -horizontal line stretching across the plotting area at the -y-coordinate 10.0. The coordinates "-Inf" and "Inf" indicate the -relative minimum and maximum of the axis (in this case the x-axis). By -default, markers are drawn last, on top of the bars. You can change this -with the \fB\-under\fR option. -.CS -# Draw the marker before elements are drawn. -\&.b marker configure low_water -under yes -.CE -You can add cross hairs or grid lines using the \fBcrosshairs\fR and -\fBgrid\fR components. -.CS -# Display both cross hairs and grid lines. -\&.b crosshairs configure -hide no -color red -\&.b grid configure -hide no -dashes { 2 2 } -.CE -Finally, to get hardcopy of the graph, use the \fBpostscript\fR -component. -.CS -# Print the bar chart into file "file.ps" -\&.b postscript output file.ps -maxpect yes -decorations no -.CE -This generates a file \f(CWfile.ps\fR containing the encapsulated -PostScript of the graph. The option \fB\-maxpect\fR says to scale the -plot to the size of the page. Turning off the \fB\-decorations\fR -option denotes that no borders or color backgrounds should be -drawn (i.e. the background of the margins, legend, and plotting -area will be white). -.SH SYNTAX -.DS -\fBbarchart \fIpathName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -The \fBbarchart\fR command creates a new window \fIpathName\fR and makes -it into a barchart widget. At the time this command is invoked, there -must not exist a window named \fIpathName\fR, but \fIpathName\fR's -parent must exist. Additional options may may be specified on the -command line or in the option database to configure aspects of the -bar chart such as its colors and font. See the \fBconfigure\fR operation -below for the exact details as to what \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are valid. -.PP -If successful, \fBbarchart\fR returns \fIpathName\fR. It also creates a -new Tcl command \fIpathName\fR. This command may be used to invoke -various operations to query or modify the bar chart. It has the general -form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fIoperation\fR \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -Both \fIoperation\fR and its arguments determine the exact behavior of -the command. The operations available for the bar chart are described in -the following section. -.SH "BARCHART OPERATIONS" -.TP -\fIpathName \fBbar \fIelemName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new barchart element \fIelemName\fR. It's an -error if an element \fIelemName\fR already exists. -See the manual for \fBbarchart\fR for details about -what \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are valid. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcget\fR \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below for the \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBconfigure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of the graph. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. -The following options are valid. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color. This includes the margins and -legend, but not the plotting area. -.TP -\fB\-barmode \fImode\fR -Indicates how related bar elements will be drawn. Related elements -have data points with the same abscissas (X-coordinates). \fIMode\fR -indicates how those segments should be drawn. \fIMode\fR can be -\f(CWinfront\fR, \f(CWaligned\fR, \f(CWoverlap\fR, or \f(CWstacked\fR. -The default mode is \f(CWinfront\fR. -.RS -.TP 1i -\f(CWinfront\fR -Each successive segment is drawn in front of the previous. -.TP 1i -\f(CWstacked\fR -Each successive segment is stacked vertically on top of the previous. -.TP 1i -\f(CWaligned\fR -Segments is displayed aligned from right-to-left. -.TP 1i -\f(CWoverlap\fR -Like \f(CWaligned\fR but segments slightly overlap each other. -.RE -.TP -\fB\-barwidth \fIvalue\fR -Specifies the width of the bars. This value can be overrided by the -individual elements using their \fB\-barwidth\fR configuration option. -\fIValue\fR is the width in terms of graph-coordinates. The -default width is \f(CW1.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3\-D border around the outside edge of the widget. The -\fB\-relief\fR option determines if the border is to be drawn. The -default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bottommargin \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the size of the margin below the X\-coordinate axis. If -\fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the size of the margin is selected automatically. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bufferelements \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether an internal pixmap to buffer the display of data -elements should be used. If \fIboolean\fR is true, data elements are -drawn to an internal pixmap. This option is especially useful when -the graph is redrawn frequently while the remains data unchanged (for -example, moving a marker across the plot). See the -.SB "SPEED TIPS" -section. -The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-cursor \fIcursor\fR -Specifies the widget's cursor. The default cursor is \f(CWcrosshair\fR. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font of the graph title. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-18-180-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-halo \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a maximum distance to consider when searching for the -closest data point (see the element's \fBclosest\fR operation below). -Data points further than \fIpixels\fR away are ignored. The default is -\f(CW0.5i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the requested height of widget. The default is -\f(CW4i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-invertxy \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the placement X\-axis and Y\-axis should be inverted. If -\fIboolean\fR is true, the X and Y axes are swapped. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the title should be justified. This matters only when -the title contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR must be -\f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-leftmargin \fIpixels\fR -Sets the size of the margin from the left edge of the window to -the Y\-coordinate axis. If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the size is -calculated automatically. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotbackground \fIcolor\fR -Specifies the background color of the plotting area. The default is -\f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotborderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the plotting area. The -\fB\-plotrelief\fR option determines if a border is drawn. The -default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotpadx \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of padding to be added to the left and right sides of -the plotting area. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen -distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the left side of the -plotting area entry is padded by the first distance and the right side -by the second. If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the left and -right sides are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW8\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotpady \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of padding to be added to the top and bottom of the -plotting area. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen -distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the top of the plotting -area is padded by the first distance and the bottom by the second. If -\fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and bottom are padded -evenly. The default is \f(CW8\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotrelief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the plotting area. \fIRelief\fR -specifies how the interior of the plotting area should appear relative -to rest of the graph; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the plot should -appear to protrude from the graph, relative to the surface of the -graph. The default is \f(CWsunken\fR. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the barchart widget. \fIRelief\fR -specifies how the graph should appear relative to widget it is packed -into; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the graph should -appear to protrude. The default is \f(CWflat\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rightmargin \fIpixels\fR -Sets the size of margin from the plotting area to the right edge of -the window. By default, the legend is drawn in this margin. If -\fIpixels\fR is than 1, the margin size is selected automatically. -.TP -\fB\-takefocus\fR \fIfocus\fR -Provides information used when moving the focus from window to window -via keyboard traversal (e.g., Tab and Shift-Tab). If \fIfocus\fR is -\f(CW0\fR, this means that this window should be skipped entirely during -keyboard traversal. \f(CW1\fR means that the this window should always -receive the input focus. An empty value means that the traversal -scripts make the decision whether to focus on the window. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tile \fIimage\fR -Specifies a tiled background for the widget. If \fIimage\fR isn't -\f(CW""\fR, the background is tiled using \fIimage\fR. -Otherwise, the normal background color is drawn (see the -\fB\-background\fR option). \fIImage\fR must be an image created -using the Tk \fBimage\fR command. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-title \fItext\fR -Sets the title to \fItext\fR. If \fItext\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -no title will be displayed. -.TP -\fB\-topmargin \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the size of the margin above the x2 axis. If \fIpixels\fR -is \f(CW0\fR, the margin size is calculated automatically. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the requested width of the widget. The default is -\f(CW5i\fR. -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR? -See the -.SB "CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "ELEMENT COMPONENTS" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBextents \fIitem\fR -Returns the size of a particular item in the graph. \fIItem\fR must -be either \f(CWleftmargin\fR, \f(CWrightmargin\fR, \f(CWtopmargin\fR, -\f(CWbottommargin\fR, \f(CWplotwidth\fR, or \f(CWplotheight\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "GRID COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBinvtransform \fIwinX winY\fR -Performs an inverse coordinate transformation, mapping window -coordinates back to graph-coordinates, using the standard X\-axis and Y\-axis. -Returns a list of containing the X-Y graph-coordinates. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBinside \fIx y\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR is the designated screen-coordinate (\fIx\fR and \fIy\fR) -is inside the plotting area and \f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "LEGEND COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBline\fB operation arg\fR... -The operation is the same as \fBelement\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "MARKER COMPONENTS" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName\fR \fBmetafile\fR ?\fIfileName\fR? -\fIThis operation is for Window platforms only\fR. -Creates a Windows enhanced metafile of the barchart. -If present, \fIfileName\fR is the file name of the new metafile. -Otherwise, the metafile is automatically added to the clipboard. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBsnap \fIphotoName\fR -Takes a snapshot of the graph and stores the contents in the photo -image \fIphotoName\fR. \fIPhotoName\fR is the name of a Tk photo -image that must already exist. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBtransform \fIx y\fR -Performs a coordinate transformation, mapping graph-coordinates to -window coordinates, using the standard X\-axis and Y\-axis. -Returns a list containing the X\-Y screen-coordinates. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBxaxis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fBx2axis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fByaxis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fBy2axis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "AXIS COMPONENTS" -section. -.SH "BARCHART COMPONENTS" -A graph is composed of several components: coordinate axes, data -elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, postscript, and annotation -markers. Instead of one big set of configuration options and -operations, the graph is partitioned, where each component has its own -configuration options and operations that specifically control that -aspect or part of the graph. -.SS "AXIS COMPONENTS" -Four coordinate axes are automatically created: two X\-coordinate axes -(\f(CWx\fR and \f(CWx2\fR) and two Y\-coordinate axes (\f(CWy\fR, and -\f(CWy2\fR). By default, the axis \f(CWx\fR is located in the bottom -margin, \f(CWy\fR in the left margin, \f(CWx2\fR in the top margin, and -\f(CWy2\fR in the right margin. -.PP -An axis consists of the axis line, title, major and minor ticks, and -tick labels. Major ticks are drawn at uniform intervals along the -axis. Each tick is labeled with its coordinate value. Minor ticks -are drawn at uniform intervals within major ticks. -.PP -The range of the axis controls what region of data is plotted. -Data points outside the minimum and maximum limits of the axis are -not plotted. By default, the minimum and maximum limits are -determined from the data, but you can reset either limit. -.PP -You can create and use several axes. To create an axis, invoke -the axis component and its create operation. -.CS -# Create a new axis called "temperature" -\&.b axis create temperature -.CE -You map data elements to an axis using the element's \-mapy and \-mapx -configuration options. They specify the coordinate axes an element -is mapped onto. -.CS -# Now map the temperature data to this axis. -\&.b element create "temp" \-xdata $x \-ydata $tempData \\ - \-mapy temperature -.CE -While you can have many axes, only four axes can be displayed -simultaneously. They are drawn in each of the margins surrounding -the plotting area. The axes \f(CWx\fR and \f(CWy\fR are drawn in the -bottom and left margins. The axes \f(CWx2\fR and \f(CWy2\fR are drawn in -top and right margins. Only \f(CWx\fR and \f(CWy\fR are shown by -default. Note that the axes can have different scales. -.PP -To display a different axis, you invoke one of the following -components: \fBxaxis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR. -The \fBuse\fR operation designates the axis to be drawn in the -corresponding margin: \fBxaxis\fR in the bottom, \fByaxis\fR in the left, -\fBx2axis\fR in the top, and \fBy2axis\fR in the right. -.CS -# Display the axis temperature in the left margin. -\&.b yaxis use temperature -.CE -.PP -You can configure axes in many ways. The axis scale can be linear or -logarithmic. The values along the axis can either monotonically -increase or decrease. If you need custom tick labels, you can specify -a Tcl procedure to format the label any way you wish. You can -control how ticks are drawn, by changing the major tick interval -or the number of minor ticks. You can define non-uniform tick intervals, -such as for time-series plots. -.PP -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBcget \fIaxisName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the option given by \fIoption\fR for -\fIaxisName\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the axis \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBconfigure \fIaxisName \fR?\fIaxisName\fR?... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of \fIaxisName\fR. -Several axes can be changed. If \fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list -describing all the current options for \fIaxisName\fR is returned. If -\fIoption\fR is specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing -\fIoption\fR is returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are specified, then for each pair, the axis option \fIoption\fR -is set to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for axes. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-autorange \fIrange\fR -Sets the range of values for the axis to \fIrange\fR. The axis limits -are automatically reset to display the most recent data points in this range. -If \fIrange\fR is 0.0, the range is -determined from the limits of the data. If \fB\-min\fR or \fB-max\fR -are specified, they override this option. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the axis and tick labels. -The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-command \fIprefix\fR -Specifies a Tcl command to be invoked when formatting the axis tick -labels. \fIPrefix\fR is a string containing the name of a Tcl proc and -any extra arguments for the procedure. This command is invoked for each -major tick on the axis. Two additional arguments are passed to the -procedure: the pathname of the widget and the current the numeric -value of the tick. The procedure returns the formatted tick label. If -\f(CW""\fR is returned, no label will appear next to the tick. You can -get the standard tick labels again by setting \fIprefix\fR to -\f(CW""\fR. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.sp 1 -Please note that this procedure is invoked while the bar chart is redrawn. -You may query the widget's configuration options. But do not reset -options, because this can have unexpected results. -.TP -\fB\-descending \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the values along the axis are monotonically increasing or -decreasing. If \fIboolean\fR is true, the axis values will be -decreasing. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the axis is displayed. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the axis title should be justified. This matters only -when the axis title contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR -must be \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-limits \fIformatStr\fR -Specifies a printf-like description to format the minimum and maximum -limits of the axis. The limits are displayed at the top/bottom or -left/right sides of the plotting area. \fIFormatStr\fR is a list of -one or two format descriptions. If one description is supplied, both -the minimum and maximum limits are formatted in the same way. If two, -the first designates the format for the minimum limit, the second for -the maximum. If \f(CW""\fR is given as either description, then -the that limit will not be displayed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the axis and tick lines. The default is \f(CW1\fR -pixel. -.TP -\fB\-logscale \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the scale of the axis is logarithmic or linear. If -\fIboolean\fR is true, the axis is logarithmic. The default scale is -linear. -.TP -\fB\-loose \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the limits of the axis should fit the data points tightly, -at the outermost data points, or loosely, at the outer tick intervals. -This is relevant only when the axis limit is automatically calculated. -If \fIboolean\fR is true, the axis range is "loose". -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-majorticks \fImajorList\fR -Specifies where to display major axis ticks. You can use this option -to display ticks at non-uniform intervals. \fIMajorList\fR is a list -of axis coordinates designating the location of major ticks. No -minor ticks are drawn. If \fImajorList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -major ticks will be automatically computed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-max \fIvalue\fR -Sets the maximum limit of \fIaxisName\fR. Any data point greater -than \fIvalue\fR is not displayed. If \fIvalue\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the maximum limit is calculated using the largest data value. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-min \fIvalue\fR -Sets the minimum limit of \fIaxisName\fR. Any data point less than -\fIvalue\fR is not displayed. If \fIvalue\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the minimum limit is calculated using the smallest data value. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-minorticks \fIminorList\fR -Specifies where to display minor axis ticks. You can use this option -to display minor ticks at non-uniform intervals. \fIMinorList\fR is a -list of real values, ranging from 0.0 to 1.0, designating the placement of -a minor tick. No minor ticks are drawn if the \fB\-majortick\fR -option is also set. If \fIminorList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, minor ticks will -be automatically computed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Specifies the how many degrees to rotate the axis tick labels. -\fITheta\fR is a real value representing the number of degrees -to rotate the tick labels. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR degrees. -.TP -\fB\-shiftby \fIvalue\fR -Specifies how much to automatically shift the range of the axis. -When the new data exceeds the current axis maximum, the maximum -is increased in increments of \fIvalue\fR. You can use this -option to prevent the axis limits from being recomputed -at each new time point. If \fIvalue\fR is 0.0, then no automatic -shifting is down. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-showticks \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether axis ticks should be drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is -true, ticks are drawn. If false, only the -axis line is drawn. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stepsize \fIvalue\fR -Specifies the interval between major axis ticks. If \fIvalue\fR isn't -a valid interval (must be less than the axis range), -the request is ignored and the step size is automatically calculated. -.TP -\fB\-subdivisions \fInumber\fR -Indicates how many minor axis ticks are -to be drawn. For example, if \fInumber\fR is two, only one minor -tick is drawn. If \fInumber\fR is one, no minor ticks are -displayed. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tickfont \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font for axis tick labels. The default is -\f(CW*-Courier-Bold-R-Normal-*-100-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-ticklength \fIpixels\fR -Sets the length of major and minor ticks (minor ticks are half the -length of major ticks). If \fIpixels\fR is less than zero, the axis -will be inverted with ticks drawn pointing towards the plot. The -default is \f(CW0.1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-title \fItext\fR -Sets the title of the axis. If \fItext\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, no axis title will be displayed. -.TP -\fB\-titlecolor \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the axis title. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-titlefont \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font for axis title. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-14-140-*\fR. -.PP -Axis configuration options may be also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource class is \f(CWAxis\fR. The resource names -are the names of the axes (such as \f(CWx\fR or \f(CWx2\fR). -.CS -option add *Barchart.Axis.Color blue -option add *Barchart.x.LogScale true -option add *Barchart.x2.LogScale false -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBcreate \fIaxisName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new axis by the name \fIaxisName\fR. No axis by the same -name can already exist. \fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR are described -in above in the axis \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBdelete \fR?\fIaxisName\fR?... -Deletes the named axes. An axis is not really -deleted until it is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete -axes mapped to elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis invtransform \fIaxisName value\fR -Performs the inverse transformation, changing the screen-coordinate -\fIvalue\fR to a graph-coordinate, mapping the value mapped to -\fIaxisName\fR. Returns the graph-coordinate. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis limits \fIaxisName\fR -Returns a list of the minimum and maximum limits for \fIaxisName\fR. The order -of the list is \f(CWmin max\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns a list of axes matching zero or more patterns. If no -\fIpattern\fR argument is give, the names of all axes are returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis transform \fIaxisName value\fR -Transforms the coordinate \fIvalue\fR to a screen-coordinate by mapping -the it to \fIaxisName\fR. Returns the transformed screen-coordinate. -.PP -Only four axes can be displayed simultaneously. By default, they are -\f(CWx\fR, \f(CWy\fR, \f(CWx2\fR, and \f(CWy2\fR. You can swap in a different -axis with \fBuse\fR operation of the special axis components: -\fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR. -.CS -\&.g create axis temp -\&.g create axis time -\&... -\&.g xaxis use temp -\&.g yaxis use time -.CE -Only the axes specified for use are displayed on the screen. -.PP -The \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR -components operate on an axis location rather than a specific axis -like the more general \fBaxis\fR component does. The \fBxaxis\fR -component manages the X-axis located in the bottom margin (whatever -axis that happens to be). Likewise, \fByaxis\fR uses the Y-axis in -the left margin, \fBx2axis\fR the top X-axis, and \fBy2axis\fR the -right Y-axis. -.PP -They implicitly control the axis that is currently using to that -location. By default, \fBxaxis\fR uses the \f(CWx\fR axis, \fByaxis\fR -uses \f(CWy\fR, \fBx2axis\fR uses \f(CWx2\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR uses -\f(CWy2\fR. These components can be more convenient to use than always -determining what axes are current being displayed by the graph. -.PP -The following operations are available for axes. They mirror exactly -the operations of the \fBaxis\fR component. The \fIaxis\fR argument -must be \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, or \fBy2axis\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBcget \fIoption\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBconfigure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB invtransform \fIvalue\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBlimits\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB transform \fIvalue\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB use \fR?\fIaxisName\fR? -Designates the axis \fIaxisName\fR is to be displayed at this -location. \fIAxisName\fR can not be already in use at another location. -This command returns the name of the axis currently using this location. -.SS "CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT" -Cross hairs consist of two intersecting lines (one vertical and one horizontal) -drawn completely across the plotting area. They are used to position -the mouse in relation to the coordinate axes. Cross hairs differ from line -markers in that they are implemented using XOR drawing primitives. -This means that they can be quickly drawn and erased without redrawing -the entire widget. -.PP -The following operations are available for cross hairs: -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the cross hairs configuration option -given by \fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option -described below for the cross hairs \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of the cross hairs. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing all the current -options for the cross hairs is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the cross hairs option \fIoption\fR is set to -\fIvalue\fR. -The following options are available for cross hairs. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the cross hairs. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the cross hairs. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up -to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes -and gaps on the cross hair lines. Each number must be between 1 and -255. If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the cross hairs will be solid -lines. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether cross hairs are drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is true, -cross hairs are not drawn. The default is \f(CWyes\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Set the width of the cross hair lines. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-position \fIpos\fR -Specifies the screen position where the cross hairs intersect. -\fIPos\fR must be in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", where \fIx\fR and \fIy\fR -are the window coordinates of the intersection. -.PP -Cross hairs configuration options may be also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are -\f(CWcrosshairs\fR and \f(CWCrosshairs\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Barchart.Crosshairs.LineWidth 2 -option add *Barchart.Crosshairs.Color red -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs off\fR -Turns off the cross hairs. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs on\fR -Turns on the display of the cross hairs. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs toggle\fR -Toggles the current state of the cross hairs, alternately mapping and -unmapping the cross hairs. -.SH "ELEMENTS" -A data element represents a set of data. It contains x and y vectors -which are the coordinates of the data points. Elements are displayed -as bars where the length of the bar is proportional to the ordinate of -the data point. Elements also control the appearance of the data, -such as the color, stipple, relief, etc. -.PP -When new data elements are created, they are automatically added to a -list of displayed elements. The display list controls what elements -are drawn and in what order. -.PP -The following operations are available for elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement activate \fIelemName \fR?\fIindex\fR?... -Specifies the data points of element \fIelemName\fR to be drawn -using active foreground and background colors. \fIElemName\fR is the -name of the element and \fIindex\fR is a number representing the index -of the data point. If no indices are present then all data points -become active. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for an element with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on graph elements, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement cget \fIelemName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the element configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any of the options described below -for the element \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement closest \fIx y\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... ?\fIelemName\fR?... -Finds the data point representing the bar closest to the window -coordinates \fIx\fR and \fIy\fR in the element \fIelemName\fR. -\fIElemName\fR is the name of an element, which must be currently displayed. -If no elements are specified, then all displayed elements are searched. It -returns a key-value list containing the name of the closest element, -the index of its closest point, and the graph-coordinates of the -point. If no data point within the threshold distance can be found, -\f(CW""\fR is returned. The following \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs -are available. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-halo \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a threshold distance where selected data points are ignored. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -If this option isn't specified, then it defaults to the value of the -\fBbarchart\fR's \fB\-halo\fR option. -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement configure \fIelemName \fR?\fIelemName\fR... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for elements. Several -elements can be modified at the same time. If \fIoption\fR isn't -specified, a list describing all the current options for -\fIelemName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, but not -\fIvalue\fR, then a list describing the option \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the element option \fIoption\fR is set -to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for elements. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-activepen \fIpenName\fR -Specifies pen to use to draw active element. If \fIpenName\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, no active elements will be drawn. The default is -\f(CWactiveLine\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for the element. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events for elements. Each tag in the list matching the current event -sequence will have its Tcl command executed. Implicitly the name of -the element is always the first tag in the list. The default value is -\f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the the color of the border around each bar. The default is -\f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-barwidth \fIvalue\fR -Specifies the width the bars drawn for the element. \fIValue\fR is -the width in X-coordinates. If this option isn't -specified, the width of each bar is the value of the widget's -\fB\-barwidth\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-baseline \fIvalue\fR -Specifies the baseline of the bar segments. This affects how bars are -drawn since bars are drawn from their respective y-coordinate the -baseline. By default the baseline is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the border width of the 3-D border drawn around the outside of -each bar. The \fB\-relief\fR option determines if such a border is -drawn. \fIPixels\fR must be a valid screen distance like \f(CW2\fR or -\f(CW0.25i\fR. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-data \fIcoordList\fR -Specifies the X\-Y coordinates of the data. \fICoordList\fR is a -list of numeric expressions representing the X\-Y coordinate pairs -of each data point. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the interior of the bars. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the element is displayed. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-label \fItext\fR -Sets the element's label in the legend. If \fItext\fR -is \f(CW""\fR, the element will have no entry in the legend. -The default label is the element's name. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Selects the X\-axis to map the element's X\-coordinates onto. -\fIXAxis\fR must be the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWx\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Selects the Y\-axis to map the element's Y\-coordinates onto. -\fIYAxis\fR must be the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIstring\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect desired for bars. \fIRelief\fR indicates how -the interior of the bar should appear relative to the surface of the -chart; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the bar should appear to -protrude from the surface of the plotting area. The default is -\f(CWraised\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies a stipple pattern with which to draw the bars. If -\fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the bar is drawn in a solid fashion. -.TP -\fB\-xdata \fIxVector\fR -Specifies the x-coordinate vector of the data. -\fIXVector\fR is the name of a BLT vector or a -list of numeric expressions. -.TP -\fB\-ydata \fIyVector\fR -Specifies the y-coordinate vector of the data. -\fIYVector\fR is the name of a BLT vector or a list of -numeric expressions. -.PP -Element configuration options may also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource names in the option database -are prefixed by \f(CWelem\fR. -.CS -option add *Barchart.Element.background blue -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement create \fIelemName\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new element \fIelemName\fR. Element -names must be unique, so an element \fIelemName\fR may not already -exist. If additional arguments are present, they specify any of the -element options valid for element \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement deactivate \fIpattern\fR... -Deactivates all the elements matching \fIpattern\fR for the graph. -Elements whose names match any of the patterns given are redrawn -using their normal colors. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement delete\fR ?\fIpattern\fR?... -Deletes all the elements matching \fIpattern\fR for the graph. -Elements whose names match any of the patterns given are deleted. -The graph will be redrawn without the deleted elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement exists \fIelemName\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR if an element \fIelemName\fR currently exists and -\f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns the elements matching one or more pattern. If no -\fIpattern\fR is given, the names of all elements is returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement show\fR ?\fInameList\fR? -Queries or modifies the element display list. The element display -list designates the elements drawn and in what -order. \fINameList\fR is a list of elements to be displayed in the -order they are named. If there is no \fInameList\fR argument, -the current display list is returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement type\fR \fIelemName\fR -Returns the type of \fIelemName\fR. -If the element is a bar element, the commands returns the string -\f(CW"bar"\fR, otherwise it returns \f(CW"line"\fR. -.CE -.SS "GRID COMPONENT" -Grid lines extend from the major and minor ticks of each axis -horizontally or vertically across the plotting area. The following -operations are available for grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the grid line configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the grid \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid configure\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for grid lines. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing all the current -grid options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the grid line option \fIoption\fR is set to -\fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for grid lines. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the grid lines. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the grid lines. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up -to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes -and gaps on the grid lines. Each number must be between 1 and 255. -If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the grid will be solid lines. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the grid should be drawn. If \fIboolean\fR -is true, grid lines are not shown. The default is \f(CWyes\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of grid lines. The default width is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Specifies the X\-axis to display grid lines. \fIXAxis\fR -must be the name of an axis or \f(CW""\fR for no grid lines. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Specifies the Y\-axis to display grid lines. \fIYAxis\fR -must be the name of an axis or \f(CW""\fR for no grid lines. -The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-minor \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the grid lines should be drawn for minor ticks. -If \fIboolean\fR is true, the lines will appear at -minor tick intervals. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.PP -Grid configuration options may also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are \f(CWgrid\fR and -\f(CWGrid\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Barchart.grid.LineWidth 2 -option add *Barchart.Grid.Color black -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid off\fR -Turns off the display the grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid on\fR -Turns on the display the grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid toggle\fR -Toggles the display of the grid. -.SS "LEGEND COMPONENT" -The legend displays a list of the data elements. Each entry consists -of the element's symbol and label. The legend can appear in any -margin (the default location is in the right margin). It -can also be positioned anywhere within the plotting area. -.PP -The following operations are valid for the legend. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend activate \fIpattern\fR... -Selects legend entries to be drawn using the active legend colors and relief. -All entries whose element names match \fIpattern\fR are selected. To -be selected, the element name must match only one \fIpattern\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for a legend entry with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. Implicitly the element names -in the entry are tags. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on legend entries, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of a legend configuration option. -\fIOption\fR may be any option described below in the -legend \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for the legend. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -legend options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is -specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the legend option \fIoption\fR is set -to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for the legend. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-activebackground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color for active legend entries. All legend -entries marked active (see the legend \fBactivate\fR operation) are -drawn using this background color. -.TP -\fB\-activeborderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge of the active legend -entries. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-activeforeground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color for active legend entries. All legend -entries marked as active (see the legend \fBactivate\fR operation) are -drawn using this foreground color. -.TP -\fB\-activerelief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect desired for active legend entries. -\fIRelief\fR denotes how the interior of the entry should appear -relative to the legend; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the entry -should appear to protrude from the legend, relative to the surface of -the legend. The default is \f(CWflat\fR. -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -Tells how to position the legend relative to the positioning point for -the legend. This is dependent on the value of the \fB\-position\fR -option. The default is \f(CWcenter\fR. -.RS -.TP 1.25i -\f(CWleft\fR or \f(CWright\fR -The anchor describes how to position the legend vertically. -.TP -\f(CWtop\fR or \f(CWbottom\fR -The anchor describes how to position the legend horizontally. -.TP -\f(CW@x,y\fR -The anchor specifies how to position the legend relative to the -positioning point. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWcenter\fR then -the legend is centered on the point; if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then -the legend will be drawn such that the top center point of the -rectangular region occupied by the legend will be at the positioning -point. -.TP -\f(CWplotarea\fR -The anchor specifies how to position the legend relative to the -plotting area. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWcenter\fR then the -legend is centered in the plotting area; if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWne\fR -then the legend will be drawn such that occupies the upper right -corner of the plotting area. -.RE -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the legend. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the legend background with be transparent. -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for legend entries. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events for legend entries. Each tag in the list matching the current -event sequence will have its Tcl command executed. The default value -is \f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge of the legend (if -such border is being drawn; the \fBrelief\fR option determines this). -The default is \f(CW2\fR pixels. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -\fIFontName\fR specifies a font to use when drawing the labels of each -element into the legend. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-12-120-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the text drawn for the element's label. -The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the legend should be displayed. If \fIboolean\fR is -true, the legend will not be draw. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-ipadx \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of internal padding to be added to the width of each -legend entry. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If -\fIpad\fR has two elements, the left side of the legend entry is -padded by the first distance and the right side by the second. If -\fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the left and right sides are padded -evenly. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-ipady \fIpad\fR -Sets an amount of internal padding to be added to the height of each -legend entry. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If -\fIpad\fR has two elements, the top of the entry is padded by the -first distance and the bottom by the second. If \fIpad\fR is just -one distance, both the top and bottom of the entry are padded evenly. -The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors of the legend. -\fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR -has two elements, the left side of the legend is padded by the first -distance and the right side by the second. If \fIpad\fR has just one -distance, both the left and right sides are padded evenly. The -default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding above and below the legend. \fIPad\fR can be a list -of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the area above -the legend is padded by the first distance and the area below by the -second. If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and -bottom areas are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-position \fIpos\fR -Specifies where the legend is drawn. The -\fB\-anchor\fR option also affects where the legend is positioned. If -\fIpos\fR is \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWtop\fR, or \f(CWbottom\fR, the -legend is drawn in the specified margin. If \fIpos\fR is -\f(CWplotarea\fR, then the legend is drawn inside the plotting area at a -particular anchor. If \fIpos\fR is in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", where -\fIx\fR and \fIy\fR are the window coordinates, the legend is drawn in -the plotting area at the specified coordinates. The default is -\f(CWright\fR. -.TP -\fB\-raised \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the legend is above or below the data elements. This -matters only if the legend is in the plotting area. If \fIboolean\fR -is true, the legend will be drawn on top of any elements that may -overlap it. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the border around the legend. -\fIRelief\fR specifies how the interior of the legend should appear -relative to the bar chart; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the legend -should appear to protrude from the bar chart, relative to the surface of -the bar chart. The default is \f(CWsunken\fR. -.PP -Legend configuration options may also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource name and class are \f(CWlegend\fR and -\f(CWLegend\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Barchart.legend.Foreground blue -option add *Barchart.Legend.Relief raised -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend deactivate \fIpattern\fR... -Selects legend entries to be drawn using the normal legend colors and -relief. All entries whose element names match \fIpattern\fR are -selected. To be selected, the element name must match only one -\fIpattern\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend get \fIpos\fR -Returns the name of the element whose entry is at the screen position -\fIpos\fR in the legend. \fIPos\fR must be in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", -where \fIx\fR and \fIy\fR are window coordinates. If the given -coordinates do not lie over a legend entry, \f(CW""\fR is returned. -.SS "PEN COMPONENTS" -Pens define attributes for elements. -Pens mirror the configuration options of data elements that pertain to -how symbols and lines are drawn. Data elements use pens to determine -how they are drawn. A data element may use several pens at once. In -this case, the pen used for a particular data point is determined from -each element's weight vector (see the element's \fB\-weight\fR and -\fB\-style\fR options). -.PP -One pen, called \f(CWactiveBar\fR, is automatically created. -It's used as the default active pen for elements. So you can change -the active attributes for all elements by simply reconfiguring this -pen. -.CS -\&.g pen configure "activeBar" -fg green -bg green4 -.CE -You can create and use several pens. To create a pen, invoke -the pen component and its create operation. -.CS -\&.g pen create myPen -.CE -You map pens to a data element using either the element's -\fB\-pen\fR or \fB\-activepen\fR options. -.CS -\&.g element create "e1" -xdata $x -ydata $tempData \\ - -pen myPen -.CE -An element can use several pens at once. This is done by specifying -the name of the pen in the element's style list (see the -\fB\-styles\fR option). -.CS -\&.g element configure "e1" -styles { myPen 2.0 3.0 } -.CE -This says that any data point with a weight between 2.0 and 3.0 -is to be drawn using the pen \f(CWmyPen\fR. All other points -are drawn with the element's default attributes. -.PP -The following operations are available for pen components. -.PP -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBcget \fIpenName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the option given by \fIoption\fR for -\fIpenName\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the pen \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBconfigure \fIpenName \fR?\fIpenName\fR... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of -\fIpenName\fR. Several pens can be modified at once. If \fIoption\fR -isn't specified, a list describing the current options for -\fIpenName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, but not -\fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. If one -or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then for -each pair, the pen option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. The -following options are valid for pens. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the the color of the border around each bar. The default is -\f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the border width of the 3-D border drawn around the outside of -each bar. The \fB\-relief\fR option determines if such a border is -drawn. \fIPixels\fR must be a valid screen distance like \f(CW2\fR or -\f(CW0.25i\fR. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the interior of the bars. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIstring\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect desired for bars. \fIRelief\fR indicates how -the interior of the bar should appear relative to the surface of the -chart; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the bar should appear to -protrude from the bar chart, relative to the surface of the plotting -area. The default is \f(CWraised\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies a stipple pattern with which to draw the bars. If -\fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the bar is drawn in a solid fashion. -.TP -\fB\-type \fIelemType\fR -Specifies the type of element the pen is to be used with. -This option should only be employed when creating the pen. This -is for those that wish to mix different types of elements (bars and -lines) on the same graph. The default type is "bar". -.PP -Pen configuration options may be also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource class is \f(CWPen\fR. The resource names -are the names of the pens. -.CS -option add *Barchart.Pen.Foreground blue -option add *Barchart.activeBar.foreground green -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBcreate \fIpenName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new pen by the name \fIpenName\fR. No pen by the same -name can already exist. \fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR are described -in above in the pen \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBdelete \fR?\fIpenName\fR?... -Deletes the named pens. A pen is not really -deleted until it is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete -pens mapped to elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns a list of pens matching zero or more patterns. If no -\fIpattern\fR argument is give, the names of all pens are returned. -.SS "POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT" -The barchart can generate encapsulated PostScript output. There -are several configuration options you can specify to control how the -plot will be generated. You can change the page dimensions and -borders. The plot itself can be scaled, centered, or rotated to -landscape. The PostScript output can be written directly to a file or -returned through the interpreter. -.PP -The following postscript operations are available. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the postscript option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below for the postscript \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for PostScript -generation. If \fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing -the current postscript options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If -\fIoption\fR is specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing -\fIoption\fR is returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are specified, then for each pair, the postscript option -\fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. The following postscript options -are available. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-center \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the plot should be centered on the PostScript page. If -\fIboolean\fR is false, the plot will be placed in the upper left -corner of the page. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-colormap \fIvarName\fR -\fIVarName\fR must be the name of a global array variable that -specifies a color mapping from the X color name to PostScript. Each -element of \fIvarName\fR must consist of PostScript code to set a -particular color value (e.g. ``\f(CW1.0 1.0 0.0 setrgbcolor\fR''). When -generating color information in PostScript, the array variable \fIvarName\fR -is checked if an element of the name as the color exists. If so, it uses -its value as the PostScript -command to set the color. If this option hasn't been specified, or if -there isn't an entry in \fIvarName\fR for a given color, then it uses -the red, green, and blue intensities from the X color. -.TP -\fB\-colormode \fImode\fR -Specifies how to output color information. \fIMode\fR must be either -\f(CWcolor\fR (for full color output), \f(CWgray\fR (convert all colors to -their gray-scale equivalents) or \f(CWmono\fR (convert foreground colors -to black and background colors to white). The default mode is -\f(CWcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fontmap \fIvarName\fR -\fIVarName\fR must be the name of a global array variable that -specifies a font mapping from the X font name to PostScript. Each -element of \fIvarName\fR must consist of a Tcl list with one or two -elements; the name and point size of a PostScript font. -When outputting PostScript commands for a particular font, the array -variable \fIvarName\fR is checked to see if an element by the -specified font exists. If there is such an element, then the font -information contained in that element is used in the PostScript -output. (If the point size is omitted from the list, the point size -of the X font is used). Otherwise the X font is examined in an -attempt to guess what PostScript font to use. This works only for -fonts whose foundry property is \fIAdobe\fR (such as Times, Helvetica, -Courier, etc.). If all of this fails then the font defaults to -\f(CWHelvetica-Bold\fR. -.TP -\fB\-decorations \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether PostScript commands to generate color backgrounds and 3-D -borders will be output. If \fIboolean\fR is false, the graph will -background will be white and no 3-D borders will be generated. The -default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Sets the height of the plot. This lets you print the bar chart with a -height different from the one drawn on the screen. If -\fIpixels\fR is 0, the height is the same as the widget's height. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-landscape \fIboolean\fR -If \fIboolean\fR is true, this specifies the printed area is to be -rotated 90 degrees. In non-rotated output the X\-axis of the printed -area runs along the short dimension of the page (``portrait'' -orientation); in rotated output the X\-axis runs along the long -dimension of the page (``landscape'' orientation). Defaults to -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-maxpect \fIboolean\fR -Indicates to scale the plot so that it fills the PostScript page. -The aspect ratio of the barchart is still retained. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the horizontal padding for the left and right page borders. The -borders are exterior to the plot. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or -two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the left border is padded -by the first distance and the right border by the second. If -\fIpad\fR has just one distance, both the left and right borders are -padded evenly. The default is \f(CW1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the vertical padding for the top and bottom page borders. The -borders are exterior to the plot. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or -two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the top border is padded -by the first distance and the bottom border by the second. If -\fIpad\fR has just one distance, both the top and bottom borders are -padded evenly. The default is \f(CW1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-paperheight \fIpixels\fR -Sets the height of the postscript page. This can be used to select -between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc). The default height is -\f(CW11.0i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-paperwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the postscript page. This can be used to select -between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc). The default width is -\f(CW8.5i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the plot. This lets you generate a plot -of a width different from that of the widget. If \fIpixels\fR -is 0, the width is the same as the widget's width. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.PP -Postscript configuration options may be also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are -\f(CWpostscript\fR and \f(CWPostscript\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Barchart.postscript.Decorations false -option add *Barchart.Postscript.Landscape true -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript output \fR?\fIfileName\fR? ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Outputs a file of encapsulated PostScript. If a -\fIfileName\fR argument isn't present, the command returns the -PostScript. If any \fIoption-value\fR pairs are present, they set -configuration options controlling how the PostScript is generated. -\fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR can be anything accepted by the -postscript \fBconfigure\fR operation above. -.SS "MARKER COMPONENTS" -Markers are simple drawing procedures used to annotate or highlight -areas of the graph. Markers have various types: text strings, -bitmaps, images, connected lines, windows, or polygons. They can be -associated with a particular element, so that when the element is -hidden or un-hidden, so is the marker. By default, markers are the -last items drawn, so that data elements will appear in -behind them. You can change this by configuring the \fB\-under\fR -option. -.PP -Markers, in contrast to elements, don't affect the scaling of the -coordinate axes. They can also have \fIelastic\fR coordinates -(specified by \f(CW-Inf\fR and \f(CWInf\fR respectively) that translate -into the minimum or maximum limit of the axis. For example, you can -place a marker so it always remains in the lower left corner of the -plotting area, by using the coordinates \f(CW-Inf\fR,\f(CW-Inf\fR. -.PP -The following operations are available for markers. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker after \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIafterId\fR? -Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first -marker after the second. If no second \fIafterId\fR argument is -specified, the marker is placed at the end of the display list. This -command can be used to control how markers are displayed since markers -are drawn in the order of this display list. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker before \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIbeforeId\fR? -Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first -marker before the second. If no second \fIbeforeId\fR argument is -specified, the marker is placed at the beginning of the display list. -This command can be used to control how markers are displayed since -markers are drawn in the order of this display list. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for a marker with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on graph markers, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the marker configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below in the \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker configure \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for markers. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -options for \fImarkerId\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the marker option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. -.sp -The following options are valid for all markers. -Each type of marker also has its own type-specific options. -They are described in the sections below. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for the marker. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events for markers are handled. Each tag in the list matching the -current event sequence will have its Tcl command executed. Implicitly -the name of the marker is always the first tag in the list. -The default value is \f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-coords \fIcoordList\fR -Specifies the coordinates of the marker. \fICoordList\fR is -a list of graph-coordinates. The number of coordinates required -is dependent on the type of marker. Text, image, and window markers -need only two coordinates (an X\-Y coordinate). Bitmap markers -can take either two or four coordinates (if four, they represent the -corners of the bitmap). Line markers -need at least four coordinates, polygons at least six. -If \fIcoordList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker will not be displayed. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-element \fIelemName\fR -Links the marker with the element \fIelemName\fR. The marker is -drawn only if the element is also currently displayed (see the -element's \fBshow\fR operation). If \fIelemName\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the -marker is always drawn. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the marker is drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is true, -the marker is not drawn. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Specifies the X\-axis to map the marker's X\-coordinates onto. -\fIXAxis\fR must the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWx\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Specifies the Y\-axis to map the marker's Y\-coordinates onto. -\fIYAxis\fR must the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-name \fImarkerId\fR -Changes the identifier for the marker. The identifier \fImarkerId\fR -can not already be used by another marker. If this option -isn't specified, the marker's name is uniquely generated. -.TP -\fB\-under \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the marker is drawn below/above data -elements. If \fIboolean\fR is true, the marker is be drawn -underneath the data elements. Otherwise, the marker is -drawn on top of the element. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-xoffset \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a screen distance to offset the marker horizontally. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-yoffset \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a screen distance to offset the markers vertically. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.PP -Marker configuration options may also be set by the \fBoption\fR command. -The resource class is either \f(CWBitmapMarker\fR, \f(CWImageMarker\fR, -\f(CWLineMarker\fR, \f(CWPolygonMarker\fR, \f(CWTextMarker\fR, or \f(CWWindowMarker\fR, -depending on the type of marker. The resource name is the name of the -marker. -.CS -option add *Barchart.TextMarker.Foreground white -option add *Barchart.BitmapMarker.Foreground white -option add *Barchart.m1.Background blue -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker create \fItype\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a marker of the selected type. \fIType\fR may be either -\f(CWtext\fR, \f(CWline\fR, \f(CWbitmap\fR, \f(CWimage\fR, \f(CWpolygon\fR, or -\f(CWwindow\fR. This command returns the marker identifier, -used as the \fImarkerId\fR argument in the other marker-related -commands. If the \fB\-name\fR option is used, this overrides the -normal marker identifier. If the name provided is already used for -another marker, the new marker will replace the old. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker delete\fR ?\fIname\fR?... -Removes one of more markers. The graph will automatically be redrawn -without the marker.\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker exists \fImarkerId\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR if the marker \fImarkerId\fR exists and \f(CW0\fR -otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker names\fR ?\fIpattern\fR? -Returns the names of all the markers that currently exist. If -\fIpattern\fR is supplied, only those markers whose names match it -will be returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker type \fImarkerId\fR -Returns the type of the marker given by \fImarkerId\fR, such as -\f(CWline\fR or \f(CWtext\fR. If \fImarkerId\fR is not a valid a marker -identifier, \f(CW""\fR is returned. -.SS "BITMAP MARKERS" -A bitmap marker displays a bitmap. The size of the -bitmap is controlled by the number of coordinates specified. If two -coordinates, they specify the position of the top-left corner of the -bitmap. The bitmap retains its normal width and height. If four -coordinates, the first and second pairs of coordinates represent the -corners of the bitmap. The bitmap will be stretched or reduced as -necessary to fit into the bounding rectangle. -.PP -Bitmap markers are created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in -the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create bitmap \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs, each -sets a configuration options for the marker. These -same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be used with the marker's -\fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to bitmap markers: -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-fill\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-bitmap \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies the bitmap to be displayed. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the marker will not be displayed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the bitmap. If \fIcolor\fR is the empty -string, no background will be transparent. The default background color is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-outline\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-mask \fImask\fR -Specifies a mask for the bitmap to be displayed. This mask is a bitmap -itself, denoting the pixels that are transparent. If \fImask\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, all pixels of the bitmap will be drawn. The default is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the bitmap. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Sets the rotation of the bitmap. \fITheta\fR is a real number -representing the angle of rotation in degrees. The marker is first -rotated and then placed according to its anchor position. The default -rotation is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.SS "IMAGE MARKERS" -A image marker displays an image. Image markers are -created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create image \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to image markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the image relative to the -positioning point for the image. For example, if \fIanchor\fR -is \f(CWcenter\fR then the image is centered on the point; if -\fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then the image will be drawn such that -the top center point of the rectangular region occupied by the -image will be at the positioning point. -This option defaults to \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-image \fIimage\fR -Specifies the image to be drawn. -If \fIimage\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker will not be -drawn. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "LINE MARKERS" -A line marker displays one or more connected line segments. -Line markers are created with marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create line \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to line markers: -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the line. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up to 11 -numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes and gaps -on the line. Each number must be between 1 and 255. If -\fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker line will be solid. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the line. This color is used with -striped lines (see the \fB\-dashes\fR option). If \fIcolor\fR is -the empty string, no background color is drawn (the line will be -dashed, not striped). The default background color is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the lines. -The default width is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the line. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies a stipple pattern used to draw the line, rather than -a solid line. -\fIBitmap\fR specifies a bitmap to use as the stipple -pattern. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the -line is drawn in a solid fashion. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "POLYGON MARKERS" -A polygon marker displays a closed region described as two or more -connected line segments. It is assumed the first and -last points are connected. Polygon markers are created using the -marker \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create polygon \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the \fBmarker configure\fR command to change the marker's -configuration. -The following options are supported for polygon markers: -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the outline of the polygon. \fIDashList\fR is a -list of up to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of -the dashes and gaps on the outline. Each number must be between 1 and -255. If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the outline will be a solid line. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the fill color of the polygon. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then -the interior of the polygon is transparent. -The default is \f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the outline of the polygon. If \fIpixels\fR is zero, -no outline is drawn. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the outline of the polygon. If the polygon is -stippled (see the \fB\-stipple\fR option), then this represents the -foreground color of the stipple. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies that the polygon should be drawn with a stippled pattern -rather than a solid color. \fIBitmap\fR specifies a bitmap to use as -the stipple pattern. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the polygon is -filled with a solid color (if the \fB\-fill\fR option is set). The -default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "TEXT MARKERS" -A text marker displays a string of characters on one or more lines of -text. Embedded newlines cause line breaks. They may be used to -annotate regions of the graph. Text markers are created with the -\fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create text \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs, -each sets a configuration option for the text marker. -These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be used with the -marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to text markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the text relative to the -positioning point for the text. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is -\f(CWcenter\fR then the text is centered on the point; if -\fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then the text will be drawn such that the -top center point of the rectangular region occupied by the text will -be at the positioning point. This default is \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-fill\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font of the text. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-120-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the text. If \fIcolor\fR is the empty -string, no background will be transparent. The default background color is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-outline\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the text should be justified. This matters only when -the marker contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR must be -\f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the text. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors of the text. -\fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR -has two elements, the left side of the text is padded by the first -distance and the right side by the second. If \fIpad\fR has just one -distance, both the left and right sides are padded evenly. The -default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding above and below the text. \fIPad\fR can be a list of -one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the area above the -text is padded by the first distance and the area below by the second. -If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and bottom areas -are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Specifies the number of degrees to rotate the text. \fITheta\fR is a -real number representing the angle of rotation. The marker is first -rotated along its center and is then drawn according to its anchor -position. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-text \fItext\fR -Specifies the text of the marker. The exact way the text is -displayed may be affected by other options such as \fB\-anchor\fR or -\fB\-rotate\fR. -.SS "WINDOW MARKERS" -A window marker displays a widget at a given position. -Window markers are created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in -the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create window \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR command. -.PP -The following options are specific to window markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the widget relative to the -positioning point for the widget. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is -\f(CWcenter\fR then the widget is centered on the point; if \fIanchor\fR -is \f(CWn\fR then the widget will be displayed such that the top center -point of the rectangular region occupied by the widget will be at the -positioning point. This option defaults to \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the height to assign to the marker's window. If this option -isn't specified, or if it is specified as \f(CW""\fR, then the window is -given whatever height the widget requests internally. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the width to assign to the marker's window. If this option -isn't specified, or if it is specified as \f(CW""\fR, then the window is -given whatever width the widget requests internally. -.TP -\fB\-window \fIpathName\fR -Specifies the widget to be managed by the barchart. \fIPathName\fR must -be a child of the \fBbarchart\fR widget. -.SH "GRAPH COMPONENT BINDINGS" -Specific barchart components, such as elements, markers and legend -entries, can have a command trigger when event occurs in them, much -like canvas items in Tk's canvas widget. Not all event sequences are -valid. The only binding events that may be specified are those -related to the mouse and keyboard (such as \fBEnter\fR, \fBLeave\fR, -\fBButtonPress\fR, \fBMotion\fR, and \fBKeyPress\fR). -.PP -Only one element or marker can be picked during an event. This means, -that if the mouse is directly over both an element and a marker, only -the uppermost component is selected. This isn't true for legend entries. -Both a legend entry and an element (or marker) binding commands -will be invoked if both items are picked. -.PP -It is possible for multiple bindings to match a particular event. -This could occur, for example, if one binding is associated with the -element name and another is associated with one of the element's tags -(see the \fB\-bindtags\fR option). When this occurs, all of the -matching bindings are invoked. A binding associated with the element -name is invoked first, followed by one binding for each of the element's -bindtags. If there are multiple matching bindings for a single tag, -then only the most specific binding is invoked. A continue command -in a binding script terminates that script, and a break command -terminates that script and skips any remaining scripts for the event, -just as for the bind command. -.PP -The \fB\-bindtags\fR option for these components controls addition -tag names which can be matched. Implicitly elements and markers -always have tags matching their names. Setting the value of -the \fB\-bindtags\fR option doesn't change this. -.SH "C LANGUAGE API" -You can manipulate data elements from the C language. There -may be situations where it is too expensive to translate the data -values from ASCII strings. Or you might want to read data in a -special file format. -.PP -Data can manipulated from the C language using BLT vectors. -You specify the X-Y data coordinates of an element as vectors and -manipulate the vector from C. The barchart will be redrawn automatically -after the vectors are updated. -.PP -From Tcl, create the vectors and configure the element to use them. -.CS -vector X Y -\&.g element configure line1 -xdata X -ydata Y -.CE -To set data points from C, you pass the values as arrays of doubles -using the \fBBlt_ResetVector\fR call. The vector is reset with the -new data and at the next idle point (when Tk re-enters its event -loop), the graph will be redrawn automatically. -.CS -#include -#include - -register int i; -Blt_Vector *xVec, *yVec; -double x[50], y[50]; - -/* Get the BLT vectors "X" and "Y" (created above from Tcl) */ -if ((Blt_GetVector(interp, "X", 50, &xVec) != TCL_OK) || - (Blt_GetVector(interp, "Y", 50, &yVec) != TCL_OK)) { - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -for (i = 0; i < 50; i++) { - x[i] = i * 0.02; - y[i] = sin(x[i]); -} - -/* Put the data into BLT vectors */ -if ((Blt_ResetVector(xVec, x, 50, 50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK) || - (Blt_ResetVector(yVec, y, 50, 50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK)) { - return TCL_ERROR; -} -.CE -See the \fBvector\fR manual page for more details. -.SH SPEED TIPS -There may be cases where the bar chart needs to be drawn and updated as -quickly as possible. If drawing speed becomes a big -problem, here are a few tips to speed up displays. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Try to minimize the number of data points. The more data points -looked at, the more work the bar chart must do. -.TP 2 -\(bu -If your data is generated as floating point values, the time required -to convert the data values to and from ASCII strings can be -significant, especially when there any many data points. You can -avoid the redundant string-to-decimal conversions using the C API to -BLT vectors. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Don't stipple or dash the element. Solid bars are much faster. -.TP 2 -\(bu -If you update data elements frequently, try turning off the -widget's \fB\-bufferelements\fR option. When the bar chart is first -displayed, it draws data elements into an internal pixmap. The pixmap -acts as a cache, so that when the bar chart needs to be redrawn again, and -the data elements or coordinate axes haven't changed, the pixmap is -simply copied to the screen. This is especially useful when you are -using markers to highlight points and regions on the bar chart. But if -the bar chart is updated frequently, changing either the element data or -coordinate axes, the buffering becomes redundant. -.SH LIMITATIONS -Auto-scale routines do not use requested min/max limits -as boundaries when the axis is logarithmically scaled. -.PP -The PostScript output generated for polygons with more than 1500 -points may exceed the limits of some printers (See PostScript Language -Reference Manual, page 568). The work-around is to break the polygon -into separate pieces. -.SH KEYWORDS -bar chart, widget diff --git a/tkblt/doc/graph.html b/tkblt/doc/graph.html deleted file mode 100644 index 70f1e6f..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/graph.html +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1759 +0,0 @@ - - -
-
-
-
-

SYNOPSIS

-       graph pathName ?option value?...
-
-
-
-

DESCRIPTION

-       The  graph  command  creates  a graph for plotting two-dimensional data
-       (X-Y coordinates). It  has  many  configurable  components:  coordinate
-       axes,  elements,  legend, grid lines, cross hairs, etc.  They allow you
-       to customize the look and feel of the graph.
-
-
-
-

INTRODUCTION

-       The graph command creates a new  window  for  plotting  two-dimensional
-       data  (X-Y coordinates).  Data points are plotted in a rectangular area
-       displayed in the center of the new window.  This is the plotting  area.
-       The  coordinate axes are drawn in the margins around the plotting area.
-       By default, the legend is displayed in the right margin.  The title  is
-       displayed in top margin.
-
-       The  graph  widget  is composed of several components: coordinate axes,
-       data elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, pens, postscript, and annota-
-       tion markers.
-
-       axis      The  graph has four standard axes (x, x2, y, and y2), but you
-                 can create and display any number of axes.  Axes control what
-                 region  of data is displayed and how the data is scaled. Each
-                 axis consists of the axis line, title, major and minor ticks,
-                 and tick labels.  Tick labels display the value at each major
-                 tick.
-
-       crosshairs
-                 Cross hairs are used to position the mouse  pointer  relative
-                 to  the  X  and  Y  coordinate axes. Two perpendicular lines,
-                 intersecting at the current location  of  the  mouse,  extend
-                 across the plotting area to the coordinate axes.
-
-       element   An  element  represents a set of data points. Elements can be
-                 plotted with a symbol at each data point and lines connecting
-                 the  points.  The appearance of the element, such as its sym-
-                 bol, line width, and color is configurable.
-
-       grid      Extends the major and minor ticks of the X-axis and/or Y-axis
-                 across the plotting area.
-
-       legend    The legend displays the name and symbol of each data element.
-                 The legend can be drawn in any  margin  or  in  the  plotting
-                 area.
-
-       marker    Markers  are  used  annotate or highlight areas of the graph.
-                 For example, you could use a polygon marker to fill  an  area
-                 under  a  curve,  or a text marker to label a particular data
-                 point. Markers come in various forms: text strings,  bitmaps,
-                 connected  line  segments, images, polygons, or embedded wid-
-                 gets.
-
-       graph  pathName ?option value?...  The graph command creates a new win-
-       dow pathName and makes it into a graph widget.  At the time  this  com-
-       mand  is  invoked,  there  must  not exist a window named pathName, but
-       pathName's parent must exist.  Additional options may be  specified  on
-       the  command line or in the option database to configure aspects of the
-       graph such as its colors and font.  See the configure  operation  below
-       for the exact details about what option and value pairs are valid.
-
-       If successful, graph returns the path name of the widget.  It also cre-
-       ates a new Tcl command by the same name.  You can use this  command  to
-       invoke  various operations that query or modify the graph.  The general
-       form is: pathName operation ?arg?...  Both operation and its  arguments
-       determine  the exact behavior of the command.  The operations available
-       for the graph are described in the GRAPH OPERATIONS section.
-
-       The command can also be used to access components of the graph.   path-
-       Name component operation ?arg?...  The operation, now located after the
-       name of the component, is the function to be performed on  that  compo-
-       nent. Each component has its own set of operations that manipulate that
-       component.  They will be described below in their own sections.
-
-
-
-

EXAMPLE

-       The graph command creates a new graph.  # Create a new graph.  Plotting
-       area  is black.  graph .g -plotbackground black A new Tcl command .g is
-       also created.  This command can be used to query and modify the  graph.
-       For example, to change the title of the graph to "My Plot", you use the
-       new command and the graph's configure operation.  # Change  the  title.
-       .g configure -title "My Plot" A graph has several components. To access
-       a particular component you use the component's name.  For  example,  to
-       add  data  elements, you use the new command and the element component.
-       # Create a  new  element  named  "line1"  .g  element  create  line1  \
-            -xdata { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 } \      -ydata {
-       26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47  143.14            155.85  166.60
-       175.38  }  The  element's  X-Y coordinates are specified using lists of
-       numbers.  Alternately, BLT vectors could be used to hold the X-Y  coor-
-       dinates.   # Create two vectors and add them to the graph.  vector xVec
-       yVec xVec set { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 }  yVec  set  {
-       26.18  50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 155.85      166.60 175.38
-       } .g element create line1 -xdata xVec  -ydata  yVec  The  advantage  of
-       using  vectors  is that when you modify one, the graph is automatically
-       redrawn to reflect the new values.  # Change the y  coordinate  of  the
-       first  point.   set yVector(0) 25.18 An element named e1 is now created
-       in .b.  It is automatically added to the display list of elements.  You
-       can  use this list to control in what order elements are displayed.  To
-       query or reset the element display list, you  use  the  element's  show
-       operation.   #  Get  the  current display list set elemList [.b element
-       show] # Remove the first element so it won't be displayed.  .b  element
-       show  [lrange $elemList 0 end] The element will be displayed by as many
-       bars as there are data points (in this case there are ten).   The  bars
-       will  be drawn centered at the x-coordinate of the data point.  All the
-       bars will have the same attributes (colors, stipple, etc).   The  width
-       of each bar is by default one unit.  You can change this with using the
-       example, you change the scale of the Y-axis from linear  to  log  using
-       the  axis  component.   #  Y-axis  is  log  scale.  .g axis configure y
-       -logscale yes One important way axes are used is to zoom in on  a  par-
-       ticular  data  region.   Zooming  is done by simply specifying new axis
-       limits using the -min and -max configuration options.  .g axis  config-
-       ure  x  -min  1.0  -max 1.5 .g axis configure y -min 12.0 -max 55.15 To
-       zoom interactively, you link the axis configure  operations  with  some
-       user  interaction  (such  as pressing the mouse button), using the bind
-       command.  To convert between screen  and  graph  coordinates,  use  the
-       invtransform  operation.   # Click the button to set a new minimum bind
-       .g <ButtonPress-1> {
-           %W axis configure x -min [%W axis invtransform x %x]
-           %W axis configure x -min [%W axis invtransform x %y] } By  default,
-       the  limits of the axis are determined from data values.  To reset back
-       to the default limits, set the -min  and  -max  options  to  the  empty
-       value.   # Reset the axes to autoscale again.  .g axis configure x -min
-       {} -max {} .g axis configure y -min {} -max {} By default,  the  legend
-       is  drawn  in the right margin.  You can change this or any legend con-
-       figuration options using the legend component.  # Configure the  legend
-       font,  color,  and  relief  .g  legend configure -position left -relief
-       raised \      -font fixed -fg blue To prevent  the  legend  from  being
-       displayed,  turn  on the -hide option.  # Don't display the legend.  .g
-       legend configure -hide yes The graph widget has simple  drawing  proce-
-       dures  called  markers.  They can be used to highlight or annotate data
-       in the graph. The types of markers available are bitmaps, images, poly-
-       gons,  lines, or windows.  Markers can be used, for example, to mark or
-       brush points.  In this example, is a text marker that labels  the  data
-       first point.  Markers are created using the marker component.  # Create
-       a label for the first data point of "line1".   .g  marker  create  text
-       -name  first_marker  -coords { 0.2 26.18 } \      -text "start" -anchor
-       se  -xoffset  -10  -yoffset  -10  This  creates  a  text  marker  named
-       first_marker.  It will display the text "start" near the coordinates of
-       the first data point.  The -anchor, -xoffset, and -yoffset options  are
-       used  to display the marker above and to the left of the data point, so
-       that the data point isn't covered by the marker.  By  default,  markers
-       are  drawn  last,  on top of data.  You can change this with the -under
-       option.  # Draw the label before elements are drawn.  .g marker config-
-       ure first_marker -under yes You can add cross hairs or grid lines using
-       the crosshairs and grid components.  # Display  both  cross  hairs  and
-       grid  lines.   .g crosshairs configure -hide no -color red .g grid con-
-       figure -hide no -dashes { 2 2 } # Set up a binding  to  reposition  the
-       crosshairs.  bind .g <Motion> {
-           .g crosshairs configure -position @%x,%y } The crosshairs are repo-
-       sitioned as the mouse pointer is moved in the graph.  The  pointer  X-Y
-       coordinates define the center of the crosshairs.
-
-       Finally, to get hardcopy of the graph, use the postscript component.  #
-       Print the graph into file "file.ps" .g postscript output file.ps  -max-
-       pect  yes  -decorations no This generates a file file.ps containing the
-       encapsulated PostScript of the graph.   The  option  -maxpect  says  to
-       scale  the  plot to the size of the page.  Turning off the -decorations
-       option denotes that no borders or color  backgrounds  should  be  drawn
-              option.   Option  may be any option described below for the con-
-              figure operation.
-
-       pathName configure ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies the configuration options of the graph.   If
-              option  isn't  specified,  a list describing the current options
-              for pathName is returned.   If  option  is  specified,  but  not
-              value,  then  a  list  describing option is returned.  If one or
-              more option and value pairs are specified, then for  each  pair,
-              the  option  option  is set to value.  The following options are
-              valid.
-
-              -aspect width/height
-                     Force a fixed aspect ratio of  width/height,  a  floating
-                     point number.
-
-              -background color
-                     Sets  the background color. This includes the margins and
-                     legend, but not the plotting area.
-
-              -borderwidth pixels
-                     Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside  edge
-                     of the widget.  The -relief option determines if the bor-
-                     der is to be drawn.  The default is 2.
-
-              -bottommargin pixels
-                     If non-zero, overrides the computed size  of  the  margin
-                     extending  below  the X-coordinate axis.  If pixels is 0,
-                     the automatically computed size is used.  The default  is
-                     0.
-
-              -bufferelements boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  an internal pixmap to buffer the dis-
-                     play of data elements should  be  used.   If  boolean  is
-                     true,  data  elements  are  drawn  to an internal pixmap.
-                     This option  is  especially  useful  when  the  graph  is
-                     redrawn  frequently while the remains data unchanged (for
-                     example, moving a marker across the plot).  See the SPEED
-                     TIPS section.  The default is 1.
-
-              -cursor cursor
-                     Specifies  the  widget's  cursor.   The default cursor is
-                     crosshair.
-
-              -font fontName
-                     Specifies the font of the graph  title.  The  default  is
-                     *-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-18-180-*.
-
-              -halo pixels
-                     Specifies  a  maximum distance to consider when searching
-                     for the closest data point  (see  the  element's  closest
-                     operation  below).   Data points further than pixels away
-                     text.  Justify  must  be  left,  right,  or  center.  The
-                     default is center.
-
-              -leftmargin pixels
-                     If non-zero, overrides the computed size  of  the  margin
-                     extending from the left edge of the window to the Y-coor-
-                     dinate axis.  If pixels is 0, the automatically  computed
-                     size is used.  The default is 0.
-
-              -plotbackground color
-                     Specifies the background color of the plotting area.  The
-                     default is white.
-
-              -plotborderwidth pixels
-                     Sets the width of the  3-D  border  around  the  plotting
-                     area.   The  -plotrelief option determines if a border is
-                     drawn.  The default is 2.
-
-              -plotpadx pad
-                     Sets the amount of padding to be added to  the  left  and
-                     right  sides  of the plotting area.  Pad can be a list of
-                     one or two screen distances.  If pad  has  two  elements,
-                     the left side of the plotting area entry is padded by the
-                     first distance and the right side by the second.  If  pad
-                     is  just  one distance, both the left and right sides are
-                     padded evenly.  The default is 8.
-
-              -plotpady pad
-                     Sets the amount of padding to be added  to  the  top  and
-                     bottom of the plotting area.  Pad can be a list of one or
-                     two screen distances.  If pad has two elements,  the  top
-                     of  the plotting area is padded by the first distance and
-                     the bottom by the second.  If pad is just  one  distance,
-                     both  the  top and bottom are padded evenly.  The default
-                     is 8.
-
-              -plotrelief relief
-                     Specifies the 3-D effect for the plotting  area.   Relief
-                     specifies  how  the  interior of the plotting area should
-                     appear relative to rest of the graph; for example, raised
-                     means  the plot should appear to protrude from the graph,
-                     relative to the surface of the  graph.   The  default  is
-                     sunken.
-
-              -relief relief
-                     Specifies  the  3-D  effect for the graph widget.  Relief
-                     specifies how the graph should appear relative to  widget
-                     it  is  packed  into; for example, raised means the graph
-                     should appear to protrude.  The default is flat.
-
-              -rightmargin pixels
-                     If non-zero, overrides the computed size  of  the  margin
-
-              -tile image
-                     Specifies  a  tiled  background for the widget.  If image
-                     isn't "", the background is tiled  using  image.   Other-
-                     wise,  the  normal  background  color  is  drawn (see the
-                     -background option).  Image  must  be  an  image  created
-                     using the Tk image command.  The default is "".
-
-              -title text
-                     Sets  the  title to text. If text is "", no title will be
-                     displayed.
-
-              -topmargin pixels
-                     If non-zero, overrides the computed size  of  the  margin
-                     above  the  x2  axis.   If pixels is 0, the automatically
-                     computed size is used.  The default is 0.
-
-              -width pixels
-                     Specifies the requested width of the widget.  The default
-                     is 5i.
-
-       pathName crosshairs operation ?arg?
-              See the CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName element operation ?arg?...
-              See the ELEMENT COMPONENTS section.
-
-       pathName extents item
-              Returns  the  size of a particular item in the graph.  Item must
-              be  either  leftmargin,  rightmargin,  topmargin,  bottommargin,
-              plotwidth, or plotheight.
-
-       pathName grid operation ?arg?...
-              See the GRID COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName invtransform winX winY
-              Performs  an  inverse  coordinate transformation, mapping window
-              coordinates back to graph coordinates, using the standard X-axis
-              and  Y-axis.  Returns a list of containing the X-Y graph coordi-
-              nates.
-
-       pathName inside x y
-              Returns 1 is the designated  screen  coordinate  (x  and  y)  is
-              inside the plotting area and 0 otherwise.
-
-       pathName legend operation ?arg?...
-              See the LEGEND COMPONENT section.
-
-       pathName line operation arg...
-              The operation is the same as element.
-
-       pathName marker operation ?arg?...
-                        photo  Saves a Tk photo image.  OutputName  represents
-                               the  name of a Tk photo image that must already
-                               have been created.
-
-                        wmf    Saves an Aldus Placeable Metafile.   OutputName
-                               represents  the  filename where the metafile is
-                               written.  If outputName is CLIPBOARD, then out-
-                               put  is  written  directly to the Windows clip-
-                               board.  This format  is  available  only  under
-                               Microsoft Windows.
-
-                        emf    Saves  an  Enhanced Metafile. OutputName repre-
-                               sents the filename where the metafile is  writ-
-                               ten.   If  outputName is CLIPBOARD, then output
-                               is written directly to the  Windows  clipboard.
-                               This  format  is available only under Microsoft
-                               Windows.
-
-              -height size
-                        Specifies the height of the graph.  Size is  a  screen
-                        distance.  The graph will be redrawn using this dimen-
-                        sion, rather than its current window height.
-
-              -width size
-                        Specifies the width of the graph.  Size  is  a  screen
-                        distance.  The graph will be redrawn using this dimen-
-                        sion, rather than its current window width.
-
-       pathName transform x y
-              Performs a coordinate transformation, mapping graph  coordinates
-              to  window  coordinates,  using  the standard X-axis and Y-axis.
-              Returns a list containing the X-Y screen coordinates.
-
-       pathName xaxis operation ?arg?...
-
-       pathName x2axis operation ?arg?...
-
-       pathName yaxis operation ?arg?...
-
-       pathName y2axis operation ?arg?...
-              See the AXIS COMPONENTS section.
-
-
-
-

GRAPH COMPONENTS

-       A graph is composed of several components: coordinate axes,  data  ele-
-       ments,  legend,  grid, cross hairs, postscript, and annotation markers.
-       Instead of one big set of configuration  options  and  operations,  the
-       graph  is  partitioned,  where each component has its own configuration
-       options and operations that specifically control that aspect or part of
-       the graph.
-
-   AXIS COMPONENTS
-       Four  coordinate  axes are automatically created: two X-coordinate axes
-       You can have several axes. To create an axis, invoke the axis component
-       and  its  create  operation.   # Create a new axis called "tempAxis" .g
-       axis create tempAxis You map data elements to an axis  using  the  ele-
-       ment's  -mapy and -mapx configuration options. They specify the coordi-
-       nate axes an element is mapped onto.  # Now map the  tempAxis  data  to
-       this  axis.   .g element create "e1" -xdata $x -ydata $y -mapy tempAxis
-       Any number of axes can be displayed simultaneously. They are  drawn  in
-       the  margins  surrounding  the plotting area.  The default axes x and y
-       are drawn in the bottom and left margins. The axes x2 and y2 are  drawn
-       in  top  and  right  margins.  By default, only x and y are shown. Note
-       that the axes can have different scales.
-
-       To display a different axis or more than one axis, you  invoke  one  of
-       the  following components: xaxis, yaxis, x2axis, and y2axis.  Each com-
-       ponent has a use operation that designates the axis  (or  axes)  to  be
-       drawn  in  that corresponding margin: xaxis in the bottom, yaxis in the
-       left, x2axis in the top, and y2axis in the right.  # Display  the  axis
-       tempAxis  in  the left margin.  .g yaxis use tempAxis The use operation
-       takes a list of axis names as its last argument.  This is the  list  of
-       axes to be drawn in this margin.
-
-       You  can  configure  axes in many ways. The axis scale can be linear or
-       logarithmic.  The  values  along  the  axis  can  either  monotonically
-       increase  or decrease.  If you need custom tick labels, you can specify
-       a Tcl procedure to format the label any way you wish.  You can  control
-       how  ticks are drawn, by changing the major tick interval or the number
-       of minor ticks.  You can define non-uniform tick intervals, such as for
-       time-series plots.
-
-
-       pathName axis bind tagName ?sequence?  ?command?
-              Associates  command  with  tagName  such that whenever the event
-              sequence given by sequence occurs for an  axis  with  this  tag,
-              command will be invoked.  The syntax is similar to the bind com-
-              mand except that it operates on graph axes, rather than widgets.
-              See  the  bind manual entry for complete details on sequence and
-              the substitutions performed on command before invoking it.
-
-              If all arguments are specified then a new  binding  is  created,
-              replacing  any  existing  binding for the same sequence and tag-
-              Name.  If the first character of command is + then command  aug-
-              ments  an existing binding rather than replacing it.  If no com-
-              mand argument is provided then the command currently  associated
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-       pathName axis cget axisName option
-              Returns the current value of the  option  given  by  option  for
-              axisName.  Option may be any option described below for the axis
-              configure operation.
-                     the  list  matching  the current event sequence will have
-                     its Tcl command executed.  Implicitly  the  name  of  the
-                     element is always the first tag in the list.  The default
-                     value is all.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets the color of the axis and tick labels.  The  default
-                     is black.
-
-              -descending boolean
-                     Indicates whether the values along the axis are monotoni-
-                     cally increasing or decreasing.  If boolean is true,  the
-                     axis values will be decreasing.  The default is 0.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates  if  the axis is displayed. If boolean is false
-                     the axis will be displayed. Any  element  mapped  to  the
-                     axis is displayed regardless.  The default value is 0.
-
-              -justify justify
-                     Specifies  how  the axis title should be justified.  This
-                     matters only when the axis title contains more  than  one
-                     line  of  text.  Justify  must be left, right, or center.
-                     The default is center.
-
-              -limits formatStr
-                     Specifies a printf-like description to format the minimum
-                     and maximum limits of the axis.  The limits are displayed
-                     at the top/bottom or left/right  sides  of  the  plotting
-                     area.   FormatStr is a list of one or two format descrip-
-                     tions.  If one description is supplied, both the  minimum
-                     and  maximum  limits  are  formatted in the same way.  If
-                     two, the first designates  the  format  for  the  minimum
-                     limit,  the  second  for  the maximum.  If "" is given as
-                     either description, then the that limit will not be  dis-
-                     loosely, at the outer tick intervals.  If the axis  limit
-                     is  set  with  the -min or -max option, the axes are dis-
-                     played tightly.  If boolean is true, the  axis  range  is
-                     "loose".  The default is 0.
-
-              -majorticks majorList
-                     Specifies where to display major axis ticks.  You can use
-                     this option to display ticks  at  non-uniform  intervals.
-                     MajorList  is  a list of axis coordinates designating the
-                     location of major ticks.  No minor ticks are  drawn.   If
-                     majorList  is  "", major ticks will be automatically com-
-                     puted. The default is "".
-
-              -max value
-                     Sets the maximum  limit  of  axisName.   Any  data  point
-                     greater than value is not displayed.  If value is "", the
-                     maximum limit is calculated using the largest data value.
-                     The default is "".
-
-              -min value
-                     Sets  the  minimum limit of axisName. Any data point less
-                     than value is not displayed.  If value is "", the minimum
-                     limit  is  calculated using the smallest data value.  The
-                     default is "".
-
-              -minorticks minorList
-                     Specifies where to display minor axis ticks.  You can use
-                     this  option to display minor ticks at non-uniform inter-
-                     vals. MinorList is a list of real  values,  ranging  from
-                     0.0  to  1.0,  designating the placement of a minor tick.
-                     No minor ticks are drawn if the -majortick option is also
-                     set.   If  minorList is "", minor ticks will be automati-
-                     cally computed. The default is "".
-
-              -rotate theta
-                     Specifies the how many degrees to rotate  the  axis  tick
-                     labels.  Theta is a real value representing the number of
-                     degrees to rotate the tick labels.  The  default  is  0.0
-                     degrees.
-
-              -scrollcommand command
-                     Specify the prefix for a command used to communicate with
-                     scrollbars for this axis, such as .sbar set.
-
-              -scrollmax value
-                     Sets the maximum limit of the  axis  scroll  region.   If
-                     value  is  "",  the maximum limit is calculated using the
-                     largest data value.  The default is "".
-
-              -scrollmin value
-                     Sets the minimum limit of axis scroll region.   If  value
-                     is "", the minimum limit is calculated using the smallest
-                     Indicates how many minor axis ticks are to be drawn.  For
-                     example, if number is two, only one minor tick is  drawn.
-                     If  number  is  one,  no  minor ticks are displayed.  The
-                     default is 2.
-
-              -tickfont fontName
-                     Specifies the font for axis tick labels. The  default  is
-                     *-Courier-Bold-R-Normal-*-100-*.
-
-              -tickformat formatStr
-                     Specifies a printf-like description to format teh axis
-                     tick labels.  You can get the standard tick labels again by
-                     setting formatStr to "".  The default is "".
-
-              -tickformatcommand, -command prefix
-                     Specifies a Tcl command to be invoked when formatting the
-                     axis tick labels. Prefix is a string containing the  name
-                     of  a Tcl proc and any extra arguments for the procedure.
-                     This command is invoked for each major tick on the  axis.
-                     Two additional arguments are passed to the procedure: the
-                     pathname of the widget and the current the numeric  value
-                     of  the  tick.   The procedure returns the formatted tick
-                     label.  If "" is returned, no label will appear  next  to
-                     the  tick.  You can get the standard tick labels again by
-                     setting prefix to "".  The default is "".
-
-                     The numeric value for the tick might change when using the
-                     -logscale and -tickformat options.
-
-                     Please note that this  procedure  is  invoked  while  the
-                     graph  is  redrawn.  You may query configuration options.
-                     But  do  not  them,  because  this  can  have  unexpected
-                     results.
-
-              -ticklength pixels
-                     Sets the length of major and minor ticks (minor ticks are
-                     half the length of major ticks). If pixels is  less  than
-                     zero, the axis will be inverted with ticks drawn pointing
-                     towards the plot.  The default is 0.1i.
-
-              -title text
-                     Sets the title of the axis. If text is "", no axis  title
-                     will be displayed.
-
-              -titlealternate boolean
-                     Indicates  to  display  the  axis  title in its alternate
-                     location.  Normally the axis title is centered along  the
-                     axis.   This  option  places the axis either to the right
-                     (horizontal axes) or above (vertical axes) the axis.  The
-                     default is 0.
-
-              -titlecolor color
-                     Sets the color of the axis title. The default is black.
-
-              -titlefont fontName
-                     Specifies  the font for axis title. The default is *-Hel-
-                     vetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-14-140-*.
-
-              Axis configuration options may be also be set by the option com-
-              mand.   The  resource class is Axis.  The resource names are the
-              names  of  the  axes  (such   as   x   or   x2).    option   add
-              *Graph.Axis.Color    blue  option  add  *Graph.x.LogScale   true
-              option add *Graph.x2.LogScale false
-
-       pathName axis create axisName ?option value?...
-              Creates a new axis by the name axisName.  No axis  by  the  same
-              name  can already exist. Option and value are described in above
-              in the axis configure operation.
-
-       pathName axis delete ?axisName?...
-              Deletes the named axes. An axis is not really deleted  until  it
-              is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete axes mapped to ele-
-              ments.
-
-       pathName axis invtransform axisName value
-              Performs the inverse transformation, changing the screen coordi-
-              nate  value  to  a graph coordinate, mapping the value mapped to
-
-       pathName axis view axisName
-              Change the viewable area of this axis. Use as an argument  to  a
-              scrollbar's "-command".
-
-       The  default  axes are x, y, x2, and y2.  But you can display more than
-       four axes simultaneously.  You can also swap in a different  axis  with
-       use operation of the special axis components: xaxis, x2axis, yaxis, and
-       y2axis.  .g create axis temp .g create axis time ...  .g xaxis use temp
-       .g  yaxis use time Only the axes specified for use are displayed on the
-       screen.
-
-       The xaxis, x2axis, yaxis, and y2axis  components  operate  on  an  axis
-       location  rather than a specific axis like the more general axis compo-
-       nent does.  They implicitly control the axis that is currently using to
-       that location.  By default, xaxis uses the x axis, yaxis uses y, x2axis
-       uses x2, and y2axis uses y2.  When more than one axis is displayed in a
-       margin, it represents the first axis displayed.
-
-       The  following  operations  are available for axes. They mirror exactly
-       the operations of the axis component.  The axis argument must be xaxis,
-       x2axis,  yaxis,  or y2axis.  This feature is deprecated since more than
-       one axis can now be used a margin.  You  should  only  use  the  xaxis,
-       x2axis,  yaxis,  and y2axis components with the use operation.  For all
-       other operations, use the general axis component instead.
-
-       pathName axis cget option
-
-       pathName axis configure ?option value?...
-
-       pathName axis invtransform value
-
-       pathName axis limits
-
-       pathName axis transform value
-
-       pathName axis use ?axisName?
-              Designates the axis axisName is to be displayed  at  this  loca-
-              tion.   AxisName  can not be already in use at another location.
-              This command returns the name of the axis currently  using  this
-              location.
-
-   CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT
-       Cross  hairs  consist  of  two intersecting lines (one vertical and one
-       horizontal) drawn completely across the plotting area.  They  are  used
-       to  position the mouse in relation to the coordinate axes.  Cross hairs
-       differ from line markers in that they are implemented using XOR drawing
-       primitives.  This means that they can be quickly drawn and erased with-
-       out redrawing the entire graph.
-
-       The following operations are available for cross hairs:
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets the color of the cross hairs.  The default is black.
-
-              -dashes dashList
-                     Sets  the  dash  style  of the cross hairs. DashList is a
-                     list of up to 11 numbers that alternately  represent  the
-                     lengths  of  the dashes and gaps on the cross hair lines.
-                     Each number must be between 1 and 255.   If  dashList  is
-                     "", the cross hairs will be solid lines.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  cross  hairs are drawn. If boolean is
-                     true, cross hairs are not drawn.  The default is yes.
-
-              -linewidth pixels
-                     Set the width of the cross hair lines.  The default is 1.
-
-              -position pos
-                     Specifies  the  screen  position  where  the  cross hairs
-                     intersect.  Pos must be in the form "@x,y", where x and y
-                     are the window coordinates of the intersection.
-
-              Cross  hairs  configuration  options  may  be also be set by the
-              option command.  The resource name and class are crosshairs  and
-              Crosshairs respectively.  option add *Graph.Crosshairs.LineWidth
-              2 option add *Graph.Crosshairs.Color     red
-
-       pathName crosshairs off
-              Turns off the cross hairs.
-
-       pathName crosshairs on
-              Turns on the display of the cross hairs.
-
-       pathName crosshairs toggle
-              Toggles the current state of the cross hairs,  alternately  map-
-              ping and unmapping the cross hairs.
-
-   ELEMENT COMPONENTS
-       A  data  element represents a set of data.  It contains x and y vectors
-       containing the coordinates of the data points.  Elements  can  be  dis-
-       played  with  a  symbol  at  each  data  point and lines connecting the
-       points.  Elements also control the appearance of the data, such as  the
-       symbol type, line width, color etc.
-
-       When  new  data elements are created, they are automatically added to a
-       list of displayed elements.   The display list controls  what  elements
-       are drawn and in what order.
-
-       The following operations are available for elements.
-
-       pathName element activate elemName ?index?...
-              Specifies  the data points of element elemName to be drawn using
-              replacing  any  existing  binding for the same sequence and tag-
-              Name.  If the first character of command is + then command  aug-
-              ments  an existing binding rather than replacing it.  If no com-
-              mand argument is provided then the command currently  associated
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-       pathName element cget elemName option
-              Returns the current value of the  element  configuration  option
-              given  by  option.   Option  may be any of the options described
-              below for the element configure operation.
-
-       pathName element closest x y ?option value?... ?elemName?...
-              Searches for the data point closest to the window coordinates  x
-              and  y.  By default, all elements are searched.  Hidden elements
-              (see the -hide option is false) are ignored.  You can limit  the
-              search  by  specifying  only the elements you want to be consid-
-              ered.  ElemName must be the name of an element that can  not  be
-              hidden.   It returns a key-value list containing the name of the
-              closest element, the index of the closest data  point,  and  the
-              graph-coordinates  of  the  point.  Returns "", if no data point
-              within the  threshold  distance  can  be  found.  The  following
-              option-value pairs are available.
-
-              -along direction
-                     Search for the closest element using the following crite-
-                     ria:
-
-                     x      Find closest element vertically from the given  X-
-                            coordinate.
-
-                     y      Find  the  closest  element  horizontally from the
-                            given Y-coordinate.
-
-                     both   Find the  closest  element  for  the  given  point
-                            (using both the X and Y coordinates).
-
-              -halo pixels
-                     Specifies a threshold distance where selected data points
-                     are ignored.  Pixels is a valid screen distance, such  as
-                     2  or  1.2i.   If  this  option  isn't specified, then it
-                     defaults to the value of the graph's -halo option.
-
-              -interpolate string
-                     Indicates whether to consider projections that lie  along
-                     the  line  segments connecting data points when searching
-                     for the closest point.  The default value is 0. The  val-
-                     ues for string are described below.
-
-                     no          Search only for the closest data point.
-
-              -activepen penName
-                     Specifies pen to use to draw active element.  If  penName
-                     is  "", no active elements will be drawn.  The default is
-                     activeLine.
-
-              -areabackground color
-                     Specifies the background color  of  the  area  under  the
-                     curve.  The  background area color is drawn only for bit-
-                     maps (see the -areapattern option).  If color is "",  the
-                     background is transparent.  The default is black.
-
-              -areaforeground color
-                     Specifies  the  foreground  color  of  the area under the
-                     curve.  The default is black.
-
-              -areapattern pattern
-                     Specifies how to fill the area under the curve.   Pattern
-                     may  be  the  name  of  a  Tk  bitmap,  solid, or "".  If
-                     "solid", then the area under the curve is drawn with  the
-                     color  designated  by  the  -areaforeground option.  If a
-                     bitmap, then the bitmap  is  stippled  across  the  area.
-                     Here  the  bitmap colors are controlled by the -areafore-
-                     ground and -areabackground options.  If pattern is "", no
-                     filled area is drawn.  The default is "".
-
-              -areatile image
-                     Specifies  the  name of a Tk image to be used to tile the
-                     area under the curve.  This option supersedes the -areap-
-                     attern option.  Image must be a photo image.  If image is
-                     "", no tiling is performed.  The default is "".
-
-              -bindtags tagList
-                     Specifies the binding tags for the element.  TagList is a
-                     list of binding tag names.  The tags and their order will
-                     determine how events are handled for elements.  Each  tag
-                     in the list matching the current event sequence will have
-                     its Tcl command executed.  Implicitly  the  name  of  the
-                     element is always the first tag in the list.  The default
-                     value is all.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets the color of the traces connecting the data  points.
-
-              -dashes dashList
-                     Sets  the  dash style of element line. DashList is a list
-                     of up  to  11  numbers  that  alternately  represent  the
-                     lengths of the dashes and gaps on the element line.  Each
-                     number must be between 1 and 255.  If dashList is "", the
-                     lines will be solid.
-
-              -data coordList
-                     Specifies  the X-Y coordinates of the data.  CoordList is
-                     Sets  the  element's label in the legend.  If text is "",
-                     the element will  have  no  entry  in  the  legend.   The
-                     default label is the element's name.
-
-              -linewidth pixels
-                     Sets  the  width  of  the  connecting  lines between data
-                     points.  If pixels is 0,  no  connecting  lines  will  be
-                     drawn between symbols.  The default is 0.
-
-              -mapx xAxis
-                     Selects  the  X-axis  to  map the element's X-coordinates
-                     onto.  XAxis must be the name of an axis.  The default is
-                     x.
-
-              -mapy yAxis
-                     Selects  the  Y-axis  to  map the element's Y-coordinates
-                     onto.  YAxis must be the name of an axis. The default  is
-                     y.
-
-              -offdash color
-                     Sets the color of the stripes when traces are dashed (see
-                     the -dashes option).  If color is "", then the "off" pix-
-                     els  will represent gaps instead of stripes.  If color is
-                     defcolor, then the color will be the same as  the  -color
-                     option.  The default is defcolor.
-
-              -outline color
-                     Sets  the  color  or  the outline around each symbol.  If
-                     color is "", then no outline is drawn. If color  is  def-
-                     color,  then  the  color  will  be the same as the -color
-                     option.  The default is defcolor.
-
-              -pen penname
-                     Set the pen to use for this element.
-
-              -outlinewidth pixels
-                     Sets the width of the outline bordering each symbol.   If
-                     pixels  is 0, no outline will be drawn. The default is 1.
-
-              -pixels pixels
-                     Sets the size of symbols.  If pixels  is  0,  no  symbols
-                     will be drawn.  The default is 0.125i.
-
-              -scalesymbols boolean
-                     If  boolean  is  true,  the size of the symbols drawn for
-                     elemName will change with scale of the X-axis and Y-axis.
-                     At the time this option is set, the current ranges of the
-                     axes are saved as the normalized scales (i.e scale factor
-                     is  1.0)  and the element is drawn at its designated size
-                     (see the -pixels option).   As  the  scale  of  the  axes
-                     change,  the  symbol  will  be  scaled  according  to the
-                     smaller of the X-axis and Y-axis scales.  If  boolean  is
-                     dratic spline is used.  The default is linear.
-
-              -styles styleList
-                     Specifies what pen to use based on the range  of  weights
-                     given.  StyleList is a list of style specifications. Each
-                     style specification, in turn, is a list consisting  of  a
-                     pen  name,  and  optionally  a minimum and maximum range.
-                     Data points whose weight (see the -weight  option)  falls
-                     in  this  range, are drawn with this pen.  If no range is
-                     specified it defaults to the index  of  the  pen  in  the
-                     list.   Note  that  this  affects only symbol attributes.
-                     Line attributes, such as line  width,  dashes,  etc.  are
-                     ignored.
-
-              -symbol symbol
-                     Specifies  the  symbol  for  data  points.  Symbol can be
-                     either  square,  circle,  diamond,  plus,  cross,  splus,
-                     scross,  triangle,  ""  (where  no symbol is drawn), or a
-                     bitmap.  Bitmaps are specified as "source ?mask?",  where
-                     source  is  the  name of the bitmap, and mask is the bit-
-                     map's optional mask.  The default is circle.
-
-              -trace direction
-                     Indicates whether connecting lines  between  data  points
-                     (whose  X-coordinate  values  are  either  increasing  or
-                     decreasing) are drawn.   Direction  must  be  increasing,
-                     decreasing,  or  both.   For  example,  if  direction  is
-                     increasing, connecting lines will be drawn  only  between
-                     those data points where X-coordinate values are monotoni-
-                     cally increasing.  If direction is both, connecting lines
-                     will  be  draw  between  all data points.  The default is
-                     both.
-
-              -weights wVec
-                     Specifies the weights  of  the  individual  data  points.
-                     This,  with the list pen styles (see the -styles option),
-                     controls how data points are drawn.  WVec is the name  of
-                     a  BLT vector or a list of numeric expressions represent-
-                     ing the weights for each data point.
-
-              -xdata xVec
-                     Specifies the X-coordinates of the  data.   XVec  is  the
-                     name of a BLT vector or a list of numeric expressions.
-
-              -ydata yVec
-                     Specifies  the  Y-coordinates  of  the data.  YVec is the
-                     name of a BLT vector or a list of numeric expressions.
-
-              Element configuration options may also be set by the option com-
-              mand.   The  resource class is Element. The resource name is the
-              name of the  element.   option  add  *Graph.Element.symbol  line
-              option add *Graph.e1.symbol line
-
-       pathName element exists elemName
-              Returns  1  if an element elemName currently exists and 0 other-
-              wise.
-
-       pathName element names ?pattern?...
-              Returns the elements matching one or more pattern.  If  no  pat-
-              tern is given, the names of all elements is returned.
-
-       pathName element show ?nameList?
-              Queries  or modifies the element display list.  The element dis-
-              play list designates the  elements  drawn  and  in  what  order.
-              NameList is a list of elements to be displayed in the order they
-              are named.  If there is no nameList argument, the  current  dis-
-              play list is returned.
-
-       pathName element type elemName
-              Returns  the type of elemName.  If the element is a bar element,
-              the commands returns the  string  "bar",  otherwise  it  returns
-              "line".
-
-   GRID COMPONENT
-       Grid  lines extend from the major and minor ticks of each axis horizon-
-       tally or vertically across the plotting area.  The following operations
-       are available for grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid cget option
-              Returns  the current value of the grid line configuration option
-              given by option.  Option may be any option described  below  for
-              the grid configure operation.
-
-       pathName grid configure ?option value?...
-              Queries  or  modifies  the configuration options for grid lines.
-              If option isn't specified, a list  describing  all  the  current
-              grid  options for pathName is returned.  If option is specified,
-              but not value, then a list describing option  is  returned.   If
-              one  or more option and value pairs are specified, then for each
-              pair, the grid line option option is set to value.  The  follow-
-              ing options are valid for grid lines.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets  the color of the grid lines.  The default is black.
-
-              -dashes dashList
-                     Sets the dash style of the grid lines. DashList is a list
-                     of  up  to  11  numbers  that  alternately  represent the
-                     lengths of the dashes and gaps on the grid  lines.   Each
-                     number must be between 1 and 255.  If dashList is "", the
-                     grid will be solid lines.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the grid should be drawn. If boolean is
-
-              -minor boolean
-                     Indicates  whether  the  grid  lines  should be drawn for
-                     minor ticks.  If boolean is true, the lines  will  appear
-                     at minor tick intervals.  The default is 1.
-
-              Grid  configuration  options  may also be set by the option com-
-              mand.  The resource name and class are  grid  and  Grid  respec-
-              tively.    option   add   *Graph.grid.LineWidth   2  option  add
-              *Graph.Grid.Color     black
-
-       pathName grid off
-              Turns off the display the grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid on
-              Turns on the display the grid lines.
-
-       pathName grid toggle
-              Toggles the display of the grid.
-
-   LEGEND COMPONENT
-       The legend displays a list of the data elements.  Each  entry  consists
-       of the element's symbol and label.  The legend can appear in any margin
-       (the default location is in the right margin).  It can  also  be  posi-
-       tioned anywhere within the plotting area.
-
-       The following operations are valid for the legend.
-
-       pathName legend activate pattern...
-              Selects  legend entries to be drawn using the active legend col-
-              ors and relief.  All entries whose element names  match  pattern
-              are  selected.  To be selected, the element name must match only
-              one pattern.
-
-       pathName legend bind tagName ?sequence?  ?command?
-              Associates command with tagName such  that  whenever  the  event
-              sequence  given  by sequence occurs for a legend entry with this
-              tag, command will be invoked.  Implicitly the element  names  in
-              the  entry  are tags.  The syntax is similar to the bind command
-              except that it operates on legend entries, rather than  widgets.
-              See  the  bind manual entry for complete details on sequence and
-              the substitutions performed on command before invoking it.
-
-              If all arguments are specified then a new  binding  is  created,
-              replacing  any  existing  binding for the same sequence and tag-
-              Name.  If the first character of command is + then command  aug-
-              ments  an existing binding rather than replacing it.  If no com-
-              mand argument is provided then the command currently  associated
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-              -activebackground color
-                     Sets the background color for active legend entries.  All
-                     legend  entries  marked  active  (see the legend activate
-                     operation) are drawn using this background color.
-
-              -activeborderwidth pixels
-                     Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside  edge
-                     of the active legend entries.  The default is 2.
-
-              -activeforeground color
-                     Sets the foreground color for active legend entries.  All
-                     legend entries marked as active (see the legend  activate
-                     operation) are drawn using this foreground color.
-
-              -activerelief relief
-                     Specifies  the  3-D  effect  desired  for  active  legend
-                     entries.  Relief denotes how the interior  of  the  entry
-                     should appear relative to the legend; for example, raised
-                     means the entry should appear to protrude from  the  leg-
-                     end,  relative to the surface of the legend.  The default
-                     is flat.
-
-              -anchor anchor
-                     Tells how to position the legend relative  to  the  posi-
-                     tioning  point  for the legend.  This is dependent on the
-                     value of the -position option.  The default is center.
-
-                     left or right
-                                 The anchor describes how to position the leg-
-                                 end vertically.
-
-                     top or bottom
-                                 The anchor describes how to position the leg-
-                                 end horizontally.
-
-                     @x,y        The anchor specifies how to position the leg-
-                                 end  relative  to  the positioning point. For
-                                 example, if anchor is center then the  legend
-                                 is centered on the point; if anchor is n then
-                                 the legend will be drawn such  that  the  top
-                                 center  point of the rectangular region occu-
-                                 pied by the legend will be at the positioning
-                                 point.
-
-                     plotarea    The anchor specifies how to position the leg-
-                                 end relative to the plotting area. For  exam-
-                                 ple,  if  anchor is center then the legend is
-                                 centered in the plotting area; if  anchor  is
-                                 ne  then  the  legend will be drawn such that
-                                 occupies the upper right corner of the  plot-
-                                 ting area.
-
-                     Sets  the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge
-                     of the legend (if such border is being drawn; the  relief
-                     option determines this).  The default is 2 pixels.
-
-              -font fontName
-                     FontName  specifies a font to use when drawing the labels
-                     of each element into the legend.  The default  is  *-Hel-
-                     vetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-12-120-*.
-
-              -foreground color
-                     Sets  the foreground color of the text drawn for the ele-
-                     ment's label.  The default is black.
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the  legend  should  be  displayed.  If
-                     boolean  is  true,  the  legend  will  not  be draw.  The
-                     default is no.
-
-              -ipadx pad
-                     Sets the amount of internal padding to be  added  to  the
-                     width  of each legend entry.  Pad can be a list of one or
-                     two screen distances.  If pad has two elements, the  left
-                     side  of the legend entry is padded by the first distance
-                     and the right side by the second.  If  pad  is  just  one
-                     distance,  both  the  left  and  right  sides  are padded
-                     evenly.  The default is 2.
-
-              -ipady pad
-                     Sets an amount of internal padding to  be  added  to  the
-                     height of each legend entry.  Pad can be a list of one or
-                     two screen distances.  If pad has two elements,  the  top
-                     of the entry is padded by the first distance and the bot-
-                     tom by the second.  If pad is just one distance, both the
-                     top  and  bottom  of  the  entry  are padded evenly.  The
-                     default is 2.
-
-              -padx pad
-                     Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors  of  the
-                     legend.   Pad  can  be  a  list of one or two screen dis-
-                     tances.  If pad has two elements, the left  side  of  the
-                     legend is padded by the first distance and the right side
-                     by the second.  If pad has just one  distance,  both  the
-                     left  and  right sides are padded evenly.  The default is
-                     4.
-
-              -pady pad
-                     Sets the padding above and below the legend.  Pad can  be
-                     a  list  of  one or two screen distances.  If pad has two
-                     elements, the area above the  legend  is  padded  by  the
-                     first  distance and the area below by the second.  If pad
-                     is just one distance, both the top and bottom  areas  are
-                     padded evenly.  The default is 0.
-                     plotting area.  If boolean is true, the  legend  will  be
-                     drawn  on  top  of  any elements that may overlap it. The
-                     default is no.
-
-              -relief relief
-                     Specifies the 3-D effect for the border around  the  leg-
-                     end.   Relief  specifies  how  the interior of the legend
-                     should appear relative to the graph; for example,  raised
-                     means  the  legend  should  appear  to  protrude from the
-                     graph, relative to the surface of the graph.  The default
-                     is sunken.
-
-              Legend  configuration options may also be set by the option com-
-              mand.  The resource name and class are legend and Legend respec-
-              tively.   option  add  *Graph.legend.Foreground  blue option add
-              *Graph.Legend.Relief     raised
-
-       pathName legend deactivate pattern...
-              Selects legend entries to be drawn using the normal legend  col-
-              ors  and  relief.  All entries whose element names match pattern
-              are selected.  To be selected, the element name must match  only
-              one pattern.
-
-       pathName legend get pos
-              Returns  the  name  of  the element whose entry is at the screen
-              position pos in the legend.  Pos must be  in  the  form  "@x,y",
-              where  x and y are window coordinates.  If the given coordinates
-              do not lie over a legend entry, "" is returned.
-
-   PEN COMPONENTS
-       Pens define attributes (both symbol and line style) for elements.  Pens
-       mirror  the  configuration options of data elements that pertain to how
-       symbols and lines are drawn.  Data elements use pens to  determine  how
-       they  are drawn.  A data element may use several pens at once.  In this
-       case, the pen used for a particular data point is determined from  each
-       element's weight vector (see the element's -weight and -style options).
-
-       One pen, called activeLine, is automatically created.  It's used as the
-       default  active  pen  for  elements.  So  you  can  change  the  active
-       attributes for all elements by simply reconfiguring this pen.   .g  pen
-       configure  "activeLine"  -color  green  You  can create and use several
-       pens. To create a pen, invoke the pen component and its  create  opera-
-       tion.   .g pen create myPen You map pens to a data element using either
-       the element's -pen or -activepen options.  .g  element  create  "line1"
-       -xdata $x -ydata $tempData \
-           -pen myPen An element can use several pens at once. This is done by
-       specifying the name of the pen in the element's  style  list  (see  the
-       -styles  option).  .g element configure "line1" -styles { myPen 2.0 3.0
-       } This says that any data point with a weight between 2.0 and 3.0 is to
-       be drawn using the pen myPen.  All other points are drawn with the ele-
-       ment's default attributes.
-
-              specified,  then  for each pair, the pen option option is set to
-              value.  The following options are valid for pens.
-
-              -color color
-                     Sets the color of the traces connecting the data  points.
-
-              -dashes dashList
-                     Sets  the  dash style of element line. DashList is a list
-                     of up  to  11  numbers  that  alternately  represent  the
-                     lengths of the dashes and gaps on the element line.  Each
-                     number must be between 1 and 255.  If dashList is "", the
-                     lines will be solid.
-
-              -fill color
-                     Sets the interior color of symbols.  If color is "", then
-                     the interior of the symbol is transparent.  If  color  is
-                     defcolor,  then  the color will be the same as the -color
-                     option.  The default is defcolor.
-
-              -linewidth pixels
-                     Sets the width  of  the  connecting  lines  between  data
-                     points.   If  pixels  is  0,  no connecting lines will be
-                     drawn between symbols.  The default is 0.
-
-              -offdash color
-                     Sets the color of the stripes when traces are dashed (see
-                     the -dashes option).  If color is "", then the "off" pix-
-                     els will represent gaps instead of stripes.  If color  is
-                     defcolor,  then  the color will be the same as the -color
-                     option.  The default is defcolor.
-
-              -outline color
-                     Sets the color or the outline  around  each  symbol.   If
-                     color  is  "", then no outline is drawn. If color is def-
-                     color, then the color will be  the  same  as  the  -color
-                     option.  The default is defcolor.
-
-              -outlinewidth pixels
-                     Sets  the width of the outline bordering each symbol.  If
-                     pixels is 0, no outline will be drawn. The default is  1.
-
-              -pixels pixels
-                     Sets  the  size  of  symbols.  If pixels is 0, no symbols
-                     will be drawn.  The default is 0.125i.
-
-              -symbol symbol
-                     Specifies the symbol for  data  points.   Symbol  can  be
-                     either  square,  circle,  diamond,  plus,  cross,  splus,
-                     scross, triangle, "" (where no symbol  is  drawn),  or  a
-                     bitmap.   Bitmaps are specified as "source ?mask?", where
-                     source is the name of the bitmap, and mask  is  the  bit-
-                     map's optional mask.  The default is circle.
-
-              Creates a new pen by the name penName.  No pen by the same  name
-              can  already  exist.  Option and value are described in above in
-              the pen configure operation.
-
-       pathName pen delete ?penName?...
-              Deletes the named pens. A pen is not really deleted until it  is
-              not  longer  in  use, so it's safe to delete pens mapped to ele-
-              ments.
-
-       pathName pen names ?pattern?...
-              Returns a list of pens matching zero or more  patterns.   If  no
-              pattern argument is give, the names of all pens are returned.
-
-   POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT
-       The  graph can generate encapsulated PostScript output.  There are sev-
-       eral configuration options you can specify to control how the plot will
-       be  generated.   You  can  change the page dimensions and borders.  The
-       plot itself can be scaled, centered,  or  rotated  to  landscape.   The
-       PostScript output can be written directly to a file or returned through
-       the interpreter.
-
-       The following postscript operations are available.
-
-       pathName postscript cget option
-              Returns the current value of  the  postscript  option  given  by
-              option.   Option may be any option described below for the post-
-              script configure operation.
-
-       pathName postscript configure ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies the  configuration  options  for  PostScript
-              generation.   If  option  isn't specified, a list describing the
-              current postscript options for pathName is returned.  If  option
-              is  specified,  but  not value, then a list describing option is
-              returned.  If one or more option and value pairs are  specified,
-              then  for  each  pair,  the  postscript  option option is set to
-              value.  The following postscript options are available.
-
-              -center boolean
-                     Indicates whether the plot  should  be  centered  on  the
-                     PostScript  page.   If boolean is false, the plot will be
-                     placed in the upper left corner of the page.  The default
-                     is 1.
-
-              -colormap varName
-                     VarName  must be the name of a global array variable that
-                     specifies a color mapping from the X color name to  Post-
-                     Script.   Each  element  of varName must consist of Post-
-                     Script code to set a particular color value  (e.g.  ``1.0
-                     1.0  0.0  setrgbcolor'').  When generating color informa-
-                     tion in PostScript, the array variable varName is checked
-                     if  an element of the name as the color exists. If so, it
-                     uses its value as  the  PostScript  command  to  set  the
-                     Script.   Each  element  of varName must consist of a Tcl
-                     list with one or two elements; the name and point size of
-                     a  PostScript  font.  When outputting PostScript commands
-                     for a particular font,  the  array  variable  varName  is
-                     checked  to  see  if  an  element  by  the specified font
-                     exists.  If there is  such  an  element,  then  the  font
-                     information  contained  in  that  element  is used in the
-                     PostScript output.  (If the point size  is  omitted  from
-                     the  list, the point size of the X font is used).  Other-
-                     wise the X font is examined in an attempt to  guess  what
-                     PostScript  font to use.  This works only for fonts whose
-                     foundry property is  Adobe  (such  as  Times,  Helvetica,
-                     Courier,  etc.).   If  all  of  this  fails then the font
-                     defaults to Helvetica-Bold.
-
-              -decorations boolean
-                     Indicates whether PostScript commands to  generate  color
-                     backgrounds  and  3-D borders will be output.  If boolean
-                     is false, the background will be white and no 3-D borders
-                     will be generated. The default is 1.
-
-              -height pixels
-                     Sets  the  height  of  the plot.  This lets you print the
-                     graph with a height different from the one drawn  on  the
-                     screen.   If  pixels  is 0, the height is the same as the
-                     widget's height.  The default is 0.
-
-              -landscape boolean
-                     If boolean is true, this specifies the printed area is to
-                     be  rotated 90 degrees.  In non-rotated output the X-axis
-                     of the printed area runs along the short dimension of the
-                     page  (``portrait''  orientation);  in rotated output the
-                     X-axis runs along the long dimension of the page (``land-
-                     scape'' orientation).  Defaults to 0.
-
-              -maxpect boolean
-                     Indicates  to  scale  the plot so that it fills the Post-
-                     Script page.  The aspect ratio  of  the  graph  is  still
-                     retained.  The default is 0.
-
-              -padx pad
-                     Sets  the  horizontal padding for the left and right page
-                     borders.  The borders are exterior to the plot.  Pad  can
-                     be a list of one or two screen distances.  If pad has two
-                     elements, the left border is padded by the first distance
-                     and  the right border by the second.  If pad has just one
-                     distance, both the left  and  right  borders  are  padded
-                     evenly.  The default is 1i.
-
-              -pady pad
-                     Sets  the  vertical  padding  for the top and bottom page
-                     borders. The borders are exterior to the plot.   Pad  can
-                     The default width is 8.5i.
-
-              -width pixels
-                     Sets  the  width  of  the plot.  This lets you generate a
-                     plot of a width different from that of  the  widget.   If
-                     pixels is 0, the width is the same as the widget's width.
-                     The default is 0.
-
-              Postscript configuration options may  be  also  be  set  by  the
-              option  command.  The resource name and class are postscript and
-              Postscript respectively.  option  add  *Graph.postscript.Decora-
-              tions false option add *Graph.Postscript.Landscape   true
-
-       pathName postscript output ?fileName? ?option value?...
-              Outputs  a file of encapsulated PostScript.  If a fileName argu-
-              ment isn't present, the command returns the PostScript.  If  any
-              option-value  pairs  are present, they set configuration options
-              controlling how the PostScript is generated.  Option  and  value
-              can  be  anything accepted by the postscript configure operation
-              above.
-
-   MARKER COMPONENTS
-       Markers are simple drawing procedures used  to  annotate  or  highlight
-       areas of the graph.  Markers have various types: text strings, bitmaps,
-       images, connected lines, windows, or polygons.  They can be  associated
-       with  a  particular  element, so that when the element is hidden or un-
-       hidden, so is the marker.  By  default,  markers  are  the  last  items
-       drawn,  so  that  data  elements  will  appear in behind them.  You can
-       change this by configuring the -under option.
-
-       Markers, in contrast to elements, don't affect the scaling of the coor-
-       dinate axes.  They can also have elastic coordinates (specified by -Inf
-       and Inf respectively) that translate into the minimum or maximum  limit
-       of  the axis.  For example, you can place a marker so it always remains
-       in the lower left corner of the plotting area, by using the coordinates
-       -Inf,-Inf.
-
-       The following operations are available for markers.
-
-       pathName marker after markerId ?afterId?
-              Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first marker after
-              the second.  If no second afterId  argument  is  specified,  the
-              marker  is  placed at the end of the display list.  This command
-              can be used to control how markers are displayed  since  markers
-              are drawn in the order of this display list.
-
-       pathName marker before markerId ?beforeId?
-              Changes  the  order  of  the  markers,  drawing the first marker
-              before the second.  If no second beforeId argument is specified,
-              the marker is placed at the beginning of the display list.  This
-              command can be used to control how markers are  displayed  since
-              markers are drawn in the order of this display list.
-              with  tagName  and  sequence (it's an error occurs if there's no
-              such binding) is returned.  If both  command  and  sequence  are
-              missing  then  a list of all the event sequences for which bind-
-              ings have been defined for tagName.
-
-       pathName marker cget option
-              Returns the current value of  the  marker  configuration  option
-              given  by  option.   Option may be any option described below in
-              the configure operation.
-
-       pathName marker configure markerId ?option value?...
-              Queries or modifies the configuration options for  markers.   If
-              option  isn't  specified,  a list describing the current options
-              for markerId is returned.   If  option  is  specified,  but  not
-              value,  then  a  list  describing option is returned.  If one or
-              more option and value pairs are specified, then for  each  pair,
-              the marker option option is set to value.
-
-              The  following  options are valid for all markers.  Each type of
-              marker  also  has  its  own  type-specific  options.   They  are
-              described in the sections below.
-
-              -bindtags tagList
-                     Specifies  the binding tags for the marker.  TagList is a
-                     list of binding tag names.  The tags and their order will
-                     determine  how  events for markers are handled.  Each tag
-                     in the list matching the current event sequence will have
-                     its  Tcl  command  executed.   Implicitly the name of the
-                     marker is always the first tag in the list.  The  default
-                     value is all.
-
-              -coords coordList
-                     Specifies  the coordinates of the marker.  CoordList is a
-                     list of graph coordinates.   The  number  of  coordinates
-                     required  is  dependent  on  the  type  of marker.  Text,
-                     image, and window markers need only two  coordinates  (an
-                     X-Y  coordinate).   Bitmap markers can take either two or
-                     four coordinates (if four, they represent the corners  of
-                     the bitmap). Line markers need at least four coordinates,
-                     polygons at least six.  If coordList is  "",  the  marker
-                     will not be displayed.  The default is "".
-
-              -element elemName
-                     Links  the  marker with the element elemName.  The marker
-                     is drawn only if the element is also currently  displayed
-                     (see  the  element's show operation).  If elemName is "",
-                     the marker is always drawn.  The default is "".
-
-              -hide boolean
-                     Indicates whether the marker  is  drawn.  If  boolean  is
-                     true, the marker is not drawn.  The default is no.
-
-              -under boolean
-                     Indicates whether the marker is  drawn  below/above  data
-                     elements.   If  boolean  is  true, the marker is be drawn
-                     underneath the data element symbols  and  lines.   Other-
-                     wise,  the  marker  is  drawn on top of the element.  The
-                     default is 0.
-
-              -xoffset pixels
-                     Specifies a screen distance to offset the marker horizon-
-                     tally.   Pixels  is a valid screen distance, such as 2 or
-                     1.2i.  The default is 0.
-
-              -yoffset pixels
-                     Specifies a screen distance to offset the markers  verti-
-                     cally.   Pixels  is a valid screen distance, such as 2 or
-                     1.2i.  The default is 0.
-
-              Marker configuration options may also be set by the option  com-
-              mand.   The resource class is either BitmapMarker,  ImageMarker,
-              LineMarker, PolygonMarker, TextMarker, or WindowMarker,  depend-
-              ing on the type of marker.  The resource name is the name of the
-              marker.  option add  *Graph.TextMarker.Foreground  white  option
-              add     *Graph.BitmapMarker.Foreground    white    option    add
-              *Graph.m1.Background     blue
-
-       pathName marker create type ?option value?...
-              Creates a marker of the selected type. Type may be either  text,
-              line,  bitmap,  image, polygon, or window.  This command returns
-              the marker identifier, used as  the  markerId  argument  in  the
-              other  marker-related  commands.   If  the -name option is used,
-              this overrides the normal marker identifier.  If the  name  pro-
-              vided  is  already  used for another marker, the new marker will
-              replace the old.
-
-       pathName marker delete ?name?...
-              Removes one of more markers.  The graph  will  automatically  be
-              redrawn without the marker..
-
-       pathName marker exists markerId
-              Returns 1 if the marker markerId exists and 0 otherwise.
-
-       pathName marker names ?pattern?
-              Returns  the  names of all the markers that currently exist.  If
-              pattern is supplied, only those markers  whose  names  match  it
-              will be returned.
-
-       pathName marker type markerId
-              Returns  the  type of the marker given by markerId, such as line
-              or text.  If markerId is not a valid a marker identifier, ""  is
-              returned.
-
-   BITMAP MARKERS
-       The following options are specific to bitmap markers:
-
-       -background color
-              Same as the -fill option.
-
-       -bitmap bitmap
-              Specifies  the  bitmap  to  be  displayed.  If bitmap is "", the
-              marker will not be displayed.  The default is "".
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets the background color of the bitmap.  If color is the  empty
-              string,  no  background  will be transparent.  The default back-
-              ground color is "".
-
-       -foreground color
-              Same as the -outline option.
-
-       -mask mask
-              Specifies a mask for the bitmap to be displayed. This mask is  a
-              bitmap  itself,  denoting  the  pixels that are transparent.  If
-              mask is "", all pixels of the bitmap will be drawn.  The default
-              is "".
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets  the  foreground  color of the bitmap. The default value is
-              black.
-
-       -rotate theta
-              Sets the rotation of the bitmap.  Theta is a real number  repre-
-              senting  the  angle of rotation in degrees.  The marker is first
-              rotated and then placed according to its anchor  position.   The
-              default rotation is 0.0.
-
-   IMAGE MARKERS
-       A  image  marker displays an image.  Image markers are created with the
-       marker's create operation in the form:  pathName  marker  create  image
-       ?option  value?...   There  may be many option-value pairs, each sets a
-       configuration option for the marker.  These same option-value pairs may
-       be used with the marker's configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to image markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor tells how to position the image relative to the position-
-              ing point for the image. For example, if anchor is  center  then
-              the  image  is  centered  on the point;  if anchor is n then the
-              image will be drawn such that the top center point of the  rect-
-              angular  region occupied by the image will be at the positioning
-              point.  This option defaults to center.
-
-       -image image
-              Specifies the image to be drawn.  If image  is  "",  the  marker
-              gaps  on  the  line.  Each number must be between 1 and 255.  If
-              dashList is "", the marker line will be solid.
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets the background color of the line.  This color is used  with
-              striped  lines  (see the -fdashes option). If color is the empty
-              string, no background color is drawn (the line will  be  dashed,
-              not striped).  The default background color is "".
-
-       -linewidth pixels
-              Sets the width of the lines.  The default width is 0.
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets  the  foreground  color  of  the line. The default value is
-              black.
-
-       -stipple bitmap
-              Specifies a stipple pattern used to draw the line, rather than a
-              solid  line.   Bitmap  specifies  a bitmap to use as the stipple
-              pattern.  If bitmap is "", then the line is  drawn  in  a  solid
-              fashion. The default is "".
-
-   POLYGON MARKERS
-       A polygon marker displays a closed region described as two or more con-
-       nected line segments.  It is assumed the first and last points are con-
-       nected.   Polygon markers are created using the marker create operation
-       in the form: pathName marker create polygon  ?option  value?...   There
-       may  be  many  option-value pairs, each sets a configuration option for
-       the marker.  These same option-value pairs may be used with the  marker
-       configure  command to change the marker's configuration.  The following
-       options are supported for polygon markers:
-
-       -dashes dashList
-              Sets the dash style of the outline of the polygon. DashList is a
-              list  of up to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths
-              of the dashes and gaps on the  outline.   Each  number  must  be
-              between  1  and  255.  If  dashList is "", the outline will be a
-              solid line.
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets the fill color of the polygon.  If color is  "",  then  the
-              interior of the polygon is transparent.  The default is white.
-
-       -linewidth pixels
-              Sets the width of the outline of the polygon. If pixels is zero,
-              no outline is drawn. The default is 0.
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets the color of the outline of the polygon.  If the polygon is
-              stippled  (see  the  -stipple  option), then this represents the
-              foreground color of the stipple.  The default is black.
-
-       the marker's configure operation.
-
-       The following options are specific to text markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor tells how to position the text relative to the  position-
-              ing  point  for  the text. For example, if anchor is center then
-              the text is centered on the point; if anchor is n then the  text
-              will  be drawn such that the top center point of the rectangular
-              region occupied by the text will be at  the  positioning  point.
-              This default is center.
-
-       -background color
-              Same as the -fill option.
-
-       -font fontName
-              Specifies  the  font  of  the text.  The default is *-Helvetica-
-              Bold-R-Normal-*-120-*.
-
-       -fill color
-              Sets the background color of the text.  If color  is  the  empty
-              string,  no  background  will be transparent.  The default back-
-              ground color is "".
-
-       -foreground color
-              Same as the -outline option.
-
-       -justify justify
-              Specifies how the text should be justified.  This  matters  only
-              when  the  marker  contains  more than one line of text. Justify
-              must be left, right, or center.  The default is center.
-
-       -outline color
-              Sets the color of the text. The default value is black.
-
-       -padx pad
-              Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors  of  the  text.
-              Pad  can  be  a list of one or two screen distances.  If pad has
-              two elements, the left side of the text is padded by  the  first
-              distance  and the right side by the second.  If pad has just one
-              distance, both the left and right sides are padded evenly.   The
-              default is 4.
-
-       -pady pad
-              Sets the padding above and below the text.  Pad can be a list of
-              one or two screen distances.  If pad has two elements, the  area
-              above  the  text  is  padded  by the first distance and the area
-              below by the second.  If pad is just one distance, both the  top
-              and bottom areas are padded evenly.  The default is 4.
-
-       -rotate theta
-              Specifies  the number of degrees to rotate the text.  Theta is a
-
-       option-value pairs may be used with the marker's configure command.
-
-       The following options are specific to window markers:
-
-       -anchor anchor
-              Anchor tells how to position the widget relative  to  the  posi-
-              tioning  point  for the widget. For example, if anchor is center
-              then the widget is centered on the point; if anchor  is  n  then
-              the  widget  will be displayed such that the top center point of
-              the rectangular region occupied by the widget  will  be  at  the
-              positioning point.  This option defaults to center.
-
-       -height pixels
-              Specifies  the height to assign to the marker's window.  If this
-              option isn't specified, or if it is specified as  "",  then  the
-              window  is given whatever height the widget requests internally.
-
-       -width pixels
-              Specifies the width to assign to the marker's window.   If  this
-              option  isn't  specified,  or if it is specified as "", then the
-              window is given whatever width the widget requests internally.
-
-       -window pathName
-              Specifies the widget to be managed by the graph.  PathName  must
-              be a child of the graph widget.
-
-
-
-

GRAPH COMPONENT BINDINGS

-       Specific  graph  components,  such  as  elements,  markers  and  legend
-       entries, can have a command trigger when event  occurs  in  them,  much
-       like  canvas  items in Tk's canvas widget.  Not all event sequences are
-       valid.  The only binding events that may be specified are those related
-       to  the  mouse and keyboard (such as Enter, Leave, ButtonPress, Motion,
-       and KeyPress).
-
-       Only one element or marker can be picked during an event.  This  means,
-       that  if  the mouse is directly over both an element and a marker, only
-       the uppermost component  is  selected.   This  isn't  true  for  legend
-       entries.   Both  a legend entry and an element (or marker) binding com-
-       mands will be invoked if both items are picked.
-
-       It is possible for multiple bindings to match a particular event.  This
-       could occur, for example, if one binding is associated with the element
-       name and another is associated with one of the element's tags (see  the
-       -bindtags  option).  When this occurs, all of the matching bindings are
-       invoked.  A binding associated with the element name is invoked  first,
-       followed  by  one binding for each of the element's bindtags.  If there
-       are multiple matching bindings for a single tag,  then  only  the  most
-       specific  binding  is  invoked.  A continue command in a binding script
-       terminates that script, and a break command terminates that script  and
-       skips  any  remaining  scripts for the event, just as for the bind com-
-       mand.
-
-       vectors are updated.
-
-       From  Tcl,  create  the  vectors and configure the element to use them.
-       vector X Y .g element configure line1 -xdata X -ydata  Y  To  set  data
-       points  from  C,  you  pass  the  values as arrays of doubles using the
-       Blt_ResetVector call.  The vector is reset with the new data and at the
-       next  idle  point (when Tk re-enters its event loop), the graph will be
-       redrawn automatically.  #include <tcl.h> #include <blt.h>
-
-       register int i; Blt_Vector *xVec, *yVec; double x[50], y[50];
-
-       /* Get the BLT vectors "X" and "Y"  (created  above  from  Tcl)  */  if
-       ((Blt_GetVector(interp, "X", &xVec) != TCL_OK) ||
-           (Blt_GetVector(interp, "Y", &yVec) != TCL_OK)) {
-           return TCL_ERROR; }
-
-       for (i = 0; i < 50; i++) {
-           x[i] = i * 0.02;
-           y[i] = sin(x[i]); }
-
-       /*  Put  the data into BLT vectors */ if ((Blt_ResetVector(xVec, x, 50,
-       50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK) ||
-           (Blt_ResetVector(yVec, y, 50, 50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK)) {
-          return TCL_ERROR; } See the vector manual page for more details.
-
-
-
-

SPEED TIPS

-       There may be cases where the graph needs to be  drawn  and  updated  as
-       quickly  as possible.  If drawing speed becomes a big problem, here are
-       a few tips to speed up displays.
-
-       o Try to minimize the number of data points.  The more data points  the
-         looked at, the more work the graph must do.
-
-       o If your data is generated as floating point values, the time required
-         to convert the data values to and from ASCII strings can be  signifi-
-         cant,  especially when there any many data points.  You can avoid the
-         redundant string-to-decimal conversions using the C API to  BLT  vec-
-         tors.
-
-       o Data  elements  without  symbols  are drawn faster than with symbols.
-         Set the data element's -symbol option to none.  If you need  to  draw
-         symbols, try using the simple symbols such as splus and scross.
-
-       o Don't stipple or dash the element.  Solid lines are much faster.
-
-       o If  you update data elements frequently, try turning off the widget's
-         -bufferelements option.  When the graph is first displayed, it  draws
-         data  elements  into an internal pixmap.  The pixmap acts as a cache,
-         so that when the graph needs to be redrawn again, and the  data  ele-
-         ments or coordinate axes haven't changed, the pixmap is simply copied
-         to the screen.  This is especially useful when you are using  markers
-         to  highlight  points  and regions on the graph.  But if the graph is
-
-
-
-BLT                               BLT_VERSION                         graph(n)
-
-
-
-Man(1) output converted with -man2html -
- - diff --git a/tkblt/doc/graph.n b/tkblt/doc/graph.n deleted file mode 100644 index fbbbb9b..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/graph.n +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2408 +0,0 @@ -'\" -'\" Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA -'\" This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made -'\" available under the same terms. -'\" -'\" Copyright 1991-1998 by Bell Labs Innovations for Lucent Technologies. -'\" -'\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its -'\" documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided -'\" that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that the -'\" copyright notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting documentation, -'\" and that the names of Lucent Technologies any of their entities not be used -'\" in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software -'\" without specific, written prior permission. -'\" -'\" Lucent Technologies disclaims all warranties with regard to this software, -'\" including all implied warranties of merchantability and fitness. In no event -'\" shall Lucent Technologies be liable for any special, indirect or -'\" consequential damages or any damages whatsoever resulting from loss of use, -'\" data or profits, whether in an action of contract, negligence or other -'\" tortuous action, arising out of or in connection with the use or performance -'\" of this software. -'\" -'\" Graph widget created by Sani Nassif and George Howlett. -'\" -.TH graph n BLT_VERSION BLT "BLT Built-In Commands" -.BS -'\" Note: do not modify the .SH NAME line immediately below! -.SH NAME -graph \- 2D graph for plotting X\-Y coordinate data. -.SH SYNOPSIS -\fBgraph\fI \fIpathName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.BE -.SH DESCRIPTION -The \fBgraph\fR command creates a graph for plotting -two-dimensional data (X\-Y coordinates). It has many configurable -components: coordinate axes, elements, legend, grid lines, cross -hairs, etc. They allow you to customize the look and feel of the -graph. -.SH INTRODUCTION -The \fBgraph\fR command creates a new window for plotting -two-dimensional data (X\-Y coordinates). Data points are plotted in a -rectangular area displayed in the center of the new window. This is the -\fIplotting area\fR. The coordinate axes are drawn in the -margins around the plotting area. By default, the legend is displayed -in the right margin. The title is displayed in top margin. -.PP -The \fBgraph\fR widget is composed of several components: coordinate -axes, data elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, pens, postscript, and -annotation markers. -.TP 1i -\f(CWaxis\fR -The graph has four standard axes (\f(CWx\fR, \f(CWx2\fR, -\f(CWy\fR, and \f(CWy2\fR), but you can create and display any number -of axes. Axes control what region of data is -displayed and how the data is scaled. Each axis consists of the axis -line, title, major and minor ticks, and tick labels. Tick labels -display the value at each major tick. -.TP 1i -\f(CWcrosshairs\fR -Cross hairs are used to position the mouse pointer relative to the X -and Y coordinate axes. Two perpendicular lines, intersecting at the -current location of the mouse, extend across the plotting area to the -coordinate axes. -.TP 1i -\f(CWelement\fR -An element represents a set of data points. Elements can be plotted -with a symbol at each data point and lines connecting the points. -The appearance of the element, such as its symbol, line width, and -color is configurable. -.TP 1i -\f(CWgrid\fR -Extends the major and minor ticks of the X\-axis and/or Y\-axis across the -plotting area. -.TP 1i -\f(CWlegend\fR -The legend displays the name and symbol of each data element. -The legend can be drawn in any margin or in the plotting area. -.TP 1i -\f(CWmarker\fR -Markers are used annotate or highlight areas of the graph. For -example, you could use a polygon marker to fill an area under a -curve, or a text marker to label a particular data point. Markers -come in various forms: text strings, bitmaps, connected line -segments, images, polygons, or embedded widgets. -.TP 1i -\f(CWpen\fR -Pens define attributes (both symbol and line style) for elements. -Data elements use pens to specify how they should be drawn. A data -element may use many pens at once. Here, the particular pen -used for a data point is determined from each element's weight -vector (see the element's \fB\-weight\fR and \fB\-style\fR options). -.TP 1i -\f(CWpostscript\fR -The widget can generate encapsulated PostScript output. This component -has several options to configure how the PostScript is generated. -.SH SYNTAX -.DS -\fBgraph \fIpathName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -The \fBgraph\fR command creates a new window \fIpathName\fR and makes -it into a \fBgraph\fR widget. At the time this command is invoked, there -must not exist a window named \fIpathName\fR, but \fIpathName\fR's -parent must exist. Additional options may be specified on the -command line or in the option database to configure aspects of the -graph such as its colors and font. See the \fBconfigure\fR operation -below for the exact details about what \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are valid. -.PP -If successful, \fBgraph\fR returns the path name of the widget. It -also creates a new Tcl command by the same name. You can use this -command to invoke various operations that query or modify the graph. -The general form is: -.DS -\fIpathName \fIoperation\fR \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -Both \fIoperation\fR and its arguments determine the exact behavior of -the command. The operations available for the graph are described in -the -.SB "GRAPH OPERATIONS" -section. -.PP -The command can also be used to access components of the graph. -.DS -\fIpathName component operation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -The operation, now located after the name of the component, is the -function to be performed on that component. Each component has its own -set of operations that manipulate that component. They will be -described below in their own sections. -.SH EXAMPLE -The \fBgraph\fR command creates a new graph. -.CS -# Create a new graph. Plotting area is black. -graph .g \-plotbackground black -.CE -A new Tcl command \f(CW.g\fR is also created. This command can be used -to query and modify the graph. For example, to change the title of -the graph to "My Plot", you use the new command and the graph's -\fBconfigure\fR operation. -.CS -# Change the title. -\&.g configure \-title "My Plot" -.CE -A graph has several components. To access a particular component you -use the component's name. For example, to add data elements, you use -the new command and the \fBelement\fR component. -.CS -# Create a new element named "line1" -\&.g element create line1 \\ - \-xdata { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 } \\ - \-ydata { 26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 - 155.85 166.60 175.38 } -.CE -The element's X-Y coordinates are specified using lists of -numbers. Alternately, BLT vectors could be used to hold the X\-Y -coordinates. -.CS -# Create two vectors and add them to the graph. -vector xVec yVec -xVec set { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 } -yVec set { 26.18 50.46 72.85 93.31 111.86 128.47 143.14 155.85 - 166.60 175.38 } -\&.g element create line1 \-xdata xVec \-ydata yVec -.CE -The advantage of using vectors is that when you modify one, the graph -is automatically redrawn to reflect the new values. -.CS -# Change the y coordinate of the first point. -set yVector(0) 25.18 -.CE -An element named \f(CWe1\fR is now created in \f(CW.b\fR. It -is automatically added to the display list of elements. You can -use this list to control in what order elements are displayed. -To query or reset the element display list, you use the element's -\fBshow\fR operation. -.CS -# Get the current display list -set elemList [.b element show] -# Remove the first element so it won't be displayed. -\&.b element show [lrange $elemList 0 end] -.CE -The element will be displayed by as many bars as there are data points -(in this case there are ten). The bars will be drawn centered at the -x-coordinate of the data point. All the bars will have the same -attributes (colors, stipple, etc). The width of each bar is by -default one unit. You can change this with using the \fB\-barwidth\fR -option. -.CS -# Change the X\-Y coordinates of the first point. -set xVec(0) 0.18 -set yVec(0) 25.18 -.CE -An element named \f(CWline1\fR is now created in \f(CW.g\fR. By -default, the element's label in the legend will be also \f(CWline1\fR. -You can change the label, or specify no legend entry, again using the -element's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.CS -# Don't display "line1" in the legend. -\&.g element configure line1 \-label "" -.CE -You can configure more than just the element's label. An element has -many attributes such as symbol type and size, dashed or solid lines, -colors, line width, etc. -.CS -\&.g element configure line1 \-symbol square \-color red \\ - \-dashes { 2 4 2 } \-linewidth 2 \-pixels 2c -.CE -Four coordinate axes are automatically created: \f(CWx\fR, \f(CWx2\fR, -\f(CWy\fR, and \f(CWy2\fR. And by default, elements are mapped onto the -axes \f(CWx\fR and \f(CWy\fR. This can be changed with the \fB\-mapx\fR -and \fB\-mapy\fR options. -.CS -# Map "line1" on the alternate Y\-axis "y2". -\&.g element configure line1 \-mapy y2 -.CE -Axes can be configured in many ways too. For example, you change the -scale of the Y\-axis from linear to log using the \fBaxis\fR component. -.CS -# Y\-axis is log scale. -\&.g axis configure y \-logscale yes -.CE -One important way axes are used is to zoom in on a particular data -region. Zooming is done by simply specifying new axis limits using -the \fB\-min\fR and \fB\-max\fR configuration options. -.CS -\&.g axis configure x \-min 1.0 \-max 1.5 -\&.g axis configure y \-min 12.0 \-max 55.15 -.CE -To zoom interactively, you link the \fBaxis configure\fR operations with -some user interaction (such as pressing the mouse button), using the -\fBbind\fR command. To convert between screen and graph coordinates, -use the \fBinvtransform\fR operation. -.CS -# Click the button to set a new minimum -bind .g { - %W axis configure x \-min [%W axis invtransform x %x] - %W axis configure x \-min [%W axis invtransform x %y] -} -.CE -By default, the limits of the axis are determined from data values. -To reset back to the default limits, set the \fB\-min\fR and -\fB\-max\fR options to the empty value. -.CS -# Reset the axes to autoscale again. -\&.g axis configure x \-min {} \-max {} -\&.g axis configure y \-min {} \-max {} -.CE -By default, the legend is drawn in the right margin. You can -change this or any legend configuration options using the -\fBlegend\fR component. -.CS -# Configure the legend font, color, and relief -\&.g legend configure \-position left \-relief raised \\ - \-font fixed \-fg blue -.CE -To prevent the legend from being displayed, turn on the \fB\-hide\fR -option. -.CS -# Don't display the legend. -\&.g legend configure \-hide yes\fR -.CE -The \fBgraph\fR widget has simple drawing procedures called markers. -They can be used to highlight or annotate data in the graph. The types -of markers available are bitmaps, images, polygons, lines, or windows. -Markers can be used, for example, to mark or brush points. In this -example, is a text marker that labels the data first point. Markers -are created using the \fBmarker\fR component. -.CS -# Create a label for the first data point of "line1". -\&.g marker create text \-name first_marker \-coords { 0.2 26.18 } \\ - \-text "start" \-anchor se \-xoffset -10 \-yoffset -10 -.CE -This creates a text marker named \f(CWfirst_marker\fR. It will display -the text "start" near the coordinates of the first data point. The -\fB\-anchor\fR, \fB\-xoffset\fR, and \fB\-yoffset\fR options are used -to display the marker above and to the left of the data point, so that -the data point isn't covered by the marker. By default, -markers are drawn last, on top of data. You can change this with the -\fB\-under\fR option. -.CS -# Draw the label before elements are drawn. -\&.g marker configure first_marker \-under yes -.CE -You can add cross hairs or grid lines using the \fBcrosshairs\fR and -\fBgrid\fR components. -.CS -# Display both cross hairs and grid lines. -\&.g crosshairs configure \-hide no \-color red -\&.g grid configure \-hide no \-dashes { 2 2 } -# Set up a binding to reposition the crosshairs. -bind .g { - .g crosshairs configure -position @%x,%y -} -.CE -The crosshairs are repositioned as the mouse pointer is moved -in the graph. The pointer X-Y coordinates define the center -of the crosshairs. -.PP -Finally, to get hardcopy of the graph, use the \fBpostscript\fR -component. -.CS -# Print the graph into file "file.ps" -\&.g postscript output file.ps \-maxpect yes \-decorations no -.CE -This generates a file \f(CWfile.ps\fR containing the encapsulated -PostScript of the graph. The option \fB\-maxpect\fR says to scale the -plot to the size of the page. Turning off the \fB\-decorations\fR -option denotes that no borders or color backgrounds should be -drawn (i.e. the background of the margins, legend, and plotting -area will be white). -.SH "GRAPH OPERATIONS" -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "AXIS COMPONENTS" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBbar \fIelemName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new barchart element \fIelemName\fR. It's an -error if an element \fIelemName\fR already exists. -See the manual for \fBbarchart\fR for details about -what \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are valid. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcget\fR \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below for the \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBconfigure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of the graph. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. -The following options are valid. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-aspect \fIwidth/height\fR -Force a fixed aspect ratio of \fIwidth/height\fR, a floating point number. -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color. This includes the margins and -legend, but not the plotting area. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3\-D border around the outside edge of the widget. The -\fB\-relief\fR option determines if the border is to be drawn. The -default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bottommargin \fIpixels\fR -If non-zero, overrides the computed size of the margin extending -below the X\-coordinate axis. -If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the automatically computed size is used. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bufferelements \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether an internal pixmap to buffer the display of data -elements should be used. If \fIboolean\fR is true, data elements are -drawn to an internal pixmap. This option is especially useful when -the graph is redrawn frequently while the remains data unchanged (for -example, moving a marker across the plot). See the -.SB "SPEED TIPS" -section. -The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-cursor \fIcursor\fR -Specifies the widget's cursor. The default cursor is \f(CWcrosshair\fR. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font of the graph title. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-18-180-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-halo \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a maximum distance to consider when searching for the -closest data point (see the element's \fBclosest\fR operation below). -Data points further than \fIpixels\fR away are ignored. The default is -\f(CW0.5i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the requested height of widget. The default is -\f(CW4i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-invertxy \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the placement X\-axis and Y\-axis should be inverted. If -\fIboolean\fR is true, the X and Y axes are swapped. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the title should be justified. This matters only when -the title contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR must be -\f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-leftmargin \fIpixels\fR -If non-zero, overrides the computed size of the margin extending -from the left edge of the window to the Y\-coordinate axis. -If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the automatically computed size is used. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotbackground \fIcolor\fR -Specifies the background color of the plotting area. The default is -\f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotborderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the plotting area. The -\fB\-plotrelief\fR option determines if a border is drawn. The -default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotpadx \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of padding to be added to the left and right sides of -the plotting area. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen -distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the left side of the -plotting area entry is padded by the first distance and the right side -by the second. If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the left and -right sides are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW8\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotpady \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of padding to be added to the top and bottom of the -plotting area. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen -distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the top of the plotting -area is padded by the first distance and the bottom by the second. If -\fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and bottom are padded -evenly. The default is \f(CW8\fR. -.TP -\fB\-plotrelief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the plotting area. \fIRelief\fR -specifies how the interior of the plotting area should appear relative -to rest of the graph; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the plot should -appear to protrude from the graph, relative to the surface of the -graph. The default is \f(CWsunken\fR. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the graph widget. \fIRelief\fR -specifies how the graph should appear relative to widget it is packed -into; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the graph should -appear to protrude. The default is \f(CWflat\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rightmargin \fIpixels\fR -If non-zero, overrides the computed size of the margin extending -from the plotting area to the right edge of -the window. By default, the legend is drawn in this margin. -If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the automatically computed size is used. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-takefocus\fR \fIfocus\fR -Provides information used when moving the focus from window to window -via keyboard traversal (e.g., Tab and Shift-Tab). If \fIfocus\fR is -\f(CW0\fR, this means that this window should be skipped entirely during -keyboard traversal. \f(CW1\fR means that the this window should always -receive the input focus. An empty value means that the traversal -scripts make the decision whether to focus on the window. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tile \fIimage\fR -Specifies a tiled background for the widget. If \fIimage\fR isn't -\f(CW""\fR, the background is tiled using \fIimage\fR. -Otherwise, the normal background color is drawn (see the -\fB\-background\fR option). \fIImage\fR must be an image created -using the Tk \fBimage\fR command. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-title \fItext\fR -Sets the title to \fItext\fR. If \fItext\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -no title will be displayed. -.TP -\fB\-topmargin \fIpixels\fR -If non-zero, overrides the computed size of the margin above the x2 -axis. If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, the automatically computed size -is used. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the requested width of the widget. The default is -\f(CW5i\fR. -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR? -See the -.SB "CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "ELEMENT COMPONENTS" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBextents \fIitem\fR -Returns the size of a particular item in the graph. \fIItem\fR must -be either \f(CWleftmargin\fR, \f(CWrightmargin\fR, \f(CWtopmargin\fR, -\f(CWbottommargin\fR, \f(CWplotwidth\fR, or \f(CWplotheight\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "GRID COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBinvtransform \fIwinX winY\fR -Performs an inverse coordinate transformation, mapping window -coordinates back to graph coordinates, using the standard X\-axis and Y\-axis. -Returns a list of containing the X-Y graph coordinates. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBinside \fIx y\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR is the designated screen coordinate (\fIx\fR and \fIy\fR) -is inside the plotting area and \f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "LEGEND COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBline\fB operation arg\fR... -The operation is the same as \fBelement\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "MARKER COMPONENTS" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript \fIoperation \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT" -section. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBsnap \fR?\fIswitches\fR? \fIoutputName\fR -Takes a snapshot of the graph, saving the output in \fIoutputName\fR. -The following switches are available. -.RS -.TP 1i -\fB\-format\fR \fIformat\fR -Specifies how the snapshot is output. \fIFormat\fR may be one of -the following listed below. The default is \f(CWphoto\fR. -.RS -.TP -\f(CWphoto\fR -Saves a Tk photo image. \fIOutputName\fR represents the name of a -Tk photo image that must already have been created. -.TP -\f(CWwmf\fR -Saves an Aldus Placeable Metafile. \fIOutputName\fR represents the -filename where the metafile is written. If \fIoutputName\fR is -\f(CWCLIPBOARD\fR, then output is written directly to the Windows -clipboard. This format is available only under Microsoft Windows. -.TP -\f(CWemf\fR -Saves an Enhanced Metafile. \fIOutputName\fR represents the filename -where the metafile is written. If \fIoutputName\fR is -\f(CWCLIPBOARD\fR, then output is written directly to the Windows -clipboard. This format is available only under Microsoft Windows. -.RE -.TP 1i -\fB\-height\fR \fIsize\fR -Specifies the height of the graph. \fISize\fR is a screen distance. -The graph will be redrawn using this dimension, rather than its -current window height. -.TP 1i -\fB\-width\fR \fIsize\fR -Specifies the width of the graph. \fISize\fR is a screen distance. -The graph will be redrawn using this dimension, rather than its -current window width. -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBtransform \fIx y\fR -Performs a coordinate transformation, mapping graph coordinates to -window coordinates, using the standard X\-axis and Y\-axis. -Returns a list containing the X\-Y screen coordinates. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBxaxis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fBx2axis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fByaxis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fBy2axis \fIoperation\fR ?\fIarg\fR?... -See the -.SB "AXIS COMPONENTS" -section. -.SH "GRAPH COMPONENTS" -A graph is composed of several components: coordinate axes, data -elements, legend, grid, cross hairs, postscript, and annotation -markers. Instead of one big set of configuration options and -operations, the graph is partitioned, where each component has its own -configuration options and operations that specifically control that -aspect or part of the graph. -.SS "AXIS COMPONENTS" -Four coordinate axes are automatically created: two X\-coordinate axes -(\f(CWx\fR and \f(CWx2\fR) and two Y\-coordinate axes (\f(CWy\fR, and -\f(CWy2\fR). By default, the axis \f(CWx\fR is located in the bottom -margin, \f(CWy\fR in the left margin, \f(CWx2\fR in the top margin, and -\f(CWy2\fR in the right margin. -.PP -An axis consists of the axis line, title, major and minor ticks, and -tick labels. Major ticks are drawn at uniform intervals along the -axis. Each tick is labeled with its coordinate value. Minor ticks -are drawn at uniform intervals within major ticks. -.PP -The range of the axis controls what region of data is plotted. -Data points outside the minimum and maximum limits of the axis are -not plotted. By default, the minimum and maximum limits are -determined from the data, but you can reset either limit. -.PP -You can have several axes. To create an axis, invoke -the axis component and its create operation. -.CS -# Create a new axis called "tempAxis" -\&.g axis create tempAxis -.CE -You map data elements to an axis using the element's \-mapy and \-mapx -configuration options. They specify the coordinate axes an element -is mapped onto. -.CS -# Now map the tempAxis data to this axis. -\&.g element create "e1" \-xdata $x \-ydata $y \-mapy tempAxis -.CE -Any number of axes can be displayed simultaneously. They are drawn in -the margins surrounding the plotting area. The default axes \f(CWx\fR -and \f(CWy\fR are drawn in the bottom and left margins. The axes -\f(CWx2\fR and \f(CWy2\fR are drawn in top and right margins. By -default, only \f(CWx\fR and \f(CWy\fR are shown. Note that the axes -can have different scales. -.PP -To display a different axis or more than one axis, you invoke one of -the following components: \fBxaxis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, and -\fBy2axis\fR. Each component has a \fBuse\fR operation that -designates the axis (or axes) to be drawn in that corresponding -margin: \fBxaxis\fR in the bottom, \fByaxis\fR in the left, -\fBx2axis\fR in the top, and \fBy2axis\fR in the right. -.CS -# Display the axis tempAxis in the left margin. -\&.g yaxis use tempAxis -.CE -The \fBuse\fR operation takes a list of axis names as its last -argument. This is the list of axes to be drawn in this margin. -.PP -You can configure axes in many ways. The axis scale can be linear or -logarithmic. The values along the axis can either monotonically -increase or decrease. If you need custom tick labels, you can specify -a Tcl procedure to format the label any way you wish. You can control -how ticks are drawn, by changing the major tick interval or the number -of minor ticks. You can define non-uniform tick intervals, such as -for time-series plots. -.PP -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for an axis with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on graph axes, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBcget \fIaxisName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the option given by \fIoption\fR for -\fIaxisName\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the axis \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBconfigure \fIaxisName \fR?\fIaxisName\fR?... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of \fIaxisName\fR. -Several axes can be changed. If \fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list -describing all the current options for \fIaxisName\fR is returned. If -\fIoption\fR is specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing -\fIoption\fR is returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are specified, then for each pair, the axis option \fIoption\fR -is set to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for axes. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for the axis. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events for axes are handled. Each tag in the list matching the current event -sequence will have its Tcl command executed. Implicitly the name of -the element is always the first tag in the list. The default value is -\f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the axis and tick labels. -The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-descending \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the values along the axis are monotonically increasing or -decreasing. If \fIboolean\fR is true, the axis values will be -decreasing. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates if the axis is displayed. If \fIboolean\fR is false the axis -will be displayed. Any element mapped to the axis is displayed regardless. -The default value is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the axis title should be justified. This matters only -when the axis title contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR -must be \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-limits \fIformatStr\fR -Specifies a printf-like description to format the minimum and maximum -limits of the axis. The limits are displayed at the top/bottom or -left/right sides of the plotting area. \fIFormatStr\fR is a list of -one or two format descriptions. If one description is supplied, both -the minimum and maximum limits are formatted in the same way. If two, -the first designates the format for the minimum limit, the second for -the maximum. If \f(CW""\fR is given as either description, then -the that limit will not be displayed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the axis and tick lines. The default is \f(CW1\fR -pixel. -.TP -\fB\-logscale \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the scale of the axis is logarithmic or linear. If -\fIboolean\fR is true, the axis is logarithmic. The default scale is -linear. -.TP -\fB\-loose \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the limits of the axis should fit the data points tightly, -at the outermost data points, or loosely, at the outer tick intervals. -If the axis limit is set with the -min or -max option, the axes are -displayed tightly. -If \fIboolean\fR is true, the axis range is "loose". -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-majorticks \fImajorList\fR -Specifies where to display major axis ticks. You can use this option -to display ticks at non-uniform intervals. \fIMajorList\fR is a list -of axis coordinates designating the location of major ticks. No -minor ticks are drawn. If \fImajorList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -major ticks will be automatically computed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-max \fIvalue\fR -Sets the maximum limit of \fIaxisName\fR. Any data point greater -than \fIvalue\fR is not displayed. If \fIvalue\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the maximum limit is calculated using the largest data value. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-min \fIvalue\fR -Sets the minimum limit of \fIaxisName\fR. Any data point less than -\fIvalue\fR is not displayed. If \fIvalue\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the minimum limit is calculated using the smallest data value. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-minorticks \fIminorList\fR -Specifies where to display minor axis ticks. You can use this option -to display minor ticks at non-uniform intervals. \fIMinorList\fR is a -list of real values, ranging from 0.0 to 1.0, designating the placement of -a minor tick. No minor ticks are drawn if the \fB\-majortick\fR -option is also set. If \fIminorList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, minor ticks will -be automatically computed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Specifies the how many degrees to rotate the axis tick labels. -\fITheta\fR is a real value representing the number of degrees -to rotate the tick labels. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR degrees. -.TP -\fB\-scrollcommand \fIcommand\fR -Specify the prefix for a command used to communicate with scrollbars -for this axis, such as \fI.sbar set\fP. -.TP -\fB\-scrollmax \fIvalue\fR -Sets the maximum limit of the axis scroll region. If \fIvalue\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, the maximum limit is calculated using the largest data -value. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-scrollmin \fIvalue\fR -Sets the minimum limit of axis scroll region. If \fIvalue\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, the minimum limit is calculated using the smallest data -value. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-showticks \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether axis ticks should be drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is -true, ticks are drawn. If false, only the -axis line is drawn. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stepsize \fIvalue\fR -Specifies the interval between major axis ticks. If \fIvalue\fR isn't -a valid interval (must be less than the axis range), -the request is ignored and the step size is automatically calculated. -.TP -\fB\-subdivisions \fInumber\fR -Indicates how many minor axis ticks are -to be drawn. For example, if \fInumber\fR is two, only one minor -tick is drawn. If \fInumber\fR is one, no minor ticks are -displayed. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tickfont \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font for axis tick labels. The default is -\f(CW*-Courier-Bold-R-Normal-*-100-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tickformat\fR \fIformatStr\fR -Specifies a printf-like description to format teh axis -tick labels. You can get the standard tick labels again by -setting \fIformatStr\fR to \f(CW""\fR. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-tickformatcommand\fR, \fB\-command \fIprefix\fR -Specifies a Tcl command to be invoked when formatting the axis tick -labels. \fIPrefix\fR is a string containing the name of a Tcl proc and -any extra arguments for the procedure. This command is invoked for each -major tick on the axis. Two additional arguments are passed to the -procedure: the pathname of the widget and the current the numeric -value of the tick. The procedure returns the formatted tick label. If -\f(CW""\fR is returned, no label will appear next to the tick. You can -get the standard tick labels again by setting \fIprefix\fR to -\f(CW""\fR. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.sp 1 -The numeric value for the tick might change when using the -\fB\-logscale\fR and \fB\-tickformat\fR options. -.sp 1 -Please note that this procedure is invoked while the graph is redrawn. -You may query configuration options. But do not them, because this -can have unexpected results. -.TP -\fB\-ticklength \fIpixels\fR -Sets the length of major and minor ticks (minor ticks are half the -length of major ticks). If \fIpixels\fR is less than zero, the axis -will be inverted with ticks drawn pointing towards the plot. The -default is \f(CW0.1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-title \fItext\fR -Sets the title of the axis. If \fItext\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, no axis title will be displayed. -.TP -\fB\-titlealternate \fIboolean\fR -Indicates to display the axis title in its alternate location. -Normally the axis title is centered along the axis. This option -places the axis either to the right (horizontal axes) or above -(vertical axes) the axis. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-titlecolor \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the axis title. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-titlefont \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font for axis title. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-14-140-*\fR. -.PP -Axis configuration options may be also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource class is \f(CWAxis\fR. The resource names -are the names of the axes (such as \f(CWx\fR or \f(CWx2\fR). -.CS -option add *Graph.Axis.Color blue -option add *Graph.x.LogScale true -option add *Graph.x2.LogScale false -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBcreate \fIaxisName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new axis by the name \fIaxisName\fR. No axis by the same -name can already exist. \fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR are described -in above in the axis \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis \fBdelete \fR?\fIaxisName\fR?... -Deletes the named axes. An axis is not really -deleted until it is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete -axes mapped to elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis invtransform \fIaxisName value\fR -Performs the inverse transformation, changing the screen coordinate -\fIvalue\fR to a graph coordinate, mapping the value mapped to -\fIaxisName\fR. Returns the graph coordinate. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis limits \fIaxisName\fR -Returns a list of the minimum and maximum limits for \fIaxisName\fR. The order -of the list is \f(CWmin max\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns a list of axes matching zero or more patterns. If no -\fIpattern\fR argument is give, the names of all axes are returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis transform \fIaxisName value\fR -Transforms the coordinate \fIvalue\fR to a screen coordinate by mapping -the it to \fIaxisName\fR. Returns the transformed screen coordinate. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBaxis view \fIaxisName\fR -Change the viewable area of this axis. Use as an argument to a scrollbar's "\fI\-command\fR". -.PP -The default axes are \f(CWx\fR, \f(CWy\fR, \f(CWx2\fR, and \f(CWy2\fR. -But you can display more than four axes simultaneously. You can also -swap in a different axis with \fBuse\fR operation of the special axis -components: \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR. -.CS -\&.g create axis temp -\&.g create axis time -\&... -\&.g xaxis use temp -\&.g yaxis use time -.CE -Only the axes specified for use are displayed on the screen. -.PP -The \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR -components operate on an axis location rather than a specific axis -like the more general \fBaxis\fR component does. They implicitly -control the axis that is currently using to that location. By -default, \fBxaxis\fR uses the \f(CWx\fR axis, \fByaxis\fR uses -\f(CWy\fR, \fBx2axis\fR uses \f(CWx2\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR uses -\f(CWy2\fR. When more than one axis is displayed in a margin, it -represents the first axis displayed. -.PP -The following operations are available for axes. They mirror exactly -the operations of the \fBaxis\fR component. The \fIaxis\fR argument -must be \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, \fByaxis\fR, or \fBy2axis\fR. This -feature is deprecated since more than one axis can now be used a -margin. You should only use the \fBxaxis\fR, \fBx2axis\fR, -\fByaxis\fR, and \fBy2axis\fR components with the \fBuse\fR operation. -For all other operations, use the general \fBaxis\fR component -instead. -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBcget \fIoption\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBconfigure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB invtransform \fIvalue\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis \fBlimits\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB transform \fIvalue\fR -.TP -\fIpathName \fIaxis\fB use \fR?\fIaxisName\fR? -Designates the axis \fIaxisName\fR is to be displayed at this -location. \fIAxisName\fR can not be already in use at another location. -This command returns the name of the axis currently using this location. -.SS "CROSSHAIRS COMPONENT" -Cross hairs consist of two intersecting lines (one vertical and one horizontal) -drawn completely across the plotting area. They are used to position -the mouse in relation to the coordinate axes. Cross hairs differ from line -markers in that they are implemented using XOR drawing primitives. -This means that they can be quickly drawn and erased without redrawing -the entire graph. -.PP -The following operations are available for cross hairs: -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the cross hairs configuration option -given by \fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option -described below for the cross hairs \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of the cross hairs. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing all the current -options for the cross hairs is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the cross hairs option \fIoption\fR is set to -\fIvalue\fR. -The following options are available for cross hairs. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the cross hairs. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the cross hairs. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up -to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes -and gaps on the cross hair lines. Each number must be between 1 and -255. If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the cross hairs will be solid -lines. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether cross hairs are drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is true, -cross hairs are not drawn. The default is \f(CWyes\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Set the width of the cross hair lines. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-position \fIpos\fR -Specifies the screen position where the cross hairs intersect. -\fIPos\fR must be in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", where \fIx\fR and \fIy\fR -are the window coordinates of the intersection. -.PP -Cross hairs configuration options may be also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are -\f(CWcrosshairs\fR and \f(CWCrosshairs\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Graph.Crosshairs.LineWidth 2 -option add *Graph.Crosshairs.Color red -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs off\fR -Turns off the cross hairs. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs on\fR -Turns on the display of the cross hairs. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBcrosshairs toggle\fR -Toggles the current state of the cross hairs, alternately mapping and -unmapping the cross hairs. -.SS "ELEMENT COMPONENTS" -A data element represents a set of data. It contains x and y vectors -containing the coordinates of the data points. Elements can be -displayed with a symbol at each data point and lines connecting the -points. Elements also control the appearance of the data, such as the -symbol type, line width, color etc. -.PP -When new data elements are created, they are automatically added to a -list of displayed elements. The display list controls what elements -are drawn and in what order. -.PP -The following operations are available for elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement activate \fIelemName \fR?\fIindex\fR?... -Specifies the data points of element \fIelemName\fR to be drawn -using active foreground and background colors. \fIElemName\fR is the -name of the element and \fIindex\fR is a number representing the index -of the data point. If no indices are present then all data points -become active. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for an element with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on graph elements, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement cget \fIelemName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the element configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any of the options described below -for the element \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement closest \fIx y\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... ?\fIelemName\fR?... -Searches for the data point closest to the window coordinates \fIx\fR -and \fIy\fR. By default, all elements are searched. Hidden elements -(see the \fB\-hide\fR option is false) are ignored. You can limit the -search by specifying only the elements you want to be considered. -\fIElemName\fR must be the name of an element that can not be hidden. -It returns a key-value list containing the name of the closest element, -the index of the closest data point, and the graph-coordinates of the point. -Returns \f(CW""\fR, if no data point within the threshold distance -can be found. The following -\fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs are available. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-along \fIdirection\fR -Search for the closest element using the following criteria: -.RS -.TP -\f(CWx\fR -Find closest element vertically from the given X-coordinate. -.TP -\f(CWy\fR -Find the closest element horizontally from the given Y-coordinate. -.TP -\f(CWboth\fR -Find the closest element for the given point (using both the X and Y -coordinates). -.RE -.TP -\fB\-halo \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a threshold distance where selected data points are ignored. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -If this option isn't specified, then it defaults to the value of the -graph's \fB\-halo\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-interpolate \fIstring\fR -Indicates whether to consider projections that lie along the line segments -connecting data points when searching for the closest point. -The default value is \f(CW0\fR. The values for \fIstring\fR are -described below. -.RS -.TP 1.25i -\f(CWno\fR -Search only for the closest data point. -.TP -\f(CWyes\fR -Search includes projections that lie along the -line segments connecting the data points. -.RE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement configure \fIelemName \fR?\fIelemName\fR... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for elements. Several -elements can be modified at the same time. If \fIoption\fR isn't -specified, a list describing all the current options for -\fIelemName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, but not -\fIvalue\fR, then a list describing the option \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the element option \fIoption\fR is set -to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for elements. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-activepen \fIpenName\fR -Specifies pen to use to draw active element. If \fIpenName\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, no active elements will be drawn. The default is -\f(CWactiveLine\fR. -.TP -\fB\-areabackground \fIcolor\fR -Specifies the background color of the area under the curve. The -background area color is drawn only for bitmaps (see the -\fB\-areapattern\fR option). If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the -background is transparent. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-areaforeground \fIcolor\fR -Specifies the foreground color of the area under the curve. -The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-areapattern \fIpattern\fR -Specifies how to fill the area under the curve. \fIPattern\fR may be -the name of a Tk bitmap, \f(CWsolid\fR, or \f(CW""\fR. If "solid", -then the area under the curve is drawn with the color designated by -the \fB\-areaforeground\fR option. If a bitmap, then the bitmap is -stippled across the area. Here the bitmap colors are controlled by the -\fB\-areaforeground\fR and \fB\-areabackground\fR options. If -\fIpattern\fR is \f(CW""\fR, no filled area is drawn. The default is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-areatile \fIimage\fR -Specifies the name of a Tk image to be used to tile the area under the -curve. This option supersedes the \fB\-areapattern\fR option. -\fIImage\fR must be a photo image. If \fIimage\fR is \f(CW""\fR, no -tiling is performed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for the element. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events are handled for elements. Each tag in the list matching the -current event -sequence will have its Tcl command executed. Implicitly the name of -the element is always the first tag in the list. The default value is -\f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the traces connecting the data points. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of element line. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up to -11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes and -gaps on the element line. Each number must be between 1 and 255. If -\fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the lines will be solid. -.TP -\fB\-data \fIcoordList\fR -Specifies the X\-Y coordinates of the data. \fICoordList\fR is a -list of numeric expressions representing the X\-Y coordinate pairs -of each data point. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the interior color of symbols. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then -the interior of the symbol is transparent. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CWdefcolor\fR, then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR -option. The default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the element is displayed. -The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-label \fItext\fR -Sets the element's label in the legend. If \fItext\fR -is \f(CW""\fR, the element will have no entry in the legend. -The default label is the element's name. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the connecting lines between data points. If -\fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, no connecting lines will be drawn between -symbols. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Selects the X\-axis to map the element's X\-coordinates onto. -\fIXAxis\fR must be the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWx\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Selects the Y\-axis to map the element's Y\-coordinates onto. -\fIYAxis\fR must be the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-offdash \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the stripes when traces are dashed (see the -\fB\-dashes\fR option). If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the "off" -pixels will represent gaps instead of stripes. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CWdefcolor\fR, then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR -option. The default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color or the outline around each symbol. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, then no outline is drawn. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CWdefcolor\fR, -then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR option. The -default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pen \fIpenname\fR -Set the pen to use for this element. -.TP -\fB\-outlinewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the outline bordering each symbol. If \fIpixels\fR -is \f(CW0\fR, no outline will be drawn. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pixels \fIpixels\fR -Sets the size of symbols. If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, no symbols will -be drawn. The default is \f(CW0.125i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-scalesymbols \fIboolean\fR -If \fIboolean\fR is true, the size of the symbols -drawn for \fIelemName\fR will change with scale of the X\-axis and Y\-axis. -At the time this option is set, the current ranges of the axes are -saved as the normalized scales (i.e scale factor is 1.0) and the -element is drawn at its designated size (see the \fB\-pixels\fR -option). As the scale of the axes change, the symbol will be scaled -according to the smaller of the X\-axis and Y\-axis scales. If \fIboolean\fR -is false, the element's symbols are drawn at the designated size, -regardless of axis scales. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-smooth \fIsmooth\fR -Specifies how connecting line segments are drawn between data points. -\fISmooth\fR can be either \f(CWlinear\fR, \f(CWstep\fR, \f(CWnatural\fR, or -\f(CWquadratic\fR. If \fIsmooth\fR is \f(CWlinear\fR, a single line -segment is drawn, connecting both data points. When \fIsmooth\fR is -\f(CWstep\fR, two line segments are drawn. The first is a horizontal -line segment that steps the next X\-coordinate. The second is a -vertical line, moving to the next Y\-coordinate. Both \fInatural\fR and -\fIquadratic\fR generate multiple segments between data points. If -\fInatural\fR, the segments are generated using a cubic spline. If -\fIquadratic\fR, a quadratic spline is used. The default is -\fIlinear\fR. -.TP -\fB\-styles \fIstyleList\fR -Specifies what pen to use based on the range of weights given. -\fIStyleList\fR is a list of style specifications. Each style -specification, in turn, is a list consisting of a pen name, and -optionally a minimum and maximum range. Data points whose weight (see -the \fB\-weight\fR option) falls in this range, are drawn with this -pen. If no range is specified it defaults to the index of the pen in -the list. Note that this affects only symbol attributes. Line -attributes, such as line width, dashes, etc. are ignored. -.TP -\fB\-symbol \fIsymbol\fR -Specifies the symbol for data points. \fISymbol\fR can be either -\f(CWsquare\fR, \f(CWcircle\fR, \f(CWdiamond\fR, \f(CWplus\fR, \f(CWcross\fR, -\f(CWsplus\fR, \f(CWscross\fR, \f(CWtriangle\fR, \f(CW""\fR (where no symbol -is drawn), or a bitmap. Bitmaps are specified as "\fIsource\fR -?\fImask\fR?", where \fIsource\fR is the name of the bitmap, and -\fImask\fR is the bitmap's optional mask. The default is -\f(CWcircle\fR. -.TP -\fB\-trace \fIdirection\fR -Indicates whether connecting lines between data points (whose -X\-coordinate values are either increasing or decreasing) are drawn. -\fIDirection\fR -must be \f(CWincreasing\fR, \f(CWdecreasing\fR, or \f(CWboth\fR. For -example, if \fIdirection\fR is \f(CWincreasing\fR, connecting lines will -be drawn only between those data points where X\-coordinate values are -monotonically increasing. If \fIdirection\fR is \f(CWboth\fR, -connecting lines will be draw between all data points. The default is -\f(CWboth\fR. -.TP -\fB\-weights \fIwVec\fR -Specifies the weights of the individual data points. This, -with the list pen styles (see the \fB\-styles\fR option), -controls how data points are drawn. \fIWVec\fR is the name of a BLT -vector or a list of numeric expressions representing the weights for -each data point. -.TP -\fB\-xdata \fIxVec\fR -Specifies the X\-coordinates of the data. \fIXVec\fR is the name of -a BLT vector or a list of numeric expressions. -.TP -\fB\-ydata \fIyVec\fR -Specifies the Y\-coordinates of the data. \fIYVec\fR is the name of -a BLT vector or a list of numeric expressions. -.PP -Element configuration options may also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource class is \f(CWElement\fR. The resource name is -the name of the element. -.CS -option add *Graph.Element.symbol line -option add *Graph.e1.symbol line -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement create \fIelemName\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new element \fIelemName\fR. It's an error is -an element \fIelemName\fR already exists. If -additional arguments are present, they specify options valid for -the element \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement deactivate \fIelemName\fR ?\fIelemName\fR?... -Deactivates all the elements matching \fIpattern\fR. -Elements whose names match any of the patterns given are redrawn using -their normal colors. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement delete\fR ?\fIelemName\fR?... -Deletes all the named elements. The graph is automatically redrawn. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement exists \fIelemName\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR if an element \fIelemName\fR currently exists and -\f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns the elements matching one or more pattern. If no -\fIpattern\fR is given, the names of all elements is returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement show\fR ?\fInameList\fR? -Queries or modifies the element display list. The element display -list designates the elements drawn and in what -order. \fINameList\fR is a list of elements to be displayed in the -order they are named. If there is no \fInameList\fR argument, -the current display list is returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBelement type\fR \fIelemName\fR -Returns the type of \fIelemName\fR. -If the element is a bar element, the commands returns the string -\f(CW"bar"\fR, otherwise it returns \f(CW"line"\fR. -.CE -.SS "GRID COMPONENT" -Grid lines extend from the major and minor ticks of each axis -horizontally or vertically across the plotting area. The following -operations are available for grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the grid line configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the grid \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid configure\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for grid lines. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing all the current -grid options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the grid line option \fIoption\fR is set to -\fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for grid lines. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the grid lines. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the grid lines. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up -to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes -and gaps on the grid lines. Each number must be between 1 and 255. -If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the grid will be solid lines. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the grid should be drawn. If \fIboolean\fR -is true, grid lines are not shown. The default is \f(CWyes\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of grid lines. The default width is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Specifies the X\-axis to display grid lines. \fIXAxis\fR -must be the name of an axis or \f(CW""\fR for no grid lines. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Specifies the Y\-axis to display grid lines. \fIYAxis\fR -must be the name of an axis or \f(CW""\fR for no grid lines. -The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-minor \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the grid lines should be drawn for minor ticks. -If \fIboolean\fR is true, the lines will appear at -minor tick intervals. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.PP -Grid configuration options may also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are \f(CWgrid\fR and -\f(CWGrid\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Graph.grid.LineWidth 2 -option add *Graph.Grid.Color black -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid off\fR -Turns off the display the grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid on\fR -Turns on the display the grid lines. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBgrid toggle\fR -Toggles the display of the grid. -.SS "LEGEND COMPONENT" -The legend displays a list of the data elements. Each entry consists -of the element's symbol and label. The legend can appear in any -margin (the default location is in the right margin). It -can also be positioned anywhere within the plotting area. -.PP -The following operations are valid for the legend. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend activate \fIpattern\fR... -Selects legend entries to be drawn using the active legend colors and relief. -All entries whose element names match \fIpattern\fR are selected. To -be selected, the element name must match only one \fIpattern\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for a legend entry with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. Implicitly the element names -in the entry are tags. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on legend entries, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of a legend configuration option. -\fIOption\fR may be any option described below in the -legend \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for the legend. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -legend options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is -specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is -returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are -specified, then for each pair, the legend option \fIoption\fR is set -to \fIvalue\fR. The following options are valid for the legend. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-activebackground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color for active legend entries. All legend -entries marked active (see the legend \fBactivate\fR operation) are -drawn using this background color. -.TP -\fB\-activeborderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge of the active legend -entries. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-activeforeground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color for active legend entries. All legend -entries marked as active (see the legend \fBactivate\fR operation) are -drawn using this foreground color. -.TP -\fB\-activerelief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect desired for active legend entries. -\fIRelief\fR denotes how the interior of the entry should appear -relative to the legend; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the entry -should appear to protrude from the legend, relative to the surface of -the legend. The default is \f(CWflat\fR. -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -Tells how to position the legend relative to the positioning point for -the legend. This is dependent on the value of the \fB\-position\fR -option. The default is \f(CWcenter\fR. -.RS -.TP 1.25i -\f(CWleft\fR or \f(CWright\fR -The anchor describes how to position the legend vertically. -.TP -\f(CWtop\fR or \f(CWbottom\fR -The anchor describes how to position the legend horizontally. -.TP -\f(CW@x,y\fR -The anchor specifies how to position the legend relative to the -positioning point. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWcenter\fR then -the legend is centered on the point; if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then -the legend will be drawn such that the top center point of the -rectangular region occupied by the legend will be at the positioning -point. -.TP -\f(CWplotarea\fR -The anchor specifies how to position the legend relative to the -plotting area. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWcenter\fR then the -legend is centered in the plotting area; if \fIanchor\fR is \f(CWne\fR -then the legend will be drawn such that occupies the upper right -corner of the plotting area. -.RE -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the legend. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the legend background with be transparent. -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for legend entries. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events are handled for legend entries. Each tag in the list matching -the current event sequence will have its Tcl command executed. The -default value is \f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-borderwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the 3-D border around the outside edge of the legend (if -such border is being drawn; the \fBrelief\fR option determines this). -The default is \f(CW2\fR pixels. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -\fIFontName\fR specifies a font to use when drawing the labels of each -element into the legend. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-12-120-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the text drawn for the element's label. -The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the legend should be displayed. If \fIboolean\fR is -true, the legend will not be draw. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-ipadx \fIpad\fR -Sets the amount of internal padding to be added to the width of each -legend entry. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If -\fIpad\fR has two elements, the left side of the legend entry is -padded by the first distance and the right side by the second. If -\fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the left and right sides are padded -evenly. The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-ipady \fIpad\fR -Sets an amount of internal padding to be added to the height of each -legend entry. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If -\fIpad\fR has two elements, the top of the entry is padded by the -first distance and the bottom by the second. If \fIpad\fR is just -one distance, both the top and bottom of the entry are padded evenly. -The default is \f(CW2\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors of the legend. -\fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR -has two elements, the left side of the legend is padded by the first -distance and the right side by the second. If \fIpad\fR has just one -distance, both the left and right sides are padded evenly. The -default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding above and below the legend. \fIPad\fR can be a list -of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the area above -the legend is padded by the first distance and the area below by the -second. If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and -bottom areas are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-position \fIpos\fR -Specifies where the legend is drawn. The -\fB\-anchor\fR option also affects where the legend is positioned. If -\fIpos\fR is \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWtop\fR, or \f(CWbottom\fR, the -legend is drawn in the specified margin. If \fIpos\fR is -\f(CWplotarea\fR, then the legend is drawn inside the plotting area at a -particular anchor. If \fIpos\fR is in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", where -\fIx\fR and \fIy\fR are the window coordinates, the legend is drawn in -the plotting area at the specified coordinates. The default is -\f(CWright\fR. -.TP -\fB\-raised \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the legend is above or below the data elements. This -matters only if the legend is in the plotting area. If \fIboolean\fR -is true, the legend will be drawn on top of any elements that may -overlap it. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-relief \fIrelief\fR -Specifies the 3-D effect for the border around the legend. -\fIRelief\fR specifies how the interior of the legend should appear -relative to the graph; for example, \f(CWraised\fR means the legend -should appear to protrude from the graph, relative to the surface of -the graph. The default is \f(CWsunken\fR. -.PP -Legend configuration options may also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource name and class are \f(CWlegend\fR and -\f(CWLegend\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Graph.legend.Foreground blue -option add *Graph.Legend.Relief raised -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend deactivate \fIpattern\fR... -Selects legend entries to be drawn using the normal legend colors and -relief. All entries whose element names match \fIpattern\fR are -selected. To be selected, the element name must match only one -\fIpattern\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBlegend get \fIpos\fR -Returns the name of the element whose entry is at the screen position -\fIpos\fR in the legend. \fIPos\fR must be in the form "\fI@x,y\fR", -where \fIx\fR and \fIy\fR are window coordinates. If the given -coordinates do not lie over a legend entry, \f(CW""\fR is returned. -.SS "PEN COMPONENTS" -Pens define attributes (both symbol and line style) for elements. -Pens mirror the configuration options of data elements that pertain to -how symbols and lines are drawn. Data elements use pens to determine -how they are drawn. A data element may use several pens at once. In -this case, the pen used for a particular data point is determined from -each element's weight vector (see the element's \fB\-weight\fR and -\fB\-style\fR options). -.PP -One pen, called \f(CWactiveLine\fR, is automatically created. -It's used as the default active pen for elements. So you can change -the active attributes for all elements by simply reconfiguring this -pen. -.CS -\&.g pen configure "activeLine" -color green -.CE -You can create and use several pens. To create a pen, invoke -the pen component and its create operation. -.CS -\&.g pen create myPen -.CE -You map pens to a data element using either the element's -\fB\-pen\fR or \fB\-activepen\fR options. -.CS -\&.g element create "line1" -xdata $x -ydata $tempData \\ - -pen myPen -.CE -An element can use several pens at once. This is done by specifying -the name of the pen in the element's style list (see the -\fB\-styles\fR option). -.CS -\&.g element configure "line1" -styles { myPen 2.0 3.0 } -.CE -This says that any data point with a weight between 2.0 and 3.0 -is to be drawn using the pen \f(CWmyPen\fR. All other points -are drawn with the element's default attributes. -.PP -The following operations are available for pen components. -.PP -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBcget \fIpenName \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the option given by \fIoption\fR for -\fIpenName\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described below -for the pen \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBconfigure \fIpenName \fR?\fIpenName\fR... ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options of -\fIpenName\fR. Several pens can be modified at once. If \fIoption\fR -isn't specified, a list describing the current options for -\fIpenName\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, but not -\fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. If one -or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then for -each pair, the pen option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. The -following options are valid for pens. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-color \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the traces connecting the data points. -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of element line. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up to -11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes and -gaps on the element line. Each number must be between 1 and 255. If -\fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the lines will be solid. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the interior color of symbols. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then -the interior of the symbol is transparent. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CWdefcolor\fR, then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR -option. The default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the connecting lines between data points. If -\fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, no connecting lines will be drawn between -symbols. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-offdash \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the stripes when traces are dashed (see the -\fB\-dashes\fR option). If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the "off" -pixels will represent gaps instead of stripes. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CWdefcolor\fR, then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR -option. The default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color or the outline around each symbol. If \fIcolor\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, then no outline is drawn. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CWdefcolor\fR, -then the color will be the same as the \fB\-color\fR option. The -default is \f(CWdefcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outlinewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the outline bordering each symbol. If \fIpixels\fR -is \f(CW0\fR, no outline will be drawn. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pixels \fIpixels\fR -Sets the size of symbols. If \fIpixels\fR is \f(CW0\fR, no symbols will -be drawn. The default is \f(CW0.125i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-symbol \fIsymbol\fR -Specifies the symbol for data points. \fISymbol\fR can be either -\f(CWsquare\fR, \f(CWcircle\fR, \f(CWdiamond\fR, \f(CWplus\fR, \f(CWcross\fR, -\f(CWsplus\fR, \f(CWscross\fR, \f(CWtriangle\fR, \f(CW""\fR (where no symbol -is drawn), or a bitmap. Bitmaps are specified as "\fIsource\fR -?\fImask\fR?", where \fIsource\fR is the name of the bitmap, and -\fImask\fR is the bitmap's optional mask. The default is -\f(CWcircle\fR. -.TP -\fB\-type \fIelemType\fR -Specifies the type of element the pen is to be used with. -This option should only be employed when creating the pen. This -is for those that wish to mix different types of elements (bars and -lines) on the same graph. The default type is "line". -.PP -Pen configuration options may be also be set by the \fBoption\fR -command. The resource class is \f(CWPen\fR. The resource names -are the names of the pens. -.CS -option add *Graph.Pen.Color blue -option add *Graph.activeLine.color green -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBcreate \fIpenName \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a new pen by the name \fIpenName\fR. No pen by the same -name can already exist. \fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR are described -in above in the pen \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen \fBdelete \fR?\fIpenName\fR?... -Deletes the named pens. A pen is not really -deleted until it is not longer in use, so it's safe to delete -pens mapped to elements. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpen names \fR?\fIpattern\fR?... -Returns a list of pens matching zero or more patterns. If no -\fIpattern\fR argument is give, the names of all pens are returned. -.SS "POSTSCRIPT COMPONENT" -The graph can generate encapsulated PostScript output. There -are several configuration options you can specify to control how the -plot will be generated. You can change the page dimensions and -borders. The plot itself can be scaled, centered, or rotated to -landscape. The PostScript output can be written directly to a file or -returned through the interpreter. -.PP -The following postscript operations are available. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the postscript option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below for the postscript \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript configure \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for PostScript -generation. If \fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing -the current postscript options for \fIpathName\fR is returned. If -\fIoption\fR is specified, but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing -\fIoption\fR is returned. If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR -pairs are specified, then for each pair, the postscript option -\fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. The following postscript options -are available. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-center \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the plot should be centered on the PostScript page. If -\fIboolean\fR is false, the plot will be placed in the upper left -corner of the page. The default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-colormap \fIvarName\fR -\fIVarName\fR must be the name of a global array variable that -specifies a color mapping from the X color name to PostScript. Each -element of \fIvarName\fR must consist of PostScript code to set a -particular color value (e.g. ``\f(CW1.0 1.0 0.0 setrgbcolor\fR''). When -generating color information in PostScript, the array variable \fIvarName\fR -is checked if an element of the name as the color exists. If so, it uses -its value as the PostScript -command to set the color. If this option hasn't been specified, or if -there isn't an entry in \fIvarName\fR for a given color, then it uses -the red, green, and blue intensities from the X color. -.TP -\fB\-colormode \fImode\fR -Specifies how to output color information. \fIMode\fR must be either -\f(CWcolor\fR (for full color output), \f(CWgray\fR (convert all colors to -their gray-scale equivalents) or \f(CWmono\fR (convert foreground colors -to black and background colors to white). The default mode is -\f(CWcolor\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fontmap \fIvarName\fR -\fIVarName\fR must be the name of a global array variable that -specifies a font mapping from the X font name to PostScript. Each -element of \fIvarName\fR must consist of a Tcl list with one or two -elements; the name and point size of a PostScript font. -When outputting PostScript commands for a particular font, the array -variable \fIvarName\fR is checked to see if an element by the -specified font exists. If there is such an element, then the font -information contained in that element is used in the PostScript -output. (If the point size is omitted from the list, the point size -of the X font is used). Otherwise the X font is examined in an -attempt to guess what PostScript font to use. This works only for -fonts whose foundry property is \fIAdobe\fR (such as Times, Helvetica, -Courier, etc.). If all of this fails then the font defaults to -\f(CWHelvetica-Bold\fR. -.TP -\fB\-decorations \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether PostScript commands to generate color backgrounds and 3-D -borders will be output. If \fIboolean\fR is false, the background will be -white and no 3-D borders will be generated. The -default is \f(CW1\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Sets the height of the plot. This lets you print the graph with a -height different from the one drawn on the screen. If -\fIpixels\fR is 0, the height is the same as the widget's height. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-landscape \fIboolean\fR -If \fIboolean\fR is true, this specifies the printed area is to be -rotated 90 degrees. In non-rotated output the X\-axis of the printed -area runs along the short dimension of the page (``portrait'' -orientation); in rotated output the X\-axis runs along the long -dimension of the page (``landscape'' orientation). Defaults to -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-maxpect \fIboolean\fR -Indicates to scale the plot so that it fills the PostScript page. -The aspect ratio of the graph is still retained. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the horizontal padding for the left and right page borders. The -borders are exterior to the plot. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or -two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the left border is padded -by the first distance and the right border by the second. If -\fIpad\fR has just one distance, both the left and right borders are -padded evenly. The default is \f(CW1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the vertical padding for the top and bottom page borders. The -borders are exterior to the plot. \fIPad\fR can be a list of one or -two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the top border is padded -by the first distance and the bottom border by the second. If -\fIpad\fR has just one distance, both the top and bottom borders are -padded evenly. The default is \f(CW1i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-paperheight \fIpixels\fR -Sets the height of the postscript page. This can be used to select -between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc). The default height is -\f(CW11.0i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-paperwidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the postscript page. This can be used to select -between different page sizes (letter, A4, etc). The default width is -\f(CW8.5i\fR. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the plot. This lets you generate a plot -of a width different from that of the widget. If \fIpixels\fR -is 0, the width is the same as the widget's width. The default is -\f(CW0\fR. -.PP -Postscript configuration options may be also be set by the -\fBoption\fR command. The resource name and class are -\f(CWpostscript\fR and \f(CWPostscript\fR respectively. -.CS -option add *Graph.postscript.Decorations false -option add *Graph.Postscript.Landscape true -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBpostscript output \fR?\fIfileName\fR? ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Outputs a file of encapsulated PostScript. If a -\fIfileName\fR argument isn't present, the command returns the -PostScript. If any \fIoption-value\fR pairs are present, they set -configuration options controlling how the PostScript is generated. -\fIOption\fR and \fIvalue\fR can be anything accepted by the -postscript \fBconfigure\fR operation above. -.SS "MARKER COMPONENTS" -Markers are simple drawing procedures used to annotate or highlight -areas of the graph. Markers have various types: text strings, -bitmaps, images, connected lines, windows, or polygons. They can be -associated with a particular element, so that when the element is -hidden or un-hidden, so is the marker. By default, markers are the -last items drawn, so that data elements will appear in -behind them. You can change this by configuring the \fB\-under\fR -option. -.PP -Markers, in contrast to elements, don't affect the scaling of the -coordinate axes. They can also have \fIelastic\fR coordinates -(specified by \f(CW-Inf\fR and \f(CWInf\fR respectively) that translate -into the minimum or maximum limit of the axis. For example, you can -place a marker so it always remains in the lower left corner of the -plotting area, by using the coordinates \f(CW-Inf\fR,\f(CW-Inf\fR. -.PP -The following operations are available for markers. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker after \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIafterId\fR? -Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first -marker after the second. If no second \fIafterId\fR argument is -specified, the marker is placed at the end of the display list. This -command can be used to control how markers are displayed since markers -are drawn in the order of this display list. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker before \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIbeforeId\fR? -Changes the order of the markers, drawing the first -marker before the second. If no second \fIbeforeId\fR argument is -specified, the marker is placed at the beginning of the display list. -This command can be used to control how markers are displayed since -markers are drawn in the order of this display list. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker bind \fItagName\fR ?\fIsequence\fR? ?\fIcommand\fR? -Associates \fIcommand\fR with \fItagName\fR such that whenever the -event sequence given by \fIsequence\fR occurs for a marker with this -tag, \fIcommand\fR will be invoked. The syntax is similar to the -\fBbind\fR command except that it operates on graph markers, rather -than widgets. See the \fBbind\fR manual entry for -complete details on \fIsequence\fR and the substitutions performed on -\fIcommand\fR before invoking it. -.sp -If all arguments are specified then a new binding is created, replacing -any existing binding for the same \fIsequence\fR and \fItagName\fR. -If the first character of \fIcommand\fR is \f(CW+\fR then \fIcommand\fR -augments an existing binding rather than replacing it. -If no \fIcommand\fR argument is provided then the command currently -associated with \fItagName\fR and \fIsequence\fR (it's an error occurs -if there's no such binding) is returned. If both \fIcommand\fR and -\fIsequence\fR are missing then a list of all the event sequences for -which bindings have been defined for \fItagName\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker cget \fIoption\fR -Returns the current value of the marker configuration option given by -\fIoption\fR. \fIOption\fR may be any option described -below in the \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker configure \fImarkerId\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Queries or modifies the configuration options for markers. If -\fIoption\fR isn't specified, a list describing the current -options for \fImarkerId\fR is returned. If \fIoption\fR is specified, -but not \fIvalue\fR, then a list describing \fIoption\fR is returned. -If one or more \fIoption\fR and \fIvalue\fR pairs are specified, then -for each pair, the marker option \fIoption\fR is set to \fIvalue\fR. -.sp -The following options are valid for all markers. -Each type of marker also has its own type-specific options. -They are described in the sections below. -.RS -.TP -\fB\-bindtags \fItagList\fR -Specifies the binding tags for the marker. \fITagList\fR is a list -of binding tag names. The tags and their order will determine how -events for markers are handled. Each tag in the list matching the -current event sequence will have its Tcl command executed. Implicitly -the name of the marker is always the first tag in the list. -The default value is \f(CWall\fR. -.TP -\fB\-coords \fIcoordList\fR -Specifies the coordinates of the marker. \fICoordList\fR is -a list of graph coordinates. The number of coordinates required -is dependent on the type of marker. Text, image, and window markers -need only two coordinates (an X\-Y coordinate). Bitmap markers -can take either two or four coordinates (if four, they represent the -corners of the bitmap). Line markers -need at least four coordinates, polygons at least six. -If \fIcoordList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker will not be displayed. -The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-element \fIelemName\fR -Links the marker with the element \fIelemName\fR. The marker is -drawn only if the element is also currently displayed (see the -element's \fBshow\fR operation). If \fIelemName\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the -marker is always drawn. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-hide \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the marker is drawn. If \fIboolean\fR is true, -the marker is not drawn. The default is \f(CWno\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapx \fIxAxis\fR -Specifies the X\-axis to map the marker's X\-coordinates onto. -\fIXAxis\fR must the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWx\fR. -.TP -\fB\-mapy \fIyAxis\fR -Specifies the Y\-axis to map the marker's Y\-coordinates onto. -\fIYAxis\fR must the name of an axis. The default is \f(CWy\fR. -.TP -\fB\-name \fImarkerId\fR -Changes the identifier for the marker. The identifier \fImarkerId\fR -can not already be used by another marker. If this option -isn't specified, the marker's name is uniquely generated. -.TP -\fB\-under \fIboolean\fR -Indicates whether the marker is drawn below/above data -elements. If \fIboolean\fR is true, the marker is be drawn -underneath the data element symbols and lines. Otherwise, the marker is -drawn on top of the element. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-xoffset \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a screen distance to offset the marker horizontally. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-yoffset \fIpixels\fR -Specifies a screen distance to offset the markers vertically. -\fIPixels\fR is a valid screen distance, such as \f(CW2\fR or \f(CW1.2i\fR. -The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.PP -Marker configuration options may also be set by the \fBoption\fR command. -The resource class is either \f(CWBitmapMarker\fR, \f(CWImageMarker\fR, -\f(CWLineMarker\fR, \f(CWPolygonMarker\fR, \f(CWTextMarker\fR, or \f(CWWindowMarker\fR, -depending on the type of marker. The resource name is the name of the -marker. -.CS -option add *Graph.TextMarker.Foreground white -option add *Graph.BitmapMarker.Foreground white -option add *Graph.m1.Background blue -.CE -.RE -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker create \fItype\fR ?\fIoption value\fR?... -Creates a marker of the selected type. \fIType\fR may be either -\f(CWtext\fR, \f(CWline\fR, \f(CWbitmap\fR, \f(CWimage\fR, \f(CWpolygon\fR, or -\f(CWwindow\fR. This command returns the marker identifier, -used as the \fImarkerId\fR argument in the other marker-related -commands. If the \fB\-name\fR option is used, this overrides the -normal marker identifier. If the name provided is already used for -another marker, the new marker will replace the old. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker delete\fR ?\fIname\fR?... -Removes one of more markers. The graph will automatically be redrawn -without the marker.\fR. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker exists \fImarkerId\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR if the marker \fImarkerId\fR exists and \f(CW0\fR -otherwise. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker names\fR ?\fIpattern\fR? -Returns the names of all the markers that currently exist. If -\fIpattern\fR is supplied, only those markers whose names match it -will be returned. -.TP -\fIpathName \fBmarker type \fImarkerId\fR -Returns the type of the marker given by \fImarkerId\fR, such as -\f(CWline\fR or \f(CWtext\fR. If \fImarkerId\fR is not a valid a marker -identifier, \f(CW""\fR is returned. -.SS "BITMAP MARKERS" -A bitmap marker displays a bitmap. The size of the -bitmap is controlled by the number of coordinates specified. If two -coordinates, they specify the position of the top-left corner of the -bitmap. The bitmap retains its normal width and height. If four -coordinates, the first and second pairs of coordinates represent the -corners of the bitmap. The bitmap will be stretched or reduced as -necessary to fit into the bounding rectangle. -.PP -Bitmap markers are created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in -the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create bitmap \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs, each -sets a configuration options for the marker. These -same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be used with the marker's -\fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to bitmap markers: -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-fill\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-bitmap \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies the bitmap to be displayed. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, -the marker will not be displayed. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the bitmap. If \fIcolor\fR is the empty -string, no background will be transparent. The default background color is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-outline\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-mask \fImask\fR -Specifies a mask for the bitmap to be displayed. This mask is a bitmap -itself, denoting the pixels that are transparent. If \fImask\fR is -\f(CW""\fR, all pixels of the bitmap will be drawn. The default is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the bitmap. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Sets the rotation of the bitmap. \fITheta\fR is a real number -representing the angle of rotation in degrees. The marker is first -rotated and then placed according to its anchor position. The default -rotation is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.SS "IMAGE MARKERS" -A image marker displays an image. Image markers are -created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create image \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to image markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the image relative to the -positioning point for the image. For example, if \fIanchor\fR -is \f(CWcenter\fR then the image is centered on the point; if -\fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then the image will be drawn such that -the top center point of the rectangular region occupied by the -image will be at the positioning point. -This option defaults to \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-image \fIimage\fR -Specifies the image to be drawn. -If \fIimage\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker will not be -drawn. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "LINE MARKERS" -A line marker displays one or more connected line segments. -Line markers are created with marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create line \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to line markers: -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the line. \fIDashList\fR is a list of up to 11 -numbers that alternately represent the lengths of the dashes and gaps -on the line. Each number must be between 1 and 255. If -\fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the marker line will be solid. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the line. This color is used with -striped lines (see the \fB\-fdashes\fR option). If \fIcolor\fR is -the empty string, no background color is drawn (the line will be -dashed, not striped). The default background color is \f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the lines. -The default width is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the foreground color of the line. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies a stipple pattern used to draw the line, rather than -a solid line. -\fIBitmap\fR specifies a bitmap to use as the stipple -pattern. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the -line is drawn in a solid fashion. The default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "POLYGON MARKERS" -A polygon marker displays a closed region described as two or more -connected line segments. It is assumed the first and -last points are connected. Polygon markers are created using the -marker \fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create polygon \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the \fBmarker configure\fR command to change the marker's -configuration. -The following options are supported for polygon markers: -.TP -\fB\-dashes \fIdashList\fR -Sets the dash style of the outline of the polygon. \fIDashList\fR is a -list of up to 11 numbers that alternately represent the lengths of -the dashes and gaps on the outline. Each number must be between 1 and -255. If \fIdashList\fR is \f(CW""\fR, the outline will be a solid line. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the fill color of the polygon. If \fIcolor\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then -the interior of the polygon is transparent. -The default is \f(CWwhite\fR. -.TP -\fB\-linewidth \fIpixels\fR -Sets the width of the outline of the polygon. If \fIpixels\fR is zero, -no outline is drawn. The default is \f(CW0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the outline of the polygon. If the polygon is -stippled (see the \fB\-stipple\fR option), then this represents the -foreground color of the stipple. The default is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-stipple \fIbitmap\fR -Specifies that the polygon should be drawn with a stippled pattern -rather than a solid color. \fIBitmap\fR specifies a bitmap to use as -the stipple pattern. If \fIbitmap\fR is \f(CW""\fR, then the polygon is -filled with a solid color (if the \fB\-fill\fR option is set). The -default is \f(CW""\fR. -.SS "TEXT MARKERS" -A text marker displays a string of characters on one or more lines of -text. Embedded newlines cause line breaks. They may be used to -annotate regions of the graph. Text markers are created with the -\fBcreate\fR operation in the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create text \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR pairs, -each sets a configuration option for the text marker. -These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be used with the -marker's \fBconfigure\fR operation. -.PP -The following options are specific to text markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the text relative to the -positioning point for the text. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is -\f(CWcenter\fR then the text is centered on the point; if -\fIanchor\fR is \f(CWn\fR then the text will be drawn such that the -top center point of the rectangular region occupied by the text will -be at the positioning point. This default is \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-background \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-fill\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-font \fIfontName\fR -Specifies the font of the text. The default is -\f(CW*-Helvetica-Bold-R-Normal-*-120-*\fR. -.TP -\fB\-fill \fIcolor\fR -Sets the background color of the text. If \fIcolor\fR is the empty -string, no background will be transparent. The default background color is -\f(CW""\fR. -.TP -\fB\-foreground \fIcolor\fR -Same as the \fB\-outline\fR option. -.TP -\fB\-justify \fIjustify\fR -Specifies how the text should be justified. This matters only when -the marker contains more than one line of text. \fIJustify\fR must be -\f(CWleft\fR, \f(CWright\fR, or \f(CWcenter\fR. The default is -\f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-outline \fIcolor\fR -Sets the color of the text. The default value is \f(CWblack\fR. -.TP -\fB\-padx \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding to the left and right exteriors of the text. -\fIPad\fR can be a list of one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR -has two elements, the left side of the text is padded by the first -distance and the right side by the second. If \fIpad\fR has just one -distance, both the left and right sides are padded evenly. The -default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-pady \fIpad\fR -Sets the padding above and below the text. \fIPad\fR can be a list of -one or two screen distances. If \fIpad\fR has two elements, the area above the -text is padded by the first distance and the area below by the second. -If \fIpad\fR is just one distance, both the top and bottom areas -are padded evenly. The default is \f(CW4\fR. -.TP -\fB\-rotate \fItheta\fR -Specifies the number of degrees to rotate the text. \fITheta\fR is a -real number representing the angle of rotation. The marker is first -rotated along its center and is then drawn according to its anchor -position. The default is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fB\-text \fItext\fR -Specifies the text of the marker. The exact way the text is -displayed may be affected by other options such as \fB\-anchor\fR or -\fB\-rotate\fR. -.SS "WINDOW MARKERS" -A window marker displays a widget at a given position. -Window markers are created with the marker's \fBcreate\fR operation in -the form: -.DS -\fIpathName \fBmarker create window \fR?\fIoption value\fR?... -.DE -There may be many \fIoption\fR-\fIvalue\fR -pairs, each sets a configuration option -for the marker. These same \fIoption\fR\-\fIvalue\fR pairs may be -used with the marker's \fBconfigure\fR command. -.PP -The following options are specific to window markers: -.TP -\fB\-anchor \fIanchor\fR -\fIAnchor\fR tells how to position the widget relative to the -positioning point for the widget. For example, if \fIanchor\fR is -\f(CWcenter\fR then the widget is centered on the point; if \fIanchor\fR -is \f(CWn\fR then the widget will be displayed such that the top center -point of the rectangular region occupied by the widget will be at the -positioning point. This option defaults to \f(CWcenter\fR. -.TP -\fB\-height \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the height to assign to the marker's window. If this option -isn't specified, or if it is specified as \f(CW""\fR, then the window is -given whatever height the widget requests internally. -.TP -\fB\-width \fIpixels\fR -Specifies the width to assign to the marker's window. If this option -isn't specified, or if it is specified as \f(CW""\fR, then the window is -given whatever width the widget requests internally. -.TP -\fB\-window \fIpathName\fR -Specifies the widget to be managed by the graph. \fIPathName\fR must -be a child of the \fBgraph\fR widget. -.SH "GRAPH COMPONENT BINDINGS" -Specific graph components, such as elements, markers and legend -entries, can have a command trigger when event occurs in them, much -like canvas items in Tk's canvas widget. Not all event sequences are -valid. The only binding events that may be specified are those -related to the mouse and keyboard (such as \fBEnter\fR, \fBLeave\fR, -\fBButtonPress\fR, \fBMotion\fR, and \fBKeyPress\fR). -.PP -Only one element or marker can be picked during an event. This means, -that if the mouse is directly over both an element and a marker, only -the uppermost component is selected. This isn't true for legend entries. -Both a legend entry and an element (or marker) binding commands -will be invoked if both items are picked. -.PP -It is possible for multiple bindings to match a particular event. -This could occur, for example, if one binding is associated with the -element name and another is associated with one of the element's tags -(see the \fB\-bindtags\fR option). When this occurs, all of the -matching bindings are invoked. A binding associated with the element -name is invoked first, followed by one binding for each of the element's -bindtags. If there are multiple matching bindings for a single tag, -then only the most specific binding is invoked. A continue command -in a binding script terminates that script, and a break command -terminates that script and skips any remaining scripts for the event, -just as for the bind command. -.PP -The \fB\-bindtags\fR option for these components controls addition -tag names which can be matched. Implicitly elements and markers -always have tags matching their names. Setting the value of -the \fB\-bindtags\fR option doesn't change this. -.SH "C LANGUAGE API" -You can manipulate data elements from the C language. There -may be situations where it is too expensive to translate the data -values from ASCII strings. Or you might want to read data in a -special file format. -.PP -Data can manipulated from the C language using BLT vectors. -You specify the X-Y data coordinates of an element as vectors and -manipulate the vector from C. The graph will be redrawn automatically -after the vectors are updated. -.PP -From Tcl, create the vectors and configure the element to use them. -.CS -vector X Y -\&.g element configure line1 -xdata X -ydata Y -.CE -To set data points from C, you pass the values as arrays of doubles -using the \fBBlt_ResetVector\fR call. The vector is reset with the -new data and at the next idle point (when Tk re-enters its event -loop), the graph will be redrawn automatically. -.CS -#include -#include - -register int i; -Blt_Vector *xVec, *yVec; -double x[50], y[50]; - -/* Get the BLT vectors "X" and "Y" (created above from Tcl) */ -if ((Blt_GetVector(interp, "X", &xVec) != TCL_OK) || - (Blt_GetVector(interp, "Y", &yVec) != TCL_OK)) { - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -for (i = 0; i < 50; i++) { - x[i] = i * 0.02; - y[i] = sin(x[i]); -} - -/* Put the data into BLT vectors */ -if ((Blt_ResetVector(xVec, x, 50, 50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK) || - (Blt_ResetVector(yVec, y, 50, 50, TCL_VOLATILE) != TCL_OK)) { - return TCL_ERROR; -} -.CE -See the \fBvector\fR manual page for more details. -.SH SPEED TIPS -There may be cases where the graph needs to be drawn and updated as -quickly as possible. If drawing speed becomes a big -problem, here are a few tips to speed up displays. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Try to minimize the number of data points. The more data points -the looked at, the more work the graph must do. -.TP 2 -\(bu -If your data is generated as floating point values, the time required -to convert the data values to and from ASCII strings can be -significant, especially when there any many data points. You can -avoid the redundant string-to-decimal conversions using the C API to -BLT vectors. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Data elements without symbols are drawn faster than with symbols. -Set the data element's \fB\-symbol\fR option to \f(CWnone\fR. If you need to -draw symbols, try using the simple symbols such as \f(CWsplus\fR and -\f(CWscross\fR. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Don't stipple or dash the element. Solid lines are much faster. -.TP 2 -\(bu -If you update data elements frequently, try turning off the -widget's \fB\-bufferelements\fR option. When the graph is first -displayed, it draws data elements into an internal pixmap. The pixmap -acts as a cache, so that when the graph needs to be redrawn again, and -the data elements or coordinate axes haven't changed, the pixmap is -simply copied to the screen. This is especially useful when you are -using markers to highlight points and regions on the graph. But if -the graph is updated frequently, changing either the element data or -coordinate axes, the buffering becomes redundant. -.SH LIMITATIONS -Auto-scale routines do not use requested min/max limits as boundaries -when the axis is logarithmically scaled. -.PP -The PostScript output generated for polygons with more than 1500 -points may exceed the limits of some printers (See PostScript Language -Reference Manual, page 568). The work-around is to break the polygon -into separate pieces. -.SH KEYWORDS -graph, widget diff --git a/tkblt/doc/vector.html b/tkblt/doc/vector.html deleted file mode 100644 index ef097c6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/vector.html +++ /dev/null @@ -1,704 +0,0 @@ - - -
-
-
-
-

SYNOPSIS

-       blt::vector create vecName ?vecName...? ?switches?
-
-       blt::vector destroy vecName ?vecName...?
-
-       blt::vector expr expression
-
-       blt::vector names ?pattern...?
-
-
-
-

DESCRIPTION

-       The vector command creates an array of floating point values.  The vec-
-       tor's components can be manipulated in three ways: through a Tcl  array
-       variable, a Tcl command, or the C API.
-
-
-
-

INTRODUCTION

-       A vector is an ordered set of real numbers.  The components of a vector
-       are indexed by integers.
-
-       Vectors are common data structures for many applications.  For example,
-       a  graph  may  use  two vectors to represent the X-Y coordinates of the
-       data plotted.  The graph will automatically be redrawn when the vectors
-       are  updated or changed. By using vectors, you can separate data analy-
-       sis from the graph widget.  This makes it easier, for example,  to  add
-       data  transformations, such as splines.  It's possible to plot the same
-       data to in multiple graphs, where each graph presents a different  view
-       or scale of the data.
-
-       You  could  try to use Tcl's associative arrays as vectors.  Tcl arrays
-       are easy to use.  You can access individual elements randomly by speci-
-       fying  the  index,  or  the set the entire array by providing a list of
-       index and value pairs for each element.  The disadvantages of  associa-
-       tive  arrays  as  vectors  lie in the fact they are implemented as hash
-       tables.
-
-       o There's no implied ordering to the associative arrays.  If  you  used
-         vectors  for  plotting, you would want to insure the second component
-         comes after the first, an so on.  This isn't  possible  since  arrays
-         are actually hash tables.  For example, you can't get a range of val-
-         ues between two indices.  Nor can you sort an array.
-
-       o Arrays consume lots of memory when the  number  of  elements  becomes
-         large  (tens of thousands).  This is because each element's index and
-         value are stored as strings in the hash table.
-
-       o The C programming interface is unwieldy.  Normally with vectors,  you
-         would  like to view the Tcl array as you do a C array, as an array of
-         floats or doubles.  But with hash tables, you must convert  both  the
-         index  and  value to and from decimal strings, just to access an ele-
-         ment in the array.  This makes it cumbersome to perform operations on
-         the array as a whole.
-
-       The  vector  command  tries to overcome these disadvantages while still
-       0.0.  In addition, both a Tcl command and array variable, both named y,
-       are created.  You can use either the command or variable  to  query  or
-       modify components of the vector.  # Set the first value.  set y(0) 9.25
-       puts "y has [y length] components" The array y can be used to  read  or
-       set individual components of the vector.  Vector components are indexed
-       from zero.  The array index must be a number less than  the  number  of
-       components.  For example, it's an error if you try to set the 51st ele-
-       ment of y.  # This is an error. The vector only has 50 components.  set
-       y(50) 0.02 You can also specify a range of indices using a colon (:) to
-       separate the first and last indices of the range.  # Set the first  six
-       components  of y set y(0:5) 25.2 If you don't include an index, then it
-       will default to the first and/or last component of the vector.  # Print
-       out  all  the  components  of y puts "y = $y(:)" There are special non-
-       numeric indices.  The index end, specifies the last  component  of  the
-       vector.  It's an error to use this index if the vector is empty (length
-       is zero).  The index ++end can be used to extend the vector by one com-
-       ponent  and initialize it to a specific value.  You can't read from the
-       array using this index, though.  # Extend the vector by one  component.
-       set  y(++end)  0.02  The  other  special indices are min and max.  They
-       return the current smallest and largest components of  the  vector.   #
-       Print the bounds of the vector puts "min=$y(min) max=$y(max)" To delete
-       components from a vector, simply unset the corresponding array element.
-       In the following example, the first component of y is deleted.  All the
-       remaining components of y will be moved down by one index as the length
-       of  the  vector  is reduced by one.  # Delete the first component unset
-       y(0) puts "new first element is $y(0)" The  vector's  Tcl  command  can
-       also  be  used to query or set the vector.  # Create and set the compo-
-       nents of a new vector blt::vector create x x set { 0.02 0.04 0.06  0.08
-       0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20 } Here we've created a vector x without a
-       initial length specification.  In this case, the length is  zero.   The
-       set  operation  resets  the vector, extending it and setting values for
-       each new component.
-
-       There are several operations for vectors.  The  range  operation  lists
-       the  components of a vector between two indices.  # List the components
-       puts "x = [x range 0 end]" You can search for a particular value  using
-       the  search  operation.  It returns a list of indices of the components
-       with the same value.  If no component has the same  value,  it  returns
-       "".   #  Find  the index of the biggest component set indices [x search
-       $x(max)] Other operations copy,  append,  or  sort  vectors.   You  can
-       append  vectors  or  new values onto an existing vector with the append
-       operation.  # Append assorted vectors and values to x x append x2 x3  {
-       2.3  4.5  }  x4 The sort operation sorts the vector.  If any additional
-       vectors are specified, they are rearranged in the  same  order  as  the
-       vector.   For example, you could use it to sort data points represented
-       by x and y vectors.  # Sort the data points x sort y The  vector  x  is
-       sorted  while  the  components of y are rearranged so that the original
-       x,y coordinate pairs are retained.
-
-       The expr operation lets you perform arithmetic on vectors.  The  result
-       is stored in the vector.  # Add the two vectors and a scalar x expr { x
-       + y } x expr { x * 2 } When a vector is modified, resized, or  deleted,
-       Vectors are created using the vector create operation.  Th create oper-
-       ation can be invoked in one of three forms:
-
-       blt::vector create vecName
-              This  creates a new vector vecName which initially has no compo-
-              nents.
-
-       blt::vector create vecName(size)
-              This second form creates a new vector which  will  contain  size
-              number  of  components.  The components will be indexed starting
-              from zero (0). The default value for the components is 0.0.
-
-       blt::vector create vecName(first:last)
-              The last form creates a new  vector  of  indexed  first  through
-              last.   First and last can be any integer value so long as first
-              is less than last.
-
-       Vector names must start with a letter and consist of  letters,  digits,
-       or  underscores.   #  Error:  must start with letter blt::vector create
-       1abc You can automatically generate vector names using the "#auto" vec-
-       tor  name.   The  create  operation will generate a unique vector name.
-       set vec [blt::vector create #auto] puts "$vec has [$vec length]  compo-
-       nents"
-
-   VECTOR INDICES
-       Vectors  are indexed by integers.  You can access the individual vector
-       components via its array variable or Tcl command.   The  string  repre-
-       senting  the index can be an integer, a numeric expression, a range, or
-       a special keyword.
-
-       The index must lie within the current range of the vector, otherwise an
-       an  error  message  is  returned.  Normally the indices of a vector are
-       start from 0.  But you can use the offset operation to  change  a  vec-
-       tor's  indices  on-the-fly.   puts  $vecName(0)  vecName offset -5 puts
-       $vecName(-5) You can also use  numeric  expressions  as  indices.   The
-       result  of  the expression must be an integer value.  set n 21 set vec-
-       Name($n+3) 50.2 The following special non-numeric  indices  are  avail-
-       able:  min,  max, end, and ++end.  puts "min = $vecName($min)" set vec-
-       Name(end) -1.2 The indices min and max will return the minimum and max-
-       imum values of the vector.  The index end returns the value of the last
-       component in the vector.  The index ++end is used to append  new  value
-       onto  the vector.  It automatically extends the vector by one component
-       and sets its value.  # Append an new component  to  the  end  set  vec-
-       Name(++end)  3.2 A range of indices can be indicated by a colon (:).  #
-       Set the first six components to 1.0 set vecName(0:5) 1.0 If no index is
-       supplied the first or last component is assumed.  # Print the values of
-       all the components puts $vecName(:)
-
-
-
-

VECTOR OPERATIONS

-       blt::vector create vecName?(size)?... ?switches?
-              The create operation creates a new vector vecName.  Both  a  Tcl
-              command  and  array variable vecName are also created.  The name
-                     then  no  variable  will be mapped.  You can always map a
-                     variable back to the vector using the  vector's  variable
-                     operation.
-
-              -command cmdName
-                     Maps  a  Tcl  command  to  the  vector. The vector can be
-                     accessed using cmdName and one  of  the  vector  instance
-                     operations.   A  Tcl  command by that name cannot already
-                     exist.  If cmdName is the empty string, no  command  map-
-                     ping will be made.
-
-              -watchunset boolean
-                     Indicates  that  the  vector  should automatically delete
-                     itself if the variable  associated  with  the  vector  is
-                     unset.  By default, the vector will not be deleted.  This
-                     is different from  previous  releases.   Set  boolean  to
-                     "true" to get the old behavior.
-
-       blt::vector destroy vecName ?vecName...?
-              Deletes  one  or  more  vectors.  Both the Tcl command and array
-              variable are removed also.
-
-       blt::vector expr expression
-              All binary operators take vectors  as  operands  (remember  that
-              numbers are treated as one-component vectors).  The exact action
-              of binary operators depends upon the length of the second  oper-
-              and.   If  the  second operand has only one component, then each
-              element of the first vector operand is computed by  that  value.
-              For  example,  the  expression "x * 2" multiples all elements of
-              the vector x by 2.  If the second operand has more than one com-
-              ponent,  both  operands  must  be the same length.  Each pair of
-              corresponding elements are computed.  So "x + y"  adds  the  the
-              first components of x and y together, the second, and so on.
-
-              The  valid  operators  are  listed  below, grouped in decreasing
-              order of precedence:
-
-              -  !                Unary minus  and  logical  NOT.   The  unary
-                                  minus  flips  the  sign of each component in
-                                  the  vector.   The  logical   not   operator
-                                  returns  a vector of whose values are 0.0 or
-                                  1.0.  For each  non-zero  component  1.0  is
-                                  returned, 0.0 otherwise.
-
-              ^                   Exponentiation.
-
-              *  /  %             Multiply, divide, remainder.
-
-              +  -                Add and subtract.
-
-              <<  >>              Left and right shift.  Circularly shifts the
-                                  values of the vector (not implemented  yet).
-
-              &&                  Logical AND.  Produces a 1  result  if  both
-                                  operands are non-zero, 0 otherwise.
-
-              ||                  Logical OR.  Produces a 0 result if both op-
-                                  erands are zero, 1 otherwise.
-
-              x?y:z               If-then-else, as  in  C.   (Not  implemented
-                                  yet).
-
-              See  the  C  manual  for more details on the results produced by
-              each operator.  All of the binary operators group  left-to-right
-              within the same precedence level.
-
-              Several  mathematical functions are supported for vectors.  Each
-              of the following functions invokes the math library function  of
-              the  same name; see the manual entries for the library functions
-              for details on what they do.  The operation is  applied  to  all
-              elements     of    the    vector    returning    the    results.
-              acos    cos     hypot   sinh        asin    cosh    log     sqrt
-              atan    exp     log10   tan ceil    floor   sin     tanh
-
-              Additional functions are:
-
-              abs       Returns the absolute value of each component.
-
-              random    Returns a vector of non-negative values uniformly dis-
-                        tributed between [0.0, 1.0) using drand48.   The  seed
-                        comes from the internal clock of the machine or may be
-                        set manual with the srandom function.
-
-              round     Rounds each component of the vector.
-
-              srandom   Initializes the random number generator using srand48.
-                        The high order 32-bits are set using the integral por-
-                        tion of the first vector component. All  other  compo-
-                        nents  are  ignored.  The low order 16-bits are set to
-                        an arbitrary value.
-
-              The following functions return a single value.
-
-              adev      Returns the average deviation (defined as the  sum  of
-                        the  absolute values of the differences between compo-
-                        nent and the mean, divided by the length of  the  vec-
-                        tor).
-
-              kurtosis  Returns  the  degree  of peakedness (fourth moment) of
-                        the vector.
-
-              length    Returns the number of components in the vector.
-
-              max       Returns the vector's maximum value.
-
-
-              skew      Returns  the skewness (or third moment) of the vector.
-                        This characterizes the degree of asymmetry of the vec-
-                        tor about the mean.
-
-              sum       Returns the sum of the components.
-
-              var       Returns  the  variance  of  the vector. The sum of the
-                        squared differences between  each  component  and  the
-                        mean  is computed.  The variance is the sum divided by
-                        the length of the vector minus 1.
-
-              The last set returns a vector of the same length  as  the  argu-
-              ment.
-
-              norm      Scales  the  values  of the vector to lie in the range
-                        [0.0..1.0].
-
-              sort      Returns the  vector  components  sorted  in  ascending
-                        order.
-
-       vector names ?pattern?
-
-
-
-

INSTANCE OPERATIONS

-       You  can  also use the vector's Tcl command to query or modify it.  The
-       general form is vecName operation  ?arg?...   Both  operation  and  its
-       arguments  determine the exact behavior of the command.  The operations
-       available for vectors are listed below.
-
-       vecName append item ?item?...
-              Appends the component values from item to vecName.  Item can  be
-              either the name of a vector or a list of numeric values.
-
-       vecName binread channel ?length? ?switches?
-              Reads  binary  values  from  a  Tcl  channel.  Values are either
-              appended to the end of the vector or placed  at  a  given  index
-              (using  the  -at  option), overwriting existing values.  Data is
-              read until EOF is found on the channel or a specified number  of
-              values  length  are  read (note that this is not necessarily the
-              same as the number of bytes). The following  switches  are  sup-
-              ported:
-
-              -swap  Swap  bytes  and  words.   The default endian is the host
-                     machine.
-
-              -at index
-                     New values will start at vector index index.   This  will
-                     overwrite any current values.
-
-              -format format
-                     Specifies  the  format of the data.  Format can be one of
-                     the following: "i1", "i2", "i4", "i8", "u1,  "u2",  "u4",
-
-              This is useful when the vector is large.
-
-       vecName delete index ?index?...
-              Deletes the indexth component from the vector vecName.  Index is
-              the  index  of  the  element to be deleted.  This is the same as
-              unsetting the array variable element index.  The vector is  com-
-              pacted after all the indices have been deleted.
-
-       vecName dup destName
-              Copies  vecName  to destName. DestName is the name of a destina-
-              tion vector.  If a vector destName already exists, it  is  over-
-              written  with the components of vecName.  Otherwise a new vector
-              is created.
-
-       vecName expr expression
-              Computes the expression and resets  the  values  of  the  vector
-              accordingly.    Both  scalar  and  vector  math  operations  are
-              allowed.  All values in expressions are either real  numbers  or
-              names of vectors.  All numbers are treated as one component vec-
-              tors.
-
-       vecName length ?newSize?
-              Queries or resets the number of components in vecName.   NewSize
-              is  a  number specifying the new size of the vector.  If newSize
-              is smaller than the current size of vecName,  vecName  is  trun-
-              cated.   If  newSize  is greater, the vector is extended and the
-              new components are initialized to 0.0.  If no  newSize  argument
-              is present, the current length of the vector is returned.
-
-       vecName merge srcName ?srcName?...
-              Merges  the  named  vectors into a single vector.  The resulting
-              vector is formed by merging the components of each source vector
-              one index at a time.
-
-       vecName notify keyword
-              Controls  how vector clients are notified of changes to the vec-
-              tor.  The exact behavior is determined by keyword.
-
-              always Indicates that clients are  to  be  notified  immediately
-                     whenever the vector is updated.
-
-              never  Indicates that no clients are to be notified.
-
-              whenidle
-                     Indicates  that  clients  are  to be notified at the next
-                     idle point whenever the vector is updated.
-
-              now    If any client notifications is  currently  pending,  they
-                     are notified immediately.
-
-              cancel Cancels  pending  notifications of clients using the vec-
-                     tor.
-
-              density number of new components, whose values are  evenly  dis-
-              tributed between the original components values.  This is useful
-              for generating abscissas to be interpolated along a spline.
-
-       vecName range firstIndex ?lastIndex?...
-              Returns a list of numeric values representing the vector  compo-
-              nents  between  two  indices.  Both firstIndex and lastIndex are
-              indices representing the range of components to be returned.  If
-              lastIndex  is less than firstIndex, the components are listed in
-              reverse order.
-
-       vecName search value ?value?
-              Searches for a value or range of values among the components  of
-              vecName.   If  one value argument is given, a list of indices of
-              the components which equal value is returned.  If a second value
-              is  also  provided, then the indices of all components which lie
-              within the range of the two values are returned.  If  no  compo-
-              nents are found, then "" is returned.
-
-       vecName set item
-              Resets  the components of the vector to item. Item can be either
-              a list of numeric expressions or another vector.
-
-       vecName seq start ?finish? ?step?
-              Generates a sequence of values starting with  the  value  start.
-              Finish  indicates  the  terminating  value of the sequence.  The
-              vector is automatically resized to contain  just  the  sequence.
-              If three arguments are present, step designates the interval.
-
-              With  only two arguments (no finish argument), the sequence will
-              continue until the vector is filled.   With  one  argument,  the
-              interval defaults to 1.0.
-
-       vecName sort ?-reverse? ?argName?...
-              Sorts  the  vector vecName in increasing order.  If the -reverse
-              flag is present, the vector is sorted in decreasing  order.   If
-              other  arguments argName are present, they are the names of vec-
-              tors which will be rearranged in the  same  manner  as  vecName.
-              Each  vector  must be the same length as vecName.  You could use
-              this to sort the x vector of a graph, while still retaining  the
-              same x,y coordinate pairs in a y vector.
-
-       vecName variable varName
-              Maps  a  Tcl  variable to the vector, creating another means for
-              accessing the vector.  The variable varName can't already exist.
-              This overrides any current variable mapping the vector may have.
-
-
-
-

C LANGUAGE API

-       You can create, modify, and destroy vectors from C code, using  library
-       routines.   You  need to include the header file blt.h. It contains the
-       definition of the structure Blt_Vector, which  represents  the  vector.
-       It appears below.  typedef struct {
-       Blt_CreateVector
-
-         Synopsis: int Blt_CreateVector (interp, vecName, length, vecPtrPtr)
-                      Tcl_Interp  *interp; char *vecName; int length; Blt_Vec-
-                      tor **vecPtrPtr;
-
-         Description:
-                   Creates a new vector  vecName  with  a  length  of  length.
-                   Blt_CreateVector  creates  both a new Tcl command and array
-                   variable vecName.  Neither a  command  nor  variable  named
-                   vecName  can  already  exist.   A  pointer to the vector is
-                   placed into vecPtrPtr.
-
-         Results:  Returns TCL_OK if the vector is successfully  created.   If
-                   length  is  negative,  a  Tcl  variable  or command vecName
-                   already exists, or memory cannot be allocated for the  vec-
-                   tor,  then  TCL_ERROR  is  returned and interp->result will
-                   contain an error message.
-
-
-       Blt_DeleteVectorByName
-
-         Synopsis: int Blt_DeleteVectorByName (interp, vecName)
-                      Tcl_Interp *interp; char *vecName;
-
-         Description:
-                   Removes the vector vecName.  VecName is the name of a  vec-
-                   tor  which  must  already  exist.  Both the Tcl command and
-                   array variable vecName are destroyed.  All clients  of  the
-                   vector  will  be  notified  immediately that the vector has
-                   been destroyed.
-
-         Results:  Returns TCL_OK if the vector is successfully  deleted.   If
-                   vecName  is  not  the  name  a  vector,  then  TCL_ERROR is
-                   returned and interp->result will contain an error  message.
-
-
-       Blt_DeleteVector
-
-         Synopsis: int Blt_DeleteVector (vecPtr)
-                      Blt_Vector *vecPtr;
-
-         Description:
-                   Removes  the  vector  pointed  to  by  vecPtr.  VecPtr is a
-                   pointer to a vector,  typically  set  by  Blt_GetVector  or
-                   Blt_CreateVector.   Both the Tcl command and array variable
-                   of the vector are destroyed.  All  clients  of  the  vector
-                   will  be  notified  immediately  that  the  vector has been
-                   destroyed.
-
-         Results:  Returns TCL_OK if the vector is successfully  deleted.   If
-                   vecName  is  not  the  name  a  vector,  then  TCL_ERROR is
-
-         Results:  Returns TCL_OK if the vector is successfully retrieved.  If
-                   vecName  is  not  the  name  of a vector, then TCL_ERROR is
-                   returned and interp->result will contain an error  message.
-
-
-       Blt_ResetVector
-
-
-         Synopsis: int  Blt_ResetVector  (vecPtr,  dataArr,         numValues,
-                   arraySize, freeProc)
-                      Blt_Vector *vecPtr; double *dataArr; int *numValues; int
-                      *arraySize; Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc;
-
-         Description:
-                   Resets  the  components of the vector pointed to by vecPtr.
-                   Calling Blt_ResetVector will trigger the vector to dispatch
-                   notifications  to its clients. DataArr is the array of dou-
-                   bles which represents the vector  data.  NumValues  is  the
-                   number  of  elements  in the array. ArraySize is the actual
-                   size of the array (the array may be bigger than the  number
-                   of values stored in it). FreeProc indicates how the storage
-                   for the vector component array (dataArr) was allocated.  It
-                   is used to determine how to reallocate memory when the vec-
-                   tor is resized  or  destroyed.   It  must  be  TCL_DYNAMIC,
-                   TCL_STATIC,  TCL_VOLATILE,  or  a  pointer to a function to
-                   free the memory allocated for the vector array. If freeProc
-                   is  TCL_VOLATILE,  it indicates that dataArr must be copied
-                   and saved.  If freeProc is TCL_DYNAMIC, it  indicates  that
-                   dataArr  was dynamically allocated and that Tcl should free
-                   dataArr if necessary.  Static indicates that nothing should
-                   be done to release storage for dataArr.
-
-         Results:  Returns  TCL_OK  if the vector is successfully resized.  If
-                   newSize is negative, a vector vecName does  not  exist,  or
-                   memory  cannot  be allocated for the vector, then TCL_ERROR
-                   is returned and interp->result will contain an  error  mes-
-                   sage.
-
-
-       Blt_ResizeVector
-
-         Synopsis: int Blt_ResizeVector (vecPtr, newSize)
-                      Blt_Vector *vecPtr; int newSize;
-
-         Description:
-                   Resets  the  length  of  the vector pointed to by vecPtr to
-                   newSize.  If newSize is smaller than the  current  size  of
-                   the  vector,  it  is truncated.  If newSize is greater, the
-                   vector is extended and the new components  are  initialized
-                   to 0.0.  Calling Blt_ResetVector will trigger the vector to
-                   dispatch notifications.
-
-            Results:  Returns 1 if a vector vecName exists and 0 otherwise.
-
-
-         If  your  application  needs to be notified when a vector changes, it
-         can allocate a unique client identifier for itself.  Using this iden-
-         tifier,  you  can  then  register a call-back to be made whenever the
-         vector is updated or destroyed.  By default, the call-backs are  made
-         at the next idle point.  This can be changed to occur at the time the
-         vector is modified.  An application can allocate more than one  iden-
-         tifier  for any vector.  When the client application is done with the
-         vector, it should free the identifier.
-
-         The call-back routine must of the following type.
-
-                typedef void (Blt_VectorChangedProc) (Tcl_Interp *interp,
-                   ClientData clientData, Blt_VectorNotify notify);
-
-         ClientData is passed to this routine whenever it is called.  You  can
-         use  this  to pass information to the call-back.  The notify argument
-         indicates whether the vector has been updated of destroyed. It is  an
-         enumerated type.
-
-                typedef enum {
-                    BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_UPDATE=1,
-                    BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY=2 } Blt_VectorNotify;
-
-
-         Blt_AllocVectorId
-
-            Synopsis: Blt_VectorId Blt_AllocVectorId (interp, vecName)
-                        Tcl_Interp *interp; char *vecName;
-
-            Description:
-                      Allocates  an client identifier for with the vector vec-
-                      Name.  This identifier can be used to  specify  a  call-
-                      back  which  is  triggered when the vector is updated or
-                      destroyed.
-
-            Results:  Returns a client identifier if successful.   If  vecName
-                      is  not  the name of a vector, then NULL is returned and
-                      interp->result will contain an error message.
-
-
-         Blt_GetVectorById
-
-            Synopsis: int Blt_GetVector (interp, clientId, vecPtrPtr)
-                        Tcl_Interp *interp; Blt_VectorId clientId;  Blt_Vector
-                        **vecPtrPtr;
-
-            Description:
-                      Retrieves  the  vector  used by clientId.  ClientId is a
-                      valid   vector   client    identifier    allocated    by
-                      Specifies  a call-back routine to be called whenever the
-                      vector associated with clientId is updated  or  deleted.
-                      Proc  is  a  pointer to call-back routine and must be of
-                      the type Blt_VectorChangedProc.  ClientData  is  a  one-
-                      word  value  to  be  passed  to  the  routine when it is
-                      invoked. If proc is NULL, then the client is  not  noti-
-                      fied.
-
-            Results:  The  designated call-back procedure will be invoked when
-                      the vector is updated or destroyed.
-
-
-         Blt_FreeVectorId
-
-            Synopsis: void Blt_FreeVectorId (clientId);
-                        Blt_VectorId clientId;
-
-            Description:
-                      Frees the client identifier.  Memory allocated  for  the
-                      identifier  is  released.   The client will no longer be
-                      notified when the vector is modified.
-
-            Results:  The designated call-back procedure will be no longer  be
-                      invoked when the vector is updated or destroyed.
-
-
-         Blt_NameOfVectorId
-
-            Synopsis: char *Blt_NameOfVectorId (clientId);
-                        Blt_VectorId clientId;
-
-            Description:
-                      Retrieves  the  name  of  the vector associated with the
-                      client identifier clientId.
-
-            Results:  Returns the name of the vector associated with clientId.
-                      If  clientId is not an identifier or the vector has been
-                      destroyed, NULL is returned.
-
-
-         Blt_InstallIndexProc
-
-            Synopsis: void Blt_InstallIndexProc (indexName, procPtr)
-                        char *indexName; Blt_VectorIndexProc *procPtr;
-
-            Description:
-                      Registers a function to be called to retrieved the index
-                      indexName from the vector's array variable.
-
-                      typedef double Blt_VectorIndexProc(Vector *vecPtr);
-
-                      The  function  will  be  passed a pointer to the vector.
-
-       reset  shortly.  The  vector  is updated when lt_ResetVector is called.
-       Blt_ResetVector makes the changes visible  to  the  Tcl  interface  and
-       other vector clients (such as a graph widget).
-
-       #include  <tcl.h>  #include  <blt.h>         Blt_Vector *vecPtr; double
-       *newArr; FILE *f; struct stat statBuf; int numBytes, numValues;
-
-       f = fopen("binary.dat", "r"); fstat(fileno(f),  &statBuf);  numBytes  =
-       (int)statBuf.st_size;
-
-       /*  Allocate an array big enough to hold all the data */ newArr = (dou-
-       ble  *)malloc(numBytes);  numValues  =   numBytes   /   sizeof(double);
-       fread((void *)newArr, numValues, sizeof(double), f); fclose(f);
-
-       if (Blt_VectorExists(interp, "data"))  {
-           if   (Blt_GetVector(interp,   "data",   &vecPtr)   !=   TCL_OK)   {
-               return TCL_ERROR;
-           } } else {
-          if  (Blt_CreateVector(interp,  "data",  0,  &vecPtr)  !=  TCL_OK)  {
-               return TCL_ERROR;
-          } } /*
-        * Reset the vector. Clients will be notified when Tk is idle.
-        * TCL_DYNAMIC tells the vector to free the memory allocated
-        * if it needs to reallocate or destroy the vector.
-        */   if   (Blt_ResetVector(vecPtr,   newArr,   numValues,   numValues,
-               TCL_DYNAMIC) != TCL_OK) {
-           return TCL_ERROR; }
-
-
-
-

INCOMPATIBILITIES

-       In previous versions, if the array variable isn't global (i.e. local to
-       a Tcl procedure), the vector is automatically destroyed when the proce-
-       dure returns.  proc doit {} {
-           # Temporary vector x
-           vector x(10)
-           set x(9) 2.0
-             ...  }
-
-       This has changed.  Variables are not automatically destroyed when their
-       variable  is  unset.   You  can restore the old behavior by setting the
-       "-watchunset" switch.
-
-
-
-

KEYWORDS

-       vector, graph, widget
-
-
-
-BLT                               BLT_VERSION                   blt::vector(n)
-
-
-
-Man(1) output converted with -man2html -
- - diff --git a/tkblt/doc/vector.n b/tkblt/doc/vector.n deleted file mode 100644 index fa8bb7e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/doc/vector.n +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1134 +0,0 @@ -'\" -'\" Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA -'\" This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made -'\" available under the same terms. -'\" -'\" Copyright 1991-1997 by Lucent Technologies, Inc. -'\" -'\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its -'\" documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided -'\" that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that the -'\" copyright notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting documentation, -'\" and that the names of Lucent Technologies any of their entities not be used -'\" in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software -'\" without specific, written prior permission. -'\" -'\" Lucent Technologies disclaims all warranties with regard to this software, -'\" including all implied warranties of merchantability and fitness. In no event -'\" shall Lucent Technologies be liable for any special, indirect or -'\" consequential damages or any damages whatsoever resulting from loss of use, -'\" data or profits, whether in an action of contract, negligence or other -'\" tortuous action, arising out of or in connection with the use or performance -'\" of this software. -'\" -'\" Vector command created by George Howlett. -'\" -.TH blt::vector n BLT_VERSION BLT "BLT Built-In Commands" -.BS -'\" Note: do not modify the .SH NAME line immediately below! -.SH NAME -\fBvector\fR \- Vector data type for Tcl -.SH SYNOPSIS -\fBblt::vector create \fIvecName \fR?\fIvecName\fR...? ?\fIswitches\fR? -.sp -\fBblt::vector destroy \fIvecName \fR?\fIvecName\fR...? -.sp -\fBblt::vector expr \fIexpression\fR -.sp -\fBblt::vector names \fR?\fIpattern\fR...? -.BE -.SH DESCRIPTION -The \fBvector\fR command creates an array of floating point -values. The vector's components can be manipulated in three ways: -through a Tcl array variable, a Tcl command, or the C API. -.SH INTRODUCTION -A vector is an ordered set of real numbers. The components of a -vector are indexed by integers. -.PP -Vectors are common data structures for many applications. For -example, a graph may use two vectors to represent the X-Y -coordinates of the data plotted. The graph will automatically -be redrawn when the vectors are updated or changed. By using vectors, -you can separate -data analysis from the graph widget. This makes it easier, for -example, to add data transformations, such as splines. It's possible -to plot the same data to in multiple graphs, where each graph presents -a different view or scale of the data. -.PP -You could try to use Tcl's associative arrays as vectors. Tcl arrays -are easy to use. You can access individual elements randomly by -specifying the index, or the set the entire array by providing a list -of index and value pairs for each element. The disadvantages of -associative arrays as vectors lie in the fact they are implemented as -hash tables. -.TP 2 -\(bu -There's no implied ordering to the associative arrays. If you used -vectors for plotting, you would want to insure the second component -comes after the first, an so on. This isn't possible since arrays -are actually hash tables. For example, you can't get a range of -values between two indices. Nor can you sort an array. -.TP 2 -\(bu -Arrays consume lots of memory when the number of elements becomes -large (tens of thousands). This is because each element's index and -value are stored as strings in the hash table. -.TP 2 -\(bu -The C programming interface is unwieldy. Normally with vectors, you -would like to view the Tcl array as you do a C array, as an array of -floats or doubles. But with hash tables, you must convert both the -index and value to and from decimal strings, just to access -an element in the array. This makes it cumbersome to perform operations on -the array as a whole. -.PP -The \fBvector\fR command tries to overcome these disadvantages while -still retaining the ease of use of Tcl arrays. The \fBvector\fR -command creates both a new Tcl command and associate array which are -linked to the vector components. You can randomly access vector -components though the elements of array. Not have all indices are -generated for the array, so printing the array (using the \fBparray\fR -procedure) does not print out all the component values. You can use -the Tcl command to access the array as a whole. You can copy, append, -or sort vector using its command. If you need greater performance, or -customized behavior, you can write your own C code to manage vectors. -.SH EXAMPLE -You create vectors using the \fBvector\fR command and its \fBcreate\fR -operation. -.CS -# Create a new vector. -blt::vector create y(50) -.CE -This creates a new vector named \f(CWy\fR. It has fifty components, by -default, initialized to \f(CW0.0\fR. In addition, both a Tcl command -and array variable, both named \f(CWy\fR, are created. You can use -either the command or variable to query or modify components of the -vector. -.CS -# Set the first value. -set y(0) 9.25 -puts "y has [y length] components" -.CE -The array \f(CWy\fR can be used to read or set individual components of -the vector. Vector components are indexed from zero. The array index -must be a number less than the number of components. For example, -it's an error if you try to set the 51st element of \f(CWy\fR. -.CS -# This is an error. The vector only has 50 components. -set y(50) 0.02 -.CE -You can also specify a range of indices using a colon (:) to separate -the first and last indices of the range. -.CS -# Set the first six components of y -set y(0:5) 25.2 -.CE -If you don't include an index, then it will default to the first -and/or last component of the vector. -.CS -# Print out all the components of y -puts "y = $y(:)" -.CE -There are special non-numeric indices. The index \f(CWend\fR, specifies -the last component of the vector. It's an error to use this index if -the vector is empty (length is zero). The index \f(CW++end\fR can be -used to extend the vector by one component and initialize it to a specific -value. You can't read from the array using this index, though. -.CS -# Extend the vector by one component. -set y(++end) 0.02 -.CE -The other special indices are \f(CWmin\fR and \f(CWmax\fR. They return the -current smallest and largest components of the vector. -.CS -# Print the bounds of the vector -puts "min=$y(min) max=$y(max)" -.CE -To delete components from a vector, simply unset the corresponding -array element. In the following example, the first component of -\f(CWy\fR is deleted. All the remaining components of \f(CWy\fR will be -moved down by one index as the length of the vector is reduced by -one. -.CS -# Delete the first component -unset y(0) -puts "new first element is $y(0)" -.CE -The vector's Tcl command can also be used to query or set the vector. -.CS -# Create and set the components of a new vector -blt::vector create x -x set { 0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20 } -.CE -Here we've created a vector \f(CWx\fR without a initial length specification. -In this case, the length is zero. The \fBset\fR operation resets the vector, -extending it and setting values for each new component. -.PP -There are several operations for vectors. The \fBrange\fR operation -lists the components of a vector between two indices. -.CS -# List the components -puts "x = [x range 0 end]" -.CE -You can search for a particular value using the \fBsearch\fR -operation. It returns a list of indices of the components with the -same value. If no component has the same value, it returns \f(CW""\fR. -.CS -# Find the index of the biggest component -set indices [x search $x(max)] -.CE -Other operations copy, append, or sort vectors. You can append -vectors or new values onto an existing vector with the \fBappend\fR -operation. -.CS -# Append assorted vectors and values to x -x append x2 x3 { 2.3 4.5 } x4 -.CE -The \fBsort\fR operation sorts the vector. If any additional vectors -are specified, they are rearranged in the same order as the vector. -For example, you could use it to sort data points represented by x and -y vectors. -.CS -# Sort the data points -x sort y -.CE -The vector \f(CWx\fR is sorted while the components of \f(CWy\fR are -rearranged so that the original x,y coordinate pairs are retained. -.PP -The \fBexpr\fR operation lets you perform arithmetic on vectors. -The result is stored in the vector. -.CS -# Add the two vectors and a scalar -x expr { x + y } -x expr { x * 2 } -.CE -When a vector is modified, resized, or deleted, it may trigger -call-backs to notify the clients of the vector. For example, when a -vector used in the \fBgraph\fR widget is updated, the vector -automatically notifies the widget that it has changed. The graph can -then redrawn itself at the next idle point. By default, the -notification occurs when Tk is next idle. This way you can modify the -vector many times without incurring the penalty of the graph redrawing -itself for each change. You can change this behavior using the -\fBnotify\fR operation. -.CS -# Make vector x notify after every change -x notify always - ... -# Never notify -x notify never - ... -# Force notification now -x notify now -.CE -To delete a vector, use the \fBvector delete\fR command. -Both the vector and its corresponding Tcl command are destroyed. -.CS -# Remove vector x -blt::vector destroy x -.CE -.SH SYNTAX -Vectors are created using the \fBvector create\fR operation. -Th \fBcreate\fR operation can be invoked in one of three forms: -.TP -\fBblt::vector create \fIvecName\fR -This creates a new vector \fIvecName\fR which initially has no components. -.TP -\fBblt::vector create \fIvecName\fR(\fIsize\fR) -This second form creates a new vector which will contain \fIsize\fR -number of components. The components will be indexed starting from -zero (0). The default value for the components is \f(CW0.0\fR. -.TP -\fBblt::vector create \fIvecName\fR(\fIfirst\fR:\fIlast\fR) -The last form creates a new vector of indexed \fIfirst\fR through -\fIlast\fR. \fIFirst\fR and \fIlast\fR can be any integer value -so long as \fIfirst\fR is less than \fIlast\fR. -.PP -Vector names must start with a letter and consist of letters, digits, -or underscores. -.CS -# Error: must start with letter -blt::vector create 1abc -.CE -You can automatically generate vector names using the -"\f(CW#auto\fR" vector name. The \fBcreate\fR operation will generate a -unique vector name. -.CS -set vec [blt::vector create #auto] -puts "$vec has [$vec length] components" -.CE -.SS VECTOR INDICES -Vectors are indexed by integers. You can access the individual vector -components via its array variable or Tcl command. The string -representing the index can be an integer, a numeric expression, a -range, or a special keyword. -.PP -The index must lie within the current range of the vector, otherwise -an an error message is returned. Normally the indices of a vector -are start from 0. But you can use the \fBoffset\fR operation to -change a vector's indices on-the-fly. -.CS -puts $vecName(0) -vecName offset -5 -puts $vecName(-5) -.CE -You can also use numeric expressions as indices. The result -of the expression must be an integer value. -.CS -set n 21 -set vecName($n+3) 50.2 -.CE -The following special non-numeric indices are available: \f(CWmin\fR, \f(CWmax\fR, \f(CWend\fR, and -\f(CW++end\fR. -.CS -puts "min = $vecName($min)" -set vecName(end) -1.2 -.CE -The indices \f(CWmin\fR and \f(CWmax\fR will return the minimum and maximum -values of the vector. The index \f(CWend\fR returns the value of the -last component in the vector. The index \f(CW++end\fR is used to append -new value onto the vector. It automatically extends the vector by -one component and sets its value. -.CS -# Append an new component to the end -set vecName(++end) 3.2 -.CE -A range of indices can be indicated by a colon (:). -.CS -# Set the first six components to 1.0 -set vecName(0:5) 1.0 -.CE -If no index is supplied the first or last component is assumed. -.CS -# Print the values of all the components -puts $vecName(:) -.CE -.SH VECTOR OPERATIONS -.TP -\fBblt::vector create \fIvecName\fR?(\fIsize\fR)?... \fR?\fIswitches\fR? -The \fBcreate\fR operation creates a new vector \fIvecName\fR. Both a -Tcl command and array variable \fIvecName\fR are also created. The -name \fIvecName\fR must be unique, so another Tcl command or array -variable can not already exist in that scope. You can access the -components of the vector using its variable. If you change a value in -the array, or unset an array element, the vector is updated to reflect -the changes. When the variable \fIvecName\fR is unset, the vector and -its Tcl command are also destroyed. -.sp -The vector has optional switches that affect how the vector is created. They -are as follows: -.RS -.TP -\fB\-variable \fIvarName\fR -Specifies the name of a Tcl variable to be mapped to the vector. If -the variable already exists, it is first deleted, then recreated. -If \fIvarName\fR is the empty string, then no variable will be mapped. -You can always map a variable back to the vector using the vector's -\fBvariable\fR operation. -.TP -\fB\-command \fIcmdName\fR -Maps a Tcl command to the vector. The vector can be accessed using -\fIcmdName\fR and one of the vector instance operations. -A Tcl command by that name cannot already exist. -If \fIcmdName\fR is the empty string, no command mapping -will be made. -.TP -\fB\-watchunset \fIboolean\fR -Indicates that the vector should automatically delete itself if -the variable associated with the vector is unset. By default, -the vector will not be deleted. This is different from previous -releases. Set \fIboolean\fR to "true" to get the old behavior. -.RE -.TP -\fBblt::vector destroy \fIvecName\fR \fR?\fIvecName...\fR? -Deletes one or more vectors. Both the Tcl command and array variable -are removed also. -.TP -\fBblt::vector expr \fIexpression\fR -.RS -All binary operators take vectors as operands (remember that numbers -are treated as one-component vectors). The exact action of binary -operators depends upon the length of the second operand. If the -second operand has only one component, then each element of the first -vector operand is computed by that value. For example, the expression -"x * 2" multiples all elements of the vector x by 2. If the second -operand has more than one component, both operands must be the same -length. Each pair of corresponding elements are computed. So "x + y" -adds the the first components of x and y together, the second, and so on. -.sp -The valid operators are listed below, grouped in decreasing order -of precedence: -.TP 20 -\fB\-\0\0!\fR -Unary minus and logical NOT. The unary minus flips the sign of each -component in the vector. The logical not operator returns a vector of -whose values are 0.0 or 1.0. For each non-zero component 1.0 is returned, -0.0 otherwise. -.TP 20 -\fB^\fR -Exponentiation. -.TP 20 -\fB*\0\0/\0\0%\fR -Multiply, divide, remainder. -.TP 20 -\fB+\0\0\-\fR -Add and subtract. -.TP 20 -\fB<<\0\0>>\fR -Left and right shift. Circularly shifts the values of the vector -(not implemented yet). -.TP 20 -\fB<\0\0>\0\0<=\0\0>=\fR -Boolean less, greater, less than or equal, and greater than or equal. -Each operator returns a vector of ones and zeros. If the condition is true, -1.0 is the component value, 0.0 otherwise. -.TP 20 -\fB==\0\0!=\fR -Boolean equal and not equal. -Each operator returns a vector of ones and zeros. If the condition is true, -1.0 is the component value, 0.0 otherwise. -.TP 20 -\fB|\fR -Bit-wise OR. (Not implemented). -.TP 20 -\fB&&\fR -Logical AND. Produces a 1 result if both operands are non-zero, 0 otherwise. -.TP 20 -\fB||\fR -Logical OR. Produces a 0 result if both operands are zero, 1 otherwise. -.TP 20 -\fIx\fB?\fIy\fB:\fIz\fR -If-then-else, as in C. (Not implemented yet). -.LP -See the C manual for more details on the results produced by each -operator. All of the binary operators group left-to-right within the -same precedence level. -.sp -Several mathematical functions are supported for vectors. Each of -the following functions invokes the math library function of the same name; -see the manual entries for the library functions for details on what -they do. The operation is applied to all elements of the vector -returning the results. -.CS -.ta 2c 4c 6c -\fBacos\fR \fBcos\fR \fBhypot\fR \fBsinh\fR -\fBasin\fR \fBcosh\fR \fBlog\fR \fBsqrt\fR -\fBatan\fR \fBexp\fR \fBlog10\fR \fBtan\fR -\fBceil\fR \fBfloor\fR \fBsin\fR \fBtanh\fR -.sp -.CE -Additional functions are: -.TP 1i -\fBabs\fR -Returns the absolute value of each component. -.TP 1i -\fBrandom\fR -Returns a vector of non-negative values uniformly distributed -between [0.0, 1.0) using \fIdrand48\fR. -The seed comes from the internal clock of the machine or may be -set manual with the srandom function. -.TP 1i -\fBround\fR -Rounds each component of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBsrandom\fR -Initializes the random number generator using \fIsrand48\fR. -The high order 32-bits are set using the integral portion of the first -vector component. All other components are ignored. The low order 16-bits -are set to an arbitrary value. -.PP -The following functions return a single value. -.TP 1i -\fBadev\fR -Returns the average deviation (defined as the sum of the absolute values -of the differences between component and the mean, divided by the length -of the vector). -.TP 1i -\fBkurtosis\fR -Returns the degree of peakedness (fourth moment) of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBlength\fR -Returns the number of components in the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBmax\fR -Returns the vector's maximum value. -.TP 1i -\fBmean\fR -Returns the mean value of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBmedian\fR -Returns the median of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBmin\fR -Returns the vector's minimum value. -.TP 1i -\fBq1\fR -Returns the first quartile of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBq3\fR -Returns the third quartile of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBprod\fR -Returns the product of the components. -.TP 1i -\fBsdev\fR -Returns the standard deviation (defined as the square root of the variance) -of the vector. -.TP 1i -\fBskew\fR -Returns the skewness (or third moment) of the vector. This characterizes -the degree of asymmetry of the vector about the mean. -.TP 1i -\fBsum\fR -Returns the sum of the components. -.TP 1i -\fBvar\fR -Returns the variance of the vector. The sum of the squared differences -between each component and the mean is computed. The variance is -the sum divided by the length of the vector minus 1. -.PP -The last set returns a vector of the same length as the argument. -.TP 1i -\fBnorm\fR -Scales the values of the vector to lie in the range [0.0..1.0]. -.TP 1i -\fBsort\fR -Returns the vector components sorted in ascending order. -.RE -.TP -\fBvector names \fR?\fIpattern\fR? -.SH INSTANCE OPERATIONS -You can also use the vector's Tcl command to query or modify it. The -general form is -.DS -\fIvecName \fIoperation\fR \fR?\fIarg\fR?... -.DE -Both \fIoperation\fR and its arguments determine the exact behavior of -the command. The operations available for vectors are listed below. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBappend\fR \fIitem\fR ?\fIitem\fR?... -Appends the component values from \fIitem\fR to \fIvecName\fR. -\fIItem\fR can be either the name of a vector or a list of numeric -values. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBbinread\fR \fIchannel\fR ?\fIlength\fR? ?\fIswitches\fR? -Reads binary values from a Tcl channel. Values are either appended -to the end of the vector or placed at a given index (using the -\fB\-at\fR option), overwriting existing values. Data is read until EOF -is found on the channel or a specified number of values \fIlength\fR -are read (note that this is not necessarily the same as the number of -bytes). The following switches are supported: -.RS -.TP -\fB\-swap\fR -Swap bytes and words. The default endian is the host machine. -.TP -\fB\-at \fIindex\fR -New values will start at vector index \fIindex\fR. This will -overwrite any current values. -.TP -\fB\-format\fR \fIformat\fR -Specifies the format of the data. \fIFormat\fR can be one of the -following: "i1", "i2", "i4", "i8", "u1, "u2", "u4", "u8", "r4", -"r8", or "r16". The number indicates the number of bytes -required for each value. The letter indicates the type: "i" for signed, -"u" for unsigned, "r" or real. The default format is "r16". -.RE -.TP -\fIvecName \fBclear\fR -Clears the element indices from the array variable associated with -\fIvecName\fR. This doesn't affect the components of the vector. By -default, the number of entries in the Tcl array doesn't match the -number of components in the vector. This is because its too expensive -to maintain decimal strings for both the index and value for each -component. Instead, the index and value are saved only when you read -or write an element with a new index. This command removes the index -and value strings from the array. This is useful when the vector is -large. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBdelete\fR \fIindex\fR ?\fIindex\fR?... -Deletes the \fIindex\fRth component from the vector \fIvecName\fR. -\fIIndex\fR is the index of the element to be deleted. This is the -same as unsetting the array variable element \fIindex\fR. The vector -is compacted after all the indices have been deleted. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBdup\fR \fIdestName\fR -Copies \fIvecName\fR to \fIdestName\fR. \fIDestName\fR is the name of a -destination vector. If a vector \fIdestName\fR already exists, it is -overwritten with the components of \fIvecName\fR. Otherwise a -new vector is created. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBexpr\fR \fIexpression\fR -Computes the expression and resets the values of the vector accordingly. -Both scalar and vector math operations are allowed. All values in -expressions are either real numbers or names of vectors. All numbers -are treated as one component vectors. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBlength\fR ?\fInewSize\fR? -Queries or resets the number of components in \fIvecName\fR. -\fINewSize\fR is a number specifying the new size of the vector. If -\fInewSize\fR is smaller than the current size of \fIvecName\fR, -\fIvecName\fR is truncated. If \fInewSize\fR is greater, the vector -is extended and the new components are initialized to \f(CW0.0\fR. If -no \fInewSize\fR argument is present, the current length of the vector -is returned. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBmerge\fR \fIsrcName\fR ?\fIsrcName\fR?... -Merges the named vectors into a single vector. The resulting -vector is formed by merging the components of each source vector -one index at a time. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBnotify\fR \fIkeyword\fR -Controls how vector clients are notified of changes to the vector. -The exact behavior is determined by \fIkeyword\fR. -.RS -.TP 0.75i -\f(CWalways\fR -Indicates that clients are to be notified immediately whenever the -vector is updated. -.TP -\f(CWnever\fR -Indicates that no clients are to be notified. -.TP -\f(CWwhenidle\fR -Indicates that clients are to be notified at the next idle point -whenever the vector is updated. -.TP -\f(CWnow\fR -If any client notifications is currently pending, they are notified -immediately. -.TP -\f(CWcancel\fR -Cancels pending notifications of clients using the vector. -.TP -\f(CWpending\fR -Returns \f(CW1\fR if a client notification is pending, and \f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.RE -.TP -\fIvecName \fBoffset\fR ?\fIvalue\fR? -Shifts the indices of the vector by the amount specified by \fIvalue\fR. -\fIValue\fR is an integer number. If no \fIvalue\fR argument is -given, the current offset is returned. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBpopulate\fR \fIdestName\fR ?\fIdensity\fR? -Creates a vector \fIdestName\fR which is a superset of \fIvecName\fR. -\fIDestName\fR will include all the components of \fIvecName\fR, in -addition the interval between each of the original components will -contain a \fIdensity\fR number of new components, whose values are -evenly distributed between the original components values. This is -useful for generating abscissas to be interpolated along a spline. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBrange\fR \fIfirstIndex\fR ?\fIlastIndex\fR?... -Returns a list of numeric values representing the vector components -between two indices. Both \fIfirstIndex\fR and \fIlastIndex\fR are -indices representing the range of components to be returned. If -\fIlastIndex\fR is less than \fIfirstIndex\fR, the components are -listed in reverse order. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBsearch\fR \fIvalue\fR ?\fIvalue\fR? -Searches for a value or range of values among the components of -\fIvecName\fR. If one \fIvalue\fR argument is given, a list of -indices of the components which equal \fIvalue\fR is returned. If a -second \fIvalue\fR is also provided, then the indices of all -components which lie within the range of the two values are returned. -If no components are found, then \f(CW""\fR is returned. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBset\fR \fIitem\fR -Resets the components of the vector to \fIitem\fR. \fIItem\fR can -be either a list of numeric expressions or another vector. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBseq\fR \fIstart\fR ?\fIfinish\fR? ?\fIstep\fR? -Generates a sequence of values starting with the value \fIstart\fR. -\fIFinish\fR indicates the terminating value of the sequence. -The vector is automatically resized to contain just the sequence. -If three arguments are present, \fIstep\fR designates the interval. -.sp -With only two arguments (no \fIfinish\fR argument), the sequence will -continue until the vector is filled. With one argument, the interval -defaults to 1.0. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBsort\fR ?\fB-reverse\fR? ?\fIargName\fR?... -Sorts the vector \fIvecName\fR in increasing order. If the -\fB-reverse\fR flag is present, the vector is sorted in decreasing -order. If other arguments \fIargName\fR are present, they are the -names of vectors which will be rearranged in the same manner as -\fIvecName\fR. Each vector must be the same length as \fIvecName\fR. -You could use this to sort the x vector of a graph, while still -retaining the same x,y coordinate pairs in a y vector. -.TP -\fIvecName \fBvariable\fR \fIvarName\fR -Maps a Tcl variable to the vector, creating another means for -accessing the vector. The variable \fIvarName\fR can't already -exist. This overrides any current variable mapping the vector -may have. -.RE -.SH C LANGUAGE API -You can create, modify, and destroy vectors from C code, using -library routines. -You need to include the header file \f(CWblt.h\fR. It contains the -definition of the structure \fBBlt_Vector\fR, which represents the -vector. It appears below. -.CS -\fRtypedef struct { - double *\fIvalueArr\fR; - int \fInumValues\fR; - int \fIarraySize\fR; - double \fImin\fR, \fImax\fR; -} \fBBlt_Vector\fR; -.CE -The field \fIvalueArr\fR points to memory holding the vector -components. The components are stored in a double precision array, -whose size size is represented by \fIarraySize\fR. \fINumValues\fR is -the length of vector. The size of the array is always equal to or -larger than the length of the vector. \fIMin\fR and \fImax\fR are -minimum and maximum component values. -.SH LIBRARY ROUTINES -The following routines are available from C to manage vectors. -Vectors are identified by the vector name. -.PP -\fBBlt_CreateVector\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_CreateVector\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIvecName\fR, \fIlength\fR, \fIvecPtrPtr\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -char *\fIvecName\fR; -int \fIlength\fR; -Blt_Vector **\fIvecPtrPtr\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Creates a new vector \fIvecName\fR\fR with a length of \fIlength\fR. -\fBBlt_CreateVector\fR creates both a new Tcl command and array -variable \fIvecName\fR. Neither a command nor variable named -\fIvecName\fR can already exist. A pointer to the vector is -placed into \fIvecPtrPtr\fR. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully created. If -\fIlength\fR is negative, a Tcl variable or command \fIvecName\fR -already exists, or memory cannot be allocated for the vector, then -\f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is returned and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain an -error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_DeleteVectorByName\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_DeleteVectorByName\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIvecName\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -char *\fIvecName\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP 1i -Description: -Removes the vector \fIvecName\fR. \fIVecName\fR is the name of a vector -which must already exist. Both the Tcl command and array variable -\fIvecName\fR are destroyed. All clients of the vector will be notified -immediately that the vector has been destroyed. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully deleted. If -\fIvecName\fR is not the name a vector, then \f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is returned -and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain an error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_DeleteVector\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_DeleteVector\fR (\fIvecPtr\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Blt_Vector *\fIvecPtr\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP 1i -Description: -Removes the vector pointed to by \fIvecPtr\fR. \fIVecPtr\fR is a -pointer to a vector, typically set by \fBBlt_GetVector\fR or -\fBBlt_CreateVector\fR. Both the Tcl command and array variable of -the vector are destroyed. All clients of the vector will be notified -immediately that the vector has been destroyed. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully deleted. If -\fIvecName\fR is not the name a vector, then \f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is returned -and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain an error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_GetVector\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_GetVector\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIvecName\fR, \fIvecPtrPtr\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -char *\fIvecName\fR; -Blt_Vector **\fIvecPtrPtr\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP 1i -Description: -Retrieves the vector \fIvecName\fR. \fIVecName\fR is the name of a -vector which must already exist. \fIVecPtrPtr\fR will point be set to -the address of the vector. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully retrieved. If -\fIvecName\fR is not the name of a vector, then \f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is -returned and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain an error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_ResetVector\fR -.PP -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_ResetVector\fR (\fIvecPtr\fR, \fIdataArr\fR, - \fInumValues\fR, \fIarraySize\fR, \fIfreeProc\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Blt_Vector *\fIvecPtr\fR; -double *\fIdataArr\fR; -int *\fInumValues\fR; -int *\fIarraySize\fR; -Tcl_FreeProc *\fIfreeProc\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Resets the components of the vector pointed to by \fIvecPtr\fR. -Calling \fBBlt_ResetVector\fR will trigger the vector to dispatch -notifications to its clients. \fIDataArr\fR is the array of doubles -which represents the vector data. \fINumValues\fR is the number of -elements in the array. \fIArraySize\fR is the actual size of the array -(the array may be bigger than the number of values stored in -it). \fIFreeProc\fP indicates how the storage for the vector component -array (\fIdataArr\fR) was allocated. It is used to determine how to -reallocate memory when the vector is resized or destroyed. It must be -\f(CWTCL_DYNAMIC\fR, \f(CWTCL_STATIC\fR, \f(CWTCL_VOLATILE\fR, or a pointer -to a function to free the memory allocated for the vector array. If -\fIfreeProc\fR is \f(CWTCL_VOLATILE\fR, it indicates that \fIdataArr\fR -must be copied and saved. If \fIfreeProc\fR is \f(CWTCL_DYNAMIC\fR, it -indicates that \fIdataArr\fR was dynamically allocated and that Tcl -should free \fIdataArr\fR if necessary. \f(CWStatic\fR indicates that -nothing should be done to release storage for \fIdataArr\fR. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully resized. If -\fInewSize\fR is negative, a vector \fIvecName\fR does not exist, or -memory cannot be allocated for the vector, then \f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is -returned and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain an error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_ResizeVector\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_ResizeVector\fR (\fIvecPtr\fR, \fInewSize\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Blt_Vector *\fIvecPtr\fR; -int \fInewSize\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Resets the length of the vector pointed to by \fIvecPtr\fR to -\fInewSize\fR. If \fInewSize\fR is smaller than the current size of -the vector, it is truncated. If \fInewSize\fR is greater, the vector -is extended and the new components are initialized to \f(CW0.0\fR. -Calling \fBBlt_ResetVector\fR will trigger the vector to dispatch -notifications. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully resized. If -\fInewSize\fR is negative or memory can not be allocated for the vector, -then \f(CWTCL_ERROR\fR is returned and \fIinterp->result\fR will contain -an error message. -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_VectorExists\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_VectorExists\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIvecName\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -char *\fIvecName\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Indicates if a vector named \fIvecName\fR exists in \fIinterp\fR. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CW1\fR if a vector \fIvecName\fR exists and \f(CW0\fR otherwise. -.RE -.sp -.PP -If your application needs to be notified when a vector changes, it can -allocate a unique \fIclient identifier\fR for itself. Using this -identifier, you can then register a call-back to be made whenever the -vector is updated or destroyed. By default, the call-backs are made at -the next idle point. This can be changed to occur at the time the -vector is modified. An application can allocate more than one -identifier for any vector. When the client application is done with -the vector, it should free the identifier. -.PP -The call-back routine must of the following type. -.CS -.RS -.sp -typedef void (\fBBlt_VectorChangedProc\fR) (Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR, -.RS .25i -ClientData \fIclientData\fR, Blt_VectorNotify \fInotify\fR); -.RE -.sp -.RE -.CE -.fi -\fIClientData\fR is passed to this routine whenever it is called. You -can use this to pass information to the call-back. The \fInotify\fR -argument indicates whether the vector has been updated of destroyed. It -is an enumerated type. -.CS -.RS -.sp -typedef enum { - \f(CWBLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_UPDATE\fR=1, - \f(CWBLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY\fR=2 -} \fBBlt_VectorNotify\fR; -.sp -.RE -.CE -.PP -\fBBlt_AllocVectorId\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -Blt_VectorId \fBBlt_AllocVectorId\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIvecName\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -char *\fIvecName\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Allocates an client identifier for with the vector \fIvecName\fR. -This identifier can be used to specify a call-back which is triggered -when the vector is updated or destroyed. -.TP -Results: -Returns a client identifier if successful. If \fIvecName\fR is not -the name of a vector, then \f(CWNULL\fR is returned and -\fIinterp->result\fR will contain an error message. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_GetVectorById\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -int \fBBlt_GetVector\fR (\fIinterp\fR, \fIclientId\fR, \fIvecPtrPtr\fR) -.RS 1.25i -Tcl_Interp *\fIinterp\fR; -Blt_VectorId \fIclientId\fR; -Blt_Vector **\fIvecPtrPtr\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP 1i -Description: -Retrieves the vector used by \fIclientId\fR. \fIClientId\fR is a valid -vector client identifier allocated by \fBBlt_AllocVectorId\fR. -\fIVecPtrPtr\fR will point be set to the address of the vector. -.TP -Results: -Returns \f(CWTCL_OK\fR if the vector is successfully retrieved. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_SetVectorChangedProc\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -void \fBBlt_SetVectorChangedProc\fR (\fIclientId\fR, \fIproc\fR, \fIclientData\fR); -.RS 1.25i -Blt_VectorId \fIclientId\fR; -Blt_VectorChangedProc *\fIproc\fR; -ClientData *\fIclientData\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Specifies a call-back routine to be called whenever the vector -associated with \fIclientId\fR is updated or deleted. \fIProc\fR is a -pointer to call-back routine and must be of the type -\fBBlt_VectorChangedProc\fR. \fIClientData\fR is a one-word value to -be passed to the routine when it is invoked. If \fIproc\fR is -\f(CWNULL\fR, then the client is not notified. -.TP -Results: -The designated call-back procedure will be invoked when the vector is -updated or destroyed. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_FreeVectorId\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -void \fBBlt_FreeVectorId\fR (\fIclientId\fR); -.RS 1.25i -Blt_VectorId \fIclientId\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Frees the client identifier. Memory allocated for the identifier -is released. The client will no longer be notified when the -vector is modified. -.TP -Results: -The designated call-back procedure will be no longer be invoked when -the vector is updated or destroyed. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_NameOfVectorId\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -char *\fBBlt_NameOfVectorId\fR (\fIclientId\fR); -.RS 1.25i -Blt_VectorId \fIclientId\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Retrieves the name of the vector associated with the client identifier -\fIclientId\fR. -.TP -Results: -Returns the name of the vector associated with \fIclientId\fR. If -\fIclientId\fR is not an identifier or the vector has been destroyed, -\f(CWNULL\fR is returned. -.RE -.sp -.PP -\fBBlt_InstallIndexProc\fR -.RS .25i -.TP 1i -Synopsis: -.CS -void \fBBlt_InstallIndexProc\fR (\fIindexName\fR, \fIprocPtr\fR) -.RS 1.25i -char *\fIindexName\fR; -Blt_VectorIndexProc *\fIprocPtr\fR; -.RE -.CE -.TP -Description: -Registers a function to be called to retrieved the index \fIindexName\fR -from the vector's array variable. -.sp -typedef double Blt_VectorIndexProc(Vector *vecPtr); -.sp -The function will be passed a pointer to the vector. The function must -return a double representing the value at the index. -.TP -Results: -The new index is installed into the vector. -.RE -.RE -.SH C API EXAMPLE -The following example opens a file of binary data and stores it in an -array of doubles. The array size is computed from the size of the -file. If the vector "data" exists, calling \fBBlt_VectorExists\fR, -\fBBlt_GetVector\fR is called to get the pointer to the vector. -Otherwise the routine \fBBlt_CreateVector\fR is called to create a new -vector and returns a pointer to it. Just like the Tcl interface, both -a new Tcl command and array variable are created when a new vector is -created. It doesn't make any difference what the initial size of the -vector is since it will be reset shortly. The vector is updated when -\fBlt_ResetVector\fR is called. Blt_ResetVector makes the changes -visible to the Tcl interface and other vector clients (such as a graph -widget). -.sp -.CS -#include -#include -... -Blt_Vector *vecPtr; -double *newArr; -FILE *f; -struct stat statBuf; -int numBytes, numValues; - -f = fopen("binary.dat", "r"); -fstat(fileno(f), &statBuf); -numBytes = (int)statBuf.st_size; - -/* Allocate an array big enough to hold all the data */ -newArr = (double *)malloc(numBytes); -numValues = numBytes / sizeof(double); -fread((void *)newArr, numValues, sizeof(double), f); -fclose(f); - -if (Blt_VectorExists(interp, "data")) { - if (Blt_GetVector(interp, "data", &vecPtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} else { - if (Blt_CreateVector(interp, "data", 0, &vecPtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} -/* - * Reset the vector. Clients will be notified when Tk is idle. - * TCL_DYNAMIC tells the vector to free the memory allocated - * if it needs to reallocate or destroy the vector. - */ -if (Blt_ResetVector(vecPtr, newArr, numValues, numValues, - TCL_DYNAMIC) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; -} -.CE -.SH "INCOMPATIBILITIES" -In previous versions, if the array variable isn't global -(i.e. local to a Tcl procedure), the vector is automatically -destroyed when the procedure returns. -.CS -proc doit {} { - # Temporary vector x - vector x(10) - set x(9) 2.0 - ... -} -.CE -.PP -This has changed. Variables are not automatically destroyed when -their variable is unset. You can restore the old behavior by -setting the "-watchunset" switch. -.CE -.SH KEYWORDS -vector, graph, widget diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkblt.decls b/tkblt/generic/tkblt.decls deleted file mode 100644 index b4b5c67..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkblt.decls +++ /dev/null @@ -1,92 +0,0 @@ -library tkblt -interface tkblt - -declare 0 generic { - int Blt_CreateVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - int size, Blt_Vector** vecPtrPtr) -} - -declare 1 generic { - int Blt_CreateVector2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - const char *cmdName, const char *varName, - int initialSize, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr) -} - -declare 2 generic { - int Blt_DeleteVectorByName(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -} - -declare 3 generic { - int Blt_DeleteVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr) -} - -declare 4 generic { - int Blt_GetVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr) -} - -declare 5 generic { - int Blt_GetVectorFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr) -} - -declare 6 generic { - int Blt_ResetVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, double *dataArr, int n, - int arraySize, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc) -} - -declare 7 generic { - int Blt_ResizeVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, int n) -} - -declare 8 generic { - int Blt_VectorExists(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -} - -declare 9 generic { - int Blt_VectorExists2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -} - -declare 10 generic { - Blt_VectorId Blt_AllocVectorId(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -} - -declare 11 generic { - int Blt_GetVectorById(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr) -} - -declare 12 generic { - void Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc, - ClientData clientData) -} - -declare 13 generic { - void Blt_FreeVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId) -} - -declare 14 generic { - const char *Blt_NameOfVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId) -} - -declare 15 generic { - const char *Blt_NameOfVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr) -} - -declare 16 generic { - int Blt_ExprVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *expr, Blt_Vector *vecPtr) -} - -declare 17 generic { - void Blt_InstallIndexProc(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *indexName, - Blt_VectorIndexProc * procPtr) -} - -declare 18 generic { - double Blt_VecMin(Blt_Vector *vPtr) -} - -declare 19 generic { - double Blt_VecMax(Blt_Vector *vPtr) -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.C deleted file mode 100644 index dbd317c..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,194 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltChain.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -// ChainLink - -ChainLink::ChainLink(void* clientData) -{ - prev_ =NULL; - next_ =NULL; - manage_ =0; - clientData_ = clientData; -} - -ChainLink::ChainLink(size_t ss) -{ - prev_ =NULL; - next_ =NULL; - manage_ =1; - clientData_ = (void*)calloc(1,ss); -} - -ChainLink::~ChainLink() -{ - if (manage_ && clientData_) - free(clientData_); -} - -// Chain - -Chain::Chain() -{ - head_ =NULL; - tail_ =NULL; - nLinks_ =0; -} - -Chain::~Chain() -{ - ChainLink* linkPtr = head_; - while (linkPtr) { - ChainLink* oldPtr =linkPtr; - linkPtr = linkPtr->next_; - delete oldPtr; - } -} - -void Chain::reset() -{ - ChainLink* linkPtr = head_; - while (linkPtr) { - ChainLink* oldPtr = linkPtr; - linkPtr = linkPtr->next_; - delete oldPtr; - } - head_ =NULL; - tail_ =NULL; - nLinks_ =0; -} - -void Chain::linkAfter(ChainLink* linkPtr, ChainLink* afterPtr) -{ - if (!head_) { - head_ = linkPtr; - tail_ = linkPtr; - } - else { - if (!afterPtr) { - linkPtr->next_ = NULL; - linkPtr->prev_ = tail_; - tail_->next_ = linkPtr; - tail_ = linkPtr; - } - else { - linkPtr->next_ = afterPtr->next_; - linkPtr->prev_ = afterPtr; - if (afterPtr == tail_) - tail_ = linkPtr; - else - afterPtr->next_->prev_ = linkPtr; - afterPtr->next_ = linkPtr; - } - } - - nLinks_++; -} - -void Chain::linkBefore(ChainLink* linkPtr, ChainLink* beforePtr) -{ - if (!head_) { - head_ = linkPtr; - tail_ = linkPtr; - } - else { - if (beforePtr == NULL) { - linkPtr->next_ = head_; - linkPtr->prev_ = NULL; - head_->prev_ = linkPtr; - head_ = linkPtr; - } - else { - linkPtr->prev_ = beforePtr->prev_; - linkPtr->next_ = beforePtr; - if (beforePtr == head_) - head_ = linkPtr; - else - beforePtr->prev_->next_ = linkPtr; - beforePtr->prev_ = linkPtr; - } - } - - nLinks_++; -} - -void Chain::unlinkLink(ChainLink* linkPtr) -{ - // Indicates if the link is actually remove from the chain - int unlinked; - - unlinked = 0; - if (head_ == linkPtr) { - head_ = linkPtr->next_; - unlinked = 1; - } - if (tail_ == linkPtr) { - tail_ = linkPtr->prev_; - unlinked = 1; - } - if (linkPtr->next_) { - linkPtr->next_->prev_ = linkPtr->prev_; - unlinked = 1; - } - if (linkPtr->prev_) { - linkPtr->prev_->next_ = linkPtr->next_; - unlinked = 1; - } - if (unlinked) - nLinks_--; - - linkPtr->prev_ =NULL; - linkPtr->next_ =NULL; -} - -void Chain::deleteLink(ChainLink* link) -{ - unlinkLink(link); - delete link; - link = NULL; -} - -ChainLink* Chain::append(void* clientData) -{ - ChainLink* link = new ChainLink(clientData); - linkAfter(link, NULL); - return link; -} - -ChainLink* Chain::prepend(void* clientData) -{ - ChainLink* link = new ChainLink(clientData); - linkBefore(link, NULL); - return link; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.h deleted file mode 100644 index 6e254f9..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltChain.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,91 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ -#ifndef _BLT_CHAIN_H -#define _BLT_CHAIN_H - -#define Chain_GetLength(c) (((c) == NULL) ? 0 : (c)->nLinks()) -#define Chain_FirstLink(c) (((c) == NULL) ? NULL : (c)->head()) -#define Chain_LastLink(c) (((c) == NULL) ? NULL : (c)->tail()) - -#define Chain_PrevLink(l) ((l)->prev()) -#define Chain_NextLink(l) ((l)->next()) -#define Chain_GetValue(l) ((l)->clientData()) - -namespace Blt { - - class Chain; - - class ChainLink { - friend class Chain; - - protected: - ChainLink* prev_; - ChainLink* next_; - int manage_; - void* clientData_; - - public: - ChainLink(void*); - ChainLink(size_t); - virtual ~ChainLink(); - - ChainLink* prev() {return prev_;} - ChainLink* next() {return next_;} - void* clientData() {return clientData_;} - void setClientData(void* d) {clientData_ =d;} - }; - - class Chain { - protected: - ChainLink* head_; - ChainLink* tail_; - long nLinks_; - - public: - Chain(); - virtual ~Chain(); - - ChainLink* head() {return head_;} - ChainLink* tail() {return tail_;} - long nLinks() {return nLinks_;} - - void reset(); - void linkAfter(ChainLink* link, ChainLink* after); - void linkBefore(ChainLink* link, ChainLink* before); - void unlinkLink(ChainLink* linkPtr); - void deleteLink(ChainLink* link); - ChainLink* append(void* clientData); - ChainLink* prepend(void* clientData); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.C deleted file mode 100644 index 82fea4e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltConfig.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,218 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright (c) 1990-1994 The Regents of the University of California. - * Copyright (c) 1994-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. - * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. - * - * Copyright 2003-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -void RestoreProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr, char *savePtr) -{ - *(double*)ptr = *(double*)savePtr; -} - -// Fill -const char* fillObjOption[] = {"none", "x", "y", "both", NULL}; - -// Dashes -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc DashesSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc DashesGetProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption dashesObjOption = - { - "dashes", DashesSetProc, DashesGetProc, NULL, NULL, NULL - }; - -static int DashesSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* save, int flags) -{ - Dashes* dashesPtr = (Dashes*)(widgRec + offset); - - int length; - const char* string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(*objPtr, &length); - if (!string || !string[0]) { - dashesPtr->values[0] = 0; - return TCL_OK; - } - - if (!strncmp(string, "dot", length)) { - dashesPtr->values[0] = 1; - dashesPtr->values[1] = 0; - } - else if (!strncmp(string, "dash", length)) { - dashesPtr->values[0] = 5; - dashesPtr->values[1] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[2] = 0; - } - else if (!strncmp(string, "dashdot", length)) { - dashesPtr->values[0] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[1] = 4; - dashesPtr->values[2] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[3] = 0; - } - else if (!strncmp(string, "dashdotdot", length)) { - dashesPtr->values[0] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[1] = 4; - dashesPtr->values[2] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[3] = 2; - dashesPtr->values[4] = 0; - } - else { - int objc; - Tcl_Obj** objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, *objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // This is the postscript limit - if (objc > 11) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "too many values in dash list \"", - string, "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int ii; - for (ii=0; ii 255)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "dash value \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[ii]), "\" is out of range", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - dashesPtr->values[ii] = (unsigned char)value; - } - - // Make sure the array ends with a NULL byte - dashesPtr->values[ii] = 0; - } - - return TCL_OK; -}; - -static Tcl_Obj* DashesGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Dashes* dashesPtr = (Dashes*)(widgRec + offset); - - // count how many - int cnt =0; - while (dashesPtr->values[cnt]) - cnt++; - - if (!cnt) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj**)NULL); - - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[cnt]; - for (int ii=0; iivalues[ii]); - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(cnt, ll); - delete [] ll; - - return listObjPtr; -}; - -// List -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc ListSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc ListGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc ListFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption listObjOption = - { - "list", ListSetProc, ListGetProc, RestoreProc, ListFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int ListSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - const char*** listPtr = (const char***)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)listPtr; - - if (!listPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - const char** argv; - int argc; - if (Tcl_SplitList(interp, Tcl_GetString(*objPtr), &argc, &argv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - *listPtr = argv; - - return TCL_OK; -}; - -static Tcl_Obj* ListGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - const char*** listPtr = (const char***)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!listPtr || !(*listPtr)) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); - - // count how many - int cnt=0; - for (const char** pp=*listPtr; *pp; pp++,cnt++) {} - if (!cnt) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); - - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[cnt]; - for (int ii=0; ii - -extern const char* fillObjOption[]; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption dashesObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption listObjOption; -extern Tk_CustomOptionRestoreProc RestoreProc; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltDecls.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltDecls.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4d7c679..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltDecls.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,152 +0,0 @@ -/* !BEGIN!: Do not edit below this line. */ - -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" { -#endif - -/* - * Exported function declarations: - */ - -/* 0 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_CreateVector(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName, int size, - Blt_Vector**vecPtrPtr); -/* 1 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_CreateVector2(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName, const char *cmdName, - const char *varName, int initialSize, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); -/* 2 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_DeleteVectorByName(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName); -/* 3 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_DeleteVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr); -/* 4 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVector(Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); -/* 5 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVectorFromObj(Tcl_Interp*interp, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); -/* 6 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ResetVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, double *dataArr, - int n, int arraySize, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc); -/* 7 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ResizeVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, int n); -/* 8 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_VectorExists(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName); -/* 9 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_VectorExists2(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName); -/* 10 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS Blt_VectorId Blt_AllocVectorId(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *vecName); -/* 11 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVectorById(Tcl_Interp*interp, - Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); -/* 12 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc, - ClientData clientData); -/* 13 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_FreeVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId); -/* 14 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS const char * Blt_NameOfVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId); -/* 15 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS const char * Blt_NameOfVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr); -/* 16 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ExprVector(Tcl_Interp*interp, char *expr, - Blt_Vector *vecPtr); -/* 17 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_InstallIndexProc(Tcl_Interp*interp, - const char *indexName, - Blt_VectorIndexProc *procPtr); -/* 18 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS double Blt_VecMin(Blt_Vector *vPtr); -/* 19 */ -TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS double Blt_VecMax(Blt_Vector *vPtr); - -typedef struct TkbltStubs { - int magic; - void *hooks; - - int (*blt_CreateVector) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName, int size, Blt_Vector**vecPtrPtr); /* 0 */ - int (*blt_CreateVector2) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName, const char *cmdName, const char *varName, int initialSize, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); /* 1 */ - int (*blt_DeleteVectorByName) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName); /* 2 */ - int (*blt_DeleteVector) (Blt_Vector *vecPtr); /* 3 */ - int (*blt_GetVector) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); /* 4 */ - int (*blt_GetVectorFromObj) (Tcl_Interp*interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); /* 5 */ - int (*blt_ResetVector) (Blt_Vector *vecPtr, double *dataArr, int n, int arraySize, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc); /* 6 */ - int (*blt_ResizeVector) (Blt_Vector *vecPtr, int n); /* 7 */ - int (*blt_VectorExists) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName); /* 8 */ - int (*blt_VectorExists2) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName); /* 9 */ - Blt_VectorId (*blt_AllocVectorId) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *vecName); /* 10 */ - int (*blt_GetVectorById) (Tcl_Interp*interp, Blt_VectorId clientId, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); /* 11 */ - void (*blt_SetVectorChangedProc) (Blt_VectorId clientId, Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc, ClientData clientData); /* 12 */ - void (*blt_FreeVectorId) (Blt_VectorId clientId); /* 13 */ - const char * (*blt_NameOfVectorId) (Blt_VectorId clientId); /* 14 */ - const char * (*blt_NameOfVector) (Blt_Vector *vecPtr); /* 15 */ - int (*blt_ExprVector) (Tcl_Interp*interp, char *expr, Blt_Vector *vecPtr); /* 16 */ - void (*blt_InstallIndexProc) (Tcl_Interp*interp, const char *indexName, Blt_VectorIndexProc *procPtr); /* 17 */ - double (*blt_VecMin) (Blt_Vector *vPtr); /* 18 */ - double (*blt_VecMax) (Blt_Vector *vPtr); /* 19 */ -} TkbltStubs; - -extern const TkbltStubs *tkbltStubsPtr; - -#ifdef __cplusplus -} -#endif - -#if defined(USE_TKBLT_STUBS) - -/* - * Inline function declarations: - */ - -#define Blt_CreateVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_CreateVector) /* 0 */ -#define Blt_CreateVector2 \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_CreateVector2) /* 1 */ -#define Blt_DeleteVectorByName \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_DeleteVectorByName) /* 2 */ -#define Blt_DeleteVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_DeleteVector) /* 3 */ -#define Blt_GetVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_GetVector) /* 4 */ -#define Blt_GetVectorFromObj \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_GetVectorFromObj) /* 5 */ -#define Blt_ResetVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_ResetVector) /* 6 */ -#define Blt_ResizeVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_ResizeVector) /* 7 */ -#define Blt_VectorExists \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_VectorExists) /* 8 */ -#define Blt_VectorExists2 \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_VectorExists2) /* 9 */ -#define Blt_AllocVectorId \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_AllocVectorId) /* 10 */ -#define Blt_GetVectorById \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_GetVectorById) /* 11 */ -#define Blt_SetVectorChangedProc \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_SetVectorChangedProc) /* 12 */ -#define Blt_FreeVectorId \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_FreeVectorId) /* 13 */ -#define Blt_NameOfVectorId \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_NameOfVectorId) /* 14 */ -#define Blt_NameOfVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_NameOfVector) /* 15 */ -#define Blt_ExprVector \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_ExprVector) /* 16 */ -#define Blt_InstallIndexProc \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_InstallIndexProc) /* 17 */ -#define Blt_VecMin \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_VecMin) /* 18 */ -#define Blt_VecMax \ - (tkbltStubsPtr->blt_VecMax) /* 19 */ - -#endif /* defined(USE_TKBLT_STUBS) */ - -/* !END!: Do not edit above this line. */ diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.C deleted file mode 100644 index 7c84593..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1984 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define AXIS_PAD_TITLE 2 -#define EXP10(x) (pow(10.0,(x))) - -AxisName Blt::axisNames[] = { - { "x", CID_AXIS_X }, - { "y", CID_AXIS_Y }, - { "x2", CID_AXIS_X }, - { "y2", CID_AXIS_Y } -} ; - -// Defs - -extern double AdjustViewport(double offset, double windowSize); - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-activeforeground", "activeForeground", "ActiveForeground", - STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, activeFgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-activerelief", "activeRelief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, activeRelief), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-autorange", "autoRange", "AutoRange", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, windowSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-background", "background", "Background", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, normalBg), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "all", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, borderWidth), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-checklimits", "checkLimits", "CheckLimits", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, checkLimits), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-color", "color", "Color", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-command", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-tickformatcommand", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-descending", "descending", "Descending", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, descending), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-exterior", "exterior", "exterior", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, exterior), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-foreground", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-grid", "grid", "Grid", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, showGrid), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-gridcolor", "gridColor", "GridColor", - "gray64", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, major.color), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-griddashes", "gridDashes", "GridDashes", - "dot", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, major.dashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-gridlinewidth", "gridLineWidth", "GridLineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, major.lineWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-gridminor", "gridMinor", "GridMinor", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, showGridMinor), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-gridminorcolor", "gridMinorColor", "GridMinorColor", - "gray64", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, minor.color), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-gridminordashes", "gridMinorDashes", "GridMinorDashes", - "dot", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, minor.dashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-gridminorlinewidth", "gridMinorLineWidth", - "GridMinorLineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, minor.lineWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, hide), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_JUSTIFY, "-justify", "justify", "Justify", - "c", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, titleJustify), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-labeloffset", "labelOffset", "LabelOffset", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, labelOffset), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-limitscolor", "limitsColor", "LimitsColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, limitsTextStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-limitsfont", "limitsFont", "LimitsFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, limitsTextStyle.font), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-limitsformat", "limitsFormat", "LimitsFormat", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, limitsFormat), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "LineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, lineWidth), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-logscale", "logScale", "LogScale", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, logScale), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-loosemin", "looseMin", "LooseMin", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, looseMin), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-loosemax", "looseMax", "LooseMax", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, looseMax), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-majorticks", "majorTicks", "MajorTicks", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, t1UPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &ticksObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-max", "max", "Max", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqMax), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &limitObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-min", "min", "Min", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqMin), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &limitObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-minorticks", "minorTicks", "MinorTicks", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, t2UPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &ticksObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, relief), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-rotate", "rotate", "Rotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickAngle), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-scrollcommand", "scrollCommand", "ScrollCommand", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, scrollCmdObjPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &objectObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-scrollincrement", "scrollIncrement", "ScrollIncrement", - "10", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, scrollUnits), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-scrollmax", "scrollMax", "ScrollMax", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqScrollMax), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &limitObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-scrollmin", "scrollMin", "ScrollMin", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqScrollMin), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &limitObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-shiftby", "shiftBy", "ShiftBy", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, shiftBy), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-showticks", "showTicks", "ShowTicks", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, showTicks), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-stepsize", "stepSize", "StepSize", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqStep), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-subdivisions", "subdivisions", "Subdivisions", - "2", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqNumMinorTicks), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-tickanchor", "tickAnchor", "Anchor", - "c", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqTickAnchor), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-tickfont", "tickFont", "Font", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickFont), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-ticklength", "tickLength", "TickLength", - "8", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickLength), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-tickdefault", "tickDefault", "TickDefault", - "4", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, reqNumMajorTicks), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-tickformat", "tickFormat", "TickFormat", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickFormat), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-tickformatcommand", "tickformatcommand", "TickFormatCommand", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, tickFormatCmd), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-title", "title", "Title", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, title), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-titlealternate", "titleAlternate", "TitleAlternate", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, titleAlternate), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-titlecolor", "titleColor", "TitleColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, titleColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-titlefont", "titleFont", "TitleFont", - STD_FONT_NORMAL, -1, Tk_Offset(AxisOptions, titleFont), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -TickLabel::TickLabel(char* str) -{ - anchorPos.x = DBL_MAX; - anchorPos.y = DBL_MAX; - width =0; - height =0; - string = dupstr(str); -} - -TickLabel::~TickLabel() -{ - delete [] string; -} - -Ticks::Ticks(int cnt) -{ - nTicks =cnt; - values = new double[cnt]; -} - -Ticks::~Ticks() -{ - delete [] values; -} - -Axis::Axis(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, int margin, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) -{ - ops_ = (AxisOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(AxisOptions)); - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - classId_ = CID_NONE; - name_ = dupstr(name); - className_ = dupstr("none"); - - hashPtr_ = hPtr; - refCount_ =0; - use_ =0; - active_ =0; - - link =NULL; - chain =NULL; - - titlePos_.x =0; - titlePos_.y =0; - titleWidth_ =0; - titleHeight_ =0; - min_ =0; - max_ =0; - scrollMin_ =0; - scrollMax_ =0; - valueRange_.min =0; - valueRange_.max =0; - valueRange_.range =0; - valueRange_.scale =0; - axisRange_.min =0; - axisRange_.max =0; - axisRange_.range =0; - axisRange_.scale =0; - prevMin_ =0; - prevMax_ =0; - t1Ptr_ =NULL; - t2Ptr_ =NULL; - minorSweep_.initial =0; - minorSweep_.step =0; - minorSweep_.nSteps =0; - majorSweep_.initial =0; - majorSweep_.step =0; - majorSweep_.nSteps =0; - - margin_ = margin; - segments_ =NULL; - nSegments_ =0; - tickLabels_ = new Chain(); - left_ =0; - right_ =0; - top_ =0; - bottom_ =0; - width_ =0; - height_ =0; - maxTickWidth_ =0; - maxTickHeight_ =0; - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_N; - tickGC_ =NULL; - activeTickGC_ =NULL; - titleAngle_ =0; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_N; - screenScale_ =0; - screenMin_ =0; - screenRange_ =0; - - ops->reqMin =NAN; - ops->reqMax =NAN; - ops->reqScrollMin =NAN; - ops->reqScrollMax =NAN; - - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->limitsTextStyle.color =NULL; - ops->limitsTextStyle.font =NULL; - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle =0; - ops->limitsTextStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, optionSpecs); -} - -Axis::~Axis() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - graphPtr_->bindTable_->deleteBindings(this); - - if (link) - chain->deleteLink(link); - - if (hashPtr_) - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hashPtr_); - - delete [] name_; - delete [] className_; - - if (tickGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, tickGC_); - - if (activeTickGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, activeTickGC_); - - delete [] ops->major.segments; - if (ops->major.gc) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(ops->major.gc); - - delete [] ops->minor.segments; - if (ops->minor.gc) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(ops->minor.gc); - - delete t1Ptr_; - delete t2Ptr_; - - freeTickLabels(); - - delete tickLabels_; - - delete [] segments_; - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - -int Axis::configure() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - // Check the requested axis limits. Can't allow -min to be greater than - // -max. Do this regardless of -checklimits option. We want to always - // detect when the user has zoomed in beyond the precision of the data - - if (((!isnan(ops->reqMin)) && (!isnan(ops->reqMax))) && - (ops->reqMin >= ops->reqMax)) { - ostringstream str; - str << "impossible axis limits (-min " << ops->reqMin - << " >= -max " << ops->reqMax << ") for \"" - << name_ << "\"" << ends; - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr_->interp_, str.str().c_str(), NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - scrollMin_ = ops->reqScrollMin; - scrollMax_ = ops->reqScrollMax; - if (ops->logScale) { - if (ops->checkLimits) { - // Check that the logscale limits are positive. - if ((!isnan(ops->reqMin)) && (ops->reqMin <= 0.0)) { - ostringstream str; - str << "bad logscale -min limit \"" << ops->reqMin - << "\" for axis \"" << name_ << "\"" << ends; - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr_->interp_, str.str().c_str(), NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - if ((!isnan(scrollMin_)) && (scrollMin_ <= 0.0)) - scrollMin_ = NAN; - - if ((!isnan(scrollMax_)) && (scrollMax_ <= 0.0)) - scrollMax_ = NAN; - } - - double angle = fmod(ops->tickAngle, 360.0); - if (angle < 0.0) - angle += 360.0; - - ops->tickAngle = angle; - resetTextStyles(); - - titleWidth_ = titleHeight_ = 0; - if (ops->title) { - int w, h; - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->titleFont, ops->title, -1, &w, &h); - titleWidth_ = (unsigned int)w; - titleHeight_ = (unsigned int)h; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Axis::map(int offset, int margin) -{ - if (isHorizontal()) { - screenMin_ = graphPtr_->hOffset_; - width_ = graphPtr_->right_ - graphPtr_->left_; - screenRange_ = graphPtr_->hRange_; - } - else { - screenMin_ = graphPtr_->vOffset_; - height_ = graphPtr_->bottom_ - graphPtr_->top_; - screenRange_ = graphPtr_->vRange_; - } - screenScale_ = 1.0 / screenRange_; - - AxisInfo info; - offsets(margin, offset, &info); - makeSegments(&info); -} - -void Axis::mapStacked(int count, int margin) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (Chain_GetLength(gops->margins[margin_].axes) > 1 - || ops->reqNumMajorTicks <= 0) - ops->reqNumMajorTicks = 4; - - unsigned int slice; - if (isHorizontal()) { - slice = graphPtr_->hRange_ / Chain_GetLength(gops->margins[margin].axes); - screenMin_ = graphPtr_->hOffset_; - width_ = slice; - } - else { - slice = graphPtr_->vRange_ / Chain_GetLength(gops->margins[margin].axes); - screenMin_ = graphPtr_->vOffset_; - height_ = slice; - } - - int w, h; - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->tickFont, "0", 1, &w, &h); - screenMin_ += (slice * count) + 2 + h / 2; - screenRange_ = slice - 2 * 2 - h; - screenScale_ = 1.0 / screenRange_; - - AxisInfo info; - offsets(margin, 0, &info); - makeSegments(&info); -} - -void Axis::mapGridlines() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - Ticks* t1Ptr = t1Ptr_; - if (!t1Ptr) - t1Ptr = generateTicks(&majorSweep_); - - Ticks* t2Ptr = t2Ptr_; - if (!t2Ptr) - t2Ptr = generateTicks(&minorSweep_); - - int needed = t1Ptr->nTicks; - if (ops->showGridMinor) - needed += (t1Ptr->nTicks * t2Ptr->nTicks); - - if (needed == 0) { - if (t1Ptr != t1Ptr_) - delete t1Ptr; - if (t2Ptr != t2Ptr_) - delete t2Ptr; - - return; - } - - needed = t1Ptr->nTicks; - if (needed != ops->major.nAllocated) { - delete [] ops->major.segments; - ops->major.segments = new Segment2d[needed]; - ops->major.nAllocated = needed; - } - needed = (t1Ptr->nTicks * t2Ptr->nTicks); - if (needed != ops->minor.nAllocated) { - delete [] ops->minor.segments; - ops->minor.segments = new Segment2d[needed]; - ops->minor.nAllocated = needed; - } - - Segment2d* s1 = ops->major.segments; - Segment2d* s2 = ops->minor.segments; - for (int ii=0; iinTicks; ii++) { - double value = t1Ptr->values[ii]; - if (ops->showGridMinor) { - for (int jj=0; jjnTicks; jj++) { - double subValue = value + (majorSweep_.step * t2Ptr->values[jj]); - if (inRange(subValue, &axisRange_)) { - makeGridLine(subValue, s2); - s2++; - } - } - } - if (inRange(value, &axisRange_)) { - makeGridLine(value, s1); - s1++; - } - } - - if (t1Ptr != t1Ptr_) - delete t1Ptr; - if (t2Ptr != t2Ptr_) - delete t2Ptr; - - ops->major.nUsed = s1 - ops->major.segments; - ops->minor.nUsed = s2 - ops->minor.segments; -} - -void Axis::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !use_) - return; - - if (ops->normalBg) { - int relief = active_ ? ops->activeRelief : ops->relief; - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(graphPtr_->tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - left_, top_, right_ - left_, bottom_ - top_, - ops->borderWidth, relief); - } - - if (ops->title) { - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_); - TextStyleOptions* tops = (TextStyleOptions*)ts.ops(); - - tops->angle = titleAngle_; - tops->font = ops->titleFont; - tops->anchor = titleAnchor_; - tops->color = active_ ? ops->activeFgColor : ops->titleColor; - tops->justify = ops->titleJustify; - - ts.xPad_ = 1; - ts.yPad_ = 0; - ts.drawText(drawable, ops->title, titlePos_.x, titlePos_.y); - } - - if (ops->scrollCmdObjPtr) { - double worldMin = valueRange_.min; - double worldMax = valueRange_.max; - if (!isnan(scrollMin_)) - worldMin = scrollMin_; - if (!isnan(scrollMax_)) - worldMax = scrollMax_; - - double viewMin = min_; - double viewMax = max_; - if (viewMin < worldMin) - viewMin = worldMin; - if (viewMax > worldMax) - viewMax = worldMax; - - if (ops->logScale) { - worldMin = log10(worldMin); - worldMax = log10(worldMax); - viewMin = log10(viewMin); - viewMax = log10(viewMax); - } - - double worldWidth = worldMax - worldMin; - double viewWidth = viewMax - viewMin; - int isHoriz = isHorizontal(); - - double fract; - if (isHoriz != ops->descending) - fract = (viewMin - worldMin) / worldWidth; - else - fract = (worldMax - viewMax) / worldWidth; - - fract = AdjustViewport(fract, viewWidth / worldWidth); - - if (isHoriz != ops->descending) { - viewMin = (fract * worldWidth); - min_ = viewMin + worldMin; - max_ = min_ + viewWidth; - viewMax = viewMin + viewWidth; - if (ops->logScale) { - min_ = EXP10(min_); - max_ = EXP10(max_); - } - updateScrollbar(graphPtr_->interp_, ops->scrollCmdObjPtr, - (int)viewMin, (int)viewMax, (int)worldWidth); - } - else { - viewMax = (fract * worldWidth); - max_ = worldMax - viewMax; - min_ = max_ - viewWidth; - viewMin = viewMax + viewWidth; - if (ops->logScale) { - min_ = EXP10(min_); - max_ = EXP10(max_); - } - updateScrollbar(graphPtr_->interp_, ops->scrollCmdObjPtr, - (int)viewMax, (int)viewMin, (int)worldWidth); - } - } - - if (ops->showTicks) { - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_); - TextStyleOptions* tops = (TextStyleOptions*)ts.ops(); - - tops->angle = ops->tickAngle; - tops->font = ops->tickFont; - tops->anchor = tickAnchor_; - tops->color = active_ ? ops->activeFgColor : ops->tickColor; - - ts.xPad_ = 2; - ts.yPad_ = 0; - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(tickLabels_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - TickLabel* labelPtr = (TickLabel*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ts.drawText(drawable, labelPtr->string, labelPtr->anchorPos.x, - labelPtr->anchorPos.y); - } - } - - if ((nSegments_ > 0) && (ops->lineWidth > 0)) { - GC gc = active_ ? activeTickGC_ : tickGC_; - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, gc, segments_, nSegments_); - } -} - -void Axis::drawGrids(Drawable drawable) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !ops->showGrid || !use_) - return; - - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, ops->major.gc, - ops->major.segments, ops->major.nUsed); - - if (ops->showGridMinor) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, ops->minor.gc, - ops->minor.segments, ops->minor.nUsed); -} - -void Axis::drawLimits(Drawable drawable) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (!ops->limitsFormat) - return; - - int vMin = graphPtr_->left_ + gops->xPad + 2; - int vMax = vMin; - int hMin = graphPtr_->bottom_ - gops->yPad - 2; - int hMax = hMin; - - const int spacing =8; - int isHoriz = isHorizontal(); - char* minPtr =NULL; - char* maxPtr =NULL; - char minString[200]; - char maxString[200]; - const char* fmt = ops->limitsFormat; - if (fmt && *fmt) { - minPtr = minString; - snprintf(minString, 200, fmt, axisRange_.min); - - maxPtr = maxString; - snprintf(maxString, 200, fmt, axisRange_.max); - } - if (ops->descending) { - char *tmp = minPtr; - minPtr = maxPtr; - maxPtr = tmp; - } - - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->limitsTextStyle); - if (maxPtr) { - if (isHoriz) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 90.0; - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_SE; - - int ww, hh; - ts.drawTextBBox(drawable, maxPtr, graphPtr_->right_, hMax, &ww, &hh); - hMax -= (hh + spacing); - } - else { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 0.0; - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_NW; - - int ww, hh; - ts.drawTextBBox(drawable, maxPtr, vMax, graphPtr_->top_, &ww, &hh); - vMax += (ww + spacing); - } - } - if (minPtr) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_SW; - - if (isHoriz) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 90.0; - - int ww, hh; - ts.drawTextBBox(drawable, minPtr, graphPtr_->left_, hMin, &ww, &hh); - hMin -= (hh + spacing); - } - else { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 0.0; - - int ww, hh; - ts.drawTextBBox(drawable, minPtr, vMin, graphPtr_->bottom_, &ww, &hh); - vMin += (ww + spacing); - } - } -} - -void Axis::setClass(ClassId classId) -{ - delete [] className_; - - classId_ = classId; - switch (classId) { - case CID_NONE: - className_ = dupstr("none"); - break; - case CID_AXIS_X: - className_ = dupstr("XAxis"); - break; - case CID_AXIS_Y: - className_ = dupstr("YAxis"); - break; - default: - className_ = NULL; - break; - } -} - -void Axis::logScale(double min, double max) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - double range; - double tickMin, tickMax; - double majorStep, minorStep; - int nMajor, nMinor; - - nMajor = nMinor = 0; - majorStep = minorStep = 0.0; - tickMin = tickMax = NAN; - if (min < max) { - min = (min != 0.0) ? log10(fabs(min)) : 0.0; - max = (max != 0.0) ? log10(fabs(max)) : 1.0; - - tickMin = floor(min); - tickMax = ceil(max); - range = tickMax - tickMin; - - if (range > 10) { - // There are too many decades to display a major tick at every - // decade. Instead, treat the axis as a linear scale - range = niceNum(range, 0); - majorStep = niceNum(range / ops->reqNumMajorTicks, 1); - tickMin = floor(tickMin/majorStep)*majorStep; - tickMax = ceil(tickMax/majorStep)*majorStep; - nMajor = (int)((tickMax - tickMin) / majorStep) + 1; - minorStep = EXP10(floor(log10(majorStep))); - if (minorStep == majorStep) { - nMinor = 4; - minorStep = 0.2; - } - else - nMinor = (int)(majorStep/minorStep) - 1; - } - else { - if (tickMin == tickMax) - tickMax++; - majorStep = 1.0; - nMajor = (int)(tickMax - tickMin + 1); /* FIXME: Check this. */ - - minorStep = 0.0; /* This is a special hack to pass - * information to the GenerateTicks - * routine. An interval of 0.0 tells 1) - * this is a minor sweep and 2) the axis - * is log scale. */ - nMinor = 10; - } - if (!ops->looseMin || (ops->looseMin && !isnan(ops->reqMin))) { - tickMin = min; - nMajor++; - } - if (!ops->looseMax || (ops->looseMax && !isnan(ops->reqMax))) { - tickMax = max; - } - } - majorSweep_.step = majorStep; - majorSweep_.initial = floor(tickMin); - majorSweep_.nSteps = nMajor; - minorSweep_.initial = minorSweep_.step = minorStep; - minorSweep_.nSteps = nMinor; - - setRange(&axisRange_, tickMin, tickMax); -} - -void Axis::linearScale(double min, double max) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - unsigned int nTicks = 0; - double step = 1.0; - double axisMin =NAN; - double axisMax =NAN; - double tickMin =NAN; - double tickMax =NAN; - - if (min < max) { - double range = max - min; - if (ops->reqStep > 0.0) { - step = ops->reqStep; - while ((2 * step) >= range && step >= (2 * DBL_EPSILON)) { - step *= 0.5; - } - } - else { - range = niceNum(range, 0); - step = niceNum(range / ops->reqNumMajorTicks, 1); - } - if (step >= DBL_EPSILON) { - axisMin = tickMin = floor(min / step) * step + 0.0; - axisMax = tickMax = ceil(max / step) * step + 0.0; - nTicks = (int)((tickMax-tickMin) / step) + 1; - } else { - /* - * A zero step can result from having a too small range, such that - * the floating point can no longer represent fractions of it (think - * subnormals). In such a case, let's just have two steps: the - * minimum and the maximum. - */ - axisMin = tickMin = min; - axisMax = tickMax = min + DBL_EPSILON; - step = DBL_EPSILON; - nTicks = 2; - } - } - majorSweep_.step = step; - majorSweep_.initial = tickMin; - majorSweep_.nSteps = nTicks; - - /* - * The limits of the axis are either the range of the data ("tight") or at - * the next outer tick interval ("loose"). The looseness or tightness has - * to do with how the axis fits the range of data values. This option is - * overridden when the user sets an axis limit (by either -min or -max - * option). The axis limit is always at the selected limit (otherwise we - * assume that user would have picked a different number). - */ - if (!ops->looseMin || (ops->looseMin && !isnan(ops->reqMin))) - axisMin = min; - - if (!ops->looseMax || (ops->looseMax && !isnan(ops->reqMax))) - axisMax = max; - - setRange(&axisRange_, axisMin, axisMax); - - if (ops->reqNumMinorTicks > 0) { - nTicks = ops->reqNumMinorTicks - 1; - step = 1.0 / (nTicks + 1); - } - else { - nTicks = 0; - step = 0.5; - } - minorSweep_.initial = minorSweep_.step = step; - minorSweep_.nSteps = nTicks; -} - -void Axis::setRange(AxisRange *rangePtr, double min, double max) -{ - rangePtr->min = min; - rangePtr->max = max; - rangePtr->range = max - min; - if (fabs(rangePtr->range) < DBL_EPSILON) { - rangePtr->range = DBL_EPSILON; - } - rangePtr->scale = 1.0 / rangePtr->range; -} - -void Axis::fixRange() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - // When auto-scaling, the axis limits are the bounds of the element data. - // If no data exists, set arbitrary limits (wrt to log/linear scale). - double min = valueRange_.min; - double max = valueRange_.max; - - // Check the requested axis limits. Can't allow -min to be greater - // than -max, or have undefined log scale limits. */ - if (((!isnan(ops->reqMin)) && (!isnan(ops->reqMax))) && - (ops->reqMin >= ops->reqMax)) { - ops->reqMin = ops->reqMax = NAN; - } - if (ops->reqMin < -DBL_MAX) { - ops->reqMin = -DBL_MAX; - } - if (ops->reqMax > DBL_MAX) { - ops->reqMax = DBL_MAX; - } - if (ops->logScale) { - if ((!isnan(ops->reqMin)) && (ops->reqMin <= 0.0)) - ops->reqMin = NAN; - - if ((!isnan(ops->reqMax)) && (ops->reqMax <= 0.0)) - ops->reqMax = NAN; - } - - if (min == DBL_MAX) { - if (!isnan(ops->reqMin)) - min = ops->reqMin; - else - min = (ops->logScale) ? 0.001 : 0.0; - } - if (max == -DBL_MAX) { - if (!isnan(ops->reqMax)) - max = ops->reqMax; - else - max = 1.0; - } - if (min >= max) { - - // There is no range of data (i.e. min is not less than max), so - // manufacture one. - if (min == 0.0) - min = 0.0, max = 1.0; - else - max = min + (fabs(min) * 0.1); - } - setRange(&valueRange_, min, max); - - // The axis limits are either the current data range or overridden by the - // values selected by the user with the -min or -max options. - min_ = min; - max_ = max; - if (!isnan(ops->reqMin)) - min_ = ops->reqMin; - - if (!isnan(ops->reqMax)) - max_ = ops->reqMax; - - if (max_ < min_) { - // If the limits still don't make sense, it's because one limit - // configuration option (-min or -max) was set and the other default - // (based upon the data) is too small or large. Remedy this by making - // up a new min or max from the user-defined limit. - if (isnan(ops->reqMin)) - min_ = max_ - (fabs(max_) * 0.1); - - if (isnan(ops->reqMax)) - max_ = min_ + (fabs(max_) * 0.1); - } - - // If a window size is defined, handle auto ranging by shifting the axis - // limits. - if ((ops->windowSize > 0.0) && - (isnan(ops->reqMin)) && (isnan(ops->reqMax))) { - if (ops->shiftBy < 0.0) - ops->shiftBy = 0.0; - - max = min_ + ops->windowSize; - if (max_ >= max) { - if (ops->shiftBy > 0.0) - max = ceil(max_/ops->shiftBy)*ops->shiftBy; - min_ = max - ops->windowSize; - } - max_ = max; - } - if ((max_ != prevMax_) || - (min_ != prevMin_)) { - /* and save the previous minimum and maximum values */ - prevMin_ = min_; - prevMax_ = max_; - } -} - -// Reference: Paul Heckbert, "Nice Numbers for Graph Labels", -// Graphics Gems, pp 61-63. -double Axis::niceNum(double x, int round) -{ - double expt; /* Exponent of x */ - double frac; /* Fractional part of x */ - double nice; /* Nice, rounded fraction */ - - expt = floor(log10(x)); - frac = x / EXP10(expt); /* between 1 and 10 */ - if (round) { - if (frac < 1.5) { - nice = 1.0; - } else if (frac < 3.0) { - nice = 2.0; - } else if (frac < 7.0) { - nice = 5.0; - } else { - nice = 10.0; - } - } else { - if (frac <= 1.0) { - nice = 1.0; - } else if (frac <= 2.0) { - nice = 2.0; - } else if (frac <= 5.0) { - nice = 5.0; - } else { - nice = 10.0; - } - } - return nice * EXP10(expt); -} - -int Axis::inRange(double x, AxisRange *rangePtr) -{ - if (rangePtr->range < DBL_EPSILON) - return (fabs(rangePtr->max - x) >= DBL_EPSILON); - else { - double norm; - - norm = (x - rangePtr->min) * rangePtr->scale; - return ((norm >= -DBL_EPSILON) && ((norm - 1.0) < DBL_EPSILON)); - } -} - -int Axis::isHorizontal() -{ - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - return ((classId_ == CID_AXIS_Y) == gops->inverted); -} - -void Axis::freeTickLabels() -{ - Chain* chain = tickLabels_; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - TickLabel* labelPtr = (TickLabel*)Chain_GetValue(link); - delete labelPtr; - } - chain->reset(); -} - -TickLabel* Axis::makeLabel(double value) -{ -#define TICK_LABEL_SIZE 200 - - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - char string[TICK_LABEL_SIZE + 1]; - - // zero out any extremely small numbers - if (value-DBL_EPSILON) - value =0; - - if (ops->tickFormat && *ops->tickFormat) { - snprintf(string, TICK_LABEL_SIZE, ops->tickFormat, value); - } else if (ops->logScale) { - snprintf(string, TICK_LABEL_SIZE, "1E%d", int(value)); - } else { - snprintf(string, TICK_LABEL_SIZE, "%.15G", value); - } - - if (ops->tickFormatCmd) { - Tcl_Interp* interp = graphPtr_->interp_; - Tk_Window tkwin = graphPtr_->tkwin_; - - // A TCL proc was designated to format tick labels. Append the path - // name of the widget and the default tick label as arguments when - // invoking it. Copy and save the new label from interp->result. - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - if (Tcl_VarEval(interp, ops->tickFormatCmd, " ", Tk_PathName(tkwin), - " ", string, NULL) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); - } - else { - // The proc could return a string of any length, so arbitrarily - // limit it to what will fit in the return string. - strncpy(string, Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), TICK_LABEL_SIZE); - string[TICK_LABEL_SIZE] = '\0'; - - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); /* Clear the interpreter's result. */ - } - } - - TickLabel* labelPtr = new TickLabel(string); - - return labelPtr; -} - -double Axis::invHMap(double x) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - double value; - - x = (double)(x - screenMin_) * screenScale_; - if (ops->descending) { - x = 1.0 - x; - } - value = (x * axisRange_.range) + axisRange_.min; - if (ops->logScale) { - value = EXP10(value); - } - return value; -} - -double Axis::invVMap(double y) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - double value; - - y = (double)(y - screenMin_) * screenScale_; - if (ops->descending) { - y = 1.0 - y; - } - value = ((1.0 - y) * axisRange_.range) + axisRange_.min; - if (ops->logScale) { - value = EXP10(value); - } - return value; -} - -double Axis::hMap(double x) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - if ((ops->logScale) && (x != 0.0)) { - x = log10(fabs(x)); - } - /* Map graph coordinate to normalized coordinates [0..1] */ - x = (x - axisRange_.min) * axisRange_.scale; - if (ops->descending) { - x = 1.0 - x; - } - return (x * screenRange_ + screenMin_); -} - -double Axis::vMap(double y) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - if ((ops->logScale) && (y != 0.0)) { - y = log10(fabs(y)); - } - /* Map graph coordinate to normalized coordinates [0..1] */ - y = (y - axisRange_.min) * axisRange_.scale; - if (ops->descending) { - y = 1.0 - y; - } - return ((1.0 - y) * screenRange_ + screenMin_); -} - -void Axis::getDataLimits(double min, double max) -{ - if (valueRange_.min > min) - valueRange_.min = min; - - if (valueRange_.max < max) - valueRange_.max = max; -} - -void Axis::resetTextStyles() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - XGCValues gcValues; - unsigned long gcMask; - gcMask = (GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCCapStyle); - gcValues.foreground = ops->tickColor->pixel; - gcValues.font = Tk_FontId(ops->tickFont); - gcValues.line_width = ops->lineWidth; - gcValues.cap_style = CapProjecting; - - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (tickGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, tickGC_); - tickGC_ = newGC; - - // Assuming settings from above GC - gcValues.foreground = ops->activeFgColor->pixel; - newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (activeTickGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, activeTickGC_); - activeTickGC_ = newGC; - - gcValues.background = gcValues.foreground = ops->major.color->pixel; - gcValues.line_width = ops->major.lineWidth; - gcMask = (GCForeground | GCBackground | GCLineWidth); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->major.dashes)) { - gcValues.line_style = LineOnOffDash; - gcMask |= GCLineStyle; - } - newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->major.dashes)) - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->major.dashes); - - if (ops->major.gc) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(ops->major.gc); - - ops->major.gc = newGC; - - gcValues.background = gcValues.foreground = ops->minor.color->pixel; - gcValues.line_width = ops->minor.lineWidth; - gcMask = (GCForeground | GCBackground | GCLineWidth); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->minor.dashes)) { - gcValues.line_style = LineOnOffDash; - gcMask |= GCLineStyle; - } - newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->minor.dashes)) - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->minor.dashes); - - if (ops->minor.gc) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(ops->minor.gc); - - ops->minor.gc = newGC; -} - -void Axis::makeLine(int line, Segment2d *sp) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - double min = axisRange_.min; - double max = axisRange_.max; - if (ops->logScale) { - min = EXP10(min); - max = EXP10(max); - } - if (isHorizontal()) { - sp->p.x = hMap(min); - sp->q.x = hMap(max); - sp->p.y = sp->q.y = line; - } - else { - sp->q.x = sp->p.x = line; - sp->p.y = vMap(min); - sp->q.y = vMap(max); - } -} - -void Axis::offsets(int margin, int offset, AxisInfo *infoPtr) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - int axisLine =0; - int t1 =0; - int t2 =0; - int labelOffset =AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - int tickLabel =0; - - float titleAngle[4] = {0.0, 90.0, 0.0, 270.0}; - titleAngle_ = titleAngle[margin]; - Margin *marginPtr = gops->margins + margin; - - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) { - if (ops->showTicks) { - t1 = ops->tickLength; - t2 = (t1 * 10) / 15; - } - labelOffset = t1 + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - if (ops->exterior) - labelOffset += ops->lineWidth; - } - - int axisPad =0; - - // Adjust offset for the interior border width and the line width */ - // fixme - int pad = 0; - // int pad = 1; - // if (graphPtr_->plotBW > 0) - // pad += graphPtr_->plotBW + 1; - - // Pre-calculate the x-coordinate positions of the axis, tick labels, and - // the individual major and minor ticks. - int inset = pad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - - switch (margin) { - case MARGIN_TOP: - { - int mark = graphPtr_->top_ - offset - pad; - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_S; - left_ = screenMin_ - inset - 2; - right_ = screenMin_ + screenRange_ + inset - 1; - if (gops->stackAxes) - top_ = mark - marginPtr->axesOffset; - else - top_ = mark - height_; - bottom_ = mark; - - axisLine = bottom_; - if (ops->exterior) { - axisLine -= gops->plotBW + axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = axisLine - 2; - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) - tickLabel -= ops->tickLength; - } - else { - if (gops->plotRelief == TK_RELIEF_SOLID) - axisLine--; - - axisLine -= axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = graphPtr_->top_ - gops->plotBW - 2; - } - - int x, y; - if (ops->titleAlternate) { - x = graphPtr_->right_ + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - y = mark - (height_ / 2); - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_W; - } - else { - x = (right_ + left_) / 2; - if (gops->stackAxes) - y = mark - marginPtr->axesOffset + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - else - y = mark - height_ + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_N; - } - titlePos_.x = x; - titlePos_.y = y; - } - break; - - case MARGIN_BOTTOM: - { - /* - * ----------- bottom + plot borderwidth - * mark -------------------------------------------- - * ===================== axisLine (linewidth) - * tick - * title - * - * ===================== axisLine (linewidth) - * ----------- bottom + plot borderwidth - * mark -------------------------------------------- - * tick - * title - */ - int mark = graphPtr_->bottom_ + offset; - double fangle = fmod(ops->tickAngle, 90.0); - if (fangle == 0.0) - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_N; - else { - int quadrant = (int)(ops->tickAngle / 90.0); - if ((quadrant == 0) || (quadrant == 2)) - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_NE; - else - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_NW; - } - - left_ = screenMin_ - inset - 2; - right_ = screenMin_ + screenRange_ + inset - 1; - top_ = mark + labelOffset - t1; - if (gops->stackAxes) - bottom_ = mark + marginPtr->axesOffset - 1; - else - bottom_ = mark + height_ - 1; - - axisLine = top_; - if (gops->plotRelief == TK_RELIEF_SOLID) - axisLine++; - - if (ops->exterior) { - axisLine += gops->plotBW + axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = axisLine + 2; - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) - tickLabel += ops->tickLength; - } - else { - axisLine -= axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = graphPtr_->bottom_ + gops->plotBW + 2; - } - - int x, y; - if (ops->titleAlternate) { - x = graphPtr_->right_ + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - y = mark + (height_ / 2); - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_W; - } - else { - x = (right_ + left_) / 2; - if (gops->stackAxes) - y = mark + marginPtr->axesOffset - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - else - y = mark + height_ - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_S; - } - titlePos_.x = x; - titlePos_.y = y; - } - break; - - case MARGIN_LEFT: - { - /* - * mark - * | : - * | : - * | : - * | : - * | : - * axisLine - */ - /* - * Exterior axis - * + plotarea right - * |A|B|C|D|E|F|G|H - * |right - * A = plot pad - * B = plot border width - * C = axis pad - * D = axis line - * E = tick length - * F = tick label - * G = graph border width - * H = highlight thickness - */ - /* - * Interior axis - * + plotarea right - * |A|B|C|D|E|F|G|H - * |right - * A = plot pad - * B = tick length - * C = axis line width - * D = axis pad - * E = plot border width - * F = tick label - * G = graph border width - * H = highlight thickness - */ - int mark = graphPtr_->left_ - offset; - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_E; - if (gops->stackAxes) - left_ = mark - marginPtr->axesOffset; - else - left_ = mark - width_; - right_ = mark - 3; - top_ = screenMin_ - inset - 2; - bottom_ = screenMin_ + screenRange_ + inset - 1; - - axisLine = right_; - if (ops->exterior) { - axisLine -= gops->plotBW + axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = axisLine - 2; - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) - tickLabel -= ops->tickLength; - } - else { - if (gops->plotRelief == TK_RELIEF_SOLID) - axisLine--; - axisLine += axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = graphPtr_->left_ - gops->plotBW - 2; - } - - int x, y; - if (ops->titleAlternate) { - x = mark - (width_ / 2); - y = graphPtr_->top_ - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_SW; - } - else { - if (gops->stackAxes) - x = mark - marginPtr->axesOffset; - else - x = mark - width_ + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - y = (bottom_ + top_) / 2; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_W; - } - titlePos_.x = x; - titlePos_.y = y; - } - break; - - case MARGIN_RIGHT: - { - int mark = graphPtr_->right_ + offset + pad; - tickAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_W; - left_ = mark; - if (gops->stackAxes) - right_ = mark + marginPtr->axesOffset - 1; - else - right_ = mark + width_ - 1; - - top_ = screenMin_ - inset - 2; - bottom_ = screenMin_ + screenRange_ + inset -1; - - axisLine = left_; - if (gops->plotRelief == TK_RELIEF_SOLID) - axisLine++; - - if (ops->exterior) { - axisLine += gops->plotBW + axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = axisLine + 2; - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) - tickLabel += ops->tickLength; - } - else { - axisLine -= axisPad + ops->lineWidth / 2; - tickLabel = graphPtr_->right_ + gops->plotBW + 2; - } - - int x, y; - if (ops->titleAlternate) { - x = mark + (width_ / 2); - y = graphPtr_->top_ - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_SE; - } - else { - if (gops->stackAxes) - x = mark + marginPtr->axesOffset - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - else - x = mark + width_ - AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - - y = (bottom_ + top_) / 2; - titleAnchor_ = TK_ANCHOR_E; - } - titlePos_.x = x; - titlePos_.y = y; - } - break; - - case MARGIN_NONE: - axisLine = 0; - break; - } - - if ((margin == MARGIN_LEFT) || (margin == MARGIN_TOP)) { - t1 = -t1; - t2 = -t2; - labelOffset = -labelOffset; - } - - infoPtr->axis = axisLine; - infoPtr->t1 = axisLine + t1; - infoPtr->t2 = axisLine + t2; - if (tickLabel > 0) - infoPtr->label = tickLabel; - else - infoPtr->label = axisLine + labelOffset; - - if (!ops->exterior) { - infoPtr->t1 = axisLine - t1; - infoPtr->t2 = axisLine - t2; - } -} - -void Axis::makeTick(double value, int tick, int line, Segment2d *sp) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->logScale) - value = EXP10(value); - - if (isHorizontal()) { - sp->p.x = hMap(value); - sp->p.y = line; - sp->q.x = sp->p.x; - sp->q.y = tick; - } - else { - sp->p.x = line; - sp->p.y = vMap(value); - sp->q.x = tick; - sp->q.y = sp->p.y; - } -} - -void Axis::makeSegments(AxisInfo *infoPtr) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - delete [] segments_; - segments_ = NULL; - - Ticks* t1Ptr = ops->t1UPtr ? ops->t1UPtr : t1Ptr_; - Ticks* t2Ptr = ops->t2UPtr ? ops->t2UPtr : t2Ptr_; - - int nMajorTicks= t1Ptr ? t1Ptr->nTicks : 0; - int nMinorTicks= t2Ptr ? t2Ptr->nTicks : 0; - - int arraySize = 1 + (nMajorTicks * (nMinorTicks + 1)); - Segment2d* segments = new Segment2d[arraySize]; - Segment2d* sp = segments; - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) { - makeLine(infoPtr->axis, sp); - sp++; - } - - if (ops->showTicks) { - int isHoriz = isHorizontal(); - for (int ii=0; iivalues[ii]; - /* Minor ticks */ - for (int jj=0; jjvalues[jj]); - if (inRange(t2, &axisRange_)) { - makeTick(t2, infoPtr->t2, infoPtr->axis, sp); - sp++; - } - } - if (!inRange(t1, &axisRange_)) - continue; - - /* Major tick */ - makeTick(t1, infoPtr->t1, infoPtr->axis, sp); - sp++; - } - - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(tickLabels_); - double labelPos = (double)infoPtr->label; - - for (int ii=0; ii< nMajorTicks; ii++) { - double t1 = t1Ptr->values[ii]; - if (ops->labelOffset) - t1 += majorSweep_.step * 0.5; - - if (!inRange(t1, &axisRange_)) - continue; - - TickLabel* labelPtr = (TickLabel*)Chain_GetValue(link); - link = Chain_NextLink(link); - Segment2d seg; - makeTick(t1, infoPtr->t1, infoPtr->axis, &seg); - // Save tick label X-Y position - if (isHoriz) { - labelPtr->anchorPos.x = seg.p.x; - labelPtr->anchorPos.y = labelPos; - } - else { - labelPtr->anchorPos.x = labelPos; - labelPtr->anchorPos.y = seg.p.y; - } - } - } - segments_ = segments; - nSegments_ = sp - segments; -} - -Ticks* Axis::generateTicks(TickSweep *sweepPtr) -{ - Ticks* ticksPtr = new Ticks(sweepPtr->nSteps); - - if (sweepPtr->step == 0.0) { - // Hack: A zero step indicates to use log values - // Precomputed log10 values [1..10] - static double logTable[] = { - 0.0, - 0.301029995663981, - 0.477121254719662, - 0.602059991327962, - 0.698970004336019, - 0.778151250383644, - 0.845098040014257, - 0.903089986991944, - 0.954242509439325, - 1.0 - }; - for (int ii=0; iinSteps; ii++) - ticksPtr->values[ii] = logTable[ii]; - } - else { - double value = sweepPtr->initial; - for (int ii=0; iinSteps; ii++) { - value = (value/sweepPtr->step)*sweepPtr->step; - ticksPtr->values[ii] = value; - value += sweepPtr->step; - } - } - - return ticksPtr; -} - -void Axis::makeGridLine(double value, Segment2d *sp) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->logScale) - value = EXP10(value); - - if (isHorizontal()) { - sp->p.x = hMap(value); - sp->p.y = graphPtr_->top_; - sp->q.x = sp->p.x; - sp->q.y = graphPtr_->bottom_; - } - else { - sp->p.x = graphPtr_->left_; - sp->p.y = vMap(value); - sp->q.x = graphPtr_->right_; - sp->q.y = sp->p.y; - } -} - -void Axis::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)graphPtr_->postscript_->ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !use_) - return; - - psPtr->format("%% Axis \"%s\"\n", name_); - if (pops->decorations) { - if (ops->normalBg) { - int relief = active_ ? ops->activeRelief : ops->relief; - psPtr->fill3DRectangle(ops->normalBg, left_, top_, - right_-left_, bottom_-top_, - ops->borderWidth, relief); - } - } - else { - psPtr->setClearBackground(); - psPtr->fillRectangle(left_, top_, right_-left_, bottom_-top_); - } - - if (ops->title) { - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_); - TextStyleOptions* tops = (TextStyleOptions*)ts.ops(); - - tops->angle = titleAngle_; - tops->font = ops->titleFont; - tops->anchor = titleAnchor_; - tops->color = active_ ? ops->activeFgColor : ops->titleColor; - tops->justify = ops->titleJustify; - - ts.xPad_ = 1; - ts.yPad_ = 0; - ts.printText(psPtr, ops->title, titlePos_.x, titlePos_.y); - } - - if (ops->showTicks) { - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_); - TextStyleOptions* tops = (TextStyleOptions*)ts.ops(); - - tops->angle = ops->tickAngle; - tops->font = ops->tickFont; - tops->anchor = tickAnchor_; - tops->color = active_ ? ops->activeFgColor : ops->tickColor; - - ts.xPad_ = 2; - ts.yPad_ = 0; - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(tickLabels_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - TickLabel *labelPtr = (TickLabel*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ts.printText(psPtr, labelPtr->string, labelPtr->anchorPos.x, - labelPtr->anchorPos.y); - } - } - - if ((nSegments_ > 0) && (ops->lineWidth > 0)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(active_ ? ops->activeFgColor : ops->tickColor, - ops->lineWidth, (Dashes*)NULL, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->printSegments(segments_, nSegments_); - } -} - -void Axis::printGrids(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !ops->showGrid || !use_) - return; - - psPtr->format("%% Axis %s: grid line attributes\n", name_); - psPtr->setLineAttributes(ops->major.color, ops->major.lineWidth, - &ops->major.dashes, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->format("%% Axis %s: major grid line segments\n", name_); - psPtr->printSegments(ops->major.segments, ops->major.nUsed); - - if (ops->showGridMinor) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(ops->minor.color, ops->minor.lineWidth, - &ops->minor.dashes, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->format("%% Axis %s: minor grid line segments\n", name_); - psPtr->printSegments(ops->minor.segments, ops->minor.nUsed); - } -} - -void Axis::printLimits(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (!ops->limitsFormat) - return; - - double vMin = graphPtr_->left_ + gops->xPad + 2; - double vMax = vMin; - double hMin = graphPtr_->bottom_ - gops->yPad - 2; - double hMax = hMin; - - const int spacing =8; - int isHoriz = isHorizontal(); - char* minPtr =NULL; - char* maxPtr =NULL; - char minString[200]; - char maxString[200]; - const char* fmt = ops->limitsFormat; - if (fmt && *fmt) { - minPtr = minString; - snprintf(minString, 200, fmt, axisRange_.min); - - maxPtr = maxString; - snprintf(maxString, 200, fmt, axisRange_.max); - } - if (ops->descending) { - char *tmp = minPtr; - minPtr = maxPtr; - maxPtr = tmp; - } - - int textWidth, textHeight; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->limitsTextStyle); - if (maxPtr) { - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->tickFont, maxPtr, -1, - &textWidth, &textHeight); - if ((textWidth > 0) && (textHeight > 0)) { - if (isHoriz) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 90.0; - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_SE; - - ts.printText(psPtr, maxPtr, graphPtr_->right_, (int)hMax); - hMax -= (textWidth + spacing); - } - else { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 0.0; - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_NW; - - ts.printText(psPtr, maxPtr, (int)vMax, graphPtr_->top_); - vMax += (textWidth + spacing); - } - } - } - - if (minPtr) { - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->tickFont, minPtr, -1, - &textWidth, &textHeight); - if ((textWidth > 0) && (textHeight > 0)) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_SW; - - if (isHoriz) { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 90.0; - - ts.printText(psPtr, minPtr, graphPtr_->left_, (int)hMin); - hMin -= (textWidth + spacing); - } - else { - ops->limitsTextStyle.angle = 0.0; - - ts.printText(psPtr, minPtr, (int)vMin, graphPtr_->bottom_); - vMin += (textWidth + spacing); - } - } - } -} - -void Axis::updateScrollbar(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *scrollCmdObjPtr, - int first, int last, int width) -{ - double firstFract =0.0; - double lastFract = 1.0; - if (width > 0) { - firstFract = (double)first / (double)width; - lastFract = (double)last / (double)width; - } - Tcl_Obj *cmdObjPtr = Tcl_DuplicateObj(scrollCmdObjPtr); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, cmdObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(firstFract)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, cmdObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(lastFract)); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(cmdObjPtr); - if (Tcl_EvalObjEx(interp, cmdObjPtr, TCL_EVAL_GLOBAL) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); - } - Tcl_DecrRefCount(cmdObjPtr); -} - -void Axis::getGeometry() -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - freeTickLabels(); - - // Leave room for axis baseline and padding - unsigned int y =0; - if (ops->exterior && (gops->plotRelief != TK_RELIEF_SOLID)) - y += ops->lineWidth + 2; - - maxTickHeight_ = maxTickWidth_ = 0; - - if (t1Ptr_) - delete t1Ptr_; - t1Ptr_ = generateTicks(&majorSweep_); - - if (t2Ptr_) - delete t2Ptr_; - t2Ptr_ = generateTicks(&minorSweep_); - - if (ops->showTicks) { - Ticks* t1Ptr = ops->t1UPtr ? ops->t1UPtr : t1Ptr_; - - int nTicks =0; - if (t1Ptr) - nTicks = t1Ptr->nTicks; - - unsigned int nLabels =0; - for (int ii=0; iivalues[ii]; - double x2 = t1Ptr->values[ii]; - if (ops->labelOffset) - x2 += majorSweep_.step * 0.5; - - if (!inRange(x2, &axisRange_)) - continue; - - TickLabel* labelPtr = makeLabel(x); - tickLabels_->append(labelPtr); - nLabels++; - - // Get the dimensions of each tick label. Remember tick labels - // can be multi-lined and/or rotated. - int lw, lh; - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->tickFont, labelPtr->string, -1, &lw, &lh); - labelPtr->width = lw; - labelPtr->height = lh; - - if (ops->tickAngle != 0.0) { - // Rotated label width and height - double rlw, rlh; - graphPtr_->getBoundingBox(lw, lh, ops->tickAngle, &rlw, &rlh, NULL); - lw = (int)rlw; - lh = (int)rlh; - } - if (maxTickWidth_ < int(lw)) - maxTickWidth_ = lw; - - if (maxTickHeight_ < int(lh)) - maxTickHeight_ = lh; - } - - unsigned int pad =0; - if (ops->exterior) { - // Because the axis cap style is "CapProjecting", we need to - // account for an extra 1.5 linewidth at the end of each line - pad = ((ops->lineWidth * 12) / 8); - } - if (isHorizontal()) - y += maxTickHeight_ + pad; - else { - y += maxTickWidth_ + pad; - if (maxTickWidth_ > 0) - // Pad either size of label. - y += 5; - } - y += 2 * AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - if ((ops->lineWidth > 0) && ops->exterior) - // Distance from axis line to tick label. - y += ops->tickLength; - - } // showTicks - - if (ops->title) { - if (ops->titleAlternate) { - if (y < titleHeight_) - y = titleHeight_; - } - else - y += titleHeight_ + AXIS_PAD_TITLE; - } - - // Correct for orientation of the axis - if (isHorizontal()) - height_ = y; - else - width_ = y; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.h deleted file mode 100644 index d459e8c..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxis.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,266 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef ___BltGrAxis_h__ -#define ___BltGrAxis_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltChain.h" - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrText.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class Postscript; - - typedef struct { - int axis; - int t1; - int t2; - int label; - } AxisInfo; - - typedef struct { - const char* name; - ClassId classId; - } AxisName; - - extern AxisName axisNames[]; - - typedef struct { - Dashes dashes; - int lineWidth; - XColor* color; - GC gc; - Segment2d *segments; - int nUsed; - int nAllocated; - } Grid; - - typedef struct { - double min; - double max; - double range; - double scale; - } AxisRange; - - class TickLabel { - public: - Point2d anchorPos; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - char* string; - - public: - TickLabel(char*); - virtual ~TickLabel(); - }; - - class Ticks { - public: - int nTicks; - double* values; - - public: - Ticks(int); - virtual ~Ticks(); - }; - - typedef struct { - double initial; - double step; - int nSteps; - } TickSweep; - - typedef struct { - const char** tags; - int checkLimits; - int exterior; - int showGrid; - int showGridMinor; - int hide; - int showTicks; - - double windowSize; - const char *tickFormatCmd; - int descending; - int labelOffset; - TextStyleOptions limitsTextStyle; - const char *limitsFormat; - int lineWidth; - int logScale; - int looseMin; - int looseMax; - Ticks* t1UPtr; - Ticks* t2UPtr; - double reqMin; - double reqMax; - Tcl_Obj *scrollCmdObjPtr; - int scrollUnits; - double reqScrollMin; - double reqScrollMax; - double shiftBy; - double reqStep; - int reqNumMajorTicks; - int reqNumMinorTicks; - int tickLength; - const char *title; - int titleAlternate; - - XColor* activeFgColor; - int activeRelief; - Tk_3DBorder normalBg; - int borderWidth; - XColor* tickColor; - Grid major; - Grid minor; - Tk_Justify titleJustify; - int relief; - double tickAngle; - Tk_Anchor reqTickAnchor; - Tk_Font tickFont; - Tk_Font titleFont; - XColor* titleColor; - - const char *tickFormat; - } AxisOptions; - - class Axis { - protected: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - ClassId classId_; - const char* name_; - const char* className_; - - Tcl_HashEntry* hashPtr_; - int refCount_; - int use_; - int active_; - - ChainLink* link; - Chain* chain; - - Point2d titlePos_; - unsigned int titleWidth_; - unsigned int titleHeight_; - double min_; - double max_; - double scrollMin_; - double scrollMax_; - AxisRange valueRange_; - AxisRange axisRange_; - double prevMin_; - double prevMax_; - Ticks* t1Ptr_; - Ticks* t2Ptr_; - TickSweep minorSweep_; - TickSweep majorSweep_; - - int margin_; - Segment2d *segments_; - int nSegments_; - Chain* tickLabels_; - int left_; - int right_; - int top_; - int bottom_; - int width_; - int height_; - int maxTickWidth_; - int maxTickHeight_; - Tk_Anchor tickAnchor_; - GC tickGC_; - GC activeTickGC_; - double titleAngle_; - Tk_Anchor titleAnchor_; - double screenScale_; - int screenMin_; - int screenRange_; - - protected: - double niceNum(double, int); - void setRange(AxisRange*, double, double); - void makeGridLine(double, Segment2d*); - void makeSegments(AxisInfo*); - void resetTextStyles(); - void makeLine(int, Segment2d*); - void makeTick(double, int, int, Segment2d*); - void offsets(int, int, AxisInfo*); - void updateScrollbar(Tcl_Interp*, Tcl_Obj*, int, int, int); - - public: - Axis(Graph*, const char*, int, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~Axis(); - - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - void* ops() {return ops_;} - ClassId classId() {return classId_;} - const char* className() {return className_;} - - int configure(); - void map(int, int); - void draw(Drawable); - void drawGrids(Drawable); - void drawLimits(Drawable); - void print(PSOutput*); - void printGrids(PSOutput*); - void printLimits(PSOutput*); - - void mapStacked(int, int); - void mapGridlines(); - void setClass(ClassId); - void logScale(double, double); - void linearScale(double, double); - void fixRange(); - int isHorizontal(); - void freeTickLabels(); - TickLabel* makeLabel(double); - void getDataLimits(double, double); - Ticks* generateTicks(TickSweep*); - int inRange(double, AxisRange*); - void getGeometry(); - - double invHMap(double x); - double invVMap(double y); - double hMap(double x); - double vMap(double y); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 2c66f78..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,676 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define EXP10(x) (pow(10.0,(x))) - -static int GetAxisScrollInfo(Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[], - double *offsetPtr, double windowSize, - double scrollUnits, double scale); - -static double Clamp(double x) -{ - return (x < 0.0) ? 0.0 : (x > 1.0) ? 1.0 : x; -} - -int Blt::AxisObjConfigure(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)axisPtr->ops(), axisPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (axisPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisCgetOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId ?option value?..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisConfigureOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int ActivateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisActivateOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int BindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->axes_.tagTable, &iter); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - char* tagName = (char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&graphPtr->axes_.tagTable, hPtr); - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(tagName, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return graphPtr->bindTable_->configure(graphPtr->axisTag(Tcl_GetString(objv[3])), objc-4, objv+4); -} - -static int CreateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (graphPtr->createAxis(objc, objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objv[3]); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeleteOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (axisPtr->refCount_ == 0) - delete axisPtr; - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int InvTransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId scoord"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisInvTransformOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int LimitsOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisLimitsOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int MarginOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisMarginOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int NamesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (objc<3) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "?pattern...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->axes_.table, &cursor); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj(axisPtr->name_, -1)); - } - } - else { - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->axes_.table, &cursor); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - for (int ii=3; iiname_, pattern)) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(axisPtr->name_, -1)); - break; - } - } - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int TransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId coord"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisTransformOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int TypeOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisTypeOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -static int ViewOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "axisId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(objv[3], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return AxisViewOp(axisPtr, interp, objc-1, objv+1); -} - -const Ensemble Blt::axisEnsemble[] = { - {"activate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"bind", BindOp, 0}, - {"cget", CgetOp,0 }, - {"configure", ConfigureOp,0 }, - {"create", CreateOp, 0}, - {"deactivate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"delete", DeleteOp, 0}, - {"invtransform", InvTransformOp, 0}, - {"limits", LimitsOp, 0}, - {"margin", MarginOp, 0}, - {"names", NamesOp, 0}, - {"transform", TransformOp, 0}, - {"type", TypeOp, 0}, - {"view", ViewOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Support - -double AdjustViewport(double offset, double windowSize) -{ - // Canvas-style scrolling allows the world to be scrolled within the window. - if (windowSize > 1.0) { - if (windowSize < (1.0 - offset)) - offset = 1.0 - windowSize; - - if (offset > 0.0) - offset = 0.0; - } - else { - if ((offset + windowSize) > 1.0) - offset = 1.0 - windowSize; - - if (offset < 0.0) - offset = 0.0; - } - return offset; -} - -static int GetAxisScrollInfo(Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[], - double *offsetPtr, double windowSize, - double scrollUnits, double scale) -{ - const char *string; - char c; - double offset; - int length; - - offset = *offsetPtr; - string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[0], &length); - c = string[0]; - scrollUnits *= scale; - if ((c == 's') && (strncmp(string, "scroll", length) == 0)) { - int count; - double fract; - - /* Scroll number unit/page */ - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[1], &count) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[2], &length); - c = string[0]; - if ((c == 'u') && (strncmp(string, "units", length) == 0)) - fract = count * scrollUnits; - else if ((c == 'p') && (strncmp(string, "pages", length) == 0)) - /* A page is 90% of the view-able window. */ - fract = (int)(count * windowSize * 0.9 + 0.5); - else if ((c == 'p') && (strncmp(string, "pixels", length) == 0)) - fract = count * scale; - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown \"scroll\" units \"", string, - "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - offset += fract; - } - else if ((c == 'm') && (strncmp(string, "moveto", length) == 0)) { - double fract; - - /* moveto fraction */ - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[1], &fract) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - offset = fract; - } - else { - int count; - double fract; - - /* Treat like "scroll units" */ - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[0], &count) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - fract = (double)count * scrollUnits; - offset += fract; - /* CHECK THIS: return TCL_OK; */ - } - *offsetPtr = AdjustViewport(offset, windowSize); - return TCL_OK; -} - -// Common Ops - -int AxisCgetOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (objc != 4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, (char*)axisPtr->ops(), - axisPtr->optionTable(), - objv[3], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (!objPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisConfigureOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (objc <= 4) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)axisPtr->ops(), - axisPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 4) ? objv[3] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (!objPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return AxisObjConfigure(axisPtr, interp, objc-3, objv+3); -} - -int AxisActivateOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - const char *string; - - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - axisPtr->active_ = (string[0] == 'a') ? 1 : 0; - - if (!ops->hide && axisPtr->use_) { - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisInvTransformOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - int sy; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[3], &sy) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Is the axis vertical or horizontal? - // Check the site where the axis was positioned. If the axis is - // virtual, all we have to go on is how it was mapped to an - // element (using either -mapx or -mapy options). - double y = axisPtr->isHorizontal() ? - axisPtr->invHMap(sy) : axisPtr->invVMap(sy); - - Tcl_SetDoubleObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), y); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisLimitsOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - double min, max; - if (ops->logScale) { - min = EXP10(axisPtr->axisRange_.min); - max = EXP10(axisPtr->axisRange_.max); - } - else { - min = axisPtr->axisRange_.min; - max = axisPtr->axisRange_.max; - } - - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(min)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(max)); - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisMarginOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - const char *marginName = ""; - if (axisPtr->use_) - marginName = axisNames[axisPtr->margin_].name; - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), marginName, -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisTransformOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - double x; - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &x) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (axisPtr->isHorizontal()) - x = axisPtr->hMap(x); - else - x = axisPtr->vMap(x); - - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), (int)x); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisTypeOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - const char* typeName = ""; - if (axisPtr->use_) { - switch (axisPtr->classId_) { - case CID_AXIS_X: - typeName = "x"; - break; - case CID_AXIS_Y: - typeName = "y"; - break; - default: - return TCL_OK; - } - } - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), typeName, -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int AxisViewOp(Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - Graph* graphPtr = axisPtr->graphPtr_; - double worldMin = axisPtr->valueRange_.min; - double worldMax = axisPtr->valueRange_.max; - /* Override data dimensions with user-selected limits. */ - if (!isnan(axisPtr->scrollMin_)) - worldMin = axisPtr->scrollMin_; - - if (!isnan(axisPtr->scrollMax_)) - worldMax = axisPtr->scrollMax_; - - double viewMin = axisPtr->min_; - double viewMax = axisPtr->max_; - /* Bound the view within scroll region. */ - if (viewMin < worldMin) - viewMin = worldMin; - - if (viewMax > worldMax) - viewMax = worldMax; - - if (ops->logScale) { - worldMin = log10(worldMin); - worldMax = log10(worldMax); - viewMin = log10(viewMin); - viewMax = log10(viewMax); - } - double worldWidth = worldMax - worldMin; - double viewWidth = viewMax - viewMin; - - /* Unlike horizontal axes, vertical axis values run opposite of the - * scrollbar first/last values. So instead of pushing the axis minimum - * around, we move the maximum instead. */ - double axisOffset; - double axisScale; - if (axisPtr->isHorizontal() != ops->descending) { - axisOffset = viewMin - worldMin; - axisScale = graphPtr->hScale_; - } else { - axisOffset = worldMax - viewMax; - axisScale = graphPtr->vScale_; - } - if (objc == 4) { - double first = Clamp(axisOffset / worldWidth); - double last = Clamp((axisOffset + viewWidth) / worldWidth); - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(first)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(last)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - double fract = axisOffset / worldWidth; - if (GetAxisScrollInfo(interp, objc, objv, &fract, viewWidth / worldWidth, - ops->scrollUnits, axisScale) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (axisPtr->isHorizontal() != ops->descending) { - ops->reqMin = (fract * worldWidth) + worldMin; - ops->reqMax = ops->reqMin + viewWidth; - } - else { - ops->reqMax = worldMax - (fract * worldWidth); - ops->reqMin = ops->reqMax - viewWidth; - } - if (ops->logScale) { - ops->reqMin = EXP10(ops->reqMin); - ops->reqMax = EXP10(ops->reqMax); - } - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 777aea7..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,60 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrAxisOp_h__ -#define __BltGrAxisOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble axisEnsemble[]; - extern int AxisObjConfigure(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -}; - -extern int AxisCgetOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisConfigureOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisActivateOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisInvTransformOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisLimitsOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisMarginOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisTransformOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisTypeOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -extern int AxisViewOp(Blt::Axis* axisPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.C deleted file mode 100644 index 6f91d99..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,264 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOption.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc AxisSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc AxisGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc AxisFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption xAxisObjOption = - { - "xaxis", AxisSetProc, AxisGetProc, RestoreProc, AxisFreeProc, - (ClientData)CID_AXIS_X - }; -Tk_ObjCustomOption yAxisObjOption = - { - "yaxis", AxisSetProc, AxisGetProc, RestoreProc, AxisFreeProc, - (ClientData)CID_AXIS_Y - }; - -static int AxisSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - Axis** axisPtrPtr = (Axis**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)axisPtrPtr; - - if (!axisPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - Graph* graphPtr = getGraphFromWindowData(tkwin); -#ifdef _WIN64 - ClassId classId = (ClassId)((long long)clientData); -#else - ClassId classId = (ClassId)((long)clientData); -#endif - - Axis *axisPtr; - if (graphPtr->getAxis(*objPtr, &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (classId != CID_NONE) { - // Set the axis type on the first use of it. - if ((axisPtr->refCount_ == 0) || (axisPtr->classId_ == CID_NONE)) - axisPtr->setClass(classId); - - else if (axisPtr->classId_ != classId) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "axis \"", Tcl_GetString(*objPtr), - "\" is already in use on an opposite ", - axisPtr->className_, "-axis", - NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - axisPtr->refCount_++; - } - - *axisPtrPtr = axisPtr; - return TCL_OK; -}; - -static Tcl_Obj* AxisGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = *(Axis**)(widgRec + offset); - if (!axisPtr) - return Tcl_NewStringObj("", -1); - - return Tcl_NewStringObj(axisPtr->name_, -1); -}; - -static void AxisFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, char *ptr) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = *(Axis**)ptr; - if (axisPtr) { - axisPtr->refCount_--; - if (axisPtr->refCount_ == 0) - delete axisPtr; - } -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc LimitSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc LimitGetProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption limitObjOption = - { - "limit", LimitSetProc, LimitGetProc, NULL, NULL, NULL - }; - -static int LimitSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* save, int flags) -{ - double* limitPtr = (double*)(widgRec + offset); - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(*objPtr); - if (!string || !string[0]) { - *limitPtr = NAN; - return TCL_OK; - } - - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, *objPtr, limitPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* LimitGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - double limit = *(double*)(widgRec + offset); - Tcl_Obj* objPtr; - - if (!isnan(limit)) - objPtr = Tcl_NewDoubleObj(limit); - else - objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj("", -1); - - return objPtr; -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc TicksSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc TicksGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc TicksFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption ticksObjOption = - { - "ticks", TicksSetProc, TicksGetProc, RestoreProc, TicksFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int TicksSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - Ticks** ticksPtrPtr = (Ticks**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)ticksPtrPtr; - - if (!ticksPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - int objc; - Tcl_Obj** objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, *objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Ticks* ticksPtr = NULL; - if (objc > 0) { - ticksPtr = new Ticks(objc); - for (int ii=0; iivalues[ii] = value; - } - ticksPtr->nTicks = objc; - } - - *ticksPtrPtr = ticksPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* TicksGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Ticks* ticksPtr = *(Ticks**)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!ticksPtr) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); - - int cnt = ticksPtr->nTicks; - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[cnt]; - for (int ii = 0; iivalues[ii]); - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(cnt, ll); - delete [] ll; - - return listObjPtr; -} - -static void TicksFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr) -{ - Ticks* ticksPtr = *(Ticks**)ptr; - delete ticksPtr; -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc ObjectSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc ObjectGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc ObjectFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption objectObjOption = - { - "object", ObjectSetProc, ObjectGetProc, RestoreProc, ObjectFreeProc, NULL, - }; - -static int ObjectSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - Tcl_Obj** objectPtrPtr = (Tcl_Obj**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)objectPtrPtr; - - if (!objectPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - Tcl_IncrRefCount(*objPtr); - *objectPtrPtr = *objPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* ObjectGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Tcl_Obj** objectPtrPtr = (Tcl_Obj**)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!objectPtrPtr) - return Tcl_NewObj(); - - return *objectPtrPtr; -} - -static void ObjectFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr) -{ - Tcl_Obj* objectPtr = *(Tcl_Obj**)ptr; - if (objectPtr) - Tcl_DecrRefCount(objectPtr); -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4efa8ee..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrAxisOption.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrAxisOption_h__ -#define __BltGrAxisOption_h__ - -#include - -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption xAxisObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption yAxisObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption limitObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption ticksObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption objectObjOption; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.C deleted file mode 100644 index 3e7e81e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,227 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1998 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include -#include -#include -using namespace std; - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_EventProc BindProc; - -BindTable::BindTable(Graph* graphPtr, Pick* pickPtr) -{ - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - pickPtr_ = pickPtr; - grab_ =0; - table_ = Tk_CreateBindingTable(graphPtr->interp_); - currentItem_ =NULL; - currentContext_ =CID_NONE; - newItem_ =NULL; - newContext_ =CID_NONE; - focusItem_ =NULL; - focusContext_ =CID_NONE; - // pickEvent =NULL; - state_ =0; - - unsigned int mask = (KeyPressMask | KeyReleaseMask | ButtonPressMask | - ButtonReleaseMask | EnterWindowMask | LeaveWindowMask | - PointerMotionMask); - Tk_CreateEventHandler(graphPtr->tkwin_, mask, BindProc, this); -} - -BindTable::~BindTable() -{ - Tk_DeleteBindingTable(table_); - unsigned int mask = (KeyPressMask | KeyReleaseMask | ButtonPressMask | - ButtonReleaseMask | EnterWindowMask | LeaveWindowMask | - PointerMotionMask); - Tk_DeleteEventHandler(graphPtr_->tkwin_, mask, BindProc, this); -} - -int BindTable::configure(ClientData item, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc == 0) { - Tk_GetAllBindings(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, item); - return TCL_OK; - } - - const char *string = Tcl_GetString(objv[0]); - if (objc == 1) { - const char* command = - Tk_GetBinding(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, item, string); - if (!command) { - Tcl_ResetResult(graphPtr_->interp_); - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr_->interp_, "invalid binding event \"", - string, "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(graphPtr_->interp_), command, -1); - return TCL_OK; - } - - const char* seq = string; - const char* command = Tcl_GetString(objv[1]); - if (command[0] == '\0') - return Tk_DeleteBinding(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, item, seq); - - unsigned long mask; - if (command[0] == '+') - mask = Tk_CreateBinding(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, - item, seq, command+1, 1); - else - mask = Tk_CreateBinding(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, - item, seq, command, 0); - if (!mask) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (mask & (unsigned) ~(ButtonMotionMask|Button1MotionMask - |Button2MotionMask|Button3MotionMask|Button4MotionMask - |Button5MotionMask|ButtonPressMask|ButtonReleaseMask - |EnterWindowMask|LeaveWindowMask|KeyPressMask - |KeyReleaseMask|PointerMotionMask|VirtualEventMask)) { - Tk_DeleteBinding(graphPtr_->interp_, table_, item, seq); - Tcl_ResetResult(graphPtr_->interp_); - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr_->interp_, "requested illegal events; ", - "only key, button, motion, enter, leave, and virtual ", - "events may be used", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void BindTable::deleteBindings(ClientData object) -{ - Tk_DeleteAllBindings(table_, object); - - if (currentItem_ == object) { - currentItem_ =NULL; - currentContext_ =CID_NONE; - } - - if (newItem_ == object) { - newItem_ =NULL; - newContext_ =CID_NONE; - } - - if (focusItem_ == object) { - focusItem_ =NULL; - focusContext_ =CID_NONE; - } -} - -void BindTable::doEvent(XEvent* eventPtr) -{ - ClientData item = currentItem_; - ClassId classId = currentContext_; - - if ((eventPtr->type == KeyPress) || (eventPtr->type == KeyRelease)) { - item = focusItem_; - classId = focusContext_; - } - if (!item) - return; - - int nTags; - const char** tagArray = graphPtr_->getTags(item, classId, &nTags); - Tk_BindEvent(table_, eventPtr, graphPtr_->tkwin_, nTags, (void**)tagArray); - - delete [] tagArray; -} - -void BindTable::pickItem(XEvent* eventPtr) -{ - int buttonDown = state_ - & (Button1Mask|Button2Mask|Button3Mask|Button4Mask|Button5Mask); - - // A LeaveNotify event automatically means that there's no current item, - if (eventPtr->type != LeaveNotify) { - int x = eventPtr->xcrossing.x; - int y = eventPtr->xcrossing.y; - newItem_ = pickPtr_->pickEntry(x, y, &newContext_); - } - else { - newItem_ =NULL; - newContext_ = CID_NONE; - } - - // Nothing to do: the current item hasn't changed. - if ((newItem_ == currentItem_) && !grab_) - return; - - if (!buttonDown) - grab_ =0; - - if ((newItem_ != currentItem_) && buttonDown) { - grab_ =1; - return; - } - - grab_ =0; - currentItem_ = newItem_; - currentContext_ = newContext_; -} - -static void BindProc(ClientData clientData, XEvent* eventPtr) -{ - BindTable* bindPtr = (BindTable*)clientData; - Tcl_Preserve(bindPtr->graphPtr_); - - switch (eventPtr->type) { - case ButtonPress: - case ButtonRelease: - bindPtr->state_ = eventPtr->xbutton.state; - break; - case EnterNotify: - case LeaveNotify: - bindPtr->state_ = eventPtr->xcrossing.state; - break; - case MotionNotify: - bindPtr->state_ = eventPtr->xmotion.state; - break; - case KeyPress: - case KeyRelease: - bindPtr->state_ = eventPtr->xkey.state; - break; - } - - bindPtr->pickItem(eventPtr); - bindPtr->doEvent(eventPtr); - - Tcl_Release(bindPtr->graphPtr_); -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.h deleted file mode 100644 index 7947210..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrBind.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,72 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1998-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrBind_h__ -#define __BltGrBind_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class Pick; - - class BindTable { - protected: - Tk_BindingTable table_; - unsigned int grab_; - ClientData newItem_; - ClassId newContext_; - Pick* pickPtr_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - ClientData currentItem_; - ClassId currentContext_; - ClientData focusItem_; - ClassId focusContext_; - int state_; - XEvent pickEvent_; - - public: - BindTable(Graph*, Pick*); - virtual ~BindTable(); - - int configure(ClientData, int, Tcl_Obj *const []); - void deleteBindings(ClientData object); - void doEvent(XEvent*); - void pickItem(XEvent*); - - ClientData currentItem() {return currentItem_;} - }; -}; - - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrDef.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrDef.h deleted file mode 100644 index d73836a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrDef.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,45 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrDef_h__ -#define __BltGrDef_h__ - -#define STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND "gray85" -#define STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND "black" -#define STD_ACTIVE_BACKGROUND "gray90" -#define STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND "black" - -#define STD_FONT_LARGE "helvetica 16 normal roman" -#define STD_FONT_MEDIUM "helvetica 14 normal roman" -#define STD_FONT_NORMAL "helvetica 12 normal roman" -#define STD_FONT_SMALL "helvetica 10 normal roman" - -#define STD_BORDERWIDTH "2" - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.C deleted file mode 100644 index faf1b72..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,284 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -// Class ElemValues - -ElemValues::ElemValues() -{ - values_ =NULL; - nValues_ =0; - min_ =0; - max_ =0; -} - -ElemValues::~ElemValues() -{ - delete [] values_; -} - -void ElemValues::reset() -{ - delete [] values_; - values_ =NULL; - nValues_ =0; - min_ =0; - max_ =0; -} - -ElemValuesSource::ElemValuesSource(int nn) : ElemValues() -{ - nValues_ = nn; - values_ = new double[nn]; -} - -ElemValuesSource::ElemValuesSource(int nn, double* vv) : ElemValues() -{ - nValues_ = nn; - values_ = vv; -} - -ElemValuesSource::~ElemValuesSource() -{ -} - -void ElemValuesSource::findRange() -{ - if (nValues_<1 || !values_) - return; - - min_ = DBL_MAX; - max_ = -DBL_MAX; - for (int ii=0; ii max_) - max_ = values_[ii]; - } - } -} - -ElemValuesVector::ElemValuesVector(Element* ptr, const char* vecName) - : ElemValues() -{ - elemPtr_ = ptr; - Graph* graphPtr = elemPtr_->graphPtr_; - source_ = Blt_AllocVectorId(graphPtr->interp_, vecName); -} - -ElemValuesVector::~ElemValuesVector() -{ - freeSource(); -} - -int ElemValuesVector::getVector() -{ - Graph* graphPtr = elemPtr_->graphPtr_; - - Blt_Vector *vecPtr; - if (Blt_GetVectorById(graphPtr->interp_, source_, &vecPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (fetchValues(vecPtr) != TCL_OK) { - freeSource(); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(source_, VectorChangedProc, this); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int ElemValuesVector::fetchValues(Blt_Vector* vector) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = elemPtr_->graphPtr_; - - delete [] values_; - values_ = NULL; - nValues_ = 0; - min_ =0; - max_ =0; - - int ss = Blt_VecLength(vector); - if (!ss) - return TCL_OK; - - double* array = new double[ss]; - if (!array) { - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr->interp_, "can't allocate new vector", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - memcpy(array, Blt_VecData(vector), ss*sizeof(double)); - values_ = array; - nValues_ = Blt_VecLength(vector); - min_ = Blt_VecMin(vector); - max_ = Blt_VecMax(vector); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void ElemValuesVector::freeSource() -{ - if (source_) { - Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(source_, NULL, NULL); - Blt_FreeVectorId(source_); - source_ = NULL; - } -} - -// Class Element - -Element::Element(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) -{ - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - name_ = dupstr(name); - optionTable_ =NULL; - ops_ =NULL; - hashPtr_ = hPtr; - - row_ =0; - col_ =0; - activeIndices_ =NULL; - nActiveIndices_ =0; - xRange_ =0; - yRange_ =0; - active_ =0; - labelActive_ =0; - - link =NULL; -} - -Element::~Element() -{ - graphPtr_->bindTable_->deleteBindings(this); - - if (link) - graphPtr_->elements_.displayList->deleteLink(link); - - if (hashPtr_) - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hashPtr_); - - delete [] name_; - - delete [] activeIndices_; - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - -double Element::FindElemValuesMinimum(ElemValues* valuesPtr, double minLimit) -{ - double min = DBL_MAX; - if (!valuesPtr) - return min; - - for (int ii=0; iinValues(); ii++) { - double x = valuesPtr->values_[ii]; - // What do you do about negative values when using log - // scale values seems like a grey area. Mirror. - if (x < 0.0) - x = -x; - if ((x > minLimit) && (min > x)) - min = x; - } - if (min == DBL_MAX) - min = minLimit; - - return min; -} - -PenStyle** Element::StyleMap() -{ - ElementOptions* ops = (ElementOptions*)ops_; - - int nPoints = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - int nWeights = MIN(ops->w ? ops->w->nValues() : 0, nPoints); - double* w = ops->w ? ops->w->values_ : NULL; - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); - PenStyle* stylePtr = (PenStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - - // Create a style mapping array (data point index to style), - // initialized to the default style. - PenStyle** dataToStyle = new PenStyle*[nPoints]; - for (int ii=0; iistylePalette); link; - link=Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - stylePtr = (PenStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - - if (stylePtr->weight.range > 0.0) { - double norm = (w[ii] - stylePtr->weight.min) / stylePtr->weight.range; - if (((norm - 1.0) <= DBL_EPSILON) && - (((1.0 - norm) - 1.0) <= DBL_EPSILON)) { - dataToStyle[ii] = stylePtr; - break; - } - } - } - } - - return dataToStyle; -} - -void Element::freeStylePalette(Chain* stylePalette) -{ - // Skip the first slot. It contains the built-in "normal" pen of the element - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(stylePalette); - if (link) { - ChainLink* next; - for (link=Chain_NextLink(link); link; link=next) { - next = Chain_NextLink(link); - PenStyle *stylePtr = (PenStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Pen* penPtr = stylePtr->penPtr; - if (penPtr) { - penPtr->refCount_--; - if (penPtr->refCount_ == 0) - delete penPtr; - } - stylePalette->deleteLink(link); - } - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8904df0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElem.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,202 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrElem_h__ -#define __BltGrElem_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltVector.h" -#include "tkbltChain.h" - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -#define SHOW_NONE 0 -#define SHOW_X 1 -#define SHOW_Y 2 -#define SHOW_BOTH 3 - -#define NUMBEROFPOINTS(e) MIN( (e)->coords.x ? (e)->coords.x->nValues() : 0, \ - (e)->coords.y ? (e)->coords.y->nValues() : 0 ) -#define NORMALPEN(e) ((((e)->normalPenPtr == NULL) ? \ - (e)->builtinPenPtr : (e)->normalPenPtr)) - -namespace Blt { - class Axis; - class Element; - class Pen; - class Postscript; - - class ElemValues { - protected: - double min_; - double max_; - int nValues_; - - public: - double* values_; - - public: - ElemValues(); - virtual ~ElemValues(); - - void reset(); - int nValues() {return nValues_;} - double min() {return min_;} - double max() {return max_;} - }; - - class ElemValuesSource : public ElemValues - { - public: - ElemValuesSource(int); - ElemValuesSource(int, double*); - ~ElemValuesSource(); - - void findRange(); - }; - - class ElemValuesVector : public ElemValues - { - public: - Element* elemPtr_; - Blt_VectorId source_; - - public: - ElemValuesVector(Element*, const char*); - ~ElemValuesVector(); - - int getVector(); - int fetchValues(Blt_Vector*); - void freeSource(); - }; - - typedef struct { - Segment2d *segments; - int *map; - int length; - } GraphSegments; - - typedef struct { - ElemValuesSource* x; - ElemValuesSource* y; - } ElemCoords; - - typedef struct { - double min; - double max; - double range; - } Weight; - - typedef struct { - Weight weight; - Pen* penPtr; - } PenStyle; - - typedef struct { - Element* elemPtr; - const char* label; - const char** tags; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - ElemCoords coords; - ElemValues* w; - ElemValues* xError; - ElemValues* yError; - ElemValues* xHigh; - ElemValues* xLow; - ElemValues* yHigh; - ElemValues* yLow; - int hide; - int legendRelief; - Chain* stylePalette; - Pen* builtinPenPtr; - Pen* activePenPtr; - Pen* normalPenPtr; - PenOptions builtinPen; - } ElementOptions; - - class Element { - protected: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - double xRange_; - double yRange_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - const char* name_; - Tcl_HashEntry* hashPtr_; - unsigned row_; - unsigned col_; - int nActiveIndices_; - int* activeIndices_; - int active_; - int labelActive_; - - ChainLink* link; - - protected: - double FindElemValuesMinimum(ElemValues*, double); - PenStyle** StyleMap(); - - public: - Element(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~Element(); - - virtual int configure() =0; - virtual void map() =0; - virtual void extents(Region2d*) =0; - virtual void draw(Drawable) =0; - virtual void drawActive(Drawable) =0; - virtual void drawSymbol(Drawable, int, int, int) =0; - virtual void closest() =0; - virtual void print(PSOutput*) =0; - virtual void printActive(PSOutput*) =0; - virtual void printSymbol(PSOutput*, double, double, int) =0; - - virtual ClassId classId() =0; - virtual const char* className() =0; - virtual const char* typeName() =0; - - void freeStylePalette (Chain*); - - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - void* ops() {return ops_;} - }; -}; - -extern void VectorChangedProc(Tcl_Interp* interp, ClientData clientData, - Blt_VectorNotify notify); - - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.C deleted file mode 100644 index 6698760..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1315 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraphBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define CLAMP(x,l,h) ((x) = (((x)<(l))? (l) : ((x)>(h)) ? (h) : (x))) -#define MIN3(a,b,c) (((a)<(b))?(((a)<(c))?(a):(c)):(((b)<(c))?(b):(c))) - -#define PointInRectangle(r,x0,y0) \ - (((x0) <= (int)((r)->x + (r)->width - 1)) && ((x0) >= (int)(r)->x) && \ - ((y0) <= (int)((r)->y + (r)->height - 1)) && ((y0) >= (int)(r)->y)) - -// OptionSpecs - -static Tk_ObjCustomOption styleObjOption = - { - "style", StyleSetProc, StyleGetProc, StyleRestoreProc, StyleFreeProc, - (ClientData)sizeof(BarStyle) - }; - -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption penObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption pairsObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption valuesObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption xAxisObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption yAxisObjOption; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-activepen", "activePen", "ActivePen", - "active", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, activePenPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &penObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-background", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-barwidth", "barWidth", "BarWidth", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, barWidth), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "all", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.borderWidth), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-color", "color", "color", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.fill), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-data", "data", "Data", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, coords), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &pairsObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-errorbarcolor", "errorBarColor", "ErrorBarColor", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS,"-errorbarwidth", "errorBarWidth", "ErrorBarWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarLineWidth), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarcap", "errorBarCap", "ErrorBarCap", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarCapWidth), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-outline", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fill", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-foreground", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-outline", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, hide), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-label", "label", "Label", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, label), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-legendrelief", "legendRelief", "LegendRelief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, legendRelief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapx", "mapX", "MapX", - "x", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, xAxis), 0, &xAxisObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapy", "mapY", "MapY", - "y", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, yAxis), 0, &yAxisObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.outlineColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-pen", "pen", "Pen", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, normalPenPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &penObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "raised", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.relief), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showerrorbars", "showErrorBars", "ShowErrorBars", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showvalues", "showValues", "ShowValues", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.valueShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-stack", "stack", "Stack", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, groupName), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-styles", "styles", "Styles", - "", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, stylePalette), - 0, &styleObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-valueanchor", "valueAnchor", "ValueAnchor", - "s", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.anchor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-valuecolor", "valueColor", "ValueColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, - Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions,builtinPen.valueStyle.color), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-valuefont", "valueFont", "ValueFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.font), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-valueformat", "valueFormat", "ValueFormat", - "%g", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.valueFormat), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-valuerotate", "valueRotate", "ValueRotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.angle), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-weights", "weights", "Weights", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, w), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-x", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-xdata", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xdata", "xData", "XData", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, coords.x), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xerror", "xError", "XError", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, xError), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xhigh", "xHigh", "XHigh", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, xHigh), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xlow", "xLow", "XLow", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, xLow), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-y", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-ydata", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-ydata", "yData", "YData", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, coords.y), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-yerror", "yError", "YError", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, yError), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-yhigh", "yHigh", "YHigh", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, yHigh), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-ylow", "yLow", "YLow", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarElementOptions, yLow), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -BarElement::BarElement(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Element(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - barToData_ =NULL; - bars_ =NULL; - activeToData_ =NULL; - activeRects_ =NULL; - nBars_ =0; - nActive_ =0; - - xeb_.segments =NULL; - xeb_.map =NULL; - xeb_.length =0; - yeb_.segments =NULL; - yeb_.map =NULL; - yeb_.length =0; - - ops_ = (BarElementOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(BarElementOptions)); - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - ops->elemPtr = (Element*)this; - - builtinPenPtr = new BarPen(graphPtr_, "builtin", &ops->builtinPen); - ops->builtinPenPtr = builtinPenPtr; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - - ops->stylePalette = new Chain(); - - // this is an option and will be freed via Tk_FreeConfigOptions - // By default an element's name and label are the same - ops->label = Tcl_Alloc(strlen(name)+1); - if (name) - strcpy((char*)ops->label,(char*)name); - - Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr_->interp_, (char*)&(ops->builtinPen), - builtinPenPtr->optionTable(), graphPtr->tkwin_); -} - -BarElement::~BarElement() -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - delete builtinPenPtr; - - reset(); - - if (ops->stylePalette) { - freeStylePalette(ops->stylePalette); - delete ops->stylePalette; - } -} - -int BarElement::configure() -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (builtinPenPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Point to the static normal pen if no external pens have been selected. - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); - if (!link) { - link = new ChainLink(sizeof(BarStyle)); - ops->stylePalette->linkAfter(link, NULL); - } - BarStyle* stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void BarElement::map() -{ - BarGraph* barGraphPtr_ = (BarGraph*)graphPtr_; - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (!link) - return; - - reset(); - if (!ops->coords.x || !ops->coords.y || - !ops->coords.x->nValues() || !ops->coords.y->nValues()) - return; - int nPoints = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - - double barWidth = (ops->barWidth > 0.0) ? ops->barWidth : gops->barWidth; - AxisOptions* axisyops = (AxisOptions*)ops->yAxis->ops(); - double baseline = (axisyops->logScale) ? 0.0 : gops->baseline; - double barOffset = barWidth * 0.5; - - // Create an array of bars representing the screen coordinates of all the - // segments in the bar. - Rectangle* bars = new Rectangle[nPoints]; - int* barToData = new int[nPoints]; - - double* x = ops->coords.x->values_; - double* y = ops->coords.y->values_; - int count = 0; - - int ii; - Rectangle* rp; - for (rp=bars, ii=0; ii ops->xAxis->axisRange_.max) || - ((x[ii] + barWidth) < ops->xAxis->axisRange_.min)) - continue; - - c1.x = x[ii] - barOffset; - c1.y = y[ii]; - c2.x = c1.x + barWidth; - c2.y = baseline; - - // If the mode is "aligned" or "stacked" we need to adjust the x or y - // coordinates of the two corners. - if ((barGraphPtr_->nBarGroups_ > 0) && - ((BarGraph::BarMode)gops->barMode != BarGraph::INFRONT) && - (!gops->stackAxes)) { - - BarSetKey key; - key.value =x[ii]; - key.xAxis =ops->xAxis; - key.yAxis =NULL; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_FindHashEntry(&barGraphPtr_->setTable_, (char*)&key); - - if (hPtr) { - Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - const char *name = (ops->groupName) ? ops->groupName:ops->yAxis->name_; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr2 = Tcl_FindHashEntry(tablePtr, name); - if (hPtr2) { - BarGroup* groupPtr = (BarGroup*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr2); - double slice = barWidth / (double)barGraphPtr_->maxBarSetSize_; - double offset = (slice * groupPtr->index); - if (barGraphPtr_->maxBarSetSize_ > 1) { - offset += slice * 0.05; - slice *= 0.90; - } - - switch ((BarGraph::BarMode)gops->barMode) { - case BarGraph::STACKED: - groupPtr->count++; - c2.y = groupPtr->lastY; - c1.y += c2.y; - groupPtr->lastY = c1.y; - c1.x += offset; - c2.x = c1.x + slice; - break; - - case BarGraph::ALIGNED: - slice /= groupPtr->nSegments; - c1.x += offset + (slice * groupPtr->count); - c2.x = c1.x + slice; - groupPtr->count++; - break; - - case BarGraph::OVERLAP: - { - slice /= (groupPtr->nSegments + 1); - double width = slice + slice; - groupPtr->count++; - c1.x += offset + - (slice * (groupPtr->nSegments - groupPtr->count)); - c2.x = c1.x + width; - } - break; - - case BarGraph::INFRONT: - break; - } - } - } - } - - int invertBar = 0; - if (c1.y < c2.y) { - // Handle negative bar values by swapping ordinates - double temp = c1.y; - c1.y = c2.y; - c2.y = temp; - invertBar = 1; - } - - // Get the two corners of the bar segment and compute the rectangle - double ybot = c2.y; - c1 = graphPtr_->map2D(c1.x, c1.y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - c2 = graphPtr_->map2D(c2.x, c2.y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - if ((ybot == 0.0) && (axisyops->logScale)) - c2.y = graphPtr_->bottom_; - - if (c2.y < c1.y) { - double t = c1.y; - c1.y = c2.y; - c2.y = t; - } - - if (c2.x < c1.x) { - double t = c1.x; - c1.x = c2.x; - c2.x = t; - } - - if ((c1.x > graphPtr_->right_) || (c2.x < graphPtr_->left_) || - (c1.y > graphPtr_->bottom_) || (c2.y < graphPtr_->top_)) - continue; - - // Bound the bars horizontally by the width of the graph window - // Bound the bars vertically by the position of the axis. - double right =0; - double left =0; - double top =0; - double bottom =0; - if (gops->stackAxes) { - top = ops->yAxis->screenMin_; - bottom = ops->yAxis->screenMin_ + ops->yAxis->screenRange_; - left = graphPtr_->left_; - right = graphPtr_->right_; - } - else { - bottom = right = 10000; - // Shouldn't really have a call to Tk_Width or Tk_Height in - // mapping routine. We only want to clamp the bar segment to the - // size of the window if we're actually mapped onscreen - if (Tk_Height(graphPtr_->tkwin_) > 1) - bottom = Tk_Height(graphPtr_->tkwin_); - if (Tk_Width(graphPtr_->tkwin_) > 1) - right = Tk_Width(graphPtr_->tkwin_); - } - - CLAMP(c1.y, top, bottom); - CLAMP(c2.y, top, bottom); - CLAMP(c1.x, left, right); - CLAMP(c2.x, left, right); - double dx = fabs(c1.x - c2.x); - double dy = fabs(c1.y - c2.y); - if ((dx == 0) || (dy == 0)) - continue; - - int height = (int)dy; - int width = (int)dx; - if (invertBar) - rp->y = (int)MIN(c1.y, c2.y); - else - rp->y = (int)(MAX(c1.y, c2.y)) - height; - - rp->x = (int)MIN(c1.x, c2.x); - - rp->width = width + 1; - rp->width |= 0x1; - if (rp->width < 1) - rp->width = 1; - - rp->height = height + 1; - if (rp->height < 1) - rp->height = 1; - - // Save the data index corresponding to the rectangle - barToData[count] = ii; - count++; - rp++; - } - nBars_ = count; - bars_ = bars; - barToData_ = barToData; - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) - mapActive(); - - int size = 20; - if (count > 0) - size = bars->width; - - // Set the symbol size of all the pen styles - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - BarPen* penPtr = stylePtr->penPtr; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - stylePtr->symbolSize = size; - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth = pops->errorBarCapWidth; - } - - BarStyle** dataToStyle = (BarStyle**)StyleMap(); - if (((ops->yHigh && ops->yHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->yLow && ops->yLow->nValues() > 0)) || - ((ops->xHigh && ops->xHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->xLow && ops->xLow->nValues() > 0)) || - (ops->xError && ops->xError->nValues() > 0) || - (ops->yError && ops->yError->nValues() > 0)) { - mapErrorBars(dataToStyle); - } - - mergePens(dataToStyle); - delete [] dataToStyle; -} - -void BarElement::extents(Region2d *regPtr) -{ - BarGraph* barGraphPtr_ = (BarGraph*)graphPtr_; - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - regPtr->top = regPtr->left = DBL_MAX; - regPtr->bottom = regPtr->right = -DBL_MAX; - - if (!ops->coords.x || !ops->coords.y || - !ops->coords.x->nValues() || !ops->coords.y->nValues()) - return; - - int nPoints = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - - double middle = 0.5; - regPtr->left = ops->coords.x->min() - middle; - regPtr->right = ops->coords.x->max() + middle; - - regPtr->top = ops->coords.y->min(); - regPtr->bottom = ops->coords.y->max(); - if (regPtr->bottom < gops->baseline) - regPtr->bottom = gops->baseline; - - // Handle stacked bar elements specially. - // If element is stacked, the sum of its ordinates may be outside the - // minimum/maximum limits of the element's data points. - if (((BarGraph::BarMode)gops->barMode == BarGraph::STACKED) && - (barGraphPtr_->nBarGroups_ > 0)) - checkStacks(ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis, ®Ptr->top, ®Ptr->bottom); - - // Warning: You get what you deserve if the x-axis is logScale - AxisOptions* axisxops = (AxisOptions*)ops->xAxis->ops(); - AxisOptions* axisyops = (AxisOptions*)ops->yAxis->ops(); - if (axisxops->logScale) - regPtr->left = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->coords.x, DBL_MIN) + middle; - - // Fix y-min limits for barchart - if (axisyops->logScale) { - if ((regPtr->top <= 0.0) || (regPtr->top > 1.0)) - regPtr->top = 1.0; - } - else { - if (regPtr->top > 0.0) - regPtr->top = 0.0; - } - - // Correct the extents for error bars if they exist - if (ops->xError && (ops->xError->nValues() > 0)) { - nPoints = MIN(ops->xError->nValues(), nPoints); - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii] + ops->xError->values_[ii]; - if (x > regPtr->right) - regPtr->right = x; - - x = ops->coords.x->values_[ii] - ops->xError->values_[ii]; - if (axisxops->logScale) { - // Mirror negative values, instead of ignoring them - if (x < 0.0) - x = -x; - - if ((x > DBL_MIN) && (x < regPtr->left)) - regPtr->left = x; - - } - else if (x < regPtr->left) - regPtr->left = x; - } - } - else { - if ((ops->xHigh) && - (ops->xHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->xHigh->max() > regPtr->right)) - regPtr->right = ops->xHigh->max(); - - if (ops->xLow && (ops->xLow->nValues() > 0)) { - double left; - if ((ops->xLow->min() <= 0.0) && (axisxops->logScale)) - left = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->xLow, DBL_MIN); - else - left = ops->xLow->min(); - - if (left < regPtr->left) - regPtr->left = left; - } - } - - if (ops->yError && (ops->yError->nValues() > 0)) { - nPoints = MIN(ops->yError->nValues(), nPoints); - - for (int ii=0; iicoords.y->values_[ii] + ops->yError->values_[ii]; - if (y > regPtr->bottom) - regPtr->bottom = y; - - y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii] - ops->yError->values_[ii]; - if (axisyops->logScale) { - // Mirror negative values, instead of ignoring them - if (y < 0.0) - y = -y; - - if ((y > DBL_MIN) && (y < regPtr->left)) - regPtr->top = y; - - } - else if (y < regPtr->top) - regPtr->top = y; - } - } - else { - if ((ops->yHigh) && - (ops->yHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->yHigh->max() > regPtr->bottom)) - regPtr->bottom = ops->yHigh->max(); - - if (ops->yLow && ops->yLow->nValues() > 0) { - double top; - if ((ops->yLow->min() <= 0.0) && - (axisyops->logScale)) - top = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->yLow, DBL_MIN); - else - top = ops->yLow->min(); - - if (top < regPtr->top) - regPtr->top = top; - } - } -} - -void BarElement::closest() -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - ClosestSearch* searchPtr = &gops->search; - double minDist = searchPtr->dist; - int imin = 0; - - int ii; - Rectangle* bp; - for (bp=bars_, ii=0; iix, searchPtr->y)) { - imin = barToData_[ii]; - minDist = 0.0; - break; - } - double left = bp->x; - double top = bp->y; - double right = (double)(bp->x + bp->width); - double bottom = (double)(bp->y + bp->height); - - Point2d outline[5]; - outline[4].x = outline[3].x = outline[0].x = left; - outline[4].y = outline[1].y = outline[0].y = top; - outline[2].x = outline[1].x = right; - outline[3].y = outline[2].y = bottom; - - Point2d *pp, *pend; - for (pp=outline, pend=outline+4; ppx, searchPtr->y, pp, pp + 1); - if (t.x > right) - t.x = right; - else if (t.x < left) - t.x = left; - - if (t.y > bottom) - t.y = bottom; - else if (t.y < top) - t.y = top; - - double dist = hypot((t.x - searchPtr->x), (t.y - searchPtr->y)); - if (dist < minDist) { - minDist = dist; - imin = barToData_[ii]; - } - } - } - if (minDist < searchPtr->dist) { - searchPtr->elemPtr = (Element*)this; - searchPtr->dist = minDist; - searchPtr->index = imin; - searchPtr->point.x = - ops->coords.x ? (double)ops->coords.x->values_[imin] : 0; - searchPtr->point.y = - ops->coords.y ? (double)ops->coords.y->values_[imin] : 0; - } -} - -void BarElement::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide) - return; - - int count = 0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - - BarStyle* stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - BarPen* penPtr = (BarPen*)stylePtr->penPtr; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (stylePtr->nBars > 0) - drawSegments(drawable, penPtr, stylePtr->bars, stylePtr->nBars); - - if ((stylePtr->xeb.length > 0) && (pops->errorBarShow & SHOW_X)) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, penPtr->errorBarGC_, - stylePtr->xeb.segments, stylePtr->xeb.length); - - if ((stylePtr->yeb.length > 0) && (pops->errorBarShow & SHOW_Y)) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, penPtr->errorBarGC_, - stylePtr->yeb.segments, stylePtr->yeb.length); - - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, stylePtr->bars, stylePtr->nBars, - barToData_ + count); - - count += stylePtr->nBars; - } -} - -void BarElement::drawActive(Drawable drawable) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !active_) - return; - - BarPen* penPtr = (BarPen*)ops->activePenPtr; - if (!penPtr) - return; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) { - mapActive(); - - drawSegments(drawable, penPtr, activeRects_, nActive_); - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, activeRects_, nActive_, activeToData_); - } - else if (nActiveIndices_ < 0) { - drawSegments(drawable, penPtr, bars_, nBars_); - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, bars_, nBars_, barToData_); - } -} - -void BarElement::drawSymbol(Drawable drawable, int x, int y, int size) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - BarPen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - int radius = (size / 2); - size--; - - x -= radius; - y -= radius; - - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(graphPtr_->tkwin_, drawable, - pops->fill, x, y, size, size, - pops->borderWidth, pops->relief); - - if (pops->outlineColor) - XDrawRectangle(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr->outlineGC_, - x, y, size, size); -} - -void BarElement::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide) - return; - - psPtr->format("\n%% Element \"%s\"\n\n", name_); - - int count = 0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - BarPen* penPtr = (BarPen*)stylePtr->penPtr; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (stylePtr->nBars > 0) - printSegments(psPtr, penPtr, stylePtr->bars, stylePtr->nBars); - - XColor* colorPtr = pops->errorBarColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = pops->outlineColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = Tk_3DBorderColor(pops->fill); - - if ((stylePtr->xeb.length > 0) && (pops->errorBarShow & SHOW_X)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(colorPtr, pops->errorBarLineWidth, - NULL, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->printSegments(stylePtr->xeb.segments, stylePtr->xeb.length); - } - - if ((stylePtr->yeb.length > 0) && (pops->errorBarShow & SHOW_Y)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(colorPtr, pops->errorBarLineWidth, - NULL, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->printSegments(stylePtr->yeb.segments, stylePtr->yeb.length); - } - - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, stylePtr->bars, stylePtr->nBars, - barToData_ + count); - - count += stylePtr->nBars; - } -} - -void BarElement::printActive(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->hide || !active_) - return; - - BarPen* penPtr = (BarPen*)ops->activePenPtr; - if (!penPtr) - return; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - psPtr->format("\n%% Active Element \"%s\"\n\n", name_); - - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) { - mapActive(); - - printSegments(psPtr, penPtr, activeRects_, nActive_); - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, activeRects_, nActive_,activeToData_); - } - else if (nActiveIndices_ < 0) { - printSegments(psPtr, penPtr, bars_, nBars_); - if (pops->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, bars_, nBars_, barToData_); - } -} - -void BarElement::printSymbol(PSOutput* psPtr, double x, double y, int size) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - BarPen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - x -= size/2.; - y -= size/2.; - - psPtr->fill3DRectangle(pops->fill, x, y, size, size, - pops->borderWidth, pops->relief); - - if (pops->outlineColor) { - psPtr->setForeground(pops->outlineColor); - psPtr->printRectangle(x, y, size, size); - } -} - -// Support - -void BarElement::ResetStylePalette(Chain* stylePalette) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->xeb.length = 0; - stylePtr->yeb.length = 0; - stylePtr->nBars = 0; - } -} - -void BarElement::checkStacks(Axis* xAxis, Axis* yAxis, - double* minPtr, double* maxPtr) -{ - BarGraph* barGraphPtr_ = (BarGraph*)graphPtr_; - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - if (((BarGraph::BarMode)gops->barMode != BarGraph::STACKED) || - barGraphPtr_->nBarGroups_ == 0) - return; - - for (BarGroup *gp = barGraphPtr_->barGroups_, - *gend = gp + barGraphPtr_->nBarGroups_; gp < gend; gp++) { - if ((gp->xAxis == xAxis) && (gp->yAxis == yAxis)) { - - // Check if any of the y-values (because of stacking) are greater - // than the current limits of the graph. - if (gp->sum < 0.0) { - if (*minPtr > gp->sum) - *minPtr = gp->sum; - } - else { - if (*maxPtr < gp->sum) - *maxPtr = gp->sum; - } - } - } -} - -void BarElement::mergePens(BarStyle** dataToStyle) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (Chain_GetLength(ops->stylePalette) < 2) { - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->nBars = nBars_; - stylePtr->bars = bars_; - stylePtr->symbolSize = bars_->width / 2; - stylePtr->xeb.length = xeb_.length; - stylePtr->xeb.segments = xeb_.segments; - stylePtr->yeb.length = yeb_.length; - stylePtr->yeb.segments = yeb_.segments; - return; - } - - // We have more than one style. Group bar segments of like pen styles together - if (nBars_ > 0) { - Rectangle* bars = new Rectangle[nBars_]; - int* barToData = new int[nBars_]; - Rectangle* bp = bars; - int* ip = barToData; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->symbolSize = bp->width / 2; - stylePtr->bars = bp; - for (int ii=0; iinBars = bp - stylePtr->bars; - } - delete [] bars_; - bars_ = bars; - delete [] barToData_; - barToData_ = barToData; - } - - if (xeb_.length > 0) { - Segment2d* bars = new Segment2d[xeb_.length]; - Segment2d *sp = bars; - int* map = new int[xeb_.length]; - int* ip = map; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->xeb.segments = sp; - for (int ii=0; iixeb.length = sp - stylePtr->xeb.segments; - } - delete [] xeb_.segments; - xeb_.segments = bars; - delete [] xeb_.map; - xeb_.map = map; - } - - if (yeb_.length > 0) { - Segment2d* bars = new Segment2d[yeb_.length]; - Segment2d* sp = bars; - int* map = new int[yeb_.length]; - int* ip = map; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarStyle *stylePtr = (BarStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->yeb.segments = sp; - for (int ii=0; iiyeb.length = sp - stylePtr->yeb.segments; - } - delete [] yeb_.segments; - yeb_.segments = bars; - delete [] yeb_.map; - yeb_.map = map; - } -} - -void BarElement::mapActive() -{ - delete [] activeRects_; - activeRects_ = NULL; - - delete [] activeToData_; - activeToData_ = NULL; - - nActive_ = 0; - - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) { - Rectangle* activeRects = new Rectangle[nActiveIndices_]; - int* activeToData = new int[nActiveIndices_]; - int count = 0; - for (int ii=0; iistylePalette); - - delete [] activeRects_; - activeRects_ = NULL; - delete [] activeToData_; - activeToData_ = NULL; - - delete [] xeb_.segments; - xeb_.segments = NULL; - delete [] xeb_.map; - xeb_.map = NULL; - xeb_.length = 0; - - delete [] yeb_.segments; - yeb_.segments = NULL; - delete [] yeb_.map; - yeb_.map = NULL; - yeb_.length = 0; - - delete [] bars_; - bars_ = NULL; - delete [] barToData_; - barToData_ = NULL; - - nActive_ = 0; - nBars_ = 0; -} - -void BarElement::mapErrorBars(BarStyle **dataToStyle) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - - Region2d reg; - graphPtr_->extents(®); - - int nPoints = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - int nn =0; - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - if (ops->xError && (ops->xError->nValues() > 0)) - nn = MIN(ops->xError->nValues(), nPoints); - else - if (ops->xHigh && ops->xLow) - nn = MIN3(ops->xHigh->nValues(), ops->xLow->nValues(), nPoints); - } - - if (nn) { - Segment2d* bars = new Segment2d[nn * 3]; - Segment2d* segPtr = bars; - int* map = new int[nn * 3]; - int* indexPtr = map; - - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii]; - BarStyle* stylePtr = dataToStyle[ii]; - - if ((isfinite(x)) && (isfinite(y))) { - double high, low; - if (ops->xError->nValues() > 0) { - high = x + ops->xError->values_[ii]; - low = x - ops->xError->values_[ii]; - } - else { - high = ops->xHigh ? ops->xHigh->values_[ii] : 0; - low = ops->xLow ? ops->xLow->values_[ii] : 0; - } - if ((isfinite(high)) && (isfinite(low))) { - Point2d p = graphPtr_->map2D(high, y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - Point2d q = graphPtr_->map2D(low, y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - segPtr->p = p; - segPtr->q = q; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Left cap - segPtr->p.x = p.x; - segPtr->q.x = p.x; - segPtr->p.y = p.y - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.y = p.y + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Right cap - segPtr->p.x = q.x; - segPtr->q.x = q.x; - segPtr->p.y = q.y - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.y = q.y + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - } - } - } - xeb_.segments = bars; - xeb_.length = segPtr - bars; - xeb_.map = map; - } - - nn =0; - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - if (ops->yError && (ops->yError->nValues() > 0)) - nn = MIN(ops->yError->nValues(), nPoints); - else - if (ops->yHigh && ops->yLow) - nn = MIN3(ops->yHigh->nValues(), ops->yLow->nValues(), nPoints); - } - - if (nn) { - Segment2d* bars = new Segment2d[nn * 3]; - Segment2d* segPtr = bars; - int* map = new int[nn * 3]; - int* indexPtr = map; - - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii]; - BarStyle *stylePtr = dataToStyle[ii]; - - if ((isfinite(x)) && (isfinite(y))) { - double high, low; - if (ops->yError->nValues() > 0) { - high = y + ops->yError->values_[ii]; - low = y - ops->yError->values_[ii]; - } - else { - high = ops->yHigh->values_[ii]; - low = ops->yLow->values_[ii]; - } - if ((isfinite(high)) && (isfinite(low))) { - Point2d p = graphPtr_->map2D(x, high, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - Point2d q = graphPtr_->map2D(x, low, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - segPtr->p = p; - segPtr->q = q; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Top cap - segPtr->p.y = p.y; - segPtr->q.y = p.y; - segPtr->p.x = p.x - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.x = p.x + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Bottom cap - segPtr->p.y = q.y; - segPtr->q.y = q.y; - segPtr->p.x = q.x - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.x = q.x + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(®, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - } - } - } - yeb_.segments = bars; - yeb_.length = segPtr - bars; - yeb_.map = map; - } -} - -void BarElement::drawSegments(Drawable drawable, BarPen* penPtr, - Rectangle *bars, int nBars) -{ - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - for (Rectangle *rp = bars, *rend = rp + nBars; rp < rend; rp++) { - if ((rp->width < 1) || (rp->height < 1)) - continue; - - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(graphPtr_->tkwin_, drawable, - pops->fill, rp->x, rp->y, rp->width, rp->height, - pops->borderWidth, pops->relief); - - if (pops->outlineColor) - XDrawRectangle(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr->outlineGC_, - rp->x, rp->y, rp->width, rp->height); - } -} - -void BarElement::drawValues(Drawable drawable, BarPen* penPtr, - Rectangle *bars, int nBars, int *barToData) -{ - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - const char *fmt = pops->valueFormat; - if (!fmt) - fmt = "%g"; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &pops->valueStyle); - - int count = 0; - for (Rectangle *rp = bars, *rend = rp + nBars; rp < rend; rp++) { - Point2d anchorPos; - char string[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE * 2 + 2]; - - double x = ops->coords.x->values_[barToData[count]]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[barToData[count]]; - - count++; - if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_X) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_Y) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_BOTH) { - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - strcat(string, ","); - snprintf(string + strlen(string), TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - } - - if (gops->inverted) { - anchorPos.y = rp->y + rp->height * 0.5; - anchorPos.x = rp->x + rp->width; - if (x < gops->baseline) - anchorPos.x -= rp->width; - } - else { - anchorPos.x = rp->x + rp->width * 0.5; - anchorPos.y = rp->y; - if (y < gops->baseline) - anchorPos.y += rp->height; - } - - ts.drawText(drawable, string, anchorPos.x, anchorPos.y); - } -} - -void BarElement::printSegments(PSOutput* psPtr, BarPen* penPtr, - Rectangle *bars, int nBars) -{ - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - for (Rectangle *rp = bars, *rend = rp + nBars; rp < rend; rp++) { - if ((rp->width < 1) || (rp->height < 1)) - continue; - - psPtr->fill3DRectangle(pops->fill, (double)rp->x, (double)rp->y, - (int)rp->width, (int)rp->height, - pops->borderWidth, pops->relief); - - if (pops->outlineColor) { - psPtr->setForeground(pops->outlineColor); - psPtr->printRectangle((double)rp->x, (double)rp->y, - (int)rp->width, (int)rp->height); - } - } -} - -void BarElement::printValues(PSOutput* psPtr, BarPen* penPtr, - Rectangle *bars, int nBars, int *barToData) -{ - BarPenOptions* pops = (BarPenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)ops_; - BarGraphOptions* gops = (BarGraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - int count = 0; - const char* fmt = pops->valueFormat; - if (!fmt) - fmt = "%g"; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &pops->valueStyle); - - for (Rectangle *rp = bars, *rend = rp + nBars; rp < rend; rp++) { - double x = ops->coords.x->values_[barToData[count]]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[barToData[count]]; - - count++; - char string[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE * 2 + 2]; - if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_X) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_Y) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_BOTH) { - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - strcat(string, ","); - snprintf(string + strlen(string), TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - } - - Point2d anchorPos; - if (gops->inverted) { - anchorPos.y = rp->y + rp->height * 0.5; - anchorPos.x = rp->x + rp->width; - if (x < gops->baseline) - anchorPos.x -= rp->width; - } - else { - anchorPos.x = rp->x + rp->width * 0.5; - anchorPos.y = rp->y; - if (y < gops->baseline) - anchorPos.y += rp->height; - } - - ts.printText(psPtr, string, anchorPos.x, anchorPos.y); - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8b48114..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemBar.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,132 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrElemBar_h__ -#define __BltGrElemBar_h__ - -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - float x1; - float y1; - float x2; - float y2; - } BarRegion; - - typedef struct { - Weight weight; - BarPen* penPtr; - Rectangle* bars; - int nBars; - GraphSegments xeb; - GraphSegments yeb; - int symbolSize; - int errorBarCapWidth; - } BarStyle; - - typedef struct { - Element* elemPtr; - const char *label; - char** tags; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - ElemCoords coords; - ElemValues* w; - ElemValues* xError; - ElemValues* yError; - ElemValues* xHigh; - ElemValues* xLow; - ElemValues* yHigh; - ElemValues* yLow; - int hide; - int legendRelief; - Chain* stylePalette; - BarPen* builtinPenPtr; - BarPen* activePenPtr; - BarPen* normalPenPtr; - BarPenOptions builtinPen; - - // derived - double barWidth; - const char *groupName; - } BarElementOptions; - - class BarElement : public Element { - protected: - BarPen* builtinPenPtr; - int* barToData_; - Rectangle* bars_; - int* activeToData_; - Rectangle* activeRects_; - int nBars_; - int nActive_; - GraphSegments xeb_; - GraphSegments yeb_; - - protected: - void ResetStylePalette(Chain*); - void checkStacks(Axis*, Axis*, double*, double*); - void mergePens(BarStyle**); - void mapActive(); - void reset(); - void mapErrorBars(BarStyle**); - void drawSegments(Drawable, BarPen*, Rectangle*, int); - void drawValues(Drawable, BarPen*, Rectangle*, int, int*); - void printSegments(PSOutput*, BarPen*, Rectangle*, int); - void printValues(PSOutput*, BarPen*, Rectangle*, int, int*); - - public: - BarElement(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~BarElement(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_ELEM_BAR;} - const char* className() {return "BarElement";} - const char* typeName() {return "bar";} - - int configure(); - void map(); - void extents(Region2d*); - void closest(); - void draw(Drawable); - void drawActive(Drawable); - void drawSymbol(Drawable, int, int, int); - void print(PSOutput*); - void printActive(PSOutput*); - void printSymbol(PSOutput*, double, double, int); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.C deleted file mode 100644 index 9e3f39a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2477 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright (c) 1993 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define SEARCH_X 0 -#define SEARCH_Y 1 -#define SEARCH_BOTH 2 - -#define SEARCH_POINTS 0 // closest data point. -#define SEARCH_TRACES 1 // closest point on trace. -#define SEARCH_AUTO 2 // traces if linewidth is > 0 and more than one - -#define MIN3(a,b,c) (((a)<(b))?(((a)<(c))?(a):(c)):(((b)<(c))?(b):(c))) -#define PointInRegion(e,x,y) (((x) <= (e)->right) && ((x) >= (e)->left) && ((y) <= (e)->bottom) && ((y) >= (e)->top)) - -#define BROKEN_TRACE(dir,last,next) (((dir == INCREASING)&&(next < last)) || ((dir == DECREASING)&&(next > last))) -#define DRAW_SYMBOL() (symbolInterval_==0||(symbolCounter_%symbolInterval_)==0) - -static const char* symbolMacros[] = - {"Li", "Sq", "Ci", "Di", "Pl", "Cr", "Sp", "Sc", "Tr", "Ar", "Bm", NULL}; - -// OptionSpecs - -static const char* smoothObjOption[] = - {"linear", "step", "cubic", "quadratic", "catrom", NULL}; - -static const char* penDirObjOption[] = - {"increasing", "decreasing", "both", NULL}; - -static Tk_ObjCustomOption styleObjOption = - { - "styles", StyleSetProc, StyleGetProc, StyleRestoreProc, StyleFreeProc, - (ClientData)sizeof(LineStyle) - }; - -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption penObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption pairsObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption valuesObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption xAxisObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption yAxisObjOption; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-activepen", "activePen", "ActivePen", - "active", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, activePenPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &penObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-areabackground", "areaBackground", "AreaBackground", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, fillBg), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "all", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-color", "color", "Color", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, - Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.traceColor), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-dashes", "dashes", "Dashes", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.traceDashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-data", "data", "Data", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, coords), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &pairsObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-errorbarcolor", "errorBarColor", "ErrorBarColor", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS,"-errorbarwidth", "errorBarWidth", "ErrorBarWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarLineWidth), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarcap", "errorBarCap", "ErrorBarCap", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarCapWidth), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-fill", "fill", "Fill", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.symbol.fillColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, hide), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-label", "label", "Label", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, label), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK | TK_OPTION_DONT_SET_DEFAULT, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-legendrelief", "legendRelief", "LegendRelief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, legendRelief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "LineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.traceWidth), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapx", "mapX", "MapX", - "x", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, xAxis), 0, &xAxisObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapy", "mapY", "MapY", - "y", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, yAxis), 0, &yAxisObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-maxsymbols", "maxSymbols", "MaxSymbols", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, reqMaxSymbols), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-offdash", "offDash", "OffDash", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.traceOffColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.symbol.outlineColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-outlinewidth", "outlineWidth", "OutlineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.symbol.outlineWidth), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-pen", "pen", "Pen", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, normalPenPtr), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &penObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-pixels", "pixels", "Pixels", - "0.1i", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.symbol.size), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-reduce", "reduce", "Reduce", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, rTolerance), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-scalesymbols", "scaleSymbols", "ScaleSymbols", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, scaleSymbols), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showerrorbars", "showErrorBars", "ShowErrorBars", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.errorBarShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showvalues", "showValues", "ShowValues", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-smooth", "smooth", "Smooth", - "linear", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, reqSmooth), - 0, &smoothObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-styles", "styles", "Styles", - "", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, stylePalette), - 0, &styleObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-symbol", "symbol", "Symbol", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.symbol), - 0, &symbolObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-trace", "trace", "Trace", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, penDir), - 0, &penDirObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-valueanchor", "valueAnchor", "ValueAnchor", - "s", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.anchor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-valuecolor", "valueColor", "ValueColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND,-1, - Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-valuefont", "valueFont", "ValueFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, - Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.font), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-valueformat", "valueFormat", "ValueFormat", - "%g", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueFormat), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-valuerotate", "valueRotate", "ValueRotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, builtinPen.valueStyle.angle), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-weights", "weights", "Weights", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, w), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-x", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-xdata", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xdata", "xData", "XData", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, coords.x), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xerror", "xError", "XError", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, xError), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xhigh", "xHigh", "XHigh", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, xHigh), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-xlow", "xLow", "XLow", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, xLow), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-y", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-ydata", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-ydata", "yData", "YData", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, coords.y), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-yerror", "yError", "YError", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, yError), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-yhigh", "yHigh", "YHigh", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, yHigh), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-ylow", "yLow", "YLow", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineElementOptions, yLow), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &valuesObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -LineElement::LineElement(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Element(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - smooth_ = LINEAR; - fillPts_ =NULL; - nFillPts_ = 0; - - symbolPts_.points =NULL; - symbolPts_.length =0; - symbolPts_.map =NULL; - activePts_.points =NULL; - activePts_.length =0; - activePts_.map =NULL; - - xeb_.segments =NULL; - xeb_.map =NULL; - xeb_.length =0; - yeb_.segments =NULL; - yeb_.map =NULL; - yeb_.length =0; - - symbolInterval_ =0; - symbolCounter_ =0; - traces_ =NULL; - - ops_ = (LineElementOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(LineElementOptions)); - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - ops->elemPtr = (Element*)this; - - builtinPenPtr = new LinePen(graphPtr, "builtin", &ops->builtinPen); - ops->builtinPenPtr = builtinPenPtr; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - - ops->stylePalette = new Chain(); - // this is an option and will be freed via Tk_FreeConfigOptions - // By default an element's name and label are the same - ops->label = Tcl_Alloc(strlen(name)+1); - if (name) - strcpy((char*)ops->label,(char*)name); - - Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr->interp_, (char*)&(ops->builtinPen), - builtinPenPtr->optionTable(), graphPtr->tkwin_); -} - -LineElement::~LineElement() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - delete builtinPenPtr; - - reset(); - - if (ops->stylePalette) { - freeStylePalette(ops->stylePalette); - delete ops->stylePalette; - } - - delete [] fillPts_; -} - -int LineElement::configure() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (builtinPenPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Point to the static normal/active pens if no external pens have been - // selected. - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); - if (!link) { - link = new ChainLink(sizeof(LineStyle)); - ops->stylePalette->linkAfter(link, NULL); - } - LineStyle* stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void LineElement::map() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (!link) - return; - - reset(); - if (!ops->coords.x || !ops->coords.y || - !ops->coords.x->nValues() || !ops->coords.y->nValues()) - return; - - MapInfo mi; - getScreenPoints(&mi); - mapSymbols(&mi); - - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) - mapActiveSymbols(); - - // Map connecting line segments if they are to be displayed. - smooth_ = (Smoothing)ops->reqSmooth; - if ((mi.nScreenPts > 1) && (ops->builtinPen.traceWidth > 0)) { - // Do smoothing if necessary. This can extend the coordinate array, - // so both mi.points and mi.nPoints may change. - switch (smooth_) { - case STEP: - generateSteps(&mi); - break; - - case CUBIC: - case QUADRATIC: - // Can't interpolate with less than three points - if (mi.nScreenPts < 3) - smooth_ = LINEAR; - else - generateSpline(&mi); - break; - - case CATROM: - // Can't interpolate with less than three points - if (mi.nScreenPts < 3) - smooth_ = LINEAR; - else - generateParametricSpline(&mi); - break; - - default: - break; - } - if (ops->rTolerance > 0.0) - reducePoints(&mi, ops->rTolerance); - - if (ops->fillBg) - mapFillArea(&mi); - - mapTraces(&mi); - } - delete [] mi.screenPts; - delete [] mi.map; - - // Set the symbol size of all the pen styles - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle* stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen *)stylePtr->penPtr; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - int size = scaleSymbol(penOps->symbol.size); - stylePtr->symbolSize = size; - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth = penOps->errorBarCapWidth; - } - - LineStyle** styleMap = (LineStyle**)StyleMap(); - if (((ops->yHigh && ops->yHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->yLow && ops->yLow->nValues() > 0)) || - ((ops->xHigh && ops->xHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->xLow && ops->xLow->nValues() > 0)) || - (ops->xError && ops->xError->nValues() > 0) || - (ops->yError && ops->yError->nValues() > 0)) { - mapErrorBars(styleMap); - } - - mergePens(styleMap); - delete [] styleMap; -} - -void LineElement::extents(Region2d *extsPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - extsPtr->top = extsPtr->left = DBL_MAX; - extsPtr->bottom = extsPtr->right = -DBL_MAX; - - if (!ops->coords.x || !ops->coords.y || - !ops->coords.x->nValues() || !ops->coords.y->nValues()) - return; - int np = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - - extsPtr->right = ops->coords.x->max(); - AxisOptions* axisxops = (AxisOptions*)ops->xAxis->ops(); - if ((ops->coords.x->min() <= 0.0) && (axisxops->logScale)) - extsPtr->left = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->coords.x, DBL_MIN); - else - extsPtr->left = ops->coords.x->min(); - - extsPtr->bottom = ops->coords.y->max(); - AxisOptions* axisyops = (AxisOptions*)ops->yAxis->ops(); - if ((ops->coords.y->min() <= 0.0) && (axisyops->logScale)) - extsPtr->top = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->coords.y, DBL_MIN); - else - extsPtr->top = ops->coords.y->min(); - - // Correct the data limits for error bars - if (ops->xError && ops->xError->nValues() > 0) { - np = MIN(ops->xError->nValues(), np); - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii] + ops->xError->values_[ii]; - if (x > extsPtr->right) - extsPtr->right = x; - - x = ops->coords.x->values_[ii] - ops->xError->values_[ii]; - AxisOptions* axisxops = (AxisOptions*)ops->xAxis->ops(); - if (axisxops->logScale) { - // Mirror negative values, instead of ignoring them - if (x < 0.0) - x = -x; - if ((x > DBL_MIN) && (x < extsPtr->left)) - extsPtr->left = x; - } - else if (x < extsPtr->left) - extsPtr->left = x; - } - } - else { - if (ops->xHigh && - (ops->xHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->xHigh->max() > extsPtr->right)) { - extsPtr->right = ops->xHigh->max(); - } - if (ops->xLow && ops->xLow->nValues() > 0) { - double left; - if ((ops->xLow->min() <= 0.0) && (axisxops->logScale)) - left = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->xLow, DBL_MIN); - else - left = ops->xLow->min(); - - if (left < extsPtr->left) - extsPtr->left = left; - } - } - - if (ops->yError && ops->yError->nValues() > 0) { - np = MIN(ops->yError->nValues(), np); - for (int ii=0; iicoords.y->values_[ii] + ops->yError->values_[ii]; - if (y > extsPtr->bottom) - extsPtr->bottom = y; - - y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii] - ops->yError->values_[ii]; - AxisOptions* axisyops = (AxisOptions*)ops->yAxis->ops(); - if (axisyops->logScale) { - // Mirror negative values, instead of ignoring them - if (y < 0.0) - y = -y; - if ((y > DBL_MIN) && (y < extsPtr->left)) - extsPtr->top = y; - } - else if (y < extsPtr->top) - extsPtr->top = y; - } - } - else { - if (ops->yHigh && (ops->yHigh->nValues() > 0) && - (ops->yHigh->max() > extsPtr->bottom)) - extsPtr->bottom = ops->yHigh->max(); - - if (ops->yLow && ops->yLow->nValues() > 0) { - double top; - if ((ops->yLow->min() <= 0.0) && (axisyops->logScale)) - top = FindElemValuesMinimum(ops->yLow, DBL_MIN); - else - top = ops->yLow->min(); - - if (top < extsPtr->top) - extsPtr->top = top; - } - } -} - -void LineElement::closest() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - ClosestSearch* searchPtr = &gops->search; - int mode = searchPtr->mode; - if (mode == SEARCH_AUTO) { - LinePen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - mode = SEARCH_POINTS; - if ((NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops) > 1) && (penOps->traceWidth > 0)) - mode = SEARCH_TRACES; - } - if (mode == SEARCH_POINTS) - closestPoint(searchPtr); - else { - int found = closestTrace(); - if ((!found) && (searchPtr->along != SEARCH_BOTH)) - closestPoint(searchPtr); - } -} - -void LineElement::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (ops->hide) - return; - - // Fill area under the curve - if (ops->fillBg && fillPts_) { - XPoint*points = new XPoint[nFillPts_]; - - unsigned int count =0; - for (Point2d *pp = fillPts_, *endp = pp + nFillPts_; pp < endp; pp++) { - points[count].x = (short)pp->x; - points[count].y = (short)pp->y; - count++; - } - Tk_Fill3DPolygon(graphPtr_->tkwin_, drawable, ops->fillBg, points, - nFillPts_, 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - delete [] points; - } - - // Error bars - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle* stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen *)stylePtr->penPtr; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if ((stylePtr->xeb.length > 0) && (penOps->errorBarShow & SHOW_X)) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, penPtr->errorBarGC_, - stylePtr->xeb.segments, stylePtr->xeb.length); - - if ((stylePtr->yeb.length > 0) && (penOps->errorBarShow & SHOW_Y)) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, penPtr->errorBarGC_, - stylePtr->yeb.segments, stylePtr->yeb.length); - } - - // traces - if ((Chain_GetLength(traces_) > 0) && (penOps->traceWidth > 0)) - drawTraces(drawable, penPtr); - - // Symbols, values - if (ops->reqMaxSymbols > 0) { - int total = 0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - total += stylePtr->symbolPts.length; - } - symbolInterval_ = total / ops->reqMaxSymbols; - symbolCounter_ = 0; - } - - unsigned int count =0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle* stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen *)stylePtr->penPtr; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if ((stylePtr->symbolPts.length > 0) && - (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE)) - drawSymbols(drawable, penPtr, stylePtr->symbolSize, - stylePtr->symbolPts.length, stylePtr->symbolPts.points); - - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, stylePtr->symbolPts.length, - stylePtr->symbolPts.points, symbolPts_.map + count); - - count += stylePtr->symbolPts.length; - } - - symbolInterval_ = 0; - symbolCounter_ = 0; -} - -void LineElement::drawActive(Drawable drawable) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen*)ops->activePenPtr; - if (!penPtr) - return; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (ops->hide || !active_) - return; - - int symbolSize = scaleSymbol(penOps->symbol.size); - - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) { - mapActiveSymbols(); - - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) - drawSymbols(drawable, penPtr, symbolSize, activePts_.length, - activePts_.points); - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, activePts_.length, activePts_.points, - activePts_.map); - } - else if (nActiveIndices_ < 0) { - if ((Chain_GetLength(traces_) > 0) && (penOps->traceWidth > 0)) - drawTraces(drawable, penPtr); - - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) - drawSymbols(drawable, penPtr, symbolSize, symbolPts_.length, - symbolPts_.points); - - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) { - drawValues(drawable, penPtr, symbolPts_.length, symbolPts_.points, - symbolPts_.map); - } - } -} - -void LineElement::drawSymbol(Drawable drawable, int x, int y, int size) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - LinePen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (penOps->traceWidth > 0) { - // Draw an extra line offset by one pixel from the previous to give a - // thicker appearance. This is only for the legend entry. This routine - // is never called for drawing the actual line segments. - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr->traceGC_, x - size, y, - x + size, y); - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr->traceGC_, x - size, y + 1, - x + size, y + 1); - } - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) { - Point2d point; - point.x = x; - point.y = y; - drawSymbols(drawable, penPtr, size, 1, &point); - } -} - -void LineElement::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (ops->hide) - return; - - psPtr->format("\n%% Element \"%s\"\n\n", name_); - - // Draw fill area - if (ops->fillBg && fillPts_) { - psPtr->append("% start fill area\n"); - psPtr->setBackground(ops->fillBg); - psPtr->printPolyline(fillPts_, nFillPts_); - psPtr->append("gsave fill grestore\n"); - psPtr->append("% end fill area\n"); - } - - // traces - if ((Chain_GetLength(traces_) > 0) && (penOps->traceWidth > 0)) - printTraces(psPtr, penPtr); - - // Symbols, error bars, values - if (ops->reqMaxSymbols > 0) { - int total = 0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - total += stylePtr->symbolPts.length; - } - symbolInterval_ = total / ops->reqMaxSymbols; - symbolCounter_ = 0; - } - - unsigned int count =0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen *)stylePtr->penPtr; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - XColor* colorPtr = penOps->errorBarColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = penOps->traceColor; - - if ((stylePtr->xeb.length > 0) && (penOps->errorBarShow & SHOW_X)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(colorPtr, penOps->errorBarLineWidth, - NULL, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->printSegments(stylePtr->xeb.segments, stylePtr->xeb.length); - } - - if ((stylePtr->yeb.length > 0) && (penOps->errorBarShow & SHOW_Y)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(colorPtr, penOps->errorBarLineWidth, - NULL, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->printSegments(stylePtr->yeb.segments, stylePtr->yeb.length); - } - - if ((stylePtr->symbolPts.length > 0) && - (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE)) - printSymbols(psPtr, penPtr, stylePtr->symbolSize, - stylePtr->symbolPts.length, stylePtr->symbolPts.points); - - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, stylePtr->symbolPts.length, - stylePtr->symbolPts.points, symbolPts_.map + count); - - count += stylePtr->symbolPts.length; - } - - symbolInterval_ = 0; - symbolCounter_ = 0; -} - -void LineElement::printActive(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePen* penPtr = (LinePen *)ops->activePenPtr; - if (!penPtr) - return; - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (ops->hide || !active_) - return; - - psPtr->format("\n%% Active Element \"%s\"\n\n", name_); - - int symbolSize = scaleSymbol(penOps->symbol.size); - if (nActiveIndices_ > 0) { - mapActiveSymbols(); - - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) - printSymbols(psPtr, penPtr, symbolSize, activePts_.length, - activePts_.points); - - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, activePts_.length, activePts_.points, - activePts_.map); - } - else if (nActiveIndices_ < 0) { - if ((Chain_GetLength(traces_) > 0) && (penOps->traceWidth > 0)) - printTraces(psPtr, (LinePen*)penPtr); - - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) - printSymbols(psPtr, penPtr, symbolSize, symbolPts_.length, - symbolPts_.points); - if (penOps->valueShow != SHOW_NONE) { - printValues(psPtr, penPtr, symbolPts_.length, symbolPts_.points, - symbolPts_.map); - } - } -} - -void LineElement::printSymbol(PSOutput* psPtr, double x, double y, int size) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - LinePen* penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (penOps->traceWidth > 0) { - // Draw an extra line offset by one pixel from the previous to give a - // thicker appearance. This is only for the legend entry. This routine - // is never called for drawing the actual line segments. - psPtr->setLineAttributes(penOps->traceColor, penOps->traceWidth, - &penOps->traceDashes, CapButt, JoinMiter); - psPtr->format("%g %g %d Li\n", x, y, size + size); - } - - if (penOps->symbol.type != SYMBOL_NONE) { - Point2d point; - point.x = x; - point.y = y; - printSymbols(psPtr, penPtr, size, 1, &point); - } -} - -// Support - -double LineElement::distanceToLine(int x, int y, Point2d *p, Point2d *q, - Point2d *t) -{ - double right, left, top, bottom; - - *t = getProjection(x, y, p, q); - if (p->x > q->x) - right = p->x, left = q->x; - else - left = p->x, right = q->x; - - if (p->y > q->y) - bottom = p->y, top = q->y; - else - top = p->y, bottom = q->y; - - if (t->x > right) - t->x = right; - else if (t->x < left) - t->x = left; - - if (t->y > bottom) - t->y = bottom; - else if (t->y < top) - t->y = top; - - return hypot((t->x - x), (t->y - y)); -} - -double LineElement::distanceToX(int x, int y, Point2d *p, Point2d *q, - Point2d *t) -{ - double dx, dy; - double d; - - if (p->x > q->x) { - if ((x > p->x) || (x < q->x)) { - return DBL_MAX; /* X-coordinate outside line segment. */ - } - } else { - if ((x > q->x) || (x < p->x)) { - return DBL_MAX; /* X-coordinate outside line segment. */ - } - } - dx = p->x - q->x; - dy = p->y - q->y; - t->x = (double)x; - if (fabs(dx) < DBL_EPSILON) { - double d1, d2; - /* - * Same X-coordinate indicates a vertical line. Pick the closest end - * point. - */ - d1 = p->y - y; - d2 = q->y - y; - if (fabs(d1) < fabs(d2)) { - t->y = p->y, d = d1; - } else { - t->y = q->y, d = d2; - } - } - else if (fabs(dy) < DBL_EPSILON) { - /* Horizontal line. */ - t->y = p->y, d = p->y - y; - } - else { - double m = dy / dx; - double b = p->y - (m * p->x); - t->y = (x * m) + b; - d = y - t->y; - } - - return fabs(d); -} - -double LineElement::distanceToY(int x, int y, Point2d *p, Point2d *q, - Point2d *t) -{ - double dx, dy; - double d; - - if (p->y > q->y) { - if ((y > p->y) || (y < q->y)) { - return DBL_MAX; - } - } - else { - if ((y > q->y) || (y < p->y)) { - return DBL_MAX; - } - } - dx = p->x - q->x; - dy = p->y - q->y; - t->y = y; - if (fabs(dy) < DBL_EPSILON) { - double d1, d2; - - /* Save Y-coordinate indicates an horizontal line. Pick the closest end - * point. */ - d1 = p->x - x; - d2 = q->x - x; - if (fabs(d1) < fabs(d2)) { - t->x = p->x, d = d1; - } - else { - t->x = q->x, d = d2; - } - } - else if (fabs(dx) < DBL_EPSILON) { - /* Vertical line. */ - t->x = p->x, d = p->x - x; - } - else { - double m = dy / dx; - double b = p->y - (m * p->x); - t->x = (y - b) / m; - d = x - t->x; - } - - return fabs(d); -} - -int LineElement::scaleSymbol(int normalSize) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - double scale = 1.0; - if (ops->scaleSymbols) { - double xRange = (ops->xAxis->max_ - ops->xAxis->min_); - double yRange = (ops->yAxis->max_ - ops->yAxis->min_); - // Save the ranges as a baseline for future scaling - if (!xRange_ || !yRange_) { - xRange_ = xRange; - yRange_ = yRange; - } - else { - // Scale the symbol by the smallest change in the X or Y axes - double xScale = xRange_ / xRange; - double yScale = yRange_ / yRange; - scale = MIN(xScale, yScale); - } - } - int newSize = (int)(normalSize * scale); - - int maxSize = MIN(graphPtr_->hRange_, graphPtr_->vRange_); - if (newSize > maxSize) - newSize = maxSize; - - // Make the symbol size odd so that its center is a single pixel. - newSize |= 0x01; - - return newSize; -} - -void LineElement::getScreenPoints(MapInfo* mapPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (!ops->coords.x || !ops->coords.y) { - mapPtr->screenPts = NULL; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = 0; - mapPtr->map = NULL; - } - - int np = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - double* x = ops->coords.x->values_; - double* y = ops->coords.y->values_; - Point2d* points = new Point2d[np]; - int* map = new int[np]; - - int count = 0; - if (gops->inverted) { - for (int ii=0; iiyAxis->hMap(y[ii]); - points[count].y = ops->xAxis->vMap(x[ii]); - map[count] = ii; - count++; - } - } - } - else { - for (int ii=0; ii< np; ii++) { - if ((isfinite(x[ii])) && (isfinite(y[ii]))) { - points[count].x = ops->xAxis->hMap(x[ii]); - points[count].y = ops->yAxis->vMap(y[ii]); - map[count] = ii; - count++; - } - } - } - mapPtr->screenPts = points; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = count; - mapPtr->map = map; -} - -void LineElement::reducePoints(MapInfo *mapPtr, double tolerance) -{ - int* simple = new int[mapPtr->nScreenPts]; - int* map = new int[mapPtr->nScreenPts]; - Point2d* screenPts = new Point2d[mapPtr->nScreenPts]; - int np = simplify(mapPtr->screenPts, 0, mapPtr->nScreenPts - 1, - tolerance, simple); - for (int ii=0; iiscreenPts[kk]; - map[ii] = mapPtr->map[kk]; - } - delete [] simple; - - delete [] mapPtr->screenPts; - mapPtr->screenPts = screenPts; - delete [] mapPtr->map; - mapPtr->map = map; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = np; -} - -// Douglas-Peucker line simplification algorithm -int LineElement::simplify(Point2d *inputPts, int low, int high, - double tolerance, int *indices) -{ -#define StackPush(a) s++, stack[s] = (a) -#define StackPop(a) (a) = stack[s], s-- -#define StackEmpty() (s < 0) -#define StackTop() stack[s] - int split = -1; - double dist2, tolerance2; - int s = -1; /* Points to top stack item. */ - - int* stack = new int[high - low + 1]; - StackPush(high); - int count = 0; - indices[count++] = 0; - tolerance2 = tolerance * tolerance; - while (!StackEmpty()) { - dist2 = findSplit(inputPts, low, StackTop(), &split); - if (dist2 > tolerance2) - StackPush(split); - else { - indices[count++] = StackTop(); - StackPop(low); - } - } - delete [] stack; - return count; -} - -double LineElement::findSplit(Point2d *points, int i, int j, int *split) -{ - double maxDist2 = -1.0; - if ((i + 1) < j) { - double a = points[i].y - points[j].y; - double b = points[j].x - points[i].x; - double c = (points[i].x * points[j].y) - (points[i].y * points[j].x); - for (int kk = (i + 1); kk < j; kk++) { - double dist2 = (points[kk].x * a) + (points[kk].y * b) + c; - if (dist2 < 0.0) - dist2 = -dist2; - - // Track the maximum. - if (dist2 > maxDist2) { - maxDist2 = dist2; - *split = kk; - } - } - // Correction for segment length---should be redone if can == 0 - maxDist2 *= maxDist2 / (a * a + b * b); - } - return maxDist2; -} - -void LineElement::generateSteps(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - int newSize = ((mapPtr->nScreenPts - 1) * 2) + 1; - Point2d* screenPts = new Point2d[newSize]; - int* map = new int[newSize]; - screenPts[0] = mapPtr->screenPts[0]; - map[0] = 0; - - int count = 1; - for (int i = 1; i < mapPtr->nScreenPts; i++) { - screenPts[count + 1] = mapPtr->screenPts[i]; - - // Hold last y-coordinate, use new x-coordinate - screenPts[count].x = screenPts[count + 1].x; - screenPts[count].y = screenPts[count - 1].y; - - // Use the same style for both the hold and the step points - map[count] = map[count + 1] = mapPtr->map[i]; - count += 2; - } - delete [] mapPtr->map; - mapPtr->map = map; - delete [] mapPtr->screenPts; - mapPtr->screenPts = screenPts; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = newSize; -} - -void LineElement::generateSpline(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - int nOrigPts = mapPtr->nScreenPts; - Point2d* origPts = mapPtr->screenPts; - - // check points are not monotonically increasing - for (int ii=0, jj=1; jj (double)graphPtr_->right_)) || - ((origPts[mapPtr->nScreenPts - 1].x < (double)graphPtr_->left_))) - return; - - // The spline is computed in screen coordinates instead of data points so - // that we can select the abscissas of the interpolated points from each - // pixel horizontally across the plotting area. - int extra = (graphPtr_->right_ - graphPtr_->left_) + 1; - if (extra < 1) - return; - - int niPts = nOrigPts + extra + 1; - Point2d* iPts = new Point2d[niPts]; - int* map = new int[niPts]; - - // Populate the x2 array with both the original X-coordinates and extra - // X-coordinates for each horizontal pixel that the line segment contains - int count = 0; - for (int ii=0, jj=1; jjmap[ii]; - count++; - - // Is any part of the interval (line segment) in the plotting area? - if ((origPts[jj].x >= (double)graphPtr_->left_) || - (origPts[ii].x <= (double)graphPtr_->right_)) { - double x = origPts[ii].x + 1.0; - - /* - * Since the line segment may be partially clipped on the left or - * right side, the points to interpolate are always interior to - * the plotting area. - * - * left right - * x1----|---------------------------|---x2 - * - * Pick the max of the starting X-coordinate and the left edge and - * the min of the last X-coordinate and the right edge. - */ - x = MAX(x, (double)graphPtr_->left_); - double last = MIN(origPts[jj].x, (double)graphPtr_->right_); - - // Add the extra x-coordinates to the interval - while (x < last) { - map[count] = mapPtr->map[ii]; - iPts[count++].x = x; - x++; - } - } - } - niPts = count; - int result = 0; - if (smooth_ == CUBIC) - result = naturalSpline(origPts, nOrigPts, iPts, niPts); - else if (smooth_ == QUADRATIC) - result = quadraticSpline(origPts, nOrigPts, iPts, niPts); - - // The spline interpolation failed. We will fall back to the current - // coordinates and do no smoothing (standard line segments) - if (!result) { - smooth_ = LINEAR; - delete [] iPts; - delete [] map; - } - else { - delete [] mapPtr->map; - mapPtr->map = map; - delete [] mapPtr->screenPts; - mapPtr->screenPts = iPts; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = niPts; - } -} - -void LineElement::generateParametricSpline(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - int nOrigPts = mapPtr->nScreenPts; - Point2d *origPts = mapPtr->screenPts; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - /* - * Populate the x2 array with both the original X-coordinates and extra - * X-coordinates for each horizontal pixel that the line segment contains. - */ - int count = 1; - for (int i = 0, j = 1; j < nOrigPts; i++, j++) { - Point2d p = origPts[i]; - Point2d q = origPts[j]; - count++; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &p, &q)) - count += (int)(hypot(q.x - p.x, q.y - p.y) * 0.5); - } - int niPts = count; - Point2d *iPts = new Point2d[niPts]; - int* map = new int[niPts]; - - /* - * FIXME: This is just plain wrong. The spline should be computed - * and evaluated in separate steps. This will mean breaking - * up this routine since the catrom coefficients can be - * independently computed for original data point. This - * also handles the problem of allocating enough points - * since evaluation is independent of the number of points - * to be evalualted. The interpolated - * line segments should be clipped, not the original segments. - */ - count = 0; - int i,j; - for (i = 0, j = 1; j < nOrigPts; i++, j++) { - Point2d p = origPts[i]; - Point2d q = origPts[j]; - - double d = hypot(q.x - p.x, q.y - p.y); - /* Add the original x-coordinate */ - iPts[count].x = (double)i; - iPts[count].y = 0.0; - - /* Include the starting offset of the point in the offset array */ - map[count] = mapPtr->map[i]; - count++; - - /* Is any part of the interval (line segment) in the plotting - * area? */ - - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &p, &q)) { - double dp, dq; - - /* Distance of original point to p. */ - dp = hypot(p.x - origPts[i].x, p.y - origPts[i].y); - /* Distance of original point to q. */ - dq = hypot(q.x - origPts[i].x, q.y - origPts[i].y); - dp += 2.0; - while(dp <= dq) { - /* Point is indicated by its interval and parameter t. */ - iPts[count].x = (double)i; - iPts[count].y = dp / d; - map[count] = mapPtr->map[i]; - count++; - dp += 2.0; - } - } - } - iPts[count].x = (double)i; - iPts[count].y = 0.0; - map[count] = mapPtr->map[i]; - count++; - niPts = count; - int result = 0; - if (smooth_ == CUBIC) - result = naturalParametricSpline(origPts, nOrigPts, &exts, 0, iPts, niPts); - else if (smooth_ == CATROM) - result = catromParametricSpline(origPts, nOrigPts, iPts, niPts); - - // The spline interpolation failed. We will fall back to the current - // coordinates and do no smoothing (standard line segments) - if (!result) { - smooth_ = LINEAR; - delete [] iPts; - delete [] map; - } - else { - delete [] mapPtr->map; - mapPtr->map = map; - delete [] mapPtr->screenPts; - mapPtr->screenPts = iPts; - mapPtr->nScreenPts = niPts; - } -} - -void LineElement::mapSymbols(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - Point2d* points = new Point2d[mapPtr->nScreenPts]; - int *map = new int[mapPtr->nScreenPts]; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - Point2d *pp; - int count = 0; - int i; - for (pp=mapPtr->screenPts, i=0; inScreenPts; i++, pp++) { - if (PointInRegion(&exts, pp->x, pp->y)) { - points[count].x = pp->x; - points[count].y = pp->y; - map[count] = mapPtr->map[i]; - count++; - } - } - symbolPts_.points = points; - symbolPts_.length = count; - symbolPts_.map = map; -} - -void LineElement::mapActiveSymbols() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - delete [] activePts_.points; - activePts_.points = NULL; - delete [] activePts_.map; - activePts_.map = NULL; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - Point2d *points = new Point2d[nActiveIndices_]; - int* map = new int[nActiveIndices_]; - int np = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - int count = 0; - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - for (int ii=0; ii= np) - continue; - - double x = ops->coords.x->values_[iPoint]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[iPoint]; - points[count] = graphPtr_->map2D(x, y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - map[count] = iPoint; - if (PointInRegion(&exts, points[count].x, points[count].y)) { - count++; - } - } - } - - if (count > 0) { - activePts_.points = points; - activePts_.map = map; - } - else { - delete [] points; - delete [] map; - } - activePts_.length = count; -} - -void LineElement::mergePens(LineStyle **styleMap) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - if (Chain_GetLength(ops->stylePalette) < 2) { - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->symbolPts.length = symbolPts_.length; - stylePtr->symbolPts.points = symbolPts_.points; - stylePtr->xeb.length = xeb_.length; - stylePtr->xeb.segments = xeb_.segments; - stylePtr->yeb.length = yeb_.length; - stylePtr->yeb.segments = yeb_.segments; - return; - } - - if (symbolPts_.length > 0) { - Point2d* points = new Point2d[symbolPts_.length]; - int* map = new int[symbolPts_.length]; - Point2d *pp = points; - int* ip = map; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->symbolPts.points = pp; - for (int ii=0; iisymbolPts.length = pp - stylePtr->symbolPts.points; - } - delete [] symbolPts_.points; - symbolPts_.points = points; - delete [] symbolPts_.map; - symbolPts_.map = map; - } - - if (xeb_.length > 0) { - Segment2d* segments = new Segment2d[xeb_.length]; - Segment2d *sp = segments; - int* map = new int[xeb_.length]; - int* ip = map; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->xeb.segments = sp; - for (int ii=0; iixeb.length = sp - stylePtr->xeb.segments; - } - delete [] xeb_.segments; - xeb_.segments = segments; - delete [] xeb_.map; - xeb_.map = map; - } - - if (yeb_.length > 0) { - Segment2d* segments = new Segment2d[yeb_.length]; - Segment2d* sp = segments; - int* map = new int [yeb_.length]; - int* ip = map; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->yeb.segments = sp; - for (int ii=0; iiyeb.length = sp - stylePtr->yeb.segments; - } - delete [] yeb_.segments; - yeb_.segments = segments; - delete [] yeb_.map; - yeb_.map = map; - } -} - -#define CLIP_TOP (1<<0) -#define CLIP_BOTTOM (1<<1) -#define CLIP_RIGHT (1<<2) -#define CLIP_LEFT (1<<3) - -int LineElement::outCode(Region2d *extsPtr, Point2d *p) -{ - int code =0; - if (p->x > extsPtr->right) - code |= CLIP_RIGHT; - else if (p->x < extsPtr->left) - code |= CLIP_LEFT; - - if (p->y > extsPtr->bottom) - code |= CLIP_BOTTOM; - else if (p->y < extsPtr->top) - code |= CLIP_TOP; - - return code; -} - -int LineElement::clipSegment(Region2d *extsPtr, int code1, int code2, - Point2d *p, Point2d *q) -{ - int inside = ((code1 | code2) == 0); - int outside = ((code1 & code2) != 0); - - /* - * In the worst case, we'll clip the line segment against each of the four - * sides of the bounding rectangle. - */ - while ((!outside) && (!inside)) { - if (code1 == 0) { - Point2d *tmp; - int code; - - /* Swap pointers and out codes */ - tmp = p, p = q, q = tmp; - code = code1, code1 = code2, code2 = code; - } - if (code1 & CLIP_LEFT) { - p->y += (q->y - p->y) * - (extsPtr->left - p->x) / (q->x - p->x); - p->x = extsPtr->left; - } else if (code1 & CLIP_RIGHT) { - p->y += (q->y - p->y) * - (extsPtr->right - p->x) / (q->x - p->x); - p->x = extsPtr->right; - } else if (code1 & CLIP_BOTTOM) { - p->x += (q->x - p->x) * - (extsPtr->bottom - p->y) / (q->y - p->y); - p->y = extsPtr->bottom; - } else if (code1 & CLIP_TOP) { - p->x += (q->x - p->x) * - (extsPtr->top - p->y) / (q->y - p->y); - p->y = extsPtr->top; - } - code1 = outCode(extsPtr, p); - - inside = ((code1 | code2) == 0); - outside = ((code1 & code2) != 0); - } - return (!inside); -} - -void LineElement::saveTrace(int start, int length, MapInfo* mapPtr) -{ - bltTrace* tracePtr = new bltTrace; - Point2d* screenPts = new Point2d[length]; - int* map = new int[length]; - - // Copy the screen coordinates of the trace into the point array - if (mapPtr->map) { - for (int ii=0, jj=start; iiscreenPts[jj].x; - screenPts[ii].y = mapPtr->screenPts[jj].y; - map[ii] = mapPtr->map[jj]; - } - } - else { - for (int ii=0, jj=start; iiscreenPts[jj].x; - screenPts[ii].y = mapPtr->screenPts[jj].y; - map[ii] = jj; - } - } - tracePtr->screenPts.length = length; - tracePtr->screenPts.points = screenPts; - tracePtr->screenPts.map = map; - tracePtr->start = start; - if (traces_ == NULL) - traces_ = new Chain(); - - traces_->append(tracePtr); -} - -void LineElement::freeTraces() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(traces_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - bltTrace* tracePtr = (bltTrace*)Chain_GetValue(link); - delete [] tracePtr->screenPts.map; - delete [] tracePtr->screenPts.points; - delete tracePtr; - } - delete traces_; - traces_ = NULL; -} - -void LineElement::mapTraces(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - int count = 1; - int code1 = outCode(&exts, mapPtr->screenPts); - Point2d* p = mapPtr->screenPts; - Point2d* q = p + 1; - - int start; - int ii; - for (ii=1; iinScreenPts; ii++, p++, q++) { - Point2d s; - s.x = 0; - s.y = 0; - int code2 = outCode(&exts, q); - // Save the coordinates of the last point, before clipping - if (code2 != 0) - s = *q; - - int broken = BROKEN_TRACE(ops->penDir, p->x, q->x); - int offscreen = clipSegment(&exts, code1, code2, p, q); - if (broken || offscreen) { - // The last line segment is either totally clipped by the plotting - // area or the x-direction is wrong, breaking the trace. Either - // way, save information about the last trace (if one exists), - // discarding the current line segment - if (count > 1) { - start = ii - count; - saveTrace(start, count, mapPtr); - count = 1; - } - } - else { - // Add the point to the trace - count++; - - // If the last point is clipped, this means that the trace is - // broken after this point. Restore the original coordinate - // (before clipping) after saving the trace. - if (code2 != 0) { - start = ii - (count - 1); - saveTrace(start, count, mapPtr); - mapPtr->screenPts[ii] = s; - count = 1; - } - } - code1 = code2; - } - if (count > 1) { - start = ii - count; - saveTrace(start, count, mapPtr); - } -} - -void LineElement::mapFillArea(MapInfo *mapPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if (fillPts_) { - delete [] fillPts_; - fillPts_ = NULL; - nFillPts_ = 0; - } - if (mapPtr->nScreenPts < 3) - return; - - int np = mapPtr->nScreenPts + 3; - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - Point2d* origPts = new Point2d[np]; - if (gops->inverted) { - int i; - double minX = (double)ops->yAxis->screenMin_; - for (i = 0; i < mapPtr->nScreenPts; i++) { - origPts[i].x = mapPtr->screenPts[i].x + 1; - origPts[i].y = mapPtr->screenPts[i].y; - if (origPts[i].x < minX) { - minX = origPts[i].x; - } - } - // Add edges to make the polygon fill to the bottom of plotting window - origPts[i].x = minX; - origPts[i].y = origPts[i - 1].y; - i++; - origPts[i].x = minX; - origPts[i].y = origPts[0].y; - i++; - origPts[i] = origPts[0]; - } - else { - int i; - double maxY = (double)ops->yAxis->bottom_; - for (i = 0; i < mapPtr->nScreenPts; i++) { - origPts[i].x = mapPtr->screenPts[i].x + 1; - origPts[i].y = mapPtr->screenPts[i].y; - if (origPts[i].y > maxY) { - maxY = origPts[i].y; - } - } - // Add edges to extend the fill polygon to the bottom of plotting window - origPts[i].x = origPts[i - 1].x; - origPts[i].y = maxY; - i++; - origPts[i].x = origPts[0].x; - origPts[i].y = maxY; - i++; - origPts[i] = origPts[0]; - } - - Point2d *clipPts = new Point2d[np * 3]; - np = polyRectClip(&exts, origPts, np - 1, clipPts); - - delete [] origPts; - if (np < 3) - delete [] clipPts; - else { - fillPts_ = clipPts; - nFillPts_ = np; - } -} - -void LineElement::reset() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - freeTraces(); - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - LineStyle *stylePtr = (LineStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->symbolPts.length = 0; - stylePtr->xeb.length = 0; - stylePtr->yeb.length = 0; - } - - delete [] symbolPts_.points; - symbolPts_.points = NULL; - - delete [] symbolPts_.map; - symbolPts_.map = NULL; - symbolPts_.length = 0; - - delete [] activePts_.points; - activePts_.points = NULL; - activePts_.length = 0; - - delete [] activePts_.map; - activePts_.map = NULL; - - delete [] xeb_.segments; - xeb_.segments = NULL; - delete [] xeb_.map; - xeb_.map = NULL; - xeb_.length = 0; - - delete [] yeb_.segments; - yeb_.segments = NULL; - delete [] yeb_.map; - yeb_.map = NULL; - yeb_.length = 0; -} - -void LineElement::mapErrorBars(LineStyle **styleMap) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr_->extents(&exts); - - int nn =0; - int np = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - if (ops->xError && (ops->xError->nValues() > 0)) - nn = MIN(ops->xError->nValues(), np); - else - if (ops->xHigh && ops->xLow) - nn = MIN3(ops->xHigh->nValues(), ops->xLow->nValues(), np); - } - - if (nn) { - Segment2d* errorBars = new Segment2d[nn * 3]; - Segment2d* segPtr = errorBars; - int* errorToData = new int[nn * 3]; - int* indexPtr = errorToData; - - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii]; - LineStyle* stylePtr = styleMap[ii]; - - if ((isfinite(x)) && (isfinite(y))) { - double high; - double low; - if (ops->xError && ops->xError->nValues() > 0) { - high = x + ops->xError->values_[ii]; - low = x - ops->xError->values_[ii]; - } - else { - high = ops->xHigh ? ops->xHigh->values_[ii] : 0; - low = ops->xLow ? ops->xLow->values_[ii] : 0; - } - - if ((isfinite(high)) && (isfinite(low))) { - Point2d p = graphPtr_->map2D(high, y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - Point2d q = graphPtr_->map2D(low, y, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - segPtr->p = p; - segPtr->q = q; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Left cap - segPtr->p.x = p.x; - segPtr->q.x = p.x; - segPtr->p.y = p.y - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.y = p.y + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Right cap - segPtr->p.x = q.x; - segPtr->q.x = q.x; - segPtr->p.y = q.y - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.y = q.y + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - } - } - } - xeb_.segments = errorBars; - xeb_.length = segPtr - errorBars; - xeb_.map = errorToData; - } - - nn =0; - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - if (ops->yError && (ops->yError->nValues() > 0)) - nn = MIN(ops->yError->nValues(), np); - else - if (ops->yHigh && ops->yLow) - nn = MIN3(ops->yHigh->nValues(), ops->yLow->nValues(), np); - } - - if (nn) { - Segment2d* errorBars = new Segment2d[nn * 3]; - Segment2d* segPtr = errorBars; - int* errorToData = new int[nn * 3]; - int* indexPtr = errorToData; - - for (int ii=0; iicoords.x->values_[ii]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[ii]; - LineStyle* stylePtr = styleMap[ii]; - - if ((isfinite(x)) && (isfinite(y))) { - double high; - double low; - if (ops->yError && ops->yError->nValues() > 0) { - high = y + ops->yError->values_[ii]; - low = y - ops->yError->values_[ii]; - } - else { - high = ops->yHigh->values_[ii]; - low = ops->yLow->values_[ii]; - } - - if ((isfinite(high)) && (isfinite(low))) { - Point2d p = graphPtr_->map2D(x, high, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - Point2d q = graphPtr_->map2D(x, low, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - segPtr->p = p; - segPtr->q = q; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Top cap - segPtr->p.y = p.y; - segPtr->q.y = p.y; - segPtr->p.x = p.x - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.x = p.x + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - // Bottom cap - segPtr->p.y = q.y; - segPtr->q.y = q.y; - segPtr->p.x = q.x - stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - segPtr->q.x = q.x + stylePtr->errorBarCapWidth; - if (lineRectClip(&exts, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - *indexPtr++ = ii; - } - } - } - } - yeb_.segments = errorBars; - yeb_.length = segPtr - errorBars; - yeb_.map = errorToData; - } -} - -int LineElement::closestTrace() -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - ClosestSearch* searchPtr = &gops->search; - - Point2d closest; - - int iClose = -1; - double dMin = searchPtr->dist; - closest.x = closest.y = 0; - for (ChainLink *link=Chain_FirstLink(traces_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - bltTrace *tracePtr = (bltTrace*)Chain_GetValue(link); - for (Point2d *p=tracePtr->screenPts.points, - *pend=p + (tracePtr->screenPts.length - 1); palong == SEARCH_X) - d = distanceToX(searchPtr->x, searchPtr->y, p, p + 1, &b); - else if (searchPtr->along == SEARCH_Y) - d = distanceToY(searchPtr->x, searchPtr->y, p, p + 1, &b); - else - d = distanceToLine(searchPtr->x, searchPtr->y, p, p + 1, &b); - - if (d < dMin) { - closest = b; - iClose = tracePtr->screenPts.map[p-tracePtr->screenPts.points]; - dMin = d; - } - } - } - if (dMin < searchPtr->dist) { - searchPtr->dist = dMin; - searchPtr->elemPtr = (Element*)this; - searchPtr->index = iClose; - searchPtr->point = graphPtr_->invMap2D(closest.x, closest.y, - ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - return 1; - } - - return 0; -} - -void LineElement::closestPoint(ClosestSearch *searchPtr) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - - double dMin = searchPtr->dist; - int iClose = 0; - - // Instead of testing each data point in graph coordinates, look at the - // array of mapped screen coordinates. The advantages are - // 1) only examine points that are visible (unclipped), and - // 2) the computed distance is already in screen coordinates. - int count =0; - for (Point2d *pp = symbolPts_.points; count < symbolPts_.length; - count++, pp++) { - double dx = (double)abs(searchPtr->x - pp->x); - double dy = (double)abs(searchPtr->y - pp->y); - double d; - if (searchPtr->along == SEARCH_BOTH) - d = hypot(dx, dy); - else if (searchPtr->along == SEARCH_X) - d = dx; - else if (searchPtr->along == SEARCH_Y) - d = dy; - else - continue; - - if (d < dMin) { - iClose = symbolPts_.map[count]; - dMin = d; - } - } - if (dMin < searchPtr->dist) { - searchPtr->elemPtr = (Element*)this; - searchPtr->dist = dMin; - searchPtr->index = iClose; - searchPtr->point.x = ops->coords.x->values_[iClose]; - searchPtr->point.y = ops->coords.y->values_[iClose]; - } -} - -void LineElement::drawCircle(Display *display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, int radius) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - int count = 0; - int s = radius + radius; - XArc* arcs = new XArc[nSymbolPts]; - XArc *ap = arcs; - for (Point2d *pp=symbolPts, *pend=pp+nSymbolPts; ppx = (short)(pp->x - radius); - ap->y = (short)(pp->y - radius); - ap->width = (short)s; - ap->height = (short)s; - ap->angle1 = 0; - ap->angle2 = 23040; - ap++; - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } - - for (XArc *ap=arcs, *aend=ap+count; apsymbol.fillGC) - XFillArc(display, drawable, penOps->symbol.fillGC, - ap->x, ap->y, ap->width, ap->height, ap->angle1, ap->angle2); - - if (penOps->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) - XDrawArc(display, drawable, penOps->symbol.outlineGC, - ap->x, ap->y, ap->width, ap->height, ap->angle1, ap->angle2); - } - - delete [] arcs; -} - -void LineElement::drawSquare(Display *display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, int r) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - int s = r + r; - int count =0; - Rectangle* rectangles = new Rectangle[nSymbolPts]; - Rectangle* rp=rectangles; - for (Point2d *pp=symbolPts, *pend=pp+nSymbolPts; ppx = (int)pp->x - r; - rp->y = (int)pp->y - r; - rp->width = s; - rp->height = s; - rp++; - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } - - for (Rectangle *rp=rectangles, *rend=rp+count; rpsymbol.fillGC) - XFillRectangle(display, drawable, penOps->symbol.fillGC, - rp->x, rp->y, rp->width, rp->height); - - if (penOps->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) - XDrawRectangle(display, drawable, penOps->symbol.outlineGC, - rp->x, rp->y, rp->width, rp->height); - } - - delete [] rectangles; -} - -void LineElement::drawSCross(Display* display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d* symbolPts, int r2) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - Point pattern[4]; - if (penOps->symbol.type == SYMBOL_SCROSS) { - r2 = (int)(r2 * M_SQRT1_2); - pattern[3].y = pattern[2].x = pattern[0].x = pattern[0].y = -r2; - pattern[3].x = pattern[2].y = pattern[1].y = pattern[1].x = r2; - } - else { - pattern[0].y = pattern[1].y = pattern[2].x = pattern[3].x = 0; - pattern[0].x = pattern[2].y = -r2; - pattern[1].x = pattern[3].y = r2; - } - - for (Point2d *pp=symbolPts, *endp=pp+nSymbolPts; ppx; - int rndy = (int)pp->y; - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penOps->symbol.outlineGC, - pattern[0].x + rndx, pattern[0].y + rndy, - pattern[1].x + rndx, pattern[1].y + rndy); - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penOps->symbol.outlineGC, - pattern[2].x + rndx, pattern[2].y + rndy, - pattern[3].x + rndx, pattern[3].y + rndy); - } - } -} - -void LineElement::drawCross(Display *display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, int r2) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - /* - * 2 3 The plus/cross symbol is a closed polygon - * of 12 points. The diagram to the left - * 0,12 1 4 5 represents the positions of the points - * x,y which are computed below. The extra - * 11 10 7 6 (thirteenth) point connects the first and - * last points. - * 9 8 - */ - int d = (r2 / 3); - Point pattern[13]; - pattern[0].x = pattern[11].x = pattern[12].x = -r2; - pattern[2].x = pattern[1].x = pattern[10].x = pattern[9].x = -d; - pattern[3].x = pattern[4].x = pattern[7].x = pattern[8].x = d; - pattern[5].x = pattern[6].x = r2; - pattern[2].y = pattern[3].y = -r2; - pattern[0].y = pattern[1].y = pattern[4].y = pattern[5].y = - pattern[12].y = -d; - pattern[11].y = pattern[10].y = pattern[7].y = pattern[6].y = d; - pattern[9].y = pattern[8].y = r2; - - if (penOps->symbol.type == SYMBOL_CROSS) { - // For the cross symbol, rotate the points by 45 degrees - for (int ii=0; ii<12; ii++) { - double dx = (double)pattern[ii].x * M_SQRT1_2; - double dy = (double)pattern[ii].y * M_SQRT1_2; - pattern[ii].x = (int)(dx - dy); - pattern[ii].y = (int)(dx + dy); - } - pattern[12] = pattern[0]; - } - - int count = 0; - XPoint* polygon = new XPoint[nSymbolPts*13]; - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (Point2d *pp = symbolPts, *endp = pp + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) { - if (DRAW_SYMBOL()) { - int rndx = (int)pp->x; - int rndy = (int)pp->y; - for (int ii=0; ii<13; ii++) { - xpp->x = (short)(pattern[ii].x + rndx); - xpp->y = (short)(pattern[ii].y + rndy); - xpp++; - } - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } - - if (penOps->symbol.fillGC) { - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.fillGC, xpp, 13, Complex, - CoordModeOrigin); - } - - if (penOps->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) { - XPoint*xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.outlineGC, xpp, 13, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - delete [] polygon; -} - -void LineElement::drawDiamond(Display *display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, int r1) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - /* - * The plus symbol is a closed polygon - * 1 of 4 points. The diagram to the left - * represents the positions of the points - * 0,4 x,y 2 which are computed below. The extra - * (fifth) point connects the first and - * 3 last points. - */ - Point pattern[5]; - pattern[1].y = pattern[0].x = -r1; - pattern[2].y = pattern[3].x = pattern[0].y = pattern[1].x = 0; - pattern[3].y = pattern[2].x = r1; - pattern[4] = pattern[0]; - - int count = 0; - XPoint* polygon = new XPoint[nSymbolPts*5]; - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (Point2d *pp = symbolPts, *endp = pp + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) { - if (DRAW_SYMBOL()) { - int rndx = (int)pp->x; - int rndy = (int)pp->y; - for (int ii=0; ii<5; ii++) { - xpp->x = (short)(pattern[ii].x + rndx); - xpp->y = (short)(pattern[ii].y + rndy); - xpp++; - } - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } - - if (penOps->symbol.fillGC) { - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.fillGC, xpp, 5, Convex, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - if (penOps->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) { - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.outlineGC, xpp, 5, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - delete [] polygon; -} - -#define B_RATIO 1.3467736870885982 -#define TAN30 0.57735026918962573 -#define COS30 0.86602540378443871 -void LineElement::drawArrow(Display *display, Drawable drawable, - LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, int size) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - double b = size * B_RATIO * 0.7 * 0.5; - short b2 = (short)b; - short h2 = (short)(TAN30 * b); - short h1 = (short)(b / COS30); - /* - * The triangle symbol is a closed polygon - * 0,3 of 3 points. The diagram to the left - * represents the positions of the points - * x,y which are computed below. The extra - * (fourth) point connects the first and - * 2 1 last points. - */ - - Point pattern[4]; - if (penOps->symbol.type == SYMBOL_ARROW) { - pattern[3].x = pattern[0].x = 0; - pattern[3].y = pattern[0].y = h1; - pattern[1].x = b2; - pattern[2].y = pattern[1].y = -h2; - pattern[2].x = -b2; - } else { - pattern[3].x = pattern[0].x = 0; - pattern[3].y = pattern[0].y = -h1; - pattern[1].x = b2; - pattern[2].y = pattern[1].y = h2; - pattern[2].x = -b2; - } - - int count = 0; - XPoint* polygon = new XPoint[nSymbolPts*4]; - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (Point2d *pp = symbolPts, *endp = pp + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) { - if (DRAW_SYMBOL()) { - int rndx = (int)pp->x; - int rndy = (int)pp->y; - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - xpp->x = (short)(pattern[ii].x + rndx); - xpp->y = (short)(pattern[ii].y + rndy); - xpp++; - } - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } - - if (penOps->symbol.fillGC) { - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.fillGC, xpp, 4, Convex, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - if (penOps->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) { - XPoint* xpp = polygon; - for (int ii=0; iidisplay_, drawable, - penOps->symbol.outlineGC, xpp, 4, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - delete [] polygon; -} - -#define S_RATIO 0.886226925452758 -void LineElement::drawSymbols(Drawable drawable, LinePen* penPtr, int size, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d* symbolPts) -{ - LinePenOptions* penOps = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - if (size < 3) { - if (penOps->symbol.fillGC) { - for (Point2d *pp = symbolPts, *endp = pp + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penOps->symbol.fillGC, - (int)pp->x, (int)pp->y, (int)pp->x+1, (int)pp->y+1); - } - return; - } - - int r1 = (int)ceil(size * 0.5); - int r2 = (int)ceil(size * S_RATIO * 0.5); - - switch (penOps->symbol.type) { - case SYMBOL_NONE: - break; - case SYMBOL_SQUARE: - drawSquare(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,r2); - break; - case SYMBOL_CIRCLE: - drawCircle(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,r1); - break; - case SYMBOL_SPLUS: - case SYMBOL_SCROSS: - drawSCross(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,r2); - break; - case SYMBOL_PLUS: - case SYMBOL_CROSS: - drawCross(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,r2); - break; - case SYMBOL_DIAMOND: - drawDiamond(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,r1); - break; - case SYMBOL_TRIANGLE: - case SYMBOL_ARROW: - drawArrow(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr, nSymbolPts,symbolPts,size); - break; - } -} - -void LineElement::drawTraces(Drawable drawable, LinePen* penPtr) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(traces_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - bltTrace* tracePtr = (bltTrace*)Chain_GetValue(link); - - int count = tracePtr->screenPts.length; - XPoint* points = new XPoint[count]; - XPoint*xpp = points; - for (int ii=0; iix = (short)tracePtr->screenPts.points[ii].x; - xpp->y = (short)tracePtr->screenPts.points[ii].y; - } - XDrawLines(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, penPtr->traceGC_, points, - count, CoordModeOrigin); - delete [] points; - } -} - -void LineElement::drawValues(Drawable drawable, LinePen* penPtr, - int length, Point2d *points, int *map) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePenOptions* pops = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - char string[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE * 2 + 2]; - const char* fmt = pops->valueFormat; - if (fmt == NULL) - fmt = "%g"; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &pops->valueStyle); - - double* xval = ops->coords.x->values_; - double* yval = ops->coords.y->values_; - int count = 0; - - for (Point2d *pp = points, *endp = points + length; pp < endp; pp++) { - double x = xval[map[count]]; - double y = yval[map[count]]; - count++; - if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_X) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_Y) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_BOTH) { - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - strcat(string, ","); - snprintf(string + strlen(string), TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - } - - ts.drawText(drawable, string, pp->x, pp->y); - } -} - -void LineElement::printSymbols(PSOutput* psPtr, LinePen* penPtr, int size, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts) -{ - LinePenOptions* pops = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - double symbolSize; - - // Set line and foreground attributes - XColor* fillColor = pops->symbol.fillColor; - if (!fillColor) - fillColor = pops->traceColor; - - XColor* outlineColor = pops->symbol.outlineColor; - if (!outlineColor) - outlineColor = pops->traceColor; - - if (pops->symbol.type == SYMBOL_NONE) - psPtr->setLineAttributes(pops->traceColor, pops->traceWidth + 2, - &pops->traceDashes, CapButt, JoinMiter); - else { - psPtr->setLineWidth(pops->symbol.outlineWidth); - psPtr->setDashes(NULL); - } - - // build DrawSymbolProc - psPtr->append("\n/DrawSymbolProc {\n"); - switch (pops->symbol.type) { - case SYMBOL_NONE: - break; - default: - psPtr->append(" "); - psPtr->setBackground(fillColor); - psPtr->append(" gsave fill grestore\n"); - - if (pops->symbol.outlineWidth > 0) { - psPtr->append(" "); - psPtr->setForeground(outlineColor); - psPtr->append(" stroke\n"); - } - break; - } - psPtr->append("} def\n\n"); - - // set size - symbolSize = (double)size; - switch (pops->symbol.type) { - case SYMBOL_SQUARE: - case SYMBOL_CROSS: - case SYMBOL_PLUS: - case SYMBOL_SCROSS: - case SYMBOL_SPLUS: - symbolSize = (double)size * S_RATIO; - break; - case SYMBOL_TRIANGLE: - case SYMBOL_ARROW: - symbolSize = (double)size * 0.7; - break; - case SYMBOL_DIAMOND: - symbolSize = (double)size * M_SQRT1_2; - break; - - default: - break; - } - - int count =0; - for (Point2d *pp=symbolPts, *endp=symbolPts + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) { - if (DRAW_SYMBOL()) { - psPtr->format("%g %g %g %s\n", pp->x, pp->y, symbolSize, - symbolMacros[pops->symbol.type]); - count++; - } - symbolCounter_++; - } -} - -void LineElement::setLineAttributes(PSOutput* psPtr, LinePen* penPtr) -{ - LinePenOptions* pops = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - psPtr->setLineAttributes(pops->traceColor, pops->traceWidth, - &pops->traceDashes, CapButt, JoinMiter); - - if ((LineIsDashed(pops->traceDashes)) && - (pops->traceOffColor)) { - psPtr->append("/DashesProc {\n gsave\n "); - psPtr->setBackground(pops->traceOffColor); - psPtr->append(" "); - psPtr->setDashes(NULL); - psPtr->append("stroke\n grestore\n} def\n"); - } else { - psPtr->append("/DashesProc {} def\n"); - } -} - -void LineElement::printTraces(PSOutput* psPtr, LinePen* penPtr) -{ - setLineAttributes(psPtr, penPtr); - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(traces_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - bltTrace *tracePtr = (bltTrace*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (tracePtr->screenPts.length > 0) { - psPtr->append("% start trace\n"); - psPtr->printMaxPolyline(tracePtr->screenPts.points, - tracePtr->screenPts.length); - psPtr->append("% end trace\n"); - } - } -} - -void LineElement::printValues(PSOutput* psPtr, LinePen* penPtr, - int nSymbolPts, Point2d *symbolPts, - int *pointToData) -{ - LineElementOptions* ops = (LineElementOptions*)ops_; - LinePenOptions* pops = (LinePenOptions*)penPtr->ops(); - - const char* fmt = pops->valueFormat; - if (fmt == NULL) - fmt = "%g"; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &pops->valueStyle); - - int count = 0; - for (Point2d *pp=symbolPts, *endp=symbolPts + nSymbolPts; pp < endp; pp++) { - double x = ops->coords.x->values_[pointToData[count]]; - double y = ops->coords.y->values_[pointToData[count]]; - count++; - - char string[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE * 2 + 2]; - if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_X) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_Y) - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - else if (pops->valueShow == SHOW_BOTH) { - snprintf(string, TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, x); - strcat(string, ","); - snprintf(string + strlen(string), TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE, fmt, y); - } - - ts.printText(psPtr, string, pp->x, pp->y); - } -} - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.h deleted file mode 100644 index f937615..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLine.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,184 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrElemLine_h__ -#define __BltGrElemLine_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - Point2d *screenPts; - int nScreenPts; - int *styleMap; - int *map; - } MapInfo; - - typedef struct { - Point2d *points; - int length; - int *map; - } GraphPoints; - - typedef struct { - int start; - GraphPoints screenPts; - } bltTrace; - - typedef struct { - Weight weight; - LinePen* penPtr; - GraphPoints symbolPts; - GraphSegments xeb; - GraphSegments yeb; - int symbolSize; - int errorBarCapWidth; - } LineStyle; - - typedef struct { - Element* elemPtr; - const char* label; - char** tags; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - ElemCoords coords; - ElemValues* w; - ElemValues* xError; - ElemValues* yError; - ElemValues* xHigh; - ElemValues* xLow; - ElemValues* yHigh; - ElemValues* yLow; - int hide; - int legendRelief; - Chain* stylePalette; - LinePen *builtinPenPtr; - LinePen *activePenPtr; - LinePen *normalPenPtr; - LinePenOptions builtinPen; - - // derived - Tk_3DBorder fillBg; - int reqMaxSymbols; - double rTolerance; - int scaleSymbols; - int reqSmooth; - int penDir; - } LineElementOptions; - - class LineElement : public Element { - public: - enum PenDirection {INCREASING, DECREASING, BOTH_DIRECTIONS}; - enum Smoothing {LINEAR, STEP, CUBIC, QUADRATIC, CATROM}; - - protected: - LinePen* builtinPenPtr; - Smoothing smooth_; - Point2d *fillPts_; - int nFillPts_; - GraphPoints symbolPts_; - GraphPoints activePts_; - GraphSegments xeb_; - GraphSegments yeb_; - int symbolInterval_; - int symbolCounter_; - Chain* traces_; - - void drawCircle(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - void drawSquare(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - void drawSCross(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - void drawCross(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - void drawDiamond(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - void drawArrow(Display*, Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int); - - protected: - int scaleSymbol(int); - void getScreenPoints(MapInfo*); - void reducePoints(MapInfo*, double); - void generateSteps(MapInfo*); - void generateSpline(MapInfo*); - void generateParametricSpline(MapInfo*); - void mapSymbols(MapInfo*); - void mapActiveSymbols(); - void mergePens(LineStyle**); - int outCode(Region2d*, Point2d*); - int clipSegment(Region2d*, int, int, Point2d*, Point2d*); - void saveTrace(int, int, MapInfo*); - void freeTraces(); - void mapTraces(MapInfo*); - void mapFillArea(MapInfo*); - void mapErrorBars(LineStyle**); - void reset(); - int closestTrace(); - void closestPoint(ClosestSearch*); - void drawSymbols(Drawable, LinePen*, int, int, Point2d*); - void drawTraces(Drawable, LinePen*); - void drawValues(Drawable, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int*); - void setLineAttributes(PSOutput*, LinePen*); - void printTraces(PSOutput*, LinePen*); - void printValues(PSOutput*, LinePen*, int, Point2d*, int*); - void printSymbols(PSOutput*, LinePen*, int, int, Point2d*); - double distanceToLine(int, int, Point2d*, Point2d*, Point2d*); - double distanceToX(int, int, Point2d*, Point2d*, Point2d*); - double distanceToY(int, int, Point2d*, Point2d*, Point2d*); - int simplify(Point2d*, int, int, double, int*); - double findSplit(Point2d*, int, int, int*); - - int naturalSpline(Point2d*, int, Point2d*, int); - int quadraticSpline(Point2d*, int, Point2d*, int); - int naturalParametricSpline(Point2d*, int, Region2d*, int, Point2d*, int); - int catromParametricSpline(Point2d*, int, Point2d*, int); - - public: - LineElement(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~LineElement(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_ELEM_LINE;} - const char* className() {return "LineElement";} - const char* typeName() {return "line";} - - int configure(); - void map(); - void extents(Region2d*); - void closest(); - void draw(Drawable); - void drawActive(Drawable); - void drawSymbol(Drawable, int, int, int); - void print(PSOutput*); - void printActive(PSOutput*); - void printSymbol(PSOutput*, double, double, int); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C deleted file mode 100644 index 9224d53..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemLineSpline.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1086 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 2009 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - * - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -typedef double TriDiagonalMatrix[3]; -typedef struct { - double b, c, d; -} Cubic2D; - -typedef struct { - double b, c, d, e, f; -} Quint2D; - -// Quadratic spline parameters -#define E1 param[0] -#define E2 param[1] -#define V1 param[2] -#define V2 param[3] -#define W1 param[4] -#define W2 param[5] -#define Z1 param[6] -#define Z2 param[7] -#define Y1 param[8] -#define Y2 param[9] - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * Search -- - * - * Conducts a binary search for a value. This routine is called - * only if key is between x(0) and x(len - 1). - * - * Results: - * Returns the index of the largest value in xtab for which - * x[i] < key. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static int Search(Point2d points[], int nPoints, double key, int *foundPtr) -{ - int low = 0; - int high = nPoints - 1; - - while (high >= low) { - int mid = (high + low) / 2; - if (key > points[mid].x) - low = mid + 1; - else if (key < points[mid].x) - high = mid - 1; - else { - *foundPtr = 1; - return mid; - } - } - *foundPtr = 0; - return low; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * QuadChoose -- - * - * Determines the case needed for the computation of the parame- - * ters of the quadratic spline. - * - * Results: - * Returns a case number (1-4) which controls how the parameters - * of the quadratic spline are evaluated. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static int QuadChoose(Point2d* p, Point2d* q, double m1, double m2, - double epsilon) -{ - // Calculate the slope of the line joining P and Q - double slope = (q->y - p->y) / (q->x - p->x); - - if (slope != 0.0) { - double prod1 = slope * m1; - double prod2 = slope * m2; - - // Find the absolute values of the slopes slope, m1, and m2 - double mref = fabs(slope); - double mref1 = fabs(m1); - double mref2 = fabs(m2); - - // If the relative deviation of m1 or m2 from slope is less than - // epsilon, then choose case 2 or case 3. - double relerr = epsilon * mref; - if ((fabs(slope - m1) > relerr) && (fabs(slope - m2) > relerr) && - (prod1 >= 0.0) && (prod2 >= 0.0)) { - double prod = (mref - mref1) * (mref - mref2); - if (prod < 0.0) { - // l1, the line through (x1,y1) with slope m1, and l2, - // the line through (x2,y2) with slope m2, intersect - // at a point whose abscissa is between x1 and x2. - // The abscissa becomes a knot of the spline. - return 1; - } - if (mref1 > (mref * 2.0)) { - if (mref2 <= ((2.0 - epsilon) * mref)) - return 3; - } - else if (mref2 <= (mref * 2.0)) { - // Both l1 and l2 cross the line through - // (x1+x2)/2.0,y1 and (x1+x2)/2.0,y2, which is the - // midline of the rectangle formed by P and Q or both - // m1 and m2 have signs different than the sign of - // slope, or one of m1 and m2 has opposite sign from - // slope and l1 and l2 intersect to the left of x1 or - // to the right of x2. The point (x1+x2)/2. is a knot - // of the spline. - return 2; - } - else if (mref1 <= ((2.0 - epsilon) * mref)) { - // In cases 3 and 4, sign(m1)=sign(m2)=sign(slope). - // Either l1 or l2 crosses the midline, but not both. - // Choose case 4 if mref1 is greater than - // (2.-epsilon)*mref; otherwise, choose case 3. - return 3; - } - // If neither l1 nor l2 crosses the midline, the spline - // requires two knots between x1 and x2. - return 4; - } - else { - // The sign of at least one of the slopes m1 or m2 does not - // agree with the sign of *slope*. - if ((prod1 < 0.0) && (prod2 < 0.0)) { - return 2; - } - else if (prod1 < 0.0) { - if (mref2 > ((epsilon + 1.0) * mref)) - return 1; - else - return 2; - } - else if (mref1 > ((epsilon + 1.0) * mref)) - return 1; - else - return 2; - } - } - else if ((m1 * m2) >= 0.0) - return 2; - else - return 1; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Computes the knots and other parameters of the spline on the - * interval PQ. - * On input-- - * P and Q are the coordinates of the points of interpolation. - * m1 is the slope at P. - * m2 is the slope at Q. - * ncase controls the number and location of the knots. - * On output-- - * - * (v1,v2),(w1,w2),(z1,z2), and (e1,e2) are the coordinates of - * the knots and other parameters of the spline on P. - * (e1,e2) and Q are used only if ncase=4. - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static void QuadCases(Point2d* p, Point2d* q, double m1, double m2, - double param[], int which) -{ - if ((which == 3) || (which == 4)) { - double c1 = p->x + (q->y - p->y) / m1; - double d1 = q->x + (p->y - q->y) / m2; - double h1 = c1 * 2.0 - p->x; - double j1 = d1 * 2.0 - q->x; - double mbar1 = (q->y - p->y) / (h1 - p->x); - double mbar2 = (p->y - q->y) / (j1 - q->x); - - if (which == 4) { - // Case 4 - Y1 = (p->x + c1) / 2.0; - V1 = (p->x + Y1) / 2.0; - V2 = m1 * (V1 - p->x) + p->y; - Z1 = (d1 + q->x) / 2.0; - W1 = (q->x + Z1) / 2.0; - W2 = m2 * (W1 - q->x) + q->y; - double mbar3 = (W2 - V2) / (W1 - V1); - Y2 = mbar3 * (Y1 - V1) + V2; - Z2 = mbar3 * (Z1 - V1) + V2; - E1 = (Y1 + Z1) / 2.0; - E2 = mbar3 * (E1 - V1) + V2; - } - else { - // Case 3 - double k1 = (p->y - q->y + q->x * mbar2 - p->x * mbar1) / (mbar2 - mbar1); - if (fabs(m1) > fabs(m2)) { - Z1 = (k1 + p->x) / 2.0; - } else { - Z1 = (k1 + q->x) / 2.0; - } - V1 = (p->x + Z1) / 2.0; - V2 = p->y + m1 * (V1 - p->x); - W1 = (q->x + Z1) / 2.0; - W2 = q->y + m2 * (W1 - q->x); - Z2 = V2 + (W2 - V2) / (W1 - V1) * (Z1 - V1); - } - } - else if (which == 2) { - // Case 2 - Z1 = (p->x + q->x) / 2.0; - V1 = (p->x + Z1) / 2.0; - V2 = p->y + m1 * (V1 - p->x); - W1 = (Z1 + q->x) / 2.0; - W2 = q->y + m2 * (W1 - q->x); - Z2 = (V2 + W2) / 2.0; - } - else { - // Case 1 - Z1 = (p->y - q->y + m2 * q->x - m1 * p->x) / (m2 - m1); - double ztwo = p->y + m1 * (Z1 - p->x); - V1 = (p->x + Z1) / 2.0; - V2 = (p->y + ztwo) / 2.0; - W1 = (Z1 + q->x) / 2.0; - W2 = (ztwo + q->y) / 2.0; - Z2 = V2 + (W2 - V2) / (W1 - V1) * (Z1 - V1); - } -} - -static int QuadSelect(Point2d* p, Point2d* q, double m1, double m2, - double epsilon, double param[]) -{ - int ncase = QuadChoose(p, q, m1, m2, epsilon); - QuadCases(p, q, m1, m2, param, ncase); - return ncase; -} - -static double QuadGetImage(double p1, double p2, double p3, double x1, - double x2, double x3) -{ - double A = x1 - x2; - double B = x2 - x3; - double C = x1 - x3; - - double y = (p1 * (A * A) + p2 * 2.0 * B * A + p3 * (B * B)) / (C * C); - return y; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Finds the image of a point in x. - * On input - * x Contains the value at which the spline is evaluated. - * leftX, leftY - * Coordinates of the left-hand data point used in the - * evaluation of x values. - * rightX, rightY - * Coordinates of the right-hand data point used in the - * evaluation of x values. - * Z1, Z2, Y1, Y2, E2, W2, V2 - * Parameters of the spline. - * ncase Controls the evaluation of the spline by indicating - * whether one or two knots were placed in the interval - * (xtabs,xtabs1). - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static void QuadSpline(Point2d* intp, Point2d* left, Point2d* right, - double param[], int ncase) - -{ - double y; - - if (ncase == 4) { - // Case 4: More than one knot was placed in the interval. - // Determine the location of data point relative to the 1st knot. - if (Y1 > intp->x) - y = QuadGetImage(left->y, V2, Y2, Y1, intp->x, left->x); - else if (Y1 < intp->x) { - // Determine the location of the data point relative to the 2nd knot. - if (Z1 > intp->x) - y = QuadGetImage(Y2, E2, Z2, Z1, intp->x, Y1); - else if (Z1 < intp->x) - y = QuadGetImage(Z2, W2, right->y, right->x, intp->x, Z1); - else - y = Z2; - } - else - y = Y2; - } - else { - // Cases 1, 2, or 3: - // Determine the location of the data point relative to the knot. - if (Z1 < intp->x) - y = QuadGetImage(Z2, W2, right->y, right->x, intp->x, Z1); - else if (Z1 > intp->x) - y = QuadGetImage(left->y, V2, Z2, Z1, intp->x, left->x); - else - y = Z2; - } - - intp->y = y; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Calculates the derivative at each of the data points. The - * slopes computed will insure that an osculatory quadratic - * spline will have one additional knot between two adjacent - * points of interpolation. Convexity and monotonicity are - * preserved wherever these conditions are compatible with the - * data. - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static void QuadSlopes(Point2d *points, double *m, int nPoints) -{ - double m1s =0; - double m2s =0; - double m1 =0; - double m2 =0; - int i, n, l; - for (l = 0, i = 1, n = 2; i < (nPoints - 1); l++, i++, n++) { - // Calculate the slopes of the two lines joining three - // consecutive data points. - double ydif1 = points[i].y - points[l].y; - double ydif2 = points[n].y - points[i].y; - m1 = ydif1 / (points[i].x - points[l].x); - m2 = ydif2 / (points[n].x - points[i].x); - if (i == 1) { - // Save slopes of starting point - m1s = m1; - m2s = m2; - } - // If one of the preceding slopes is zero or if they have opposite - // sign, assign the value zero to the derivative at the middle point. - if ((m1 == 0.0) || (m2 == 0.0) || ((m1 * m2) <= 0.0)) - m[i] = 0.0; - else if (fabs(m1) > fabs(m2)) { - // Calculate the slope by extending the line with slope m1. - double xbar = ydif2 / m1 + points[i].x; - double xhat = (xbar + points[n].x) / 2.0; - m[i] = ydif2 / (xhat - points[i].x); - } - else { - // Calculate the slope by extending the line with slope m2. - double xbar = -ydif1 / m2 + points[i].x; - double xhat = (points[l].x + xbar) / 2.0; - m[i] = ydif1 / (points[i].x - xhat); - } - } - - // Calculate the slope at the last point, x(n). - i = nPoints - 2; - n = nPoints - 1; - if ((m1 * m2) < 0.0) - m[n] = m2 * 2.0; - else { - double xmid = (points[i].x + points[n].x) / 2.0; - double yxmid = m[i] * (xmid - points[i].x) + points[i].y; - m[n] = (points[n].y - yxmid) / (points[n].x - xmid); - if ((m[n] * m2) < 0.0) - m[n] = 0.0; - } - - // Calculate the slope at the first point, x(0). - if ((m1s * m2s) < 0.0) - m[0] = m1s * 2.0; - else { - double xmid = (points[0].x + points[1].x) / 2.0; - double yxmid = m[1] * (xmid - points[1].x) + points[1].y; - m[0] = (yxmid - points[0].y) / (xmid - points[0].x); - if ((m[0] * m1s) < 0.0) - m[0] = 0.0; - } -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * QuadEval -- - * - * QuadEval controls the evaluation of an osculatory quadratic - * spline. The user may provide his own slopes at the points of - * interpolation or use the subroutine 'QuadSlopes' to calculate - * slopes which are consistent with the shape of the data. - * - * ON INPUT-- - * intpPts must be a nondecreasing vector of points at which the - * spline will be evaluated. - * origPts contains the abscissas of the data points to be - * interpolated. xtab must be increasing. - * y contains the ordinates of the data points to be - * interpolated. - * m contains the slope of the spline at each point of - * interpolation. - * nPoints number of data points (dimension of xtab and y). - * numEval is the number of points of evaluation (dimension of - * xval and yval). - * epsilon is a relative error tolerance used in subroutine - * 'QuadChoose' to distinguish the situation m(i) or - * m(i+1) is relatively close to the slope or twice - * the slope of the linear segment between xtab(i) and - * xtab(i+1). If this situation occurs, roundoff may - * cause a change in convexity or monotonicity of the - * resulting spline and a change in the case number - * provided by 'QuadChoose'. If epsilon is not equal to zero, - * then epsilon should be greater than or equal to machine - * epsilon. - * ON OUTPUT-- - * yval contains the images of the points in xval. - * err is one of the following error codes: - * 0 - QuadEval ran normally. - * 1 - xval(i) is less than xtab(1) for at least one - * i or xval(i) is greater than xtab(num) for at - * least one i. QuadEval will extrapolate to provide - * function values for these abscissas. - * 2 - xval(i+1) < xval(i) for some i. - * - * - * QuadEval calls the following subroutines or functions: - * Search - * QuadCases - * QuadChoose - * QuadSpline - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static int QuadEval(Point2d origPts[], int nOrigPts, Point2d intpPts[], - int nIntpPts, double *m, double epsilon) -{ - double param[10]; - - // Initialize indices and set error result - int error = 0; - int l = nOrigPts - 1; - int p = l - 1; - int ncase = 1; - - // Determine if abscissas of new vector are non-decreasing. - for (int jj=1; jj= origPts[0].x) - break; - } - // Determine if any of the points in xval are GREATER than the - // abscissa of the l data point. - int end; - for (end = nIntpPts - 1; end >= 0; end--) { - if (intpPts[end].x <= origPts[l].x) - break; - } - - if (start > 0) { - // Set error value to indicate that extrapolation has occurred - error = 1; - - // Calculate the images of points of evaluation whose abscissas - // are less than the abscissa of the first data point. - ncase = QuadSelect(origPts, origPts + 1, m[0], m[1], epsilon, param); - for (int jj=0; jj<(start - 1); jj++) - QuadSpline(intpPts + jj, origPts, origPts + 1, param, ncase); - if (nIntpPts == 1) - return error; - } - int ii; - int nn; - if ((nIntpPts == 1) && (end != (nIntpPts - 1))) - goto noExtrapolation; - - // Search locates the interval in which the first in-range - // point of evaluation lies. - int found; - ii = Search(origPts, nOrigPts, intpPts[start].x, &found); - - nn = ii + 1; - if (nn >= nOrigPts) { - nn = nOrigPts - 1; - ii = nOrigPts - 2; - } - /* - * If the first in-range point of evaluation is equal to one - * of the data points, assign the appropriate value from y. - * Continue until a point of evaluation is found which is not - * equal to a data point. - */ - if (found) { - do { - intpPts[start].y = origPts[ii].y; - start++; - if (start >= nIntpPts) { - return error; - } - } while (intpPts[start - 1].x == intpPts[start].x); - - for (;;) { - if (intpPts[start].x < origPts[nn].x) { - break; /* Break out of for-loop */ - } - if (intpPts[start].x == origPts[nn].x) { - do { - intpPts[start].y = origPts[nn].y; - start++; - if (start >= nIntpPts) { - return error; - } - } while (intpPts[start].x == intpPts[start - 1].x); - } - ii++; - nn++; - } - } - /* - * Calculate the images of all the points which lie within - * range of the data. - */ - if ((ii > 0) || (error != 1)) - ncase = QuadSelect(origPts+ii, origPts+nn, m[ii], m[nn], epsilon, param); - - for (int jj=start; jj<=end; jj++) { - // If xx(j) - x(n) is negative, do not recalculate - // the parameters for this section of the spline since - // they are already known. - if (intpPts[jj].x == origPts[nn].x) { - intpPts[jj].y = origPts[nn].y; - continue; - } - else if (intpPts[jj].x > origPts[nn].x) { - double delta; - - // Determine that the routine is in the correct part of the spline - do { - ii++; - nn++; - delta = intpPts[jj].x - origPts[nn].x; - } while (delta > 0.0); - - if (delta < 0.0) - ncase = QuadSelect(origPts+ii, origPts+nn, m[ii], m[nn], - epsilon, param); - else if (delta == 0.0) { - intpPts[jj].y = origPts[nn].y; - continue; - } - } - QuadSpline(intpPts+jj, origPts+ii, origPts+nn, param, ncase); - } - - if (end == (nIntpPts - 1)) - return error; - - if ((nn == l) && (intpPts[end].x != origPts[l].x)) - goto noExtrapolation; - - // Set error value to indicate that extrapolation has occurred - error = 1; - ncase = QuadSelect(origPts + p, origPts + l, m[p], m[l], epsilon, param); - - noExtrapolation: - // Calculate the images of the points of evaluation whose - // abscissas are greater than the abscissa of the last data point. - for (int jj=(end + 1); jj 1) { - return 0; - } - return 1; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Reference: - * Numerical Analysis, R. Burden, J. Faires and A. Reynolds. - * Prindle, Weber & Schmidt 1981 pp 112 - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -int LineElement::naturalSpline(Point2d *origPts, int nOrigPts, - Point2d *intpPts, int nIntpPts) -{ - Point2d *ip, *iend; - double x, dy, alpha; - int isKnot; - int i, j, n; - - double* dx = new double[nOrigPts]; - /* Calculate vector of differences */ - for (i = 0, j = 1; j < nOrigPts; i++, j++) { - dx[i] = origPts[j].x - origPts[i].x; - if (dx[i] < 0.0) { - return 0; - } - } - n = nOrigPts - 1; /* Number of intervals. */ - TriDiagonalMatrix* A = new TriDiagonalMatrix[nOrigPts]; - if (!A) { - delete [] dx; - return 0; - } - /* Vectors to solve the tridiagonal matrix */ - A[0][0] = A[n][0] = 1.0; - A[0][1] = A[n][1] = 0.0; - A[0][2] = A[n][2] = 0.0; - - /* Calculate the intermediate results */ - for (i = 0, j = 1; j < n; j++, i++) { - alpha = 3.0 * ((origPts[j + 1].y / dx[j]) - (origPts[j].y / dx[i]) - - (origPts[j].y / dx[j]) + (origPts[i].y / dx[i])); - A[j][0] = 2 * (dx[j] + dx[i]) - dx[i] * A[i][1]; - A[j][1] = dx[j] / A[j][0]; - A[j][2] = (alpha - dx[i] * A[i][2]) / A[j][0]; - } - - Cubic2D* eq = new Cubic2D[nOrigPts]; - if (!eq) { - delete [] A; - delete [] dx; - return 0; - } - eq[0].c = eq[n].c = 0.0; - for (j = n, i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--, j--) { - eq[i].c = A[i][2] - A[i][1] * eq[j].c; - dy = origPts[i+1].y - origPts[i].y; - eq[i].b = (dy) / dx[i] - dx[i] * (eq[j].c + 2.0 * eq[i].c) / 3.0; - eq[i].d = (eq[j].c - eq[i].c) / (3.0 * dx[i]); - } - delete [] A; - delete [] dx; - - /* Now calculate the new values */ - for (ip = intpPts, iend = ip + nIntpPts; ip < iend; ip++) { - ip->y = 0.0; - x = ip->x; - - /* Is it outside the interval? */ - if ((x < origPts[0].x) || (x > origPts[n].x)) { - continue; - } - /* Search for the interval containing x in the point array */ - i = Search(origPts, nOrigPts, x, &isKnot); - if (isKnot) { - ip->y = origPts[i].y; - } else { - i--; - x -= origPts[i].x; - ip->y = origPts[i].y + x * (eq[i].b + x * (eq[i].c + x * eq[i].d)); - } - } - delete [] eq; - return 1; -} - -typedef struct { - double t; /* Arc length of interval. */ - double x; /* 2nd derivative of X with respect to T */ - double y; /* 2nd derivative of Y with respect to T */ -} CubicSpline; - -/* - * The following two procedures solve the special linear system which arise - * in cubic spline interpolation. If x is assumed cyclic ( x[i]=x[n+i] ) the - * equations can be written as (i=0,1,...,n-1): - * m[i][0] * x[i-1] + m[i][1] * x[i] + m[i][2] * x[i+1] = b[i] . - * In matrix notation one gets A * x = b, where the matrix A is tridiagonal - * with additional elements in the upper right and lower left position: - * A[i][0] = A_{i,i-1} for i=1,2,...,n-1 and m[0][0] = A_{0,n-1} , - * A[i][1] = A_{i, i } for i=0,1,...,n-1 - * A[i][2] = A_{i,i+1} for i=0,1,...,n-2 and m[n-1][2] = A_{n-1,0}. - * A should be symmetric (A[i+1][0] == A[i][2]) and positive definite. - * The size of the system is given in n (n>=1). - * - * In the first procedure the Cholesky decomposition A = C^T * D * C - * (C is upper triangle with unit diagonal, D is diagonal) is calculated. - * Return TRUE if decomposition exist. - */ -static int SolveCubic1(TriDiagonalMatrix A[], int n) -{ - int i; - double m_ij, m_n, m_nn, d; - - if (n < 1) { - return 0; /* Dimension should be at least 1 */ - } - d = A[0][1]; /* D_{0,0} = A_{0,0} */ - if (d <= 0.0) { - return 0; /* A (or D) should be positive definite */ - } - m_n = A[0][0]; /* A_{0,n-1} */ - m_nn = A[n - 1][1]; /* A_{n-1,n-1} */ - for (i = 0; i < n - 2; i++) { - m_ij = A[i][2]; /* A_{i,1} */ - A[i][2] = m_ij / d; /* C_{i,i+1} */ - A[i][0] = m_n / d; /* C_{i,n-1} */ - m_nn -= A[i][0] * m_n; /* to get C_{n-1,n-1} */ - m_n = -A[i][2] * m_n; /* to get C_{i+1,n-1} */ - d = A[i + 1][1] - A[i][2] * m_ij; /* D_{i+1,i+1} */ - if (d <= 0.0) { - return 0; /* Elements of D should be positive */ - } - A[i + 1][1] = d; - } - if (n >= 2) { /* Complete last column */ - m_n += A[n - 2][2]; /* add A_{n-2,n-1} */ - A[n - 2][0] = m_n / d; /* C_{n-2,n-1} */ - A[n - 1][1] = d = m_nn - A[n - 2][0] * m_n; /* D_{n-1,n-1} */ - if (d <= 0.0) { - return 0; - } - } - return 1; -} - -/* - * The second procedure solves the linear system, with the Cholesky - * decomposition calculated above (in m[][]) and the right side b given - * in x[]. The solution x overwrites the right side in x[]. - */ -static void SolveCubic2(TriDiagonalMatrix A[], CubicSpline spline[], - int nIntervals) -{ - int n = nIntervals - 2; - int m = nIntervals - 1; - - // Division by transpose of C : b = C^{-T} * b - double x = spline[m].x; - double y = spline[m].y; - for (int ii=0; ii= 0) { - // C_{n-2,n-1} * x_{n-1} - spline[m].x = x - A[n][0] * spline[n].x; - spline[m].y = y - A[n][0] * spline[n].y; - } - // Division by D: b = D^{-1} * b - for (int ii=0; ii= 0) { - // C_{n-2,n-1} * x_{n-1} - spline[n].x -= A[n][0] * x; - spline[n].y -= A[n][0] * y; - } - for (int ii=(n - 1); ii>=0; ii--) { - // C_{i,i+1} * x_{i+1} + C_{i,n-1} * x_{n-1} - spline[ii].x -= A[ii][2] * spline[ii + 1].x + A[ii][0] * x; - spline[ii].y -= A[ii][2] * spline[ii + 1].y + A[ii][0] * y; - } -} - -/* - * Find second derivatives (x''(t_i),y''(t_i)) of cubic spline interpolation - * through list of points (x_i,y_i). The parameter t is calculated as the - * length of the linear stroke. The number of points must be at least 3. - * Note: For CLOSED_CONTOURs the first and last point must be equal. - */ -static CubicSpline* CubicSlopes(Point2d points[], int nPoints, - int isClosed, double unitX, double unitY) -{ - CubicSpline *s1, *s2; - int n, i; - double norm, dx, dy; - - CubicSpline* spline = new CubicSpline[nPoints]; - if (!spline) - return NULL; - - TriDiagonalMatrix *A = new TriDiagonalMatrix[nPoints]; - if (!A) { - delete [] spline; - return NULL; - } - /* - * Calculate first differences in (dxdt2[i], y[i]) and interval lengths - * in dist[i]: - */ - s1 = spline; - for (i = 0; i < nPoints - 1; i++) { - s1->x = points[i+1].x - points[i].x; - s1->y = points[i+1].y - points[i].y; - - /* - * The Norm of a linear stroke is calculated in "normal coordinates" - * and used as interval length: - */ - dx = s1->x / unitX; - dy = s1->y / unitY; - s1->t = sqrt(dx * dx + dy * dy); - - s1->x /= s1->t; /* first difference, with unit norm: */ - s1->y /= s1->t; /* || (dxdt2[i], y[i]) || = 1 */ - s1++; - } - - /* - * Setup linear System: Ax = b - */ - n = nPoints - 2; /* Without first and last point */ - if (isClosed) { - /* First and last points must be equal for CLOSED_CONTOURs */ - spline[nPoints - 1].t = spline[0].t; - spline[nPoints - 1].x = spline[0].x; - spline[nPoints - 1].y = spline[0].y; - n++; /* Add last point (= first point) */ - } - s1 = spline, s2 = s1 + 1; - for (i = 0; i < n; i++) { - /* Matrix A, mainly tridiagonal with cyclic second index - ("j = j+n mod n") - */ - A[i][0] = s1->t; /* Off-diagonal element A_{i,i-1} */ - A[i][1] = 2.0 * (s1->t + s2->t); /* A_{i,i} */ - A[i][2] = s2->t; /* Off-diagonal element A_{i,i+1} */ - - /* Right side b_x and b_y */ - s1->x = (s2->x - s1->x) * 6.0; - s1->y = (s2->y - s1->y) * 6.0; - - /* - * If the linear stroke shows a cusp of more than 90 degree, - * the right side is reduced to avoid oscillations in the - * spline: - */ - /* - * The Norm of a linear stroke is calculated in "normal coordinates" - * and used as interval length: - */ - dx = s1->x / unitX; - dy = s1->y / unitY; - norm = sqrt(dx * dx + dy * dy) / 8.5; - if (norm > 1.0) { - /* The first derivative will not be continuous */ - s1->x /= norm; - s1->y /= norm; - } - s1++, s2++; - } - - if (!isClosed) { - /* Third derivative is set to zero at both ends */ - A[0][1] += A[0][0]; /* A_{0,0} */ - A[0][0] = 0.0; /* A_{0,n-1} */ - A[n-1][1] += A[n-1][2]; /* A_{n-1,n-1} */ - A[n-1][2] = 0.0; /* A_{n-1,0} */ - } - /* Solve linear systems for dxdt2[] and y[] */ - - if (SolveCubic1(A, n)) { /* Cholesky decomposition */ - SolveCubic2(A, spline, n); /* A * dxdt2 = b_x */ - } - else { /* Should not happen, but who knows ... */ - delete [] A; - delete [] spline; - return NULL; - } - /* Shift all second derivatives one place right and update the ends. */ - s2 = spline + n, s1 = s2 - 1; - for (/* empty */; s2 > spline; s2--, s1--) { - s2->x = s1->x; - s2->y = s1->y; - } - if (isClosed) { - spline[0].x = spline[n].x; - spline[0].y = spline[n].y; - } else { - /* Third derivative is 0.0 for the first and last interval. */ - spline[0].x = spline[1].x; - spline[0].y = spline[1].y; - spline[n + 1].x = spline[n].x; - spline[n + 1].y = spline[n].y; - } - delete [] A; - return spline; -} - -// Calculate interpolated values of the spline function (defined via p_cntr -// and the second derivatives dxdt2[] and dydt2[]). The number of tabulated -// values is n. On an equidistant grid n_intpol values are calculated. -static int CubicEval(Point2d *origPts, int nOrigPts, Point2d *intpPts, - int nIntpPts, CubicSpline *spline) -{ - double t, tSkip; - Point2d q; - int count; - - /* Sum the lengths of all the segments (intervals). */ - double tMax = 0.0; - for (int ii=0; iiright - extsPtr->left; - double unitY = extsPtr->bottom - extsPtr->top; - if (unitX < FLT_EPSILON) - unitX = FLT_EPSILON; - if (unitY < FLT_EPSILON) - unitY = FLT_EPSILON; - - /* Calculate parameters for cubic spline: - * t = arc length of interval. - * dxdt2 = second derivatives of x with respect to t, - * dydt2 = second derivatives of y with respect to t, - */ - CubicSpline* spline = CubicSlopes(origPts, nOrigPts, isClosed, unitX, unitY); - if (spline == NULL) - return 0; - - int result= CubicEval(origPts, nOrigPts, intpPts, nIntpPts, spline); - - delete [] spline; - return result; -} - -static void CatromCoeffs(Point2d* p, Point2d* a, Point2d* b, - Point2d* c, Point2d* d) -{ - a->x = -p[0].x + 3.0 * p[1].x - 3.0 * p[2].x + p[3].x; - b->x = 2.0 * p[0].x - 5.0 * p[1].x + 4.0 * p[2].x - p[3].x; - c->x = -p[0].x + p[2].x; - d->x = 2.0 * p[1].x; - a->y = -p[0].y + 3.0 * p[1].y - 3.0 * p[2].y + p[3].y; - b->y = 2.0 * p[0].y - 5.0 * p[1].y + 4.0 * p[2].y - p[3].y; - c->y = -p[0].y + p[2].y; - d->y = 2.0 * p[1].y; -} - -int LineElement::catromParametricSpline(Point2d* points, int nPoints, - Point2d* intpPts, int nIntpPts) -{ - // The spline is computed in screen coordinates instead of data points so - // that we can select the abscissas of the interpolated points from each - // pixel horizontally across the plotting area. - - Point2d* origPts = new Point2d[nPoints + 4]; - memcpy(origPts + 1, points, sizeof(Point2d) * nPoints); - - origPts[0] = origPts[1]; - origPts[nPoints + 2] = origPts[nPoints + 1] = origPts[nPoints]; - - for (int ii=0; ii - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static int GetIndex(Tcl_Interp* interp, Element* elemPtr, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, int *indexPtr); -static Tcl_Obj *DisplayListObj(Graph* graphPtr); - -int Blt::ElementObjConfigure(Element* elemPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = elemPtr->graphPtr_; - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)elemPtr->ops(), elemPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (elemPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* elemPtr; - if (graphPtr->getElement(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)elemPtr->ops(), - elemPtr->optionTable(), - objv[4], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId ?option value...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* elemPtr; - if (graphPtr->getElement(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc <= 5) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)elemPtr->ops(), - elemPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 5) ? objv[4] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return ElementObjConfigure(elemPtr, interp, objc-4, objv+4); -} - -static int ActivateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc<3) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "?elemId? ?index...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // List all the currently active elements - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.table, &iter); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - if (elemPtr->active_) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1)); - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - - Element* elemPtr; - if (graphPtr->getElement(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int* indices = NULL; - int nIndices = -1; - if (objc > 4) { - nIndices = objc - 4; - indices = new int[nIndices]; - - int* activePtr = indices; - for (int ii=4; iiactiveIndices_; - elemPtr->activeIndices_ = indices; - elemPtr->nActiveIndices_ = nIndices; - - elemPtr->active_ = 1; - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int BindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.tagTable, &iter); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - char* tagName = - (char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&graphPtr->elements_.tagTable, hPtr); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr,Tcl_NewStringObj(tagName,-1)); - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - - return graphPtr->bindTable_->configure(graphPtr->elementTag(Tcl_GetString(objv[3])), objc - 4, objv + 4); -} - -static int ClosestOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "x y ?elemName?..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr->ops_; - ClosestSearch* searchPtr = &gops->search; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - int x; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[3], &x) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, ": bad window x-coordinate", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - int y; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[4], &y) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, ": bad window y-coordinate", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - searchPtr->x = x; - searchPtr->y = y; - searchPtr->index = -1; - searchPtr->dist = (double)(searchPtr->halo + 1); - - if (objc>5) { - for (int ii=5; iigetElement(objv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (!eops->hide) - elemPtr->closest(); - } - } - else { - // Find the closest point from the set of displayed elements, - // searching the display list from back to front. That way if - // the points from two different elements overlay each other - // exactly, the last one picked will be the topmost. - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (!eops->hide) - elemPtr->closest(); - } - } - - if (searchPtr->dist < (double)searchPtr->halo) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj("name", -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj(searchPtr->elemPtr->name_, -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj("index", -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewIntObj(searchPtr->index)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj("x", -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(searchPtr->point.x)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj("y", -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(searchPtr->point.y)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewStringObj("dist", -1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(searchPtr->dist)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int CreateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - // may vary in length - // if (objc!=4) { - // Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId"); - // return TCL_ERROR; - // } - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (graphPtr->createElement(objc, objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objv[3]); - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeactivateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - for (int ii=3; iigetElement(objv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - delete [] elemPtr->activeIndices_; - elemPtr->activeIndices_ = NULL; - elemPtr->nActiveIndices_ = 0; - elemPtr->active_ = 0; - } - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeleteOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - for (int ii=3; iigetElement(objv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->legend_->removeElement(elemPtr); - delete elemPtr; - } - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ExistsOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = - Tcl_FindHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.table, Tcl_GetString(objv[3])); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), (hPtr != NULL)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int LowerOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // Move the links of lowered elements out of the display list into - // a temporary list - Chain* chain = new Chain(); - - for (int ii=3; iigetElement(objv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // look for duplicates - int ok=1; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* ptr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (ptr == elemPtr) { - ok=0; - break; - } - } - - if (ok && elemPtr->link) { - graphPtr->elements_.displayList->unlinkLink(elemPtr->link); - chain->linkAfter(elemPtr->link, NULL); - } - } - - // Append the links to end of the display list - ChainLink *next; - for (ChainLink *link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; link = next) { - next = Chain_NextLink(link); - chain->unlinkLink(link); - graphPtr->elements_.displayList->linkAfter(link, NULL); - } - delete chain; - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, DisplayListObj(graphPtr)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NamesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc<3) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "?pattern...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.table, &iter); hPtr != NULL; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - } - else { - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.table, &iter); hPtr != NULL; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - - for (int ii=3; iiname_,Tcl_GetString(objv[ii]))) { - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - break; - } - } - } - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int RaiseOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Chain* chain = new Chain(); - for (int ii=3; iigetElement(objv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // look for duplicates - int ok=1; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* ptr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (ptr == elemPtr) { - ok=0; - break; - } - } - - if (ok && elemPtr->link) { - graphPtr->elements_.displayList->unlinkLink(elemPtr->link); - chain->linkAfter(elemPtr->link, NULL); - } - } - - // Prepend the links to beginning of the display list in reverse order - ChainLink *prev; - for (ChainLink *link = Chain_LastLink(chain); link; link = prev) { - prev = Chain_PrevLink(link); - chain->unlinkLink(link); - graphPtr->elements_.displayList->linkBefore(link, NULL); - } - delete chain; - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, DisplayListObj(graphPtr)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ShowOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - // may vary in length - if (objc<3) { - // if (objc!=3 || objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "?nameList?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, DisplayListObj(graphPtr)); - return TCL_OK; - } - - int elemObjc; - Tcl_Obj** elemObjv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objv[3], &elemObjc, &elemObjv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Collect the named elements into a list - Chain* chain = new Chain(); - for (int ii=0; iigetElement(elemObjv[ii], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) { - delete chain; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // look for duplicates - int ok=1; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* ptr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (ptr == elemPtr) { - ok=0; - break; - } - } - - if (ok) - chain->append(elemPtr); - } - - // Clear the links from the currently displayed elements - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->link = NULL; - } - delete graphPtr->elements_.displayList; - graphPtr->elements_.displayList = chain; - - // Set links on all the displayed elements - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->link = link; - } - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, DisplayListObj(graphPtr)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int TypeOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "elemId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* elemPtr; - if (graphPtr->getElement(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), elemPtr->typeName(), -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::elementEnsemble[] = { - {"activate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"bind", BindOp, 0}, - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"closest", ClosestOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"create", CreateOp, 0}, - {"deactivate", DeactivateOp, 0}, - {"delete", DeleteOp, 0}, - {"exists", ExistsOp, 0}, - {"lower", LowerOp, 0}, - {"names", NamesOp, 0}, - {"raise", RaiseOp, 0}, - {"show", ShowOp, 0}, - {"type", TypeOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Support - -static Tcl_Obj *DisplayListObj(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(graphPtr->interp_, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - - return listObjPtr; -} - -static int GetIndex(Tcl_Interp* interp, Element* elemPtr, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, int *indexPtr) -{ - ElementOptions* ops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - char *string = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - if ((*string == 'e') && (strcmp("end", string) == 0)) - *indexPtr = NUMBEROFPOINTS(ops); - else if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objPtr, indexPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index b596b11..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrElemOp_h__ -#define __BltGrElemOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble elementEnsemble[]; - extern int ElementObjConfigure(Blt::Element* elemPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.C deleted file mode 100644 index a0a67e6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,396 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltChain.h" - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define SETRANGE(l) ((l).range = ((l).max > (l).min) ? ((l).max - (l).min) : DBL_EPSILON) -#define SETWEIGHT(l, lo, hi) ((l).min = (lo), (l).max = (hi), SETRANGE(l)) - -// Defs - -static int GetPenStyleFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Graph* graphPtr, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, ClassId classId, - PenStyle *stylePtr); -static int ParseValues(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, int *nValuesPtr, - double **arrayPtr); - -// OptionSpecs - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc ValuesSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc ValuesGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc ValuesFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption valuesObjOption = - { - "values", ValuesSetProc, ValuesGetProc, RestoreProc, ValuesFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int ValuesSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - ElemValues** valuesPtrPtr = (ElemValues**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)valuesPtrPtr; - ElementOptions* ops = (ElementOptions*)widgRec; - Element* elemPtr = ops->elemPtr; - - if (!valuesPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - Tcl_Obj** objv; - int objc; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, *objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc == 0) { - *valuesPtrPtr = NULL; - return TCL_OK; - } - - const char *string = Tcl_GetString(objv[0]); - if (objc == 1) { - if (Blt_VectorExists2(interp, string)) { - ElemValuesVector* valuesPtr = new ElemValuesVector(elemPtr, string); - if (valuesPtr->getVector() != TCL_OK) { - delete valuesPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *valuesPtrPtr = valuesPtr; - } - else - return TCL_ERROR; - } - else { - double* values; - int nValues; - if (ParseValues(interp, *objPtr, &nValues, &values) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - ElemValuesSource* valuesPtr = new ElemValuesSource(nValues, values); - valuesPtr->findRange(); - *valuesPtrPtr = valuesPtr; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* ValuesGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - ElemValues* valuesPtr = *(ElemValues**)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!valuesPtr) - return Tcl_NewStringObj("", -1); - - int cnt = valuesPtr->nValues(); - if (!cnt) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj**)NULL); - - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[cnt]; - for (int ii=0; iivalues_[ii]); - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(cnt, ll); - delete [] ll; - - return listObjPtr; -} - -static void ValuesFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, char *ptr) -{ - ElemValues* valuesPtr = *(ElemValues**)ptr; - delete valuesPtr; -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc PairsSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc PairsGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionRestoreProc PairsRestoreProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc PairsFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption pairsObjOption = - { - "pairs", PairsSetProc, PairsGetProc, PairsRestoreProc, PairsFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int PairsSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - ElemCoords* coordsPtr = (ElemCoords*)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = (double)NULL; - - double* values; - int nValues; - if (ParseValues(interp, *objPtr, &nValues, &values) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (nValues == 0) - return TCL_OK; - - if (nValues & 1) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "odd number of data points", NULL); - delete [] values; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - nValues /= 2; - delete coordsPtr->x; - coordsPtr->x = new ElemValuesSource(nValues); - - delete coordsPtr->y; - coordsPtr->y = new ElemValuesSource(nValues); - - int ii=0; - for (double* p = values; iix->values_[ii] = *p++; - coordsPtr->y->values_[ii] = *p++; - } - delete [] values; - - coordsPtr->x->findRange(); - coordsPtr->y->findRange(); - - return TCL_OK; -}; - -static Tcl_Obj* PairsGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - ElemCoords* coordsPtr = (ElemCoords*)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!coordsPtr || - !coordsPtr->x || !coordsPtr->y || - !coordsPtr->x->nValues() || !coordsPtr->y->nValues()) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj**)NULL); - - int cnt = MIN(coordsPtr->x->nValues(), coordsPtr->y->nValues()); - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[2*cnt]; - for (int ii=0, jj=0; iix->values_[ii]); - ll[jj++] = Tcl_NewDoubleObj(coordsPtr->y->values_[ii]); - } - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(2*cnt, ll); - delete [] ll; - - return listObjPtr; -}; - -static void PairsRestoreProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr, char *savePtr) -{ - // do nothing -} - -static void PairsFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, char *ptr) -{ - // do nothing -} - -int StyleSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* save, int flags) -{ - Chain* stylePalette = *(Chain**)(widgRec + offset); - ElementOptions* ops = (ElementOptions*)(widgRec); - Element* elemPtr = ops->elemPtr; - size_t size = (size_t)clientData; - - int objc; - Tcl_Obj** objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, *objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Reserve the first entry for the "normal" pen. We'll set the style later - elemPtr->freeStylePalette(stylePalette); - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(stylePalette); - if (!link) { - link = new ChainLink(size); - stylePalette->linkAfter(link, NULL); - } - - PenStyle* stylePtr = (PenStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - stylePtr->penPtr = NORMALPEN(ops); - for (int ii = 0; iiweight.min = (double)ii; - stylePtr->weight.max = (double)ii + 1.0; - stylePtr->weight.range = 1.0; - if (GetPenStyleFromObj(interp, elemPtr->graphPtr_, objv[ii], - elemPtr->classId(), - (PenStyle*)stylePtr) != TCL_OK) { - elemPtr->freeStylePalette(stylePalette); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - stylePalette->linkAfter(link, NULL); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -Tcl_Obj* StyleGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Chain* stylePalette = *(Chain**)(widgRec + offset); - - // count how many - int cnt =0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link), cnt++) {} - if (!cnt) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj**)NULL); - - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[3*cnt]; - int ii=0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(stylePalette); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - PenStyle *stylePtr = (PenStyle*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ll[ii++] = Tcl_NewStringObj(stylePtr->penPtr->name_, -1); - ll[ii++] = Tcl_NewDoubleObj(stylePtr->weight.min); - ll[ii++] = Tcl_NewDoubleObj(stylePtr->weight.max); - } - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(3*cnt,ll); - delete [] ll; - - return listObjPtr; -} - -void StyleRestoreProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr, char *savePtr) -{ - // do nothing -} - -void StyleFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, char *ptr) -{ - // do nothing -} - -// Support - -static int GetPenStyleFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Graph* graphPtr, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, ClassId classId, - PenStyle *stylePtr) -{ - int objc; - Tcl_Obj **objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if ((objc != 1) && (objc != 3)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad style entry \"", - Tcl_GetString(objPtr), - "\": should be \"penName\" or \"penName min max\"", - NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(objv[0], &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc == 3) { - double min, max; - if ((Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[1], &min) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &max) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - SETWEIGHT(stylePtr->weight, min, max); - } - - penPtr->refCount_++; - stylePtr->penPtr = penPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -void VectorChangedProc(Tcl_Interp* interp, ClientData clientData, - Blt_VectorNotify notify) -{ - ElemValuesVector* valuesPtr = (ElemValuesVector*)clientData; - if (!valuesPtr) - return; - - if (notify == BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY) { - valuesPtr->freeSource(); - valuesPtr->reset(); - } - else { - Blt_Vector* vector; - Blt_GetVectorById(interp, valuesPtr->source_, &vector); - if (valuesPtr->fetchValues(vector) != TCL_OK) - return; - } - - Element* elemPtr = valuesPtr->elemPtr_; - Graph* graphPtr = elemPtr->graphPtr_; - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); -} - -static int ParseValues(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, int *nValuesPtr, - double **arrayPtr) -{ - int objc; - Tcl_Obj **objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - *arrayPtr = NULL; - *nValuesPtr = 0; - if (objc > 0) { - double* array = new double[objc]; - if (!array) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't allocate new vector", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int i=0; - for (double* p = array; i < objc; i++, p++) { - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[i], p) != TCL_OK) { - delete [] array; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - *arrayPtr = array; - *nValuesPtr = objc; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4312691..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrElemOption.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrElemOption_h__ -#define __BltGrElemOption_h__ - -#include - -extern const char* fillObjOption[]; -extern Tk_CustomOptionSetProc StyleSetProc; -extern Tk_CustomOptionGetProc StyleGetProc; -extern Tk_CustomOptionRestoreProc StyleRestoreProc; -extern Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc StyleFreeProc; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.C deleted file mode 100644 index d7ea3d2..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,145 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-color", "color", "Color", - "green", -1, Tk_Offset(CrosshairsOptions, colorPtr), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-dashes", "dashes", "Dashes", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(CrosshairsOptions, dashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "Linewidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(CrosshairsOptions, lineWidth), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-x", "x", "X", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(CrosshairsOptions, x), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-y", "y", "Y", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(CrosshairsOptions, y), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -Crosshairs::Crosshairs(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - ops_ = (CrosshairsOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(CrosshairsOptions)); - - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - visible_ =0; - gc_ =NULL; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr->interp_, (char*)ops_, optionTable_, - graphPtr->tkwin_); -} - -Crosshairs::~Crosshairs() -{ - if (gc_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(gc_); - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - -// Configure - -int Crosshairs::configure() -{ - CrosshairsOptions* ops = (CrosshairsOptions*)ops_; - - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.foreground = ops->colorPtr->pixel; - gcValues.line_width = ops->lineWidth; - unsigned long gcMask = (GCForeground | GCLineWidth); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) { - gcValues.line_style = LineOnOffDash; - gcMask |= GCLineStyle; - } - GC newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->dashes); - - if (gc_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(gc_); - gc_ = newGC; - - // Are the new coordinates on the graph? - map(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Crosshairs::map() -{ - CrosshairsOptions* ops = (CrosshairsOptions*)ops_; - - segArr_[0].x = ops->x; - segArr_[1].x = ops->x; - segArr_[0].y = graphPtr_->bottom_; - segArr_[1].y = graphPtr_->top_; - segArr_[2].y = ops->y; - segArr_[3].y = ops->y; - segArr_[2].x = graphPtr_->left_; - segArr_[3].x = graphPtr_->right_; -} - -void Crosshairs::on() -{ - visible_ =1; -} - -void Crosshairs::off() -{ - visible_ =0; -} - -void Crosshairs::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - CrosshairsOptions* ops = (CrosshairsOptions*)ops_; - - if (visible_ && Tk_IsMapped(graphPtr_->tkwin_)) { - if (ops->x <= graphPtr_->right_ && - ops->x >= graphPtr_->left_ && - ops->y <= graphPtr_->bottom_ && - ops->y >= graphPtr_->top_) { - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, gc_, - segArr_[0].x, segArr_[0].y, segArr_[1].x, segArr_[1].y); - XDrawLine(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, gc_, - segArr_[2].x, segArr_[2].y, segArr_[3].x, segArr_[3].y); - } - } -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.h deleted file mode 100644 index a86d0c6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairs.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,78 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrHairs_h__ -#define __BltGrHairs_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - - typedef struct { - XColor* colorPtr; - Dashes dashes; - int lineWidth; - int x; - int y; - } CrosshairsOptions; - - class Crosshairs { - protected: - Graph* graphPtr_; - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - int visible_; - GC gc_; - Point segArr_[4]; - - public: - Crosshairs(Graph*); - virtual ~Crosshairs(); - - int configure(); - void map(); - void draw(Drawable); - - void on(); - void off(); - int isOn() {return visible_;} - - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - void* ops() {return ops_;} - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 57650ce..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,164 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairsOp.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static int CrosshairsObjConfigure(Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Crosshairs* chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)chPtr->ops(), chPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (chPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc != 4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Crosshairs* chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)chPtr->ops(), - chPtr->optionTable(), - objv[3], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Crosshairs* chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - if (objc <= 4) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)chPtr->ops(), - chPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 4) ? objv[3] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return CrosshairsObjConfigure(graphPtr, interp, objc-3, objv+3); -} - -static int OnOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Crosshairs *chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - - chPtr->on(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int OffOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Crosshairs *chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - - chPtr->off(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ToggleOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Crosshairs *chPtr = graphPtr->crosshairs_; - - if (chPtr->isOn()) - chPtr->off(); - else - chPtr->on(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::crosshairsEnsemble[] = { - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"off", OffOp, 0}, - {"on", OnOp, 0}, - {"toggle", ToggleOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 3f3d009..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrHairsOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,42 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrHairsOp_h__ -#define __BltGrHairsOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble crosshairsEnsemble[]; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.C deleted file mode 100644 index b8822f1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1070 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static void SelectCmdProc(ClientData); -static Tk_SelectionProc SelectionProc; - -// OptionSpecs - -static const char* selectmodeObjOption[] = { - "single", "multiple", NULL -}; -static const char* positionObjOption[] = { - "rightmargin", "leftmargin", "topmargin", "bottommargin", - "plotarea", "xy", NULL -}; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-activebackground", "activeBackground", - "ActiveBackground", - STD_ACTIVE_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, activeBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-activeborderwidth", "activeBorderWidth", - "ActiveBorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, entryBW), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-activeforeground", "activeForeground", "ActiveForeground", - STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, activeFgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-activerelief", "activeRelief", "ActiveRelief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, activeRelief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-anchor", "anchor", "Anchor", - "n", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, anchor), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-background", "background", "Background", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, normalBg), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, borderWidth), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-columns", "columns", "columns", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, reqColumns), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-exportselection", "exportSelection", "ExportSelection", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, exportSelection), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-focusdashes", "focusDashes", "FocusDashes", - "dot", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, focusDashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-focusforeground", "focusForeground", "FocusForeground", - STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, focusColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-font", "font", "Font", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, style.font), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-foreground", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-foreground", "foreground", "Foreground", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, fgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, hide), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-ipadx", "iPadX", "Pad", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, ixPad), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-ipady", "iPadY", "Pad", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, iyPad), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-nofocusselectbackground", "noFocusSelectBackground", - "NoFocusSelectBackground", - STD_ACTIVE_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selOutFocusBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-nofocusselectforeground", "noFocusSelectForeground", - "NoFocusSelectForeground", - STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selOutFocusFgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-padx", "padX", "Pad", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, xPad), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-pady", "padY", "Pad", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, yPad), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-position", "position", "Position", - "rightmargin", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, position), - 0, &positionObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-raised", "raised", "Raised", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, raised), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, relief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-rows", "rows", "rows", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, reqRows), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-selectbackground", "selectBackground", - "SelectBackground", - STD_ACTIVE_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selInFocusBg), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-selectborderwidth", "selectBorderWidth", - "SelectBorderWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selBW), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-selectcommand", "selectCommand", "SelectCommand", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selectCmd), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-selectforeground", "selectForeground", "SelectForeground", - STD_ACTIVE_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selInFocusFgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-selectmode", "selectMode", "SelectMode", - "multiple", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selectMode), - 0, &selectmodeObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-selectrelief", "selectRelief", "SelectRelief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, selRelief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-title", "title", "Title", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, title), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-titlecolor", "titleColor", "TitleColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, titleStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-titlefont", "titleFont", "TitleFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, titleStyle.font), - 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-x", "x", "X", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, xReq), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-y", "y", "Y", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LegendOptions, yReq), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -Legend::Legend(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - ops_ = (void*)calloc(1, sizeof(LegendOptions)); - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - flags =0; - nEntries_ =0; - nColumns_ =0; - nRows_ =0; - width_ =0; - height_ =0; - entryWidth_ =0; - entryHeight_ =0; - x_ =0; - y_ =0; - bindTable_ =NULL; - focusGC_ =NULL; - focusPtr_ =NULL; - selAnchorPtr_ =NULL; - selMarkPtr_ =NULL; - selected_ = new Chain(); - titleWidth_ =0; - titleHeight_ =0; - - ops->style.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->style.color =NULL; - ops->style.font =NULL; - ops->style.angle =0; - ops->style.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - ops->titleStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->titleStyle.color =NULL; - ops->titleStyle.font =NULL; - ops->titleStyle.angle =0; - ops->titleStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - bindTable_ = new BindTable(graphPtr, this); - - Tcl_InitHashTable(&selectTable_, TCL_ONE_WORD_KEYS); - - Tk_CreateSelHandler(graphPtr_->tkwin_, XA_PRIMARY, XA_STRING, - SelectionProc, this, XA_STRING); - - optionTable_ =Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr->interp_, (char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr->tkwin_); -} - -Legend::~Legend() -{ - // LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - delete bindTable_; - - if (focusGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(focusGC_); - - if (graphPtr_->tkwin_) - Tk_DeleteSelHandler(graphPtr_->tkwin_, XA_PRIMARY, XA_STRING); - - delete selected_; - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - -int Legend::configure() -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - // GC for active label, Dashed outline - unsigned long gcMask = GCForeground | GCLineStyle; - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.foreground = ops->focusColor->pixel; - gcValues.line_style = (LineIsDashed(ops->focusDashes)) - ? LineOnOffDash : LineSolid; - GC newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->focusDashes)) { - ops->focusDashes.offset = 2; - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->focusDashes); - } - if (focusGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(focusGC_); - - focusGC_ = newGC; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Legend::map(int plotWidth, int plotHeight) -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - entryWidth_ =0; - entryHeight_ = 0; - nRows_ =0; - nColumns_ =0; - nEntries_ =0; - height_ =0; - width_ = 0; - - TextStyle tts(graphPtr_, &ops->titleStyle); - tts.getExtents(ops->title, &titleWidth_, &titleHeight_); - - // Count the number of legend entries and determine the widest and tallest - // label. The number of entries would normally be the number of elements, - // but elements can have no legend entry (-label ""). - int nEntries =0; - int maxWidth =0; - int maxHeight =0; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - int w, h; - ts.getExtents(elemOps->label, &w, &h); - if (maxWidth < (int)w) - maxWidth = w; - - if (maxHeight < (int)h) - maxHeight = h; - - nEntries++; - } - if (nEntries == 0) - return; - - Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics; - Tk_GetFontMetrics(ops->style.font, &fontMetrics); - int symbolWidth = 2 * fontMetrics.ascent; - - maxWidth += 2 * ops->entryBW + 2*ops->ixPad + - + symbolWidth + 3 * 2; - - maxHeight += 2 * ops->entryBW + 2*ops->iyPad; - - maxWidth |= 0x01; - maxHeight |= 0x01; - - int lw = plotWidth - 2 * ops->borderWidth - 2*ops->xPad; - int lh = plotHeight - 2 * ops->borderWidth - 2*ops->yPad; - - /* - * The number of rows and columns is computed as one of the following: - * - * both options set User defined. - * -rows Compute columns from rows. - * -columns Compute rows from columns. - * neither set Compute rows and columns from - * size of plot. - */ - int nRows =0; - int nColumns =0; - if (ops->reqRows > 0) { - nRows = MIN(ops->reqRows, nEntries); - if (ops->reqColumns > 0) - nColumns = MIN(ops->reqColumns, nEntries); - else - nColumns = ((nEntries - 1) / nRows) + 1; /* Only -rows. */ - } - else if (ops->reqColumns > 0) { /* Only -columns. */ - nColumns = MIN(ops->reqColumns, nEntries); - nRows = ((nEntries - 1) / nColumns) + 1; - } - else { - // Compute # of rows and columns from the legend size - nRows = lh / maxHeight; - nColumns = lw / maxWidth; - if (nRows < 1) { - nRows = nEntries; - } - if (nColumns < 1) { - nColumns = nEntries; - } - if (nRows > nEntries) { - nRows = nEntries; - } - switch ((Position)ops->position) { - case TOP: - case BOTTOM: - nRows = ((nEntries - 1) / nColumns) + 1; - break; - case LEFT: - case RIGHT: - default: - nColumns = ((nEntries - 1) / nRows) + 1; - break; - } - } - if (nColumns < 1) - nColumns = 1; - - if (nRows < 1) - nRows = 1; - - lh = (nRows * maxHeight); - if (titleHeight_ > 0) - lh += titleHeight_ + ops->yPad; - - lw = nColumns * maxWidth; - if (lw < (int)(titleWidth_)) - lw = titleWidth_; - - width_ = lw + 2 * ops->borderWidth + 2*ops->xPad; - height_ = lh + 2 * ops->borderWidth + 2*ops->yPad; - nRows_ = nRows; - nColumns_ = nColumns; - nEntries_ = nEntries; - entryHeight_ = maxHeight; - entryWidth_ = maxWidth; - - int row =0; - int col =0; - int count =0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - count++; - elemPtr->row_ = row; - elemPtr->col_ = col; - row++; - if ((count % nRows) == 0) { - col++; - row = 0; - } - } -} - -void Legend::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - if ((ops->hide) || (nEntries_ == 0)) - return; - - setOrigin(); - Tk_Window tkwin = graphPtr_->tkwin_; - int w = width_; - int h = height_; - - Pixmap pixmap = Tk_GetPixmap(graphPtr_->display_, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), w, h, - Tk_Depth(tkwin)); - - if (ops->normalBg) - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, ops->normalBg, 0, 0, - w, h, 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - else { - switch ((Position)ops->position) { - case TOP: - case BOTTOM: - case RIGHT: - case LEFT: - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, gops->normalBg, 0, 0, - w, h, 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - break; - case PLOT: - case XY: - // Legend background is transparent and is positioned over the the - // plot area. Either copy the part of the background from the backing - // store pixmap or (if no backing store exists) just fill it with the - // background color of the plot. - if (graphPtr_->cache_ != None) - XCopyArea(graphPtr_->display_, graphPtr_->cache_, pixmap, - graphPtr_->drawGC_, x_, y_, w, h, 0, 0); - else - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, gops->plotBg, 0, 0, - w, h, TK_RELIEF_FLAT, 0); - break; - }; - } - - Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics; - Tk_GetFontMetrics(ops->style.font, &fontMetrics); - - int symbolSize = fontMetrics.ascent; - int xMid = symbolSize + 1 + ops->entryBW; - int yMid = (symbolSize / 2) + 1 + ops->entryBW; - int xLabel = 2 * symbolSize + ops->entryBW + ops->ixPad + 2 * 2; - int ySymbol = yMid + ops->iyPad; - int xSymbol = xMid + 2; - - int x = ops->xPad + ops->borderWidth; - int y = ops->yPad + ops->borderWidth; - - TextStyle tts(graphPtr_, &ops->titleStyle); - tts.drawText(pixmap, ops->title, x, y); - if (titleHeight_ > 0) - y += titleHeight_ + ops->yPad; - - int count = 0; - int yStart = y; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - int isSelected = entryIsSelected(elemPtr); - if (elemPtr->labelActive_) - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, ops->activeBg, - x, y, entryWidth_, entryHeight_, - ops->entryBW, ops->activeRelief); - else if (isSelected) { - XColor* fg = (flags & FOCUS) ? - ops->selInFocusFgColor : ops->selOutFocusFgColor; - Tk_3DBorder bg = (flags & FOCUS) ? - ops->selInFocusBg : ops->selOutFocusBg; - ops->style.color = fg; - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, bg, x, y, - entryWidth_, entryHeight_, - ops->selBW, ops->selRelief); - } - else { - ops->style.color = ops->fgColor; - if (elemOps->legendRelief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, gops->normalBg, - x, y, entryWidth_, - entryHeight_, ops->entryBW, - elemOps->legendRelief); - } - elemPtr->drawSymbol(pixmap, x + xSymbol, y + ySymbol, symbolSize); - - ts.drawText(pixmap, elemOps->label, x+xLabel, y+ops->entryBW+ops->iyPad); - count++; - - if (focusPtr_ == elemPtr) { - if (isSelected) { - XColor* color = (flags & FOCUS) ? - ops->selInFocusFgColor : ops->selOutFocusFgColor; - XSetForeground(graphPtr_->display_, focusGC_, color->pixel); - } - XDrawRectangle(graphPtr_->display_, pixmap, focusGC_, - x + 1, y + 1, entryWidth_ - 3, - entryHeight_ - 3); - if (isSelected) - XSetForeground(graphPtr_->display_, focusGC_, ops->focusColor->pixel); - } - - // Check when to move to the next column - if ((count % nRows_) > 0) - y += entryHeight_; - else { - x += entryWidth_; - y = yStart; - } - } - - Tk_3DBorder bg = ops->normalBg; - if (!bg) - bg = gops->normalBg; - - Tk_Draw3DRectangle(tkwin, pixmap, bg, 0, 0, w, h, - ops->borderWidth, ops->relief); - XCopyArea(graphPtr_->display_, pixmap, drawable, graphPtr_->drawGC_, - 0, 0, w, h, x_, y_); - - Tk_FreePixmap(graphPtr_->display_, pixmap); -} - -void Legend::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)graphPtr_->postscript_->ops_; - - if ((ops->hide) || (nEntries_ == 0)) - return; - - setOrigin(); - - double x = x_; - double y = y_; - int width = width_ - 2*ops->xPad; - int height = height_ - 2*ops->yPad; - - psPtr->append("% Legend\n"); - if (pops->decorations) { - if (ops->normalBg) - psPtr->fill3DRectangle(ops->normalBg, x, y, width, height, - ops->borderWidth, ops->relief); - else - psPtr->print3DRectangle(gops->normalBg, x, y, width, height, - ops->borderWidth, ops->relief); - - } - else { - psPtr->setClearBackground(); - psPtr->fillRectangle(x, y, width, height); - } - - Tk_FontMetrics fontMetrics; - Tk_GetFontMetrics(ops->style.font, &fontMetrics); - int symbolSize = fontMetrics.ascent; - int xMid = symbolSize + 1 + ops->entryBW; - int yMid = (symbolSize / 2) + 1 + ops->entryBW; - int xLabel = 2 * symbolSize + ops->entryBW + ops->ixPad + 5; - int xSymbol = xMid + ops->ixPad; - int ySymbol = yMid + ops->iyPad; - - x += ops->borderWidth; - y += ops->borderWidth; - TextStyle tts(graphPtr_, &ops->titleStyle); - tts.printText(psPtr, ops->title, x, y); - if (titleHeight_ > 0) - y += titleHeight_ + ops->yPad; - - int count = 0; - double yStart = y; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - if (elemPtr->labelActive_) { - ops->style.color = ops->activeFgColor; - psPtr->fill3DRectangle(ops->activeBg, x, y, entryWidth_, - entryHeight_, ops->entryBW, - ops->activeRelief); - } - else { - ops->style.color = ops->fgColor; - if (elemOps->legendRelief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) - psPtr->print3DRectangle(gops->normalBg, x, y, entryWidth_, entryHeight_, - ops->entryBW, elemOps->legendRelief); - } - elemPtr->printSymbol(psPtr, x + xSymbol, y + ySymbol, symbolSize); - ts.printText(psPtr, elemOps->label, x + xLabel, - y + ops->entryBW + ops->iyPad); - count++; - - if ((count % nRows_) > 0) - y += entryHeight_; - else { - x += entryWidth_; - y = yStart; - } - } -} - -void Legend::removeElement(Element* elemPtr) -{ - bindTable_->deleteBindings(elemPtr); -} - -void Legend::eventuallyInvokeSelectCmd() -{ - if ((flags & SELECT_PENDING) == 0) { - flags |= SELECT_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(SelectCmdProc, this); - } -} - -void Legend::setOrigin() -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - - int x =0; - int y =0; - int w =0; - int h =0; - switch ((Position)ops->position) { - case RIGHT: - w = gops->rightMargin.width - gops->rightMargin.axesOffset; - h = graphPtr_->bottom_ - graphPtr_->top_; - x = graphPtr_->right_ + gops->rightMargin.axesOffset; - y = graphPtr_->top_; - break; - - case LEFT: - w = gops->leftMargin.width - gops->leftMargin.axesOffset; - h = graphPtr_->bottom_ - graphPtr_->top_; - x = graphPtr_->inset_; - y = graphPtr_->top_; - break; - - case TOP: - w = graphPtr_->right_ - graphPtr_->left_; - h = gops->topMargin.height - gops->topMargin.axesOffset; - if (gops->title) - h -= graphPtr_->titleHeight_; - - x = graphPtr_->left_; - y = graphPtr_->inset_; - if (gops->title) - y += graphPtr_->titleHeight_; - break; - - case BOTTOM: - w = graphPtr_->right_ - graphPtr_->left_; - h = gops->bottomMargin.height - gops->bottomMargin.axesOffset; - x = graphPtr_->left_; - y = graphPtr_->bottom_ + gops->bottomMargin.axesOffset; - break; - - case PLOT: - w = graphPtr_->right_ - graphPtr_->left_; - h = graphPtr_->bottom_ - graphPtr_->top_; - x = graphPtr_->left_; - y = graphPtr_->top_; - break; - - case XY: - w = width_; - h = height_; - x = ops->xReq; - y = ops->yReq; - if (x < 0) - x += graphPtr_->width_; - - if (y < 0) - y += graphPtr_->height_; - break; - } - - switch (ops->anchor) { - case TK_ANCHOR_NW: - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_W: - if (h > height_) - y += (h - height_) / 2; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SW: - if (h > height_) - y += (h - height_); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_N: - if (w > width_) - x += (w - width_) / 2; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_CENTER: - if (h > height_) - y += (h - height_) / 2; - - if (w > width_) - x += (w - width_) / 2; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_S: - if (w > width_) - x += (w - width_) / 2; - - if (h > height_) - y += (h - height_); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_NE: - if (w > width_) - x += w - width_; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_E: - if (w > width_) - x += w - width_; - - if (h > height_) - y += (h - height_) / 2; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SE: - if (w > width_) { - x += w - width_; - } - if (h > height_) { - y += (h - height_); - } - break; - } - - x_ = x + ops->xPad; - y_ = y + ops->yPad; -} - -void Legend::selectEntry(Element* elemPtr) -{ - switch (flags & SELECT_TOGGLE) { - case SELECT_CLEAR: - deselectElement(elemPtr); - break; - case SELECT_SET: - selectElement(elemPtr); - break; - case SELECT_TOGGLE: - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&selectTable_, (char*)elemPtr); - if (hPtr) - deselectElement(elemPtr); - else - selectElement(elemPtr); - break; - } -} - -void Legend::selectElement(Element* elemPtr) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&selectTable_, (char*)elemPtr, &isNew); - if (isNew) { - ChainLink* link = selected_->append(elemPtr); - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, link); - } -} - -void Legend::deselectElement(Element* elemPtr) -{ - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&selectTable_, (char*)elemPtr); - if (hPtr) { - ChainLink* link = (ChainLink*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - selected_->deleteLink(link); - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hPtr); - } -} - - -int Legend::selectRange(Element *fromPtr, Element *toPtr) -{ - int isBefore=0; - for (ChainLink* linkPtr = fromPtr->link; linkPtr; linkPtr = linkPtr->next()) - if (linkPtr == toPtr->link) - isBefore =1; - - if (isBefore) { - for (ChainLink* link = fromPtr->link; link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - selectEntry(elemPtr); - if (link == toPtr->link) - break; - } - } - else { - for (ChainLink* link = fromPtr->link; link; link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - selectEntry(elemPtr); - if (link == toPtr->link) - break; - } - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Legend::clearSelection() -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&selectTable_); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&selectTable_, TCL_ONE_WORD_KEYS); - selected_->reset(); - - if (ops->selectCmd) - eventuallyInvokeSelectCmd(); -} - -int Legend::entryIsSelected(Element* elemPtr) -{ - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&selectTable_, (char*)elemPtr); - return (hPtr != NULL); -} - -int Legend::getElementFromObj(Tcl_Obj* objPtr, Element** elemPtrPtr) -{ - const char *string = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - Element* elemPtr = NULL; - - if (!strcmp(string, "anchor")) - elemPtr = selAnchorPtr_; - else if (!strcmp(string, "current")) - elemPtr = (Element*)bindTable_->currentItem(); - else if (!strcmp(string, "first")) - elemPtr = getFirstElement(); - else if (!strcmp(string, "focus")) - elemPtr = focusPtr_; - else if (!strcmp(string, "last")) - elemPtr = getLastElement(); - else if (!strcmp(string, "end")) - elemPtr = getLastElement(); - else if (!strcmp(string, "next.row")) - elemPtr = getNextRow(focusPtr_); - else if (!strcmp(string, "next.column")) - elemPtr = getNextColumn(focusPtr_); - else if (!strcmp(string, "previous.row")) - elemPtr = getPreviousRow(focusPtr_); - else if (!strcmp(string, "previous.column")) - elemPtr = getPreviousColumn(focusPtr_); - else if (string[0] == '@') { - int x, y; - if (graphPtr_->getXY(string, &x, &y) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - ClassId classId; - elemPtr = (Element*)pickEntry(x, y, &classId); - } - else { - if (graphPtr_->getElement(objPtr, &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (!elemPtr->link) { - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr_->interp_, "bad legend index \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (!elemOps->label) - elemPtr = NULL; - } - - *elemPtrPtr = elemPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -Element* Legend::getNextRow(Element* focusPtr) -{ - unsigned col = focusPtr->col_; - unsigned row = focusPtr->row_ + 1; - for (ChainLink* link = focusPtr->link; link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - if ((elemPtr->col_ == col) && (elemPtr->row_ == row)) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -Element* Legend::getNextColumn(Element* focusPtr) -{ - unsigned col = focusPtr->col_ + 1; - unsigned row = focusPtr->row_; - for (ChainLink* link = focusPtr->link; link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - if ((elemPtr->col_ == col) && (elemPtr->row_ == row)) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -Element* Legend::getPreviousRow(Element* focusPtr) -{ - unsigned col = focusPtr->col_; - unsigned row = focusPtr->row_ - 1; - for (ChainLink* link = focusPtr->link; link; link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - if ((elemPtr->col_ == col) && (elemPtr->row_ == row)) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -Element* Legend::getPreviousColumn(Element* focusPtr) -{ - unsigned col = focusPtr->col_ - 1; - unsigned row = focusPtr->row_; - for (ChainLink* link = focusPtr->link; link; link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - - if (!elemOps->label) - continue; - - if ((elemPtr->col_ == col) && (elemPtr->row_ == row)) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -Element* Legend::getFirstElement() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (elemOps->label) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -Element* Legend::getLastElement() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (elemOps->label) - return elemPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -ClientData Legend::pickEntry(int xx, int yy, ClassId* classIdPtr) -{ - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)ops_; - - int ww = width_; - int hh = height_; - - if (titleHeight_ > 0) - yy -= titleHeight_ + ops->yPad; - - xx -= x_ + ops->borderWidth; - yy -= y_ + ops->borderWidth; - ww -= 2 * ops->borderWidth + 2*ops->xPad; - hh -= 2 * ops->borderWidth + 2*ops->yPad; - - // In the bounding box? if so, compute the index - if (xx >= 0 && xx < ww && yy >= 0 && yy < hh) { - int row = yy / entryHeight_; - int column = xx / entryWidth_; - int nn = (column * nRows_) + row; - - // Legend entries are stored in bottom-to-top - if (nn < nEntries_) { - int count = 0; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr_->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemOps = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (elemOps->label) { - if (count == nn) { - *classIdPtr = elemPtr->classId(); - return elemPtr; - } - count++; - } - } - } - } - - return NULL; -} - -// Support - -static int SelectionProc(ClientData clientData, int offset, char *buffer, - int maxBytes) -{ - Legend* legendPtr = (Legend*)clientData; - Graph* graphPtr = legendPtr->graphPtr_; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - - if ((ops->exportSelection) == 0) - return -1; - - // Retrieve the names of the selected entries - Tcl_DString dString; - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString); - if (legendPtr->flags & SELECT_SORTED) { - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_FirstLink(legendPtr->selected_); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString, elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString, "\n", -1); - } - } - else { - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (legendPtr->entryIsSelected(elemPtr)) { - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString, elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString, "\n", -1); - } - } - } - - int nBytes = Tcl_DStringLength(&dString) - offset; - strncpy(buffer, Tcl_DStringValue(&dString) + offset, maxBytes); - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - buffer[maxBytes] = '\0'; - return MIN(nBytes, maxBytes); -} - -static void SelectCmdProc(ClientData clientData) -{ - Legend* legendPtr = (Legend*)clientData; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - - Tcl_Preserve(legendPtr); - legendPtr->flags &= ~SELECT_PENDING; - if (ops->selectCmd) { - Tcl_Interp* interp = legendPtr->graphPtr_->interp_; - if (Tcl_GlobalEval(interp, ops->selectCmd) != TCL_OK) - Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); - } - Tcl_Release(legendPtr); -} - - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.h deleted file mode 100644 index 66ffbc1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegd.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,178 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrLegend_h__ -#define __BltGrLegend_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrText.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class Pick; - class Element; - - /* - * Selection related flags: - * SELECT_PENDING A "selection" command idle task is pending. - * SELECT_CLEAR Clear selection flag of entry. - * SELECT_SET Set selection flag of entry. - * SELECT_TOGGLE Toggle selection flag of entry. - * Mask of selection set/clear/toggle flags. - * SELECT_SORTED Indicates if the entries in the selection - * should be sorted or displayed in the order - * they were selected. - */ - -#define SELECT_CLEAR (1<<24) -#define SELECT_PENDING (1<<25) -#define SELECT_SET (1<<26) -#define SELECT_SORTED (1<<27) -#define SELECT_TOGGLE (SELECT_SET | SELECT_CLEAR) - - typedef enum { - SELECT_MODE_SINGLE, SELECT_MODE_MULTIPLE - } SelectMode; - - typedef struct { - Tk_3DBorder activeBg; - XColor* activeFgColor; - int activeRelief; - Tk_3DBorder normalBg; - XColor* fgColor; - Tk_Anchor anchor; - int borderWidth; - int reqColumns; - int exportSelection; - Dashes focusDashes; - XColor* focusColor; - TextStyleOptions style; - int hide; - int ixPad; - int iyPad; - int xPad; - int yPad; - int raised; - int relief; - int reqRows; - int entryBW; - int selBW; - int xReq; - int yReq; - int position; - const char *selectCmd; - Tk_3DBorder selOutFocusBg; - Tk_3DBorder selInFocusBg; - XColor* selOutFocusFgColor; - XColor* selInFocusFgColor; - SelectMode selectMode; - int selRelief; - const char *title; - TextStyleOptions titleStyle; - } LegendOptions; - - class Legend : public Pick { - public: - enum Position {RIGHT, LEFT, TOP, BOTTOM, PLOT, XY}; - - protected: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - GC focusGC_; - Tcl_HashTable selectTable_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - unsigned int flags; - - int width_; - int height_; - int x_; - int y_; - - int nEntries_; - int nColumns_; - int nRows_; - int entryWidth_; - int entryHeight_; - BindTable* bindTable_; - Element* focusPtr_; - Element* selAnchorPtr_; - Element* selMarkPtr_; - Chain* selected_; - int titleWidth_; - int titleHeight_; - - protected: - void setOrigin(); - Element* getNextRow(Element*); - Element* getNextColumn(Element*); - Element* getPreviousRow(Element*); - Element* getPreviousColumn(Element*); - Element* getFirstElement(); - Element* getLastElement(); - - public: - Legend(Graph*); - virtual ~Legend(); - - int configure(); - void map(int, int); - void draw(Drawable drawable); - void print(PSOutput* ps); - void eventuallyInvokeSelectCmd(); - - void removeElement(Element*); - int getElementFromObj(Tcl_Obj*, Element**); - - void selectEntry(Element*); - void selectElement(Element*); - void deselectElement(Element*); - int selectRange(Element*, Element*); - void clearSelection(); - int entryIsSelected(Element*); - - void* ops() {return ops_;} - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - - Position position() {return (Position)((LegendOptions*)ops_)->position;} - int isRaised() {return ((LegendOptions*)ops_)->raised;} - int isHidden() {return ((LegendOptions*)ops_)->hide;} - - ClientData pickEntry(int, int, ClassId*); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 139d2f1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,496 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegdOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_LostSelProc LostSelectionProc; - -static int LegendObjConfigure(Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)legendPtr->ops(), - legendPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (legendPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc != 4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)legendPtr->ops(), - legendPtr->optionTable(), - objv[3], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - if (objc <= 4) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)legendPtr->ops(), - legendPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 4) ? objv[3] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return LegendObjConfigure(graphPtr, interp, objc-3, objv+3); -} - -static int ActivateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - - const char *string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - int active = (string[0] == 'a') ? 1 : 0; - int redraw = 0; - for (int ii=3; iielements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (Tcl_StringMatch(elemPtr->name_, pattern)) { - if (active) { - if (!elemPtr->labelActive_) { - elemPtr->labelActive_ =1; - redraw = 1; - } - } - else { - if (elemPtr->labelActive_) { - elemPtr->labelActive_ =0; - redraw = 1; - } - } - } - } - } - - if (redraw && !ops->hide) { - graphPtr->flags |= LAYOUT; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } - - // List active elements in stacking order - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (elemPtr->labelActive_) { - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int BindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->elements_.tagTable, &iter); hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - char* tagName = - (char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&graphPtr->elements_.tagTable, hPtr); - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(tagName, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - - return graphPtr->legend_->bindTable_->configure(graphPtr->elementTag(Tcl_GetString(objv[3])), objc - 4, objv + 4); -} - -static int CurselectionOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (legendPtr->flags & SELECT_SORTED) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(legendPtr->selected_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - } - else { - // List of selected entries is in stacking order - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - - if (legendPtr->entryIsSelected(elemPtr)) { - Tcl_Obj *objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(elemPtr->name_, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int FocusOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - - legendPtr->focusPtr_ = NULL; - if (objc == 4) { - Element* elemPtr; - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (elemPtr) { - legendPtr->focusPtr_ = elemPtr; - - legendPtr->bindTable_->focusItem_ = (ClientData)elemPtr; - legendPtr->bindTable_->focusContext_ = elemPtr->classId(); - } - } - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - if (legendPtr->focusPtr_) - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp),legendPtr->focusPtr_->name_,-1); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int GetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<3) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - - if (((ops->hide) == 0) && (legendPtr->nEntries_ > 0)) { - Element* elemPtr; - - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[3], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (elemPtr) - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), elemPtr->name_, -1); - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::legendEnsemble[] = { - {"activate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"bind", BindOp, 0}, - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"curselection", CurselectionOp, 0}, - {"deactivate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"focus", FocusOp, 0}, - {"get", GetOp, 0}, - {"selection", 0, selectionEnsemble}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Selection Ops - -static int SelectionAnchorOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - Element* elemPtr; - - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[4], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Set both the anchor and the mark. Indicates that a single entry - // is selected - legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_ = elemPtr; - legendPtr->selMarkPtr_ = NULL; - if (elemPtr) - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), elemPtr->name_, -1); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SelectionClearallOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - legendPtr->clearSelection(); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SelectionIncludesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - Element* elemPtr; - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[4], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int boo = legendPtr->entryIsSelected(elemPtr); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), boo); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SelectionMarkOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - Element* elemPtr; - - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[4], &elemPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_ == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "selection anchor must be set first", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (legendPtr->selMarkPtr_ != elemPtr) { - // Deselect entry from the list all the way back to the anchor - ChainLink *link, *next; - for (link = Chain_LastLink(legendPtr->selected_); link; link = next) { - next = Chain_PrevLink(link); - Element *selectPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if (selectPtr == legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_) - break; - - legendPtr->deselectElement(selectPtr); - } - - legendPtr->flags &= ~SELECT_TOGGLE; - legendPtr->flags |= SELECT_SET; - legendPtr->selectRange(legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_, elemPtr); - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), elemPtr->name_, -1); - legendPtr->selMarkPtr_ = elemPtr; - - if (ops->selectCmd) - legendPtr->eventuallyInvokeSelectCmd(); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SelectionPresentOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - int boo = (Chain_GetLength(legendPtr->selected_) > 0); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), boo); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SelectionSetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Legend* legendPtr = graphPtr->legend_; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - - legendPtr->flags &= ~SELECT_TOGGLE; - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - switch (string[0]) { - case 's': - legendPtr->flags |= SELECT_SET; - break; - case 'c': - legendPtr->flags |= SELECT_CLEAR; - break; - case 't': - legendPtr->flags |= SELECT_TOGGLE; - break; - } - - Element *firstPtr; - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[4], &firstPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)firstPtr->ops(); - - if ((eops->hide) && ((legendPtr->flags & SELECT_CLEAR)==0)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't select hidden node \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[4]), "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* lastPtr = firstPtr; - if (objc > 5) { - if (legendPtr->getElementFromObj(objv[5], &lastPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)firstPtr->ops(); - - if (eops->hide && ((legendPtr->flags & SELECT_CLEAR) == 0)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't select hidden node \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[5]), "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - - if (firstPtr == lastPtr) - legendPtr->selectEntry(firstPtr); - else - legendPtr->selectRange(firstPtr, lastPtr); - - // Set both the anchor and the mark. Indicates that a single entry is - // selected - if (legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_ == NULL) - legendPtr->selAnchorPtr_ = firstPtr; - - if (ops->exportSelection) - Tk_OwnSelection(graphPtr->tkwin_, XA_PRIMARY, LostSelectionProc, legendPtr); - - if (ops->selectCmd) - legendPtr->eventuallyInvokeSelectCmd(); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::selectionEnsemble[] = { - {"anchor", SelectionAnchorOp, 0}, - {"clear", SelectionSetOp, 0}, - {"clearall", SelectionClearallOp, 0}, - {"includes", SelectionIncludesOp, 0}, - {"mark", SelectionMarkOp, 0}, - {"present", SelectionPresentOp, 0}, - {"set", SelectionSetOp, 0}, - {"toggle", SelectionSetOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Support - -static void LostSelectionProc(ClientData clientData) -{ - Legend* legendPtr = (Legend*)clientData; - LegendOptions* ops = (LegendOptions*)legendPtr->ops(); - Graph* graphPtr = legendPtr->graphPtr_; - - if (ops->exportSelection) - legendPtr->clearSelection(); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); -} - - - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 6369a2b..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrLegdOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,40 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrLegdOp_h__ -#define __BltGrLegdOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble legendEnsemble[]; - extern const Ensemble selectionEnsemble[]; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.C deleted file mode 100644 index 6f701f8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,177 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -Marker::Marker(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) -{ - optionTable_ =NULL; - ops_ =NULL; - - graphPtr_ =graphPtr; - name_ = dupstr(name); - hashPtr_ = hPtr; - link =NULL; - flags =0; - clipped_ =0; -} - -Marker::~Marker() -{ - graphPtr_->bindTable_->deleteBindings(this); - - if (link) - graphPtr_->markers_.displayList->deleteLink(link); - - if (hashPtr_) - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hashPtr_); - - delete [] name_; - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - -double Marker::HMap(Axis *axisPtr, double x) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - - if (x == DBL_MAX) - x = 1.0; - else if (x == -DBL_MAX) - x = 0.0; - else { - if (ops->logScale) { - if (x > 0.0) - x = log10(x); - else if (x < 0.0) - x = 0.0; - } - x = (x - axisPtr->axisRange_.min) * axisPtr->axisRange_.scale; - } - if (ops->descending) - x = 1.0 - x; - - // Horizontal transformation - return (x * axisPtr->screenRange_ + axisPtr->screenMin_); -} - -double Marker::VMap(Axis *axisPtr, double y) -{ - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - - if (y == DBL_MAX) - y = 1.0; - else if (y == -DBL_MAX) - y = 0.0; - else { - if (ops->logScale) { - if (y > 0.0) - y = log10(y); - else if (y < 0.0) - y = 0.0; - } - y = (y - axisPtr->axisRange_.min) * axisPtr->axisRange_.scale; - } - if (ops->descending) - y = 1.0 - y; - - // Vertical transformation - return (((1.0 - y) * axisPtr->screenRange_) + axisPtr->screenMin_); -} - -Point2d Marker::mapPoint(Point2d* pointPtr, Axis* xAxis, Axis* yAxis) -{ - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - Point2d result; - if (gops->inverted) { - result.x = HMap(yAxis, pointPtr->y); - result.y = VMap(xAxis, pointPtr->x); - } - else { - result.x = HMap(xAxis, pointPtr->x); - result.y = VMap(yAxis, pointPtr->y); - } - - return result; -} - -int Marker::boxesDontOverlap(Graph* graphPtr_, Region2d *extsPtr) -{ - return (((double)graphPtr_->right_ < extsPtr->left) || - ((double)graphPtr_->bottom_ < extsPtr->top) || - (extsPtr->right < (double)graphPtr_->left_) || - (extsPtr->bottom < (double)graphPtr_->top_)); -} - -int Marker::regionInPolygon(Region2d *regionPtr, Point2d *points, int nPoints, - int enclosed) -{ - if (enclosed) { - // All points of the polygon must be inside the rectangle. - for (Point2d *pp = points, *pend = pp + nPoints; pp < pend; pp++) { - if ((pp->x < regionPtr->left) || (pp->x > regionPtr->right) || - (pp->y < regionPtr->top) || (pp->y > regionPtr->bottom)) { - return 0; /* One point is exterior. */ - } - } - return 1; - } - else { - // If any segment of the polygon clips the bounding region, the - // polygon overlaps the rectangle. - points[nPoints] = points[0]; - for (Point2d *pp = points, *pend = pp + nPoints; pp < pend; pp++) { - Point2d p = *pp; - Point2d q = *(pp + 1); - if (lineRectClip(regionPtr, &p, &q)) - return 1; - } - - // Otherwise the polygon and rectangle are either disjoint or - // enclosed. Check if one corner of the rectangle is inside the polygon. - Point2d r; - r.x = regionPtr->left; - r.y = regionPtr->top; - - return pointInPolygon(&r, points, nPoints); - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.h deleted file mode 100644 index 573357d..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarker.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,103 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrMarker_h__ -#define __BltGrMarker_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltChain.h" - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class Postscript; - class Axis; - - typedef struct { - Point2d* points; - int num; - } Coords; - - typedef struct { - const char** tags; - Coords* worldPts; - const char* elemName; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - int hide; - int drawUnder; - int xOffset; - int yOffset; - } MarkerOptions; - - class Marker { - protected: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - const char *name_; - Tcl_HashEntry* hashPtr_; - ChainLink* link; - unsigned int flags; - int clipped_; - - protected: - double HMap(Axis*, double); - double VMap(Axis*, double); - Point2d mapPoint(Point2d*, Axis*, Axis*); - int boxesDontOverlap(Graph*, Region2d*); - int regionInPolygon(Region2d *extsPtr, Point2d *points, - int nPoints, int enclosed); - - public: - Marker(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~Marker(); - - virtual int configure() =0; - virtual void draw(Drawable) =0; - virtual void map() =0; - virtual int pointIn(Point2d*) =0; - virtual int regionIn(Region2d*, int) =0; - virtual void print(PSOutput*) =0; - - virtual ClassId classId() =0; - virtual const char* className() =0; - virtual const char* typeName() =0; - - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - void* ops() {return ops_;} - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.C deleted file mode 100644 index 82c9ab8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,298 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define BOUND(x, lo, hi) (((x) > (hi)) ? (hi) : ((x) < (lo)) ? (lo) : (x)) - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "Line all", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-cap", "cap", "Cap", - "butt", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, capStyle), - 0, &capStyleObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-coords", "coords", "Coords", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, worldPts), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &coordsObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-dashes", "dashes", "Dashes", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, dashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-dashoffset", "dashOffset", "DashOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, dashes.offset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-element", "element", "Element", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, elemName), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-fill", "fill", "Fill", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, fillColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-join", "join", "Join", - "miter", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, joinStyle), - 0, &joinStyleObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "LineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, lineWidth), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, hide), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapx", "mapX", "MapX", - "x", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, xAxis), 0, &xAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapy", "mapY", "MapY", - "y", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, yAxis), 0, &yAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, outlineColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-under", "under", "Under", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, drawUnder), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-xoffset", "xOffset", "XOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, xOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-yoffset", "yOffset", "YOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineMarkerOptions, yOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -LineMarker::LineMarker(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Marker(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - ops_ = (LineMarkerOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(LineMarkerOptions)); - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - - gc_ =NULL; - segments_ =NULL; - nSegments_ =0; -} - -LineMarker::~LineMarker() -{ - if (gc_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(gc_); - delete [] segments_; -} - -int LineMarker::configure() -{ - LineMarkerOptions* ops = (LineMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - unsigned long gcMask = (GCLineWidth | GCLineStyle | GCCapStyle | GCJoinStyle); - XGCValues gcValues; - if (ops->outlineColor) { - gcMask |= GCForeground; - gcValues.foreground = ops->outlineColor->pixel; - } - if (ops->fillColor) { - gcMask |= GCBackground; - gcValues.background = ops->fillColor->pixel; - } - gcValues.cap_style = ops->capStyle; - gcValues.join_style = ops->joinStyle; - gcValues.line_width = ops->lineWidth; - gcValues.line_style = LineSolid; - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) { - gcValues.line_style = - (gcMask & GCBackground) ? LineDoubleDash : LineOnOffDash; - } - - GC newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (gc_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(gc_); - - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->dashes); - gc_ = newGC; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void LineMarker::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - if (nSegments_ > 0) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, gc_, segments_, nSegments_); -} - -void LineMarker::map() -{ - LineMarkerOptions* ops = (LineMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - delete [] segments_; - segments_ = NULL; - nSegments_ = 0; - - if (!ops->worldPts || (ops->worldPts->num < 2)) - return; - - Region2d extents; - graphPtr_->extents(&extents); - - // Allow twice the number of world coordinates. The line will represented - // as series of line segments, not one continous polyline. This is - // because clipping against the plot area may chop the line into several - // disconnected segments. - - Segment2d* segments = new Segment2d[ops->worldPts->num]; - Point2d* srcPtr = ops->worldPts->points; - Point2d p = mapPoint(srcPtr, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - p.x += ops->xOffset; - p.y += ops->yOffset; - - Segment2d* segPtr = segments; - Point2d* pend; - for (srcPtr++, pend = ops->worldPts->points + ops->worldPts->num; - srcPtr < pend; srcPtr++) { - Point2d next = mapPoint(srcPtr, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - next.x += ops->xOffset; - next.y += ops->yOffset; - Point2d q = next; - - if (lineRectClip(&extents, &p, &q)) { - segPtr->p = p; - segPtr->q = q; - segPtr++; - } - p = next; - } - nSegments_ = segPtr - segments; - segments_ = segments; - clipped_ = (nSegments_ == 0); -} - -int LineMarker::pointIn(Point2d *samplePtr) -{ - GraphOptions* gops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr_->ops_; - return pointInSegments(samplePtr, segments_, nSegments_, - (double)gops->search.halo); -} - -int LineMarker::pointInSegments(Point2d* samplePtr, Segment2d* segments, - int nSegments, double halo) -{ - double minDist = DBL_MAX; - for (Segment2d *sp = segments, *send = sp + nSegments; sp < send; sp++) { - Point2d t = getProjection((int)samplePtr->x, (int)samplePtr->y, - &sp->p, &sp->q); - double right; - double left; - if (sp->p.x > sp->q.x) { - right = sp->p.x; - left = sp->q.x; - } - else { - right = sp->q.x; - left = sp->p.x; - } - - double top; - double bottom; - if (sp->p.y > sp->q.y) { - bottom = sp->p.y; - top = sp->q.y; - } - else { - bottom = sp->q.y; - top = sp->p.y; - } - - Point2d p; - p.x = BOUND(t.x, left, right); - p.y = BOUND(t.y, top, bottom); - - double dist = hypot(p.x - samplePtr->x, p.y - samplePtr->y); - if (dist < minDist) - minDist = dist; - } - - return (minDist < halo); -} - -int LineMarker::regionIn(Region2d *extsPtr, int enclosed) -{ - LineMarkerOptions* ops = (LineMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (!ops->worldPts || ops->worldPts->num < 2) - return 0; - - if (enclosed) { - for (Point2d *pp = ops->worldPts->points, *pend = pp + ops->worldPts->num; - pp < pend; pp++) { - Point2d p = mapPoint(pp, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - if ((p.x < extsPtr->left) && (p.x > extsPtr->right) && - (p.y < extsPtr->top) && (p.y > extsPtr->bottom)) { - return 0; - } - } - return 1; - } - else { - int count = 0; - for (Point2d *pp=ops->worldPts->points, *pend=pp+(ops->worldPts->num - 1); - pp < pend; pp++) { - Point2d p = mapPoint(pp, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - Point2d q = mapPoint(pp + 1, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - if (lineRectClip(extsPtr, &p, &q)) - count++; - } - return (count > 0); /* At least 1 segment passes through - * region. */ - } -} - -void LineMarker::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - LineMarkerOptions* ops = (LineMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (nSegments_ > 0) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(ops->outlineColor, ops->lineWidth, - &ops->dashes, ops->capStyle, ops->joinStyle); - if ((LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) && (ops->fillColor)) { - psPtr->append("/DashesProc {\n gsave\n "); - psPtr->setBackground(ops->fillColor); - psPtr->append(" "); - psPtr->setDashes(NULL); - psPtr->append("stroke\n"); - psPtr->append("grestore\n"); - psPtr->append("} def\n"); - } - else - psPtr->append("/DashesProc {} def\n"); - - psPtr->printSegments(segments_, nSegments_); - } -} - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.h deleted file mode 100644 index 3191951..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerLine.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,82 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrMarkerLine_h__ -#define __BltGrMarkerLine_h__ - -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - const char** tags; - Coords* worldPts; - const char* elemName; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - int hide; - int drawUnder; - int xOffset; - int yOffset; - - int capStyle; - Dashes dashes; - XColor* fillColor; - int joinStyle; - int lineWidth; - XColor* outlineColor; - } LineMarkerOptions; - - class LineMarker : public Marker { - protected: - GC gc_; - Segment2d* segments_; - int nSegments_; - - protected: - int configure(); - void draw(Drawable); - void map(); - int pointIn(Point2d*); - int regionIn(Region2d*, int); - void print(PSOutput*); - int pointInSegments(Point2d *samplePtr, Segment2d *segments, - int nSegments, double halo); - - public: - LineMarker(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~LineMarker(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_MARKER_LINE;} - const char* className() {return "LineMarker";} - const char* typeName() {return "line";} - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 0865556..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,495 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerText.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static int GetMarkerFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Graph* graphPtr, - Tcl_Obj* objPtr, Marker** markerPtrPtr); - -#define FIND_ENCLOSED (1<<0) -#define FIND_OVERLAPPING (1<<1) - -static int MarkerObjConfigure( Graph* graphPtr,Marker* markerPtr, - Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)markerPtr->ops(), - markerPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - markerPtr->flags |= MAP_ITEM; - if (markerPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - MarkerOptions* ops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - if (ops->drawUnder) - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CreateMarker(Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int offset = 5; - const char* name =NULL; - ostringstream str; - if (objc == 4) { - offset = 4; - str << "marker" << graphPtr->nextMarkerId_++ << ends; - name = dupstr(str.str().c_str()); - } - else { - name = dupstr(Tcl_GetString(objv[4])); - if (name[0] == '-') { - delete [] name; - offset = 4; - str << "marker" << graphPtr->nextMarkerId_++ << ends; - name = dupstr(str.str().c_str()); - } - } - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&graphPtr->markers_.table, name, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(graphPtr->interp_, "marker \"", name, - "\" already exists in \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), - "\"", NULL); - delete [] name; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - const char* type = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - Marker* markerPtr; - if (!strcmp(type, "line")) - markerPtr = new LineMarker(graphPtr, name, hPtr); - else if (!strcmp(type, "polygon")) - markerPtr = new PolygonMarker(graphPtr, name, hPtr); - else if (!strcmp(type, "text")) - markerPtr = new TextMarker(graphPtr, name, hPtr); - else { - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hPtr); - delete [] name; - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown marker type ", type, NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, markerPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr->interp_, (char*)markerPtr->ops(), markerPtr->optionTable(), graphPtr->tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (MarkerObjConfigure(graphPtr, markerPtr, interp, objc-offset, objv+offset) != TCL_OK)) { - delete markerPtr; - delete [] name; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // Unlike elements, new markers are drawn on top of old markers - markerPtr->link = graphPtr->markers_.displayList->prepend(markerPtr); - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), name, -1); - - delete [] name; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Marker* markerPtr; - if (GetMarkerFromObj(interp, graphPtr, objv[3], &markerPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)markerPtr->ops(), - markerPtr->optionTable(), - objv[4], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId ?option value...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Marker* markerPtr; - if (GetMarkerFromObj(interp, graphPtr, objv[3], &markerPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc <= 5) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)markerPtr->ops(), - markerPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 5) ? objv[4] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return MarkerObjConfigure(graphPtr, markerPtr, interp, objc-4, objv+4); -} - -static int BindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hp = - Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->markers_.tagTable, &iter); - hp; hp = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - - const char* tag = - (const char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&graphPtr->markers_.tagTable, hp); - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tcl_NewStringObj(tag, -1); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, objPtr); - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } else if (objc >= 4) { - return graphPtr->bindTable_->configure(graphPtr->markerTag(Tcl_GetString(objv[3])), objc - 4, objv + 4); - } else { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId ?tag? ?sequence? ?command?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CreateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "markerId ?type? ?option value...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (CreateMarker(graphPtr, interp, objc, objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - // set in CreateMarker - // Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objv[3]); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeleteOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc<4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "markerId..."); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int res = TCL_OK; - - for (int ii=3; iimarkers_.table, string); - if (!hPtr) { - if (res == TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't find markers in \"", - Tk_PathName(graphPtr->tkwin_), "\":", NULL); - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " ", Tcl_GetString(objv[ii]), NULL); - res = TCL_ERROR; - } else { - markerPtr = (Marker*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - delete markerPtr; - } - } - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return res; -} - -static int ExistsOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_FindHashEntry(&graphPtr->markers_.table, Tcl_GetString(objv[3])); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), (hPtr != NULL)); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int FindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=8) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "searchtype left top right bottom"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - int mode; - if (strcmp(string, "enclosed") == 0) - mode = FIND_ENCLOSED; - else if (strcmp(string, "overlapping") == 0) - mode = FIND_OVERLAPPING; - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad search type \"", string, - ": should be \"enclosed\", or \"overlapping\"", - NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int left, right, top, bottom; - if ((Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[4], &left) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[5], &top) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[6], &right) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[7], &bottom) != TCL_OK)) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Region2d extents; - if (left < right) { - extents.left = (double)left; - extents.right = (double)right; - } - else { - extents.left = (double)right; - extents.right = (double)left; - } - if (top < bottom) { - extents.top = (double)top; - extents.bottom = (double)bottom; - } - else { - extents.top = (double)bottom; - extents.bottom = (double)top; - } - - int enclosed = (mode == FIND_ENCLOSED); - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->markers_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - MarkerOptions* ops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - if (ops->hide) - continue; - - if (graphPtr->isElementHidden(markerPtr)) - continue; - - if (markerPtr->regionIn(&extents, enclosed)) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_SetStringObj(objPtr, markerPtr->name_, -1); - return TCL_OK; - } - } - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), "", -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NamesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (objc == 3) { - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->markers_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(markerPtr->name_, -1)); - } - } - else { - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_FirstLink(graphPtr->markers_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - for (int ii = 3; iiname_, pattern)) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(markerPtr->name_, -1)); - break; - } - } - } - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int RelinkOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4 && objc!=5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId ?placeId?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Marker* markerPtr; - if (GetMarkerFromObj(interp, graphPtr, objv[3], &markerPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Marker* placePtr =NULL; - if (objc == 5) - if (GetMarkerFromObj(interp, graphPtr, objv[4], &placePtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - ChainLink* link = markerPtr->link; - graphPtr->markers_.displayList->unlinkLink(markerPtr->link); - - ChainLink* place = placePtr ? placePtr->link : NULL; - - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - if (string[0] == 'l') - graphPtr->markers_.displayList->linkAfter(link, place); - else - graphPtr->markers_.displayList->linkBefore(link, place); - - graphPtr->flags |= CACHE; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int TypeOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc!=4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "markerId"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Marker* markerPtr; - if (GetMarkerFromObj(interp, graphPtr, objv[3], &markerPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), markerPtr->typeName(), -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::markerEnsemble[] = { - {"bind", BindOp, 0}, - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"create", CreateOp, 0}, - {"delete", DeleteOp, 0}, - {"exists", ExistsOp, 0}, - {"find", FindOp, 0}, - {"lower", RelinkOp, 0}, - {"names", NamesOp, 0}, - {"raise", RelinkOp, 0}, - {"type", TypeOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Support - -static int GetMarkerFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Graph* graphPtr, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, Marker** markerPtrPtr) -{ - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&graphPtr->markers_.table, string); - if (hPtr) { - *markerPtrPtr = (Marker*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - if (interp) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't find marker \"", string, - "\" in \"", Tk_PathName(graphPtr->tkwin_), "\"", NULL); - } - - return TCL_ERROR; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 6f7c16f..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,39 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __Blt_GrMarkerOp_h__ -#define __Blt_GrMarkerOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble markerEnsemble[]; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.C deleted file mode 100644 index 6b13fd9..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,209 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOption.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tcl_Obj* PrintCoordinate(double x); -static int GetCoordinate(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, double *valuePtr); - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc CoordsSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc CoordsGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc CoordsFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption coordsObjOption = - { - "coords", CoordsSetProc, CoordsGetProc, RestoreProc, CoordsFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int CoordsSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - Coords** coordsPtrPtr = (Coords**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)coordsPtrPtr; - - if (!coordsPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - int objc; - Tcl_Obj** objv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, *objPtr, &objc, &objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc == 0) { - *coordsPtrPtr = NULL; - return TCL_OK; - } - - if (objc & 1) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "odd number of marker coordinates specified",NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Coords* coordsPtr = new Coords; - coordsPtr->num = objc/2; - coordsPtr->points = new Point2d[coordsPtr->num]; - - Point2d* pp = coordsPtr->points; - for (int ii=0; iix = x; - pp->y = y; - pp++; - } - - *coordsPtrPtr = coordsPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* CoordsGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Coords* coordsPtr = *(Coords**)(widgRec + offset); - - if (!coordsPtr) - return Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); - - int cnt = coordsPtr->num*2; - Tcl_Obj** ll = new Tcl_Obj*[cnt]; - - Point2d* pp = coordsPtr->points; - for (int ii=0; iix); - ll[ii++] = PrintCoordinate(pp->y); - } - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(cnt, ll); - delete [] ll; - return listObjPtr; -} - -static void CoordsFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *ptr) -{ - Coords* coordsPtr = *(Coords**)ptr; - if (coordsPtr) { - delete [] coordsPtr->points; - delete coordsPtr; - } -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc CapStyleSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc CapStyleGetProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption capStyleObjOption = - { - "capStyle", CapStyleSetProc, CapStyleGetProc, NULL, NULL, NULL - }; - -static int CapStyleSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* save, int flags) -{ - int* ptr = (int*)(widgRec + offset); - - Tk_Uid uid = Tk_GetUid(Tcl_GetString(*objPtr)); - int cap; - if (Tk_GetCapStyle(interp, uid, &cap) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - *ptr = cap; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* CapStyleGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - int* ptr = (int*)(widgRec + offset); - return Tcl_NewStringObj(Tk_NameOfCapStyle(*ptr), -1); -} - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc JoinStyleSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc JoinStyleGetProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption joinStyleObjOption = - { - "joinStyle", JoinStyleSetProc, JoinStyleGetProc, NULL, NULL, NULL - }; - -static int JoinStyleSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* save, int flags) -{ - int* ptr = (int*)(widgRec + offset); - - Tk_Uid uid = Tk_GetUid(Tcl_GetString(*objPtr)); - int join; - if (Tk_GetJoinStyle(interp, uid, &join) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - *ptr = join; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* JoinStyleGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - int* ptr = (int*)(widgRec + offset); - return Tcl_NewStringObj(Tk_NameOfJoinStyle(*ptr), -1); -} - -static Tcl_Obj* PrintCoordinate(double x) -{ - if (x == DBL_MAX) - return Tcl_NewStringObj("+Inf", -1); - else if (x == -DBL_MAX) - return Tcl_NewStringObj("-Inf", -1); - else - return Tcl_NewDoubleObj(x); -} - -static int GetCoordinate(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, double *valuePtr) -{ - const char* expr = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - char c = expr[0]; - if ((c == 'I') && (strcmp(expr, "Inf") == 0)) - *valuePtr = DBL_MAX; /* Elastic upper bound */ - else if ((c == '-') && (expr[1] == 'I') && (strcmp(expr, "-Inf") == 0)) - *valuePtr = -DBL_MAX; /* Elastic lower bound */ - else if ((c == '+') && (expr[1] == 'I') && (strcmp(expr, "+Inf") == 0)) - *valuePtr = DBL_MAX; /* Elastic upper bound */ - else if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objPtr, valuePtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.h deleted file mode 100644 index 143810e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerOption.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,39 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __Blt_GrMarkerOption_h__ -#define __Blt_GrMarkerOption_h__ - -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption coordsObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption capStyleObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption joinStyleObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption xAxisObjOption; -extern Tk_ObjCustomOption yAxisObjOption; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C deleted file mode 100644 index 383d0e8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,298 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "Polygon all", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-cap", "cap", "Cap", - "butt", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, capStyle), - 0, &capStyleObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-coords", "coords", "Coords", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, worldPts), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &coordsObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-dashes", "dashes", "Dashes", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, dashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-element", "element", "Element", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, elemName), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-fill", "fill", "Fill", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, fill), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-join", "join", "Join", - "miter", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, joinStyle), - 0, &joinStyleObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "LineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, lineWidth), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, hide), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapx", "mapX", "MapX", - "x", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, xAxis), 0, &xAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapy", "mapY", "MapY", - "y", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, yAxis), 0, &yAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, outline), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-under", "under", "Under", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, drawUnder), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-xoffset", "xOffset", "XOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, xOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-yoffset", "yOffset", "YOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(PolygonMarkerOptions, yOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -PolygonMarker::PolygonMarker(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Marker(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - ops_ = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(PolygonMarkerOptions)); - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); - - screenPts_ =NULL; - outlineGC_ =NULL; - fillGC_ =NULL; - fillPts_ =NULL; - nFillPts_ =0; - outlinePts_ =NULL; - nOutlinePts_ =0; -} - -PolygonMarker::~PolygonMarker() -{ - if (fillGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, fillGC_); - if (outlineGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(outlineGC_); - delete [] fillPts_; - delete [] outlinePts_; - delete [] screenPts_; -} - -int PolygonMarker::configure() -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - // outlineGC - unsigned long gcMask = (GCLineWidth | GCLineStyle); - XGCValues gcValues; - if (ops->outline) { - gcMask |= GCForeground; - gcValues.foreground = ops->outline->pixel; - } - gcMask |= (GCCapStyle | GCJoinStyle); - gcValues.cap_style = ops->capStyle; - gcValues.join_style = ops->joinStyle; - gcValues.line_style = LineSolid; - gcValues.dash_offset = 0; - gcValues.line_width = ops->lineWidth; - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) - gcValues.line_style = LineOnOffDash; - - GC newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (LineIsDashed(ops->dashes)) - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->dashes); - if (outlineGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(outlineGC_); - outlineGC_ = newGC; - - // fillGC - gcMask = 0; - if (ops->fill) { - gcMask |= GCForeground; - gcValues.foreground = ops->fill->pixel; - } - newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (fillGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, fillGC_); - fillGC_ = newGC; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void PolygonMarker::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - // fill region - if ((nFillPts_ > 0) && (ops->fill)) { - XPoint* points = new XPoint[nFillPts_]; - if (!points) - return; - - XPoint* dp = points; - for (Point2d *sp = fillPts_, *send = sp + nFillPts_; sp < send; sp++) { - dp->x = (short)sp->x; - dp->y = (short)sp->y; - dp++; - } - - XFillPolygon(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, fillGC_, points, - nFillPts_, Complex, CoordModeOrigin); - delete [] points; - } - - // outline - if ((nOutlinePts_ > 0) && (ops->lineWidth > 0) && (ops->outline)) - graphPtr_->drawSegments(drawable, outlineGC_, outlinePts_, nOutlinePts_); -} - -void PolygonMarker::map() -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (outlinePts_) { - delete [] outlinePts_; - outlinePts_ = NULL; - nOutlinePts_ = 0; - } - - if (fillPts_) { - delete [] fillPts_; - fillPts_ = NULL; - nFillPts_ = 0; - } - - if (screenPts_) { - delete [] screenPts_; - screenPts_ = NULL; - } - - if (!ops->worldPts || ops->worldPts->num < 3) - return; - - // Allocate and fill a temporary array to hold the screen coordinates of - // the polygon. - - int nScreenPts = ops->worldPts->num + 1; - Point2d* screenPts = new Point2d[nScreenPts + 1]; - { - Point2d* dp = screenPts; - for (Point2d *sp = ops->worldPts->points, *send = sp + ops->worldPts->num; - sp < send; sp++) { - *dp = mapPoint(sp, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - dp->x += ops->xOffset; - dp->y += ops->yOffset; - dp++; - } - *dp = screenPts[0]; - } - Region2d extents; - graphPtr_->extents(&extents); - - clipped_ = 1; - if (ops->fill) { - Point2d* lfillPts = new Point2d[nScreenPts * 3]; - int n = polyRectClip(&extents, screenPts, ops->worldPts->num,lfillPts); - if (n < 3) - delete [] lfillPts; - else { - nFillPts_ = n; - fillPts_ = lfillPts; - clipped_ = 0; - } - } - if ((ops->outline) && (ops->lineWidth > 0)) { - // Generate line segments representing the polygon outline. The - // resulting outline may or may not be closed from viewport clipping. - Segment2d* outlinePts = new Segment2d[nScreenPts]; - if (!outlinePts) - return; - - // Note that this assumes that the point array contains an extra point - // that closes the polygon. - Segment2d* segPtr = outlinePts; - for (Point2d *sp=screenPts, *send=sp+(nScreenPts - 1); sp < send; sp++) { - segPtr->p = sp[0]; - segPtr->q = sp[1]; - if (lineRectClip(&extents, &segPtr->p, &segPtr->q)) { - segPtr++; - } - } - nOutlinePts_ = segPtr - outlinePts; - outlinePts_ = outlinePts; - if (nOutlinePts_ > 0) - clipped_ = 0; - } - - screenPts_ = screenPts; -} - -int PolygonMarker::pointIn(Point2d *samplePtr) -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->worldPts && (ops->worldPts->num >= 3) && screenPts_) - return pointInPolygon(samplePtr, screenPts_, ops->worldPts->num + 1); - - return 0; -} - -int PolygonMarker::regionIn(Region2d *extsPtr, int enclosed) -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->worldPts && (ops->worldPts->num >= 3) && screenPts_) - return regionInPolygon(extsPtr, screenPts_, ops->worldPts->num, enclosed); - - return 0; -} - -void PolygonMarker::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - PolygonMarkerOptions* ops = (PolygonMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->fill) { - psPtr->printPolyline(fillPts_, nFillPts_); - psPtr->setForeground(ops->fill); - psPtr->append("fill\n"); - } - - if ((ops->lineWidth > 0) && (ops->outline)) { - psPtr->setLineAttributes(ops->outline, ops->lineWidth, &ops->dashes, - ops->capStyle, ops->joinStyle); - psPtr->append("/DashesProc {} def\n"); - - psPtr->printSegments(outlinePts_, nOutlinePts_); - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h deleted file mode 100644 index 8eb2216..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerPolygon.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,84 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrMarkerPolygon_h__ -#define __BltGrMarkerPolygon_h__ - -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - const char** tags; - Coords* worldPts; - const char* elemName; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - int hide; - int drawUnder; - int xOffset; - int yOffset; - - int capStyle; - Dashes dashes; - XColor* fill; - int joinStyle; - int lineWidth; - XColor* outline; - } PolygonMarkerOptions; - - class PolygonMarker : public Marker { - protected: - Point2d *screenPts_; - GC outlineGC_; - GC fillGC_; - Point2d *fillPts_; - int nFillPts_; - Segment2d *outlinePts_; - int nOutlinePts_; - - protected: - int configure(); - void draw(Drawable); - void map(); - int pointIn(Point2d*); - int regionIn(Region2d*, int); - void print(PSOutput*); - - public: - PolygonMarker(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~PolygonMarker(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_MARKER_POLYGON;} - const char* className() {return "PolygonMarker";} - const char* typeName() {return "polygon";} - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.C deleted file mode 100644 index 9c4da2a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,276 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerText.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOption.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-anchor", "anchor", "Anchor", - "center", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, anchor), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-background", "background", "Background", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, fillColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-bindtags", "bindTags", "BindTags", - "Text all", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, tags), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-coords", "coords", "Coords", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, worldPts), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &coordsObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-element", "element", "Element", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, elemName), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-foreground", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fill", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-font", "font", "Font", - STD_FONT_NORMAL, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, style.font), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-foreground", "foreground", "Foreground", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, style.color), - 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_JUSTIFY, "-justify", "justify", "Justify", - "left", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, style.justify), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-hide", "hide", "Hide", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, hide), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapx", "mapX", "MapX", - "x", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, xAxis), 0, &xAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-mapy", "mapY", "MapY", - "y", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, yAxis), 0, &yAxisObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-outline", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-foreground", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-rotate", "rotate", "Rotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, style.angle), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-text", "text", "Text", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, string), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-under", "under", "Under", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, drawUnder), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-xoffset", "xOffset", "XOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, xOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-yoffset", "yOffset", "YOffset", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(TextMarkerOptions, yOffset), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -TextMarker::TextMarker(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Marker(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - ops_ = (TextMarkerOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(TextMarkerOptions)); - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - ops->style.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->style.color =NULL; - ops->style.font =NULL; - ops->style.angle =0; - ops->style.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - anchorPt_.x =0; - anchorPt_.y =0; - width_ =0; - height_ =0; - fillGC_ =NULL; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr->interp_, optionSpecs); -} - -TextMarker::~TextMarker() -{ -} - -int TextMarker::configure() -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - ops->style.angle = (float)fmod(ops->style.angle, 360.0); - if (ops->style.angle < 0.0) - ops->style.angle += 360.0; - - GC newGC = NULL; - XGCValues gcValues; - unsigned long gcMask; - if (ops->fillColor) { - gcMask = GCForeground; - gcValues.foreground = ops->fillColor->pixel; - newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - } - if (fillGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, fillGC_); - fillGC_ = newGC; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void TextMarker::draw(Drawable drawable) -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (!ops->string) - return; - - if (fillGC_) { - XPoint points[4]; - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - points[ii].x = (short)(outline_[ii].x + anchorPt_.x); - points[ii].y = (short)(outline_[ii].y + anchorPt_.y); - } - XFillPolygon(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, fillGC_, points, 4, - Convex, CoordModeOrigin); - } - - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - ts.drawText(drawable, ops->string, anchorPt_.x, anchorPt_.y); -} - -void TextMarker::map() -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (!ops->string) - return; - - if (!ops->worldPts || (ops->worldPts->num < 1)) - return; - - width_ =0; - height_ =0; - - int w, h; - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - ts.getExtents(ops->string, &w, &h); - - double rw; - double rh; - graphPtr_->getBoundingBox(w, h, ops->style.angle, &rw, &rh, outline_); - width_ = (int)rw; - height_ = (int)rh; - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - outline_[ii].x += rw * 0.5; - outline_[ii].y += rh * 0.5; - } - outline_[4].x = outline_[0].x; - outline_[4].y = outline_[0].y; - - Point2d anchorPtr = mapPoint(ops->worldPts->points, ops->xAxis, ops->yAxis); - anchorPtr = graphPtr_->anchorPoint(anchorPtr.x, anchorPtr.y, - width_, height_, ops->anchor); - anchorPtr.x += ops->xOffset; - anchorPtr.y += ops->yOffset; - - Region2d extents; - extents.left = anchorPtr.x; - extents.top = anchorPtr.y; - extents.right = anchorPtr.x + width_ - 1; - extents.bottom = anchorPtr.y + height_ - 1; - clipped_ = boxesDontOverlap(graphPtr_, &extents); - - anchorPt_ = anchorPtr; -} - -int TextMarker::pointIn(Point2d *samplePtr) -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (!ops->string) - return 0; - - if (ops->style.angle != 0.0) { - Point2d points[5]; - - // Figure out the bounding polygon (isolateral) for the text and see - // if the point is inside of it. - for (int ii=0; ii<5; ii++) { - points[ii].x = outline_[ii].x + anchorPt_.x; - points[ii].y = outline_[ii].y + anchorPt_.y; - } - return pointInPolygon(samplePtr, points, 5); - } - - return ((samplePtr->x >= anchorPt_.x) && - (samplePtr->x < (anchorPt_.x + width_)) && - (samplePtr->y >= anchorPt_.y) && - (samplePtr->y < (anchorPt_.y + height_))); -} - -int TextMarker::regionIn(Region2d *extsPtr, int enclosed) -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->style.angle != 0.0) { - Point2d points[5]; - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - points[ii].x = outline_[ii].x + anchorPt_.x; - points[ii].y = outline_[ii].y + anchorPt_.y; - } - return regionInPolygon(extsPtr, points, 4, enclosed); - } - - if (enclosed) - return ((anchorPt_.x >= extsPtr->left) && - (anchorPt_.y >= extsPtr->top) && - ((anchorPt_.x + width_) <= extsPtr->right) && - ((anchorPt_.y + height_) <= extsPtr->bottom)); - - return !((anchorPt_.x >= extsPtr->right) || - (anchorPt_.y >= extsPtr->bottom) || - ((anchorPt_.x + width_) <= extsPtr->left) || - ((anchorPt_.y + height_) <= extsPtr->top)); -} - -void TextMarker::print(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - TextMarkerOptions* ops = (TextMarkerOptions*)ops_; - - if (!ops->string) - return; - - if (fillGC_) { - Point2d points[4]; - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - points[ii].x = outline_[ii].x + anchorPt_.x; - points[ii].y = outline_[ii].y + anchorPt_.y; - } - psPtr->setBackground(ops->fillColor); - psPtr->fillPolygon(points, 4); - } - - TextStyle ts(graphPtr_, &ops->style); - ts.printText(psPtr, ops->string, anchorPt_.x, anchorPt_.y); -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.h deleted file mode 100644 index 99dc814..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMarkerText.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,82 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrMarkerText_h__ -#define __BltGrMarkerText_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - const char** tags; - Coords* worldPts; - const char* elemName; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - int hide; - int drawUnder; - int xOffset; - int yOffset; - - Tk_Anchor anchor; - XColor* fillColor; - TextStyleOptions style; - const char* string; - } TextMarkerOptions; - - class TextMarker : public Marker { - protected: - Point2d anchorPt_; - int width_; - int height_; - GC fillGC_; - Point2d outline_[5]; - - protected: - int configure(); - void draw(Drawable); - void map(); - int pointIn(Point2d*); - int regionIn(Region2d*, int); - void print(PSOutput*); - - public: - TextMarker(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~TextMarker(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_MARKER_TEXT;} - const char* className() {return "TextMarker";} - const char* typeName() {return "text";} - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.C deleted file mode 100644 index d951494..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,335 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -char* Blt::dupstr(const char* str) -{ - char* copy =NULL; - if (str) { - copy=new char[strlen(str)+1]; - strcpy(copy,str); - } - - return copy; -} - -int Blt::pointInPolygon(Point2d *s, Point2d *points, int nPoints) -{ - int count = 0; - for (Point2d *p=points, *q=p+1, *qend=p + nPoints; q < qend; p++, q++) { - if (((p->y <= s->y) && (s->y < q->y)) || - ((q->y <= s->y) && (s->y < p->y))) { - double b; - - b = (q->x - p->x) * (s->y - p->y) / (q->y - p->y) + p->x; - if (s->x < b) { - count++; /* Count the number of intersections. */ - } - } - } - return (count & 0x01); -} - -static int ClipTest (double ds, double dr, double *t1, double *t2) -{ - double t; - - if (ds < 0.0) { - t = dr / ds; - if (t > *t2) { - return 0; - } - if (t > *t1) { - *t1 = t; - } - } else if (ds > 0.0) { - t = dr / ds; - if (t < *t1) { - return 0; - } - if (t < *t2) { - *t2 = t; - } - } else { - /* d = 0, so line is parallel to this clipping edge */ - if (dr < 0.0) { /* Line is outside clipping edge */ - return 0; - } - } - return 1; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Clips the given line segment to a rectangular region. The coordinates - * of the clipped line segment are returned. The original coordinates - * are overwritten. - * - * Reference: - * Liang, Y-D., and B. Barsky, A new concept and method for - * Line Clipping, ACM, TOG,3(1), 1984, pp.1-22. - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -int Blt::lineRectClip(Region2d* regionPtr, Point2d *p, Point2d *q) -{ - double t1, t2; - double dx, dy; - - t1 = 0.0, t2 = 1.0; - dx = q->x - p->x; - if ((ClipTest (-dx, p->x - regionPtr->left, &t1, &t2)) && - (ClipTest (dx, regionPtr->right - p->x, &t1, &t2))) { - dy = q->y - p->y; - if ((ClipTest (-dy, p->y - regionPtr->top, &t1, &t2)) && - (ClipTest (dy, regionPtr->bottom - p->y, &t1, &t2))) { - if (t2 < 1.0) { - q->x = p->x + t2 * dx; - q->y = p->y + t2 * dy; - } - if (t1 > 0.0) { - p->x += t1 * dx; - p->y += t1 * dy; - } - return 1; - } - } - return 0; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Clips the given polygon to a rectangular region. The resulting - * polygon is returned. Note that the resulting polyon may be complex, - * connected by zero width/height segments. The drawing routine (such as - * XFillPolygon) will not draw a connecting segment. - * - * Reference: - * Liang Y. D. and Brian A. Barsky, "Analysis and Algorithm for - * Polygon Clipping", Communications of ACM, Vol. 26, - * p.868-877, 1983 - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -#define AddVertex(vx, vy) r->x=(vx), r->y=(vy), r++, count++ -#define LastVertex(vx, vy) r->x=(vx), r->y=(vy), count++ - -int Blt::polyRectClip(Region2d *regionPtr, Point2d *points, int nPoints, - Point2d *clipPts) -{ - Point2d* r = clipPts; - // Counts # of vertices in output polygon. - int count = 0; - - points[nPoints] = points[0]; - for (Point2d *p=points, *q=p+1, *pend=p+nPoints; px - p->x; /* X-direction */ - dy = q->y - p->y; /* Y-direction */ - - if (fabs(dx) < FLT_EPSILON) - dx = (p->x > regionPtr->left) ? -FLT_EPSILON : FLT_EPSILON ; - - if (fabs(dy) < FLT_EPSILON) - dy = (p->y > regionPtr->top) ? -FLT_EPSILON : FLT_EPSILON ; - - if (dx > 0.0) { /* Left */ - xin = regionPtr->left; - xout = regionPtr->right + 1.0; - } - else { /* Right */ - xin = regionPtr->right + 1.0; - xout = regionPtr->left; - } - if (dy > 0.0) { /* Top */ - yin = regionPtr->top; - yout = regionPtr->bottom + 1.0; - } - else { /* Bottom */ - yin = regionPtr->bottom + 1.0; - yout = regionPtr->top; - } - - tinx = (xin - p->x) / dx; - tiny = (yin - p->y) / dy; - - if (tinx < tiny) { /* Hits x first */ - tin1 = tinx; - tin2 = tiny; - } - else { /* Hits y first */ - tin1 = tiny; - tin2 = tinx; - } - - if (tin1 <= 1.0) { - if (tin1 > 0.0) { - AddVertex(xin, yin); - } - if (tin2 <= 1.0) { - double toutx = (xout - p->x) / dx; - double touty = (yout - p->y) / dy; - double tout1 = MIN(toutx, touty); - - if ((tin2 > 0.0) || (tout1 > 0.0)) { - if (tin2 <= tout1) { - if (tin2 > 0.0) { - if (tinx > tiny) { - AddVertex(xin, p->y + tinx * dy); - } else { - AddVertex(p->x + tiny * dx, yin); - } - } - if (tout1 < 1.0) { - if (toutx < touty) { - AddVertex(xout, p->y + toutx * dy); - } else { - AddVertex(p->x + touty * dx, yout); - } - } else { - AddVertex(q->x, q->y); - } - } else { - if (tinx > tiny) { - AddVertex(xin, yout); - } else { - AddVertex(xout, yin); - } - - } - } - } - } - } - if (count > 0) { - LastVertex(clipPts[0].x, clipPts[0].y); - } - return count; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * Computes the projection of a point on a line. The line (given by two - * points), is assumed the be infinite. - * - * Compute the slope (angle) of the line and rotate it 90 degrees. Using - * the slope-intercept method (we know the second line from the sample - * test point and the computed slope), then find the intersection of both - * lines. This will be the projection of the sample point on the first - * line. - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -Point2d Blt::getProjection(int x, int y, Point2d *p, Point2d *q) -{ - double dx = p->x - q->x; - double dy = p->y - q->y; - - /* Test for horizontal and vertical lines */ - Point2d t; - if (fabs(dx) < DBL_EPSILON) { - t.x = p->x; - t.y = (double)y; - } - else if (fabs(dy) < DBL_EPSILON) { - t.x = (double)x; - t.y = p->y; - } - else { - /* Compute the slope and intercept of PQ. */ - double m1 = (dy / dx); - double b1 = p->y - (p->x * m1); - - /* - * Compute the slope and intercept of a second line segment: one that - * intersects through sample X-Y coordinate with a slope perpendicular - * to original line. - */ - - /* Find midpoint of PQ. */ - double midX = (p->x + q->x) * 0.5; - double midY = (p->y + q->y) * 0.5; - - /* Rotate the line 90 degrees */ - double ax = midX - (0.5 * dy); - double ay = midY - (0.5 * -dx); - double bx = midX + (0.5 * dy); - double by = midY + (0.5 * -dx); - - double m2 = (ay - by) / (ax - bx); - double b2 = y - (x * m2); - - /* - * Given the equations of two lines which contain the same point, - * - * y = m1 * x + b1 - * y = m2 * x + b2 - * - * solve for the intersection. - * - * x = (b2 - b1) / (m1 - m2) - * y = m1 * x + b1 - * - */ - - t.x = (b2 - b1) / (m1 - m2); - t.y = m1 * t.x + b1; - } - - return t; -} - -Graph* Blt::getGraphFromWindowData(Tk_Window tkwin) -{ - while (tkwin) { - TkWindow* winPtr = (TkWindow*)tkwin; - if (winPtr->instanceData != NULL) { - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)winPtr->instanceData; - if (graphPtr) - return graphPtr; - } - tkwin = Tk_Parent(tkwin); - } - return NULL; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.h deleted file mode 100644 index ba86b75..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrMisc.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,118 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrMisc_h__ -#define __BltGrMisc_h__ - -#include -#include -#include -using namespace std; - -#include - -#ifndef MIN -# define MIN(x,y) ((x)<(y)?(x):(y)) -#endif - -#ifndef MAX -# define MAX(x,y) ((x)>(y)?(x):(y)) -#endif - -#define GRAPH_DELETED (1<<1) -#define REDRAW_PENDING (1<<2) -#define FOCUS (1<<3) - -#define MAP_ITEM (1<<4) - -#define RESET (1<<5) -#define LAYOUT (1<<6) -#define MAP_MARKERS (1<<7) -#define CACHE (1<<8) - -#define MARGIN_NONE -1 -#define MARGIN_BOTTOM 0 /* x */ -#define MARGIN_LEFT 1 /* y */ -#define MARGIN_TOP 2 /* x2 */ -#define MARGIN_RIGHT 3 /* y2 */ - -#define LineIsDashed(d) ((d).values[0] != 0) - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - - typedef struct { - int x, y; - } Point; - - typedef struct { - int x, y; - unsigned width, height; - } Rectangle; - - typedef struct { - double x; - double y; - } Point2d; - - typedef struct { - Point2d p; - Point2d q; - } Segment2d; - - typedef struct { - double left; - double right; - double top; - double bottom; - } Region2d; - - typedef enum { - CID_NONE, CID_AXIS_X, CID_AXIS_Y, CID_ELEM_BAR, CID_ELEM_LINE, - CID_MARKER_BITMAP, CID_MARKER_IMAGE, CID_MARKER_LINE, CID_MARKER_POLYGON, - CID_MARKER_TEXT - } ClassId; - - typedef struct { - unsigned char values[12]; - int offset; - } Dashes; - - extern char* dupstr(const char*); - extern Graph* getGraphFromWindowData(Tk_Window tkwin); - - extern int pointInPolygon(Point2d *samplePtr, Point2d *screenPts, - int nScreenPts); - extern int polyRectClip(Region2d *extsPtr, Point2d *inputPts, - int nInputPts, Point2d *outputPts); - extern int lineRectClip(Region2d *regionPtr, Point2d *p, Point2d *q); - extern Point2d getProjection (int x, int y, Point2d *p, Point2d *q); -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.C deleted file mode 100644 index 01a3101..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,931 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - * - */ - -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tk.h" - -// copied from tk3d.h - -typedef struct TkBorder { - Screen *screen; /* Screen on which the border will be used. */ - Visual *visual; /* Visual for all windows and pixmaps using - * the border. */ - int depth; /* Number of bits per pixel of drawables where - * the border will be used. */ - Colormap colormap; /* Colormap out of which pixels are - * allocated. */ - int resourceRefCount; /* Number of active uses of this color (each - * active use corresponds to a call to - * Tk_Alloc3DBorderFromObj or Tk_Get3DBorder). - * If this count is 0, then this structure is - * no longer valid and it isn't present in - * borderTable: it is being kept around only - * because there are objects referring to it. - * The structure is freed when objRefCount and - * resourceRefCount are both 0. */ - int objRefCount; /* The number of Tcl objects that reference - * this structure. */ - XColor *bgColorPtr; /* Background color (intensity between - * lightColorPtr and darkColorPtr). */ - XColor *darkColorPtr; /* Color for darker areas (must free when - * deleting structure). NULL means shadows - * haven't been allocated yet.*/ - XColor *lightColorPtr; /* Color used for lighter areas of border - * (must free this when deleting structure). - * NULL means shadows haven't been allocated - * yet. */ - Pixmap shadow; /* Stipple pattern to use for drawing shadows - * areas. Used for displays with <= 64 colors - * or where colormap has filled up. */ - GC bgGC; /* Used (if necessary) to draw areas in the - * background color. */ - GC darkGC; /* Used to draw darker parts of the border. - * None means the shadow colors haven't been - * allocated yet.*/ - GC lightGC; /* Used to draw lighter parts of the border. - * None means the shadow colors haven't been - * allocated yet. */ - Tcl_HashEntry *hashPtr; /* Entry in borderTable (needed in order to - * delete structure). */ - struct TkBorder *nextPtr; /* Points to the next TkBorder structure with - * the same color name. Borders with the same - * name but different screens or colormaps are - * chained together off a single entry in - * borderTable. */ -} TkBorder; - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -PSOutput::PSOutput(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString_); -} - -PSOutput::~PSOutput() -{ - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString_); -} - -void PSOutput::printPolyline(Point2d* screenPts, int nScreenPts) -{ - Point2d* pp = screenPts; - append("newpath\n"); - format(" %g %g moveto\n", pp->x, pp->y); - - Point2d* pend; - for (pp++, pend = screenPts + nScreenPts; pp < pend; pp++) - format(" %g %g lineto\n", pp->x, pp->y); -} - -void PSOutput::printMaxPolyline(Point2d* points, int nPoints) -{ - if (nPoints <= 0) - return; - - for (int nLeft = nPoints; nLeft > 0; nLeft -= 1500) { - int length = MIN(1500, nLeft); - printPolyline(points, length); - append("DashesProc stroke\n"); - points += length; - } -} - -void PSOutput::printSegments(Segment2d* segments, int nSegments) -{ - append("newpath\n"); - - for (Segment2d *sp = segments, *send = sp + nSegments; sp < send; sp++) { - format(" %g %g moveto %g %g lineto\n", sp->p.x, sp->p.y, sp->q.x, sp->q.y); - append("DashesProc stroke\n"); - } -} - -void PSOutput::computeBBox(int width, int height) -{ - Postscript* setupPtr = graphPtr_->postscript_; - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)setupPtr->ops_; - - // scale from points to pica - double pica = 25.4 / 72 * - WidthOfScreen(Tk_Screen(graphPtr_->tkwin_)) / - WidthMMOfScreen(Tk_Screen(graphPtr_->tkwin_)); - - double hBorder = 2*pops->xPad/pica; - double vBorder = 2*pops->yPad/pica; - int hSize = !pops->landscape ? width : height; - int vSize = !pops->landscape ? height : width; - - // If the paper size wasn't specified, set it to the graph size plus the - // paper border. - double paperWidth = pops->reqPaperWidth > 0 ? pops->reqPaperWidth/pica : - hSize + hBorder; - double paperHeight = pops->reqPaperHeight > 0 ? pops->reqPaperHeight/pica : - vSize + vBorder; - - // Scale the plot size if it's bigger than the paper - double hScale = (hSize+hBorder)>paperWidth ? (paperWidth-hBorder)/hSize - : 1.0; - double vScale = (vSize+vBorder)>paperHeight ? (paperHeight-vBorder)/vSize - : 1.0; - - double scale = MIN(hScale, vScale); - if (scale != 1.0) { - hSize = (int)(hSize*scale + 0.5); - vSize = (int)(vSize*scale + 0.5); - } - - int x = (int)((paperWidth > hSize) && pops->center ? - (paperWidth - hSize) / 2 : pops->xPad/pica); - int y = (int)((paperHeight > vSize) && pops->center ? - (paperHeight - vSize) / 2 : pops->yPad/pica); - - setupPtr->left = x; - setupPtr->bottom = y; - setupPtr->right = x + hSize - 1; - setupPtr->top = y + vSize - 1; - setupPtr->scale = scale; - setupPtr->paperHeight = (int)paperHeight; - setupPtr->paperWidth = (int)paperWidth; -} - -const char* PSOutput::getValue(int* lengthPtr) -{ - *lengthPtr = strlen(Tcl_DStringValue(&dString_)); - return Tcl_DStringValue(&dString_); -} - -void PSOutput::append(const char* string) -{ - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString_, string, -1); -} - -void PSOutput::format(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list argList; - - va_start(argList, fmt); - vsnprintf(scratchArr_, POSTSCRIPT_BUFSIZ, fmt, argList); - va_end(argList); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&dString_, scratchArr_, -1); -} - -void PSOutput::setLineWidth(int lineWidth) -{ - if (lineWidth < 1) - lineWidth = 1; - format("%d setlinewidth\n", lineWidth); -} - -void PSOutput::printRectangle(double x, double y, int width, int height) -{ - append("newpath\n"); - format(" %g %g moveto\n", x, y); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", width, 0); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", 0, height); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", -width, 0); - append("closepath\n"); - append("stroke\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::fillRectangle(double x, double y, int width, int height) -{ - append("newpath\n"); - format(" %g %g moveto\n", x, y); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", width, 0); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", 0, height); - format(" %d %d rlineto\n", -width, 0); - append("closepath\n"); - append("fill\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::fillRectangles(Rectangle* rectangles, int nRectangles) -{ - for (Rectangle *rp = rectangles, *rend = rp + nRectangles; rp < rend; rp++) - fillRectangle((double)rp->x, (double)rp->y, (int)rp->width,(int)rp->height); -} - -void PSOutput::setBackground(XColor* colorPtr) -{ - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)graphPtr_->postscript_->ops_; - printXColor(colorPtr); - append(" setrgbcolor\n"); - if (pops->greyscale) - append(" currentgray setgray\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::setForeground(XColor* colorPtr) -{ - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)graphPtr_->postscript_->ops_; - printXColor(colorPtr); - append(" setrgbcolor\n"); - if (pops->greyscale) - append(" currentgray setgray\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::setBackground(Tk_3DBorder border) -{ - TkBorder* borderPtr = (TkBorder*)border; - setBackground(borderPtr->bgColorPtr); -} - -void PSOutput::setFont(Tk_Font font) -{ - Tcl_DString psdstr; - Tcl_DStringInit(&psdstr); - int psSize = Tk_PostscriptFontName(font, &psdstr); - format("%d /%s SetFont\n", psSize, Tcl_DStringValue(&psdstr)); - Tcl_DStringFree(&psdstr); -} - -void PSOutput::setLineAttributes(XColor* colorPtr,int lineWidth, - Dashes* dashesPtr, int capStyle, - int joinStyle) -{ - setJoinStyle(joinStyle); - setCapStyle(capStyle); - setForeground(colorPtr); - setLineWidth(lineWidth); - setDashes(dashesPtr); - append("/DashesProc {} def\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::fill3DRectangle(Tk_3DBorder border, double x, double y, - int width, int height, int borderWidth, - int relief) -{ - TkBorder* borderPtr = (TkBorder*)border; - - setBackground(borderPtr->bgColorPtr); - fillRectangle(x, y, width, height); - print3DRectangle(border, x, y, width, height, borderWidth, relief); -} - -void PSOutput::setClearBackground() -{ - append("1 1 1 setrgbcolor\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::setDashes(Dashes* dashesPtr) -{ - - append("[ "); - if (dashesPtr) { - for (unsigned char* vp = dashesPtr->values; *vp != 0; vp++) - format(" %d", *vp); - } - append("] 0 setdash\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::fillPolygon(Point2d *screenPts, int nScreenPts) -{ - printPolygon(screenPts, nScreenPts); - append("fill\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::setJoinStyle(int joinStyle) -{ - // miter = 0, round = 1, bevel = 2 - format("%d setlinejoin\n", joinStyle); -} - -void PSOutput::setCapStyle(int capStyle) -{ - // X11:not last = 0, butt = 1, round = 2, projecting = 3 - // PS: butt = 0, round = 1, projecting = 2 - if (capStyle > 0) - capStyle--; - - format("%d setlinecap\n", capStyle); -} - -void PSOutput::printPolygon(Point2d *screenPts, int nScreenPts) -{ - Point2d* pp = screenPts; - append("newpath\n"); - format(" %g %g moveto\n", pp->x, pp->y); - - Point2d* pend; - for (pp++, pend = screenPts + nScreenPts; pp < pend; pp++) - format(" %g %g lineto\n", pp->x, pp->y); - - format(" %g %g lineto\n", screenPts[0].x, screenPts[0].y); - append("closepath\n"); -} - -void PSOutput::print3DRectangle(Tk_3DBorder border, double x, double y, - int width, int height, int borderWidth, - int relief) -{ - int twiceWidth = (borderWidth * 2); - if ((width < twiceWidth) || (height < twiceWidth)) - return; - - TkBorder* borderPtr = (TkBorder*)border; - - // Handle grooves and ridges with recursive calls - if ((relief == TK_RELIEF_GROOVE) || (relief == TK_RELIEF_RIDGE)) { - int halfWidth = borderWidth / 2; - int insideOffset = borderWidth - halfWidth; - print3DRectangle(border, (double)x, (double)y, width, height, halfWidth, - (relief == TK_RELIEF_GROOVE) ? - TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN : TK_RELIEF_RAISED); - print3DRectangle(border, (double)(x + insideOffset), - (double)(y + insideOffset), width - insideOffset * 2, - height - insideOffset * 2, halfWidth, - (relief == TK_RELIEF_GROOVE) ? - TK_RELIEF_RAISED : TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN); - return; - } - - XColor* lightPtr = borderPtr->lightColorPtr; - XColor* darkPtr = borderPtr->darkColorPtr; - XColor light; - if (!lightPtr) { - light.red = 0x00; - light.blue = 0x00; - light.green = 0x00; - lightPtr = &light; - } - XColor dark; - if (!darkPtr) { - dark.red = 0x00; - dark.blue = 0x00; - dark.green = 0x00; - darkPtr = &dark; - } - - XColor* topPtr, *bottomPtr; - if (relief == TK_RELIEF_RAISED) { - topPtr = lightPtr; - bottomPtr = darkPtr; - } - else if (relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { - topPtr = darkPtr; - bottomPtr = lightPtr; - } - else if (relief == TK_RELIEF_SOLID) { - topPtr = lightPtr; - bottomPtr = lightPtr; - } - else { - topPtr = borderPtr->bgColorPtr; - bottomPtr = borderPtr->bgColorPtr; - } - - setBackground(bottomPtr); - fillRectangle(x, y + height - borderWidth, width, borderWidth); - fillRectangle(x + width - borderWidth, y, borderWidth, height); - - Point2d points[7]; - points[0].x = points[1].x = points[6].x = x; - points[0].y = points[6].y = y + height; - points[1].y = points[2].y = y; - points[2].x = x + width; - points[3].x = x + width - borderWidth; - points[3].y = points[4].y = y + borderWidth; - points[4].x = points[5].x = x + borderWidth; - points[5].y = y + height - borderWidth; - if (relief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) - setBackground(topPtr); - - fillPolygon(points, 7); -} - -void PSOutput::printXColor(XColor* colorPtr) -{ - format("%g %g %g", - ((double)(colorPtr->red >> 8) / 255.0), - ((double)(colorPtr->green >> 8) / 255.0), - ((double)(colorPtr->blue >> 8) / 255.0)); -} - -int PSOutput::preamble(const char* fileName) -{ - Postscript* setupPtr = graphPtr_->postscript_; - PostscriptOptions* ops = (PostscriptOptions*)setupPtr->ops_; - - if (!fileName) - fileName = Tk_PathName(graphPtr_->tkwin_); - - // Comments - append("%!PS-Adobe-3.0 EPSF-3.0\n"); - - // The "BoundingBox" comment is required for EPS files. The box - // coordinates are integers, so we need round away from the center of the - // box. - format("%%%%BoundingBox: %d %d %d %d\n", - setupPtr->left, setupPtr->paperHeight - setupPtr->top, - setupPtr->right, setupPtr->paperHeight - setupPtr->bottom); - - append("%%Pages: 0\n"); - - format("%%%%Creator: (%s %s %s)\n", PACKAGE_NAME, PACKAGE_VERSION, - Tk_Class(graphPtr_->tkwin_)); - - time_t ticks = time((time_t *) NULL); - char date[200]; - strcpy(date, ctime(&ticks)); - char* newline = date + strlen(date) - 1; - if (*newline == '\n') - *newline = '\0'; - - format("%%%%CreationDate: (%s)\n", date); - format("%%%%Title: (%s)\n", fileName); - append("%%DocumentData: Clean7Bit\n"); - if (ops->landscape) - append("%%Orientation: Landscape\n"); - else - append("%%Orientation: Portrait\n"); - - append("%%DocumentNeededResources: font Helvetica Courier\n"); - addComments(ops->comments); - append("%%EndComments\n\n"); - - // Prolog - prolog(); - - // Setup - append("%%BeginSetup\n"); - append("gsave\n"); - append("1 setlinewidth\n"); - append("1 setlinejoin\n"); - append("0 setlinecap\n"); - append("[] 0 setdash\n"); - append("0 0 0 setrgbcolor\n"); - - if (ops->footer) { - const char* who = getenv("LOGNAME"); - if (!who) - who = "???"; - - append("8 /Helvetica SetFont\n"); - append("10 30 moveto\n"); - format("(Date: %s) show\n", date); - append("10 20 moveto\n"); - format("(File: %s) show\n", fileName); - append("10 10 moveto\n"); - format("(Created by: %s@%s) show\n", who, Tcl_GetHostName()); - append("0 0 moveto\n"); - } - - // Set the conversion from postscript to X11 coordinates. Scale pica to - // pixels and flip the y-axis (the origin is the upperleft corner). - // Papersize is in pixels. Translate the new origin *after* changing the scale - append("% Transform coordinate system to use X11 coordinates\n"); - append("% 1. Flip y-axis over by reversing the scale,\n"); - append("% 2. Translate the origin to the other side of the page,\n"); - append("% making the origin the upper left corner\n"); - append("1 -1 scale\n"); - format("0 %d translate\n", -setupPtr->paperHeight); - - // Set Origin - format("%% Set origin\n%d %d translate\n\n", setupPtr->left,setupPtr->bottom); - if (ops->landscape) - format("%% Landscape orientation\n0 %g translate\n-90 rotate\n", - ((double)graphPtr_->width_ * setupPtr->scale)); - - append("\n%%EndSetup\n\n"); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void PSOutput::addComments(const char** comments) -{ - if (!comments) - return; - - for (const char** pp = comments; *pp; pp+=2) { - if (*(pp+1) == NULL) - break; - format("%% %s: %s\n", *pp, *(pp+1)); - } -} - -unsigned char PSOutput::reverseBits(unsigned char byte) -{ - byte = ((byte >> 1) & 0x55) | ((byte << 1) & 0xaa); - byte = ((byte >> 2) & 0x33) | ((byte << 2) & 0xcc); - byte = ((byte >> 4) & 0x0f) | ((byte << 4) & 0xf0); - return byte; -} - -void PSOutput::byteToHex(unsigned char byte, char* string) -{ - static char hexDigits[] = "0123456789ABCDEF"; - - string[0] = hexDigits[byte >> 4]; - string[1] = hexDigits[byte & 0x0F]; -} - -void PSOutput::prolog() -{ - append( -"%%BeginProlog\n" -"%\n" -"% PostScript prolog file of the BLT graph widget.\n" -"%\n" -"% Copyright 1989-1992 Regents of the University of California.\n" -"% Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this\n" -"% software and its documentation for any purpose and without\n" -"% fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright\n" -"% notice appear in all copies. The University of California\n" -"% makes no representations about the suitability of this\n" -"% software for any purpose. It is provided 'as is' without\n" -"% express or implied warranty.\n" -"%\n" -"% Copyright 1991-1997 Bell Labs Innovations for Lucent Technologies.\n" -"%\n" -"% Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its\n" -"% documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided\n" -"% that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that the\n" -"% copyright notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting documentation,\n" -"% and that the names of Lucent Technologies any of their entities not be used\n" -"% in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software\n" -"% without specific, written prior permission.\n" -"%\n" -"% Lucent Technologies disclaims all warranties with regard to this software,\n" -"% including all implied warranties of merchantability and fitness. In no event\n" -"% shall Lucent Technologies be liable for any special, indirect or\n" -"% consequential damages or any damages whatsoever resulting from loss of use,\n" -"% data or profits, whether in an action of contract, negligence or other\n" -"% tortuous action, arising out of or in connection with the use or performance\n" -"% of this software.\n" -"%\n" -"\n" -"200 dict begin\n" -"\n" -"/BaseRatio 1.3467736870885982 def % Ratio triangle base / symbol size\n" -"/DrawSymbolProc 0 def % Routine to draw symbol outline/fill\n" -"/DashesProc 0 def % Dashes routine (line segments)\n" -"\n" -"% Define the array ISOLatin1Encoding (which specifies how characters are \n" -"% encoded for ISO-8859-1 fonts), if it isn't already present (Postscript \n" -"% level 2 is supposed to define it, but level 1 doesn't). \n" -"\n" -"systemdict /ISOLatin1Encoding known not { \n" -" /ISOLatin1Encoding [ \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /space /exclam /quotedbl /numbersign /dollar /percent /ampersand \n" -" /quoteright \n" -" /parenleft /parenright /asterisk /plus /comma /minus /period /slash \n" -" /zero /one /two /three /four /five /six /seven \n" -" /eight /nine /colon /semicolon /less /equal /greater /question \n" -" /at /A /B /C /D /E /F /G \n" -" /H /I /J /K /L /M /N /O \n" -" /P /Q /R /S /T /U /V /W \n" -" /X /Y /Z /bracketleft /backslash /bracketright /asciicircum /underscore \n" -" /quoteleft /a /b /c /d /e /f /g \n" -" /h /i /j /k /l /m /n /o \n" -" /p /q /r /s /t /u /v /w \n" -" /x /y /z /braceleft /bar /braceright /asciitilde /space \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /space /space /space /space /space /space /space /space \n" -" /dotlessi /grave /acute /circumflex /tilde /macron /breve /dotaccent \n" -" /dieresis /space /ring /cedilla /space /hungarumlaut /ogonek /caron \n" -" /space /exclamdown /cent /sterling /currency /yen /brokenbar /section \n" -" /dieresis /copyright /ordfeminine /guillemotleft /logicalnot /hyphen \n" -" /registered /macron \n" -" /degree /plusminus /twosuperior /threesuperior /acute /mu /paragraph \n" -" /periodcentered \n" -" /cedillar /onesuperior /ordmasculine /guillemotright /onequarter \n" -" /onehalf /threequarters /questiondown \n" -" /Agrave /Aacute /Acircumflex /Atilde /Adieresis /Aring /AE /Ccedilla \n" -" /Egrave /Eacute /Ecircumflex /Edieresis /Igrave /Iacute /Icircumflex \n" -" /Idieresis \n" -" /Eth /Ntilde /Ograve /Oacute /Ocircumflex /Otilde /Odieresis /multiply \n" -" /Oslash /Ugrave /Uacute /Ucircumflex /Udieresis /Yacute /Thorn \n" -" /germandbls \n" -" /agrave /aacute /acircumflex /atilde /adieresis /aring /ae /ccedilla \n" -" /egrave /eacute /ecircumflex /edieresis /igrave /iacute /icircumflex \n" -" /idieresis \n" -" /eth /ntilde /ograve /oacute /ocircumflex /otilde /odieresis /divide \n" -" /oslash /ugrave /uacute /ucircumflex /udieresis /yacute /thorn \n" -" /ydieresis \n" -" ] def \n" -"} if \n" -"\n" -"% font ISOEncode font \n" -"% This procedure changes the encoding of a font from the default \n" -"% Postscript encoding to ISOLatin1. It is typically invoked just \n" -"% before invoking 'setfont'. The body of this procedure comes from \n" -"% Section 5.6.1 of the Postscript book. \n" -"\n" -"/ISOEncode { \n" -" dup length dict\n" -" begin \n" -" {1 index /FID ne {def} {pop pop} ifelse} forall \n" -" /Encoding ISOLatin1Encoding def \n" -" currentdict \n" -" end \n" -"\n" -" % I'm not sure why it's necessary to use 'definefont' on this new \n" -" % font, but it seems to be important; just use the name 'Temporary' \n" -" % for the font. \n" -"\n" -" /Temporary exch definefont \n" -"} bind def \n" -"\n" -"/Stroke {\n" -" gsave\n" -" stroke\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"/Fill {\n" -" gsave\n" -" fill\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"/SetFont { \n" -" % Stack: pointSize fontName\n" -" findfont exch scalefont ISOEncode setfont\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"/Box {\n" -" % Stack: x y width height\n" -" newpath\n" -" exch 4 2 roll moveto\n" -" dup 0 rlineto\n" -" exch 0 exch rlineto\n" -" neg 0 rlineto\n" -" closepath\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"/LS { % Stack: x1 y1 x2 y2\n" -" newpath \n" -" 4 2 roll moveto \n" -" lineto \n" -" closepath\n" -" stroke\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"/baselineSampler ( TXygqPZ) def\n" -"% Put an extra-tall character in; done this way to avoid encoding trouble\n" -"baselineSampler 0 196 put\n" -"\n" -"/cstringshow {\n" -" {\n" -" dup type /stringtype eq\n" -" { show } { glyphshow }\n" -" ifelse\n" -" } forall\n" -"} bind def\n" -"\n" -"/cstringwidth {\n" -" 0 exch 0 exch\n" -" {\n" -" dup type /stringtype eq\n" -" { stringwidth } {\n" -" currentfont /Encoding get exch 1 exch put (\001)\n" -" stringwidth\n" -" }\n" -" ifelse\n" -" exch 3 1 roll add 3 1 roll add exch\n" -" } forall\n" -"} bind def\n" -"\n" -"/DrawText {\n" -" gsave\n" -" /justify exch def\n" -" /yoffset exch def\n" -" /xoffset exch def\n" -" /strings exch def\n" -" % Compute the baseline offset and the actual font height.\n" -" 0 0 moveto baselineSampler false charpath\n" -" pathbbox dup /baseline exch def\n" -" exch pop exch sub /height exch def pop\n" -" newpath\n" -" % overall width\n" -" /ww 0 def\n" -" strings {\n" -" cstringwidth pop\n" -" dup ww gt {/ww exch def} {pop} ifelse\n" -" newpath\n" -" } forall\n" -" % overall height\n" -" /hh 0 def\n" -" strings length height mul /hh exch def\n" -" newpath\n" -" % Translate to x,y\n" -" translate\n" -" % Translate to offset\n" -" ww xoffset mul hh yoffset mul translate\n" -" % rotate\n" -" ww 2 div hh 2 div translate\n" -" neg rotate\n" -" ww -2 div hh -2 div translate\n" -" % Translate to justify and baseline\n" -" justify ww mul baseline translate\n" -" % For each line, justify and display\n" -" strings {\n" -" dup cstringwidth pop\n" -" justify neg mul 0 moveto\n" -" gsave\n" -" 1 -1 scale\n" -" cstringshow\n" -" grestore\n" -" 0 height translate\n" -" } forall\n" -" grestore\n" -"} bind def \n" -"\n" -"% Symbols:\n" -"\n" -"% Skinny-cross\n" -"/Sc {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate 45 rotate\n" -" 0 0 3 -1 roll Sp\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Skinny-plus\n" -"/Sp {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate\n" -" 2 div\n" -" dup 2 copy\n" -" newpath \n" -" neg 0 \n" -" moveto 0 \n" -" lineto\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" newpath \n" -" neg 0 \n" -" exch moveto 0 \n" -" exch lineto\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Cross\n" -"/Cr {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate 45 rotate\n" -" 0 0 3 -1 roll Pl\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Plus\n" -"/Pl {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate\n" -" dup 2 div\n" -" exch 6 div\n" -"\n" -" %\n" -" % 2 3 The plus/cross symbol is a\n" -" % closed polygon of 12 points.\n" -" % 0 1 4 5 The diagram to the left\n" -" % x,y represents the positions of\n" -" % 11 10 7 6 the points which are computed\n" -" % below.\n" -" % 9 8\n" -" %\n" -"\n" -" newpath\n" -" 2 copy exch neg exch neg moveto \n" -" dup neg dup lineto\n" -" 2 copy neg exch neg lineto\n" -" 2 copy exch neg lineto\n" -" dup dup neg lineto \n" -" 2 copy neg lineto 2 copy lineto\n" -" dup dup lineto \n" -" 2 copy exch lineto \n" -" 2 copy neg exch lineto\n" -" dup dup neg exch lineto \n" -" exch neg exch lineto\n" -" closepath\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Circle\n" -"/Ci {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 copy pop moveto \n" -" newpath\n" -" 2 div 0 360 arc\n" -" closepath \n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Square\n" -"/Sq {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" dup dup 2 div dup\n" -" 6 -1 roll exch sub exch\n" -" 5 -1 roll exch sub 4 -2 roll Box\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Line\n" -"/Li {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 1 roll exch 3 -1 roll 2 div 3 copy\n" -" newpath\n" -" sub exch moveto \n" -" add exch lineto\n" -" closepath\n" -" stroke\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Diamond\n" -"/Di {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 1 roll translate 45 rotate 0 0 3 -1 roll Sq\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -" \n" -"% Triangle\n" -"/Tr {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate\n" -" BaseRatio mul 0.5 mul % Calculate 1/2 base\n" -" dup 0 exch 30 cos mul % h1 = height above center point\n" -" neg % b2 0 -h1\n" -" newpath \n" -" moveto % point 1; b2\n" -" dup 30 sin 30 cos div mul % h2 = height below center point\n" -" 2 copy lineto % point 2; b2 h2\n" -" exch neg exch lineto % \n" -" closepath\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"% Arrow\n" -"/Ar {\n" -" % Stack: x y symbolSize\n" -" gsave\n" -" 3 -2 roll translate\n" -" BaseRatio mul 0.5 mul % Calculate 1/2 base\n" -" dup 0 exch 30 cos mul % h1 = height above center point\n" -" % b2 0 h1\n" -" newpath moveto % point 1; b2\n" -" dup 30 sin 30 cos div mul % h2 = height below center point\n" -" neg % -h2 b2\n" -" 2 copy lineto % point 2; b2 h2\n" -" exch neg exch lineto % \n" -" closepath\n" -" DrawSymbolProc\n" -" grestore\n" -"} def\n" -"\n" -"%%EndProlog\n" -); -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.h deleted file mode 100644 index 04bb2fd..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPSOutput.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,90 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __Blt_GrPSOutput_h__ -#define __Blt_GrPSOutput_h__ - -#include - -#define POSTSCRIPT_BUFSIZ ((BUFSIZ*2)-1) - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class Postscript; - - class PSOutput { - protected: - Graph* graphPtr_; - Tcl_DString dString_; - char scratchArr_[POSTSCRIPT_BUFSIZ+1]; - - protected: - void addComments(const char**); - void printXColor(XColor*); - unsigned char reverseBits(unsigned char); - void byteToHex(unsigned char, char*); - void setJoinStyle(int); - void setCapStyle(int); - void prolog(); - - public: - PSOutput(Graph*); - virtual ~PSOutput(); - - void printPolyline(Point2d*, int); - void printMaxPolyline(Point2d*, int); - void printSegments(Segment2d*, int); - void printRectangle(double, double, int, int); - void printPolygon(Point2d*, int); - void print3DRectangle(Tk_3DBorder, double, double, int, int, int, int); - - void fillRectangle(double, double, int, int); - void fillRectangles(Rectangle*, int); - void fill3DRectangle(Tk_3DBorder, double, double, int, int, int, int); - void fillPolygon(Point2d*, int); - - void setFont(Tk_Font); - void setLineWidth(int); - void setBackground(XColor*); - void setForeground(XColor*); - void setBackground(Tk_3DBorder); - void setLineAttributes(XColor*,int, Dashes*, int, int); - void setClearBackground(); - void setDashes(Dashes*); - - int preamble(const char*); - void computeBBox(int, int); - const char* getValue(int*); - void append(const char*); - void format(const char*, ...); - void varAppend(const char*, ...); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.C deleted file mode 100644 index 71e5fe9..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,62 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -Pen::Pen(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) -{ - optionTable_ = NULL; - ops_ = NULL; - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - name_ = dupstr(name); - hashPtr_ = hPtr; - refCount_ =0; - flags =0; - manageOptions_ =0; -} - -Pen::~Pen() -{ - delete [] name_; - - if (hashPtr_) - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hashPtr_); - - // PenOptions* ops = (PenOptions*)ops_; - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - - if (manageOptions_) - free(ops_); -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.h deleted file mode 100644 index 003e8dd..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPen.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,79 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPen_h__ -#define __BltGrPen_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrText.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - - typedef struct { - int errorBarShow; - int errorBarLineWidth; - int errorBarCapWidth; - XColor* errorBarColor; - int valueShow; - const char* valueFormat; - TextStyleOptions valueStyle; - } PenOptions; - - class Pen { - protected: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - - public: - Graph* graphPtr_; - const char *name_; - Tcl_HashEntry *hashPtr_; - int refCount_; - unsigned int flags; - int manageOptions_; - - public: - Pen(); - Pen(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - virtual ~Pen(); - - virtual ClassId classId() =0; - virtual const char* className() =0; - virtual const char* typeName() =0; - - Tk_OptionTable optionTable() {return optionTable_;} - void* ops() {return ops_;} - - virtual int configure() =0; - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.C deleted file mode 100644 index 8f6e59a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,174 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_OptionSpec barPenOptionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-background", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, borderWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-color", "color", "Color", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, fill), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-errorbarcolor", "errorBarColor", "ErrorBarColor", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, errorBarColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarwidth", "errorBarWidth","ErrorBarWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, errorBarLineWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarcap", "errorBarCap", "ErrorBarCap", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, errorBarCapWidth), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-outline", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fill", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-color", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-foreground", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-outline", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, outlineColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "raised", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, relief), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showerrorbars", "showErrorBars", "ShowErrorBars", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, errorBarShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showvalues", "showValues", "ShowValues", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueShow), 0, &fillObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-valueanchor", "valueAnchor", "ValueAnchor", - "s", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueStyle.anchor), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-valuecolor", "valueColor", "ValueColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-valuefont", "valueFont", "ValueFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueStyle.font), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-valueformat", "valueFormat", "ValueFormat", - "%g", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueFormat), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-valuerotate", "valueRotate", "ValueRotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarPenOptions, valueStyle.angle), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -BarPen::BarPen(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Pen(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - ops_ = calloc(1, sizeof(BarPenOptions)); - BarPenOptions* ops = (BarPenOptions*)ops_; - manageOptions_ =1; - - outlineGC_ =NULL; - errorBarGC_ =NULL; - - ops->valueStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->valueStyle.color =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.font =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.angle =0; - ops->valueStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, barPenOptionSpecs); -} - -BarPen::BarPen(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, void* options) - : Pen(graphPtr, name, NULL) -{ - ops_ = options; - BarPenOptions* ops = (BarPenOptions*)ops_; - manageOptions_ =0; - - outlineGC_ =NULL; - errorBarGC_ =NULL; - - ops->valueStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->valueStyle.color =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.font =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.angle =0; - ops->valueStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, barPenOptionSpecs); -} - -BarPen::~BarPen() -{ - if (outlineGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, outlineGC_); - if (errorBarGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, errorBarGC_); -} - -int BarPen::configure() -{ - BarPenOptions* ops = (BarPenOptions*)ops_; - - // outlineGC - { - unsigned long gcMask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth; - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.line_width = ops->borderWidth; - if (ops->outlineColor) - gcValues.foreground = ops->outlineColor->pixel; - else if (ops->fill) - gcValues.foreground = Tk_3DBorderColor(ops->fill)->pixel; - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (outlineGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, outlineGC_); - outlineGC_ = newGC; - } - - // errorBarGC - { - unsigned long gcMask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth; - XGCValues gcValues; - if (ops->errorBarColor) - gcValues.foreground = ops->errorBarColor->pixel; - else if (ops->outlineColor) - gcValues.foreground = ops->outlineColor->pixel; - else if (ops->fill) - gcValues.foreground = Tk_3DBorderColor(ops->fill)->pixel; - - gcValues.line_width = ops->errorBarLineWidth; - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (errorBarGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, errorBarGC_); - errorBarGC_ = newGC; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.h deleted file mode 100644 index f39db94..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenBar.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,73 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPenBar_h__ -#define __BltGrPenBar_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - int errorBarShow; - int errorBarLineWidth; - int errorBarCapWidth; - XColor* errorBarColor; - int valueShow; - const char *valueFormat; - TextStyleOptions valueStyle; - - XColor* outlineColor; - Tk_3DBorder fill; - int borderWidth; - int relief; - } BarPenOptions; - - class BarPen : public Pen { - public: - GC fillGC_; - GC outlineGC_; - GC errorBarGC_; - - public: - BarPen(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - BarPen(Graph*, const char*, void*); - virtual ~BarPen(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_ELEM_BAR;} - const char* className() {return "BarElement";} - const char* typeName() {return "bar";} - - int configure(); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.C deleted file mode 100644 index 5f15ce8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,243 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -const char* symbolObjOption[] = - {"none", "square", "circle", "diamond", "plus", "cross", "splus", "scross", "triangle", "arrow", NULL}; - -// Defs - -static Tk_OptionSpec linePenOptionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-color", "color", "Color", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, traceColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-dashes", "dashes", "Dashes", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, traceDashes), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &dashesObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-errorbarcolor", "errorBarColor", "ErrorBarColor", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, errorBarColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarwidth", "errorBarWidth", "ErrorBarWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, errorBarLineWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-errorbarcap", "errorBarCap", "ErrorBarCap", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, errorBarCapWidth), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-fill", "fill", "Fill", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, symbol.fillColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-linewidth", "lineWidth", "LineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, traceWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-offdash", "offDash", "OffDash", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, traceOffColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-outline", "outline", "Outline", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, symbol.outlineColor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-outlinewidth", "outlineWidth", "OutlineWidth", - "1", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, symbol.outlineWidth), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-pixels", "pixels", "Pixels", - "0.1i", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, symbol.size), 0, NULL, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showerrorbars", "showErrorBars", "ShowErrorBars", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, errorBarShow), - 0, &fillObjOption, LAYOUT}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-showvalues", "showValues", "ShowValues", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueShow), 0, &fillObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-symbol", "symbol", "Symbol", - "none", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, symbol), 0, &symbolObjOption, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_ANCHOR, "-valueanchor", "valueAnchor", "ValueAnchor", - "s", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueStyle.anchor), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-valuecolor", "valueColor", "ValueColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-valuefont", "valueFont", "ValueFont", - STD_FONT_SMALL, -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueStyle.font), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-valueformat", "valueFormat", "ValueFormat", - "%g", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueFormat), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-valuerotate", "valueRotate", "ValueRotate", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LinePenOptions, valueStyle.angle), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -LinePen::LinePen(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr) - : Pen(graphPtr, name, hPtr) -{ - ops_ = calloc(1, sizeof(LinePenOptions)); - LinePenOptions* ops = (LinePenOptions*)ops_; - manageOptions_ =1; - - traceGC_ =NULL; - errorBarGC_ =NULL; - - ops->symbol.type = SYMBOL_NONE; - - ops->valueStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->valueStyle.color =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.font =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.angle =0; - ops->valueStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, linePenOptionSpecs); -} - -LinePen::LinePen(Graph* graphPtr, const char* name, void* options) - : Pen(graphPtr, name, NULL) -{ - ops_ = options; - LinePenOptions* ops = (LinePenOptions*)ops_; - manageOptions_ =0; - - traceGC_ =NULL; - errorBarGC_ =NULL; - - ops->symbol.type = SYMBOL_NONE; - - ops->valueStyle.anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->valueStyle.color =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.font =NULL; - ops->valueStyle.angle =0; - ops->valueStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, linePenOptionSpecs); -} - -LinePen::~LinePen() -{ - LinePenOptions* ops = (LinePenOptions*)ops_; - - if (errorBarGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, errorBarGC_); - - if (traceGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(traceGC_); - - if (ops->symbol.outlineGC) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, ops->symbol.outlineGC); - - if (ops->symbol.fillGC) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, ops->symbol.fillGC); -} - -int LinePen::configure() -{ - LinePenOptions* ops = (LinePenOptions*)ops_; - - // symbol outline - { - unsigned long gcMask = (GCLineWidth | GCForeground); - XColor* colorPtr = ops->symbol.outlineColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = ops->traceColor; - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.foreground = colorPtr->pixel; - gcValues.line_width = ops->symbol.outlineWidth; - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (ops->symbol.outlineGC) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, ops->symbol.outlineGC); - ops->symbol.outlineGC = newGC; - } - - // symbol fill - { - unsigned long gcMask = (GCLineWidth | GCForeground); - XColor* colorPtr = ops->symbol.fillColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = ops->traceColor; - GC newGC = NULL; - XGCValues gcValues; - if (colorPtr) { - gcValues.foreground = colorPtr->pixel; - newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - } - if (ops->symbol.fillGC) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, ops->symbol.fillGC); - ops->symbol.fillGC = newGC; - } - - // trace - { - unsigned long gcMask = - (GCLineWidth | GCForeground | GCLineStyle | GCCapStyle | GCJoinStyle); - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.cap_style = CapButt; - gcValues.join_style = JoinRound; - gcValues.line_style = LineSolid; - gcValues.line_width = ops->traceWidth; - - gcValues.foreground = ops->traceColor->pixel; - XColor* colorPtr = ops->traceOffColor; - if (colorPtr) { - gcMask |= GCBackground; - gcValues.background = colorPtr->pixel; - } - if (LineIsDashed(ops->traceDashes)) { - gcValues.line_width = ops->traceWidth; - gcValues.line_style = !colorPtr ? LineOnOffDash : LineDoubleDash; - } - GC newGC = graphPtr_->getPrivateGC(gcMask, &gcValues); - if (traceGC_) - graphPtr_->freePrivateGC(traceGC_); - - if (LineIsDashed(ops->traceDashes)) { - ops->traceDashes.offset = ops->traceDashes.values[0] / 2; - graphPtr_->setDashes(newGC, &ops->traceDashes); - } - traceGC_ = newGC; - } - - // errorbar - { - unsigned long gcMask = (GCLineWidth | GCForeground); - XColor* colorPtr = ops->errorBarColor; - if (!colorPtr) - colorPtr = ops->traceColor; - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.line_width = ops->errorBarLineWidth; - gcValues.foreground = colorPtr->pixel; - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (errorBarGC_) { - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, errorBarGC_); - } - errorBarGC_ = newGC; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.h deleted file mode 100644 index 63eeeb8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenLine.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,88 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPenLine_h__ -#define __BltGrPenLine_h__ - -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef enum { - SYMBOL_NONE, SYMBOL_SQUARE, SYMBOL_CIRCLE, SYMBOL_DIAMOND, SYMBOL_PLUS, - SYMBOL_CROSS, SYMBOL_SPLUS, SYMBOL_SCROSS, SYMBOL_TRIANGLE, SYMBOL_ARROW - } SymbolType; - - typedef struct { - SymbolType type; - int size; - XColor* outlineColor; - int outlineWidth; - GC outlineGC; - XColor* fillColor; - GC fillGC; - } Symbol; - - typedef struct { - int errorBarShow; - int errorBarLineWidth; - int errorBarCapWidth; - XColor* errorBarColor; - int valueShow; - const char* valueFormat; - TextStyleOptions valueStyle; - - Symbol symbol; - int traceWidth; - Dashes traceDashes; - XColor* traceColor; - XColor* traceOffColor; - } LinePenOptions; - - class LinePen : public Pen { - public: - GC traceGC_; - GC errorBarGC_; - - public: - LinePen(Graph*, const char*, Tcl_HashEntry*); - LinePen(Graph*, const char*, void*); - virtual ~LinePen(); - - ClassId classId() {return CID_ELEM_LINE;} - const char* className() {return "LineElement";} - const char* typeName() {return "line";} - - int configure(); - }; -}; - -extern const char* symbolObjOption[]; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 8c5669d..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,217 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1996-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -int Blt::PenObjConfigure(Graph* graphPtr, Pen* penPtr, - Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)penPtr->ops(), penPtr->optionTable(), - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (penPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc != 5) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 3, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(objv[3], &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)penPtr->ops(), - penPtr->optionTable(), - objv[4], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(objv[3], &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (objc <= 5) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)penPtr->ops(), - penPtr->optionTable(), - (objc == 5) ? objv[4] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return PenObjConfigure(graphPtr, penPtr, interp, objc-4, objv+4); -} - -static int CreateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (graphPtr->createPen(Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), objc, objv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objv[3]); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeleteOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(objv[3], &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (penPtr->refCount_ == 0) - delete penPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NamesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->penTable_, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr=Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Pen* penPtr = (Pen*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(penPtr->name_, -1)); - } - } - else { - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&graphPtr->penTable_, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr=Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Pen* penPtr = (Pen*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - for (int ii=3; iiname_, pattern)) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(penPtr->name_, -1)); - break; - } - } - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int TypeOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc<4) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(objv[3], &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), penPtr->typeName(), -1); - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::penEnsemble[] = { - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"create", CreateOp, 0}, - {"delete", DeleteOp, 0}, - {"names", NamesOp, 0}, - {"type", TypeOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5dab592..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,42 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPenOp_h__ -#define __BltGrPenOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble penEnsemble[]; - extern int PenObjConfigure(Blt::Graph* graphPtr, Blt::Pen* penPtr, - Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOption.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOption.C deleted file mode 100644 index b1da1b6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPenOption.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,89 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1996-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_CustomOptionSetProc PenSetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionGetProc PenGetProc; -static Tk_CustomOptionFreeProc PenFreeProc; -Tk_ObjCustomOption penObjOption = - { - "pen", PenSetProc, PenGetProc, RestoreProc, PenFreeProc, NULL - }; - -static int PenSetProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Tk_Window tkwin, Tcl_Obj** objPtr, char* widgRec, - int offset, char* savePtr, int flags) -{ - Pen** penPtrPtr = (Pen**)(widgRec + offset); - *(double*)savePtr = *(double*)penPtrPtr; - - if (!penPtrPtr) - return TCL_OK; - - const char* string = Tcl_GetString(*objPtr); - if (!string || !string[0]) { - *penPtrPtr = NULL; - return TCL_OK; - } - - Graph* graphPtr = getGraphFromWindowData(tkwin); - Pen* penPtr; - if (graphPtr->getPen(*objPtr, &penPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - penPtr->refCount_++; - *penPtrPtr = penPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -}; - -static Tcl_Obj* PenGetProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, - char *widgRec, int offset) -{ - Pen* penPtr = *(Pen**)(widgRec + offset); - if (!penPtr) - return Tcl_NewStringObj("", -1); - - return Tcl_NewStringObj(penPtr->name_, -1); -}; - -static void PenFreeProc(ClientData clientData, Tk_Window tkwin, char *ptr) -{ - Pen* penPtr = *(Pen**)ptr; - if (penPtr) - if (penPtr->refCount_ > 0) - penPtr->refCount_--; -} - - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.C deleted file mode 100644 index 4bbf504..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,84 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltConfig.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-center", "center", "Center", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, center), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_CUSTOM, "-comments", "comments", "Comments", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, comments), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, &listObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-decorations", "decorations", "Decorations", - "yes", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, decorations), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-footer", "footer", "Footer", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, footer), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-greyscale", "greyscale", "Greyscale", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, greyscale), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-height", "height", "Height", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, reqHeight), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-landscape", "landscape", "Landscape", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, landscape), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_INT, "-level", "level", "Level", - "2", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, level), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-padx", "padX", "PadX", - "1.0i", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, xPad), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-pady", "padY", "PadY", - "1.0i", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, yPad), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-paperheight", "paperHeight", "PaperHeight", - "11.0i", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, reqPaperHeight), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-paperwidth", "paperWidth", "PaperWidth", - "8.5i", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, reqPaperWidth), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-width", "width", "Width", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(PostscriptOptions, reqWidth), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -Postscript::Postscript(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - ops_ = (PostscriptOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(PostscriptOptions)); - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - - optionTable_ =Tk_CreateOptionTable(graphPtr_->interp_, optionSpecs); - Tk_InitOptions(graphPtr_->interp_, (char*)ops_, optionTable_, - graphPtr_->tkwin_); -} - -Postscript::~Postscript() -{ - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, graphPtr_->tkwin_); - free(ops_); -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.h deleted file mode 100644 index a0c35a1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscript.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,73 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPostscript_h__ -#define __BltGrPostscript_h__ - -#include - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - int center; - const char **comments; - int decorations; - int footer; - int greyscale; - int landscape; - int level; - int xPad; - int yPad; - int reqPaperWidth; - int reqPaperHeight; - int reqWidth; - int reqHeight; - } PostscriptOptions; - - class Postscript { - public: - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - Graph* graphPtr_; - - int left; - int bottom; - int right; - int top; - double scale; - int paperHeight; - int paperWidth; - - public: - Postscript(Graph*); - virtual ~Postscript(); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 931feb9..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,183 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -int Blt::PostscriptObjConfigure(Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Postscript* setupPtr = graphPtr->postscript_; - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)setupPtr->ops_, setupPtr->optionTable_, - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (objc != 4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Postscript *setupPtr = graphPtr->postscript_; - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)setupPtr->ops_, - setupPtr->optionTable_, - objv[3], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Postscript* setupPtr = graphPtr->postscript_; - if (objc <= 4) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)setupPtr->ops_, - setupPtr->optionTable_, - (objc == 4) ? objv[3] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return PostscriptObjConfigure(graphPtr, interp, objc-3, objv+3); -} - -static int OutputOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - const char *fileName = NULL; - Tcl_Channel channel = NULL; - if (objc > 3) { - fileName = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - if (fileName[0] != '-') { - // First argument is the file name - objv++, objc--; - - channel = Tcl_OpenFileChannel(interp, fileName, "w", 0666); - if (!channel) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (Tcl_SetChannelOption(interp, channel, "-translation", "binary") - != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - - PSOutput* psPtr = new PSOutput(graphPtr); - - if (PostscriptObjConfigure(graphPtr, interp, objc-3, objv+3) != TCL_OK) { - if (channel) - Tcl_Close(interp, channel); - delete psPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (graphPtr->print(fileName, psPtr) != TCL_OK) { - if (channel) - Tcl_Close(interp, channel); - delete psPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int length; - const char* buffer = psPtr->getValue(&length); - if (channel) { - int nBytes = Tcl_Write(channel, buffer, length); - if (nBytes < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "error writing file \"", fileName, "\": ", - Tcl_PosixError(interp), (char *)NULL); - if (channel) - Tcl_Close(interp, channel); - delete psPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Tcl_Close(interp, channel); - } - else - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), buffer, length); - - delete psPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -const Ensemble Blt::postscriptEnsemble[] = { - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"output", OutputOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index 9a81266..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,41 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrPostscriptOp_h__ -#define __BltGrPostscriptOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble postscriptEnsemble[]; - extern int PostscriptObjConfigure(Blt::Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.C deleted file mode 100644 index 0b4e3e3..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,233 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltGrText.h" -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -TextStyle::TextStyle(Graph* graphPtr) -{ - ops_ = (TextStyleOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(TextStyleOptions)); - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - manageOptions_ = 1; - - ops->anchor =TK_ANCHOR_NW; - ops->color =NULL; - ops->font =NULL; - ops->angle =0; - ops->justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - xPad_ = 0; - yPad_ = 0; - gc_ = NULL; -} - -TextStyle::TextStyle(Graph* graphPtr, TextStyleOptions* ops) -{ - ops_ = (TextStyleOptions*)ops; - graphPtr_ = graphPtr; - manageOptions_ = 0; - - xPad_ = 0; - yPad_ = 0; - gc_ = NULL; -} - -TextStyle::~TextStyle() -{ - // TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - if (gc_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, gc_); - - if (manageOptions_) - free(ops_); -} - -void TextStyle::drawText(Drawable drawable, const char *text, double x, double y) { - drawText(drawable, text, (int)x, (int)y); -} - -void TextStyle::drawText(Drawable drawable, const char *text, int x, int y) -{ - drawTextBBox(drawable, text, x, y, NULL, NULL); -} - -void TextStyle::drawTextBBox(Drawable drawable, const char *text, - int x, int y, int* ww, int* hh) -{ - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - if (!text || !(*text)) - return; - - if (!gc_) - resetStyle(); - - int w1, h1; - Tk_TextLayout layout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(ops->font, text, -1, -1, - ops->justify, 0, &w1, &h1); - Point2d rr = rotateText(x, y, w1, h1); -#if (TCL_MAJOR_VERSION == 8) && (TCL_MINOR_VERSION >= 6) - TkDrawAngledTextLayout(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, gc_, layout, - (int)rr.x, (int)rr.y, ops->angle, 0, -1); -#else - Tk_DrawTextLayout(graphPtr_->display_, drawable, gc_, layout, - (int)rr.x, (int)rr.y, 0, -1); -#endif - Tk_FreeTextLayout(layout); - - if (ww && hh) { - double angle = fmod(ops->angle, 360.0); - if (angle < 0.0) - angle += 360.0; - - if (angle != 0.0) { - double rotWidth, rotHeight; - graphPtr_->getBoundingBox(w1, h1, angle, &rotWidth, &rotHeight, NULL); - w1 = (int)rotWidth; - h1 = (int)rotHeight; - } - - *ww = w1; - *hh = h1; - } -} - -void TextStyle::printText(PSOutput* psPtr, const char *text, int x, int y) -{ - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - if (!text || !(*text)) - return; - - int w1, h1; - Tk_TextLayout layout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(ops->font, text, -1, -1, - ops->justify, 0, &w1, &h1); - - int xx =0; - int yy =0; - switch (ops->anchor) { - case TK_ANCHOR_NW: xx = 0; yy = 0; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_N: xx = 1; yy = 0; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_NE: xx = 2; yy = 0; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_E: xx = 2; yy = 1; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SE: xx = 2; yy = 2; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_S: xx = 1; yy = 2; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SW: xx = 0; yy = 2; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_W: xx = 0; yy = 1; break; - case TK_ANCHOR_CENTER: xx = 1; yy = 1; break; - } - - const char* justify =NULL; - switch (ops->justify) { - case TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT: justify = "0"; break; - case TK_JUSTIFY_CENTER: justify = "0.5"; break; - case TK_JUSTIFY_RIGHT: justify = "1"; break; - } - - psPtr->setFont(ops->font); - psPtr->setForeground(ops->color); - - psPtr->format("%g %d %d [\n", ops->angle, x, y); - Tcl_ResetResult(graphPtr_->interp_); - Tk_TextLayoutToPostscript(graphPtr_->interp_, layout); - psPtr->append(Tcl_GetStringResult(graphPtr_->interp_)); - Tcl_ResetResult(graphPtr_->interp_); - psPtr->format("] %g %g %s DrawText\n", xx/-2.0, yy/-2.0, justify); -} - -void TextStyle::printText(PSOutput* psPtr, const char *text, double x, double y) { - return printText(psPtr, text, (int)x, (int)y); -} - -void TextStyle::resetStyle() -{ - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - unsigned long gcMask; - gcMask = GCFont; - - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.font = Tk_FontId(ops->font); - if (ops->color) { - gcMask |= GCForeground; - gcValues.foreground = ops->color->pixel; - } - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(graphPtr_->tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (gc_) - Tk_FreeGC(graphPtr_->display_, gc_); - - gc_ = newGC; -} - -Point2d TextStyle::rotateText(int x, int y, int w1, int h1) -{ - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - // Matrix t0 = Translate(-x,-y); - // Matrix t1 = Translate(-w1/2,-h1/2); - // Matrix rr = Rotate(angle); - // Matrix t2 = Translate(w2/2,h2/2); - // Matrix t3 = Translate(x,y); - - double angle = ops->angle; - double ccos = cos(M_PI*angle/180.); - double ssin = sin(M_PI*angle/180.); - double w2, h2; - graphPtr_->getBoundingBox(w1, h1, angle, &w2, &h2, NULL); - - double x1 = x+w1/2.; - double y1 = y+h1/2.; - double x2 = w2/2.+x; - double y2 = h2/2.+y; - - double rx = x*ccos + y*ssin + (-x1*ccos -y1*ssin +x2); - double ry = -x*ssin + y*ccos + ( x1*ssin -y1*ccos +y2); - - return graphPtr_->anchorPoint(rx, ry, w2, h2, ops->anchor); -} - -void TextStyle::getExtents(const char *text, int* ww, int* hh) -{ - TextStyleOptions* ops = (TextStyleOptions*)ops_; - - int w, h; - graphPtr_->getTextExtents(ops->font, text, -1, &w, &h); - *ww = w + 2*xPad_; - *hh = h + 2*yPad_; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.h deleted file mode 100644 index 4593b33..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrText.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,79 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltText_h__ -#define __BltText_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -namespace Blt { - class Graph; - class PSOutput; - - typedef struct { - Tk_Anchor anchor; - XColor* color; - Tk_Font font; - double angle; - Tk_Justify justify; - } TextStyleOptions; - - class TextStyle { - protected: - Graph* graphPtr_; - void* ops_; - GC gc_; - int manageOptions_; - - public: - int xPad_; - int yPad_; - - protected: - void resetStyle(); - Point2d rotateText(int, int, int, int); - - public: - TextStyle(Graph*); - TextStyle(Graph*, TextStyleOptions*); - virtual ~TextStyle(); - - void* ops() {return ops_;} - void drawText(Drawable, const char*, int, int); - void drawText(Drawable, const char*, double, double); - void drawTextBBox(Drawable, const char*, int, int, int*, int*); - void printText(PSOutput*, const char*, int, int); - void printText(PSOutput*, const char*, double, double); - void getExtents(const char*, int*, int*); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index ac788ff..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,222 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGrXAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOp.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Axis* GetAxisFromCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Obj* obj) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr->ops_; - - int margin; - const char* name = Tcl_GetString(obj); - if (!strcmp(name,"xaxis")) - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_LEFT : MARGIN_BOTTOM; - else if (!strcmp(name,"yaxis")) - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_BOTTOM : MARGIN_LEFT; - else if (!strcmp(name,"x2axis")) - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_RIGHT : MARGIN_TOP; - else if (!strcmp(name,"y2axis")) - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_TOP : MARGIN_RIGHT; - else - return NULL; - - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->margins[margin].axes); - return (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisCgetOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisConfigureOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int ActivateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisActivateOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int BindOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return graphPtr->bindTable_->configure(graphPtr->axisTag(axisPtr->name_), objc-3, objv+3); -} - -static int InvTransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisInvTransformOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int LimitsOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisLimitsOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int TransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisTransformOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static int UseOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr->ops_; - - int margin; - ClassId classId; - const char* name = Tcl_GetString(objv[1]); - if (!strcmp(name,"xaxis")) { - classId = CID_AXIS_X; - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_LEFT : MARGIN_BOTTOM; - } - else if (!strcmp(name,"yaxis")) { - classId = CID_AXIS_Y; - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_BOTTOM : MARGIN_LEFT; - } - else if (!strcmp(name,"x2axis")) { - classId = CID_AXIS_X; - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_RIGHT : MARGIN_TOP; - } - else if (!strcmp(name,"y2axis")) { - classId = CID_AXIS_Y; - margin = (ops->inverted) ? MARGIN_TOP : MARGIN_RIGHT; - } - else - return TCL_ERROR; - - Chain* chain = ops->margins[margin].axes; - - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(axisPtr->name_, -1)); - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - - int axisObjc; - Tcl_Obj **axisObjv; - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objv[3], &axisObjc, &axisObjv) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - axisPtr->link = NULL; - axisPtr->use_ =0; - axisPtr->margin_ = MARGIN_NONE; - // Clear the axis type if it's not currently used - if (axisPtr->refCount_ == 0) - axisPtr->setClass(CID_NONE); - } - - chain->reset(); - for (int ii=0; iigetAxis(axisObjv[ii], &axisPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (axisPtr->classId_ == CID_NONE) - axisPtr->setClass(classId); - else if (axisPtr->classId_ != classId) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "wrong type axis \"", - axisPtr->name_, "\": can't use ", - axisPtr->className_, " type axis.", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (axisPtr->link) { - // Move the axis from the old margin's "use" list to the new - axisPtr->chain->unlinkLink(axisPtr->link); - chain->linkAfter(axisPtr->link, NULL); - } - else - axisPtr->link = chain->append(axisPtr); - - axisPtr->chain = chain; - axisPtr->use_ =1; - axisPtr->margin_ = margin; - } - - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ViewOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Axis* axisPtr = GetAxisFromCmd(clientData, objv[1]); - return AxisViewOp(axisPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -const Ensemble Blt::xaxisEnsemble[] = { - {"activate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"bind", BindOp, 0}, - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"deactivate", ActivateOp, 0}, - {"invtransform", InvTransformOp, 0}, - {"limits", LimitsOp, 0}, - {"transform", TransformOp, 0}, - {"use", UseOp, 0}, - {"view", ViewOp, 0}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index b813c83..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGrXAxisOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,39 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGrXAxisOp_h__ -#define __BltGrXAxisOp_h__ - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - extern const Ensemble xaxisEnsemble[]; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.C deleted file mode 100644 index f1453dc..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1458 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGraphOp.h" - -#include "tkbltGrBind.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrXAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrPSOutput.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define MARKER_ABOVE 0 -#define MARKER_UNDER 1 - -// OptionSpecs - -Graph::Graph(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - valid_ =1; - interp_ = interp; - tkwin_ = Tk_CreateWindowFromPath(interp_, Tk_MainWindow(interp_), - Tcl_GetString(objv[1]), NULL); - if (!tkwin_) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - display_ = Tk_Display(tkwin_); - ((TkWindow*)tkwin_)->instanceData = this; - - cmdToken_ = Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp_, Tk_PathName(tkwin_), - GraphInstCmdProc, this, - GraphInstCmdDeleteProc); - - flags = RESET; - nextMarkerId_ = 1; - - inset_ =0; - titleX_ =0; - titleY_ =0; - titleWidth_ =0; - titleHeight_ =0; - width_ =0; - height_ =0; - left_ =0; - right_ =0; - top_ =0; - bottom_ =0; - focusPtr_ =NULL; - halo_ =0; - drawGC_ =NULL; - vRange_ =0; - hRange_ =0; - vOffset_ =0; - hOffset_ =0; - vScale_ =0; - hScale_ =0; - cache_ =None; - cacheWidth_ =0; - cacheHeight_ =0; - - Tcl_InitHashTable(&axes_.table, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&axes_.tagTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&elements_.table, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&elements_.tagTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&markers_.table, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&markers_.tagTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&penTable_, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - - axes_.displayList = new Chain(); - elements_.displayList = new Chain(); - markers_.displayList = new Chain(); - bindTable_ = new BindTable(this, this); - - // Keep a hold of the associated tkwin until we destroy the graph, - // otherwise Tk might free it while we still need it. - Tcl_Preserve(tkwin_); - - Tk_CreateEventHandler(tkwin_, - ExposureMask|StructureNotifyMask|FocusChangeMask, - GraphEventProc, this); -} - -Graph::~Graph() -{ - // GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - destroyMarkers(); - destroyElements(); // must come before legend and others - - delete crosshairs_; - delete legend_; - delete postscript_; - - destroyAxes(); - destroyPens(); - - delete bindTable_; - - if (drawGC_) - Tk_FreeGC(display_, drawGC_); - - if (cache_ != None) - Tk_FreePixmap(display_, cache_); - - Tk_FreeConfigOptions((char*)ops_, optionTable_, tkwin_); - Tcl_Release(tkwin_); - tkwin_ = NULL; - - free (ops_); -} - -int Graph::configure() -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - inset_ = ops->borderWidth + ops->highlightWidth; - if ((ops->reqHeight != Tk_ReqHeight(tkwin_)) || - (ops->reqWidth != Tk_ReqWidth(tkwin_))) - Tk_GeometryRequest(tkwin_, ops->reqWidth, ops->reqHeight); - - Tk_SetInternalBorder(tkwin_, ops->borderWidth); - XColor* colorPtr = Tk_3DBorderColor(ops->normalBg); - - titleWidth_ =0; - titleHeight_ =0; - if (ops->title != NULL) { - int w, h; - TextStyle ts(this, &ops->titleTextStyle); - ts.getExtents(ops->title, &w, &h); - titleHeight_ = h; - } - - // Create GCs for interior and exterior regions, and a background GC for - // clearing the margins with XFillRectangle - // Margin - XGCValues gcValues; - gcValues.foreground = ops->titleTextStyle.color->pixel; - gcValues.background = colorPtr->pixel; - unsigned long gcMask = (GCForeground | GCBackground); - GC newGC = Tk_GetGC(tkwin_, gcMask, &gcValues); - if (drawGC_ != NULL) - Tk_FreeGC(display_, drawGC_); - drawGC_ = newGC; - - // If the -inverted option changed, we need to readjust the pointers - // to the axes and recompute the their scales. - adjustAxes(); - - // Free the pixmap if we're not buffering the display of elements anymore. - if (cache_ != None) { - Tk_FreePixmap(display_, cache_); - cache_ = None; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Graph::map() -{ - if (flags & RESET) { - resetAxes(); - flags &= ~RESET; - flags |= LAYOUT; - } - - if (flags & LAYOUT) { - layoutGraph(); - crosshairs_->map(); - mapAxes(); - mapElements(); - flags &= ~LAYOUT; - flags |= MAP_MARKERS | CACHE; - } - - mapMarkers(); -} - -void Graph::draw() -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - flags &= ~REDRAW_PENDING; - if ((flags & GRAPH_DELETED) || !Tk_IsMapped(tkwin_)) - return; - - // Don't bother computing the layout until the size of the window is - // something reasonable. - if ((Tk_Width(tkwin_) <= 1) || (Tk_Height(tkwin_) <= 1)) - return; - - width_ = Tk_Width(tkwin_); - height_ = Tk_Height(tkwin_); - - map(); - - // Create a pixmap the size of the window for double buffering - Pixmap drawable = Tk_GetPixmap(display_, Tk_WindowId(tkwin_), - width_, height_, Tk_Depth(tkwin_)); - - if (cache_ == None || cacheWidth_ != width_ || cacheHeight_ != height_) { - if (cache_ != None) - Tk_FreePixmap(display_, cache_); - cache_ = Tk_GetPixmap(display_, Tk_WindowId(tkwin_), width_, height_, - Tk_Depth(tkwin_)); - cacheWidth_ = width_; - cacheHeight_ = height_; - flags |= CACHE; - } - - // Update cache if needed - if (flags & CACHE) { - drawMargins(cache_); - - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::TOP: - case Legend::BOTTOM: - case Legend::RIGHT: - case Legend::LEFT: - legend_->draw(cache_); - break; - default: - break; - } - - // Draw the background of the plotting area with 3D border - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin_, cache_, ops->plotBg, - left_-ops->plotBW, - top_-ops->plotBW, - right_-left_+1+2*ops->plotBW, - bottom_-top_+1+2*ops->plotBW, - ops->plotBW, ops->plotRelief); - - drawAxesGrids(cache_); - drawAxes(cache_); - drawAxesLimits(cache_); - - if (!legend_->isRaised()) { - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::PLOT: - case Legend::XY: - legend_->draw(cache_); - break; - default: - break; - } - } - - drawMarkers(cache_, MARKER_UNDER); - drawElements(cache_); - drawActiveElements(cache_); - - if (legend_->isRaised()) { - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::PLOT: - case Legend::XY: - legend_->draw(cache_); - break; - default: - break; - } - } - - flags &= ~CACHE; - } - - XCopyArea(display_, cache_, drawable, drawGC_, 0, 0, Tk_Width(tkwin_), - Tk_Height(tkwin_), 0, 0); - - drawMarkers(drawable, MARKER_ABOVE); - - // Draw 3D border just inside of the focus highlight ring - if ((ops->borderWidth > 0) && (ops->relief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT)) - Tk_Draw3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - ops->highlightWidth, ops->highlightWidth, - width_ - 2*ops->highlightWidth, - height_ - 2*ops->highlightWidth, - ops->borderWidth, ops->relief); - - // Draw focus highlight ring - if ((ops->highlightWidth > 0) && (flags & FOCUS)) { - GC gc = Tk_GCForColor(ops->highlightColor, drawable); - Tk_DrawFocusHighlight(tkwin_, gc, ops->highlightWidth, drawable); - } - - // crosshairs - crosshairs_->draw(drawable); - - XCopyArea(display_, drawable, Tk_WindowId(tkwin_), drawGC_, - 0, 0, width_, height_, 0, 0); - - Tk_FreePixmap(display_, drawable); -} - -int Graph::print(const char* ident, PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)postscript_->ops_; - - // be sure the window is realized so that relief colors are available - if (flags & REDRAW_PENDING) { - flags |= REDRAW_PENDING; - DisplayGraph(this); - } - - // We need to know how big a graph to print. If the graph hasn't been drawn - // yet, the width and height will be 1. Instead use the requested size of - // the widget. The user can still override this with the -width and -height - // postscript options. - if (pops->reqWidth > 0) - width_ = pops->reqWidth; - else if (width_ < 2) - width_ = Tk_ReqWidth(tkwin_); - - if (pops->reqHeight > 0) - height_ = pops->reqHeight; - else if (height_ < 2) - height_ = Tk_ReqHeight(tkwin_); - - psPtr->computeBBox(width_, height_); - flags |= RESET; - - // Turn on PostScript measurements when computing the graph's layout. - reconfigure(); - - map(); - - int x = left_ - ops->plotBW; - int y = top_ - ops->plotBW; - - int w = (right_ - left_ + 1) + (2*ops->plotBW); - int h = (bottom_ - top_ + 1) + (2*ops->plotBW); - - int result = psPtr->preamble(ident); - if (result != TCL_OK) - goto error; - - psPtr->setFont(ops->titleTextStyle.font); - if (pops->decorations) - psPtr->setBackground(Tk_3DBorderColor(ops->plotBg)); - else - psPtr->setClearBackground(); - - psPtr->fillRectangle(x, y, w, h); - psPtr->append("gsave\n\n"); - - // Start - printMargins(psPtr); - - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::TOP: - case Legend::BOTTOM: - case Legend::RIGHT: - case Legend::LEFT: - legend_->print(psPtr); - break; - default: - break; - } - - printAxesGrids(psPtr); - printAxes(psPtr); - printAxesLimits(psPtr); - - if (!legend_->isRaised()) { - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::PLOT: - case Legend::XY: - legend_->print(psPtr); - break; - default: - break; - } - } - - printMarkers(psPtr, MARKER_UNDER); - printElements(psPtr); - printActiveElements(psPtr); - - if (legend_->isRaised()) { - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::PLOT: - case Legend::XY: - legend_->print(psPtr); - break; - default: - break; - } - } - printMarkers(psPtr, MARKER_ABOVE); - - psPtr->append("\n"); - psPtr->append("% Unset clipping\n"); - psPtr->append("grestore\n\n"); - psPtr->append("showpage\n"); - psPtr->append("%Trailer\n"); - psPtr->append("grestore\n"); - psPtr->append("end\n"); - psPtr->append("%EOF\n"); - - error: - width_ = Tk_Width(tkwin_); - height_ = Tk_Height(tkwin_); - reconfigure(); - - // Redraw the graph in order to re-calculate the layout as soon as - // possible. This is in the case the crosshairs are active. - flags |= LAYOUT; - eventuallyRedraw(); - - return result; -} - -void Graph::eventuallyRedraw() -{ - if (flags & GRAPH_DELETED) - return; - - if (!(flags & REDRAW_PENDING)) { - flags |= REDRAW_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(DisplayGraph, this); - } -} - -void Graph::extents(Region2d* regionPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - regionPtr->left = (double)(hOffset_ - ops->xPad); - regionPtr->top = (double)(vOffset_ - ops->yPad); - regionPtr->right = (double)(hOffset_ + hRange_ + ops->xPad); - regionPtr->bottom = (double)(vOffset_ + vRange_ + ops->yPad); -} - -int Graph::invoke(const Ensemble* ensemble, int cmdIndex, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - while (cmdIndex < objc) { - int index; - if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObjStruct(interp_, objv[cmdIndex], ensemble, sizeof(ensemble[0]), "command", 0, &index) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (ensemble[index].proc) - return ensemble[index].proc(this, interp_, objc, objv); - - ensemble = ensemble[index].subensemble; - ++cmdIndex; - } - - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp_, cmdIndex, objv, "option ?arg ...?"); - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -void Graph::reconfigure() -{ - configure(); - legend_->configure(); - configureElements(); - configureAxes(); - configureMarkers(); -} - -// Margins - -void Graph::drawMargins(Drawable drawable) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - Rectangle rects[4]; - - // Draw the four outer rectangles which encompass the plotting - // surface. This clears the surrounding area and clips the plot. - rects[0].x = rects[0].y = rects[3].x = rects[1].x = 0; - rects[0].width = rects[3].width = width_; - rects[0].height = top_; - rects[3].y = bottom_; - rects[3].height = height_ - bottom_; - rects[2].y = rects[1].y = top_; - rects[1].width = left_; - rects[2].height = rects[1].height = bottom_ - top_; - rects[2].x = right_; - rects[2].width = width_ - right_; - - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - rects[0].x, rects[0].y, rects[0].width, rects[0].height, - 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - rects[1].x, rects[1].y, rects[1].width, rects[1].height, - 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - rects[2].x, rects[2].y, rects[2].width, rects[2].height, - 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - rects[3].x, rects[3].y, rects[3].width, rects[3].height, - 0, TK_RELIEF_FLAT); - - // Draw 3D border around the plotting area - if (ops->plotBW > 0) { - int x = left_ - ops->plotBW; - int y = top_ - ops->plotBW; - int w = (right_ - left_) + (2*ops->plotBW); - int h = (bottom_ - top_) + (2*ops->plotBW); - Tk_Draw3DRectangle(tkwin_, drawable, ops->normalBg, - x, y, w, h, ops->plotBW, ops->plotRelief); - } - - if (ops->title) { - TextStyle ts(this, &ops->titleTextStyle); - ts.drawText(drawable, ops->title, titleX_, titleY_); - } -} - -void Graph::printMargins(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - PostscriptOptions* pops = (PostscriptOptions*)postscript_->ops_; - Rectangle margin[4]; - - margin[0].x = margin[0].y = margin[3].x = margin[1].x = 0; - margin[0].width = margin[3].width = width_; - margin[0].height = top_; - margin[3].y = bottom_; - margin[3].height = height_ - bottom_; - margin[2].y = margin[1].y = top_; - margin[1].width = left_; - margin[2].height = margin[1].height = bottom_ - top_; - margin[2].x = right_; - margin[2].width = width_ - right_; - - // Clear the surrounding margins and clip the plotting surface - if (pops->decorations) - psPtr->setBackground(Tk_3DBorderColor(ops->normalBg)); - else - psPtr->setClearBackground(); - - psPtr->append("% Margins\n"); - psPtr->fillRectangles(margin, 4); - - if (pops->decorations) { - psPtr->append("% Interior 3D border\n"); - if (ops->plotBW > 0) { - int x = left_ - ops->plotBW; - int y = top_ - ops->plotBW; - int w = (right_ - left_) + (2*ops->plotBW); - int h = (bottom_ - top_) + (2*ops->plotBW); - psPtr->print3DRectangle(ops->normalBg, (double)x, (double)y, w, h, - ops->plotBW, ops->plotRelief); - } - } - - if (ops->title) { - psPtr->append("% Graph title\n"); - TextStyle ts(this, &ops->titleTextStyle); - ts.printText(psPtr, ops->title, titleX_, titleY_); - } -} - -// Pens - -void Graph::destroyPens() -{ - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&penTable_, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Pen* penPtr = (Pen*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - delete penPtr; - } - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&penTable_); -} - -int Graph::getPen(Tcl_Obj* objPtr, Pen** penPtrPtr) -{ - *penPtrPtr = NULL; - const char *name = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - if (!name || !name[0]) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&penTable_, name); - if (!hPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "can't find pen \"", name, "\" in \"", - Tk_PathName(tkwin_), "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *penPtrPtr = (Pen*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -// Elements - -void Graph::destroyElements() -{ - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&elements_.table, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - legend_->removeElement(elemPtr); - delete elemPtr; - } - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&elements_.table); - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&elements_.tagTable); - delete elements_.displayList; -} - -void Graph::configureElements() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->configure(); - } -} - -void Graph::mapElements() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->map(); - } -} - -void Graph::drawElements(Drawable drawable) -{ - // Draw with respect to the stacking order - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_LastLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->draw(drawable); - } -} - -void Graph::drawActiveElements(Drawable drawable) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->drawActive(drawable); - } -} - -void Graph::printElements(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->print(psPtr); - } -} - -void Graph::printActiveElements(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - elemPtr->printActive(psPtr); - } -} - -int Graph::getElement(Tcl_Obj *objPtr, Element **elemPtrPtr) -{ - *elemPtrPtr =NULL; - const char* name = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - if (!name || !name[0]) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_HashEntry*hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&elements_.table, name); - if (!hPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "can't find element \"", name, "\" in \"", - Tk_PathName(tkwin_), "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *elemPtrPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -ClientData Graph::elementTag(const char *tagName) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&elements_.tagTable, tagName, &isNew); - return Tcl_GetHashKey(&elements_.tagTable, hPtr); -} - -// Markers - -void Graph::destroyMarkers() -{ - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&markers_.table, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr=Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - delete markerPtr; - } - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&markers_.table); - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&markers_.tagTable); - delete markers_.displayList; -} - - -void Graph::configureMarkers() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(markers_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - markerPtr->configure(); - } -} - -void Graph::mapMarkers() -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(markers_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - MarkerOptions* mops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - - if (mops->hide) - continue; - - if ((flags & MAP_MARKERS) || (markerPtr->flags & MAP_ITEM)) { - markerPtr->map(); - markerPtr->flags &= ~MAP_ITEM; - } - } - - flags &= ~MAP_MARKERS; -} - -void Graph::drawMarkers(Drawable drawable, int under) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(markers_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - MarkerOptions* mops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - - if ((mops->drawUnder != under) || markerPtr->clipped_ || mops->hide) - continue; - - if (isElementHidden(markerPtr)) - continue; - - markerPtr->draw(drawable); - } -} - -void Graph::printMarkers(PSOutput* psPtr, int under) -{ - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(markers_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - MarkerOptions* mops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - if (mops->drawUnder != under) - continue; - - if (mops->hide) - continue; - - if (isElementHidden(markerPtr)) - continue; - - psPtr->format("%% Marker \"%s\" is a %s.\n", - markerPtr->name_, markerPtr->className()); - markerPtr->print(psPtr); - } -} - -ClientData Graph::markerTag(const char* tagName) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&markers_.tagTable, tagName,&isNew); - return Tcl_GetHashKey(&markers_.tagTable, hPtr); -} - -Marker* Graph::nearestMarker(int x, int y, int under) -{ - Point2d point; - point.x = (double)x; - point.y = (double)y; - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(markers_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Marker* markerPtr = (Marker*)Chain_GetValue(link); - MarkerOptions* mops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - - if ((markerPtr->flags & MAP_ITEM) || mops->hide) - continue; - - if (isElementHidden(markerPtr)) - continue; - - if (mops->drawUnder == under) - if (markerPtr->pointIn(&point)) - return markerPtr; - } - return NULL; -} - -int Graph::isElementHidden(Marker* markerPtr) -{ - MarkerOptions* mops = (MarkerOptions*)markerPtr->ops(); - - if (mops->elemName) { - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&elements_.table, mops->elemName); - if (hPtr) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (!elemPtr->link || eops->hide) - return 1; - } - } - return 0; -} - -// Axis - -int Graph::createAxes() -{ - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&axes_.table, axisNames[ii].name, &isNew); - Chain* chain = new Chain(); - - Axis* axisPtr = new Axis(this, axisNames[ii].name, ii, hPtr); - if (!axisPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, axisPtr); - - axisPtr->refCount_ = 1; - axisPtr->use_ =1; - - axisPtr->setClass(!(ii&1) ? CID_AXIS_X : CID_AXIS_Y); - - if (Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)axisPtr->ops(), - axisPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (axisPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if ((axisPtr->margin_ == MARGIN_RIGHT) || (axisPtr->margin_ == MARGIN_TOP)) - ops->hide = 1; - - axisChain_[ii] = chain; - axisPtr->link = chain->append(axisPtr); - axisPtr->chain = chain; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Graph::createAxis(int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char *string = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - if (string[0] == '-') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "name of axis \"", string, - "\" can't start with a '-'", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&axes_.table, string, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "axis \"", string, "\" already exists in \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Axis* axisPtr = new Axis(this, Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), MARGIN_NONE, hPtr); - if (!axisPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, axisPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)axisPtr->ops(), axisPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (AxisObjConfigure(axisPtr, interp_, objc-4, objv+4) != TCL_OK)) { - delete axisPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Graph::destroyAxes() -{ - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr=Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - delete axisPtr; - } - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&axes_.table); - - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) - delete axisChain_[ii]; - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&axes_.tagTable); - delete axes_.displayList; -} - -void Graph::configureAxes() -{ - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - axisPtr->configure(); - } -} - -void Graph::mapAxes() -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - int count =0; - int offset =0; - - Chain* chain = ops->margins[ii].axes; - for (ChainLink* link=Chain_FirstLink(chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - AxisOptions* aops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - if (!axisPtr->use_) - continue; - - if (aops->reqNumMajorTicks <= 0) - aops->reqNumMajorTicks = 4; - - if (ops->stackAxes) - axisPtr->mapStacked(count, ii); - else - axisPtr->map(offset, ii); - - if (aops->showGrid) - axisPtr->mapGridlines(); - - offset += axisPtr->isHorizontal() ? axisPtr->height_ : axisPtr->width_; - count++; - } - } -} - -void Graph::drawAxes(Drawable drawable) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(ops->margins[ii].axes); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - axisPtr->draw(drawable); - } - } -} - -void Graph::drawAxesLimits(Drawable drawable) -{ - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - axisPtr->drawLimits(drawable); - } -} - -void Graph::drawAxesGrids(Drawable drawable) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->margins[ii].axes); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - axisPtr->drawGrids(drawable); - } - } -} - -void Graph::printAxes(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - for (Margin *mp = ops->margins, *mend = mp + 4; mp < mend; mp++) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(mp->axes); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - axisPtr->print(psPtr); - } - } -} - -void Graph::printAxesGrids(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(ops->margins[ii].axes); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - axisPtr->printGrids(psPtr); - } - } -} - -void Graph::printAxesLimits(PSOutput* psPtr) -{ - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - axisPtr->printLimits(psPtr); - } -} - -int Graph::getAxis(Tcl_Obj *objPtr, Axis **axisPtrPtr) -{ - *axisPtrPtr = NULL; - const char* name = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - if (!name || !name[0]) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&axes_.table, name); - if (!hPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "can't find axis \"", name, "\" in \"", - Tk_PathName(tkwin_), "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *axisPtrPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -ClientData Graph::axisTag(const char *tagName) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&axes_.tagTable, tagName, &isNew); - return Tcl_GetHashKey(&axes_.tagTable, hPtr); -} - -void Graph::adjustAxes() -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - if (ops->inverted) { - ops->leftMargin.axes = axisChain_[0]; - ops->bottomMargin.axes = axisChain_[1]; - ops->rightMargin.axes = axisChain_[2]; - ops->topMargin.axes = axisChain_[3]; - } - else { - ops->leftMargin.axes = axisChain_[1]; - ops->bottomMargin.axes = axisChain_[0]; - ops->rightMargin.axes = axisChain_[3]; - ops->topMargin.axes = axisChain_[2]; - } -} - -Point2d Graph::map2D(double x, double y, Axis* xAxis, Axis* yAxis) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - Point2d point; - if (ops->inverted) { - point.x = yAxis->hMap(y); - point.y = xAxis->vMap(x); - } - else { - point.x = xAxis->hMap(x); - point.y = yAxis->vMap(y); - } - return point; -} - -Point2d Graph::invMap2D(double x, double y, Axis* xAxis, Axis* yAxis) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - Point2d point; - if (ops->inverted) { - point.x = xAxis->invVMap(y); - point.y = yAxis->invHMap(x); - } - else { - point.x = xAxis->invHMap(x); - point.y = yAxis->invVMap(y); - } - return point; -} - -void Graph::resetAxes() -{ - // Step 1: Reset all axes. Initialize the data limits of the axis to - // impossible values. - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - axisPtr->min_ = axisPtr->valueRange_.min = DBL_MAX; - axisPtr->max_ = axisPtr->valueRange_.max = -DBL_MAX; - } - - // Step 2: For each element that's to be displayed, get the smallest - // and largest data values mapped to each X and Y-axis. This - // will be the axis limits if the user doesn't override them - // with -min and -max options. - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Region2d exts; - - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* elemops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - elemPtr->extents(&exts); - elemops->xAxis->getDataLimits(exts.left, exts.right); - elemops->yAxis->getDataLimits(exts.top, exts.bottom); - } - - // Step 3: Now that we know the range of data values for each axis, - // set axis limits and compute a sweep to generate tick values. - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - axisPtr->fixRange(); - - double min = axisPtr->min_; - double max = axisPtr->max_; - if ((!isnan(axisPtr->scrollMin_)) && (min < axisPtr->scrollMin_)) - min = axisPtr->scrollMin_; - - if ((!isnan(axisPtr->scrollMax_)) && (max > axisPtr->scrollMax_)) - max = axisPtr->scrollMax_; - - if (ops->logScale) - axisPtr->logScale(min, max); - else - axisPtr->linearScale(min, max); - } -} - -Axis* Graph::nearestAxis(int x, int y) -{ - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&axes_.table, &cursor); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Axis *axisPtr = (Axis*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - if (ops->hide || !axisPtr->use_) - continue; - - if (ops->showTicks) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(axisPtr->tickLabels_); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - TickLabel *labelPtr = (TickLabel*)Chain_GetValue(link); - double rw, rh; - Point2d bbox[5]; - getBoundingBox(labelPtr->width, labelPtr->height, ops->tickAngle, - &rw, &rh, bbox); - Point2d t; - t = anchorPoint(labelPtr->anchorPos.x, labelPtr->anchorPos.y, - rw, rh, axisPtr->tickAnchor_); - t.x = x - t.x - (rw * 0.5); - t.y = y - t.y - (rh * 0.5); - - bbox[4] = bbox[0]; - if (pointInPolygon(&t, bbox, 5)) { - return axisPtr; - } - } - } - - if (ops->title) { - int w, h; - double rw, rh; - Point2d bbox[5]; - getTextExtents(ops->titleFont, ops->title, -1, &w, &h); - getBoundingBox(w, h, axisPtr->titleAngle_, &rw, &rh, bbox); - Point2d t = anchorPoint(axisPtr->titlePos_.x, axisPtr->titlePos_.y, - rw, rh, axisPtr->titleAnchor_); - // Translate the point so that the 0,0 is the upper left - // corner of the bounding box - t.x = x - t.x - (rw * 0.5); - t.y = y - t.y - (rh * 0.5); - - bbox[4] = bbox[0]; - if (pointInPolygon(&t, bbox, 5)) { - return axisPtr; - } - } - if (ops->lineWidth > 0) { - if ((x <= axisPtr->right_) && (x >= axisPtr->left_) && - (y <= axisPtr->bottom_) && (y >= axisPtr->top_)) { - return axisPtr; - } - } - } - - return NULL; -} - -// Bind - -const char** Graph::getTags(ClientData object, ClassId classId, int* num) -{ - const char** tags =NULL; - - switch (classId) { - case CID_ELEM_BAR: - case CID_ELEM_LINE: - { - Element* ptr = (Element*)object; - ElementOptions* ops = (ElementOptions*)ptr->ops(); - int cnt =0; - for (const char** pp=ops->tags; *pp; pp++) - cnt++; - cnt +=2; - - tags = new const char*[cnt]; - tags[0] = (const char*)elementTag(ptr->name_); - tags[1] = (const char*)elementTag(ptr->className()); - int ii=2; - for (const char** pp = ops->tags; *pp; pp++, ii++) - tags[ii] = (const char*)elementTag(*pp); - - *num = cnt; - return tags; - } - break; - case CID_AXIS_X: - case CID_AXIS_Y: - { - Axis* ptr = (Axis*)object; - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)ptr->ops(); - int cnt =0; - for (const char** pp=ops->tags; *pp; pp++) - cnt++; - cnt +=2; - - tags = new const char*[cnt]; - tags[0] = (const char*)axisTag(ptr->name_); - tags[1] = (const char*)axisTag(ptr->className()); - int ii=2; - for (const char** pp = ops->tags; *pp; pp++, ii++) - tags[ii] = (const char*)axisTag(*pp); - - *num = cnt; - return tags; - } - break; - case CID_MARKER_BITMAP: - case CID_MARKER_LINE: - case CID_MARKER_POLYGON: - case CID_MARKER_TEXT: - { - Marker* ptr = (Marker*)object; - MarkerOptions* ops = (MarkerOptions*)ptr->ops(); - int cnt =0; - for (const char** pp=ops->tags; *pp; pp++) - cnt++; - cnt +=2; - - tags = new const char*[cnt]; - tags[0] = (const char*)markerTag(ptr->name_); - tags[1] = (const char*)markerTag(ptr->className()); - int ii=2; - for (const char** pp = ops->tags; *pp; pp++, ii++) - tags[ii] = (const char*)markerTag(*pp); - - *num = cnt; - return tags; - } - break; - default: - break; - } - - return NULL; -} - -ClientData Graph::pickEntry(int xx, int yy, ClassId* classIdPtr) -{ - if (flags & (LAYOUT | MAP_MARKERS)) { - *classIdPtr = CID_NONE; - return NULL; - } - - // Sample coordinate is in one of the graph margins. Can only pick an axis. - Region2d exts; - extents(&exts); - if (xx>=exts.right || xx=exts.bottom || yyclassId(); - return axisPtr; - } - } - - // From top-to-bottom check: - // 1. markers drawn on top (-under false). - // 2. elements using its display list back to front. - // 3. markers drawn under element (-under true). - Marker* markerPtr = nearestMarker(xx, yy, 0); - if (markerPtr) { - *classIdPtr = markerPtr->classId(); - return markerPtr; - } - - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - ClosestSearch* searchPtr = &ops->search; - searchPtr->index = -1; - searchPtr->x = xx; - searchPtr->y = yy; - searchPtr->dist = (double)(searchPtr->halo + 1); - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_LastLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_PrevLink(link)) { - Element* elemPtr = (Element*)Chain_GetValue(link); - ElementOptions* eops = (ElementOptions*)elemPtr->ops(); - if (eops->hide) - continue; - elemPtr->closest(); - } - - // Found an element within the minimum halo distance. - if (searchPtr->dist <= (double)searchPtr->halo) { - *classIdPtr = searchPtr->elemPtr->classId(); - return searchPtr->elemPtr; - } - - markerPtr = nearestMarker(xx, yy, 1); - if (markerPtr) { - *classIdPtr = markerPtr->classId(); - return markerPtr; - } - - *classIdPtr = CID_NONE; - return NULL; -} - -int Graph::getXY(const char* string, int* xPtr, int* yPtr) -{ - if (!string || !*string) { - *xPtr = -SHRT_MAX; - *yPtr = -SHRT_MAX; - return TCL_OK; - } - - if (*string != '@') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "bad position \"", string, - "\": should be \"@x,y\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - char* comma = (char*)strchr(string + 1, ','); - if (!comma) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "bad position \"", string, - "\": should be \"@x,y\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *comma = '\0'; - int x, y; - int result = ((Tk_GetPixels(interp_, tkwin_, string + 1, &x) == TCL_OK) && - (Tk_GetPixels(interp_, tkwin_, comma + 1, &y) == TCL_OK)); - *comma = ','; - if (!result) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, ": can't parse position \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *xPtr = x; - *yPtr = y; - return TCL_OK; -} - -// Graphics - -void Graph::drawSegments(Drawable drawable, GC gc, - Segment2d* segments, int nSegments) -{ - for (Segment2d *sp = segments, *send = sp + nSegments; sp < send; sp++) - XDrawLine(display_, drawable, gc, (int)sp->p.x, (int)sp->p.y, (int)sp->q.x, (int)sp->q.y); -} - -GC Graph::getPrivateGC(unsigned long gcMask, XGCValues *valuePtr) -{ - Pixmap pixmap = None; - Drawable drawable = Tk_WindowId(tkwin_); - Display* display = Tk_Display(tkwin_); - if (drawable == None) - drawable = RootWindow(Tk_Display(tkwin_),Tk_ScreenNumber(tkwin_)); - - GC gc = XCreateGC(display, drawable, gcMask, valuePtr); - if (pixmap != None) - Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap); - - return gc; -} - -void Graph::freePrivateGC(GC gc) -{ - Tk_FreeXId(display_, (XID)XGContextFromGC(gc)); - XFreeGC(display_, gc); -} - -void Graph::setDashes(GC gc, Dashes* dashesPtr) -{ - XSetDashes(display_, gc, dashesPtr->offset, (const char*)dashesPtr->values, - (int)strlen((char*)dashesPtr->values)); -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.h deleted file mode 100644 index 6f8df01..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraph.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,256 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGraph_h__ -#define __BltGraph_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltChain.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" -#include "tkbltGrText.h" - -typedef struct Ensemble { - const char *name; - Tcl_ObjCmdProc *proc; - const struct Ensemble *subensemble; -} Ensemble; - -namespace Blt { - class Axis; - class BindTable; - class Crosshairs; - class Element; - class Marker; - class Legend; - class Pen; - class Postscript; - class PSOutput; - - class Pick { - public: - virtual ClientData pickEntry(int, int, ClassId*) =0; - }; - - typedef struct { - int halo; - int mode; - int x; - int y; - int along; - - Element* elemPtr; - Point2d point; - int index; - double dist; - } ClosestSearch; - - typedef struct { - int width; - int height; - int axesOffset; - int axesTitleLength; - int maxTickWidth; - int maxTickHeight; - unsigned int nAxes; - Chain* axes; - int reqSize; - int site; - } Margin; - - typedef struct { - Tcl_HashTable table; - Chain* displayList; - Tcl_HashTable tagTable; - } Component; - -#define rightMargin margins[MARGIN_RIGHT] -#define leftMargin margins[MARGIN_LEFT] -#define topMargin margins[MARGIN_TOP] -#define bottomMargin margins[MARGIN_BOTTOM] - - typedef struct { - double aspect; - Tk_3DBorder normalBg; - int borderWidth; - Margin margins[4]; - Tk_Cursor cursor; - TextStyleOptions titleTextStyle; - int reqHeight; - XColor* highlightBgColor; - XColor* highlightColor; - int highlightWidth; - int inverted; - Tk_3DBorder plotBg; - int plotBW; - int xPad; - int yPad; - int plotRelief; - int relief; - ClosestSearch search; - int stackAxes; - const char *takeFocus; // nor used in C code - const char *title; - int reqWidth; - int reqPlotWidth; - int reqPlotHeight; - } GraphOptions; - - class Graph : public Pick { - public: - Tcl_Interp* interp_; - Tk_Window tkwin_; - Display *display_; - Tcl_Command cmdToken_; - Tk_OptionTable optionTable_; - void* ops_; - int valid_; - - unsigned int flags; - int nextMarkerId_; - - Component axes_; - Component elements_; - Component markers_; - Tcl_HashTable penTable_; - BindTable* bindTable_; - Chain* axisChain_[4]; - - Legend* legend_; - Crosshairs* crosshairs_; - Postscript* postscript_; - - int inset_; - int titleX_; - int titleY_; - int titleWidth_; - int titleHeight_; - int width_; - int height_; - int left_; - int right_; - int top_; - int bottom_; - Axis* focusPtr_; - int halo_; - GC drawGC_; - int vRange_; - int hRange_; - int vOffset_; - int hOffset_; - double vScale_; - double hScale_; - Pixmap cache_; - int cacheWidth_; - int cacheHeight_; - - protected: - void layoutGraph(); - - void drawMargins(Drawable); - void printMargins(PSOutput*); - int getMarginGeometry(Margin*); - - void destroyPens(); - - void destroyElements(); - void configureElements(); - virtual void mapElements(); - void drawElements(Drawable); - void drawActiveElements(Drawable); - void printElements(PSOutput*); - void printActiveElements(PSOutput*); - - void destroyMarkers(); - void configureMarkers(); - void mapMarkers(); - void drawMarkers(Drawable, int); - void printMarkers(PSOutput*, int); - - int createAxes(); - void destroyAxes(); - void configureAxes(); - void mapAxes(); - void drawAxes(Drawable); - void drawAxesLimits(Drawable); - void drawAxesGrids(Drawable); - void adjustAxes(); - - public: - Graph(ClientData, Tcl_Interp*, int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - virtual ~Graph(); - - virtual int configure(); - void map(); - void draw(); - void eventuallyRedraw(); - int print(const char*, PSOutput*); - void extents(Region2d*); - int invoke(const Ensemble*, int, int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - void reconfigure(); - - int createAxis(int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - void printAxes(PSOutput*); - void printAxesGrids(PSOutput*); - void printAxesLimits(PSOutput*); - int getAxis(Tcl_Obj*, Axis**); - ClientData axisTag(const char*); - Point2d map2D(double, double, Axis*, Axis*); - Point2d invMap2D(double, double, Axis*, Axis*); - virtual void resetAxes(); - Axis* nearestAxis(int, int); - - ClientData markerTag(const char*); - Marker* nearestMarker(int, int, int); - int isElementHidden(Marker*); - - virtual int createElement(int, Tcl_Obj* const []) =0; - int getElement(Tcl_Obj*, Element**); - ClientData elementTag(const char*); - - virtual int createPen(const char*, int, Tcl_Obj* const []) =0; - int getPen(Tcl_Obj*, Pen**); - - int getXY(const char*, int*, int*); - void getTextExtents(Tk_Font, const char*, int, int*, int*); - void getBoundingBox(int, int, double, double*, double*, Point2d*); - Point2d anchorPoint(double, double, double, double, Tk_Anchor); - - const char** getTags(ClientData, ClassId, int*); - ClientData pickEntry(int, int, ClassId*); - - void drawSegments(Drawable, GC, Segment2d*, int); - void setDashes(GC, Dashes*); - - GC getPrivateGC(unsigned long, XGCValues*); - void freePrivateGC(GC); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.C deleted file mode 100644 index 861c12a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,516 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraphBar.h" -#include "tkbltGraphOp.h" - -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrXAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -// BarGroup - -BarGroup::BarGroup() -{ - nSegments =0; - xAxis =NULL; - yAxis =NULL; - sum =0; - count =0; - lastY =0; - index =0; -} - -// BarGraph - -static const char* barmodeObjOption[] = - {"normal", "stacked", "aligned", "overlap", NULL}; -static const char* searchModeObjOption[] = {"points", "traces", "auto", NULL}; -static const char* searchAlongObjOption[] = {"x", "y", "both", NULL}; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-aspect", "aspect", "Aspect", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, aspect), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-background", "background", "Background", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, normalBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-barmode", "barMode", "BarMode", - "normal", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, barMode), - 0, &barmodeObjOption, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-barwidth", "barWidth", "BarWidth", - ".9", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, barWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-baseline", "baseline", "Baseline", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, baseline), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-bottommargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, borderWidth), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-bottommargin", "bottomMargin", "BottomMargin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, bottomMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CURSOR, "-cursor", "cursor", "Cursor", - "crosshair", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, cursor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-foreground", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-font", "font", "Font", - STD_FONT_MEDIUM, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.font), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-foreground", "foreground", "Foreground", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.color), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-halo", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-searchhalo", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-height", "height", "Height", - "4i", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, reqHeight), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-highlightbackground", "highlightBackground", - "HighlightBackground", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, highlightBgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-highlightcolor", "highlightColor", "HighlightColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, highlightColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-highlightthickness", "highlightThickness", - "HighlightThickness", - "2", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, highlightWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-invertxy", "invertXY", "InvertXY", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, inverted), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_JUSTIFY, "-justify", "justify", "Justify", - "center", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.justify), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-leftmargin", "leftMargin", "Margin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, leftMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-lm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-leftmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-plotbackground", "plotbackground", "PlotBackground", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, plotBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotborderwidth", "plotBorderWidth", "PlotBorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, plotBW), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotpadx", "plotPadX", "PlotPad", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, xPad), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotpady", "plotPadY", "PlotPad", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, yPad), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-plotrelief", "plotRelief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, plotRelief), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, relief), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-rightmargin", "rightMargin", "Margin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, rightMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-rm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-rightmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-searchhalo", "searchhalo", "SearchHalo", - "2m", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, search.halo), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-searchmode", "searchMode", "SearchMode", - "points", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, search.mode), - 0, &searchModeObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-searchalong", "searchAlong", "SearchAlong", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, search.along), - 0, &searchAlongObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-stackaxes", "stackAxes", "StackAxes", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, stackAxes), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-takefocus", "takeFocus", "TakeFocus", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, takeFocus), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-title", "title", "Title", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, title), TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-tm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-topmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-topmargin", "topMargin", "TopMargin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, topMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-width", "width", "Width", - "5i", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, reqWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotwidth", "plotWidth", "PlotWidth", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, reqPlotWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotheight", "plotHeight", "PlotHeight", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(BarGraphOptions, reqPlotHeight), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -// Create - -BarGraph::BarGraph(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) - : Graph(clientData, interp, objc, objv) -{ - // problems so far? - if (!valid_) - return; - - ops_ = (BarGraphOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(BarGraphOptions)); - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - - Tk_SetClass(tkwin_, "Barchart"); - - barGroups_ =NULL; - nBarGroups_ =0; - maxBarSetSize_ =0; - Tcl_InitHashTable(&setTable_, sizeof(BarSetKey)/sizeof(int)); - - ops->bottomMargin.site = MARGIN_BOTTOM; - ops->leftMargin.site = MARGIN_LEFT; - ops->topMargin.site = MARGIN_TOP; - ops->rightMargin.site = MARGIN_RIGHT; - - ops->titleTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_N; - ops->titleTextStyle.color =NULL; - ops->titleTextStyle.font =NULL; - ops->titleTextStyle.angle =0; - ops->titleTextStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(interp_, optionSpecs); - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)ops_, optionTable_, tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (GraphObjConfigure(this, interp_, objc-2, objv+2) != TCL_OK)) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - // do this last after Tk_SetClass set - legend_ = new Legend(this); - crosshairs_ = new Crosshairs(this); - postscript_ = new Postscript(this); - - if (createPen("active", 0, NULL) != TCL_OK) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - if (createAxes() != TCL_OK) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - adjustAxes(); - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp_), Tk_PathName(tkwin_), -1); -} - -BarGraph::~BarGraph() -{ - destroyBarSets(); -} - -int BarGraph::configure() -{ - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - // Don't allow negative bar widths. Reset to an arbitrary value (0.1) - if (ops->barWidth <= 0.0) - ops->barWidth = 0.9; - - return Graph::configure(); -} - -int BarGraph::createPen(const char* penName, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&penTable_, penName, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "pen \"", penName, "\" already exists in \"", - Tk_PathName(tkwin_), "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Pen* penPtr = new BarPen(this, penName, hPtr); - if (!penPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, penPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)penPtr->ops(), penPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (PenObjConfigure(this, penPtr, interp_, objc-4, objv+4) != TCL_OK)) { - delete penPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - flags |= RESET; - eventuallyRedraw(); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -int BarGraph::createElement(int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char *name = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - if (name[0] == '-') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "name of element \"", name, - "\" can't start with a '-'", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&elements_.table, name, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "element \"", name, - "\" already exists in \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), - "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* elemPtr = new BarElement(this, name, hPtr); - if (!elemPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, elemPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)elemPtr->ops(), elemPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (ElementObjConfigure(elemPtr, interp_, objc-4, objv+4) != TCL_OK)) { - delete elemPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - elemPtr->link = elements_.displayList->append(elemPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -void BarGraph::mapElements() -{ - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - if ((BarMode)ops->barMode != INFRONT) - resetBarSets(); - - Graph::mapElements(); -} - -void BarGraph::resetAxes() -{ - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - - /* FIXME: This should be called whenever the display list of - * elements change. Maybe yet another flag INIT_STACKS to - * indicate that the element display list has changed. - * Needs to be done before the axis limits are set. - */ - initBarSets(); - if (((BarMode)ops->barMode == STACKED) && (nBarGroups_ > 0)) - computeBarStacks(); - - Graph::resetAxes(); -} - -void BarGraph::initBarSets() -{ - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - - // Free resources associated with a previous frequency table. This includes - // the array of frequency information and the table itself - destroyBarSets(); - if ((BarMode)ops->barMode == INFRONT) - return; - - // Initialize a hash table and fill it with unique abscissas. Keep track - // of the frequency of each x-coordinate and how many abscissas have - // duplicate mappings. - Tcl_HashTable setTable; - Tcl_InitHashTable(&setTable, sizeof(BarSetKey)/sizeof(int)); - int nSegs =0; - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(elements_.displayList); - link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarElement* bePtr = (BarElement*)Chain_GetValue(link); - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)bePtr->ops(); - if (ops->hide) - continue; - - nSegs++; - if (ops->coords.x) { - int nPoints = ops->coords.x->nValues(); - for (double *x=ops->coords.x->values_, *xend=x+nPoints; xxAxis; - key.yAxis =NULL; - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hhPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&setTable, (char*)&key, &isNew); - Tcl_HashTable* tablePtr; - if (isNew) { - tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)malloc(sizeof(Tcl_HashTable)); - Tcl_InitHashTable(tablePtr, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_SetHashValue(hhPtr, tablePtr); - } - else - tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hhPtr); - - const char* name = ops->groupName ? ops->groupName : ops->yAxis->name_; - Tcl_HashEntry* hhPtr2 = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(tablePtr, name, &isNew); - size_t count =1; - if (!isNew) { - count = (size_t)Tcl_GetHashValue(hhPtr2); - count++; - } - Tcl_SetHashValue(hhPtr2, count); - } - } - } - - // no bar elements to be displayed - if (setTable.numEntries == 0) - return; - - int sum =0; - int max =0; - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hhPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&setTable, &iter); hhPtr; - hhPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - BarSetKey* keyPtr = (BarSetKey*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&setTable, hhPtr); - Tcl_HashTable* tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hhPtr); - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&setTable_, (char*)keyPtr, &isNew); - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, tablePtr); - - if (max < tablePtr->numEntries) - max = tablePtr->numEntries; // # of stacks in group - sum += tablePtr->numEntries; - } - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&setTable); - - if (sum > 0) { - barGroups_ = new BarGroup[sum]; - BarGroup* groupPtr = barGroups_; - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&setTable_, &iter); - hPtr; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - BarSetKey* keyPtr = (BarSetKey*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&setTable_, hPtr); - Tcl_HashTable* tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - - size_t xcount = 0; - Tcl_HashSearch iter2; - for (Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr2 = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(tablePtr, &iter2); - hPtr2; hPtr2 = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter2)) { - size_t count = (size_t)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr2); - groupPtr->nSegments = count; - groupPtr->xAxis = keyPtr->xAxis; - groupPtr->yAxis = keyPtr->yAxis; - groupPtr->index = xcount++; - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr2, groupPtr); - - groupPtr++; - } - } - } - - maxBarSetSize_ = max; - nBarGroups_ = sum; -} - -void BarGraph::destroyBarSets() -{ - delete [] barGroups_; - barGroups_ = NULL; - - nBarGroups_ = 0; - Tcl_HashSearch iter; - for (Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr=Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&setTable_, &iter); hPtr; - hPtr=Tcl_NextHashEntry(&iter)) { - Tcl_HashTable* tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(tablePtr); - free(tablePtr); - } - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&setTable_); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&setTable_, sizeof(BarSetKey)/sizeof(int)); -} - -void BarGraph::resetBarSets() -{ - for (BarGroup *gp = barGroups_, *gend = gp + nBarGroups_; gp < gend; gp++) { - gp->lastY = 0.0; - gp->count = 0; - } -} - -void BarGraph::computeBarStacks() -{ - BarGraphOptions* ops = (BarGraphOptions*)ops_; - - if (((BarMode)ops->barMode != STACKED) || (nBarGroups_ == 0)) - return; - - // Initialize the stack sums to zero - for (BarGroup *gp = barGroups_, *gend = gp + nBarGroups_; gp < gend; gp++) - gp->sum = 0.0; - - // Consider each bar x-y coordinate. Add the ordinates of duplicate - // abscissas - - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(elements_.displayList); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - BarElement* bePtr = (BarElement*)Chain_GetValue(link); - BarElementOptions* ops = (BarElementOptions*)bePtr->ops(); - if (ops->hide) - continue; - - if (ops->coords.x && ops->coords.y) { - for (double *x=ops->coords.x->values_, *y=ops->coords.y->values_, - *xend=x+ops->coords.x->nValues(); xxAxis; - key.yAxis =NULL; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&setTable_, (char*)&key); - if (!hPtr) - continue; - - Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr = (Tcl_HashTable*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - const char *name = ops->groupName ? ops->groupName : ops->yAxis->name_; - hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(tablePtr, name); - if (!hPtr) - continue; - - BarGroup *groupPtr = (BarGroup*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - groupPtr->sum += *y; - } - } - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.h deleted file mode 100644 index 5ee1ab8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphBar.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,119 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGraphBar_h__ -#define __BltGraphBar_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - double value; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - } BarSetKey; - - class BarGroup { - public: - int nSegments; - Axis* xAxis; - Axis* yAxis; - double sum; - int count; - double lastY; - size_t index; - - public: - BarGroup(); - }; - - typedef struct { - double aspect; - Tk_3DBorder normalBg; - int borderWidth; - Margin margins[4]; - Tk_Cursor cursor; - TextStyleOptions titleTextStyle; - int reqHeight; - XColor* highlightBgColor; - XColor* highlightColor; - int highlightWidth; - int inverted; - Tk_3DBorder plotBg; - int plotBW; - int xPad; - int yPad; - int plotRelief; - int relief; - ClosestSearch search; - int stackAxes; - const char *takeFocus; // nor used in C code - const char *title; - int reqWidth; - int reqPlotWidth; - int reqPlotHeight; - - // bar graph - int barMode; - double barWidth; - double baseline; - } BarGraphOptions; - - class BarGraph : public Graph { - public: - enum BarMode {INFRONT, STACKED, ALIGNED, OVERLAP}; - - public: - BarGroup* barGroups_; - int nBarGroups_; - Tcl_HashTable setTable_; - int maxBarSetSize_; - - protected: - void resetAxes(); - void mapElements(); - void initBarSets(); - void destroyBarSets(); - void resetBarSets(); - void computeBarStacks(); - - public: - BarGraph(ClientData, Tcl_Interp*, int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - virtual ~BarGraph(); - - int configure(); - int createPen(const char*, int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - int createElement(int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.C deleted file mode 100644 index fe3f5d0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,267 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraphLine.h" -#include "tkbltGraphOp.h" - -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrXAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemBar.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemLine.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrDef.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static const char* searchModeObjOption[] = {"points", "traces", "auto", NULL}; -static const char* searchAlongObjOption[] = {"x", "y", "both", NULL}; - -static Tk_OptionSpec optionSpecs[] = { - {TK_OPTION_DOUBLE, "-aspect", "aspect", "Aspect", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, aspect), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-background", "background", "Background", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, normalBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bd", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-borderwidth", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-background", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-bm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-bottommargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-borderwidth", "borderWidth", "BorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, borderWidth), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-bottommargin", "bottomMargin", "BottomMargin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, bottomMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_CURSOR, "-cursor", "cursor", "Cursor", - "crosshair", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, cursor), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-fg", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-foreground", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_FONT, "-font", "font", "Font", - STD_FONT_MEDIUM, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.font), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-foreground", "foreground", "Foreground", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, - Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.color), 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-halo", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-searchhalo", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-height", "height", "Height", - "4i", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, reqHeight), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-highlightbackground", "highlightBackground", - "HighlightBackground", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, highlightBgColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_COLOR, "-highlightcolor", "highlightColor", "HighlightColor", - STD_NORMAL_FOREGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, highlightColor), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-highlightthickness", "highlightThickness", - "HighlightThickness", - "2", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, highlightWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-invertxy", "invertXY", "InvertXY", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, inverted), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_JUSTIFY, "-justify", "justify", "Justify", - "center", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, titleTextStyle.justify), - 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-leftmargin", "leftMargin", "Margin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, leftMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-lm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-leftmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BORDER, "-plotbackground", "plotbackground", "PlotBackground", - STD_NORMAL_BACKGROUND, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, plotBg), - 0, NULL, CACHE}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotborderwidth", "plotBorderWidth", "PlotBorderWidth", - STD_BORDERWIDTH, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, plotBW), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotpadx", "plotPadX", "PlotPad", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, xPad), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotpady", "plotPadY", "PlotPad", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, yPad), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-plotrelief", "plotRelief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, plotRelief), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_RELIEF, "-relief", "relief", "Relief", - "flat", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, relief), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-rightmargin", "rightMargin", "Margin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, rightMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-rm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-rightmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-searchhalo", "searchhalo", "SearchHalo", - "2m", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, search.halo), 0, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-searchmode", "searchMode", "SearchMode", - "points", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, search.mode), - 0, &searchModeObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING_TABLE, "-searchalong", "searchAlong", "SearchAlong", - "both", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, search.along), - 0, &searchAlongObjOption, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_BOOLEAN, "-stackaxes", "stackAxes", "StackAxes", - "no", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, stackAxes), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-takefocus", "takeFocus", "TakeFocus", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, takeFocus), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, 0}, - {TK_OPTION_STRING, "-title", "title", "Title", - NULL, -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, title), - TK_OPTION_NULL_OK, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_SYNONYM, "-tm", NULL, NULL, - NULL, 0, -1, 0, (ClientData)"-topmargin", 0}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-topmargin", "topMargin", "TopMargin", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, topMargin.reqSize), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-width", "width", "Width", - "5i", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, reqWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotwidth", "plotWidth", "PlotWidth", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, reqPlotWidth), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_PIXELS, "-plotheight", "plotHeight", "PlotHeight", - "0", -1, Tk_Offset(LineGraphOptions, reqPlotHeight), 0, NULL, RESET}, - {TK_OPTION_END, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0, -1, 0, 0, 0} -}; - -// Create - -LineGraph::LineGraph(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) - : Graph(clientData, interp, objc, objv) -{ - // problems so far? - if (!valid_) - return; - - ops_ = (LineGraphOptions*)calloc(1, sizeof(LineGraphOptions)); - LineGraphOptions* ops = (LineGraphOptions*)ops_; - - Tk_SetClass(tkwin_, "Graph"); - - ops->bottomMargin.site = MARGIN_BOTTOM; - ops->leftMargin.site = MARGIN_LEFT; - ops->topMargin.site = MARGIN_TOP; - ops->rightMargin.site = MARGIN_RIGHT; - - ops->titleTextStyle.anchor = TK_ANCHOR_N; - ops->titleTextStyle.color =NULL; - ops->titleTextStyle.font =NULL; - ops->titleTextStyle.angle =0; - ops->titleTextStyle.justify =TK_JUSTIFY_LEFT; - - optionTable_ = Tk_CreateOptionTable(interp_, optionSpecs); - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)ops_, optionTable_, tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (GraphObjConfigure(this, interp_, objc-2, objv+2) != TCL_OK)) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - // do this last after Tk_SetClass set - legend_ = new Legend(this); - crosshairs_ = new Crosshairs(this); - postscript_ = new Postscript(this); - - if (createPen("active", 0, NULL) != TCL_OK) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - if (createAxes() != TCL_OK) { - valid_ =0; - return; - } - - adjustAxes(); - - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp_), Tk_PathName(tkwin_), -1); -} - -LineGraph::~LineGraph() -{ -} - -int LineGraph::createPen(const char* penName, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&penTable_, penName, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "pen \"", penName, "\" already exists in \"", - Tk_PathName(tkwin_), "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Pen* penPtr = new LinePen(this, penName, hPtr); - if (!penPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, penPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)penPtr->ops(), penPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (PenObjConfigure(this, penPtr, interp_, objc-4, objv+4) != TCL_OK)) { - delete penPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -int LineGraph::createElement(int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char *name = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - if (name[0] == '-') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "name of element \"", name, - "\" can't start with a '-'", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int isNew; - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = - Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&elements_.table, name, &isNew); - if (!isNew) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp_, "element \"", name, - "\" already exists in \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), - "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Element* elemPtr = new LineElement(this, name, hPtr); - if (!elemPtr) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, elemPtr); - - if ((Tk_InitOptions(interp_, (char*)elemPtr->ops(), elemPtr->optionTable(), tkwin_) != TCL_OK) || (ElementObjConfigure(elemPtr, interp_, objc-4, objv+4) != TCL_OK)) { - delete elemPtr; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - elemPtr->link = elements_.displayList->append(elemPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.h deleted file mode 100644 index ea8d2a0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphLine.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,76 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGraphLine_h__ -#define __BltGraphLine_h__ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - double aspect; - Tk_3DBorder normalBg; - int borderWidth; - Margin margins[4]; - Tk_Cursor cursor; - Blt::TextStyleOptions titleTextStyle; - int reqHeight; - XColor* highlightBgColor; - XColor* highlightColor; - int highlightWidth; - int inverted; - Tk_3DBorder plotBg; - int plotBW; - int xPad; - int yPad; - int plotRelief; - int relief; - ClosestSearch search; - int stackAxes; - const char *takeFocus; // nor used in C code - const char *title; - int reqWidth; - int reqPlotWidth; - int reqPlotHeight; - } LineGraphOptions; - - class LineGraph : public Graph { - public: - LineGraph(ClientData, Tcl_Interp*, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const []); - virtual ~LineGraph(); - - int createElement(int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - int createPen(const char*, int, Tcl_Obj* const []); - }; -}; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index ada2758..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,462 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGraphLine.h" -#include "tkbltGraphBar.h" -#include "tkbltGraphOp.h" - -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxisOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrElemOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairs.h" -#include "tkbltGrHairsOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegdOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarker.h" -#include "tkbltGrMarkerOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscript.h" -#include "tkbltGrPostscriptOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrPen.h" -#include "tkbltGrPenOp.h" -#include "tkbltGrXAxisOp.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static Tcl_ObjCmdProc BarchartObjCmd; -static Tcl_ObjCmdProc GraphObjCmd; - -static Axis* GetFirstAxis(Chain* chain); - -int GraphObjConfigure(Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tk_SavedOptions savedOptions; - int mask =0; - int error; - Tcl_Obj* errorResult; - - for (error=0; error<=1; error++) { - if (!error) { - if (Tk_SetOptions(interp, (char*)graphPtr->ops_, graphPtr->optionTable_, - objc, objv, graphPtr->tkwin_, &savedOptions, &mask) - != TCL_OK) - continue; - } - else { - errorResult = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - Tcl_IncrRefCount(errorResult); - Tk_RestoreSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - } - - if (graphPtr->configure() != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - graphPtr->flags |= mask; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - - break; - } - - if (!error) { - Tk_FreeSavedOptions(&savedOptions); - return TCL_OK; - } - else { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, errorResult); - Tcl_DecrRefCount(errorResult); - return TCL_ERROR; - } -} - -static int CgetOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc != 3) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, "cget option"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionValue(interp, - (char*)graphPtr->ops_, - graphPtr->optionTable_, - objv[2], graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ConfigureOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (objc <= 3) { - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tk_GetOptionInfo(interp, (char*)graphPtr->ops_, - graphPtr->optionTable_, - (objc == 3) ? objv[2] : NULL, - graphPtr->tkwin_); - if (objPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - else - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - else - return GraphObjConfigure(graphPtr, interp, objc-2, objv+2); -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * ExtentsOp -- - * - * Reports the size of one of several items within the graph. The - * following are valid items: - * - * "bottommargin" Height of the bottom margin - * "leftmargin" Width of the left margin - * "legend" x y w h of the legend - * "plotarea" x y w h of the plotarea - * "plotheight" Height of the plot area - * "rightmargin" Width of the right margin - * "topmargin" Height of the top margin - * "plotwidth" Width of the plot area - * - * Results: - * Always returns TCL_OK. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ - -static int ExtentsOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)graphPtr->ops_; - int length; - const char* string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[2], &length); - char c = string[0]; - if ((c == 'p') && (length > 4) && - (strncmp("plotheight", string, length) == 0)) { - int height = graphPtr->bottom_ - graphPtr->top_ + 1; - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), height); - } - else if ((c == 'p') && (length > 4) && - (strncmp("plotwidth", string, length) == 0)) { - int width = graphPtr->right_ - graphPtr->left_ + 1; - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), width); - } - else if ((c == 'p') && (length > 4) && - (strncmp("plotarea", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->left_)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->top_)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->right_ - graphPtr->left_+1)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->bottom_ - graphPtr->top_+1)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - else if ((c == 'l') && (length > 2) && - (strncmp("legend", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->legend_->x_)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->legend_->y_)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->legend_->width_)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(graphPtr->legend_->height_)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - else if ((c == 'l') && (length > 2) && - (strncmp("leftmargin", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), ops->leftMargin.width); - } - else if ((c == 'r') && (length > 1) && - (strncmp("rightmargin", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), ops->rightMargin.width); - } - else if ((c == 't') && (length > 1) && - (strncmp("topmargin", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), ops->topMargin.height); - } - else if ((c == 'b') && (length > 1) && - (strncmp("bottommargin", string, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), ops->bottomMargin.height); - } - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad extent item \"", objv[2], - "\": should be plotheight, plotwidth, leftmargin, rightmargin, \ -topmargin, bottommargin, plotarea, or legend", (char*)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int InsideOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc != 4) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "x y"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - int x; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[2], &x) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int y; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[3], &y) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Region2d exts; - graphPtr->extents(&exts); - - int result = (x<=exts.right && x>=exts.left && y<=exts.bottom && y>=exts.top); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), result); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int InvtransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - double x, y; - if ((Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &x) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &y) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - // Perform the reverse transformation, converting from window coordinates - // to graph data coordinates. Note that the point is always mapped to the - // bottom and left axes (which may not be what the user wants) - Axis* xAxis = GetFirstAxis(graphPtr->axisChain_[0]); - Axis* yAxis = GetFirstAxis(graphPtr->axisChain_[1]); - Point2d point = graphPtr->invMap2D(x, y, xAxis, yAxis); - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(point.x)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(point.y)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int TransformOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - double x, y; - if ((Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &x) != TCL_OK) || - (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &y) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (graphPtr->flags & RESET) - graphPtr->resetAxes(); - - // Perform the transformation from window to graph coordinates. Note that - // the points are always mapped onto the bottom and left axes (which may - // not be the what the user wants - Axis* xAxis = GetFirstAxis(graphPtr->axisChain_[0]); - Axis* yAxis = GetFirstAxis(graphPtr->axisChain_[1]); - - Point2d point = graphPtr->map2D(x, y, xAxis, yAxis); - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewIntObj((int)point.x)); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewIntObj((int)point.y)); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static const Ensemble graphEnsemble[] = { - {"axis", 0, Blt::axisEnsemble}, - {"bar", 0, Blt::elementEnsemble}, - {"cget", CgetOp, 0}, - {"configure", ConfigureOp, 0}, - {"crosshairs", 0, Blt::crosshairsEnsemble}, - {"element", 0, Blt::elementEnsemble}, - {"extents", ExtentsOp, 0}, - {"inside", InsideOp, 0}, - {"invtransform",InvtransformOp, 0}, - {"legend", 0, Blt::legendEnsemble}, - {"line", 0, Blt::elementEnsemble}, - {"marker", 0, Blt::markerEnsemble}, - {"pen", 0, Blt::penEnsemble}, - {"postscript", 0, Blt::postscriptEnsemble}, - {"transform", TransformOp, 0}, - {"xaxis", 0, Blt::xaxisEnsemble}, - {"yaxis", 0, Blt::xaxisEnsemble}, - {"x2axis", 0, Blt::xaxisEnsemble}, - {"y2axis", 0, Blt::xaxisEnsemble}, - { 0,0,0 } -}; - -// Support - -static Axis* GetFirstAxis(Chain* chain) -{ - ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(chain); - if (!link) - return NULL; - - return (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); -} - -// Tk Interface - -int Blt_GraphCmdInitProc(Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - Tcl_Namespace* nsPtr = Tcl_FindNamespace(interp, "::blt", NULL, - TCL_LEAVE_ERR_MSG); - if (nsPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - { - const char* cmdPath = "::blt::graph"; - Tcl_Command cmdToken = Tcl_FindCommand(interp, cmdPath, NULL, 0); - if (cmdToken) - return TCL_OK; - cmdToken = Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, cmdPath, GraphObjCmd, NULL, NULL); - if (Tcl_Export(interp, nsPtr, "graph", 0) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - { - const char* cmdPath = "::blt::barchart"; - Tcl_Command cmdToken = Tcl_FindCommand(interp, cmdPath, NULL, 0); - if (cmdToken) - return TCL_OK; - cmdToken = Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, cmdPath, BarchartObjCmd, NULL,NULL); - if (Tcl_Export(interp, nsPtr, "barchart", 0) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int GraphObjCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc < 2) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, "pathName ?options?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Graph* graphPtr = new LineGraph(clientData, interp, objc, objv); - return graphPtr->valid_ ? TCL_OK : TCL_ERROR; -} - -static int BarchartObjCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc < 2) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, "pathName ?options?"); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Graph* graphPtr = new BarGraph(clientData, interp, objc, objv); - return graphPtr->valid_ ? TCL_OK : TCL_ERROR; -} - -int GraphInstCmdProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - Tcl_Preserve(graphPtr); - int result = graphPtr->invoke(graphEnsemble, 1, objc, objv); - Tcl_Release(graphPtr); - return result; -} - -// called by Tcl_DeleteCommand -void GraphInstCmdDeleteProc(ClientData clientData) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - if (!(graphPtr->flags & GRAPH_DELETED)) - Tk_DestroyWindow(graphPtr->tkwin_); -} - -void GraphEventProc(ClientData clientData, XEvent* eventPtr) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - - if (eventPtr->type == Expose) { - if (eventPtr->xexpose.count == 0) - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } - else if (eventPtr->type == FocusIn || eventPtr->type == FocusOut) { - if (eventPtr->xfocus.detail != NotifyInferior) { - if (eventPtr->type == FocusIn) - graphPtr->flags |= FOCUS; - else - graphPtr->flags &= ~FOCUS; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } - } - else if (eventPtr->type == DestroyNotify) { - if (!(graphPtr->flags & GRAPH_DELETED)) { - graphPtr->flags |= GRAPH_DELETED; - Tcl_DeleteCommandFromToken(graphPtr->interp_, graphPtr->cmdToken_); - if (graphPtr->flags & REDRAW_PENDING) - Tcl_CancelIdleCall(DisplayGraph, graphPtr); - Tcl_EventuallyFree(graphPtr, DestroyGraph); - } - } - else if (eventPtr->type == ConfigureNotify) { - graphPtr->flags |= RESET; - graphPtr->eventuallyRedraw(); - } -} - -void DisplayGraph(ClientData clientData) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)clientData; - graphPtr->draw(); -} - -// called by Tcl_EventuallyFree and others -void DestroyGraph(char* dataPtr) -{ - Graph* graphPtr = (Graph*)dataPtr; - delete graphPtr; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index ff3f6ef..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,44 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltGraphOp_h__ -#define __BltGraphOp_h__ - -#include - -extern int GraphObjConfigure(Blt::Graph* graphPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); - -extern Tcl_ObjCmdProc GraphInstCmdProc; -extern Tcl_CmdDeleteProc GraphInstCmdDeleteProc; -extern Tk_EventProc GraphEventProc; -extern Tcl_IdleProc DisplayGraph; -extern Tcl_FreeProc DestroyGraph; - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphSup.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphSup.C deleted file mode 100644 index d5eb3d1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltGraphSup.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,686 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltGraph.h" -#include "tkbltGrAxis.h" -#include "tkbltGrElem.h" -#include "tkbltGrLegd.h" -#include "tkbltGrMisc.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define AXIS_PAD_TITLE 2 -#define ROTATE_0 0 -#define ROTATE_90 1 -#define ROTATE_180 2 -#define ROTATE_270 3 - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * layoutGraph -- - * - * Calculate the layout of the graph. Based upon the data, axis limits, - * X and Y titles, and title height, determine the cavity left which is - * the plotting surface. The first step get the data and axis limits for - * calculating the space needed for the top, bottom, left, and right - * margins. - * - * 1) The LEFT margin is the area from the left border to the Y axis - * (not including ticks). It composes the border width, the width an - * optional Y axis label and its padding, and the tick numeric labels. - * The Y axis label is rotated 90 degrees so that the width is the - * font height. - * - * 2) The RIGHT margin is the area from the end of the graph - * to the right window border. It composes the border width, - * some padding, the font height (this may be dubious. It - * appears to provide a more even border), the max of the - * legend width and 1/2 max X tick number. This last part is - * so that the last tick label is not clipped. - * - * Window Width - * ___________________________________________________________ - * | | | | - * | | TOP height of title | | - * | | | | - * | | x2 title | | - * | | | | - * | | height of x2-axis | | - * |__________|_______________________________|_______________| W - * | | -plotpady | | i - * |__________|_______________________________|_______________| n - * | | top right | | d - * | | | | o - * | LEFT | | RIGHT | w - * | | | | - * | y | Free area = 104% | y2 | H - * | | Plotting surface = 100% | | e - * | t | Tick length = 2 + 2% | t | i - * | i | | i | g - * | t | | t legend| h - * | l | | l width| t - * | e | | e | - * | height| |height | - * | of | | of | - * | y-axis| |y2-axis | - * | | | | - * | |origin 0,0 | | - * |__________|_left_________________bottom___|_______________| - * | |-plotpady | | - * |__________|_______________________________|_______________| - * | | (xoffset, yoffset) | | - * | | | | - * | | height of x-axis | | - * | | | | - * | | BOTTOM x title | | - * |__________|_______________________________|_______________| - * - * 3) The TOP margin is the area from the top window border to the top - * of the graph. It composes the border width, twice the height of - * the title font (if one is given) and some padding between the - * title. - * - * 4) The BOTTOM margin is area from the bottom window border to the - * X axis (not including ticks). It composes the border width, the height - * an optional X axis label and its padding, the height of the font - * of the tick labels. - * - * The plotting area is between the margins which includes the X and Y axes - * including the ticks but not the tick numeric labels. The length of the - * ticks and its padding is 5% of the entire plotting area. Hence the entire - * plotting area is scaled as 105% of the width and height of the area. - * - * The axis labels, ticks labels, title, and legend may or may not be - * displayed which must be taken into account. - * - * if reqWidth > 0 : set outer size - * if reqPlotWidth > 0 : set plot size - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ - -void Graph::layoutGraph() -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - - int width = width_; - int height = height_; - - // Step 1 - // Compute the amount of space needed to display the axes - // associated with each margin. They can be overridden by - // -leftmargin, -rightmargin, -bottommargin, and -topmargin - // graph options, respectively. - int left = getMarginGeometry(&ops->leftMargin); - int right = getMarginGeometry(&ops->rightMargin); - int top = getMarginGeometry(&ops->topMargin); - int bottom = getMarginGeometry(&ops->bottomMargin); - - int pad = ops->bottomMargin.maxTickWidth; - if (pad < ops->topMargin.maxTickWidth) - pad = ops->topMargin.maxTickWidth; - - pad = pad / 2 + 3; - if (right < pad) - right = pad; - - if (left < pad) - left = pad; - - pad = ops->leftMargin.maxTickHeight; - if (pad < ops->rightMargin.maxTickHeight) - pad = ops->rightMargin.maxTickHeight; - - pad = pad / 2; - if (top < pad) - top = pad; - - if (bottom < pad) - bottom = pad; - - if (ops->leftMargin.reqSize > 0) - left = ops->leftMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->rightMargin.reqSize > 0) - right = ops->rightMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->topMargin.reqSize > 0) - top = ops->topMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->bottomMargin.reqSize > 0) - bottom = ops->bottomMargin.reqSize; - - // Step 2 - // Add the graph title height to the top margin. - if (ops->title) - top += titleHeight_ + 6; - - int inset = (inset_ + ops->plotBW); - int inset2 = 2 * inset; - - // Step 3 - // Estimate the size of the plot area from the remaining - // space. This may be overridden by the -plotwidth and - // -plotheight graph options. We use this to compute the - // size of the legend. - if (width == 0) - width = 400; - - if (height == 0) - height = 400; - - int plotWidth = (ops->reqPlotWidth > 0) ? ops->reqPlotWidth : - width - (inset2 + left + right); - int plotHeight = (ops->reqPlotHeight > 0) ? ops->reqPlotHeight : - height - (inset2 + top + bottom); - legend_->map(plotWidth, plotHeight); - - // Step 4 - // Add the legend to the appropiate margin. - if (!legend_->isHidden()) { - switch (legend_->position()) { - case Legend::RIGHT: - right += legend_->width_ + 2; - break; - case Legend::LEFT: - left += legend_->width_ + 2; - break; - case Legend::TOP: - top += legend_->height_ + 2; - break; - case Legend::BOTTOM: - bottom += legend_->height_ + 2; - break; - case Legend::XY: - case Legend::PLOT: - break; - } - } - - // Recompute the plotarea or graph size, now accounting for the legend. - if (ops->reqPlotWidth == 0) { - plotWidth = width - (inset2 + left + right); - if (plotWidth < 1) - plotWidth = 1; - } - if (ops->reqPlotHeight == 0) { - plotHeight = height - (inset2 + top + bottom); - if (plotHeight < 1) - plotHeight = 1; - } - - // Step 5 - // If necessary, correct for the requested plot area aspect ratio. - if ((ops->reqPlotWidth == 0) && (ops->reqPlotHeight == 0) && - (ops->aspect > 0.0)) { - double ratio; - - // Shrink one dimension of the plotarea to fit the requested - // width/height aspect ratio. - ratio = plotWidth / plotHeight; - if (ratio > ops->aspect) { - // Shrink the width - int scaledWidth = (int)(plotHeight * ops->aspect); - if (scaledWidth < 1) - scaledWidth = 1; - - // Add the difference to the right margin. - // CHECK THIS: w = scaledWidth - right += (plotWidth - scaledWidth); - } - else { - // Shrink the height - int scaledHeight = (int)(plotWidth / ops->aspect); - if (scaledHeight < 1) - scaledHeight = 1; - - // Add the difference to the top margin - // CHECK THIS: h = scaledHeight; - top += (plotHeight - scaledHeight); - } - } - - // Step 6 - // If there's multiple axes in a margin, the axis titles will be - // displayed in the adjoining margins. Make sure there's room - // for the longest axis titles. - if (top < ops->leftMargin.axesTitleLength) - top = ops->leftMargin.axesTitleLength; - - if (right < ops->bottomMargin.axesTitleLength) - right = ops->bottomMargin.axesTitleLength; - - if (top < ops->rightMargin.axesTitleLength) - top = ops->rightMargin.axesTitleLength; - - if (right < ops->topMargin.axesTitleLength) - right = ops->topMargin.axesTitleLength; - - // Step 7 - // Override calculated values with requested margin sizes. - if (ops->leftMargin.reqSize > 0) - left = ops->leftMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->rightMargin.reqSize > 0) - right = ops->rightMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->topMargin.reqSize > 0) - top = ops->topMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->bottomMargin.reqSize > 0) - bottom = ops->bottomMargin.reqSize; - - if (ops->reqPlotWidth > 0) { - // Width of plotarea is constained. If there's extra space, add it to - // the left and/or right margins. If there's too little, grow the - // graph width to accomodate it. - int w = plotWidth + inset2 + left + right; - - // Extra space in window - if (width > w) { - int extra = (width - w) / 2; - if (ops->leftMargin.reqSize == 0) { - left += extra; - if (ops->rightMargin.reqSize == 0) - right += extra; - else - left += extra; - } - else if (ops->rightMargin.reqSize == 0) - right += extra + extra; - } - else if (width < w) - width = w; - } - - // Constrain the plotarea height - if (ops->reqPlotHeight > 0) { - - // Height of plotarea is constained. If there's extra space, - // add it to th top and/or bottom margins. If there's too little, - // grow the graph height to accomodate it. - int h = plotHeight + inset2 + top + bottom; - - // Extra space in window - if (height > h) { - int extra = (height - h) / 2; - if (ops->topMargin.reqSize == 0) { - top += extra; - if (ops->bottomMargin.reqSize == 0) - bottom += extra; - else - top += extra; - } - else if (ops->bottomMargin.reqSize == 0) - bottom += extra + extra; - } - else if (height < h) - height = h; - } - - width_ = width; - height_ = height; - left_ = left + inset; - top_ = top + inset; - right_ = width - right - inset; - bottom_ = height - bottom - inset; - - ops->leftMargin.width = left + inset_; - ops->rightMargin.width = right + inset_; - ops->topMargin.height = top + inset_; - ops->bottomMargin.height = bottom + inset_; - - vOffset_ = top_ + ops->yPad; - vRange_ = plotHeight - 2*ops->yPad; - hOffset_ = left_ + ops->xPad; - hRange_ = plotWidth - 2*ops->xPad; - - if (vRange_ < 1) - vRange_ = 1; - - if (hRange_ < 1) - hRange_ = 1; - - hScale_ = 1.0 / hRange_; - vScale_ = 1.0 / vRange_; - - // Calculate the placement of the graph title so it is centered within the - // space provided for it in the top margin - titleY_ = 3 + inset_; - titleX_ = (right_ + left_) / 2; -} - -int Graph::getMarginGeometry(Margin *marginPtr) -{ - GraphOptions* ops = (GraphOptions*)ops_; - int isHoriz = !(marginPtr->site & 0x1); /* Even sites are horizontal */ - - // Count the visible axes. - unsigned int nVisible = 0; - unsigned int l =0; - int w =0; - int h =0; - - marginPtr->maxTickWidth =0; - marginPtr->maxTickHeight =0; - - if (ops->stackAxes) { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(marginPtr->axes); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - if (!ops->hide && axisPtr->use_) { - nVisible++; - axisPtr->getGeometry(); - - if (isHoriz) { - if (h < axisPtr->height_) - h = axisPtr->height_; - } - else { - if (w < axisPtr->width_) - w = axisPtr->width_; - } - if (axisPtr->maxTickWidth_ > marginPtr->maxTickWidth) - marginPtr->maxTickWidth = axisPtr->maxTickWidth_; - - if (axisPtr->maxTickHeight_ > marginPtr->maxTickHeight) - marginPtr->maxTickHeight = axisPtr->maxTickHeight_; - } - } - } - else { - for (ChainLink* link = Chain_FirstLink(marginPtr->axes); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - Axis* axisPtr = (Axis*)Chain_GetValue(link); - AxisOptions* ops = (AxisOptions*)axisPtr->ops(); - if (!ops->hide && axisPtr->use_) { - nVisible++; - axisPtr->getGeometry(); - - if ((ops->titleAlternate) && (l < axisPtr->titleWidth_)) - l = axisPtr->titleWidth_; - - if (isHoriz) - h += axisPtr->height_; - else - w += axisPtr->width_; - - if (axisPtr->maxTickWidth_ > marginPtr->maxTickWidth) - marginPtr->maxTickWidth = axisPtr->maxTickWidth_; - - if (axisPtr->maxTickHeight_ > marginPtr->maxTickHeight) - marginPtr->maxTickHeight = axisPtr->maxTickHeight_; - } - } - } - // Enforce a minimum size for margins. - if (w < 3) - w = 3; - - if (h < 3) - h = 3; - - marginPtr->nAxes = nVisible; - marginPtr->axesTitleLength = l; - marginPtr->width = w; - marginPtr->height = h; - marginPtr->axesOffset = (isHoriz) ? h : w; - return marginPtr->axesOffset; -} - -void Graph::getTextExtents(Tk_Font font, const char *text, int textLen, - int* ww, int* hh) -{ - if (!text) { - *ww =0; - *hh =0; - return; - } - - Tk_FontMetrics fm; - Tk_GetFontMetrics(font, &fm); - int lineHeight = fm.linespace; - - if (textLen < 0) - textLen = strlen(text); - - int maxWidth =0; - int maxHeight =0; - int lineLen =0; - const char *line =NULL; - const char *p, *pend; - for (p =line=text, pend=text+textLen; p 0) { - int lineWidth = Tk_TextWidth(font, line, lineLen); - if (lineWidth > maxWidth) - maxWidth = lineWidth; - } - maxHeight += lineHeight; - line = p + 1; /* Point to the start of the next line. */ - lineLen = 0; /* Reset counter to indicate the start of a - * new line. */ - continue; - } - lineLen++; - } - - if ((lineLen > 0) && (*(p - 1) != '\n')) { - maxHeight += lineHeight; - int lineWidth = Tk_TextWidth(font, line, lineLen); - if (lineWidth > maxWidth) - maxWidth = lineWidth; - } - - *ww = maxWidth; - *hh = maxHeight; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * Computes the dimensions of the bounding box surrounding a rectangle - * rotated about its center. If pointArr isn't NULL, the coordinates of - * the rotated rectangle are also returned. - * - * The dimensions are determined by rotating the rectangle, and doubling - * the maximum x-coordinate and y-coordinate. - * - * w = 2 * maxX, h = 2 * maxY - * - * Since the rectangle is centered at 0,0, the coordinates of the - * bounding box are (-w/2,-h/2 w/2,-h/2, w/2,h/2 -w/2,h/2). - * - * 0 ------- 1 - * | | - * | x | - * | | - * 3 ------- 2 - * - * Results: - * The width and height of the bounding box containing the rotated - * rectangle are returned. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -void Graph::getBoundingBox(int width, int height, double angle, - double *rotWidthPtr, double *rotHeightPtr, - Point2d *bbox) -{ - angle = fmod(angle, 360.0); - if (fmod(angle, 90.0) == 0.0) { - int ll, ur, ul, lr; - double rotWidth, rotHeight; - - // Handle right-angle rotations specially - int quadrant = (int)(angle / 90.0); - switch (quadrant) { - case ROTATE_270: - ul = 3, ur = 0, lr = 1, ll = 2; - rotWidth = (double)height; - rotHeight = (double)width; - break; - case ROTATE_90: - ul = 1, ur = 2, lr = 3, ll = 0; - rotWidth = (double)height; - rotHeight = (double)width; - break; - case ROTATE_180: - ul = 2, ur = 3, lr = 0, ll = 1; - rotWidth = (double)width; - rotHeight = (double)height; - break; - default: - case ROTATE_0: - ul = 0, ur = 1, lr = 2, ll = 3; - rotWidth = (double)width; - rotHeight = (double)height; - break; - } - if (bbox) { - double x = rotWidth * 0.5; - double y = rotHeight * 0.5; - bbox[ll].x = bbox[ul].x = -x; - bbox[ur].y = bbox[ul].y = -y; - bbox[lr].x = bbox[ur].x = x; - bbox[ll].y = bbox[lr].y = y; - } - *rotWidthPtr = rotWidth; - *rotHeightPtr = rotHeight; - return; - } - - // Set the four corners of the rectangle whose center is the origin - Point2d corner[4]; - corner[1].x = corner[2].x = (double)width * 0.5; - corner[0].x = corner[3].x = -corner[1].x; - corner[2].y = corner[3].y = (double)height * 0.5; - corner[0].y = corner[1].y = -corner[2].y; - - double radians = (-angle / 180.0) * M_PI; - double sinTheta = sin(radians); - double cosTheta = cos(radians); - double xMax =0; - double yMax =0; - - // Rotate the four corners and find the maximum X and Y coordinates - for (int ii=0; ii<4; ii++) { - double x = (corner[ii].x * cosTheta) - (corner[ii].y * sinTheta); - double y = (corner[ii].x * sinTheta) + (corner[ii].y * cosTheta); - if (x > xMax) - xMax = x; - - if (y > yMax) - yMax = y; - - if (bbox) { - bbox[ii].x = x; - bbox[ii].y = y; - } - } - - // By symmetry, the width and height of the bounding box are twice the - // maximum x and y coordinates. - *rotWidthPtr = xMax + xMax; - *rotHeightPtr = yMax + yMax; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * Blt_AnchorPoint -- - * - * Translates a position, using both the dimensions of the bounding box, - * and the anchor direction, returning the coordinates of the upper-left - * corner of the box. The anchor indicates where the given x-y position - * is in relation to the bounding box. - * - * 7 nw --- 0 n --- 1 ne - * | | - * 6 w 8 center 2 e - * | | - * 5 sw --- 4 s --- 3 se - * - * The coordinates returned are translated to the origin of the bounding - * box (suitable for giving to XCopyArea, XCopyPlane, etc.) - * - * Results: - * The translated coordinates of the bounding box are returned. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -Point2d Graph::anchorPoint(double x, double y, double w, double h, - Tk_Anchor anchor) -{ - Point2d t; - - switch (anchor) { - case TK_ANCHOR_NW: /* 7 Upper left corner */ - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_W: /* 6 Left center */ - y -= (h * 0.5); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SW: /* 5 Lower left corner */ - y -= h; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_N: /* 0 Top center */ - x -= (w * 0.5); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_CENTER: /* 8 Center */ - x -= (w * 0.5); - y -= (h * 0.5); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_S: /* 4 Bottom center */ - x -= (w * 0.5); - y -= h; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_NE: /* 1 Upper right corner */ - x -= w; - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_E: /* 2 Right center */ - x -= w; - y -= (h * 0.5); - break; - case TK_ANCHOR_SE: /* 3 Lower right corner */ - x -= w; - y -= h; - break; - } - - t.x = x; - t.y = y; - return t; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.C deleted file mode 100644 index 3f9c3ac..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,74 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include -using namespace std; - -extern "C" { -DLLEXPORT Tcl_AppInitProc Tkblt_Init; -DLLEXPORT Tcl_AppInitProc Tkblt_SafeInit; -}; - -Tcl_AppInitProc Blt_VectorCmdInitProc; -Tcl_AppInitProc Blt_GraphCmdInitProc; - -#include "tkbltStubInit.c" - -DLLEXPORT int Tkblt_Init(Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - Tcl_Namespace *nsPtr; - - if (Tcl_InitStubs(interp, TCL_PATCH_LEVEL, 0) == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - if (Tk_InitStubs(interp, TK_PATCH_LEVEL, 0) == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - nsPtr = Tcl_FindNamespace(interp, "::blt", (Tcl_Namespace *)NULL, 0); - if (nsPtr == NULL) { - nsPtr = Tcl_CreateNamespace(interp, "::blt", NULL, NULL); - if (nsPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (Blt_VectorCmdInitProc(interp) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - if (Blt_GraphCmdInitProc(interp) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (Tcl_PkgProvideEx(interp, PACKAGE_NAME, PACKAGE_VERSION, (ClientData)&tkbltStubs) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -DLLEXPORT int Tkblt_SafeInit(Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - return Tkblt_Init(interp); -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.h deleted file mode 100644 index 2bf96ee..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltInt.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,58 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Copyright 2017 Patzschke+Rasp Software GmbH - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __TKBLT_INT_H__ - -#if defined(_MSC_VER) - -#include - -#if !defined(NAN) -#define NAN (std::numeric_limits::quiet_NaN()) -#endif - -#if !defined(isnan) -#define isnan(x) _isnan(x) -#endif - -#if !defined(isfinite) -#define isfinite(x) _finite(x) -#endif - -#if !defined(isinf) -#define isinf(x) !_finite(x) -#endif - -#if !defined(numeric_limits) -#define numeric_limits(x) _numeric_limits(x) -#endif - -#if _MSC_VER < 1900 -#define snprintf _snprintf -#else -#include //sprintf -#endif - -#endif /* _MSC_VER */ - -#endif /* __TKBLT_INT_H__ */ diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.C deleted file mode 100644 index f2ecfa3..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,129 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1997-2008 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifdef __CYGWIN__ -extern "C" { -#include -} -#else -#include -#endif - -#include "tkbltNsUtil.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -Tcl_Namespace* Blt::GetCommandNamespace(Tcl_Command cmdToken) -{ - Command* cmdPtr = (Command*)cmdToken; - return (Tcl_Namespace *)cmdPtr->nsPtr; -} - -int Blt::ParseObjectName(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *path, - Blt_ObjectName *namePtr, unsigned int flags) -{ - namePtr->nsPtr = NULL; - namePtr->name = NULL; - char* colon = NULL; - - /* Find the last namespace separator in the qualified name. */ - char* last = (char *)(path + strlen(path)); - while (--last > path) { - if ((*last == ':') && (*(last - 1) == ':')) { - last++; /* just after the last "::" */ - colon = last - 2; - break; - } - } - if (colon == NULL) { - namePtr->name = path; - if ((flags & BLT_NO_DEFAULT_NS) == 0) { - namePtr->nsPtr = Tcl_GetCurrentNamespace(interp); - } - return 1; /* No namespace designated in name. */ - } - - /* Separate the namespace and the object name. */ - *colon = '\0'; - if (path[0] == '\0') { - namePtr->nsPtr = Tcl_GetGlobalNamespace(interp); - } else { - namePtr->nsPtr = Tcl_FindNamespace(interp, (char *)path, NULL, - (flags & BLT_NO_ERROR_MSG) ? 0 : TCL_LEAVE_ERR_MSG); - } - /* Repair the string. */ *colon = ':'; - - if (namePtr->nsPtr == NULL) { - return 0; /* Namespace doesn't exist. */ - } - namePtr->name =last; - return 1; -} - -char* Blt::MakeQualifiedName(Blt_ObjectName *namePtr, Tcl_DString *resultPtr) -{ - Tcl_DStringInit(resultPtr); - if ((namePtr->nsPtr->fullName[0] != ':') || - (namePtr->nsPtr->fullName[1] != ':') || - (namePtr->nsPtr->fullName[2] != '\0')) { - Tcl_DStringAppend(resultPtr, namePtr->nsPtr->fullName, -1); - } - Tcl_DStringAppend(resultPtr, "::", -1); - Tcl_DStringAppend(resultPtr, (char *)namePtr->name, -1); - return Tcl_DStringValue(resultPtr); -} - -static Tcl_Namespace* NamespaceOfVariable(Var *varPtr) -{ - if (varPtr->flags & VAR_IN_HASHTABLE) { - VarInHash *vhashPtr = (VarInHash *)varPtr; - TclVarHashTable *vtablePtr; - - vtablePtr = (TclVarHashTable *)vhashPtr->entry.tablePtr; - return (Tcl_Namespace*)(vtablePtr->nsPtr); - } - return NULL; -} - -Tcl_Namespace* Blt::GetVariableNamespace(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *path) -{ - Blt_ObjectName objName; - if (!ParseObjectName(interp, path, &objName, BLT_NO_DEFAULT_NS)) - return NULL; - - if (objName.nsPtr == NULL) { - Var*varPtr = (Var*)Tcl_FindNamespaceVar(interp, (char *)path, - (Tcl_Namespace *)NULL, - TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); - if (varPtr) - return NamespaceOfVariable(varPtr); - - } - return objName.nsPtr; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.h deleted file mode 100644 index 950a48a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltNsUtil.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,64 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef BLT_NS_UTIL_H -#define BLT_NS_UTIL_H 1 - -#define NS_SEARCH_NONE (0) -#define NS_SEARCH_CURRENT (1<<0) -#define NS_SEARCH_GLOBAL (1<<1) -#define NS_SEARCH_BOTH (NS_SEARCH_GLOBAL | NS_SEARCH_CURRENT) - -#define BLT_NO_DEFAULT_NS (1<<0) -#define BLT_NO_ERROR_MSG (1<<1) - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - const char *name; - Tcl_Namespace *nsPtr; - } Blt_ObjectName; - - extern Tcl_Namespace* GetVariableNamespace(Tcl_Interp* interp, - const char *varName); - - extern Tcl_Namespace* GetCommandNamespace(Tcl_Command cmdToken); - - extern int ParseObjectName(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *name, - Blt_ObjectName *objNamePtr, - unsigned int flags); - - extern char* MakeQualifiedName(Blt_ObjectName *objNamePtr, - Tcl_DString *resultPtr); -}; - -#endif /* BLT_NS_UTIL_H */ diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 4199a44..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,171 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltOp.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -static int BinaryOpSearch(Blt_OpSpec *specs, int nSpecs, const char *string, - int length) -{ - int low = 0; - int high = nSpecs - 1; - char c = string[0]; - while (low <= high) { - int median = (low + high) >> 1; - Blt_OpSpec *specPtr = specs + median; - - /* Test the first character */ - int compare = c - specPtr->name[0]; - if (compare == 0) { - /* Now test the entire string */ - compare = strncmp(string, specPtr->name, length); - if (compare == 0) { - if ((int)length < specPtr->minChars) { - return -2; /* Ambiguous operation name */ - } - } - } - if (compare < 0) { - high = median - 1; - } else if (compare > 0) { - low = median + 1; - } else { - return median; /* Op found. */ - } - } - return -1; /* Can't find operation */ -} - -static int LinearOpSearch(Blt_OpSpec *specs, int nSpecs, const char *string, - int length) -{ - char c = string[0]; - int nMatches = 0; - int last = -1; - int i =0; - for (Blt_OpSpec *specPtr = specs; iname[0]) && - (strncmp(string, specPtr->name, length) == 0)) { - last = i; - nMatches++; - if ((int)length == specPtr->minChars) { - break; - } - } - } - if (nMatches > 1) - return -2; /* Ambiguous operation name */ - - if (nMatches == 0) - return -1; /* Can't find operation */ - - return last; /* Op found. */ -} - -void* Blt::GetOpFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, int nSpecs, Blt_OpSpec *specs, - int operPos, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[], - int flags) -{ - Blt_OpSpec *specPtr; - int n; - - if (objc <= operPos) { /* No operation argument */ - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "wrong # args: ", (char *)NULL); - usage: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "should be one of...", (char *)NULL); - for (n = 0; n < nSpecs; n++) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "\n ", (char *)NULL); - for (int ii = 0; ii < operPos; ii++) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_GetString(objv[ii]), " ", - (char *)NULL); - } - specPtr = specs + n; - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, specPtr->name, " ", specPtr->usage, - (char *)NULL); - } - return NULL; - } - - int length; - const char* string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[operPos], &length); - if (flags & BLT_OP_LINEAR_SEARCH) - n = LinearOpSearch(specs, nSpecs, string, length); - else - n = BinaryOpSearch(specs, nSpecs, string, length); - - if (n == -2) { - char c; - - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "ambiguous", (char *)NULL); - if (operPos > 2) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " ", Tcl_GetString(objv[operPos - 1]), - (char *)NULL); - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " operation \"", string, "\" matches: ", - (char *)NULL); - - c = string[0]; - for (n = 0; n < nSpecs; n++) { - specPtr = specs + n; - if ((c == specPtr->name[0]) && - (strncmp(string, specPtr->name, length) == 0)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " ", specPtr->name, (char *)NULL); - } - } - return NULL; - - } else if (n == -1) { /* Can't find operation, display help */ - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad", (char *)NULL); - if (operPos > 2) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " ", Tcl_GetString(objv[operPos - 1]), - (char *)NULL); - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, " operation \"", string, "\": ", (char *)NULL); - goto usage; - } - specPtr = specs + n; - if ((objc < specPtr->minArgs) || - ((specPtr->maxArgs > 0) && (objc > specPtr->maxArgs))) { - int i; - - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "wrong # args: should be \"", (char *)NULL); - for (i = 0; i < operPos; i++) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), " ", - (char *)NULL); - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, specPtr->name, " ", specPtr->usage, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - return NULL; - } - return specPtr->proc; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.h deleted file mode 100644 index fc9ffb7..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltOp.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,67 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef __BltOp_h__ -#define __BltOp_h__ - -#include - -#define BLT_OP_BINARY_SEARCH 0 -#define BLT_OP_LINEAR_SEARCH 1 - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - const char *name; /* Name of operation */ - int minChars; /* Minimum # characters to disambiguate */ - void *proc; - int minArgs; /* Minimum # args required */ - int maxArgs; /* Maximum # args required */ - const char *usage; /* Usage message */ - } Blt_OpSpec; - - typedef enum { - BLT_OP_ARG0, /* Op is the first argument. */ - BLT_OP_ARG1, /* Op is the second argument. */ - BLT_OP_ARG2, /* Op is the third argument. */ - BLT_OP_ARG3, /* Op is the fourth argument. */ - BLT_OP_ARG4 /* Op is the fifth argument. */ - - } Blt_OpIndex; - - void *GetOpFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, int nSpecs, - Blt_OpSpec *specs, int operPos, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[], int flags); -}; - -#endif - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.C deleted file mode 100644 index 095b16a..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,388 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * - * This file is copied from tclParse.c in the TCL library distribution. - * - * Copyright (c) 1987-1993 The Regents of the University of - * California. - * - * Copyright (c) 1994-1998 Sun Microsystems, Inc. - * - */ - -/* - * Since TCL 8.1.0 these routines have been replaced by ones that - * generate byte-codes. But since these routines are used in vector - * expressions, where no such byte-compilation is necessary, I now - * include them. In fact, the byte-compiled versions would be slower - * since the compiled code typically runs only one time. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include -#include -#include -using namespace std; - -#include - -#include "tkbltParse.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -/* - * A table used to classify input characters to assist in parsing - * TCL commands. The table should be indexed with a signed character - * using the CHAR_TYPE macro. The character may have a negative - * value. The CHAR_TYPE macro takes a pointer to a signed character - * and a pointer to the last character in the source string. If the - * src pointer is pointing at the terminating null of the string, - * CHAR_TYPE returns TCL_COMMAND_END. - */ - -#define STATIC_STRING_SPACE 150 -#define TCL_NORMAL 0x01 -#define TCL_SPACE 0x02 -#define TCL_COMMAND_END 0x04 -#define TCL_QUOTE 0x08 -#define TCL_OPEN_BRACKET 0x10 -#define TCL_OPEN_BRACE 0x20 -#define TCL_CLOSE_BRACE 0x40 -#define TCL_BACKSLASH 0x80 -#define TCL_DOLLAR 0x00 - -/* - * The following table assigns a type to each character. Only types - * meaningful to TCL parsing are represented here. The table is - * designed to be referenced with either signed or unsigned characters, - * so it has 384 entries. The first 128 entries correspond to negative - * character values, the next 256 correspond to positive character - * values. The last 128 entries are identical to the first 128. The - * table is always indexed with a 128-byte offset (the 128th entry - * corresponds to a 0 character value). - */ - -static unsigned char tclTypeTable[] = -{ - /* - * Negative character values, from -128 to -1: - */ - - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - - /* - * Positive character values, from 0-127: - */ - - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_SPACE, TCL_COMMAND_END, TCL_SPACE, - TCL_SPACE, TCL_SPACE, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_SPACE, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_QUOTE, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_DOLLAR, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_COMMAND_END, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_OPEN_BRACKET, - TCL_BACKSLASH, TCL_COMMAND_END, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_OPEN_BRACE, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_CLOSE_BRACE, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - - /* - * Large unsigned character values, from 128-255: - */ - - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, - TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, TCL_NORMAL, -}; - -#define CHAR_TYPE(src,last) \ - (((src)==(last))?TCL_COMMAND_END:(tclTypeTable+128)[(int)*(src)]) - -int Blt::ParseNestedCmd(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - int flags, const char **termPtr, ParseValue *parsePtr) - -{ - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -int Blt::ParseBraces(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - const char **termPtr, ParseValue *parsePtr) -{ - int level; - const char *src; - char *dest, *end; - char c; - const char *lastChar = string + strlen(string); - - src = string; - dest = parsePtr->next; - end = parsePtr->end; - level = 1; - - /* - * Copy the characters one at a time to the result area, stopping - * when the matching close-brace is found. - */ - - for (;;) { - c = *src; - src++; - - if (dest == end) { - parsePtr->next = dest; - (*parsePtr->expandProc) (parsePtr, 20); - dest = parsePtr->next; - end = parsePtr->end; - } - *dest = c; - dest++; - - if (CHAR_TYPE(src - 1, lastChar) == TCL_NORMAL) { - continue; - } else if (c == '{') { - level++; - } else if (c == '}') { - level--; - if (level == 0) { - dest--; /* Don't copy the last close brace. */ - break; - } - } else if (c == '\\') { - int count; - - /* - * Must always squish out backslash-newlines, even when in - * braces. This is needed so that this sequence can appear - * anywhere in a command, such as the middle of an expression. - */ - - if (*src == '\n') { - dest[-1] = Tcl_Backslash(src - 1, &count); - src += count - 1; - } else { - Tcl_Backslash(src - 1, &count); - while (count > 1) { - if (dest == end) { - parsePtr->next = dest; - (*parsePtr->expandProc) (parsePtr, 20); - dest = parsePtr->next; - end = parsePtr->end; - } - *dest = *src; - dest++; - src++; - count--; - } - } - } else if (c == '\0') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "missing close-brace", (char *)NULL); - *termPtr = string - 1; - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - - *dest = '\0'; - parsePtr->next = dest; - *termPtr = src; - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Blt::ExpandParseValue(ParseValue *parsePtr, int needed) - -{ - /* - * Either double the size of the buffer or add enough new space - * to meet the demand, whichever produces a larger new buffer. - */ - int size = (parsePtr->end - parsePtr->buffer) + 1; - if (size < needed) - size += needed; - else - size += size; - - char* buffer = (char*)malloc((unsigned int)size); - - /* - * Copy from old buffer to new, free old buffer if needed, and - * mark new buffer as malloc-ed. - */ - memcpy((VOID *) buffer, (VOID *) parsePtr->buffer, - (size_t) (parsePtr->next - parsePtr->buffer)); - parsePtr->next = buffer + (parsePtr->next - parsePtr->buffer); - if (parsePtr->clientData != 0) { - free(parsePtr->buffer); - } - parsePtr->buffer = buffer; - parsePtr->end = buffer + size - 1; - parsePtr->clientData = (ClientData)1; -} - -int Blt::ParseQuotes(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, int termChar, - int flags, const char **termPtr, ParseValue *parsePtr) -{ - const char *src; - char *dest, c; - const char *lastChar = string + strlen(string); - - src = string; - dest = parsePtr->next; - - for (;;) { - if (dest == parsePtr->end) { - /* - * Target buffer space is about to run out. Make more space. - */ - parsePtr->next = dest; - (*parsePtr->expandProc) (parsePtr, 1); - dest = parsePtr->next; - } - c = *src; - src++; - if (c == termChar) { - *dest = '\0'; - parsePtr->next = dest; - *termPtr = src; - return TCL_OK; - } else if (CHAR_TYPE(src - 1, lastChar) == TCL_NORMAL) { - copy: - *dest = c; - dest++; - continue; - } else if (c == '$') { - int length; - const char *value; - - value = Tcl_ParseVar(interp, src - 1, termPtr); - if (value == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - src = *termPtr; - length = strlen(value); - if ((parsePtr->end - dest) <= length) { - parsePtr->next = dest; - (*parsePtr->expandProc) (parsePtr, length); - dest = parsePtr->next; - } - strcpy(dest, value); - dest += length; - continue; - } else if (c == '[') { - int result; - - parsePtr->next = dest; - result = ParseNestedCmd(interp, src, flags, termPtr, parsePtr); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return result; - } - src = *termPtr; - dest = parsePtr->next; - continue; - } else if (c == '\\') { - int nRead; - - src--; - *dest = Tcl_Backslash(src, &nRead); - dest++; - src += nRead; - continue; - } else if (c == '\0') { - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - ostringstream str; - str << "missing " << termChar << ends; - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), str.str().c_str(), 9); - *termPtr = string - 1; - return TCL_ERROR; - } else { - goto copy; - } - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.h deleted file mode 100644 index ee215a5..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltParse.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,55 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef _BLT_PARSE_H -#define _BLT_PARSE_H - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct _ParseValue ParseValue; - struct _ParseValue { - char *buffer; - char *next; - char *end; - void (*expandProc)(ParseValue *pvPtr, int needed); - ClientData clientData; - }; - - extern int ParseBraces(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - const char **termPtr, ParseValue *pvPtr); - extern int ParseNestedCmd(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - int flags, const char **termPtr, - ParseValue *pvPtr); - extern int ParseQuotes(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - int termChar, int flags, const char **termPtr, - ParseValue * pvPtr); - extern void ExpandParseValue(ParseValue *pvPtr, int needed); -} - -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubInit.c b/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubInit.c deleted file mode 100644 index 354b7f1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubInit.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,30 +0,0 @@ -#include "tkbltVector.h" - -/* !BEGIN!: Do not edit below this line. */ - -const TkbltStubs tkbltStubs = { - TCL_STUB_MAGIC, - 0, - Blt_CreateVector, /* 0 */ - Blt_CreateVector2, /* 1 */ - Blt_DeleteVectorByName, /* 2 */ - Blt_DeleteVector, /* 3 */ - Blt_GetVector, /* 4 */ - Blt_GetVectorFromObj, /* 5 */ - Blt_ResetVector, /* 6 */ - Blt_ResizeVector, /* 7 */ - Blt_VectorExists, /* 8 */ - Blt_VectorExists2, /* 9 */ - Blt_AllocVectorId, /* 10 */ - Blt_GetVectorById, /* 11 */ - Blt_SetVectorChangedProc, /* 12 */ - Blt_FreeVectorId, /* 13 */ - Blt_NameOfVectorId, /* 14 */ - Blt_NameOfVector, /* 15 */ - Blt_ExprVector, /* 16 */ - Blt_InstallIndexProc, /* 17 */ - Blt_VecMin, /* 18 */ - Blt_VecMax, /* 19 */ -}; - -/* !END!: Do not edit above this line. */ diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubLib.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubLib.C deleted file mode 100644 index e973063..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltStubLib.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,15 +0,0 @@ -#ifndef USE_TCL_STUBS -#define USE_TCL_STUBS -#endif - -#include - -ClientData tkbltStubsPtr =NULL; - -const char* Tkblt_InitStubs(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char* version, int exact) -{ - const char* actualVersion = - Tcl_PkgRequireEx(interp, "tkblt", version, exact, &tkbltStubsPtr); - - return (actualVersion && tkbltStubsPtr) ? actualVersion : NULL; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.C deleted file mode 100644 index bb80663..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,407 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include -#include - -#include -#include -#include -using namespace std; - -#include - -#include "tkbltSwitch.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define COUNT_NNEG 0 -#define COUNT_POS 1 -#define COUNT_ANY 2 - -static char* Blt_Strdup(const char *string) -{ - size_t size = strlen(string) + 1; - char* ptr = (char*)malloc(size * sizeof(char)); - if (ptr != NULL) { - strcpy(ptr, string); - } - return ptr; -} - -static int Blt_GetCountFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, int check, - long *valuePtr) -{ - long count; - if (Tcl_GetLongFromObj(interp, objPtr, &count) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - switch (check) { - case COUNT_NNEG: - if (count < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad value \"", Tcl_GetString(objPtr), - "\": can't be negative", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - case COUNT_POS: - if (count <= 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad value \"", Tcl_GetString(objPtr), - "\": must be positive", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - case COUNT_ANY: - break; - } - *valuePtr = count; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static void DoHelp(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_SwitchSpec *specs) -{ - Tcl_DString ds; - Tcl_DStringInit(&ds); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, "following switches are available:", -1); - for (Blt_SwitchSpec *sp = specs; sp->type != BLT_SWITCH_END; sp++) { - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, "\n ", 4); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, sp->switchName, -1); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, " ", 1); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, sp->help, -1); - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_DStringValue(&ds), (char *)NULL); - Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); -} - -static Blt_SwitchSpec *FindSwitchSpec(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_SwitchSpec *specs, - const char *name, int length, - int needFlags, int hateFlags) -{ - char c = name[1]; - Blt_SwitchSpec *matchPtr = NULL; - for (Blt_SwitchSpec *sp = specs; sp->type != BLT_SWITCH_END; sp++) { - if (sp->switchName == NULL) - continue; - - if (((sp->flags & needFlags) != needFlags) || (sp->flags & hateFlags)) - continue; - - if ((sp->switchName[1] != c) || (strncmp(sp->switchName,name,length)!=0)) - continue; - - if (sp->switchName[length] == '\0') - return sp; /* Stop on a perfect match. */ - - if (matchPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "ambiguous switch \"", name, "\"\n", - (char *) NULL); - DoHelp(interp, specs); - return NULL; - } - matchPtr = sp; - } - - if (strcmp(name, "-help") == 0) { - DoHelp(interp, specs); - return NULL; - } - - if (matchPtr == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown switch \"", name, "\"\n", - (char *)NULL); - DoHelp(interp, specs); - return NULL; - } - - return matchPtr; -} - -static int DoSwitch(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_SwitchSpec *sp, - Tcl_Obj *objPtr, void *record) -{ - do { - char *ptr = (char *)record + sp->offset; - switch (sp->type) { - case BLT_SWITCH_BOOLEAN: - { - int boo; - - if (Tcl_GetBooleanFromObj(interp, objPtr, &boo) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (sp->mask > 0) { - if (boo) { - *((int *)ptr) |= sp->mask; - } else { - *((int *)ptr) &= ~sp->mask; - } - } else { - *((int *)ptr) = boo; - } - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_DOUBLE: - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objPtr, (double *)ptr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_OBJ: - Tcl_IncrRefCount(objPtr); - *(Tcl_Obj **)ptr = objPtr; - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_FLOAT: - { - double value; - - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj(interp, objPtr, &value) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *(float *)ptr = (float)value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_INT: - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objPtr, (int *)ptr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_INT_NNEG: - { - long value; - - if (Blt_GetCountFromObj(interp, objPtr, COUNT_NNEG, - &value) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *(int *)ptr = (int)value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_INT_POS: - { - long value; - - if (Blt_GetCountFromObj(interp, objPtr, COUNT_POS, - &value) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *(int *)ptr = (int)value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_LIST: - { - int argc; - - if (Tcl_SplitList(interp, Tcl_GetString(objPtr), &argc, - (const char ***)ptr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_LONG: - if (Tcl_GetLongFromObj(interp, objPtr, (long *)ptr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_LONG_NNEG: - { - long value; - - if (Blt_GetCountFromObj(interp, objPtr, COUNT_NNEG, - &value) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *(long *)ptr = value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_LONG_POS: - { - long value; - - if (Blt_GetCountFromObj(interp, objPtr, COUNT_POS, &value) - != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *(long *)ptr = value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_STRING: - { - char *value; - - value = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - value = (*value == '\0') ? NULL : Blt_Strdup(value); - if (*(char **)ptr != NULL) { - free(*(char **)ptr); - } - *(char **)ptr = value; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM: - if ((*sp->customPtr->parseProc)(sp->customPtr->clientData, interp, - sp->switchName, objPtr, (char *)record, sp->offset, sp->flags) - != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - break; - - default: - ostringstream str; - str << sp->type << ends; - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad switch table: unknown type \"", - str.str().c_str(), "\"", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - sp++; - } while ((sp->switchName == NULL) && (sp->type != BLT_SWITCH_END)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt::ParseSwitches(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_SwitchSpec *specs, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[], void *record, - int flags) -{ - Blt_SwitchSpec *sp; - int needFlags = flags & ~(BLT_SWITCH_USER_BIT - 1); - int hateFlags = 0; - - /* - * Pass 1: Clear the change flags on all the specs so that we - * can check it later. - */ - for (sp = specs; sp->type != BLT_SWITCH_END; sp++) - sp->flags &= ~BLT_SWITCH_SPECIFIED; - - /* - * Pass 2: Process the arguments that match entries in the specs. - * It's an error if the argument doesn't match anything. - */ - int count; - for (count = 0; count < objc; count++) { - char *arg; - int length; - - arg = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objv[count], &length); - if (flags & BLT_SWITCH_OBJV_PARTIAL) { - /* - * If the argument doesn't start with a '-' (not a switch) or is - * '--', stop processing and return the number of arguments - * comsumed. - */ - if (arg[0] != '-') { - return count; - } - if ((arg[1] == '-') && (arg[2] == '\0')) { - return count + 1; /* include the "--" in the count. */ - } - } - sp = FindSwitchSpec(interp, specs, arg, length, needFlags, hateFlags); - if (sp == NULL) { - return -1; - } - if (sp->type == BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK) { - char *ptr; - - ptr = (char *)record + sp->offset; - *((int *)ptr) |= sp->mask; - } else if (sp->type == BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK_INVERT) { - char *ptr; - - ptr = (char *)record + sp->offset; - *((int *)ptr) &= ~sp->mask; - } else if (sp->type == BLT_SWITCH_VALUE) { - char *ptr; - - ptr = (char *)record + sp->offset; - *((int *)ptr) = sp->mask; - } else { - count++; - if (count == objc) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "value for \"", arg, "\" missing", - (char *) NULL); - return -1; - } - if (DoSwitch(interp, sp, objv[count], record) != TCL_OK) { - ostringstream str; - str << "\n (processing \"" << sp->switchName << "\" switch)" << ends; - Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, str.str().c_str()); - return -1; - } - } - sp->flags |= BLT_SWITCH_SPECIFIED; - } - - return count; -} - -void Blt::FreeSwitches(Blt_SwitchSpec *specs, void *record, int needFlags) -{ - for (Blt_SwitchSpec *sp = specs; sp->type != BLT_SWITCH_END; sp++) { - if ((sp->flags & needFlags) == needFlags) { - char *ptr = (char *)record + sp->offset; - switch (sp->type) { - case BLT_SWITCH_STRING: - case BLT_SWITCH_LIST: - if (*((char **) ptr) != NULL) { - free(*((char **) ptr)); - *((char **) ptr) = NULL; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_OBJ: - if (*((Tcl_Obj **) ptr) != NULL) { - Tcl_DecrRefCount(*((Tcl_Obj **)ptr)); - *((Tcl_Obj **) ptr) = NULL; - } - break; - - case BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM: - if ((*(char **)ptr != NULL) && - (sp->customPtr->freeProc != NULL)) { - (*sp->customPtr->freeProc)((char *)record, sp->offset, - sp->flags); - } - break; - - default: - break; - } - } - } -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.h deleted file mode 100644 index eed7b31..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltSwitch.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,129 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef BLT_SWITCH_H -#define BLT_SWITCH_H - -#include - -#define BLT_SWITCH_DEFAULTS (0) -#define BLT_SWITCH_ARGV_PARTIAL (1<<1) -#define BLT_SWITCH_OBJV_PARTIAL (1<<1) - - /* - * Possible flag values for Blt_SwitchSpec structures. Any bits at or - * above BLT_SWITCH_USER_BIT may be used by clients for selecting - * certain entries. - */ -#define BLT_SWITCH_NULL_OK (1<<0) -#define BLT_SWITCH_DONT_SET_DEFAULT (1<<3) -#define BLT_SWITCH_SPECIFIED (1<<4) -#define BLT_SWITCH_USER_BIT (1<<8) - -namespace Blt { - - typedef int (Blt_SwitchParseProc)(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - const char *switchName, - Tcl_Obj *valueObjPtr, char *record, - int offset, int flags); - typedef void (Blt_SwitchFreeProc)(char *record, int offset, int flags); - - typedef struct { - Blt_SwitchParseProc *parseProc; /* Procedure to parse a switch - * value and store it in its * - * converted form in the data * - * record. */ - - Blt_SwitchFreeProc *freeProc; /* Procedure to free a switch. */ - - ClientData clientData; /* Arbitrary one-word value used by - * switch parser, passed to - * parseProc. */ - } Blt_SwitchCustom; - - /* - * Type values for Blt_SwitchSpec structures. See the user - * documentation for details. - */ - typedef enum { - BLT_SWITCH_BOOLEAN, - BLT_SWITCH_DOUBLE, - BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, - BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK_INVERT, - BLT_SWITCH_FLOAT, - BLT_SWITCH_INT, - BLT_SWITCH_INT_NNEG, - BLT_SWITCH_INT_POS, - BLT_SWITCH_LIST, - BLT_SWITCH_LONG, - BLT_SWITCH_LONG_NNEG, - BLT_SWITCH_LONG_POS, - BLT_SWITCH_OBJ, - BLT_SWITCH_STRING, - BLT_SWITCH_VALUE, - BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM, - BLT_SWITCH_END - } Blt_SwitchTypes; - - typedef struct { - Blt_SwitchTypes type; /* Type of option, such as - * BLT_SWITCH_COLOR; see definitions - * below. Last option in table must - * have type BLT_SWITCH_END. */ - - const char *switchName; /* Switch used to specify option in - * argv. NULL means this spec is part - * of a group. */ - - const char *help; /* Help string. */ - int offset; /* Where in widget record to store - * value; use Blt_Offset macro to - * generate values for this. */ - - int flags; /* Any combination of the values - * defined below. */ - - unsigned int mask; - - Blt_SwitchCustom *customPtr; /* If type is BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM then - * this is a pointer to info about how - * to parse and print the option. - * Otherwise it is irrelevant. */ - } Blt_SwitchSpec; - - extern int ParseSwitches(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_SwitchSpec *specPtr, - int objc, Tcl_Obj *const *objv, void *rec, - int flags); - extern void FreeSwitches(Blt_SwitchSpec *specs, void *rec, int flags); -}; - -#endif /* BLT_SWITCH_H */ diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecCmd.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecCmd.C deleted file mode 100644 index 8a03fe6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecCmd.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1821 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1995-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - * - * Code for binary data read operation was donated by Harold Kirsch. - * - */ - -/* - * TODO: - * o Add H. Kirsch's vector binary read operation - * x binread file0 - * x binread -file file0 - * - * o Add ASCII/binary file reader - * x read fileName - * - * o Allow Tcl-based client notifications. - * vector x - * x notify call Display - * x notify delete Display - * x notify reorder #1 #2 - */ - -#include -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltVecInt.h" -#include "tkbltOp.h" -#include "tkbltNsUtil.h" -#include "tkbltSwitch.h" -#include "tkbltInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -extern int Blt_SimplifyLine (Point2d *origPts, int low, int high, - double tolerance, int *indices); - -typedef int (VectorCmdProc)(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); -typedef int (QSortCompareProc) (const void *, const void *); - -static Blt_SwitchParseProc ObjToFFTVector; -static Blt_SwitchCustom fftVectorSwitch = { - ObjToFFTVector, NULL, (ClientData)0, -}; - -static Blt_SwitchParseProc ObjToIndex; -static Blt_SwitchCustom indexSwitch = { - ObjToIndex, NULL, (ClientData)0, -}; - -typedef struct { - Tcl_Obj *formatObjPtr; - int from, to; -} PrintSwitches; - -static Blt_SwitchSpec printSwitches[] = - { - {BLT_SWITCH_OBJ, "-format", "string", - Tk_Offset(PrintSwitches, formatObjPtr), 0}, - {BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM, "-from", "index", - Tk_Offset(PrintSwitches, from), 0, 0, &indexSwitch}, - {BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM, "-to", "index", - Tk_Offset(PrintSwitches, to), 0, 0, &indexSwitch}, - {BLT_SWITCH_END} - }; - - -typedef struct { - int flags; -} SortSwitches; - -#define SORT_DECREASING (1<<0) -#define SORT_UNIQUE (1<<1) - -static Blt_SwitchSpec sortSwitches[] = - { - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-decreasing", "", - Tk_Offset(SortSwitches, flags), 0, SORT_DECREASING}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-reverse", "", - Tk_Offset(SortSwitches, flags), 0, SORT_DECREASING}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-uniq", "", - Tk_Offset(SortSwitches, flags), 0, SORT_UNIQUE}, - {BLT_SWITCH_END} - }; - -typedef struct { - double delta; - Vector *imagPtr; /* Vector containing imaginary part. */ - Vector *freqPtr; /* Vector containing frequencies. */ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; - int mask; /* Flags controlling FFT. */ -} FFTData; - - -static Blt_SwitchSpec fftSwitches[] = { - {BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM, "-imagpart", "vector", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, imagPtr), 0, 0, &fftVectorSwitch}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-noconstant", "", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, mask), 0, FFT_NO_CONSTANT}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-spectrum", "", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, mask), 0, FFT_SPECTRUM}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BITMASK, "-bartlett", "", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, mask), 0, FFT_BARTLETT}, - {BLT_SWITCH_DOUBLE, "-delta", "float", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, mask), 0, 0, }, - {BLT_SWITCH_CUSTOM, "-frequencies", "vector", - Tk_Offset(FFTData, freqPtr), 0, 0, &fftVectorSwitch}, - {BLT_SWITCH_END} -}; - -static int Blt_ExprIntFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - int *valuePtr) -{ - // First try to extract the value as a simple integer. - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, objPtr, valuePtr) == TCL_OK) - return TCL_OK; - - // Otherwise try to parse it as an expression. - long lvalue; - if (Tcl_ExprLong(interp, Tcl_GetString(objPtr), &lvalue) == TCL_OK) { - *valuePtr = lvalue; - return TCL_OK; - } - - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -static int Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - double *valuePtr) -{ - // First try to extract the value as a double precision number. - if (Tcl_GetDoubleFromObj((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, objPtr, valuePtr) == TCL_OK) - return TCL_OK; - - // Interpret the empty string "" and "NaN" as NaN. - int length; - char *string; - string = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(objPtr, &length); - if (length == 0 || (length == 3 && strcmp(string, "NaN") == 0)) { - *valuePtr = NAN; - return TCL_OK; - } - - // Then try to parse it as an expression. - if (Tcl_ExprDouble(interp, string, valuePtr) == TCL_OK) - return TCL_OK; - - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -static int ObjToFFTVector(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - const char *switchName, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - char *record, int offset, int flags) -{ - FFTData *dataPtr = (FFTData *)record; - Vector *vPtr; - Vector **vPtrPtr = (Vector **)(record + offset); - int isNew; /* Not used. */ - char *string; - - string = Tcl_GetString(objPtr); - vPtr = Vec_Create(dataPtr->dataPtr, string, string, string, &isNew); - if (vPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *vPtrPtr = vPtr; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ObjToIndex(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - const char *switchName, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, char *record, - int offset, int flags) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector*)clientData; - int *indexPtr = (int *)(record + offset); - int index; - - if (Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, Tcl_GetString(objPtr), &index, - INDEX_CHECK, (Blt_VectorIndexProc **)NULL) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *indexPtr = index; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Tcl_Obj* GetValues(Vector *vPtr, int first, int last) -{ - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - for (double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+last; - vp <= vend; vp++) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(vPtr->interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(*vp)); - - return listObjPtr; -} - -static void ReplicateValue(Vector *vPtr, int first, int last, double value) -{ - for (double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+last; - vp <= vend; vp++) - *vp = value; - - vPtr->notifyFlags |= UPDATE_RANGE; -} - -static int CopyList(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (Vec_SetLength(interp, vPtr, objc) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - for (int ii = 0; ii < objc; ii++) { - double value; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[ii], &value) != TCL_OK) { - Vec_SetLength(interp, vPtr, ii); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->valueArr[ii] = value; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int AppendVector(Vector *destPtr, Vector *srcPtr) -{ - size_t oldSize = destPtr->length; - size_t newSize = oldSize + srcPtr->last - srcPtr->first + 1; - if (Vec_ChangeLength(destPtr->interp, destPtr, newSize) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - size_t nBytes = (newSize - oldSize) * sizeof(double); - memcpy((char *)(destPtr->valueArr + oldSize), - (srcPtr->valueArr + srcPtr->first), nBytes); - destPtr->notifyFlags |= UPDATE_RANGE; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int AppendList(Vector *vPtr, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tcl_Interp* interp = vPtr->interp; - - int oldSize = vPtr->length; - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, vPtr->length + objc) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int count = oldSize; - for (int i = 0; i < objc; i++) { - double value; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[i], &value) != TCL_OK) { - Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, count); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->valueArr[count++] = value; - } - vPtr->notifyFlags |= UPDATE_RANGE; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -// Vector instance option commands - -static int AppendOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - for (int i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_ParseElement((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, vPtr->dataPtr, - Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), - (const char **)NULL, NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - int result; - if (v2Ptr != NULL) - result = AppendVector(vPtr, v2Ptr); - else { - int nElem; - Tcl_Obj **elemObjArr; - - if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objv[i], &nElem, &elemObjArr) - != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - result = AppendList(vPtr, nElem, elemObjArr); - } - - if (result != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (objc > 2) { - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ClearOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DeleteOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - // FIXME: Don't delete vector with no indices - if (objc == 2) { - Vec_Free(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - - // Allocate an "unset" bitmap the size of the vector - unsigned char* unsetArr = - (unsigned char*)calloc(sizeof(unsigned char), (vPtr->length + 7) / 8); -#define SetBit(i) (unsetArr[(i) >> 3] |= (1 << ((i) & 0x07))) -#define GetBit(i) (unsetArr[(i) >> 3] & (1 << ((i) & 0x07))) - - for (int i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - if (Vec_GetIndexRange(interp, vPtr, string, (INDEX_COLON | INDEX_CHECK), - (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL) != TCL_OK) { - free(unsetArr); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // Mark the range of elements for deletion - for (int j = vPtr->first; j <= vPtr->last; j++) - SetBit(j); - } - - int count = 0; - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - // Skip elements marked for deletion - if (GetBit(i)) - continue; - - if (count < i) { - vPtr->valueArr[count] = vPtr->valueArr[i]; - } - count++; - } - free(unsetArr); - vPtr->length = count; - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int DupOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - for (int i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - char* name = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - int isNew; - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, name, name, name, &isNew); - if (v2Ptr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (v2Ptr == vPtr) - continue; - - if (Vec_Duplicate(v2Ptr, vPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (!isNew) { - if (v2Ptr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - } - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int FFTOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - FFTData data; - memset(&data, 0, sizeof(data)); - data.delta = 1.0; - - char* realVecName = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - int isNew; - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, realVecName, realVecName, - realVecName, &isNew); - if (v2Ptr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (v2Ptr == vPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "real vector \"", realVecName, "\"", - " can't be the same as the source", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (ParseSwitches(interp, fftSwitches, objc - 3, objv + 3, &data, - BLT_SWITCH_DEFAULTS) < 0) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (Vec_FFT(interp, v2Ptr, data.imagPtr, data.freqPtr, data.delta, - data.mask, vPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Update bookkeeping - if (!isNew) { - if (v2Ptr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - } - - if (data.imagPtr != NULL) { - if (data.imagPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(data.imagPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(data.imagPtr); - } - - if (data.freqPtr != NULL) { - if (data.freqPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(data.freqPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(data.freqPtr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int InverseFFTOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char* name = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - Vector *srcImagPtr; - if (Vec_LookupName(vPtr->dataPtr, name, &srcImagPtr) != TCL_OK ) - return TCL_ERROR; - - name = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - int isNew; - Vector* destRealPtr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, name, name, name, &isNew); - name = Tcl_GetString(objv[4]); - Vector* destImagPtr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, name, name, name, &isNew); - - if (Vec_InverseFFT(interp, srcImagPtr, destRealPtr, destImagPtr, vPtr) - != TCL_OK ) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (destRealPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(destRealPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(destRealPtr); - - if (destImagPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(destImagPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(destImagPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int IndexOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - if (Vec_GetIndexRange(interp, vPtr, string, INDEX_ALL_FLAGS, - (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int first = vPtr->first; - int last = vPtr->last; - if (objc == 3) { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr; - - if (first == vPtr->length) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't get index \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; /* Can't read from index "++end" */ - } - listObjPtr = GetValues(vPtr, first, last); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - else { - // FIXME: huh? Why set values here? - if (first == SPECIAL_INDEX) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't set index \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - // Tried to set "min" or "max" - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - double value; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &value) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (first == vPtr->length) { - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, vPtr->length + 1) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - ReplicateValue(vPtr, first, last, value); - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objv[3]); - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int LengthOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc == 3) { - int nElem; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[2], &nElem) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (nElem < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector size \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if ((Vec_SetSize(interp, vPtr, nElem) != TCL_OK) || - (Vec_SetLength(interp, vPtr, nElem) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), vPtr->length); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int MapOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc > 2) { - if (Vec_MapVariable(interp, vPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[2])) - != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (vPtr->arrayName != NULL) - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), vPtr->arrayName, -1); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int MaxOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tcl_SetDoubleObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), Vec_Max(vPtr)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int MergeOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - // Allocate an array of vector pointers of each vector to be - // merged in the current vector. - Vector** vecArr = (Vector**)malloc(sizeof(Vector *) * objc); - Vector** vPtrPtr = vecArr; - - int refSize = -1; - int nElem = 0; - for (int i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - Vector *v2Ptr; - if (Vec_LookupName(vPtr->dataPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), &v2Ptr) - != TCL_OK) { - free(vecArr); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // Check that all the vectors are the same length - int length = v2Ptr->last - v2Ptr->first + 1; - if (refSize < 0) - refSize = length; - else if (length != refSize) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "vectors \"", vPtr->name, - "\" and \"", v2Ptr->name, "\" differ in length", - (char *)NULL); - free(vecArr); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *vPtrPtr++ = v2Ptr; - nElem += refSize; - } - *vPtrPtr = NULL; - - double* valueArr = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * nElem); - if (valueArr == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "not enough memory to allocate ", - Itoa(nElem), " vector elements", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - // Merge the values from each of the vectors into the current vector - double* valuePtr = valueArr; - for (int i = 0; i < refSize; i++) { - for (Vector** vpp = vecArr; *vpp != NULL; vpp++) { - *valuePtr++ = (*vpp)->valueArr[i + (*vpp)->first]; - } - } - free(vecArr); - Vec_Reset(vPtr, valueArr, nElem, nElem, TCL_DYNAMIC); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int MinOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Tcl_SetDoubleObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), Vec_Min(vPtr)); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NormalizeOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Vec_UpdateRange(vPtr); - double range = vPtr->max - vPtr->min; - if (objc > 2) { - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - int isNew; - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, string, string, string, &isNew); - if (v2Ptr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (Vec_SetLength(interp, v2Ptr, vPtr->length) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) - v2Ptr->valueArr[i] = (vPtr->valueArr[i] - vPtr->min) / range; - - Vec_UpdateRange(v2Ptr); - if (!isNew) { - if (v2Ptr->flush) { - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - } - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - } - } - else { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - double norm = (vPtr->valueArr[i] - vPtr->min) / range; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewDoubleObj(norm)); - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NotifyOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - enum optionIndices { - OPTION_ALWAYS, OPTION_NEVER, OPTION_WHENIDLE, - OPTION_NOW, OPTION_CANCEL, OPTION_PENDING - }; - static const char *optionArr[] = { - "always", "never", "whenidle", "now", "cancel", "pending", NULL - }; - - int option; - if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[2], optionArr, "qualifier", TCL_EXACT, - &option) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_OK; - - switch (option) { - case OPTION_ALWAYS: - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~NOTIFY_WHEN_MASK; - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_ALWAYS; - break; - case OPTION_NEVER: - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~NOTIFY_WHEN_MASK; - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_NEVER; - break; - case OPTION_WHENIDLE: - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~NOTIFY_WHEN_MASK; - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_WHENIDLE; - break; - case OPTION_NOW: - // FIXME: How does this play when an update is pending? - Blt_Vec_NotifyClients(vPtr); - break; - case OPTION_CANCEL: - if (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_PENDING) { - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~NOTIFY_PENDING; - Tcl_CancelIdleCall(Blt_Vec_NotifyClients, (ClientData)vPtr); - } - break; - case OPTION_PENDING: - int boll = (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_PENDING); - Tcl_SetBooleanObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), boll); - break; - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int PopulateOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - int isNew; - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, string, string, string, &isNew); - if (v2Ptr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Source vector is empty - if (vPtr->length == 0) - return TCL_OK; - - int density; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[3], &density) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (density < 1) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad density \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), - "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - int size = (vPtr->length - 1) * (density + 1) + 1; - if (Vec_SetLength(interp, v2Ptr, size) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int count = 0; - double* valuePtr = v2Ptr->valueArr; - int i; - for (i = 0; i < (vPtr->length - 1); i++) { - double range = vPtr->valueArr[i + 1] - vPtr->valueArr[i]; - double slice = range / (double)(density + 1); - for (int j = 0; j <= density; j++) { - *valuePtr = vPtr->valueArr[i] + (slice * (double)j); - valuePtr++; - count++; - } - } - count++; - *valuePtr = vPtr->valueArr[i]; - if (!isNew) { - if (v2Ptr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ValuesOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - PrintSwitches switches; - switches.formatObjPtr = NULL; - switches.from = 0; - switches.to = vPtr->length - 1; - indexSwitch.clientData = vPtr; - if (ParseSwitches(interp, printSwitches, objc - 2, objv + 2, &switches, - BLT_SWITCH_DEFAULTS) < 0) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (switches.from > switches.to) { - // swap positions - int tmp = switches.to; - switches.to = switches.from; - switches.from = tmp; - } - - if (switches.formatObjPtr == NULL) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - for (int i = switches.from; i <= switches.to; i++) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewDoubleObj(vPtr->valueArr[i])); - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - else { - Tcl_DString ds; - Tcl_DStringInit(&ds); - const char* fmt = Tcl_GetString(switches.formatObjPtr); - for (int i = switches.from; i <= switches.to; i++) { - char buffer[200]; - sprintf(buffer, fmt, vPtr->valueArr[i]); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, buffer, -1); - } - Tcl_DStringResult(interp, &ds); - Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); - } - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int RangeOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int first; - int last; - - if (objc == 2) { - first = 0; - last = vPtr->length - 1; - } - else if (objc == 4) { - if ((Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), &first, - INDEX_CHECK, (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL) != TCL_OK) || - (Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), &last, - INDEX_CHECK, (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - } - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "wrong # args: should be \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), " range ?first last?", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (first > last) { - // Return the list reversed - for (int i=last; i<=first; i++) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewDoubleObj(vPtr->valueArr[i])); - } - else { - for (int i=first; i<=last; i++) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewDoubleObj(vPtr->valueArr[i])); - } - - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int InRange(double value, double min, double max) -{ - double range = max - min; - if (range < DBL_EPSILON) - return (fabs(max - value) < DBL_EPSILON); - - double norm = (value - min) / range; - return ((norm >= -DBL_EPSILON) && ((norm - 1.0) < DBL_EPSILON)); -} - -enum NativeFormats { - FMT_UNKNOWN = -1, - FMT_UCHAR, FMT_CHAR, - FMT_USHORT, FMT_SHORT, - FMT_UINT, FMT_INT, - FMT_ULONG, FMT_LONG, - FMT_FLOAT, FMT_DOUBLE -}; - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * GetBinaryFormat - * - * Translates a format string into a native type. Valid formats are - * - * signed i1, i2, i4, i8 - * unsigned u1, u2, u4, u8 - * real r4, r8, r16 - * - * There must be a corresponding native type. For example, this for - * reading 2-byte binary integers from an instrument and converting them - * to unsigned shorts or ints. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static enum NativeFormats GetBinaryFormat(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *string, - int *sizePtr) -{ - char c = tolower(string[0]); - if (Tcl_GetInt(interp, string + 1, sizePtr) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown binary format \"", string, - "\": incorrect byte size", (char *)NULL); - return FMT_UNKNOWN; - } - - switch (c) { - case 'r': - if (*sizePtr == sizeof(double)) - return FMT_DOUBLE; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(float)) - return FMT_FLOAT; - - break; - - case 'i': - if (*sizePtr == sizeof(char)) - return FMT_CHAR; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(int)) - return FMT_INT; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(long)) - return FMT_LONG; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(short)) - return FMT_SHORT; - - break; - - case 'u': - if (*sizePtr == sizeof(unsigned char)) - return FMT_UCHAR; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(unsigned int)) - return FMT_UINT; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(unsigned long)) - return FMT_ULONG; - else if (*sizePtr == sizeof(unsigned short)) - return FMT_USHORT; - - break; - - default: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown binary format \"", string, - "\": should be either i#, r#, u# (where # is size in bytes)", - (char *)NULL); - return FMT_UNKNOWN; - } - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't handle format \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - - return FMT_UNKNOWN; -} - -static int CopyValues(Vector *vPtr, char *byteArr, enum NativeFormats fmt, - int size, int length, int swap, int *indexPtr) -{ - if ((swap) && (size > 1)) { - int nBytes = size * length; - for (int i = 0; i < nBytes; i += size) { - unsigned char* p = (unsigned char *)(byteArr + i); - int left, right; - for (left = 0, right = size - 1; left < right; left++, right--) { - p[left] ^= p[right]; - p[right] ^= p[left]; - p[left] ^= p[right]; - } - } - } - - int newSize = *indexPtr + length; - if (newSize > vPtr->length) { - if (Vec_ChangeLength(vPtr->interp, vPtr, newSize) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - -#define CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, arr) \ - for (int i = 0, n = *indexPtr; i < length; i++, n++) { \ - (vPtr)->valueArr[n] = (double)(arr)[i]; \ - } - - switch (fmt) { - case FMT_CHAR: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (char *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_UCHAR: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (unsigned char *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_INT: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (int *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_UINT: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (unsigned int *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_LONG: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (long *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_ULONG: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (unsigned long *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_SHORT: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (short int *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_USHORT: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (unsigned short int *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_FLOAT: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (float *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_DOUBLE: - CopyArrayToVector(vPtr, (double *)byteArr); - break; - - case FMT_UNKNOWN: - break; - } - *indexPtr += length; - return TCL_OK; -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * BinreadOp -- - * - * Reads binary values from a TCL channel. Values are either appended to - * the end of the vector or placed at a given index (using the "-at" - * option), overwriting existing values. Data is read until EOF is found - * on the channel or a specified number of values are read. (note that - * this is not necessarily the same as the number of bytes). - * - * The following flags are supported: - * -swap Swap bytes - * -at index Start writing data at the index. - * -format fmt Specifies the format of the data. - * - * This binary reader was created and graciously donated by Harald Kirsch - * (kir@iitb.fhg.de). Anything that's wrong is due to my (gah) munging - * of the code. - * - * Results: - * Returns a standard TCL result. The interpreter result will contain the - * number of values (not the number of bytes) read. - * - * Caveats: - * Channel reads must end on an element boundary. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ - -static int BinreadOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - enum NativeFormats fmt; - - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - int mode; - Tcl_Channel channel = Tcl_GetChannel(interp, string, &mode); - if (channel == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if ((mode & TCL_READABLE) == 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "channel \"", string, - "\" wasn't opened for reading", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - int first = vPtr->length; - fmt = FMT_DOUBLE; - int size = sizeof(double); - int swap = 0; - int count = 0; - - if (objc > 3) { - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); - if (string[0] != '-') { - long int value; - // Get the number of values to read. - if (Tcl_GetLongFromObj(interp, objv[3], &value) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (value < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "count can't be negative", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - count = (size_t)value; - objc--, objv++; - } - } - - // Process any option-value pairs that remain. - for (int i = 3; i < objc; i++) { - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - if (strcmp(string, "-swap") == 0) - swap = 1; - else if (strcmp(string, "-format") == 0) { - i++; - if (i >= objc) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "missing arg after \"", string, - "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - fmt = GetBinaryFormat(interp, string, &size); - if (fmt == FMT_UNKNOWN) - return TCL_ERROR; - } - else if (strcmp(string, "-at") == 0) { - i++; - if (i >= objc) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "missing arg after \"", string, - "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - if (Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, string, &first, 0, - (Blt_VectorIndexProc **)NULL) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (first > vPtr->length) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "index \"", string, - "\" is out of range", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - } - -#define BUFFER_SIZE 1024 - int arraySize = (count == 0) ? BUFFER_SIZE*size : count*size; - - char* byteArr = (char*)malloc(arraySize); - // FIXME: restore old channel translation later? - if (Tcl_SetChannelOption(interp, channel, "-translation","binary") != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int total = 0; - while (!Tcl_Eof(channel)) { - int bytesRead = Tcl_Read(channel, byteArr, arraySize); - if (bytesRead < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "error reading channel: ", - Tcl_PosixError(interp), (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if ((bytesRead % size) != 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "error reading channel: short read", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - int length = bytesRead / size; - if (CopyValues(vPtr, byteArr, fmt, size, length, swap, &first) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - total += length; - if (count > 0) - break; - } - free(byteArr); - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - // Set the result as the number of values read - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), total); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SearchOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int wantValue = 0; - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[2]); - if ((string[0] == '-') && (strcmp(string, "-value") == 0)) { - wantValue = 1; - objv++, objc--; - } - double min; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &min) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - double max = min; - if (objc > 4) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "wrong # arguments: should be \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), " search ?-value? min ?max?", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if ((objc > 3) && (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &max) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - // Bogus range. Don't bother looking - if ((min - max) >= DBL_EPSILON) - return TCL_OK; - - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - if (wantValue) { - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - if (InRange(vPtr->valueArr[i], min, max)) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewDoubleObj(vPtr->valueArr[i])); - } - } - else { - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - if (InRange(vPtr->valueArr[i], min, max)) - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewIntObj(i + vPtr->offset)); - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int OffsetOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (objc == 3) { - int newOffset; - if (Tcl_GetIntFromObj(interp, objv[2], &newOffset) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - vPtr->offset = newOffset; - } - Tcl_SetIntObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), vPtr->offset); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int RandomOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) - vPtr->valueArr[i] = drand48(); - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SeqOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - double start; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &start) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - double stop; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[3], &stop) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int n = vPtr->length; - if ((objc > 4) && (Blt_ExprIntFromObj(interp, objv[4], &n) != TCL_OK)) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (n > 1) { - if (Vec_SetLength(interp, vPtr, n) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - double step = (stop - start) / (double)(n - 1); - for (int i = 0; i < n; i++) - vPtr->valueArr[i] = start + (step * i); - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SetOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int nElem; - Tcl_Obj **elemObjArr; - - // The source can be either a list of numbers or another vector. - - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_ParseElement((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, vPtr->dataPtr, - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), NULL, - NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - int result; - if (v2Ptr != NULL) { - if (vPtr == v2Ptr) { - // Source and destination vectors are the same. Copy the source - // first into a temporary vector to avoid memory overlaps. - Vector* tmpPtr = Vec_New(vPtr->dataPtr); - result = Vec_Duplicate(tmpPtr, v2Ptr); - if (result == TCL_OK) { - result = Vec_Duplicate(vPtr, tmpPtr); - } - Vec_Free(tmpPtr); - } - else - result = Vec_Duplicate(vPtr, v2Ptr); - } - else if (Tcl_ListObjGetElements(interp, objv[2], &nElem, &elemObjArr) - == TCL_OK) - result = CopyList(vPtr, interp, nElem, elemObjArr); - else - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (result == TCL_OK) { - // The vector has changed; so flush the array indices (they're wrong - // now), find the new range of the data, and notify the vector's - //clients that it's been modified. - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - - return result; -} - -static int SimplifyOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - double tolerance = 10.0; - - int nPoints = vPtr->length / 2; - int* simple = (int*)malloc(nPoints * sizeof(int)); - Point2d* reduced = (Point2d*)malloc(nPoints * sizeof(Point2d)); - Point2d* orig = (Point2d *)vPtr->valueArr; - int n = Blt_SimplifyLine(orig, 0, nPoints - 1, tolerance, simple); - for (int i = 0; i < n; i++) - reduced[i] = orig[simple[i]]; - - free(simple); - Vec_Reset(vPtr, (double *)reduced, n * 2, vPtr->length, TCL_DYNAMIC); - // The vector has changed; so flush the array indices (they're wrong - // now), find the new range of the data, and notify the vector's - // clients that it's been modified. - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int SplitOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - int nVectors = objc - 2; - if ((vPtr->length % nVectors) != 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't split vector \"", vPtr->name, - "\" into ", Itoa(nVectors), " even parts.", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if (nVectors > 0) { - int extra = vPtr->length / nVectors; - for (int i = 0; i < nVectors; i++) { - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i+2]); - int isNew; - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_Create(vPtr->dataPtr, string, string, string, &isNew); - int oldSize = v2Ptr->length; - int newSize = oldSize + extra; - if (Vec_SetLength(interp, v2Ptr, newSize) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int j,k; - for (j = i, k = oldSize; j < vPtr->length; j += nVectors, k++) - v2Ptr->valueArr[k] = vPtr->valueArr[j]; - - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - if (v2Ptr->flush) { - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - } - } - } - return TCL_OK; -} - - -// Pointer to the array of values currently being sorted. -static Vector **sortVectors; -// Indicates the ordering of the sort. If non-zero, the vectors are sorted in -// decreasing order -static int sortDecreasing; -static int nSortVectors; - -static int CompareVectors(void *a, void *b) -{ - int sign = (sortDecreasing) ? -1 : 1; - for (int i = 0; i < nSortVectors; i++) { - Vector* vPtr = sortVectors[i]; - double delta = vPtr->valueArr[*(int *)a] - vPtr->valueArr[*(int *)b]; - if (delta < 0.0) - return (-1 * sign); - else if (delta > 0.0) - return (1 * sign); - } - - return 0; -} - -size_t* Blt::Vec_SortMap(Vector **vectors, int nVectors) -{ - Vector *vPtr = *vectors; - int length = vPtr->last - vPtr->first + 1; - size_t* map = (size_t*)malloc(sizeof(size_t) * length); - for (int i = vPtr->first; i <= vPtr->last; i++) - map[i] = i; - - // Set global variables for sorting routine - sortVectors = vectors; - nSortVectors = nVectors; - qsort((char *)map, length, sizeof(size_t),(QSortCompareProc *)CompareVectors); - - return map; -} - -static size_t* SortVectors(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - - Vector** vectors = (Vector**)malloc(sizeof(Vector *) * (objc + 1)); - vectors[0] = vPtr; - size_t* map = NULL; - for (int i = 0; i < objc; i++) { - Vector* v2Ptr; - if (Vec_LookupName(vPtr->dataPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), - &v2Ptr) != TCL_OK) - goto error; - - if (v2Ptr->length != vPtr->length) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "vector \"", v2Ptr->name, - "\" is not the same size as \"", vPtr->name, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - vectors[i + 1] = v2Ptr; - } - map = Vec_SortMap(vectors, objc + 1); - - error: - free(vectors); - - return map; -} - -static int SortOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - sortDecreasing = 0; - SortSwitches switches; - switches.flags = 0; - int i = ParseSwitches(interp, sortSwitches, objc - 2, objv + 2, &switches, - BLT_SWITCH_OBJV_PARTIAL); - if (i < 0) - return TCL_ERROR; - - objc -= i, objv += i; - sortDecreasing = (switches.flags & SORT_DECREASING); - - size_t *map = (objc > 2) ? SortVectors(vPtr, interp, objc - 2, objv + 2) : - Vec_SortMap(&vPtr, 1); - - if (map == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - int sortLength = vPtr->length; - - // Create an array to store a copy of the current values of the - // vector. We'll merge the values back into the vector based upon the - // indices found in the index array. - size_t nBytes = sizeof(double) * sortLength; - double* copy = (double*)malloc(nBytes); - memcpy((char *)copy, (char *)vPtr->valueArr, nBytes); - if (switches.flags & SORT_UNIQUE) { - int count =1; - for (int n = 1; n < sortLength; n++) { - size_t next = map[n]; - size_t prev = map[n - 1]; - if (copy[next] != copy[prev]) { - map[count] = next; - count++; - } - } - sortLength = count; - nBytes = sortLength * sizeof(double); - } - - if (sortLength != vPtr->length) - Vec_SetLength(interp, vPtr, sortLength); - - for (int n = 0; n < sortLength; n++) - vPtr->valueArr[n] = copy[map[n]]; - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - // Now sort any other vectors in the same fashion. The vectors must be - // the same size as the map though - int result = TCL_ERROR; - for (int i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - Vector *v2Ptr; - if (Vec_LookupName(vPtr->dataPtr, Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), &v2Ptr) != TCL_OK) - goto error; - - if (sortLength != v2Ptr->length) - Vec_SetLength(interp, v2Ptr, sortLength); - - memcpy((char *)copy, (char *)v2Ptr->valueArr, nBytes); - for (int n = 0; n < sortLength; n++) - v2Ptr->valueArr[n] = copy[map[n]]; - - Vec_UpdateClients(v2Ptr); - if (v2Ptr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(v2Ptr); - } - result = TCL_OK; - - error: - free(copy); - free(map); - - return result; -} - -static int InstExprOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - if (Blt_ExprVector(interp, Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), (Blt_Vector *)vPtr) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ArithOp(Vector *vPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - double value; - double scalar; - - Vector* v2Ptr = Vec_ParseElement((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, vPtr->dataPtr, - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), NULL, - NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - if (v2Ptr != NULL) { - int length = v2Ptr->last - v2Ptr->first + 1; - if (length != vPtr->length) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "vectors \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[0]), - "\" and \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - "\" are not the same length", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[1]); - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - switch (string[0]) { - case '*': - for (int i = 0, j = v2Ptr->first; i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] * v2Ptr->valueArr[j]; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '/': - for (int i = 0, j = v2Ptr->first; i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] / v2Ptr->valueArr[j]; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '-': - for (int i = 0, j = v2Ptr->first; i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] - v2Ptr->valueArr[j]; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '+': - for (int i = 0, j = v2Ptr->first; i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] + v2Ptr->valueArr[j]; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - - } - else if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objv[2], &scalar) == TCL_OK) { - Tcl_Obj* listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **)NULL); - char* string = Tcl_GetString(objv[1]); - switch (string[0]) { - case '*': - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] * scalar; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '/': - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] / scalar; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '-': - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] - scalar; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - - case '+': - for (int i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - value = vPtr->valueArr[i] + scalar; - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value)); - } - break; - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - else - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static Blt_OpSpec vectorInstOps[] = - { - {"*", 1, (void*)ArithOp, 3, 3, "item",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"+", 1, (void*)ArithOp, 3, 3, "item",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"-", 1, (void*)ArithOp, 3, 3, "item",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"/", 1, (void*)ArithOp, 3, 3, "item",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"append", 1, (void*)AppendOp, 3, 0, "items ?items...?",}, - {"binread", 1, (void*)BinreadOp, 3, 0, "channel ?numValues? ?flags?",}, - {"clear", 1, (void*)ClearOp, 2, 2, "",}, - {"delete", 2, (void*)DeleteOp, 2, 0, "index ?index...?",}, - {"dup", 2, (void*)DupOp, 3, 0, "vecName",}, - {"expr", 1, (void*)InstExprOp, 3, 3, "expression",}, - {"fft", 1, (void*)FFTOp, 3, 0, "vecName ?switches?",}, - {"index", 3, (void*)IndexOp, 3, 4, "index ?value?",}, - {"inversefft",3, (void*)InverseFFTOp,4, 4, "vecName vecName",}, - {"length", 1, (void*)LengthOp, 2, 3, "?newSize?",}, - {"max", 2, (void*)MaxOp, 2, 2, "",}, - {"merge", 2, (void*)MergeOp, 3, 0, "vecName ?vecName...?",}, - {"min", 2, (void*)MinOp, 2, 2, "",}, - {"normalize", 3, (void*)NormalizeOp, 2, 3, "?vecName?",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"notify", 3, (void*)NotifyOp, 3, 3, "keyword",}, - {"offset", 1, (void*)OffsetOp, 2, 3, "?offset?",}, - {"populate", 1, (void*)PopulateOp, 4, 4, "vecName density",}, - {"random", 4, (void*)RandomOp, 2, 2, "",}, /*Deprecated*/ - {"range", 4, (void*)RangeOp, 2, 4, "first last",}, - {"search", 3, (void*)SearchOp, 3, 5, "?-value? value ?value?",}, - {"seq", 3, (void*)SeqOp, 4, 5, "begin end ?num?",}, - {"set", 3, (void*)SetOp, 3, 3, "list",}, - {"simplify", 2, (void*)SimplifyOp, 2, 2, }, - {"sort", 2, (void*)SortOp, 2, 0, "?switches? ?vecName...?",}, - {"split", 2, (void*)SplitOp, 2, 0, "?vecName...?",}, - {"values", 3, (void*)ValuesOp, 2, 0, "?switches?",}, - {"variable", 3, (void*)MapOp, 2, 3, "?varName?",}, - }; - -static int nInstOps = sizeof(vectorInstOps) / sizeof(Blt_OpSpec); - -int Blt::Vec_InstCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)clientData; - vPtr->first = 0; - vPtr->last = vPtr->length - 1; - VectorCmdProc *proc = - (VectorCmdProc*)GetOpFromObj(interp, nInstOps, vectorInstOps, - BLT_OP_ARG1, objc, objv, 0); - if (proc == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return (*proc) (vPtr, interp, objc, objv); -} - -#define MAX_ERR_MSG 1023 -static char message[MAX_ERR_MSG + 1]; -char* Blt::Vec_VarTrace(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - const char *part1, const char *part2, int flags) -{ - Blt_VectorIndexProc *indexProc; - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)clientData; - - if (part2 == NULL) { - if (flags & TCL_TRACE_UNSETS) { - free((void*)(vPtr->arrayName)); - vPtr->arrayName = NULL; - if (vPtr->freeOnUnset) - Vec_Free(vPtr); - } - - return NULL; - } - - int first; - int last; - int varFlags; - - if (Vec_GetIndexRange(interp, vPtr, part2, INDEX_ALL_FLAGS, &indexProc) - != TCL_OK) - goto error; - - first = vPtr->first; - last = vPtr->last; - varFlags = TCL_LEAVE_ERR_MSG | (TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY & flags); - if (flags & TCL_TRACE_WRITES) { - // Tried to set "min" or "max" - if (first == SPECIAL_INDEX) - return (char *)"read-only index"; - - Tcl_Obj* objPtr = Tcl_GetVar2Ex(interp, part1, part2, varFlags); - if (objPtr == NULL) - goto error; - - double value; - if (Blt_ExprDoubleFromObj(interp, objPtr, &value) != TCL_OK) { - // Single numeric index. Reset the array element to - // its old value on errors - if ((last == first) && (first >= 0)) - Tcl_SetVar2Ex(interp, part1, part2, objPtr, varFlags); - goto error; - } - - if (first == vPtr->length) { - if (Vec_ChangeLength((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, vPtr, vPtr->length + 1) - != TCL_OK) - return (char *)"error resizing vector"; - } - - // Set possibly an entire range of values - ReplicateValue(vPtr, first, last, value); - } - else if (flags & TCL_TRACE_READS) { - Tcl_Obj *objPtr; - - if (vPtr->length == 0) { - if (Tcl_SetVar2(interp, part1, part2, "", varFlags) == NULL) - goto error; - - return NULL; - } - - if (first == vPtr->length) - return (char *)"write-only index"; - - if (first == last) { - double value; - if (first >= 0) - value = vPtr->valueArr[first]; - else { - vPtr->first = 0, vPtr->last = vPtr->length - 1; - value = (*indexProc) ((Blt_Vector *) vPtr); - } - - objPtr = Tcl_NewDoubleObj(value); - if (Tcl_SetVar2Ex(interp, part1, part2, objPtr, varFlags) == NULL) { - Tcl_DecrRefCount(objPtr); - goto error; - } - } - else { - objPtr = GetValues(vPtr, first, last); - if (Tcl_SetVar2Ex(interp, part1, part2, objPtr, varFlags) == NULL) - Tcl_DecrRefCount(objPtr); - goto error; - } - } - else if (flags & TCL_TRACE_UNSETS) { - if ((first == vPtr->length) || (first == SPECIAL_INDEX)) - return (char *)"special vector index"; - - // Collapse the vector from the point of the first unset element. - // Also flush any array variable entries so that the shift is - // reflected when the array variable is read. - for (int i = first, j = last + 1; j < vPtr->length; i++, j++) - vPtr->valueArr[i] = vPtr->valueArr[j]; - - vPtr->length -= ((last - first) + 1); - if (vPtr->flush) - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - - } - else - return (char *)"unknown variable trace flag"; - - if (flags & (TCL_TRACE_UNSETS | TCL_TRACE_WRITES)) - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - return NULL; - - error: - strncpy(message, Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), MAX_ERR_MSG); - message[MAX_ERR_MSG] = '\0'; - return message; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecInt.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecInt.h deleted file mode 100644 index cc516a1..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecInt.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,202 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1995-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - - -#include "tkbltChain.h" -#include "tkbltVector.h" - -#define VECTOR_THREAD_KEY "BLT Vector Data" -#define VECTOR_MAGIC ((unsigned int) 0x46170277) - -/* These defines allow parsing of different types of indices */ - -#define INDEX_SPECIAL (1<<0) /* Recognize "min", "max", and "++end" as - * valid indices */ -#define INDEX_COLON (1<<1) /* Also recognize a range of indices separated - * by a colon */ -#define INDEX_CHECK (1<<2) /* Verify that the specified index or range of - * indices are within limits */ -#define INDEX_ALL_FLAGS (INDEX_SPECIAL | INDEX_COLON | INDEX_CHECK) - -#define SPECIAL_INDEX -2 - -#define FFT_NO_CONSTANT (1<<0) -#define FFT_BARTLETT (1<<1) -#define FFT_SPECTRUM (1<<2) - -#define NOTIFY_UPDATED ((int)BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_UPDATE) -#define NOTIFY_DESTROYED ((int)BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY) - -#define NOTIFY_NEVER (1<<3) /* Never notify clients of updates to - * the vector */ -#define NOTIFY_ALWAYS (1<<4) /* Notify clients after each update - * of the vector is made */ -#define NOTIFY_WHENIDLE (1<<5) /* Notify clients at the next idle point - * that the vector has been updated. */ - -#define NOTIFY_PENDING (1<<6) /* A do-when-idle notification of the - * vector's clients is pending. */ -#define NOTIFY_NOW (1<<7) /* Notify clients of changes once - * immediately */ - -#define NOTIFY_WHEN_MASK (NOTIFY_NEVER|NOTIFY_ALWAYS|NOTIFY_WHENIDLE) - -#define UPDATE_RANGE (1<<9) /* The data of the vector has changed. - * Update the min and max limits when - * they are needed */ - -#define FindRange(array, first, last, min, max) \ - { \ - min = max = 0.0; \ - if (first <= last) { \ - register int i; \ - min = max = array[first]; \ - for (i = first + 1; i <= last; i++) { \ - if (min > array[i]) { \ - min = array[i]; \ - } else if (max < array[i]) { \ - max = array[i]; \ - } \ - } \ - } \ - } - -namespace Blt { - - typedef struct { - double x; - double y; - } Point2d; - - typedef struct { - Tcl_HashTable vectorTable; /* Table of vectors */ - Tcl_HashTable mathProcTable; /* Table of vector math functions */ - Tcl_HashTable indexProcTable; - Tcl_Interp* interp; - unsigned int nextId; - } VectorInterpData; - - typedef struct { - // If you change these fields, make sure you change the definition of - // Blt_Vector in blt.h too. - double *valueArr; /* Array of values (malloc-ed) */ - int length; /* Current number of values in the array. */ - int size; /* Maximum number of values that can be stored - * in the value array. */ - double min, max; /* Minimum and maximum values in the vector */ - int dirty; /* Indicates if the vector has been updated */ - int reserved; - - /* The following fields are local to this module */ - - const char *name; /* The namespace-qualified name of the vector. - * It points to the hash key allocated for the - * entry in the vector hash table. */ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; - Tcl_Interp* interp; /* Interpreter associated with the vector */ - Tcl_HashEntry *hashPtr; /* If non-NULL, pointer in a hash table to - * track the vectors in use. */ - Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc; /* Address of procedure to call to release - * storage for the value array, Optionally can - * be one of the following: TCL_STATIC, - * TCL_DYNAMIC, or TCL_VOLATILE. */ - const char *arrayName; /* The name of the TCL array variable mapped - * to the vector (malloc'ed). If NULL, - * indicates that the vector isn't mapped to - * any variable */ - Tcl_Namespace *nsPtr; /* Namespace context of the vector itself. */ - int offset; /* Offset from zero of the vector's starting - * index */ - Tcl_Command cmdToken; /* Token for vector's TCL command. */ - Chain* chain; /* List of clients using this vector */ - int notifyFlags; /* Notification flags. See definitions - * below */ - int varFlags; /* Indicate if the variable is global, - * namespace, or local */ - int freeOnUnset; /* For backward compatibility only: If - * non-zero, free the vector when its variable - * is unset. */ - int flush; - int first, last; /* Selected region of vector. This is used - * mostly for the math routines */ - } Vector; - - extern const char* Itoa(int value); - extern int Vec_GetIndex(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, - const char *string, int *indexPtr, int flags, - Blt_VectorIndexProc **procPtrPtr); - extern int Vec_GetIndexRange(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, - const char *string, int flags, - Blt_VectorIndexProc **procPtrPtr); - extern Vector* Vec_ParseElement(Tcl_Interp* interp, VectorInterpData *dataPtr, - const char *start, const char **endPtr, - int flags); - extern int Vec_SetLength(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, int length); - extern int Vec_SetSize(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, int size); - extern void Vec_FlushCache(Vector *vPtr); - extern void Vec_UpdateRange(Vector *vPtr); - extern void Vec_UpdateClients(Vector *vPtr); - extern void Vec_Free(Vector *vPtr); - extern Vector* Vec_New(VectorInterpData *dataPtr); - extern int Vec_MapVariable(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, - const char *name); - extern int Vec_ChangeLength(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr, int length); - extern Vector* Vec_Create(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, const char *name, - const char *cmdName, const char *varName, - int *newPtr); - extern int Vec_LookupName(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, const char *vecName, - Vector **vPtrPtr); - extern VectorInterpData* Vec_GetInterpData (Tcl_Interp* interp); - extern int Vec_Reset(Vector *vPtr, double *dataArr, int nValues, - int arraySize, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc); - extern int Vec_FFT(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *realPtr, - Vector *phasesPtr, Vector *freqPtr, double delta, - int flags, Vector *srcPtr); - extern int Vec_InverseFFT(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *iSrcPtr, - Vector *rDestPtr, Vector *iDestPtr, - Vector *srcPtr); - extern int Vec_Duplicate(Vector *destPtr, Vector *srcPtr); - extern size_t *Vec_SortMap(Vector **vectors, int nVectors); - extern double Vec_Max(Vector *vecObjPtr); - extern double Vec_Min(Vector *vecObjPtr); - extern int ExprVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *string, Blt_Vector *vector); - - extern Tcl_ObjCmdProc Vec_InstCmd; - extern Tcl_VarTraceProc Vec_VarTrace; - extern void Vec_InstallMathFunctions(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr); - extern void Vec_UninstallMathFunctions(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr); - extern void Vec_InstallSpecialIndices(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr); -}; - -extern Tcl_IdleProc Blt_Vec_NotifyClients; - -#ifdef _WIN32 -double drand48(void); -void srand48(long int seed); -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecMath.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecMath.C deleted file mode 100644 index 03277d4..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecMath.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1612 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1995-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include -#include -#include -#include -#include - -#include "tkbltInt.h" -#include "tkbltVecInt.h" -#include "tkbltNsUtil.h" -#include "tkbltParse.h" - -using namespace std; -using namespace Blt; - -/* - * Three types of math functions: - * - * ComponentProc Function is applied in multiple calls to - * each component of the vector. - * VectorProc Entire vector is passed, each component is - * modified. - * ScalarProc Entire vector is passed, single scalar value - * is returned. - */ - -typedef double (ComponentProc)(double value); -typedef int (VectorProc)(Vector *vPtr); -typedef double (ScalarProc)(Vector *vPtr); - -/* - * Built-in math functions: - */ -typedef int (GenericMathProc) (void*, Tcl_Interp*, Vector*); - -/* - * MathFunction -- - * - * Contains information about math functions that can be called - * for vectors. The table of math functions is global within the - * application. So you can't define two different "sqrt" - * functions. - */ -typedef struct { - const char *name; /* Name of built-in math function. If - * NULL, indicates that the function - * was user-defined and dynamically - * allocated. Function names are - * global across all interpreters. */ - - void *proc; /* Procedure that implements this math - * function. */ - - ClientData clientData; /* Argument to pass when invoking the - * function. */ - -} MathFunction; - -/* The data structure below is used to describe an expression value, - * which can be either a double-precision floating-point value, or a - * string. A given number has only one value at a time. */ - -#define STATIC_STRING_SPACE 150 - -/* - * Tokens -- - * - * The token types are defined below. In addition, there is a - * table associating a precedence with each operator. The order - * of types is important. Consult the code before changing it. - */ -enum Tokens { - VALUE, OPEN_PAREN, CLOSE_PAREN, COMMA, END, UNKNOWN, - MULT = 8, DIVIDE, MOD, PLUS, MINUS, - LEFT_SHIFT, RIGHT_SHIFT, - LESS, GREATER, LEQ, GEQ, EQUAL, NEQ, - OLD_BIT_AND, EXPONENT, OLD_BIT_OR, OLD_QUESTY, OLD_COLON, - AND, OR, UNARY_MINUS, OLD_UNARY_PLUS, NOT, OLD_BIT_NOT -}; - -typedef struct { - Vector *vPtr; - char staticSpace[STATIC_STRING_SPACE]; - ParseValue pv; /* Used to hold a string value, if any. */ -} Value; - -/* - * ParseInfo -- - * - * The data structure below describes the state of parsing an - * expression. It's passed among the routines in this module. - */ -typedef struct { - const char *expr; /* The entire right-hand side of the - * expression, as originally passed to - * Blt_ExprVector. */ - - const char *nextPtr; /* Position of the next character to - * be scanned from the expression - * string. */ - - enum Tokens token; /* Type of the last token to be parsed - * from nextPtr. See below for - * definitions. Corresponds to the - * characters just before nextPtr. */ - -} ParseInfo; - -/* - * Precedence table. The values for non-operator token types are ignored. - */ -static int precTable[] = - { - 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, - 12, 12, 12, /* MULT, DIVIDE, MOD */ - 11, 11, /* PLUS, MINUS */ - 10, 10, /* LEFT_SHIFT, RIGHT_SHIFT */ - 9, 9, 9, 9, /* LESS, GREATER, LEQ, GEQ */ - 8, 8, /* EQUAL, NEQ */ - 7, /* OLD_BIT_AND */ - 13, /* EXPONENTIATION */ - 5, /* OLD_BIT_OR */ - 4, /* AND */ - 3, /* OR */ - 2, /* OLD_QUESTY */ - 1, /* OLD_COLON */ - 14, 14, 14, 14 /* UNARY_MINUS, OLD_UNARY_PLUS, NOT, - * OLD_BIT_NOT */ - }; - - -/* - * Forward declarations. - */ - -static int NextValue(Tcl_Interp* interp, ParseInfo *piPtr, int prec, - Value *valuePtr); - -static int Sort(Vector *vPtr) -{ - size_t* map = Vec_SortMap(&vPtr, 1); - double* values = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * vPtr->length); - for(int ii = vPtr->first; ii <= vPtr->last; ii++) - values[ii] = vPtr->valueArr[map[ii]]; - - free(map); - for (int ii = vPtr->first; ii <= vPtr->last; ii++) - vPtr->valueArr[ii] = values[ii]; - - free(values); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static double Length(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - return (double)(vPtr->last - vPtr->first + 1); -} - -double Blt_VecMax(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - return Vec_Max(vPtr); -} - -double Blt_VecMin(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - return Vec_Min(vPtr); -} - -int Blt_ExprVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *string, Blt_Vector *vector) -{ - return ExprVector(interp,string,vector); -} - -static double Product(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double prod; - double *vp, *vend; - - prod = 1.0; - for(vp = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->first, - vend = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->last; vp <= vend; vp++) { - prod *= *vp; - } - return prod; -} - -static double Sum(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - // Kahan summation algorithm - - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double* vp = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->first; - double sum = *vp++; - double c = 0.0; /* A running compensation for lost - * low-order bits.*/ - for (double* vend = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->last; vp <= vend; vp++) { - double y = *vp - c; /* So far, so good: c is zero.*/ - double t = sum + y; /* Alas, sum is big, y small, so - * low-order digits of y are lost.*/ - c = (t - sum) - y; /* (t - sum) recovers the high-order - * part of y; subtracting y recovers - * -(low part of y) */ - sum = t; - } - - return sum; -} - -static double Mean(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double sum = Sum(vectorPtr); - int n = vPtr->last - vPtr->first + 1; - - return sum / (double)n; -} - -// var = 1/N Sum( (x[i] - mean)^2 ) -static double Variance(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double mean = Mean(vectorPtr); - double var = 0.0; - int count = 0; - for(double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->last; - vp <= vend; vp++) { - double dx = *vp - mean; - var += dx * dx; - count++; - } - - if (count < 2) - return 0.0; - - var /= (double)(count - 1); - return var; -} - -// skew = Sum( (x[i] - mean)^3 ) / (var^3/2) -static double Skew(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double mean = Mean(vectorPtr); - double var = 0; - double skew = 0; - int count = 0; - for(double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->last; - vp <= vend; vp++) { - double diff = *vp - mean; - diff = fabs(diff); - double diffsq = diff * diff; - var += diffsq; - skew += diffsq * diff; - count++; - } - - if (count < 2) - return 0.0; - - var /= (double)(count - 1); - skew /= count * var * sqrt(var); - return skew; -} - -static double StdDeviation(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - double var; - - var = Variance(vectorPtr); - if (var > 0.0) { - return sqrt(var); - } - return 0.0; -} - -static double AvgDeviation(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double mean = Mean(vectorPtr); - double avg = 0.0; - int count = 0; - for(double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->last; - vp <= vend; vp++) { - double diff = *vp - mean; - avg += fabs(diff); - count++; - } - - if (count < 2) - return 0.0; - - avg /= (double)count; - return avg; -} - -static double Kurtosis(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double mean = Mean(vectorPtr); - double var = 0; - double kurt = 0; - int count = 0; - for(double *vp=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->first, *vend=vPtr->valueArr+vPtr->last; - vp <= vend; vp++) { - double diff = *vp - mean; - double diffsq = diff * diff; - var += diffsq; - kurt += diffsq * diffsq; - count++; - } - - if (count < 2) - return 0.0; - - var /= (double)(count - 1); - - if (var == 0.0) - return 0.0; - - kurt /= (count * var * var); - return kurt - 3.0; /* Fisher Kurtosis */ -} - -static double Median(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - size_t *map; - double q2; - int mid; - - if (vPtr->length == 0) { - return -DBL_MAX; - } - map = Vec_SortMap(&vPtr, 1); - mid = (vPtr->length - 1) / 2; - - /* - * Determine Q2 by checking if the number of elements [0..n-1] is - * odd or even. If even, we must take the average of the two - * middle values. - */ - if (vPtr->length & 1) { /* Odd */ - q2 = vPtr->valueArr[map[mid]]; - } else { /* Even */ - q2 = (vPtr->valueArr[map[mid]] + - vPtr->valueArr[map[mid + 1]]) * 0.5; - } - free(map); - return q2; -} - -static double Q1(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double q1; - size_t *map; - - if (vPtr->length == 0) { - return -DBL_MAX; - } - map = Vec_SortMap(&vPtr, 1); - - if (vPtr->length < 4) { - q1 = vPtr->valueArr[map[0]]; - } else { - int mid, q; - - mid = (vPtr->length - 1) / 2; - q = mid / 2; - - /* - * Determine Q1 by checking if the number of elements in the - * bottom half [0..mid) is odd or even. If even, we must - * take the average of the two middle values. - */ - if (mid & 1) { /* Odd */ - q1 = vPtr->valueArr[map[q]]; - } else { /* Even */ - q1 = (vPtr->valueArr[map[q]] + - vPtr->valueArr[map[q + 1]]) * 0.5; - } - } - free(map); - return q1; -} - -static double Q3(Blt_Vector *vectorPtr) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vectorPtr; - double q3; - size_t *map; - - if (vPtr->length == 0) { - return -DBL_MAX; - } - - map = Vec_SortMap(&vPtr, 1); - - if (vPtr->length < 4) { - q3 = vPtr->valueArr[map[vPtr->length - 1]]; - } else { - int mid, q; - - mid = (vPtr->length - 1) / 2; - q = (vPtr->length + mid) / 2; - - /* - * Determine Q3 by checking if the number of elements in the - * upper half (mid..n-1] is odd or even. If even, we must - * take the average of the two middle values. - */ - if (mid & 1) { /* Odd */ - q3 = vPtr->valueArr[map[q]]; - } else { /* Even */ - q3 = (vPtr->valueArr[map[q]] + - vPtr->valueArr[map[q + 1]]) * 0.5; - } - } - free(map); - return q3; -} - -static int Norm(Blt_Vector *vector) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vector; - double norm, range, min, max; - int i; - - min = Vec_Min(vPtr); - max = Vec_Max(vPtr); - range = max - min; - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - norm = (vPtr->valueArr[i] - min) / range; - vPtr->valueArr[i] = norm; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static double Nonzeros(Blt_Vector *vector) -{ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vector; - int count; - double *vp, *vend; - - count = 0; - for(vp = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->first, vend = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->last; vp <= vend; vp++) { - if (*vp == 0.0) - count++; - } - return (double) count; -} - -static double Fabs(double value) -{ - if (value < 0.0) - return -value; - return value; -} - -static double Round(double value) -{ - if (value < 0.0) - return ceil(value - 0.5); - else - return floor(value + 0.5); -} - -static double Fmod(double x, double y) -{ - if (y == 0.0) - return 0.0; - return x - (floor(x / y) * y); -} - -/* - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * - * MathError -- - * - * This procedure is called when an error occurs during a - * floating-point operation. It reads errno and sets - * interp->result accordingly. - * - * Results: - * Interp->result is set to hold an error message. - * - * Side effects: - * None. - * - *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ -static void MathError(Tcl_Interp* interp, double value) -{ - if ((errno == EDOM) || (value != value)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "domain error: argument not in valid range", - (char *)NULL); - Tcl_SetErrorCode(interp, "ARITH", "DOMAIN", - Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), (char *)NULL); - } - else if ((errno == ERANGE) || isinf(value)) { - if (value == 0.0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "floating-point value too small to represent", - (char *)NULL); - Tcl_SetErrorCode(interp, "ARITH", "UNDERFLOW", - Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), (char *)NULL); - } - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "floating-point value too large to represent", - (char *)NULL); - Tcl_SetErrorCode(interp, "ARITH", "OVERFLOW", - Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), (char *)NULL); - } - } - else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown floating-point error, ", - "errno = ", Itoa(errno), (char *)NULL); - Tcl_SetErrorCode(interp, "ARITH", "UNKNOWN", - Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), (char *)NULL); - } -} - -static int ParseString(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, Value *valuePtr) -{ - const char *endPtr; - double value; - - errno = 0; - - /* - * The string can be either a number or a vector. First try to - * convert the string to a number. If that fails then see if - * we can find a vector by that name. - */ - - value = strtod(string, (char **)&endPtr); - if ((endPtr != string) && (*endPtr == '\0')) { - if (errno != 0) { - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - MathError(interp, value); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - /* Numbers are stored as single element vectors. */ - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, valuePtr->vPtr, 1) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - valuePtr->vPtr->valueArr[0] = value; - return TCL_OK; - } else { - Vector *vPtr; - - while (isspace((unsigned char)(*string))) { - string++; /* Skip spaces leading the vector name. */ - } - vPtr = Vec_ParseElement(interp, valuePtr->vPtr->dataPtr, - string, &endPtr, NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - if (vPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (*endPtr != '\0') { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "extra characters after vector", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - /* Copy the designated vector to our temporary. */ - Vec_Duplicate(valuePtr->vPtr, vPtr); - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ParseMathFunction(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *start, - ParseInfo *piPtr, Value *valuePtr) -{ - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - MathFunction *mathPtr; /* Info about math function. */ - char *p; - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - GenericMathProc *proc; - - /* - * Find the end of the math function's name and lookup the - * record for the function. - */ - p = (char *)start; - while (isspace((unsigned char)(*p))) { - p++; - } - piPtr->nextPtr = p; - while (isalnum((unsigned char)(*p)) || (*p == '_')) { - p++; - } - if (*p != '(') { - return TCL_RETURN; /* Must start with open parenthesis */ - } - dataPtr = valuePtr->vPtr->dataPtr; - *p = '\0'; - hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&dataPtr->mathProcTable, piPtr->nextPtr); - *p = '('; - if (hPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_RETURN; /* Name doesn't match any known function */ - } - /* Pick up the single value as the argument to the function */ - piPtr->token = OPEN_PAREN; - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 1; - valuePtr->pv.next = valuePtr->pv.buffer; - if (NextValue(interp, piPtr, -1, valuePtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; /* Parse error */ - } - if (piPtr->token != CLOSE_PAREN) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unmatched parentheses in expression \"", - piPtr->expr, "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; /* Missing right parenthesis */ - } - mathPtr = (MathFunction*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - proc = (GenericMathProc*)mathPtr->proc; - if ((*proc) (mathPtr->clientData, interp, valuePtr->vPtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; /* Function invocation error */ - } - piPtr->token = VALUE; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NextToken(Tcl_Interp* interp, ParseInfo *piPtr, Value *valuePtr) -{ - const char *p; - const char *endPtr; - const char *var; - int result; - - p = piPtr->nextPtr; - while (isspace((unsigned char)(*p))) { - p++; - } - if (*p == '\0') { - piPtr->token = END; - piPtr->nextPtr = p; - return TCL_OK; - } - /* - * Try to parse the token as a floating-point number. But check - * that the first character isn't a "-" or "+", which "strtod" - * will happily accept as an unary operator. Otherwise, we might - * accidently treat a binary operator as unary by mistake, which - * will eventually cause a syntax error. - */ - if ((*p != '-') && (*p != '+')) { - double value; - - errno = 0; - value = strtod(p, (char **)&endPtr); - if (endPtr != p) { - if (errno != 0) { - MathError(interp, value); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - piPtr->token = VALUE; - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - - /* - * Save the single floating-point value as an 1-component vector. - */ - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, valuePtr->vPtr, 1) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - valuePtr->vPtr->valueArr[0] = value; - return TCL_OK; - } - } - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 1; - switch (*p) { - case '$': - piPtr->token = VALUE; - var = Tcl_ParseVar(interp, p, &endPtr); - if (var == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - result = ParseString(interp, var, valuePtr); - return result; - - case '[': - piPtr->token = VALUE; - result = ParseNestedCmd(interp, p + 1, 0, &endPtr, &valuePtr->pv); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return result; - } - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - result = ParseString(interp, valuePtr->pv.buffer, valuePtr); - return result; - - case '"': - piPtr->token = VALUE; - result = ParseQuotes(interp, p + 1, '"', 0, &endPtr, &valuePtr->pv); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return result; - } - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - result = ParseString(interp, valuePtr->pv.buffer, valuePtr); - return result; - - case '{': - piPtr->token = VALUE; - result = ParseBraces(interp, p + 1, &endPtr, &valuePtr->pv); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return result; - } - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - Tcl_ResetResult(interp); - result = ParseString(interp, valuePtr->pv.buffer, valuePtr); - return result; - - case '(': - piPtr->token = OPEN_PAREN; - break; - - case ')': - piPtr->token = CLOSE_PAREN; - break; - - case ',': - piPtr->token = COMMA; - break; - - case '*': - piPtr->token = MULT; - break; - - case '/': - piPtr->token = DIVIDE; - break; - - case '%': - piPtr->token = MOD; - break; - - case '+': - piPtr->token = PLUS; - break; - - case '-': - piPtr->token = MINUS; - break; - - case '^': - piPtr->token = EXPONENT; - break; - - case '<': - switch (*(p + 1)) { - case '<': - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = LEFT_SHIFT; - break; - case '=': - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = LEQ; - break; - default: - piPtr->token = LESS; - break; - } - break; - - case '>': - switch (*(p + 1)) { - case '>': - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = RIGHT_SHIFT; - break; - case '=': - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = GEQ; - break; - default: - piPtr->token = GREATER; - break; - } - break; - - case '=': - if (*(p + 1) == '=') { - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = EQUAL; - } else { - piPtr->token = UNKNOWN; - } - break; - - case '&': - if (*(p + 1) == '&') { - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = AND; - } else { - piPtr->token = UNKNOWN; - } - break; - - case '|': - if (*(p + 1) == '|') { - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = OR; - } else { - piPtr->token = UNKNOWN; - } - break; - - case '!': - if (*(p + 1) == '=') { - piPtr->nextPtr = p + 2; - piPtr->token = NEQ; - } else { - piPtr->token = NOT; - } - break; - - default: - piPtr->token = VALUE; - result = ParseMathFunction(interp, p, piPtr, valuePtr); - if ((result == TCL_OK) || (result == TCL_ERROR)) { - return result; - } else { - Vector *vPtr; - - while (isspace((unsigned char)(*p))) { - p++; /* Skip spaces leading the vector name. */ - } - vPtr = Vec_ParseElement(interp, valuePtr->vPtr->dataPtr, - p, &endPtr, NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - if (vPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Vec_Duplicate(valuePtr->vPtr, vPtr); - piPtr->nextPtr = endPtr; - } - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int NextValue(Tcl_Interp* interp, ParseInfo *piPtr, - int prec, Value *valuePtr) -{ - Value value2; /* Second operand for current operator. */ - int oper; /* Current operator (either unary or binary). */ - int gotOp; /* Non-zero means already lexed the operator - * (while picking up value for unary operator). - * Don't lex again. */ - int result; - Vector *vPtr, *v2Ptr; - int i; - - /* - * There are two phases to this procedure. First, pick off an initial - * value. Then, parse (binary operator, value) pairs until done. - */ - - vPtr = valuePtr->vPtr; - v2Ptr = Vec_New(vPtr->dataPtr); - gotOp = 0; - value2.vPtr = v2Ptr; - value2.pv.buffer = value2.pv.next = value2.staticSpace; - value2.pv.end = value2.pv.buffer + STATIC_STRING_SPACE - 1; - value2.pv.expandProc = ExpandParseValue; - value2.pv.clientData = NULL; - - result = NextToken(interp, piPtr, valuePtr); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto done; - } - if (piPtr->token == OPEN_PAREN) { - - /* Parenthesized sub-expression. */ - - result = NextValue(interp, piPtr, -1, valuePtr); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto done; - } - if (piPtr->token != CLOSE_PAREN) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unmatched parentheses in expression \"", - piPtr->expr, "\"", (char *)NULL); - result = TCL_ERROR; - goto done; - } - } else { - if (piPtr->token == MINUS) { - piPtr->token = UNARY_MINUS; - } - if (piPtr->token >= UNARY_MINUS) { - oper = piPtr->token; - result = NextValue(interp, piPtr, precTable[oper], valuePtr); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto done; - } - gotOp = 1; - /* Process unary operators. */ - switch (oper) { - case UNARY_MINUS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - vPtr->valueArr[i] = -(vPtr->valueArr[i]); - } - break; - - case NOT: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - vPtr->valueArr[i] = (double)(!vPtr->valueArr[i]); - } - break; - default: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown operator", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } else if (piPtr->token != VALUE) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "missing operand", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - if (!gotOp) { - result = NextToken(interp, piPtr, &value2); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto done; - } - } - /* - * Got the first operand. Now fetch (operator, operand) pairs. - */ - for (;;) { - oper = piPtr->token; - - value2.pv.next = value2.pv.buffer; - if ((oper < MULT) || (oper >= UNARY_MINUS)) { - if ((oper == END) || (oper == CLOSE_PAREN) || - (oper == COMMA)) { - result = TCL_OK; - goto done; - } else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad operator", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - if (precTable[oper] <= prec) { - result = TCL_OK; - goto done; - } - result = NextValue(interp, piPtr, precTable[oper], &value2); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto done; - } - if ((piPtr->token < MULT) && (piPtr->token != VALUE) && - (piPtr->token != END) && (piPtr->token != CLOSE_PAREN) && - (piPtr->token != COMMA)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unexpected token in expression", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - /* - * At this point we have two vectors and an operator. - */ - - if (v2Ptr->length == 1) { - double *opnd; - double scalar; - - /* - * 2nd operand is a scalar. - */ - scalar = v2Ptr->valueArr[0]; - opnd = vPtr->valueArr; - switch (oper) { - case MULT: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] *= scalar; - } - break; - - case DIVIDE: - if (scalar == 0.0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "divide by zero", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] /= scalar; - } - break; - - case PLUS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] += scalar; - } - break; - - case MINUS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] -= scalar; - } - break; - - case EXPONENT: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = pow(opnd[i], scalar); - } - break; - - case MOD: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = Fmod(opnd[i], scalar); - } - break; - - case LESS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] < scalar); - } - break; - - case GREATER: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] > scalar); - } - break; - - case LEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] <= scalar); - } - break; - - case GEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] >= scalar); - } - break; - - case EQUAL: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] == scalar); - } - break; - - case NEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] != scalar); - } - break; - - case AND: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] && scalar); - } - break; - - case OR: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] || scalar); - } - break; - - case LEFT_SHIFT: - { - int offset; - - offset = (int)scalar % vPtr->length; - if (offset > 0) { - double *hold; - int j; - - hold = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * offset); - for (i = 0; i < offset; i++) { - hold[i] = opnd[i]; - } - for (i = offset, j = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - opnd[j] = opnd[i]; - } - for (i = 0, j = vPtr->length - offset; - j < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - opnd[j] = hold[i]; - } - free(hold); - } - } - break; - - case RIGHT_SHIFT: - { - int offset; - - offset = (int)scalar % vPtr->length; - if (offset > 0) { - double *hold; - int j; - - hold = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * offset); - for (i = vPtr->length - offset, j = 0; - i < vPtr->length; i++, j++) { - hold[j] = opnd[i]; - } - for (i = vPtr->length - offset - 1, - j = vPtr->length - 1; i >= 0; i--, j--) { - opnd[j] = opnd[i]; - } - for (i = 0; i < offset; i++) { - opnd[i] = hold[i]; - } - free(hold); - } - } - break; - - default: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown operator in expression", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - - } else if (vPtr->length == 1) { - double *opnd; - double scalar; - - /* - * 1st operand is a scalar. - */ - scalar = vPtr->valueArr[0]; - Vec_Duplicate(vPtr, v2Ptr); - opnd = vPtr->valueArr; - switch (oper) { - case MULT: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] *= scalar; - } - break; - - case PLUS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] += scalar; - } - break; - - case DIVIDE: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - if (opnd[i] == 0.0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "divide by zero", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - opnd[i] = (scalar / opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case MINUS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = scalar - opnd[i]; - } - break; - - case EXPONENT: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = pow(scalar, opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case MOD: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = Fmod(scalar, opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case LESS: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(scalar < opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case GREATER: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(scalar > opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case LEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(scalar >= opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case GEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(scalar <= opnd[i]); - } - break; - - case EQUAL: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] == scalar); - } - break; - - case NEQ: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] != scalar); - } - break; - - case AND: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] && scalar); - } - break; - - case OR: - for(i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd[i] = (double)(opnd[i] || scalar); - } - break; - - case LEFT_SHIFT: - case RIGHT_SHIFT: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "second shift operand must be scalar", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - - default: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown operator in expression", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } else { - double *opnd1, *opnd2; - /* - * Carry out the function of the specified operator. - */ - if (vPtr->length != v2Ptr->length) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "vectors are different lengths", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - opnd1 = vPtr->valueArr, opnd2 = v2Ptr->valueArr; - switch (oper) { - case MULT: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] *= opnd2[i]; - } - break; - - case DIVIDE: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - if (opnd2[i] == 0.0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "can't divide by 0.0 vector component", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - opnd1[i] /= opnd2[i]; - } - break; - - case PLUS: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] += opnd2[i]; - } - break; - - case MINUS: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] -= opnd2[i]; - } - break; - - case MOD: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = Fmod(opnd1[i], opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case EXPONENT: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = pow(opnd1[i], opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case LESS: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] < opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case GREATER: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] > opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case LEQ: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] <= opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case GEQ: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] >= opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case EQUAL: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] == opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case NEQ: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] != opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case AND: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] && opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case OR: - for (i = 0; i < vPtr->length; i++) { - opnd1[i] = (double)(opnd1[i] || opnd2[i]); - } - break; - - case LEFT_SHIFT: - case RIGHT_SHIFT: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "second shift operand must be scalar", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - - default: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unknown operator in expression", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - } - done: - if (value2.pv.buffer != value2.staticSpace) { - free(value2.pv.buffer); - } - Vec_Free(v2Ptr); - return result; - - error: - if (value2.pv.buffer != value2.staticSpace) { - free(value2.pv.buffer); - } - Vec_Free(v2Ptr); - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -static int EvaluateExpression(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *string, - Value *valuePtr) -{ - ParseInfo info; - int result; - Vector *vPtr; - double *vp, *vend; - - info.expr = info.nextPtr = string; - valuePtr->pv.buffer = valuePtr->pv.next = valuePtr->staticSpace; - valuePtr->pv.end = valuePtr->pv.buffer + STATIC_STRING_SPACE - 1; - valuePtr->pv.expandProc = ExpandParseValue; - valuePtr->pv.clientData = NULL; - - result = NextValue(interp, &info, -1, valuePtr); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return result; - } - if (info.token != END) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, ": syntax error in expression \"", - string, "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr = valuePtr->vPtr; - - /* Check for NaN's and overflows. */ - for (vp = vPtr->valueArr, vend = vp + vPtr->length; vp < vend; vp++) { - if (!isfinite(*vp)) { - /* - * IEEE floating-point error. - */ - MathError(interp, *vp); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ComponentFunc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - Vector *vPtr) -{ - ComponentProc *procPtr = (ComponentProc *) clientData; - double *vp, *vend; - - errno = 0; - for(vp = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->first, - vend = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->last; vp <= vend; vp++) { - *vp = (*procPtr) (*vp); - if (errno != 0) { - MathError(interp, *vp); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (!isfinite(*vp)) { - /* - * IEEE floating-point error. - */ - MathError(interp, *vp); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int ScalarFunc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr) -{ - double value; - ScalarProc *procPtr = (ScalarProc *) clientData; - - errno = 0; - value = (*procPtr) (vPtr); - if (errno != 0) { - MathError(interp, value); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, 1) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->valueArr[0] = value; - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int VectorFunc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector *vPtr) -{ - VectorProc *procPtr = (VectorProc *) clientData; - - return (*procPtr) (vPtr); -} - - -static MathFunction mathFunctions[] = - { - {"abs", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)Fabs}, - {"acos", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))acos}, - {"asin", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))asin}, - {"atan", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))atan}, - {"adev", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)AvgDeviation}, - {"ceil", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))ceil}, - {"cos", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))cos}, - {"cosh", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))cosh}, - {"exp", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))exp}, - {"floor", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))floor}, - {"kurtosis",(void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Kurtosis}, - {"length", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Length}, - {"log", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))log}, - {"log10", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))log10}, - {"max", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Blt_VecMax}, - {"mean", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Mean}, - {"median", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Median}, - {"min", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Blt_VecMin}, - {"norm", (void*)VectorFunc, (ClientData)Norm}, - {"nz", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Nonzeros}, - {"q1", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Q1}, - {"q3", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Q3}, - {"prod", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Product}, - {"random", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)drand48}, - {"round", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)Round}, - {"sdev", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)StdDeviation}, - {"sin", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))sin}, - {"sinh", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))sinh}, - {"skew", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Skew}, - {"sort", (void*)VectorFunc, (ClientData)Sort}, - {"sqrt", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))sqrt}, - {"sum", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Sum}, - {"tan", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))tan}, - {"tanh", (void*)ComponentFunc, (ClientData)(double (*)(double))tanh}, - {"var", (void*)ScalarFunc, (ClientData)Variance}, - {(char *)NULL,}, - }; - -void Blt::Vec_InstallMathFunctions(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr) -{ - MathFunction *mathPtr; - - for (mathPtr = mathFunctions; mathPtr->name != NULL; mathPtr++) { - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - int isNew; - - hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(tablePtr, mathPtr->name, &isNew); - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, (ClientData)mathPtr); - } -} - -void Blt::Vec_UninstallMathFunctions(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr) -{ - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - - for (hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(tablePtr, &cursor); hPtr != NULL; - hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - MathFunction *mathPtr = (MathFunction*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - if (mathPtr->name == NULL) - free(mathPtr); - } -} - -static void InstallIndexProc(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr, const char *string, - Blt_VectorIndexProc *procPtr) -{ - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - int dummy; - - hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(tablePtr, string, &dummy); - if (procPtr == NULL) - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hPtr); - else - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, (ClientData)procPtr); -} - -void Blt::Vec_InstallSpecialIndices(Tcl_HashTable *tablePtr) -{ - InstallIndexProc(tablePtr, "min", Blt_VecMin); - InstallIndexProc(tablePtr, "max", Blt_VecMax); - InstallIndexProc(tablePtr, "mean", Mean); - InstallIndexProc(tablePtr, "sum", Sum); - InstallIndexProc(tablePtr, "prod", Product); -} - -int Blt::ExprVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *string, Blt_Vector *vector) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Vector *vPtr = (Vector *)vector; - Value value; - - dataPtr = (vector != NULL) ? vPtr->dataPtr : Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - value.vPtr = Vec_New(dataPtr); - if (EvaluateExpression(interp, string, &value) != TCL_OK) { - Vec_Free(value.vPtr); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (vPtr != NULL) { - Vec_Duplicate(vPtr, value.vPtr); - } else { - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr; - double *vp, *vend; - - /* No result vector. Put values in interp->result. */ - listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **) NULL); - for (vp = value.vPtr->valueArr, vend = vp + value.vPtr->length; - vp < vend; vp++) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, Tcl_NewDoubleObj(*vp)); - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - } - Vec_Free(value.vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -#ifdef _WIN32 -double drand48(void) -{ - return (double)rand() / (double)RAND_MAX; -} - -void srand48(long int seed) -{ - srand(seed); -} -#endif diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecOp.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecOp.C deleted file mode 100644 index 6c84723..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVecOp.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,56 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1991-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#include - -#include "tkbltVecInt.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -extern Tcl_ObjCmdProc VectorObjCmd; - -int Blt_VectorCmdInitProc(Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - - Tcl_Namespace* nsPtr = Tcl_FindNamespace(interp, "::blt", NULL, - TCL_LEAVE_ERR_MSG); - if (nsPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - const char* cmdPath = "::blt::vector"; - Tcl_Command cmdToken = Tcl_FindCommand(interp, cmdPath, NULL, 0); - if (cmdToken) - return TCL_OK; - cmdToken = Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, cmdPath, VectorObjCmd, - Vec_GetInterpData(interp), NULL); - if (Tcl_Export(interp, nsPtr, "vector", 0) != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - return TCL_OK; -} diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.C b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.C deleted file mode 100644 index 0837917..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.C +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1875 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1995-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining - * a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the - * "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including - * without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, - * distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to - * permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to - * the following conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, - * EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF - * MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND - * NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE - * LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION - * OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION - * WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -/* - * TODO: - * o Add H. Kirsch's vector binary read operation - * x binread file0 - * x binread -file file0 - * - * o Add ASCII/binary file reader - * x read fileName - * - * o Allow Tcl-based client notifications. - * vector x - * x notify call Display - * x notify delete Display - * x notify reorder #1 #2 - */ - -#include -#include -#include -#include -#include -#include - -#include - -#include "tkbltInt.h" -#include "tkbltVecInt.h" -#include "tkbltNsUtil.h" -#include "tkbltSwitch.h" -#include "tkbltOp.h" - -using namespace Blt; - -#define DEF_ARRAY_SIZE 64 -#define TRACE_ALL (TCL_TRACE_WRITES | TCL_TRACE_READS | TCL_TRACE_UNSETS) - - -#define VECTOR_CHAR(c) ((isalnum((unsigned char)(c))) || \ - (c == '_') || (c == ':') || (c == '@') || (c == '.')) - -/* - * VectorClient -- - * - * A vector can be shared by several clients. Each client allocates this - * structure that acts as its key for using the vector. Clients can also - * designate a callback routine that is executed whenever the vector is - * updated or destroyed. - * - */ -typedef struct { - unsigned int magic; /* Magic value designating whether this really - * is a vector token or not */ - Vector* serverPtr; /* Pointer to the master record of the vector. - * If NULL, indicates that the vector has been - * destroyed but as of yet, this client hasn't - * recognized it. */ - Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc;/* Routine to call when the contents of the - * vector change or the vector is deleted. */ - ClientData clientData; /* Data passed whenever the vector change - * procedure is called. */ - ChainLink* link; /* Used to quickly remove this entry from its - * server's client chain. */ -} VectorClient; - -static Tcl_CmdDeleteProc VectorInstDeleteProc; -extern Tcl_ObjCmdProc VectorObjCmd; -static Tcl_InterpDeleteProc VectorInterpDeleteProc; - -typedef struct { - char *varName; /* Requested variable name. */ - char *cmdName; /* Requested command name. */ - int flush; /* Flush */ - int watchUnset; /* Watch when variable is unset. */ -} CreateSwitches; - -static Blt_SwitchSpec createSwitches[] = - { - {BLT_SWITCH_STRING, "-variable", "varName", - Tk_Offset(CreateSwitches, varName), BLT_SWITCH_NULL_OK}, - {BLT_SWITCH_STRING, "-command", "command", - Tk_Offset(CreateSwitches, cmdName), BLT_SWITCH_NULL_OK}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BOOLEAN, "-watchunset", "bool", - Tk_Offset(CreateSwitches, watchUnset), 0}, - {BLT_SWITCH_BOOLEAN, "-flush", "bool", - Tk_Offset(CreateSwitches, flush), 0}, - {BLT_SWITCH_END} - }; - -typedef int (VectorCmdProc)(Vector* vecObjPtr, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]); - -static char stringRep[200]; - -const char *Blt::Itoa(int value) -{ - snprintf(stringRep, 200, "%d", value); - return stringRep; -} - -static char* Blt_Strdup(const char *string) -{ - size_t size = strlen(string) + 1; - char* ptr = (char*)malloc(size * sizeof(char)); - if (ptr != NULL) - strcpy(ptr, string); - - return ptr; -} - -static Vector* FindVectorInNamespace(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, - Blt_ObjectName *objNamePtr) -{ - Tcl_DString dString; - const char* name = MakeQualifiedName(objNamePtr, &dString); - Tcl_HashEntry* hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, name); - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - if (hPtr != NULL) - return (Vector*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - - return NULL; -} - -static Vector* GetVectorObject(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, const char *name, - int flags) -{ - Tcl_Interp* interp = dataPtr->interp; - Blt_ObjectName objName; - if (!ParseObjectName(interp, name, &objName, BLT_NO_ERROR_MSG | BLT_NO_DEFAULT_NS)) - return NULL; - - Vector* vPtr = NULL; - if (objName.nsPtr != NULL) - vPtr = FindVectorInNamespace(dataPtr, &objName); - else { - if (flags & NS_SEARCH_CURRENT) { - objName.nsPtr = Tcl_GetCurrentNamespace(interp); - vPtr = FindVectorInNamespace(dataPtr, &objName); - } - if ((vPtr == NULL) && (flags & NS_SEARCH_GLOBAL)) { - objName.nsPtr = Tcl_GetGlobalNamespace(interp); - vPtr = FindVectorInNamespace(dataPtr, &objName); - } - } - - return vPtr; -} - -void Blt::Vec_UpdateRange(Vector* vPtr) -{ - double* vp = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->first; - double* vend = vPtr->valueArr + vPtr->last; - double min = *vp; - double max = *vp++; - for (/* empty */; vp <= vend; vp++) { - if (min > *vp) - min = *vp; - else if (max < *vp) - max = *vp; - } - vPtr->min = min; - vPtr->max = max; - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~UPDATE_RANGE; -} - -int Blt::Vec_GetIndex(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, const char *string, - int *indexPtr, int flags, Blt_VectorIndexProc **procPtrPtr) -{ - int value; - char c = string[0]; - - // Treat the index "end" like a numeric index - if ((c == 'e') && (strcmp(string, "end") == 0)) { - if (vPtr->length < 1) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad index \"end\": vector is empty", - (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *indexPtr = vPtr->length - 1; - return TCL_OK; - } else if ((c == '+') && (strcmp(string, "++end") == 0)) { - *indexPtr = vPtr->length; - return TCL_OK; - } - if (procPtrPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - - hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&vPtr->dataPtr->indexProcTable, string); - if (hPtr != NULL) { - *indexPtr = SPECIAL_INDEX; - *procPtrPtr = (Blt_VectorIndexProc*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - return TCL_OK; - } - } - if (Tcl_GetInt(interp, (char *)string, &value) != TCL_OK) { - long int lvalue; - /* - * Unlike Tcl_GetInt, Tcl_ExprLong needs a valid interpreter, but the - * interp passed in may be NULL. So we have to use vPtr->interp and - * then reset the result. - */ - if (Tcl_ExprLong(vPtr->interp, (char *)string, &lvalue) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_ResetResult(vPtr->interp); - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad index \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - value = (int)lvalue; - } - /* - * Correct the index by the current value of the offset. This makes all - * the numeric indices non-negative, which is how we distinguish the - * special non-numeric indices. - */ - value -= vPtr->offset; - - if ((value < 0) || ((flags & INDEX_CHECK) && (value >= vPtr->length))) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "index \"", string, "\" is out of range", - (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - *indexPtr = (int)value; - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt::Vec_GetIndexRange(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, const char *string, - int flags, Blt_VectorIndexProc** procPtrPtr) -{ - int ielem; - char* colon = NULL; - if (flags & INDEX_COLON) - colon = (char*)strchr(string, ':'); - - if (colon != NULL) { - if (string == colon) { - vPtr->first = 0; /* Default to the first index */ - } - else { - int result; - - *colon = '\0'; - result = Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, string, &ielem, flags, - (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL); - *colon = ':'; - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->first = ielem; - } - if (*(colon + 1) == '\0') { - /* Default to the last index */ - vPtr->last = (vPtr->length > 0) ? vPtr->length - 1 : 0; - } else { - if (Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, colon + 1, &ielem, flags, - (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->last = ielem; - } - if (vPtr->first > vPtr->last) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad range \"", string, - "\" (first > last)", (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } else { - if (Vec_GetIndex(interp, vPtr, string, &ielem, flags, - procPtrPtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->last = vPtr->first = ielem; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -Vector* Blt::Vec_ParseElement(Tcl_Interp* interp, VectorInterpData *dataPtr, - const char* start, const char** endPtr, int flags) -{ - char* p = (char*)start; - // Find the end of the vector name - while (VECTOR_CHAR(*p)) { - p++; - } - char saved = *p; - *p = '\0'; - - Vector* vPtr = GetVectorObject(dataPtr, start, flags); - if (vPtr == NULL) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't find vector \"", start, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - } - *p = saved; - return NULL; - } - *p = saved; - vPtr->first = 0; - vPtr->last = vPtr->length - 1; - if (*p == '(') { - int count, result; - - start = p + 1; - p++; - - /* Find the matching right parenthesis */ - count = 1; - while (*p != '\0') { - if (*p == ')') { - count--; - if (count == 0) { - break; - } - } else if (*p == '(') { - count++; - } - p++; - } - if (count > 0) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "unbalanced parentheses \"", start, - "\"", (char *)NULL); - } - return NULL; - } - *p = '\0'; - result = Vec_GetIndexRange(interp, vPtr, start, (INDEX_COLON | INDEX_CHECK), (Blt_VectorIndexProc **) NULL); - *p = ')'; - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return NULL; - } - p++; - } - if (endPtr != NULL) { - *endPtr = p; - } - return vPtr; -} - -void Blt_Vec_NotifyClients(ClientData clientData) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)clientData; - ChainLink *link, *next; - Blt_VectorNotify notify; - - notify = (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_DESTROYED) - ? BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY : BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_UPDATE; - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~(NOTIFY_UPDATED | NOTIFY_DESTROYED | NOTIFY_PENDING); - for (link = Chain_FirstLink(vPtr->chain); link; link = next) { - next = Chain_NextLink(link); - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient*)Chain_GetValue(link); - if ((clientPtr->proc != NULL) && (clientPtr->serverPtr != NULL)) { - (*clientPtr->proc) (vPtr->interp, clientPtr->clientData, notify); - } - } - - // Some clients may not handle the "destroy" callback properly (they - // should call Blt_FreeVectorId to release the client identifier), so mark - // any remaining clients to indicate that vector's server has gone away. - if (notify == BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY) { - for (link = Chain_FirstLink(vPtr->chain); link; - link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient*)Chain_GetValue(link); - clientPtr->serverPtr = NULL; - } - } -} - -void Blt::Vec_UpdateClients(Vector* vPtr) -{ - vPtr->dirty++; - vPtr->max = vPtr->min = NAN; - if (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_NEVER) { - return; - } - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_UPDATED; - if (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_ALWAYS) { - Blt_Vec_NotifyClients(vPtr); - return; - } - if (!(vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_PENDING)) { - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_PENDING; - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(Blt_Vec_NotifyClients, vPtr); - } -} - -void Blt::Vec_FlushCache(Vector* vPtr) -{ - Tcl_Interp* interp = vPtr->interp; - - if (vPtr->arrayName == NULL) - return; - - /* Turn off the trace temporarily so that we can unset all the - * elements in the array. */ - - Tcl_UntraceVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, (char *)NULL, - TRACE_ALL | vPtr->varFlags, Vec_VarTrace, vPtr); - - /* Clear all the element entries from the entire array */ - Tcl_UnsetVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, (char *)NULL, vPtr->varFlags); - - /* Restore the "end" index by default and the trace on the entire array */ - Tcl_SetVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, "end", "", vPtr->varFlags); - Tcl_TraceVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, (char *)NULL, - TRACE_ALL | vPtr->varFlags, Vec_VarTrace, vPtr); -} - -int Blt::Vec_LookupName(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, const char *vecName, - Vector** vPtrPtr) -{ - - const char *endPtr; - Vector* vPtr = Vec_ParseElement(dataPtr->interp, dataPtr, vecName, &endPtr, NS_SEARCH_BOTH); - if (vPtr == NULL) - return TCL_ERROR; - - if (*endPtr != '\0') { - Tcl_AppendResult(dataPtr->interp, - "extra characters after vector name", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - *vPtrPtr = vPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -double Blt::Vec_Min(Vector* vecObjPtr) -{ - double* vp = vecObjPtr->valueArr + vecObjPtr->first; - double* vend = vecObjPtr->valueArr + vecObjPtr->last; - double min = *vp++; - for (/* empty */; vp <= vend; vp++) { - if (min > *vp) - min = *vp; - } - vecObjPtr->min = min; - return vecObjPtr->min; -} - -double Blt::Vec_Max(Vector* vecObjPtr) -{ - double max = NAN; - double* vp = vecObjPtr->valueArr + vecObjPtr->first; - double* vend = vecObjPtr->valueArr + vecObjPtr->last; - max = *vp++; - for (/* empty */; vp <= vend; vp++) { - if (max < *vp) - max = *vp; - } - vecObjPtr->max = max; - return vecObjPtr->max; -} - -static void DeleteCommand(Vector* vPtr) -{ - Tcl_Interp* interp = vPtr->interp; - char *qualName; - Tcl_CmdInfo cmdInfo; - Tcl_DString dString; - Blt_ObjectName objName; - - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString); - objName.name = Tcl_GetCommandName(interp, vPtr->cmdToken); - objName.nsPtr = GetCommandNamespace(vPtr->cmdToken); - qualName = MakeQualifiedName(&objName, &dString); - if (Tcl_GetCommandInfo(interp, qualName, &cmdInfo)) { - // Disable the callback before deleting the TCL command - cmdInfo.deleteProc = NULL; - Tcl_SetCommandInfo(interp, qualName, &cmdInfo); - Tcl_DeleteCommandFromToken(interp, vPtr->cmdToken); - } - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - vPtr->cmdToken = 0; -} - -static void UnmapVariable(Vector* vPtr) -{ - Tcl_Interp* interp = vPtr->interp; - - // Unset the entire array - Tcl_UntraceVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, (char *)NULL, - (TRACE_ALL | vPtr->varFlags), Vec_VarTrace, vPtr); - Tcl_UnsetVar2(interp, vPtr->arrayName, (char *)NULL, vPtr->varFlags); - - if (vPtr->arrayName != NULL) { - free((void*)(vPtr->arrayName)); - vPtr->arrayName = NULL; - } -} - -int Blt::Vec_MapVariable(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, const char *path) -{ - Blt_ObjectName objName; - char *newPath; - const char *result; - Tcl_DString dString; - - if (vPtr->arrayName != NULL) { - UnmapVariable(vPtr); - } - if ((path == NULL) || (path[0] == '\0')) { - return TCL_OK; /* If the variable pathname is the empty - * string, simply return after removing any - * existing variable. */ - } - /* Get the variable name (without the namespace qualifier). */ - if (!ParseObjectName(interp, path, &objName, BLT_NO_DEFAULT_NS)) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (objName.nsPtr == NULL) { - /* - * If there was no namespace qualifier, try harder to see if the - * variable is non-local. - */ - objName.nsPtr = GetVariableNamespace(interp, objName.name); - } - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString); - vPtr->varFlags = 0; - if (objName.nsPtr != NULL) { /* Global or namespace variable. */ - newPath = MakeQualifiedName(&objName, &dString); - vPtr->varFlags |= (TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); - } else { /* Local variable. */ - newPath = (char *)objName.name; - } - - /* - * To play it safe, delete the variable first. This has the benefical - * side-effect of unmapping the variable from another vector that may be - * currently associated with it. - */ - Tcl_UnsetVar2(interp, newPath, (char *)NULL, 0); - - /* - * Set the index "end" in the array. This will create the variable - * immediately so that we can check its namespace context. - */ - result = Tcl_SetVar2(interp, newPath, "end", "", TCL_LEAVE_ERR_MSG); - if (result == NULL) { - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - /* Create a full-array trace on reads, writes, and unsets. */ - Tcl_TraceVar2(interp, newPath, (char *)NULL, TRACE_ALL, Vec_VarTrace, - vPtr); - vPtr->arrayName = Blt_Strdup(newPath); - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt::Vec_SetSize(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, int newSize) -{ - if (newSize <= 0) { - newSize = DEF_ARRAY_SIZE; - } - if (newSize == vPtr->size) { - /* Same size, use the current array. */ - return TCL_OK; - } - if (vPtr->freeProc == TCL_DYNAMIC) { - /* Old memory was dynamically allocated, so use realloc. */ - double* newArr = (double*)realloc(vPtr->valueArr, newSize * sizeof(double)); - if (newArr == NULL) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't reallocate ", - Itoa(newSize), " elements for vector \"", - vPtr->name, "\"", (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - vPtr->size = newSize; - vPtr->valueArr = newArr; - return TCL_OK; - } - - { - /* Old memory was created specially (static or special allocator). - * Replace with dynamically allocated memory (malloc-ed). */ - - double* newArr = (double*)calloc(newSize, sizeof(double)); - if (newArr == NULL) { - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't allocate ", - Itoa(newSize), " elements for vector \"", - vPtr->name, "\"", (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - { - int used, wanted; - - /* Copy the contents of the old memory into the new. */ - used = vPtr->length; - wanted = newSize; - - if (used > wanted) { - used = wanted; - } - /* Copy any previous data */ - if (used > 0) { - memcpy(newArr, vPtr->valueArr, used * sizeof(double)); - } - } - - /* - * We're not using the old storage anymore, so free it if it's not - * TCL_STATIC. It's static because the user previously reset the - * vector with a statically allocated array (setting freeProc to - * TCL_STATIC). - */ - if (vPtr->freeProc != TCL_STATIC) { - if (vPtr->freeProc == TCL_DYNAMIC) { - free(vPtr->valueArr); - } else { - (*vPtr->freeProc) ((char *)vPtr->valueArr); - } - } - vPtr->freeProc = TCL_DYNAMIC; /* Set the type of the new storage */ - vPtr->valueArr = newArr; - vPtr->size = newSize; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt::Vec_SetLength(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, int newLength) -{ - if (vPtr->size < newLength) { - if (Vec_SetSize(interp, vPtr, newLength) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - vPtr->length = newLength; - vPtr->first = 0; - vPtr->last = newLength - 1; - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt::Vec_ChangeLength(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* vPtr, int newLength) -{ - if (newLength < 0) { - newLength = 0; - } - if (newLength > vPtr->size) { - int newSize; /* Size of array in elements */ - - /* Compute the new size of the array. It's a multiple of - * DEF_ARRAY_SIZE. */ - newSize = DEF_ARRAY_SIZE; - while (newSize < newLength) { - newSize += newSize; - } - if (newSize != vPtr->size) { - if (Vec_SetSize(interp, vPtr, newSize) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - } - vPtr->length = newLength; - vPtr->first = 0; - vPtr->last = newLength - 1; - return TCL_OK; - -} - -int Blt::Vec_Reset(Vector* vPtr, double *valueArr, int length, - int size, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc) -{ - if (vPtr->valueArr != valueArr) { /* New array of values resides - * in different memory than - * the current vector. */ - if ((valueArr == NULL) || (size == 0)) { - /* Empty array. Set up default values */ - valueArr = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * DEF_ARRAY_SIZE); - size = DEF_ARRAY_SIZE; - if (valueArr == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "can't allocate ", - Itoa(size), " elements for vector \"", - vPtr->name, "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - freeProc = TCL_DYNAMIC; - length = 0; - } - else if (freeProc == TCL_VOLATILE) { - /* Data is volatile. Make a copy of the value array. */ - double* newArr = (double*)malloc(size * sizeof(double)); - if (newArr == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "can't allocate ", - Itoa(size), " elements for vector \"", - vPtr->name, "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - memcpy((char *)newArr, (char *)valueArr, - sizeof(double) * length); - valueArr = newArr; - freeProc = TCL_DYNAMIC; - } - - if (vPtr->freeProc != TCL_STATIC) { - /* Old data was dynamically allocated. Free it before attaching - * new data. */ - if (vPtr->freeProc == TCL_DYNAMIC) { - free(vPtr->valueArr); - } else { - (*freeProc) ((char *)vPtr->valueArr); - } - } - vPtr->freeProc = freeProc; - vPtr->valueArr = valueArr; - vPtr->size = size; - } - - vPtr->length = length; - if (vPtr->flush) { - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - } - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -Vector* Blt::Vec_New(VectorInterpData *dataPtr) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)calloc(1, sizeof(Vector)); - vPtr->valueArr = (double*)malloc(sizeof(double) * DEF_ARRAY_SIZE); - if (vPtr->valueArr == NULL) { - free(vPtr); - return NULL; - } - vPtr->size = DEF_ARRAY_SIZE; - vPtr->freeProc = TCL_DYNAMIC; - vPtr->length = 0; - vPtr->interp = dataPtr->interp; - vPtr->hashPtr = NULL; - vPtr->chain = new Chain(); - vPtr->flush = 0; - vPtr->min = vPtr->max = NAN; - vPtr->notifyFlags = NOTIFY_WHENIDLE; - vPtr->dataPtr = dataPtr; - return vPtr; -} - -void Blt::Vec_Free(Vector* vPtr) -{ - ChainLink* link; - - if (vPtr->cmdToken != 0) { - DeleteCommand(vPtr); - } - if (vPtr->arrayName != NULL) { - UnmapVariable(vPtr); - } - vPtr->length = 0; - - /* Immediately notify clients that vector is going away */ - if (vPtr->notifyFlags & NOTIFY_PENDING) { - vPtr->notifyFlags &= ~NOTIFY_PENDING; - Tcl_CancelIdleCall(Blt_Vec_NotifyClients, vPtr); - } - vPtr->notifyFlags |= NOTIFY_DESTROYED; - Blt_Vec_NotifyClients(vPtr); - - for (link = Chain_FirstLink(vPtr->chain); link; link = Chain_NextLink(link)) { - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient*)Chain_GetValue(link); - free(clientPtr); - } - delete vPtr->chain; - if ((vPtr->valueArr != NULL) && (vPtr->freeProc != TCL_STATIC)) { - if (vPtr->freeProc == TCL_DYNAMIC) { - free(vPtr->valueArr); - } else { - (*vPtr->freeProc) ((char *)vPtr->valueArr); - } - } - if (vPtr->hashPtr != NULL) { - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(vPtr->hashPtr); - } -#ifdef NAMESPACE_DELETE_NOTIFY - if (vPtr->nsPtr != NULL) { - Blt_DestroyNsDeleteNotify(vPtr->interp, vPtr->nsPtr, vPtr); - } -#endif /* NAMESPACE_DELETE_NOTIFY */ - free(vPtr); -} - -static void VectorInstDeleteProc(ClientData clientData) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)clientData; - vPtr->cmdToken = 0; - Vec_Free(vPtr); -} - -Vector* Blt::Vec_Create(VectorInterpData *dataPtr, const char *vecName, - const char *cmdName, const char *varName, int *isNewPtr) -{ - Tcl_DString dString; - Blt_ObjectName objName; - char *qualName; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - Tcl_Interp* interp = dataPtr->interp; - - int isNew = 0; - Vector* vPtr = NULL; - - if (!ParseObjectName(interp, vecName, &objName, 0)) - return NULL; - - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString); - if ((objName.name[0] == '#') && (strcmp(objName.name, "#auto") == 0)) { - - do { /* Generate a unique vector name. */ - char string[200]; - - snprintf(string, 200, "vector%d", dataPtr->nextId++); - objName.name = string; - qualName = MakeQualifiedName(&objName, &dString); - hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, qualName); - } while (hPtr != NULL); - } else { - const char *p; - - for (p = objName.name; *p != '\0'; p++) { - if (!VECTOR_CHAR(*p)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector name \"", objName.name, - "\": must contain digits, letters, underscore, or period", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - qualName = MakeQualifiedName(&objName, &dString); - vPtr = Vec_ParseElement((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, dataPtr, qualName, - NULL, NS_SEARCH_CURRENT); - } - if (vPtr == NULL) { - hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, qualName, &isNew); - vPtr = Vec_New(dataPtr); - vPtr->hashPtr = hPtr; - vPtr->nsPtr = objName.nsPtr; - - vPtr->name = (const char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&dataPtr->vectorTable, hPtr); -#ifdef NAMESPACE_DELETE_NOTIFY - Blt_CreateNsDeleteNotify(interp, objName.nsPtr, vPtr, - VectorInstDeleteProc); -#endif /* NAMESPACE_DELETE_NOTIFY */ - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, vPtr); - } - if (cmdName != NULL) { - Tcl_CmdInfo cmdInfo; - - if ((cmdName == vecName) || - ((cmdName[0] == '#') && (strcmp(cmdName, "#auto")==0))) { - cmdName = qualName; - } - if (Tcl_GetCommandInfo(interp, (char *)cmdName, &cmdInfo)) { - if (vPtr != cmdInfo.objClientData) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "command \"", cmdName, - "\" already exists", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - /* We get here only if the old name is the same as the new. */ - goto checkVariable; - } - } - if (vPtr->cmdToken != 0) { - DeleteCommand(vPtr); /* Command already exists, delete old first */ - } - if (cmdName != NULL) { - Tcl_DString dString2; - - Tcl_DStringInit(&dString2); - if (cmdName != qualName) { - if (!ParseObjectName(interp, cmdName, &objName, 0)) { - goto error; - } - cmdName = MakeQualifiedName(&objName, &dString2); - } - vPtr->cmdToken = Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, (char *)cmdName, Vec_InstCmd, - vPtr, VectorInstDeleteProc); - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString2); - } - checkVariable: - if (varName != NULL) { - if ((varName[0] == '#') && (strcmp(varName, "#auto") == 0)) { - varName = qualName; - } - if (Vec_MapVariable(interp, vPtr, varName) != TCL_OK) { - goto error; - } - } - - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - *isNewPtr = isNew; - return vPtr; - - error: - Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - if (vPtr != NULL) { - Vec_Free(vPtr); - } - return NULL; -} - -int Blt::Vec_Duplicate(Vector* destPtr, Vector* srcPtr) -{ - size_t nBytes; - size_t length; - - if (destPtr == srcPtr) { - /* Copying the same vector. */ - } - length = srcPtr->last - srcPtr->first + 1; - if (Vec_ChangeLength(destPtr->interp, destPtr, length) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - nBytes = length * sizeof(double); - memcpy(destPtr->valueArr, srcPtr->valueArr + srcPtr->first, nBytes); - destPtr->offset = srcPtr->offset; - return TCL_OK; -} - - -static int VectorNamesOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - VectorInterpData* dataPtr = (VectorInterpData*)clientData; - Tcl_Obj *listObjPtr; - - listObjPtr = Tcl_NewListObj(0, (Tcl_Obj **) NULL); - if (objc == 2) { - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - - for (hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, &cursor); - hPtr != NULL; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - char *name = (char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&dataPtr->vectorTable, hPtr); - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(name, -1)); - } - } else { - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - - for (hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, &cursor); - hPtr != NULL; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - char *name = (char*)Tcl_GetHashKey(&dataPtr->vectorTable, hPtr); - int i; - for (i = 2; i < objc; i++) { - char *pattern; - - pattern = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - if (Tcl_StringMatch(name, pattern)) { - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, listObjPtr, - Tcl_NewStringObj(name, -1)); - break; - } - } - } - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, listObjPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -static int VectorCreate2(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int argStart, int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr = (VectorInterpData*)clientData; - Vector* vPtr; - int count, i; - CreateSwitches switches; - - // Handle switches to the vector command and collect the vector name - // arguments into an array. - count = 0; - vPtr = NULL; - for (i = argStart; i < objc; i++) { - char *string; - - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i]); - if (string[0] == '-') { - break; - } - } - count = i - argStart; - if (count == 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "no vector names supplied", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - memset(&switches, 0, sizeof(switches)); - if (ParseSwitches(interp, createSwitches, objc - i, objv + i, - &switches, BLT_SWITCH_DEFAULTS) < 0) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (count > 1) { - if (switches.cmdName != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "can't specify more than one vector with \"-command\" switch", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - if (switches.varName != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "can't specify more than one vector with \"-variable\" switch", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - for (i = 0; i < count; i++) { - char *leftParen, *rightParen; - char *string; - int isNew; - int size, first, last; - - size = first = last = 0; - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[i + argStart]); - leftParen = strchr(string, '('); - rightParen = strchr(string, ')'); - if (((leftParen != NULL) && (rightParen == NULL)) || - ((leftParen == NULL) && (rightParen != NULL)) || - (leftParen > rightParen)) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector specification \"", string, - "\"", (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - if (leftParen != NULL) { - int result; - char *colon; - - *rightParen = '\0'; - colon = strchr(leftParen + 1, ':'); - if (colon != NULL) { - - /* Specification is in the form vecName(first:last) */ - *colon = '\0'; - result = Tcl_GetInt(interp, leftParen + 1, &first); - if ((*(colon + 1) != '\0') && (result == TCL_OK)) { - result = Tcl_GetInt(interp, colon + 1, &last); - if (first > last) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector range \"", - string, "\"", (char *)NULL); - result = TCL_ERROR; - } - size = (last - first) + 1; - } - *colon = ':'; - } else { - /* Specification is in the form vecName(size) */ - result = Tcl_GetInt(interp, leftParen + 1, &size); - } - *rightParen = ')'; - if (result != TCL_OK) { - goto error; - } - if (size < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector size \"", string, "\"", - (char *)NULL); - goto error; - } - } - if (leftParen != NULL) { - *leftParen = '\0'; - } - /* - * By default, we create a TCL command by the name of the vector. - */ - vPtr = Vec_Create(dataPtr, string, - (switches.cmdName == NULL) ? string : switches.cmdName, - (switches.varName == NULL) ? string : switches.varName, &isNew); - if (leftParen != NULL) { - *leftParen = '('; - } - if (vPtr == NULL) { - goto error; - } - vPtr->freeOnUnset = switches.watchUnset; - vPtr->flush = switches.flush; - vPtr->offset = first; - if (size > 0) { - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, size) != TCL_OK) { - goto error; - } - } - if (!isNew) { - if (vPtr->flush) { - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - } - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - } - } - FreeSwitches(createSwitches, (char *)&switches, 0); - if (vPtr != NULL) { - /* Return the name of the last vector created */ - Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), vPtr->name, -1); - } - return TCL_OK; - error: - FreeSwitches(createSwitches, (char *)&switches, 0); - return TCL_ERROR; -} - -static int VectorCreateOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc, Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - return VectorCreate2(clientData, interp, 2, objc, objv); -} - -static int VectorDestroyOp(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp, - int objc,Tcl_Obj* const objv[]) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr = (VectorInterpData*)clientData; - - for (int ii=2; ii 1) { - char *string; - char c; - int i; - Blt_OpSpec *specPtr; - - string = Tcl_GetString(objv[1]); - c = string[0]; - for (specPtr = vectorCmdOps, i = 0; i < nCmdOps; i++, specPtr++) { - if ((c == specPtr->name[0]) && - (strcmp(string, specPtr->name) == 0)) { - goto doOp; - } - } - // The first argument is not an operation, so assume that its - // actually the name of a vector to be created - return VectorCreate2(clientData, interp, 1, objc, objv); - } - doOp: - /* Do the usual vector operation lookup now. */ - proc = (VectorCmdProc*)GetOpFromObj(interp, nCmdOps, vectorCmdOps, - BLT_OP_ARG1, objc, objv,0); - if (proc == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - return (*proc) ((Vector*)clientData, interp, objc, objv); -} - -static void VectorInterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr = (VectorInterpData*)clientData; - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - Tcl_HashSearch cursor; - - for (hPtr = Tcl_FirstHashEntry(&dataPtr->vectorTable, &cursor); - hPtr != NULL; hPtr = Tcl_NextHashEntry(&cursor)) { - Vector* vPtr = (Vector*)Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - vPtr->hashPtr = NULL; - Vec_Free(vPtr); - } - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&dataPtr->vectorTable); - - /* If any user-defined math functions were installed, remove them. */ - Vec_UninstallMathFunctions(&dataPtr->mathProcTable); - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&dataPtr->mathProcTable); - - Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&dataPtr->indexProcTable); - Tcl_DeleteAssocData(interp, VECTOR_THREAD_KEY); - free(dataPtr); -} - -VectorInterpData* Blt::Vec_GetInterpData(Tcl_Interp* interp) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; - Tcl_InterpDeleteProc *proc; - - dataPtr = (VectorInterpData *) - Tcl_GetAssocData(interp, VECTOR_THREAD_KEY, &proc); - if (dataPtr == NULL) { - dataPtr = (VectorInterpData*)malloc(sizeof(VectorInterpData)); - dataPtr->interp = interp; - dataPtr->nextId = 0; - Tcl_SetAssocData(interp, VECTOR_THREAD_KEY, VectorInterpDeleteProc, - dataPtr); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&dataPtr->vectorTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&dataPtr->mathProcTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Tcl_InitHashTable(&dataPtr->indexProcTable, TCL_STRING_KEYS); - Vec_InstallMathFunctions(&dataPtr->mathProcTable); - Vec_InstallSpecialIndices(&dataPtr->indexProcTable); - srand48((long)time((time_t *) NULL)); - } - return dataPtr; -} - -/* C Application interface to vectors */ - -int Blt_CreateVector2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - const char *cmdName, const char *varName, - int initialSize, Blt_Vector* *vecPtrPtr) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Vector* vPtr; - int isNew; - char *nameCopy; - - if (initialSize < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector size \"", Itoa(initialSize), - "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - - nameCopy = Blt_Strdup(vecName); - vPtr = Vec_Create(dataPtr, nameCopy, cmdName, varName, &isNew); - free(nameCopy); - - if (vPtr == NULL) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (initialSize > 0) { - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, vPtr, initialSize) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - if (vecPtrPtr != NULL) { - *vecPtrPtr = (Blt_Vector* ) vPtr; - } - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt_CreateVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *name, int size, - Blt_Vector* *vecPtrPtr) -{ - return Blt_CreateVector2(interp, name, name, name, size, vecPtrPtr); -} - -int Blt_DeleteVector(Blt_Vector* vecPtr) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector* )vecPtr; - - Vec_Free(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt_DeleteVectorByName(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *name) -{ - // If the vector name was passed via a read-only string (e.g. "x"), the - // Vec_ParseElement routine will segfault when it tries to write into - // the string. Therefore make a writable copy and free it when we're done. - char* nameCopy = Blt_Strdup(name); - VectorInterpData *dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - Vector* vPtr; - int result = Vec_LookupName(dataPtr, nameCopy, &vPtr); - free(nameCopy); - - if (result != TCL_OK) - return TCL_ERROR; - - Vec_Free(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt_VectorExists2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; - - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - if (GetVectorObject(dataPtr, vecName, NS_SEARCH_BOTH) != NULL) { - return 1; - } - return 0; -} - -int Blt_VectorExists(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName) -{ - char *nameCopy; - int result; - - /* - * If the vector name was passed via a read-only string (e.g. "x"), the - * Blt_VectorParseName routine will segfault when it tries to write into - * the string. Therefore make a writable copy and free it when we're - * done. - */ - nameCopy = Blt_Strdup(vecName); - result = Blt_VectorExists2(interp, nameCopy); - free(nameCopy); - return result; -} - -int Blt_GetVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *name, Blt_Vector* *vecPtrPtr) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Vector* vPtr; - char *nameCopy; - int result; - - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - /* - * If the vector name was passed via a read-only string (e.g. "x"), the - * Blt_VectorParseName routine will segfault when it tries to write into - * the string. Therefore make a writable copy and free it when we're - * done. - */ - nameCopy = Blt_Strdup(name); - result = Vec_LookupName(dataPtr, nameCopy, &vPtr); - free(nameCopy); - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Vec_UpdateRange(vPtr); - *vecPtrPtr = (Blt_Vector* ) vPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt_GetVectorFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - Blt_Vector* *vecPtrPtr) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Vector* vPtr; - - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - if (Vec_LookupName(dataPtr, Tcl_GetString(objPtr), &vPtr) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Vec_UpdateRange(vPtr); - *vecPtrPtr = (Blt_Vector* ) vPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -int Blt_ResetVector(Blt_Vector* vecPtr, double *valueArr, int length, - int size, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector* )vecPtr; - - if (size < 0) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "bad array size", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - return Vec_Reset(vPtr, valueArr, length, size, freeProc); -} - -int Blt_ResizeVector(Blt_Vector* vecPtr, int length) -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector* )vecPtr; - - if (Vec_ChangeLength((Tcl_Interp *)NULL, vPtr, length) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(vPtr->interp, "can't resize vector \"", vPtr->name, - "\"", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (vPtr->flush) { - Vec_FlushCache(vPtr); - } - Vec_UpdateClients(vPtr); - return TCL_OK; -} - -Blt_VectorId Blt_AllocVectorId(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *name) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Vector* vPtr; - VectorClient *clientPtr; - Blt_VectorId clientId; - int result; - char *nameCopy; - - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - /* - * If the vector name was passed via a read-only string (e.g. "x"), the - * Blt_VectorParseName routine will segfault when it tries to write into - * the string. Therefore make a writable copy and free it when we're - * done. - */ - nameCopy = Blt_Strdup(name); - result = Vec_LookupName(dataPtr, nameCopy, &vPtr); - free(nameCopy); - - if (result != TCL_OK) { - return (Blt_VectorId) 0; - } - /* Allocate a new client structure */ - clientPtr = (VectorClient*)calloc(1, sizeof(VectorClient)); - clientPtr->magic = VECTOR_MAGIC; - - /* Add the new client to the server's list of clients */ - clientPtr->link = vPtr->chain->append(clientPtr); - clientPtr->serverPtr = vPtr; - clientId = (Blt_VectorId) clientPtr; - return clientId; -} - -void Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc, - ClientData clientData) -{ - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient *)clientId; - - if (clientPtr->magic != VECTOR_MAGIC) { - return; /* Not a valid token */ - } - clientPtr->clientData = clientData; - clientPtr->proc = proc; -} - -void Blt_FreeVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId) -{ - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient *)clientId; - - if (clientPtr->magic != VECTOR_MAGIC) - return; - - if (clientPtr->serverPtr != NULL) { - // Remove the client from the server's list - clientPtr->serverPtr->chain->deleteLink(clientPtr->link); - } - free(clientPtr); -} - -const char* Blt_NameOfVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId) -{ - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient *)clientId; - - if ((clientPtr->magic != VECTOR_MAGIC) || (clientPtr->serverPtr == NULL)) { - return NULL; - } - return clientPtr->serverPtr->name; -} - -const char* Blt_NameOfVector(Blt_Vector* vecPtr) /* Vector to query. */ -{ - Vector* vPtr = (Vector* )vecPtr; - return vPtr->name; -} - -int Blt_GetVectorById(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_Vector* *vecPtrPtr) -{ - VectorClient *clientPtr = (VectorClient *)clientId; - - if (clientPtr->magic != VECTOR_MAGIC) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad vector token", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (clientPtr->serverPtr == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "vector no longer exists", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - Vec_UpdateRange(clientPtr->serverPtr); - *vecPtrPtr = (Blt_Vector* ) clientPtr->serverPtr; - return TCL_OK; -} - -void Blt_InstallIndexProc(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *string, - Blt_VectorIndexProc *procPtr) -{ - VectorInterpData *dataPtr; /* Interpreter-specific data. */ - Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; - int isNew; - - dataPtr = Vec_GetInterpData(interp); - hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&dataPtr->indexProcTable, string, &isNew); - if (procPtr == NULL) { - Tcl_DeleteHashEntry(hPtr); - } else { - Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, procPtr); - } -} - -#define SWAP(a,b) tempr=(a);(a)=(b);(b)=tempr - -/* routine by Brenner - * data is the array of complex data points, perversely - * starting at 1 - * nn is the number of complex points, i.e. half the length of data - * isign is 1 for forward, -1 for inverse - */ -static void four1(double *data, unsigned long nn, int isign) -{ - unsigned long n,mmax,m,j,istep,i; - double wtemp,wr,wpr,wpi,wi,theta; - double tempr,tempi; - - n=nn << 1; - j=1; - for (i = 1;i i) { - SWAP(data[j],data[i]); - SWAP(data[j+1],data[i+1]); - } - m=n >> 1; - while (m >= 2 && j > m) { - j -= m; - m >>= 1; - } - j += m; - } - mmax=2; - while (n > mmax) { - istep=mmax << 1; - theta=isign*(6.28318530717959/mmax); - wtemp=sin(0.5*theta); - wpr = -2.0*wtemp*wtemp; - wpi=sin(theta); - wr=1.0; - wi=0.0; - for (m=1;mlast - srcPtr->first + 1; - /* new length */ - pow2len = smallest_power_of_2_not_less_than( length ); - - /* We do not do in-place FFTs */ - if (realPtr == srcPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "real vector \"", realPtr->name, - "\" can't be the same as the source", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (phasesPtr != NULL) { - if (phasesPtr == srcPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "imaginary vector \"", phasesPtr->name, - "\" can't be the same as the source", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, phasesPtr, - pow2len/2-noconstant+middle) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - if (freqPtr != NULL) { - if (freqPtr == srcPtr) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "frequency vector \"", freqPtr->name, - "\" can't be the same as the source", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, freqPtr, - pow2len/2-noconstant+middle) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - } - - /* Allocate memory zero-filled array. */ - paddedData = (double*)calloc(pow2len * 2, sizeof(double)); - if (paddedData == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't allocate memory for padded data", - (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - /* - * Since we just do real transforms, only even locations will be - * filled with data. - */ - if (flags & FFT_BARTLETT) { /* Bartlett window 1 - ( (x - N/2) / (N/2) ) */ - double Nhalf = pow2len*0.5; - double Nhalf_1 = 1.0 / Nhalf; - double w; - - for (i = 0; i < length; i++) { - w = 1.0 - fabs( (i-Nhalf) * Nhalf_1 ); - Wss += w; - paddedData[2*i] = w * srcPtr->valueArr[i]; - } - for(/*empty*/; i < pow2len; i++) { - w = 1.0 - fabs((i-Nhalf) * Nhalf_1); - Wss += w; - } - } else { /* Squared window, i.e. no data windowing. */ - for (i = 0; i < length; i++) { - paddedData[2*i] = srcPtr->valueArr[i]; - } - Wss = pow2len; - } - - /* Fourier */ - four1(paddedData-1, pow2len, 1); - - /* - for(i=0;ivalueArr; - - for (i = 0 + noconstant; i < pow2len / 2; i++) { - re = paddedData[2*i]; - im = paddedData[2*i+1]; - reS = paddedData[2*pow2len-2*i-2]; - imS = paddedData[2*pow2len-2*i-1]; - v[i - noconstant] = factor * ( -# if 0 - hypot( paddedData[2*i], paddedData[2*i+1] ) - + hypot( - paddedData[pow2len*2-2*i-2], - paddedData[pow2len*2-2*i-1] - ) -# else - sqrt( re*re + im* im ) + sqrt( reS*reS + imS*imS ) -# endif - ); - } - } else { - for(i = 0 + noconstant; i < pow2len / 2 + middle; i++) { - realPtr->valueArr[i - noconstant] = paddedData[2*i]; - } - } - if( phasesPtr != NULL ){ - for (i = 0 + noconstant; i < pow2len / 2 + middle; i++) { - phasesPtr->valueArr[i-noconstant] = paddedData[2*i+1]; - } - } - - /* Compute frequencies */ - if (freqPtr != NULL) { - double N = pow2len; - double denom = 1.0 / N / delta; - for( i=0+noconstant; ivalueArr[i-noconstant] = ((double) i) * denom; - } - } - - /* Memory is necessarily dynamic, because nobody touched it ! */ - free(paddedData); - - realPtr->offset = 0; - return TCL_OK; -} - - -int Blt::Vec_InverseFFT(Tcl_Interp* interp, Vector* srcImagPtr, - Vector* destRealPtr, Vector* destImagPtr, Vector* srcPtr) -{ - int length; - int pow2len; - double *paddedData; - int i; - double oneOverN; - - if ((destRealPtr == srcPtr) || (destImagPtr == srcPtr )){ - /* we do not do in-place FFTs */ - return TCL_ERROR; - } - length = srcPtr->last - srcPtr->first + 1; - - /* minus one because of the magical middle element! */ - pow2len = smallest_power_of_2_not_less_than( (length-1)*2 ); - oneOverN = 1.0 / pow2len; - - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, destRealPtr, pow2len) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - if (Vec_ChangeLength(interp, destImagPtr, pow2len) != TCL_OK) { - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - if( length != (srcImagPtr->last - srcImagPtr->first + 1) ){ - Tcl_AppendResult(srcPtr->interp, - "the length of the imagPart vector must ", - "be the same as the real one", (char *)NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; - } - - paddedData = (double*)malloc( pow2len*2*sizeof(double) ); - if( paddedData == NULL ){ - if (interp != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "memory allocation failed", (char *)NULL); - } - return TCL_ERROR; - } - for(i=0;ivalueArr[i]; - paddedData[2*i+1] = srcImagPtr->valueArr[i]; - paddedData[pow2len*2 - 2*i - 2 ] = srcPtr->valueArr[i+1]; - paddedData[pow2len*2 - 2*i - 1 ] = - srcImagPtr->valueArr[i+1]; - } - /* mythical middle element */ - paddedData[(length-1)*2] = srcPtr->valueArr[length-1]; - paddedData[(length-1)*2+1] = srcImagPtr->valueArr[length-1]; - - /* - for(i=0;ivalueArr[i] = paddedData[2*i] * oneOverN; - destImagPtr->valueArr[i] = paddedData[2*i+1] * oneOverN; - } - - /* memory is necessarily dynamic, because nobody touched it ! */ - free( paddedData ); - - return TCL_OK; -} - -static double FindSplit(Point2d *points, int i, int j, int *split) -{ - double maxDist2; - - maxDist2 = -1.0; - if ((i + 1) < j) { - int k; - double a, b, c; - - /* - * - * dist2 P(k) = | 1 P(i).x P(i).y | - * | 1 P(j).x P(j).y | - * | 1 P(k).x P(k).y | - * ------------------------------------------ - * (P(i).x - P(j).x)^2 + (P(i).y - P(j).y)^2 - */ - - a = points[i].y - points[j].y; - b = points[j].x - points[i].x; - c = (points[i].x * points[j].y) - (points[i].y * points[j].x); - for (k = (i + 1); k < j; k++) { - double dist2; - - dist2 = (points[k].x * a) + (points[k].y * b) + c; - if (dist2 < 0.0) { - dist2 = -dist2; - } - if (dist2 > maxDist2) { - maxDist2 = dist2; /* Track the maximum. */ - *split = k; - } - } - /* Correction for segment length---should be redone if can == 0 */ - maxDist2 *= maxDist2 / (a * a + b * b); - } - return maxDist2; -} - -// Douglas-Peucker line simplification algorithm */ -int Blt_SimplifyLine(Point2d *inputPts, int low, int high, double tolerance, - int *indices) -{ -#define StackPush(a) s++, stack[s] = (a) -#define StackPop(a) (a) = stack[s], s-- -#define StackEmpty() (s < 0) -#define StackTop() stack[s] - int *stack; - int split = -1; - double dist2, tolerance2; - int s = -1; /* Points to top stack item. */ - int count; - - stack = (int*)malloc(sizeof(int) * (high - low + 1)); - StackPush(high); - count = 0; - indices[count++] = 0; - tolerance2 = tolerance * tolerance; - while (!StackEmpty()) { - dist2 = FindSplit(inputPts, low, StackTop(), &split); - if (dist2 > tolerance2) { - StackPush(split); - } else { - indices[count++] = StackTop(); - StackPop(low); - } - } - free(stack); - return count; -} - diff --git a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.h b/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.h deleted file mode 100644 index 45ddf6e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/generic/tkbltVector.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,140 +0,0 @@ -/* - * Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory, Cambridge, MA, USA - * This code has been modified under the terms listed below and is made - * available under the same terms. - */ - -/* - * Copyright 1993-2004 George A Howlett. - * - * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person - * obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation - * files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without - * restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, - * copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or - * sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the - * Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following - * conditions: - * - * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be - * included in all copies or substantial portions of the - * Software. - * - * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY - * KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE - * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR - * PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS - * OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR - * OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR - * OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE - * SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. - */ - -#ifndef _BLT_VECTOR_H -#define _BLT_VECTOR_H - -#include - -#ifdef BUILD_tkblt -# define TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS DLLEXPORT -#else -# ifdef USE_TCL_STUBS -# define TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS /* */ -# else -# define TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS DLLIMPORT -# endif -#endif - - -typedef enum { - BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_UPDATE = 1, /* The vector's values has been updated */ - BLT_VECTOR_NOTIFY_DESTROY /* The vector has been destroyed and the client - * should no longer use its data (calling - * Blt_FreeVectorId) */ -} Blt_VectorNotify; - -typedef struct _Blt_VectorId *Blt_VectorId; - -typedef void (Blt_VectorChangedProc)(Tcl_Interp* interp, ClientData clientData, - Blt_VectorNotify notify); - -typedef struct { - double *valueArr; /* Array of values (possibly malloc-ed) */ - int numValues; /* Number of values in the array */ - int arraySize; /* Size of the allocated space */ - double min, max; /* Minimum and maximum values in the vector */ - int dirty; /* Indicates if the vector has been updated */ - int reserved; /* Reserved for future use */ - -} Blt_Vector; - -typedef double (Blt_VectorIndexProc)(Blt_Vector * vecPtr); - -typedef enum { - BLT_MATH_FUNC_SCALAR = 1, /* The function returns a single double - * precision value. */ - BLT_MATH_FUNC_VECTOR /* The function processes the entire vector. */ -} Blt_MathFuncType; - -/* - * To be safe, use the macros below, rather than the fields of the - * structure directly. - * - * The Blt_Vector is basically an opaque type. But it's also the - * actual memory address of the vector itself. I wanted to make the - * API as unobtrusive as possible. So instead of giving you a copy of - * the vector, providing various functions to access and update the - * vector, you get your hands on the actual memory (array of doubles) - * shared by all the vector's clients. - * - * The trade-off for speed and convenience is safety. You can easily - * break things by writing into the vector when other clients are - * using it. Use Blt_ResetVector to get around this. At least the - * macros are a reminder it isn't really safe to reset the data - * fields, except by the API routines. - */ -#define Blt_VecData(v) ((v)->valueArr) -#define Blt_VecLength(v) ((v)->numValues) -#define Blt_VecSize(v) ((v)->arraySize) -#define Blt_VecDirty(v) ((v)->dirty) - -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" { -#endif - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_CreateVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - int size, Blt_Vector** vecPtrPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_CreateVector2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - const char *cmdName, const char *varName, - int initialSize, Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_DeleteVectorByName(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_DeleteVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVectorFromObj(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj *objPtr, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ResetVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, double *dataArr, int n, - int arraySize, Tcl_FreeProc *freeProc); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ResizeVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr, int n); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_VectorExists(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_VectorExists2(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS Blt_VectorId Blt_AllocVectorId(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *vecName); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_GetVectorById(Tcl_Interp* interp, Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_Vector **vecPtrPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_SetVectorChangedProc(Blt_VectorId clientId, - Blt_VectorChangedProc *proc, - ClientData clientData); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_FreeVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS const char *Blt_NameOfVectorId(Blt_VectorId clientId); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS const char *Blt_NameOfVector(Blt_Vector *vecPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS int Blt_ExprVector(Tcl_Interp* interp, char *expr, Blt_Vector *vecPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS void Blt_InstallIndexProc(Tcl_Interp* interp, const char *indexName, - Blt_VectorIndexProc * procPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS double Blt_VecMin(Blt_Vector *vPtr); - TKBLT_STORAGE_CLASS double Blt_VecMax(Blt_Vector *vPtr); -#ifdef __cplusplus -} -#endif - -#include "tkbltDecls.h" - -#endif /* _BLT_VECTOR_H */ diff --git a/tkblt/library/graph.tcl b/tkblt/library/graph.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index a4dfe8e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/library/graph.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,554 +0,0 @@ -package provide Tkblt 3.0 - -namespace eval ::blt::legend { - variable _private - array set _private { - afterId "" - scroll 0 - space off - drag 0 - x 0 - y 0 - } -} - -namespace eval ::blt::ZoomStack { - variable _private - array set _private { - afterId "" - scroll 0 - space off - drag 0 - x 0 - y 0 - } -} - -proc blt::legend::SetSelectionAnchor { w tagOrId } { - set elem [$w legend get $tagOrId] - # If the anchor hasn't changed, don't do anything - if { $elem != [$w legend get anchor] } { - $w legend selection clearall - $w legend focus $elem - $w legend selection set $elem - $w legend selection anchor $elem - } -} - -# ---------------------------------------------------------------------- -# -# MoveFocus -- -# -# Invoked by KeyPress bindings. Moves the active selection to -# the entry , which is an index such as "up", "down", -# "prevsibling", "nextsibling", etc. -# -# ---------------------------------------------------------------------- -proc blt::legend::MoveFocus { w elem } { - catch {$w legend focus $elem} result - puts stderr "result=$result elem=$elem" - if { [$w legend cget -selectmode] == "single" } { - $w legend selection clearall - $w legend selection set focus - $w legend selection anchor focus - } -} - - -proc Blt_ActiveLegend { g } { - $g legend bind all [list blt::ActivateLegend $g ] - $g legend bind all [list blt::DeactivateLegend $g] - $g legend bind all [list blt::HighlightLegend $g] -} - -proc Blt_Crosshairs { g } { - blt::Crosshairs $g -} - -proc Blt_ResetCrosshairs { g state } { - blt::Crosshairs $g "Any-Motion" $state -} - -proc Blt_ZoomStack { g args } { - array set params { - -mode click - -button "ButtonPress-3" - } - array set params $args - if { $params(-mode) == "click" } { - blt::ZoomStack::ClickClick $g $params(-button) - } else { - blt::ZoomStack::ClickRelease $g $params(-button) - } -} - -proc Blt_ClosestPoint { g } { - blt::ClosestPoint $g -} - -# -# The following procedures that reside in the "blt" namespace are -# supposed to be private. -# - -proc blt::ActivateLegend { g } { - set elem [$g legend get current] - $g legend activate $elem -} -proc blt::DeactivateLegend { g } { - set elem [$g legend get current] - $g legend deactivate $elem -} - -proc blt::HighlightLegend { g } { - set elem [$g legend get current] - if { $elem != "" } { - set relief [$g element cget $elem -legendrelief] - if { $relief == "flat" } { - $g element configure $elem -legendrelief raised - $g element activate $elem - } else { - $g element configure $elem -legendrelief flat - $g element deactivate $elem - } - } -} - -proc blt::Crosshairs { g {event "Any-Motion"} {state "on"}} { - $g crosshairs $state - bind crosshairs-$g <$event> { - %W crosshairs configure -position @%x,%y - } - bind crosshairs-$g { - %W crosshairs off - } - bind crosshairs-$g { - %W crosshairs on - } - $g crosshairs configure -color red - if { $state == "on" } { - blt::AddBindTag $g crosshairs-$g - } elseif { $state == "off" } { - blt::RemoveBindTag $g crosshairs-$g - } -} - -proc blt::ClosestPoint { g {event "Control-ButtonPress-2"} } { - bind closest-point-$g <$event> { - blt::FindElement %W %x %y - } - blt::AddBindTag $g closest-point-$g -} - -proc blt::AddBindTag { widget tag } { - set oldTagList [bindtags $widget] - if { [lsearch $oldTagList $tag] < 0 } { - bindtags $widget [linsert $oldTagList 0 $tag] - } -} - -proc blt::RemoveBindTag { widget tag } { - set oldTagList [bindtags $widget] - set index [lsearch $oldTagList $tag] - if { $index >= 0 } { - bindtags $widget [lreplace $oldTagList $index $index] - } -} - -proc blt::FindElement { g x y } { - array set info [$g element closest $x $y -interpolate yes] - if { ![info exists info(name)] } { - beep - return - } - # -------------------------------------------------------------- - # find(name) - element Id - # find(index) - index of closest point - # find(x) find(y) - coordinates of closest point - # or closest point on line segment. - # find(dist) - distance from sample coordinate - # -------------------------------------------------------------- - set markerName "bltClosest_$info(name)" - catch { $g marker delete $markerName } - $g marker create text $markerName \ - -coords "$info(x) $info(y)" \ - -text "$info(name): $info(dist)\nindex $info(index)" \ - -anchor center -justify left \ - -yoffset 0 -bg {} - - set coords [$g invtransform $x $y] - set nx [lindex $coords 0] - set ny [lindex $coords 1] - - $g marker create line line.$markerName -coords "$nx $ny $info(x) $info(y)" - - blt::FlashPoint $g $info(name) $info(index) 10 - blt::FlashPoint $g $info(name) [expr $info(index) + 1] 10 -} - -proc blt::FlashPoint { g name index count } { - if { $count & 1 } { - $g element deactivate $name - } else { - $g element activate $name $index - } - incr count -1 - if { $count > 0 } { - after 200 blt::FlashPoint $g $name $index $count - update - } else { - catch {eval $g marker delete [$g marker names "bltClosest_*"]} - } -} - - -proc blt::ZoomStack::Init { g } { - variable _private - set _private($g,interval) 100 - set _private($g,afterId) 0 - set _private($g,A,x) {} - set _private($g,A,y) {} - set _private($g,B,x) {} - set _private($g,B,y) {} - set _private($g,stack) {} - set _private($g,corner) A -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::ClickClick { g reset } { - variable _private - - Init $g - - bind zoom-$g "focus %W" - bind zoom-$g { blt::ZoomStack::Reset %W } - bind zoom-$g { blt::ZoomStack::SetPoint %W %x %y } - bind zoom-$g <${reset}> { - if { [%W inside %x %y] } { - blt::ZoomStack::Reset %W - } - } - blt::AddBindTag $g zoom-$g -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::ClickRelease { g reset } { - variable _private - - Init $g - bind zoom-$g "focus %W" - bind zoom-$g {blt::ZoomStack::Reset %W} - bind zoom-$g {blt::ZoomStack::DragStart %W %x %y} - bind zoom-$g {blt::ZoomStack::DragMotion %W %x %y} - bind zoom-$g {blt::ZoomStack::DragFinish %W %x %y} - bind zoom-$g <${reset}> { - if { [%W inside %x %y] } { - blt::ZoomStack::Reset %W - } - } - blt::AddBindTag $g zoom-$g -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::GetCoords { g x y index } { - variable _private - if { [$g cget -invertxy] } { - set _private($g,$index,x) $y - set _private($g,$index,y) $x - } else { - set _private($g,$index,x) $x - set _private($g,$index,y) $y - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::MarkPoint { g index } { - variable _private - - if { [llength [$g xaxis use]] > 0 } { - set x [$g xaxis invtransform $_private($g,$index,x)] - } else if { [llength [$g x2axis use]] > 0 } { - set x [$g x2axis invtransform $_private($g,$index,x)] - } - if { [llength [$g yaxis use]] > 0 } { - set y [$g yaxis invtransform $_private($g,$index,y)] - } else if { [llength [$g y2axis use]] > 0 } { - set y [$g y2axis invtransform $_private($g,$index,y)] - } - set marker "zoomText_$index" - set text [format "x=%.4g\ny=%.4g" $x $y] - - if [$g marker exists $marker] { - $g marker configure $marker -coords "$x $y" -text $text - } else { - $g marker create text $marker \ - -coords "$x $y" \ - -text $text -anchor center -bg {} -justify left - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::DestroyTitle { g } { - variable _private - - if { $_private($g,corner) == "A" } { - catch { $g marker delete "zoomTitle" } - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::Pop { g } { - variable _private - - set zoomStack $_private($g,stack) - if { [llength $zoomStack] > 0 } { - set cmd [lindex $zoomStack 0] - set _private($g,stack) [lrange $zoomStack 1 end] - eval $cmd - TitleLast $g - update - after 2000 [list blt::ZoomStack::DestroyTitle $g] - } else { - catch { $g marker delete "zoomTitle" } - } -} - -# Push the old axis limits on the stack and set the new ones - -proc blt::ZoomStack::Push { g } { - variable _private - - catch {eval $g marker delete [$g marker names "zoom*"]} - if { [info exists _private($g,afterId)] } { - after cancel $_private($g,afterId) - } - set x1 $_private($g,A,x) - set y1 $_private($g,A,y) - set x2 $_private($g,B,x) - set y2 $_private($g,B,y) - - if { ($x1 == $x2) || ($y1 == $y2) } { - # No delta, revert to start - return - } - set cmd {} - foreach axis [$g axis names] { - if { [$g axis cget $axis -hide] } { - continue - } - set min [$g axis cget $axis -min] - set max [$g axis cget $axis -max] - set logscale [$g axis cget $axis -logscale] - # Save the current scale (log or linear) so that we can restore it. - # This is for the case where the user changes to logscale while - # zooming. A previously pushed axis limit could be negative. It - # seems better for popping the zoom stack to restore a previous view - # (not convert the ranges). - set c [list $g axis configure $axis] - lappend c -min $min -max $max -logscale $logscale - append cmd "$c\n" - } - - # This effectively pushes the command to reset the graph to the current - # zoom level onto the stack. This is useful if the new axis ranges are - # bad and we need to reset the zoom stack. - set _private($g,stack) [linsert $_private($g,stack) 0 $cmd] - foreach axis [$g axis names] { - if { [$g axis cget $axis -hide] } { - continue; # Don't set zoom on axes not displayed. - } - set type [$g axis type $axis] - if { $type == "x" } { - set min [$g axis invtransform $axis $x1] - set max [$g axis invtransform $axis $x2] - } elseif { $type == "y" } { - set min [$g axis invtransform $axis $y1] - set max [$g axis invtransform $axis $y2] - } else { - continue; # Axis is not bound to any margin. - } - if { ![SetAxisRanges $g $axis $min $max] } { - Pop $g - bell - return - } - } - update; # This "update" redraws the graph -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::SetAxisRanges { g axis min max } { - if { $min > $max } { - set tmp $max; set max $min; set min $tmp - } - if { [catch { $g axis configure $axis -min $min -max $max }] != 0 } { - return 0 - } - return 1 -} - -# -# This routine terminates either an existing zoom, or pops back to -# the previous zoom level (if no zoom is in progress). -# -proc blt::ZoomStack::Reset { g } { - variable _private - - if { ![info exists _private($g,corner)] } { - Init $g - } - catch {eval $g marker delete [$g marker names "zoom*"]} - - if { $_private($g,corner) == "A" } { - # Reset the whole axis - Pop $g - } else { - set _private($g,corner) A - blt::RemoveBindTag $g select-region-$g - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::TitleNext { g } { - variable _private - - set level [expr [llength $_private($g,stack)] + 1] - if { [$g cget -invertxy] } { - set coords "Inf -Inf" - } else { - set coords "-Inf Inf" - } - set marker "zoomTitle" - if {![$g marker exists $marker]} { - $g marker create text $marker -bindtags "" -anchor nw - } - $g marker configure $marker -text "Zoom #$level" -coords $coords -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::TitleLast { g } { - variable _private - - set level [llength $_private($g,stack)] - if { [$g cget -invertxy] } { - set coords "Inf -Inf" - } else { - set coords "-Inf Inf" - } - - set marker "zoomTitle" - if { $level > 0 } { - if {![$g marker exists $marker]} { - $g marker create text "zoomTitle" -anchor nw - } - $g marker configure $marker -text "Zoom #$level" -coords $coords - } -} - - -proc blt::ZoomStack::SetPoint { g x y } { - variable _private - if { ![info exists _private($g,corner)] } { - Init $g - } - GetCoords $g $x $y $_private($g,corner) - bind select-region-$g { - blt::ZoomStack::GetCoords %W %x %y B - #blt::ZoomStack::MarkPoint $g B - blt::ZoomStack::Box %W - } - if { $_private($g,corner) == "A" } { - if { ![$g inside $x $y] } { - return - } - # First corner selected, start watching motion events - - #MarkPoint $g A - TitleNext $g - - blt::AddBindTag $g select-region-$g - set _private($g,corner) B - } else { - # Delete the modal binding - blt::RemoveBindTag $g select-region-$g - Push $g - set _private($g,corner) A - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::DragStart { g x y } { - variable _private - if { ![info exists _private($g,corner)] } { - Init $g - } - GetCoords $g $x $y A - if { ![$g inside $x $y] } { - return - } - set _private(drag) 1 - TitleNext $g -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::DragMotion { g x y } { - variable _private - - if { $_private(drag) } { - GetCoords $g $x $y B - set dx [expr abs($_private($g,B,x) - $_private($g,A,x))] - set dy [expr abs($_private($g,B,y) - $_private($g,A,y))] - Box $g - if { $dy > 10 && $dx > 10 } { - return 1 - } - } - return 0 -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::DragFinish { g x y } { - variable _private - if { [DragMotion $g $x $y] } { - Push $g - } else { - catch {eval $g marker delete [$g marker names "zoom*"]} - if { [info exists _private($g,afterId)] } { - after cancel $_private($g,afterId) - } - } - set _private(drag) 0 -} - - -proc blt::ZoomStack::MarchingAnts { g offset } { - variable _private - - incr offset - # wrap the counter after 2^16 - set offset [expr $offset & 0xFFFF] - if { [$g marker exists zoomOutline] } { - $g marker configure zoomOutline -dashoffset $offset - set interval $_private($g,interval) - set id [after $interval [list blt::ZoomStack::MarchingAnts $g $offset]] - set _private($g,afterId) $id - } -} - -proc blt::ZoomStack::Box { g } { - variable _private - - if { $_private($g,A,x) > $_private($g,B,x) } { - set x1 [$g xaxis invtransform $_private($g,B,x)] - set y1 [$g yaxis invtransform $_private($g,B,y)] - set x2 [$g xaxis invtransform $_private($g,A,x)] - set y2 [$g yaxis invtransform $_private($g,A,y)] - } else { - set x1 [$g xaxis invtransform $_private($g,A,x)] - set y1 [$g yaxis invtransform $_private($g,A,y)] - set x2 [$g xaxis invtransform $_private($g,B,x)] - set y2 [$g yaxis invtransform $_private($g,B,y)] - } - set coords "$x1 $y1 $x2 $y1 $x2 $y2 $x1 $y2 $x1 $y1" - if { [$g marker exists "zoomOutline"] } { - $g marker configure "zoomOutline" -coords $coords - } else { - set X [lindex [$g xaxis use] 0] - set Y [lindex [$g yaxis use] 0] - $g marker create line "zoomOutline" \ - -coords $coords -mapx $X -mapy $Y \ - -dashes 4 -linewidth 1 - set interval $_private($g,interval) - set id [after $interval [list blt::ZoomStack::MarchingAnts $g 0]] - set _private($g,afterId) $id - } -} - diff --git a/tkblt/pkgIndex.tcl.in b/tkblt/pkgIndex.tcl.in deleted file mode 100644 index ea7d80b..0000000 --- a/tkblt/pkgIndex.tcl.in +++ /dev/null @@ -1,5 +0,0 @@ -# -# Tcl package index file -# -package ifneeded @PACKAGE_NAME@ @PACKAGE_VERSION@ \ - [list load [file join $dir @PKG_LIB_FILE@] @PACKAGE_NAME@]\n[list source [file join $dir graph.tcl]] diff --git a/tkblt/tclconfig/ChangeLog b/tkblt/tclconfig/ChangeLog deleted file mode 100644 index 9504def..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tclconfig/ChangeLog +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1003 +0,0 @@ -2016-03-11 Sean Woods - *tcl.m4 Fixed the search for Tcl and Wish shells under MinGW. Static builds and threaded builds - get an "s" or "t" added to the name. - -2015-08-28 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Rfe [00189c4afc]: Allow semi-static UCRT build on - Windows with VC 14.0 - -2013-10-08 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Bug [172223e008]: Wrong filename in - --disable-shared compile on MinGW - -2013-10-04 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: stub library is no longer linked with msvcrt??.dll. - -2013-10-01 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Workaround for MinGW bug #2065: "gcc --shared" links - with libgcc_s_dw2-1.dll when using 64-bit division in C - -2013-07-04 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Bug [3324676]: AC_PROG_INSTALL incompat, - Bug [3606445]: Unneeded -DHAVE_NO_SEH=1 when not building on Windows - -2013-07-02 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Bug [32afa6e256]: dirent64 check is incorrect in tcl.m4 - (thanks to Brian Griffin) - -2013-06-20 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Use X11/Xlib.h for checking where X11 can be found - in stead of X11/XIntrinsic.h. Suggested by Pietro Cerutti. - -2013-06-04 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Eliminate NO_VIZ macro as current - zlib uses HAVE_HIDDEN in stead. One more last-moment - fix for FreeBSD by Pietro Cerutti - -2013-05-19 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Fix for FreeBSD, and remove support for old - FreeBSD versions. Patch by Pietro Cerutti - -2013-03-12 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Patch by Andrew Shadura, providing better support for - * three architectures they have in Debian. - -2012-08-07 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: Added "-DNDEBUG" to CFLAGS_DEFAULT - when building with --disable-symbols. - -2012-08-07 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: [Bug 3555058]: Checkin [30736d63f0] broke - CFLAGS_DEFAULT, LDFLAGS_DEFAULT - -2012-08-07 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: [Bug 3511806]: Checkin [30736d63f0] broke CFLAGS - -2012-08-07 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [Bug 3511806]: Checkin [30736d63f0] broke CFLAGS - -2012-07-25 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: My previous commit (2012-04-03) broke the ActiveTcl - build for AMD64, because of the quotes in "C://AMD64/cl.exe". - It turns out that the AC_TRY_COMPILE macro cannot handle that. - -2012-07-22 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: Tidy: consistency, spelling, phrasing, whitespace. - No functional change. - -2012-04-03 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [Bug 3511806] Compiler checks too early - This change allows to build the cygwin and mingw32 ports of - Tcl/Tk extensions to build out-of-the-box using a native or - cross-compiler, e.g. on Cygwin, Linux or Darwin. - -2011-04-02 Jan Nijtmans - - * install-sh: Fix issue with library stripping in install-sh - (backported from kevin_walzer's patch from Tcl 8.6 trunk) - -2011-04-05 Andreas Kupries - - * tcl.m4: Applied patch by Jeff Lawson. Nicer error message when - tclConfig.sh was not found. - -2010-12-15 Stuart Cassoff - - * install-sh: Upgrade to newer install-sh and use it. - * tcl.m4: - -2010-12-14 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: Better building on OpenBSD. - -2010-12-14 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: when using gcc, don't try to determine Win64 SDK - -2010-12-12 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Determine correctly a cross-compiler-windres - -2010-11-23 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: add some cross-compile support, borrowed from Tcl 8.6 - -2010-09-16 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct HP-UX LDFLAGS (only used when building big shell) - -2010-09-14 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: add extra if check for .manifest file generation - Add notice about package name and version being built. - -2010-09-09 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [FREQ #3058486] TEA_LOAD_CONFIG doesn't set all BUILD_ vars - Slightly related: defining BUILD_$1 on all platforms - not only win - - allows the -fvisibility feature to be used in extensions as well, at - least if you compile against tcl >= 8.5. - -2010-08-26 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: ensure safe quoting for autoheader usage - -2010-08-19 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: add TEA_ADD_CLEANFILES macro to make adding cleanfiles - easier, and add *.exp to CLEANFILES Windows default. - (TEA_MAKE_LIB): Enhanced to check for MSVC that requires manifests - and auto-embed it into proj DLL via MAKE_SHARED_LIB. Also define - VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL and VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE that do the same - magic in case it is needed for extended TEA projects. - -2010-08-16 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Bump to TEA_VERSION 3.9 *** - If upgrading from TEA_VERSION 3.8, copy over tcl.m4, change - TEA_INIT to use 3.9 and reconfigure (ac-2.59+). - BUILD_${PACKAGE_NAME} will be auto-defined on Windows for - correct setting of TCL_STORAGE_CLASS. - TEA_LOAD_CONFIG users should remove the SHLIB_LD_LIBS setting done - in configure.in (LIBS will be automagically populated by - TEA_LOAD_CONFIG). - TEA_EXPORT_CONFIG has been added for ${pkg}Config.sh creators - SHLIB_LD_FLAGS was deprecated a while ago, remove it if it is - still in your Makefile.in. - - * tcl.m4: add /usr/lib64 to set of auto-search dirs. [Bug 1230554] - Auto-define BUILD_$PACKAGE_NAME so users don't need to. This - needs to correspond with $pkg.h define magic for TCL_STORAGE_CLASS. - Auto-define CLEANFILES. Users can expand it. - (SHLIB_LD_LIBS): define to '${LIBS}' default and change it only if - necessary. Platforms not using this may simply not work or have - very funky linkers. - (TEA_LOAD_CONFIG): When loading config for another extension, - auto-add stub libraries found with TEA_ADD_LIBS. Eases - configure.in for modules like itk and img::*. - (TEA_EXPORT_CONFIG): Add standardized function for exporting a - ${pkg}Config.sh. See use by img::* and itcl. - -2010-08-12 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Bump to TEA_VERSION 3.8 *** - If upgrading from TEA_VERSION 3.7, copy over tcl.m4, change - TEA_INIT to use 3.8 and reconfigure (ac-2.59+). - No other changes should be necessary. - - * tcl.m4: remove more vestigial bits from removed platforms. - Add back SCO_SV-3.2*. - Remove use of DL_LIBS and DL_OBJS and related baggage - these are - only needed by the core to support 'load'. - Allow for macosx in TEA_ADD_SOURCES. - Correct check for found_xincludes=no in TEA_PATH_UNIX_X. - -2010-08-11 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: remove the following old platform configurations: - UNIX_SV*|UnixWare-5*, SunOS-4.*, SINIX*5.4*, SCO_SV-3.2*, - OSF1-1.*, NEXTSTEP-*, NetBSD-1.*|FreeBSD-[[1-2]].*, MP-RAS-*, - IRIX-5.*, HP-UX-*.08.*|HP-UX-*.09.*|HP-UX-*.10.*, dgux*, - BSD/OS-2.1*|BSD/OS-3* - (AIX): drop AIX-pre4 support and use of ldAix, use -bexpall/-brtl - -2010-07-05 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [Patch #1055668] removal of exported internals from - tclInt.h (EXTERN macro) - -2010-04-14 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4 - Backport a lot of quoting fixes from tcl8.6/unix/tcl.m4 - - Fix determination of CYGPATH for CYGWIN - With those fixes, itcl and tdbc compile fine with CYGWIN - -2010-04-06 Jan Nijtmans - - * install-sh [Bug 2982540] configure and install* script files - should always have LF - -2010-02-19 Stuart Cassoff - - * tcl.m4: Correct compiler/linker flags for threaded builds on - OpenBSD. - -2010-01-19 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: Detect CYGWIN variant: win32 or unix - -2010-01-03 Donal K. Fellows - - * unix/tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): [Tcl Bug 1636685]: Use the - configuration for modern FreeBSD suggested by the FreeBSD porter. - -2009-10-22 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [Tcl Patch #2883533] tcl.m4 support for Haiku OS - -2009-04-27 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): harden the check to add _r to CC on - AIX with threads. - -2009-04-10 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): check for 64-bit TkAqua. - -2009-03-26 Jan Nijtmans - - * tclconfig/tcl.m4: Adapt LDFLAGS and LD_SEARCH_FLAGS - together with SHLIB_LD definition to unbreak building on HPUX. - -2009-03-20 Andreas Kupries - - * tclconfig/tcl.m4: Changed SHLIB_LD definition to unbreak - building on HPUX. - -2009-03-16 Joe English - - * tcl.m4(TEA_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS): Look at ${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC} - (found in tkConfig.sh) when trying to guess where tk.h might be - [Patch 1960628]. - -2009-03-11 Joe English - - * tcl.m4: Allow ${SHLIB_SUFFIX} to be overridden at - configure-time [Patch 1960628]. Also fix some comment typos, - and an uninitialized variable bug-waiting-to-happen. - -2008-12-21 Jan Nijtmans - - * tcl.m4: [Bug 2073255] Tcl_GetString(NULL) doesn't crash on HP-UX - (this bug report was for Tcl, but holds for TEA as well.) - -2008-12-20 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: sync with tdbc tcl.m4 changes - (SunOS-5.11): Sun cc SHLIB_LD: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - -2008-12-02 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Bump to TEA_VERSION 3.7 *** - - * tcl.m4: in private header check, check for Port.h instead - of Int.h to ensure all private headers are available. - -2008-11-04 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): sync TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS handling of - Tk.framework PrivateHeaders with TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS. - -2008-11-04 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG, TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG): exit with error - when tclConfig.sh cannot be found. [Bug #1997760] - (TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS, TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS): allow for - finding the headers installed in the public areas, e.g. a result of - make install-private-headers. [Bug #1631922] - -2008-08-12 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): link shlib with current and compatiblity version - flags; look for libX11.dylib when searching for X11 libraries. - -2008-06-12 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (SunOS-5.11): fix 64bit amd64 support with gcc & Sun cc. - -2008-03-27 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (SunOS-5.1x): fix 64bit support for Sun cc. [Bug 1921166] - -2008-02-01 Donal K. Fellows - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Updated to work at least in part with - more modern VC versions. Currently just made the linker flags more - flexible; more work may be needed. - -2007-10-26 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): add support for 64-bit X11. - -2007-10-23 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Tagged tea-3-branch to start TEA 4 development on HEAD *** - -2007-09-17 Joe English - - * tcl.m4: use '${CC} -shared' instead of 'ld -Bshareable' - to build shared libraries on current NetBSDs [Bug 1749251]. - -2007-09-15 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: replace all direct references to compiler by ${CC} to - enable CC overriding at configure & make time. - (SunOS-5.1x): replace direct use of '/usr/ccs/bin/ld' in SHLIB_LD by - 'cc' compiler driver. - -2007-08-08 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: check Ttk dir for Tk private headers (8.5). - Add some comments to other bits. - -2007-06-25 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_PROG_WISH): move where / is added. - -2007-06-13 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: fix --with-tkinclude alignment. [Bug 1506111] - -2007-06-06 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): fix 64bit arch removal in fat 32&64bit builds. - -2007-05-18 Donal K. Fellows - - * tcl.m4: Added quoting so that paths with spaces cause fewer - problems. - -2007-03-07 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): s/CFLAGS/CPPFLAGS/ in -mmacosx-version-min check. - -2007-02-15 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct private header check to search in generic subdir - -2007-02-09 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Bump to TEA_VERSION 3.6 *** - - * tcl.m4: correct -d to -f - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): SHLIB_SUFFIX is .so on HP ia64 [Bug 1615058] - -2007-02-08 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS, TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS): check - that the dirs actually have private headers. [Bug 1631922] - -2007-02-04 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: add caching to -pipe check. - -2007-01-25 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: integrate CPPFLAGS into CFLAGS as late as possible and - move (rather than duplicate) -isysroot flags from CFLAGS to CPPFLAGS to - avoid errors about multiple -isysroot flags from some older gcc builds. - -2006-01-19 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: ensure CPPFLAGS env var is used when set. [Bug 1586861] - (Darwin): add -isysroot and -mmacosx-version-min flags to CPPFLAGS when - present in CFLAGS to avoid discrepancies between what headers configure - sees during preprocessing tests and compiling tests. - -2006-12-19 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): --enable-64bit: verify linking with 64bit -arch flag - succeeds before enabling 64bit build. - -2006-12-16 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Linux): fix previous change to use makefile variable - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS in SHLIB_LD, to ensure linker - flags in sampleextension Makefile are picked up. - -2006-11-26 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Linux): --enable-64bit support. [Patch 1597389], [Bug 1230558] - -2006-08-18 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): add support for --enable-64bit on x86_64, for - universal builds including x86_64 and for use of -mmacosx-version-min - instead of MACOSX_DEPLOYMENT_TARGET. For Tk extensions, remove 64-bit - arch flags from CFLAGS like in the Tk configure, as neither TkAqua nor - TkX11 can be built for 64-bit at present. - -2006-03-28 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: []-quote AC_DEFUN functions. - (TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG): Fixed Windows-specific check for tkConfig.sh. - (TEA_MAKE_LIB): Prepend 'lib' for Windows-gcc configs. - -2006-03-07 Joe English - - * tcl.m4: Set SHLIB_LD_FLAGS='${LIBS}' on NetBSD, - as per the other *BSD variants [Bug 1334613]. - -2006-01-25 Jeff Hobbs - - *** Bump to TEA version 3.5 *** - - * tcl.m4: keep LD_SEARCH_FLAGS and CC_SEARCH_FLAGS synchronous - with core tcl.m4 meaning. - -2006-01-24 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): use makefile variable LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of - LDFLAGS in SHLIB_LD, to ensure linker flags in sampleextension Makefile - are picked up. [Bug 1403343] - -2006-01-23 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: add C:/Tcl/lib and C:/Progra~1/Tcl/lib dirs to check for - *Config.sh on Windows. [Bug 1407544] - -2006-01-23 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): for Tk extensions, remove -arch ppc64 from CFLAGS - like in the Tk configure, as neither TkAqua nor TkX11 can be built for - 64bit at present (no 64bit GUI libraries). - -2006-01-22 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: restore system=windows on Windows. - Remove error if 'ar' isn't found (it may not be on Windows). - Do not add -lxnet or define _XOPEN_SOURCE on HP-UX by default. - Ensure the C|LDFLAGS_DEFAULT gets the fully sub'd value at - configure time. - -2006-01-10 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: add caching, use AC_CACHE_CHECK instead of AC_CACHE_VAL - where possible, consistent message quoting, sync relevant - tcl/unix/tcl.m4 HEAD changes and gratuitous formatting differences - (notably sunc removal of support for for ancient BSD's, IRIX 4, - RISCos and Ultrix by kennykb), Darwin improvements to - TEA_LOAD_*CONFIG to make linking work against Tcl/Tk frameworks - installed in arbitrary location, change TEA_PROG_* search order - (look in *_BIN_DIR parents before *_PREFIX). - -2006-01-05 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: add dkf's system config refactor - -2006-01-04 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: remove extraneous ' that causes bash 3.1 to choke - -2005-12-19 Joe English - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG &c): Look for tclConfig.sh &c - in ${libdir}, where they are installed by default [Patch #1377407]. - -2005-12-05 Don Porter - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PUBLIC_*_HEADERS): Better support for finding - header files for uninstalled Tcl and Tk. - -2005-12-02 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correctly bump TEA_VERSION var to 3.4 - -2005-12-01 Daniel Steffen - - * unix/tcl.m4 (Darwin): fixed error when MACOSX_DEPLOYMENT_TARGET unset - -2005-11-29 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: *** Bump to TEA version 3.4 *** - Add Windows x64 build support. - Remove TEA_PATH_NOSPACE and handle the problem with ""s where - necessary - the macro relied on TCLSH_PROG which didn't work for - cross-compiles. - -2005-11-27 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): add 64bit support, add CFLAGS to SHLIB_LD to - support passing -isysroot in env(CFLAGS) to configure (flag can't - be present twice, so can't be in both CFLAGS and LDFLAGS during - configure), don't use -prebind when deploying on 10.4. - (TEA_ENABLE_LANGINFO, TEA_TIME_HANDLER): add/fix caching. - -2005-10-30 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: fixed two tests for TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM = "aqua" that - should have been for `uname -s` = "Darwin" instead; added some - missing quoting. - (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_PROG_WISH): fix incorrect assumption that - install location of tclConfig.sh/tkConfig.sh allows to determine - the tclsh/wish install dir via ../bin. Indeed tcl/tk can be - configured with arbitrary --libdir and --bindir (independent of - prefix) and such a configuration is in fact standard with Darwin - framework builds. At least now also check ${TCL_PREFIX}/bin - resp. ${TK_PREFIX}/bin for presence of tclsh resp. wish (if tcl/tk - have been configured with arbitrary --bindir, this will still not - find them, for a general solution *Config.sh would need to contain - the values of bindir/libdir/includedir passed to configure). - -2005-10-07 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: Fix Solaris 5.10 check and Solaris AMD64 64-bit builds. - -2005-10-04 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS): add / to finish sed macro - (TEA_ENABLE_THREADS): don't check for pthread_attr_setstacksize func - -2005-09-13 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: *** Update to TEA version 3.3 *** - define TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM in TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG. - Make --enable-threads the default (users can --disable-threads). - Improve AIX ${CC}_r fix to better check existing ${CC} value. - Do the appropriate evals to not require the *TOP_DIR_NATIVE vars - be set for extensions that use private headers. - Make aqua check for Xlib compat headers the same as win32. - -2005-07-26 Mo DeJong - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_BUILD_TCLSH, - TEA_PROG_WISH, TEA_BUILD_WISH): Remove - TEA_BUILD_TCLSH and TEA_BUILD_WISH because - of complaints that it broke the build when - only an installed version of Tcl was available - at extension build time. The TEA_PROG_TCLSH and - TEA_PROG_WISH macros will no longer search the - path at all. The build tclsh or installed - tclsh shell will now be found by TEA_PROG_TCLSH. - -2005-07-24 Mo DeJong - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_BUILD_TCLSH, - TEA_PROG_WISH, TEA_BUILD_WISH): - Split confused search for tclsh on PATH and - build and install locations into two macros. - TEA_PROG_TCLSH and TEA_PROG_WISH search the - system PATH for an installed tclsh or wish. - The TEA_BUILD_TCLSH and TEA_BUILD_WISH - macros determine the name of tclsh or - wish in the Tcl or Tk build directory even - if tclsh or wish has not yet been built. - [Tcl bug 1160114] - [Tcl patch 1244153] - -2005-06-23 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS): add ${TK_SRC_DIR}/macosx to - TK_INCLUDES when building against TkAqua. - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PATH_X): fixed missing comma in AC_DEFINE - - * tcl.m4: changes to better support framework builds of Tcl and Tk out - of the box: search framework install locations for *Config.sh, and if in - presence of a framework build, use the framework's Headers and - PrivateHeaders directories for public and private includes. [FR 947735] - -2005-06-18 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): add -headerpad_max_install_names to LDFLAGS to - ensure we can always relocate binaries with install_name_tool. - -2005-06-04 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PATH_X): for TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM == aqua, check if xlib - compat headers are available in tkheaders location, otherwise add xlib - sourcedir to TK_XINCLUDES. - -2005-04-25 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4: added AC_DEFINE* descriptions (from core tcl.m4) to allow - use with autoheader. - (Darwin): added configure checks for recently added linker flags - -single_module and -search_paths_first to allow building with older - tools (and on Mac OS X 10.1), use -single_module in SHLIB_LD. - (TEA_MISSING_POSIX_HEADERS): added caching of dirent.h check. - (TEA_BUGGY_STRTOD): added caching (sync with core tcl.m4). - -2005-03-24 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS): use Tcl header defaults for wide - int type only on Windows when __int64 is detected as valid. - -2005-03-24 Don Porter - - * README.txt: Update reference to "SC_* macros" to "TEA_* macros". - * tcl.m4: Incorporated recent improvements in SC_PATH_TCLCONFIG - and SC_PATH_TKCONFIG into TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG and TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG. - Corrected search path in TEA_PATH_CONFIG and added - AC_SUBST($1_BIN_DIR) to TEA_LOAD_CONFIG so that packages that load - the configuration of another package can know where they loaded - it from. - -2005-03-18 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): correct 2005-03-17 change to have - variant LD_SEARCH_FLAGS for gcc and cc builds. - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_PROG_WISH): correct x-compile check. - -2005-03-17 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: Correct gcc build and HP-UX-11. - -2005-02-08 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_ADD_LIBS): don't touch lib args starting with -. - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): only define _DLL for CE in shared build. - (TEA_MAKE_LIB): set RANLIB* to : on Windows (it's not needed). - -2005-02-01 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: redo of 2005-01-27 changes to correctly handle paths - with spaces. Win/CE and Win/64 builds now require a prebuilt - tclsh to handle conversion to short pathnames. This is done in - the new TEA_PATH_NOSPACE macro. For Win/CE|64, make CC just the - compiler and move the necessary includes to CFLAGS. - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Add Solaris 64-bit gcc build support. - (TEA_PROG_TCLSH, TEA_PROG_WISH): Allow TCLSH_PROG and WISH_PROG to - be set in the env and prevent resetting. - (TEA_ADD_LIBS): On Windows using GCC (mingw), convert foo.lib - args to -lfoo, for use with mingw. - *** POTENTIAL INCOMPATABILITY *** - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Fix AIX gcc builds to work out-of-box. - Bumped TEA to 3.2. - -2005-01-27 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: remove cygpath calls to support msys. - Update base CE build assumption to "420,ARMV4,ARM,Pocket PC 2003". - Make STLIB_LD use $LINKBIN -lib. - -2005-01-25 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (Darwin): fixed bug with static build linking to dynamic - library in /usr/lib etc instead of linking to static library earlier - in search path. [Tcl Bug 956908] - Removed obsolete references to Rhapsody. - -2004-12-29 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: Updates for VC7 compatibility, fixing CFLAGS and LDFLAGS - options, using better default -O levels. [Bug 1092952, 1091967] - -2004-12-29 Joe English - - * tcl.m4: Do not use ${DBGX} suffix when building - shared libraries [patch #1081595, TIP #34] - -2004-09-07 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): support eVC4 Win/CE builds - -2004-08-10 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_INIT, TEA_PREFIX): update handling of exec_prefix to - work around subdir configures since autoconf only propagates the - prefix (not exec_prefix). - -2004-07-23 Daniel Steffen - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Darwin section: brought inline with - Tcl 8.5 HEAD config, removed core specific & obsolete settings. - -2004-07-22 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_PATH_X): check in TK_DEFS for MAC_OSX_TK to see if - we are compiling on Aqua. Add TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM var that - reflects 'tk windowingsystem' value. - -2004-07-16 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_ENABLE_THREADS): force a threaded build when - building against a threaded core. - (CFLAGS_WARNING): Remove -Wconversion for gcc builds - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Reorder configure.in for better 64-bit build - configuration, replacing EXTRA_CFLAGS with CFLAGS. [Bug #874058] - Update to latest Tcl 8.5 head config settings. - Call this TEA version 3.1. - -2004-04-29 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS): replace AC_TRY_RUN test with - AC_TRY_COMPILE for the long vs. long long check. (kenny) - -2004-04-26 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS): update against core tcl.m4 to - define TCL_WIDE_INT_IS_LONG if 'using long'. - -2004-03-19 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct Windows builds getting LDFLAGS info in MAKE_LIB - -2004-02-11 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct TCL_INCLUDES for private headers on Windows - it - doesn't need the eval. - -2004-02-10 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: don't require TK_INCLUDES and TCL_INCLUDES to have the - DIR_NATIVE vars defined when using private headers on unix. - Allow $... to TEA_ADD_SOURCES for constructs like - TEA_ADD_SOURCES([\$(WIN_OBJECTS)]), that allow the developer to - place more in the Makefile.in. - tkUnixPort.h checks for HAVE_LIMITS_H, so do both HAVE and - CHECK on limits.h - -2003-12-10 Jeff Hobbs - - * Makefile.in: added TEA_ADD_LIBS, TEA_ADD_INCLUDES and - * configure: TEA_ADD_CFLAGS to configurable parameters with - * configure.in: PKG_* equivs in the Makefile. This allows the - * tclconfig/tcl.m4: user to worry less about actual magic VAR names. - Corrected Makefile.in to note that TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES requires - exact file names. - -2003-12-09 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: updated OpenBSD support based on [Patch #775246] (cassoff) - -2003-12-05 Jeff Hobbs - - * configure: - * configure.in: - * Makefile.in (VPATH): readd $(srcdir) to front of VPATH as the - first part of VPATH can get chopped off. - Change .c.$(OBJEXT) rule to .c.@OBJEXT@ to support more makes. - * tclconfig/tcl.m4: add TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES to support libstub - generation and TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES to replace RUNTIME_SOURCES as - the way the user specifies library files. - -2003-12-03 Jeff Hobbs - - * configure: Update of TEA spec to (hopefully) simplify - * configure.in: some aspects of TEA by making use of more - * Makefile.in: AC 2.5x features. Use PACKAGE_NAME (instead - * generic/tclsample.c: of PACKAGE) and PACKAGE_VERSION (instead of - * tclconfig/tcl.m4: VERSION) arguments to AC_INIT as the TEA - package name and version. - Provide a version argument to TEA_INIT - starting with 3.0. - Drop all use of interior shell substs that older makefiles didn't - like. Use PKG_* naming convention instead. - Move specification of source files and public headers into - configure.in with TEA_ADD_SOURCES and TEA_ADD_HEADERS. These will - be munged during ./configure into the right obj file names (no - $(SOURCES:.c=.obj) needed). - There is almost nothing that should be touched in Makefile.in now - for the developer. May want to add a TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES for the - RUNTIME_SOURCES that remains. - Use SHLID_LD_FLAGS (instead of SHLID_LDFLAGS) as Tcl does. - Only specify the user requested LDFLAGS/CFLAGS in the Makefile, - don't mention the _OPTIMIZE/_DEBUG variants. - -2003-10-15 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: create a TEA_SETUP_COMPILER_CC the precedes the - TEA_SETUP_COMPILER macro. They are split so the check for CC - occurs before any use of CC. Also add AC_PROG_CPP to the compiler - checks. - -2003-10-06 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: Updated for autoconf 2.5x prereq. - Where TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE would be __int64, defer to the code checks - in tcl.h, which also handles TCL_LL_MODIFIER* properly. - -2003-04-22 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct default setting of ARCH for WinCE builds. - Correct \ escaping for CE sed macros. - -2003-04-10 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: replace $(syscal) construct with older `syscall` for - systems where sh != bash. - -2003-04-09 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_WITH_CELIB): add --enable-wince and --with-celib - options for Windows/CE compilation support. Requires the - Microsoft eMbedded SDK and Keuchel's celib emulation layer. - -2003-02-18 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_ENABLE_THREADS): Make sure -lpthread gets passed on - the link line when checking for the pthread_attr_setstacksize - symbol. (dejong) - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_SETUP_COMPILER): added default calls to - TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAGS, TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS, - TEA_MISSING_POSIX_HEADERS and TEA_BUGGY_STRTOD. - -2003-02-14 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: correct HP-UX ia64 --enable-64bit build flags - -2003-01-29 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: check $prefix/lib as well as $exec_prefix/lib when - looking for tcl|tkConfig.sh, as this check is done before we would - set exec_prefix when the user does not define it. - -2003-01-21 Mo DeJong - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): Fix build support - for mingw, the previous implementation would - use VC++ when compiling with mingw gcc. Don't - pass -fPIC since gcc always compiles pic code - under win32. Change some hard coded cases - of gcc to ${CC}. - -2002-10-15 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: move the CFLAGS definition from TEA_ENABLE_SHARED to - TEA_MAKE_LIB because setting too early confuses other AC_* macros. - Correct the HP-11 SHLIB_LD_LIBS setting. - - * tcl.m4: add the CFLAGS definition into TEA_ENABLE_SHARED and - make it pick up the env CFLAGS at configure time. - -2002-10-09 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: add --enable-symbols=mem option to enable TCL_MEM_DEBUG. - Improved AIX 64-bit build support, allow it on AIX-4 as well. - Enable 64-bit HP-11 compilation with gcc. - Enable 64-bit IRIX64-6 cc build support. - Correct FreeBSD thread library linkage. - Add OSF1 static build support. - Improve SunOS-5 shared build SHLIB_LD macro. - -2002-07-20 Zoran Vasiljevic - - * tcl.m4: Added MINGW32 to list of systems checked for Windows build. - Also, fixes some indentation issues with "--with-XXX" options. - -2002-04-23 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_ENABLE_THREADS): added USE_THREAD_ALLOC define to - use new threaded allocatory by default on Unix for Tcl 8.4. - (TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS): corrected LD_SEARCH_FLAGS for FreeBSD-3+. - -2002-04-22 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4 (TEA_SETUP_COMPILER): removed call to AC_CYGWIN so that - we can use autoconf 2.5x as well as 2.13. This prevents us from - being able to warn against the use of cygwin gcc at configure - time, but allows autoconf 2.5x, which is what is shipped with most - newer systems. - -2002-04-11 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: Enabled COFF as well as CV style debug info with - --enable-symbols to allow Dr. Watson users to see function info. - More info on debugging levels can be obtained at: - http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/dnvc60/html/gendepdebug.asp - -2002-04-03 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: change all SC_* macros to TEA_*. The SC_ was for - Scriptics, which is no more. TEA represents a better, independent - prefix that won't need changing. - Added preliminary mingw gcc support. [Patch #538772] - Added TEA_PREFIX macro that handles defaulting the prefix and - exec_prefix vars to those used by Tcl if none were specified. - Added TEA_SETUP_COMPILER macro that encompasses the AC_PROG_CC - check and several other basic AC_PROG checks needed for making - executables. This greatly simplifies user's configure.in files. - Collapsed AIX-5 defines into AIX-* with extra checks for doing the - ELF stuff on AIX-5-ia64. - Updated TEA_ENABLE_THREADS to take an optional arg to allow - switching it on by default (for Thread) and add sanity checking to - warn the user if configuring threads incompatibly. - -2002-03-29 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: made sure that SHLIB_LDFLAGS was set to LDFLAGS_DEFAULT. - Removed --enable-64bit support for AIX-4 because it wasn't correct. - Added -MT or -MD Windows linker switches to properly support - symbols-enabled builds. - -2002-03-28 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: called AC_MSG_ERROR when SC_TEA_INIT wasn't called first - instead of calling it as that inlines it each time in shell code. - Changed Windows CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE to use -O2 instead of -Oti. - Noted TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots for Windows builds. - A few changes to support itcl (and perhaps others): - Added support for making your own stub libraries to SC_MAKE_LIB. - New SC_PATH_CONFIG and SC_LOAD_CONFIG that take a package name arg - and find that ${pkg}Config.sh file. itk uses this for itcl. - -2002-03-27 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: made SC_LOAD_TKCONFIG recognize when working with a Tk - build dir setup. - Added EXTRA_CFLAGS and SHLIB_LD_LIBS substs to SC_CONFIG_CFLAGS. - Added XLIBSW onto LIBS when it is defined. - Remove TCL_LIBS from MAKE_LIB and correctly use SHLIB_LD_LIBS - instead to not rely as much on tclConfig.sh cached info. - Add TK_BIN_DIR to paths to find wish in SC_PROG_WISH. - These move towards making TEA much more independent of *Config.sh. - -2002-03-19 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: corrected forgotten (UN)SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX and - SHLIB_SUFFIX defines for Win. - (SC_PATH_X): made this only do the check on unix platforms. - -2002-03-12 Jeff Hobbs - - * README.txt: updated to reflect fewer files - -2002-03-06 Jeff Hobbs - - * config.guess (removed): - * config.sub (removed): removed unnecessary files - - * installFile.tcl (removed): - * mkinstalldirs (removed): these aren't really necessary for - making TEA work - - * tcl.m4 (SC_PUBLIC_TCL_HEADERS, SC_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS): don't - check /usr(/local)/include for includes on Windows when not using - gcc - -2002-03-05 Jeff Hobbs - - * tcl.m4: added warnings on Windows, removed RELPATH define and - added TCL_LIBS to MAKE_LIB macro. - - This import represents 2.0.0, or a new start at attempting to - make TEA much easier for C extension developers. - - **** moved from tclpro project to core tcl project, **** - **** renamed to 'tclconfig' **** - -2001-03-15 Karl Lehenbauer - - * installFile.tcl: Added updating of the modification time of - the target file whether we overwrote it or decided that it - hadn't changed. This was necessary for us to be able to - determine whether or not a module install touched the file. - -2001-03-08 Karl Lehenbauer - - * installFile.tcl: Added support for converting new-style (1.1+) - Cygnus drive paths to Tcl-style. - -2001-01-15 - - * tcl.m4: Added FreeBSD clause. - -2001-01-03 - - * tcl.m4: Fixed typo in SC_LIB_SPEC where it is checking - for exec-prefix. - -2000-12-01 - - * tcl.m4: Concatenated most of the Ajuba acsite.m4 file - so we don't need to modify the autoconf installation. - * config.guess: - * config.sub: - * installFile.tcl: - Added files from the itcl config subdirectory, - which should go away. - -2000-7-29 - - * Fixed the use of TCL_SRC_DIR and TK_SRC_DIR within - TCL_PRIVATE_INCLUDES and TK_PRIVATE_INCLUDES to match their recent - change from $(srcdir) to $(srcdir)/.. diff --git a/tkblt/tclconfig/README.txt b/tkblt/tclconfig/README.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 59b5a3e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tclconfig/README.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,26 +0,0 @@ -These files comprise the basic building blocks for a Tcl Extension -Architecture (TEA) extension. For more information on TEA see: - - http://www.tcl.tk/doc/tea/ - -This package is part of the Tcl project at SourceForge, and latest -sources should be available there: - - http://tcl.sourceforge.net/ - -This package is a freely available open source package. You can do -virtually anything you like with it, such as modifying it, redistributing -it, and selling it either in whole or in part. - -CONTENTS -======== -The following is a short description of the files you will find in -the sample extension. - -README.txt This file - -install-sh Program used for copying binaries and script files - to their install locations. - -tcl.m4 Collection of Tcl autoconf macros. Included by a package's - aclocal.m4 to define TEA_* macros. diff --git a/tkblt/tclconfig/install-sh b/tkblt/tclconfig/install-sh deleted file mode 100755 index 7c34c3f..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tclconfig/install-sh +++ /dev/null @@ -1,528 +0,0 @@ -#!/bin/sh -# install - install a program, script, or datafile - -scriptversion=2011-04-20.01; # UTC - -# This originates from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh), which was -# later released in X11R6 (xc/config/util/install.sh) with the -# following copyright and license. -# -# Copyright (C) 1994 X Consortium -# -# Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy -# of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to -# deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the -# rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or -# sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is -# furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: -# -# The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in -# all copies or substantial portions of the Software. -# -# THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR -# IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, -# FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE -# X CONSORTIUM BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -# AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNEC- -# TION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. -# -# Except as contained in this notice, the name of the X Consortium shall not -# be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other deal- -# ings in this Software without prior written authorization from the X Consor- -# tium. -# -# -# FSF changes to this file are in the public domain. -# -# Calling this script install-sh is preferred over install.sh, to prevent -# `make' implicit rules from creating a file called install from it -# when there is no Makefile. -# -# This script is compatible with the BSD install script, but was written -# from scratch. - -nl=' -' -IFS=" "" $nl" - -# set DOITPROG to echo to test this script - -# Don't use :- since 4.3BSD and earlier shells don't like it. -doit=${DOITPROG-} -if test -z "$doit"; then - doit_exec=exec -else - doit_exec=$doit -fi - -# Put in absolute file names if you don't have them in your path; -# or use environment vars. - -chgrpprog=${CHGRPPROG-chgrp} -chmodprog=${CHMODPROG-chmod} -chownprog=${CHOWNPROG-chown} -cmpprog=${CMPPROG-cmp} -cpprog=${CPPROG-cp} -mkdirprog=${MKDIRPROG-mkdir} -mvprog=${MVPROG-mv} -rmprog=${RMPROG-rm} -stripprog=${STRIPPROG-strip} - -posix_glob='?' -initialize_posix_glob=' - test "$posix_glob" != "?" || { - if (set -f) 2>/dev/null; then - posix_glob= - else - posix_glob=: - fi - } -' - -posix_mkdir= - -# Desired mode of installed file. -mode=0755 - -chgrpcmd= -chmodcmd=$chmodprog -chowncmd= -mvcmd=$mvprog -rmcmd="$rmprog -f" -stripcmd= - -src= -dst= -dir_arg= -dst_arg= - -copy_on_change=false -no_target_directory= - -usage="\ -Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [-T] SRCFILE DSTFILE - or: $0 [OPTION]... SRCFILES... DIRECTORY - or: $0 [OPTION]... -t DIRECTORY SRCFILES... - or: $0 [OPTION]... -d DIRECTORIES... - -In the 1st form, copy SRCFILE to DSTFILE. -In the 2nd and 3rd, copy all SRCFILES to DIRECTORY. -In the 4th, create DIRECTORIES. - -Options: - --help display this help and exit. - --version display version info and exit. - - -c (ignored) - -C install only if different (preserve the last data modification time) - -d create directories instead of installing files. - -g GROUP $chgrpprog installed files to GROUP. - -m MODE $chmodprog installed files to MODE. - -o USER $chownprog installed files to USER. - -s $stripprog installed files. - -S $stripprog installed files. - -t DIRECTORY install into DIRECTORY. - -T report an error if DSTFILE is a directory. - -Environment variables override the default commands: - CHGRPPROG CHMODPROG CHOWNPROG CMPPROG CPPROG MKDIRPROG MVPROG - RMPROG STRIPPROG -" - -while test $# -ne 0; do - case $1 in - -c) ;; - - -C) copy_on_change=true;; - - -d) dir_arg=true;; - - -g) chgrpcmd="$chgrpprog $2" - shift;; - - --help) echo "$usage"; exit $?;; - - -m) mode=$2 - case $mode in - *' '* | *' '* | *' -'* | *'*'* | *'?'* | *'['*) - echo "$0: invalid mode: $mode" >&2 - exit 1;; - esac - shift;; - - -o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2" - shift;; - - -s) stripcmd=$stripprog;; - - -S) stripcmd="$stripprog $2" - shift;; - - -t) dst_arg=$2 - shift;; - - -T) no_target_directory=true;; - - --version) echo "$0 $scriptversion"; exit $?;; - - --) shift - break;; - - -*) echo "$0: invalid option: $1" >&2 - exit 1;; - - *) break;; - esac - shift -done - -if test $# -ne 0 && test -z "$dir_arg$dst_arg"; then - # When -d is used, all remaining arguments are directories to create. - # When -t is used, the destination is already specified. - # Otherwise, the last argument is the destination. Remove it from $@. - for arg - do - if test -n "$dst_arg"; then - # $@ is not empty: it contains at least $arg. - set fnord "$@" "$dst_arg" - shift # fnord - fi - shift # arg - dst_arg=$arg - done -fi - -if test $# -eq 0; then - if test -z "$dir_arg"; then - echo "$0: no input file specified." >&2 - exit 1 - fi - # It's OK to call `install-sh -d' without argument. - # This can happen when creating conditional directories. - exit 0 -fi - -if test -z "$dir_arg"; then - do_exit='(exit $ret); exit $ret' - trap "ret=129; $do_exit" 1 - trap "ret=130; $do_exit" 2 - trap "ret=141; $do_exit" 13 - trap "ret=143; $do_exit" 15 - - # Set umask so as not to create temps with too-generous modes. - # However, 'strip' requires both read and write access to temps. - case $mode in - # Optimize common cases. - *644) cp_umask=133;; - *755) cp_umask=22;; - - *[0-7]) - if test -z "$stripcmd"; then - u_plus_rw= - else - u_plus_rw='% 200' - fi - cp_umask=`expr '(' 777 - $mode % 1000 ')' $u_plus_rw`;; - *) - if test -z "$stripcmd"; then - u_plus_rw= - else - u_plus_rw=,u+rw - fi - cp_umask=$mode$u_plus_rw;; - esac -fi - -for src -do - # Protect names starting with `-'. - case $src in - -*) src=./$src;; - esac - - if test -n "$dir_arg"; then - dst=$src - dstdir=$dst - test -d "$dstdir" - dstdir_status=$? - else - - # Waiting for this to be detected by the "$cpprog $src $dsttmp" command - # might cause directories to be created, which would be especially bad - # if $src (and thus $dsttmp) contains '*'. - if test ! -f "$src" && test ! -d "$src"; then - echo "$0: $src does not exist." >&2 - exit 1 - fi - - if test -z "$dst_arg"; then - echo "$0: no destination specified." >&2 - exit 1 - fi - - dst=$dst_arg - # Protect names starting with `-'. - case $dst in - -*) dst=./$dst;; - esac - - # If destination is a directory, append the input filename; won't work - # if double slashes aren't ignored. - if test -d "$dst"; then - if test -n "$no_target_directory"; then - echo "$0: $dst_arg: Is a directory" >&2 - exit 1 - fi - dstdir=$dst - dst=$dstdir/`basename "$src"` - dstdir_status=0 - else - # Prefer dirname, but fall back on a substitute if dirname fails. - dstdir=` - (dirname "$dst") 2>/dev/null || - expr X"$dst" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \ - X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \ - X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \ - X"$dst" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null || - echo X"$dst" | - sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\/\)$/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - /^X\(\/\).*/{ - s//\1/ - q - } - s/.*/./; q' - ` - - test -d "$dstdir" - dstdir_status=$? - fi - fi - - obsolete_mkdir_used=false - - if test $dstdir_status != 0; then - case $posix_mkdir in - '') - # Create intermediate dirs using mode 755 as modified by the umask. - # This is like FreeBSD 'install' as of 1997-10-28. - umask=`umask` - case $stripcmd.$umask in - # Optimize common cases. - *[2367][2367]) mkdir_umask=$umask;; - .*0[02][02] | .[02][02] | .[02]) mkdir_umask=22;; - - *[0-7]) - mkdir_umask=`expr $umask + 22 \ - - $umask % 100 % 40 + $umask % 20 \ - - $umask % 10 % 4 + $umask % 2 - `;; - *) mkdir_umask=$umask,go-w;; - esac - - # With -d, create the new directory with the user-specified mode. - # Otherwise, rely on $mkdir_umask. - if test -n "$dir_arg"; then - mkdir_mode=-m$mode - else - mkdir_mode= - fi - - posix_mkdir=false - case $umask in - *[123567][0-7][0-7]) - # POSIX mkdir -p sets u+wx bits regardless of umask, which - # is incompatible with FreeBSD 'install' when (umask & 300) != 0. - ;; - *) - tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$ - trap 'ret=$?; rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null; exit $ret' 0 - - if (umask $mkdir_umask && - exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/d") >/dev/null 2>&1 - then - if test -z "$dir_arg" || { - # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m. - # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or - # other-writeable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't. - # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory. - ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"` - case $ls_ld_tmpdir in - d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;; - d????-?--*) different_mode=755;; - *) false;; - esac && - $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$tmpdir" && { - ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"` - test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1" - } - } - then posix_mkdir=: - fi - rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir" - else - # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations. - rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- 2>/dev/null - fi - trap '' 0;; - esac;; - esac - - if - $posix_mkdir && ( - umask $mkdir_umask && - $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir" - ) - then : - else - - # The umask is ridiculous, or mkdir does not conform to POSIX, - # or it failed possibly due to a race condition. Create the - # directory the slow way, step by step, checking for races as we go. - - case $dstdir in - /*) prefix='/';; - -*) prefix='./';; - *) prefix='';; - esac - - eval "$initialize_posix_glob" - - oIFS=$IFS - IFS=/ - $posix_glob set -f - set fnord $dstdir - shift - $posix_glob set +f - IFS=$oIFS - - prefixes= - - for d - do - test -z "$d" && continue - - prefix=$prefix$d - if test -d "$prefix"; then - prefixes= - else - if $posix_mkdir; then - (umask=$mkdir_umask && - $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir") && break - # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently. - test -d "$prefix" || exit 1 - else - case $prefix in - *\'*) qprefix=`echo "$prefix" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;; - *) qprefix=$prefix;; - esac - prefixes="$prefixes '$qprefix'" - fi - fi - prefix=$prefix/ - done - - if test -n "$prefixes"; then - # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently. - (umask $mkdir_umask && - eval "\$doit_exec \$mkdirprog $prefixes") || - test -d "$dstdir" || exit 1 - obsolete_mkdir_used=true - fi - fi - fi - - if test -n "$dir_arg"; then - { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dst"; } && - { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dst"; } && - { test "$obsolete_mkdir_used$chowncmd$chgrpcmd" = false || - test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd $mode "$dst"; } || exit 1 - else - - # Make a couple of temp file names in the proper directory. - dsttmp=$dstdir/_inst.$$_ - rmtmp=$dstdir/_rm.$$_ - - # Trap to clean up those temp files at exit. - trap 'ret=$?; rm -f "$dsttmp" "$rmtmp" && exit $ret' 0 - - # Copy the file name to the temp name. - (umask $cp_umask && $doit_exec $cpprog "$src" "$dsttmp") && - - # and set any options; do chmod last to preserve setuid bits. - # - # If any of these fail, we abort the whole thing. If we want to - # ignore errors from any of these, just make sure not to ignore - # errors from the above "$doit $cpprog $src $dsttmp" command. - # - { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dsttmp"; } && - { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dsttmp"; } && - { test -z "$stripcmd" || $doit $stripcmd "$dsttmp"; } && - { test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd $mode "$dsttmp"; } && - - # If -C, don't bother to copy if it wouldn't change the file. - if $copy_on_change && - old=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dst" 2>/dev/null` && - new=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dsttmp" 2>/dev/null` && - - eval "$initialize_posix_glob" && - $posix_glob set -f && - set X $old && old=:$2:$4:$5:$6 && - set X $new && new=:$2:$4:$5:$6 && - $posix_glob set +f && - - test "$old" = "$new" && - $cmpprog "$dst" "$dsttmp" >/dev/null 2>&1 - then - rm -f "$dsttmp" - else - # Rename the file to the real destination. - $doit $mvcmd -f "$dsttmp" "$dst" 2>/dev/null || - - # The rename failed, perhaps because mv can't rename something else - # to itself, or perhaps because mv is so ancient that it does not - # support -f. - { - # Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location. - # We try this two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some - # systems and the destination file might be busy for other - # reasons. In this case, the final cleanup might fail but the new - # file should still install successfully. - { - test ! -f "$dst" || - $doit $rmcmd -f "$dst" 2>/dev/null || - { $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null && - { $doit $rmcmd -f "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; } - } || - { echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dst" >&2 - (exit 1); exit 1 - } - } && - - # Now rename the file to the real destination. - $doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dst" - } - fi || exit 1 - - trap '' 0 - fi -done - -# Local variables: -# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) -# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion=" -# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" -# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC" -# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC" -# End: diff --git a/tkblt/tclconfig/tcl.m4 b/tkblt/tclconfig/tcl.m4 deleted file mode 100644 index 655be25..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tclconfig/tcl.m4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,4176 +0,0 @@ -# tcl.m4 -- -# -# This file provides a set of autoconf macros to help TEA-enable -# a Tcl extension. -# -# Copyright (c) 1999-2000 Ajuba Solutions. -# Copyright (c) 2002-2005 ActiveState Corporation. -# -# See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution -# of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. - -AC_PREREQ(2.57) - -# Possible values for key variables defined: -# -# TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM - win32 aqua x11 (mirrors 'tk windowingsystem') -# TEA_PLATFORM - windows unix -# TEA_TK_EXTENSION - True if this is a Tk extension -# - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG -- -# -# Locate the tclConfig.sh file and perform a sanity check on -# the Tcl compile flags -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --with-tcl=... -# -# Defines the following vars: -# TCL_BIN_DIR Full path to the directory containing -# the tclConfig.sh file -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_TCLCONFIG], [ - dnl TEA specific: Make sure we are initialized - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_INIT]) - # - # Ok, lets find the tcl configuration - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tcl - # - - if test x"${no_tcl}" = x ; then - # we reset no_tcl in case something fails here - no_tcl=true - AC_ARG_WITH(tcl, - AC_HELP_STRING([--with-tcl], - [directory containing tcl configuration (tclConfig.sh)]), - with_tclconfig="${withval}") - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tcl configuration]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tclconfig,[ - - # First check to see if --with-tcl was specified. - if test x"${with_tclconfig}" != x ; then - case "${with_tclconfig}" in - */tclConfig.sh ) - if test -f "${with_tclconfig}"; then - AC_MSG_WARN([--with-tcl argument should refer to directory containing tclConfig.sh, not to tclConfig.sh itself]) - with_tclconfig="`echo "${with_tclconfig}" | sed 's!/tclConfig\.sh$!!'`" - fi ;; - esac - if test -f "${with_tclconfig}/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd "${with_tclconfig}"; pwd)`" - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tclconfig} directory doesn't contain tclConfig.sh]) - fi - fi - - # then check for a private Tcl installation - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../../tcl \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # on Darwin, check in Framework installation locations - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin" -a x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ~/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Network/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /System/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Network/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/System/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/Tcl.framework/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/Tcl.framework; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # TEA specific: on Windows, check in common installation locations - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d C:/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d C:/Progra~1/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few common install locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${exec_prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/pkg/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tcl8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tcl8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few other private locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ${srcdir}/../tcl \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tcl[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tclConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" = x ; then - TCL_BIN_DIR="# no Tcl configs found" - AC_MSG_ERROR([Can't find Tcl configuration definitions. Use --with-tcl to specify a directory containing tclConfig.sh]) - else - no_tcl= - TCL_BIN_DIR="${ac_cv_c_tclconfig}" - AC_MSG_RESULT([found ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh]) - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG -- -# -# Locate the tkConfig.sh file -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --with-tk=... -# -# Defines the following vars: -# TK_BIN_DIR Full path to the directory containing -# the tkConfig.sh file -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_TKCONFIG], [ - # - # Ok, lets find the tk configuration - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-tk - # - - if test x"${no_tk}" = x ; then - # we reset no_tk in case something fails here - no_tk=true - AC_ARG_WITH(tk, - AC_HELP_STRING([--with-tk], - [directory containing tk configuration (tkConfig.sh)]), - with_tkconfig="${withval}") - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tk configuration]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tkconfig,[ - - # First check to see if --with-tkconfig was specified. - if test x"${with_tkconfig}" != x ; then - case "${with_tkconfig}" in - */tkConfig.sh ) - if test -f "${with_tkconfig}"; then - AC_MSG_WARN([--with-tk argument should refer to directory containing tkConfig.sh, not to tkConfig.sh itself]) - with_tkconfig="`echo "${with_tkconfig}" | sed 's!/tkConfig\.sh$!!'`" - fi ;; - esac - if test -f "${with_tkconfig}/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd "${with_tkconfig}"; pwd)`" - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tkconfig} directory doesn't contain tkConfig.sh]) - fi - fi - - # then check for a private Tk library - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../tk \ - `ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../tk \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../../tk \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # on Darwin, check in Framework installation locations - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin" -a x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ~/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Network/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /System/Library/Frameworks 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/Network/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /Applications/Xcode.app/Contents/Developer/Platforms/MacOSX.platform/Developer/SDKs/MacOSX.sdk/System/Library/Frameworks/Tcl.framework 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/Tk.framework/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/Tk.framework; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few common install locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${exec_prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/pkg/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tk8.6 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib/tcl/tk8.5 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # TEA specific: on Windows, check in common installation locations - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d C:/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d C:/Progra~1/Tcl/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few other private locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ${srcdir}/../tk \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../tk[[8-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` ; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" \ - -a -f "$i/win/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/win; pwd)`" - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/tkConfig.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkconfig="`(cd $i/unix; pwd)`" - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" = x ; then - TK_BIN_DIR="# no Tk configs found" - AC_MSG_ERROR([Can't find Tk configuration definitions. Use --with-tk to specify a directory containing tkConfig.sh]) - else - no_tk= - TK_BIN_DIR="${ac_cv_c_tkconfig}" - AC_MSG_RESULT([found ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh]) - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG -- -# -# Load the tclConfig.sh file -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires the following vars to be set: -# TCL_BIN_DIR -# -# Results: -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TCL_BIN_DIR -# TCL_SRC_DIR -# TCL_LIB_FILE -# TCL_ZIP_FILE -# TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for existence of ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh]) - - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([loading]) - . "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh" - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([could not find ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclConfig.sh]) - fi - - # eval is required to do the TCL_DBGX substitution - eval "TCL_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_LIB_FILE}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}\"" - - # If the TCL_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), - # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. - # For example, the variable TCL_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value - # of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of TCL_LIB_SPEC - # instead of TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an - # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - TCL_LIB_SPEC="${TCL_BUILD_LIB_SPEC}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC="${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TCL_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH}" - elif test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use the libraries - # from the framework at the given location so that linking works - # against Tcl.framework installed in an arbitrary location. - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_LIB_FILE}"; then - for i in "`cd "${TCL_BIN_DIR}"; pwd`" \ - "`cd "${TCL_BIN_DIR}"/../..; pwd`"; do - if test "`basename "$i"`" = "${TCL_LIB_FILE}.framework"; then - TCL_LIB_SPEC="-F`dirname "$i" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` -framework ${TCL_LIB_FILE}" - break - fi - done - fi - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}"; then - TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`echo "${TCL_BIN_DIR}" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` ${TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - TCL_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - fi - ;; - esac - fi - - # eval is required to do the TCL_DBGX substitution - eval "TCL_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TCL_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_LIB_SPEC}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC=\"${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC}\"" - - AC_SUBST(TCL_VERSION) - AC_SUBST(TCL_PATCH_LEVEL) - AC_SUBST(TCL_BIN_DIR) - AC_SUBST(TCL_SRC_DIR) - - AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_FLAG) - AC_SUBST(TCL_LIB_SPEC) - - AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_FLAG) - AC_SUBST(TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC) - - AC_MSG_CHECKING([platform]) - hold_cc=$CC; CC="$TCL_CC" - AC_TRY_COMPILE(,[ - #ifdef _WIN32 - #error win32 - #endif - ], [ - TEA_PLATFORM="unix" - CYGPATH=echo - ], [ - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - AC_CHECK_PROG(CYGPATH, cygpath, cygpath -m, echo) ] - ) - CC=$hold_cc - AC_MSG_RESULT($TEA_PLATFORM) - - # The BUILD_$pkg is to define the correct extern storage class - # handling when making this package - AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(BUILD_${PACKAGE_NAME}, [], - [Building extension source?]) - # Do this here as we have fully defined TEA_PLATFORM now - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - EXEEXT=".exe" - CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES *.lib *.dll *.pdb *.exp" - fi - - # TEA specific: - AC_SUBST(CLEANFILES) - AC_SUBST(TCL_LIBS) - AC_SUBST(TCL_DEFS) - AC_SUBST(TCL_EXTRA_CFLAGS) - AC_SUBST(TCL_LD_FLAGS) - AC_SUBST(TCL_SHLIB_LD_LIBS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG -- -# -# Load the tkConfig.sh file -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires the following vars to be set: -# TK_BIN_DIR -# -# Results: -# -# Sets the following vars that should be in tkConfig.sh: -# TK_BIN_DIR -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for existence of ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh]) - - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([loading]) - . "${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh" - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([could not find ${TK_BIN_DIR}/tkConfig.sh]) - fi - - # eval is required to do the TK_DBGX substitution - eval "TK_LIB_FILE=\"${TK_LIB_FILE}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_FILE=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}\"" - - # If the TK_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), - # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. - # For example, the variable TK_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value - # of TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of TK_LIB_SPEC - # instead of TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an - # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - TK_LIB_SPEC="${TK_BUILD_LIB_SPEC}" - TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC="${TK_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - TK_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TK_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH}" - elif test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use the libraries - # from the framework at the given location so that linking works - # against Tk.framework installed in an arbitrary location. - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_LIB_FILE}"; then - for i in "`cd "${TK_BIN_DIR}"; pwd`" \ - "`cd "${TK_BIN_DIR}"/../..; pwd`"; do - if test "`basename "$i"`" = "${TK_LIB_FILE}.framework"; then - TK_LIB_SPEC="-F`dirname "$i" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` -framework ${TK_LIB_FILE}" - break - fi - done - fi - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}"; then - TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L` echo "${TK_BIN_DIR}" | sed -e 's/ /\\\\ /g'` ${TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - TK_STUB_LIB_PATH="${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - fi - ;; - esac - fi - - # eval is required to do the TK_DBGX substitution - eval "TK_LIB_FLAG=\"${TK_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TK_LIB_SPEC=\"${TK_LIB_SPEC}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG}\"" - eval "TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC=\"${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}\"" - - # TEA specific: Ensure windowingsystem is defined - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" ; then - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *MAC_OSX_TK*) - AC_DEFINE(MAC_OSX_TK, 1, [Are we building against Mac OS X TkAqua?]) - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="aqua" - ;; - *) - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="x11" - ;; - esac - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM="win32" - fi - - AC_SUBST(TK_VERSION) - AC_SUBST(TK_BIN_DIR) - AC_SUBST(TK_SRC_DIR) - - AC_SUBST(TK_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST(TK_LIB_FLAG) - AC_SUBST(TK_LIB_SPEC) - - AC_SUBST(TK_STUB_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST(TK_STUB_LIB_FLAG) - AC_SUBST(TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC) - - # TEA specific: - AC_SUBST(TK_LIBS) - AC_SUBST(TK_XINCLUDES) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PROG_TCLSH -# Determine the fully qualified path name of the tclsh executable -# in the Tcl build directory or the tclsh installed in a bin -# directory. This macro will correctly determine the name -# of the tclsh executable even if tclsh has not yet been -# built in the build directory. The tclsh found is always -# associated with a tclConfig.sh file. This tclsh should be used -# only for running extension test cases. It should never be -# or generation of files (like pkgIndex.tcl) at build time. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TCLSH_PROG -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PROG_TCLSH], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for tclsh]) - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - # tclConfig.sh is in Tcl build directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" ; then - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" - fi - else - TCLSH_PROG="${TCL_BIN_DIR}/tclsh" - fi - else - # tclConfig.sh is in install location - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TCLSH_PROG="tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - else - TCLSH_PROG="tclsh${TCL_MAJOR_VERSION}.${TCL_MINOR_VERSION}${TCL_DBGX}" - fi - list="`ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../bin 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/.. 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/bin 2>/dev/null`" - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/${TCLSH_PROG}" ; then - REAL_TCL_BIN_DIR="`cd "$i"; pwd`/" - break - fi - done - TCLSH_PROG="${REAL_TCL_BIN_DIR}${TCLSH_PROG}" - fi - AC_MSG_RESULT([${TCLSH_PROG}]) - AC_SUBST(TCLSH_PROG) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PROG_WISH -# Determine the fully qualified path name of the wish executable -# in the Tk build directory or the wish installed in a bin -# directory. This macro will correctly determine the name -# of the wish executable even if wish has not yet been -# built in the build directory. The wish found is always -# associated with a tkConfig.sh file. This wish should be used -# only for running extension test cases. It should never be -# or generation of files (like pkgIndex.tcl) at build time. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -# WISH_PROG -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PROG_WISH], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for wish]) - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - # tkConfig.sh is in Tk build directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}s${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}$s{EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}t${EXEEXT}" - elif test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" ; then - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}st${EXEEXT}" - fi - else - WISH_PROG="${TK_BIN_DIR}/wish" - fi - else - # tkConfig.sh is in install location - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - WISH_PROG="wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}${EXEEXT}" - else - WISH_PROG="wish${TK_MAJOR_VERSION}.${TK_MINOR_VERSION}${TK_DBGX}" - fi - list="`ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/../bin 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/.. 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_PREFIX}/bin 2>/dev/null`" - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/${WISH_PROG}" ; then - REAL_TK_BIN_DIR="`cd "$i"; pwd`/" - break - fi - done - WISH_PROG="${REAL_TK_BIN_DIR}${WISH_PROG}" - fi - AC_MSG_RESULT([${WISH_PROG}]) - AC_SUBST(WISH_PROG) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ENABLE_SHARED -- -# -# Allows the building of shared libraries -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --enable-shared=yes|no -# --enable-stubs=yes|no -# -# Defines the following vars: -# STATIC_BUILD Used for building import/export libraries -# on Windows. -# -# Sets the following vars: -# SHARED_BUILD Value of 1 or 0 -# STUBS_BUILD Value if 1 or 0 -# USE_TCL_STUBS Value true: if SHARED_BUILD or --enable-stubs -# USE_TCLOO_STUBS Value true: if SHARED_BUILD or --enable-stubs -# USE_TK_STUBS Value true: if SHARED_BUILD or --enable-stubs -# AND TEA_WINDOWING_SYSTEM != "" -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ENABLE_SHARED], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([how to build libraries]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(shared, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-shared], - [build and link with shared libraries (default: on)]), - [shared_ok=$enableval], [shared_ok=yes]) - - if test "${enable_shared+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_shared" - shared_ok=$enableval - else - shared_ok=yes - fi - - AC_ARG_ENABLE(stubs, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-stubs], - [build and link with stub libraries. Always true for shared builds (default: on)]), - [stubs_ok=$enableval], [stubs_ok=yes]) - - if test "${enable_stubs+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_stubs" - stubs_ok=$enableval - else - stubs_ok=yes - fi - - # Stubs are always enabled for shared builds - if test "$shared_ok" = "yes" ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([shared]) - SHARED_BUILD=1 - STUBS_BUILD=1 - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([static]) - SHARED_BUILD=0 - AC_DEFINE(STATIC_BUILD, 1, [This a static build]) - if test "$stubs_ok" = "yes" ; then - STUBS_BUILD=1 - else - STUBS_BUILD=0 - fi - fi - if test "${STUBS_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - AC_DEFINE(USE_TCL_STUBS, 1, [Use Tcl stubs]) - AC_DEFINE(USE_TCLOO_STUBS, 1, [Use TclOO stubs]) - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != ""; then - AC_DEFINE(USE_TK_STUBS, 1, [Use Tk stubs]) - fi - fi - - AC_SUBST(SHARED_BUILD) - AC_SUBST(STUBS_BUILD) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ENABLE_THREADS -- -# -# Specify if thread support should be enabled. If "yes" is specified -# as an arg (optional), threads are enabled by default, "no" means -# threads are disabled. "yes" is the default. -# -# TCL_THREADS is checked so that if you are compiling an extension -# against a threaded core, your extension must be compiled threaded -# as well. -# -# Note that it is legal to have a thread enabled extension run in a -# threaded or non-threaded Tcl core, but a non-threaded extension may -# only run in a non-threaded Tcl core. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --enable-threads -# -# Sets the following vars: -# THREADS_LIBS Thread library(s) -# -# Defines the following vars: -# TCL_THREADS -# _REENTRANT -# _THREAD_SAFE -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ENABLE_THREADS], [ - AC_ARG_ENABLE(threads, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-threads], - [build with threads (default: on)]), - [tcl_ok=$enableval], [tcl_ok=yes]) - - if test "${enable_threads+set}" = set; then - enableval="$enable_threads" - tcl_ok=$enableval - else - tcl_ok=yes - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes" -o "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1; then - TCL_THREADS=1 - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" ; then - # We are always OK on Windows, so check what this platform wants: - - # USE_THREAD_ALLOC tells us to try the special thread-based - # allocator that significantly reduces lock contention - AC_DEFINE(USE_THREAD_ALLOC, 1, - [Do we want to use the threaded memory allocator?]) - AC_DEFINE(_REENTRANT, 1, [Do we want the reentrant OS API?]) - if test "`uname -s`" = "SunOS" ; then - AC_DEFINE(_POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS, 1, - [Do we really want to follow the standard? Yes we do!]) - fi - AC_DEFINE(_THREAD_SAFE, 1, [Do we want the thread-safe OS API?]) - AC_CHECK_LIB(pthread,pthread_mutex_init,tcl_ok=yes,tcl_ok=no) - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - # Check a little harder for __pthread_mutex_init in the same - # library, as some systems hide it there until pthread.h is - # defined. We could alternatively do an AC_TRY_COMPILE with - # pthread.h, but that will work with libpthread really doesn't - # exist, like AIX 4.2. [Bug: 4359] - AC_CHECK_LIB(pthread, __pthread_mutex_init, - tcl_ok=yes, tcl_ok=no) - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -lpthread" - else - AC_CHECK_LIB(pthreads, pthread_mutex_init, - tcl_ok=yes, tcl_ok=no) - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -lpthreads" - else - AC_CHECK_LIB(c, pthread_mutex_init, - tcl_ok=yes, tcl_ok=no) - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - AC_CHECK_LIB(c_r, pthread_mutex_init, - tcl_ok=yes, tcl_ok=no) - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - # The space is needed - THREADS_LIBS=" -pthread" - else - TCL_THREADS=0 - AC_MSG_WARN([Do not know how to find pthread lib on your system - thread support disabled]) - fi - fi - fi - fi - fi - else - TCL_THREADS=0 - fi - # Do checking message here to not mess up interleaved configure output - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for building with threads]) - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1; then - AC_DEFINE(TCL_THREADS, 1, [Are we building with threads enabled?]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([yes (default)]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([no]) - fi - # TCL_THREADS sanity checking. See if our request for building with - # threads is the same as the way Tcl was built. If not, warn the user. - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *THREADS=1*) - if test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "0"; then - AC_MSG_WARN([ - Building ${PACKAGE_NAME} without threads enabled, but building against Tcl - that IS thread-enabled. It is recommended to use --enable-threads.]) - fi - ;; - esac - AC_SUBST(TCL_THREADS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ENABLE_SYMBOLS -- -# -# Specify if debugging symbols should be used. -# Memory (TCL_MEM_DEBUG) debugging can also be enabled. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# TEA varies from core Tcl in that C|LDFLAGS_DEFAULT receives -# the value of C|LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE|DEBUG already substituted. -# Requires the following vars to be set in the Makefile: -# CFLAGS_DEFAULT -# LDFLAGS_DEFAULT -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --enable-symbols -# -# Defines the following vars: -# CFLAGS_DEFAULT Sets to $(CFLAGS_DEBUG) if true -# Sets to "$(CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE) -DNDEBUG" if false -# LDFLAGS_DEFAULT Sets to $(LDFLAGS_DEBUG) if true -# Sets to $(LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE) if false -# DBGX Formerly used as debug library extension; -# always blank now. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ENABLE_SYMBOLS], [ - dnl TEA specific: Make sure we are initialized - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS]) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for build with symbols]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(symbols, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-symbols], - [build with debugging symbols (default: off)]), - [tcl_ok=$enableval], [tcl_ok=no]) - DBGX="" - if test "$tcl_ok" = "no"; then - CFLAGS_DEFAULT="${CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE} -DNDEBUG" - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE}" - AC_MSG_RESULT([no]) - else - CFLAGS_DEFAULT="${CFLAGS_DEBUG}" - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS_DEBUG}" - if test "$tcl_ok" = "yes"; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([yes (standard debugging)]) - fi - fi - # TEA specific: - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" ; then - LDFLAGS_DEFAULT="${LDFLAGS}" - fi - AC_SUBST(CFLAGS_DEFAULT) - AC_SUBST(LDFLAGS_DEFAULT) - AC_SUBST(TCL_DBGX) - - if test "$tcl_ok" = "mem" -o "$tcl_ok" = "all"; then - AC_DEFINE(TCL_MEM_DEBUG, 1, [Is memory debugging enabled?]) - fi - - if test "$tcl_ok" != "yes" -a "$tcl_ok" != "no"; then - if test "$tcl_ok" = "all"; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([enabled symbols mem debugging]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([enabled $tcl_ok debugging]) - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ENABLE_LANGINFO -- -# -# Allows use of modern nl_langinfo check for better l10n. -# This is only relevant for Unix. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --enable-langinfo=yes|no (default is yes) -# -# Defines the following vars: -# HAVE_LANGINFO Triggers use of nl_langinfo if defined. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ENABLE_LANGINFO], [ - AC_ARG_ENABLE(langinfo, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-langinfo], - [use nl_langinfo if possible to determine encoding at startup, otherwise use old heuristic (default: on)]), - [langinfo_ok=$enableval], [langinfo_ok=yes]) - - HAVE_LANGINFO=0 - if test "$langinfo_ok" = "yes"; then - AC_CHECK_HEADER(langinfo.h,[langinfo_ok=yes],[langinfo_ok=no]) - fi - AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether to use nl_langinfo]) - if test "$langinfo_ok" = "yes"; then - AC_CACHE_VAL(tcl_cv_langinfo_h, [ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ], [nl_langinfo(CODESET);], - [tcl_cv_langinfo_h=yes],[tcl_cv_langinfo_h=no])]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([$tcl_cv_langinfo_h]) - if test $tcl_cv_langinfo_h = yes; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LANGINFO, 1, [Do we have nl_langinfo()?]) - fi - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([$langinfo_ok]) - fi -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_CONFIG_SYSTEM -# -# Determine what the system is (some things cannot be easily checked -# on a feature-driven basis, alas). This can usually be done via the -# "uname" command. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Defines the following var: -# -# system - System/platform/version identification code. -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_CONFIG_SYSTEM], [ - AC_CACHE_CHECK([system version], tcl_cv_sys_version, [ - # TEA specific: - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=windows - else - tcl_cv_sys_version=`uname -s`-`uname -r` - if test "$?" -ne 0 ; then - AC_MSG_WARN([can't find uname command]) - tcl_cv_sys_version=unknown - else - if test "`uname -s`" = "AIX" ; then - tcl_cv_sys_version=AIX-`uname -v`.`uname -r` - fi - fi - fi - ]) - system=$tcl_cv_sys_version -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS -# -# Try to determine the proper flags to pass to the compiler -# for building shared libraries and other such nonsense. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substitutes the following vars: -# -# DL_OBJS, DL_LIBS - removed for TEA, only needed by core. -# LDFLAGS - Flags to pass to the compiler when linking object -# files into an executable application binary such -# as tclsh. -# LD_SEARCH_FLAGS-Flags to pass to ld, such as "-R /usr/local/tcl/lib", -# that tell the run-time dynamic linker where to look -# for shared libraries such as libtcl.so. Depends on -# the variable LIB_RUNTIME_DIR in the Makefile. Could -# be the same as CC_SEARCH_FLAGS if ${CC} is used to link. -# CC_SEARCH_FLAGS-Flags to pass to ${CC}, such as "-Wl,-rpath,/usr/local/tcl/lib", -# that tell the run-time dynamic linker where to look -# for shared libraries such as libtcl.so. Depends on -# the variable LIB_RUNTIME_DIR in the Makefile. -# SHLIB_CFLAGS - Flags to pass to cc when compiling the components -# of a shared library (may request position-independent -# code, among other things). -# SHLIB_LD - Base command to use for combining object files -# into a shared library. -# SHLIB_LD_LIBS - Dependent libraries for the linker to scan when -# creating shared libraries. This symbol typically -# goes at the end of the "ld" commands that build -# shared libraries. The value of the symbol defaults to -# "${LIBS}" if all of the dependent libraries should -# be specified when creating a shared library. If -# dependent libraries should not be specified (as on -# SunOS 4.x, where they cause the link to fail, or in -# general if Tcl and Tk aren't themselves shared -# libraries), then this symbol has an empty string -# as its value. -# SHLIB_SUFFIX - Suffix to use for the names of dynamically loadable -# extensions. An empty string means we don't know how -# to use shared libraries on this platform. -# LIB_SUFFIX - Specifies everything that comes after the "libfoo" -# in a static or shared library name, using the $PACKAGE_VERSION variable -# to put the version in the right place. This is used -# by platforms that need non-standard library names. -# Examples: ${PACKAGE_VERSION}.so.1.1 on NetBSD, since it needs -# to have a version after the .so, and ${PACKAGE_VERSION}.a -# on AIX, since a shared library needs to have -# a .a extension whereas shared objects for loadable -# extensions have a .so extension. Defaults to -# ${PACKAGE_VERSION}${SHLIB_SUFFIX}. -# CFLAGS_DEBUG - -# Flags used when running the compiler in debug mode -# CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE - -# Flags used when running the compiler in optimize mode -# CFLAGS - Additional CFLAGS added as necessary (usually 64-bit) -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS], [ - dnl TEA specific: Make sure we are initialized - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_INIT]) - - # Step 0.a: Enable 64 bit support? - - AC_MSG_CHECKING([if 64bit support is requested]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(64bit, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-64bit], - [enable 64bit support (default: off)]), - [do64bit=$enableval], [do64bit=no]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([$do64bit]) - - # Step 0.b: Enable Solaris 64 bit VIS support? - - AC_MSG_CHECKING([if 64bit Sparc VIS support is requested]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(64bit-vis, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-64bit-vis], - [enable 64bit Sparc VIS support (default: off)]), - [do64bitVIS=$enableval], [do64bitVIS=no]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([$do64bitVIS]) - # Force 64bit on with VIS - AS_IF([test "$do64bitVIS" = "yes"], [do64bit=yes]) - - # Step 0.c: Check if visibility support is available. Do this here so - # that platform specific alternatives can be used below if this fails. - - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if compiler supports visibility "hidden"], - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden, [ - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS; CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -Werror" - AC_TRY_LINK([ - extern __attribute__((__visibility__("hidden"))) void f(void); - void f(void) {}], [f();], tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=yes, - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=no) - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden = yes], [ - AC_DEFINE(MODULE_SCOPE, - [extern __attribute__((__visibility__("hidden")))], - [Compiler support for module scope symbols]) - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_HIDDEN, [1], [Compiler support for module scope symbols]) - ]) - - # Step 0.d: Disable -rpath support? - - AC_MSG_CHECKING([if rpath support is requested]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(rpath, - AC_HELP_STRING([--disable-rpath], - [disable rpath support (default: on)]), - [doRpath=$enableval], [doRpath=yes]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([$doRpath]) - - # TEA specific: Cross-compiling options for Windows/CE builds? - - AS_IF([test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = windows], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([if Windows/CE build is requested]) - AC_ARG_ENABLE(wince, - AC_HELP_STRING([--enable-wince], - [enable Win/CE support (where applicable)]), - [doWince=$enableval], [doWince=no]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([$doWince]) - ]) - - # Set the variable "system" to hold the name and version number - # for the system. - - TEA_CONFIG_SYSTEM - - # Require ranlib early so we can override it in special cases below. - - AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB]) - - # Set configuration options based on system name and version. - # This is similar to Tcl's unix/tcl.m4 except that we've added a - # "windows" case and removed some core-only vars. - - do64bit_ok=no - # default to '{$LIBS}' and set to "" on per-platform necessary basis - SHLIB_LD_LIBS='${LIBS}' - # When ld needs options to work in 64-bit mode, put them in - # LDFLAGS_ARCH so they eventually end up in LDFLAGS even if [load] - # is disabled by the user. [Bug 1016796] - LDFLAGS_ARCH="" - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX="" - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - TCL_TRIM_DOTS='`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`' - ECHO_VERSION='`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION}`' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=ok - CFLAGS_DEBUG=-g - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-O2 - CFLAGS_WARNING="-Wall" - ], [ - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-O - CFLAGS_WARNING="" - ]) - AC_CHECK_TOOL(AR, ar) - STLIB_LD='${AR} cr' - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LD_LIBRARY_PATH" - AS_IF([test "x$SHLIB_VERSION" = x],[SHLIB_VERSION=""],[SHLIB_VERSION=".$SHLIB_VERSION"]) - case $system in - # TEA specific: - windows) - # This is a 2-stage check to make sure we have the 64-bit SDK - # We have to know where the SDK is installed. - # This magic is based on MS Platform SDK for Win2003 SP1 - hobbs - # MACHINE is IX86 for LINK, but this is used by the manifest, - # which requires x86|amd64|ia64. - MACHINE="X86" - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - if test "x${MSSDK}x" = "xx" ; then - MSSDK="C:/Progra~1/Microsoft Platform SDK" - fi - MSSDK=`echo "$MSSDK" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - PATH64="" - case "$do64bit" in - amd64|x64|yes) - MACHINE="AMD64" ; # default to AMD64 64-bit build - PATH64="${MSSDK}/Bin/Win64/x86/AMD64" - ;; - ia64) - MACHINE="IA64" - PATH64="${MSSDK}/Bin/Win64" - ;; - esac - if test "$GCC" != "yes" -a ! -d "${PATH64}" ; then - AC_MSG_WARN([Could not find 64-bit $MACHINE SDK to enable 64bit mode]) - AC_MSG_WARN([Ensure latest Platform SDK is installed]) - do64bit="no" - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([ Using 64-bit $MACHINE mode]) - do64bit_ok="yes" - fi - fi - - if test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([Windows/CE and 64-bit builds incompatible]) - fi - if test "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([Windows/CE and GCC builds incompatible]) - fi - TEA_PATH_CELIB - # Set defaults for common evc4/PPC2003 setup - # Currently Tcl requires 300+, possibly 420+ for sockets - CEVERSION=420; # could be 211 300 301 400 420 ... - TARGETCPU=ARMV4; # could be ARMV4 ARM MIPS SH3 X86 ... - ARCH=ARM; # could be ARM MIPS X86EM ... - PLATFORM="Pocket PC 2003"; # or "Pocket PC 2002" - if test "$doWince" != "yes"; then - # If !yes then the user specified something - # Reset ARCH to allow user to skip specifying it - ARCH= - eval `echo $doWince | awk -F, '{ \ - if (length([$]1)) { printf "CEVERSION=\"%s\"\n", [$]1; \ - if ([$]1 < 400) { printf "PLATFORM=\"Pocket PC 2002\"\n" } }; \ - if (length([$]2)) { printf "TARGETCPU=\"%s\"\n", toupper([$]2) }; \ - if (length([$]3)) { printf "ARCH=\"%s\"\n", toupper([$]3) }; \ - if (length([$]4)) { printf "PLATFORM=\"%s\"\n", [$]4 }; \ - }'` - if test "x${ARCH}" = "x" ; then - ARCH=$TARGETCPU; - fi - fi - OSVERSION=WCE$CEVERSION; - if test "x${WCEROOT}" = "x" ; then - WCEROOT="C:/Program Files/Microsoft eMbedded C++ 4.0" - if test ! -d "${WCEROOT}" ; then - WCEROOT="C:/Program Files/Microsoft eMbedded Tools" - fi - fi - if test "x${SDKROOT}" = "x" ; then - SDKROOT="C:/Program Files/Windows CE Tools" - if test ! -d "${SDKROOT}" ; then - SDKROOT="C:/Windows CE Tools" - fi - fi - WCEROOT=`echo "$WCEROOT" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - SDKROOT=`echo "$SDKROOT" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - if test ! -d "${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/Lib/${TARGETCPU}" \ - -o ! -d "${WCEROOT}/EVC/${OSVERSION}/bin"; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([could not find PocketPC SDK or target compiler to enable WinCE mode [$CEVERSION,$TARGETCPU,$ARCH,$PLATFORM]]) - doWince="no" - else - # We could PATH_NOSPACE these, but that's not important, - # as long as we quote them when used. - CEINCLUDE="${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/include" - if test -d "${CEINCLUDE}/${TARGETCPU}" ; then - CEINCLUDE="${CEINCLUDE}/${TARGETCPU}" - fi - CELIBPATH="${SDKROOT}/${OSVERSION}/${PLATFORM}/Lib/${TARGETCPU}" - fi - fi - - if test "$GCC" != "yes" ; then - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "0" ; then - runtime=-MT - else - runtime=-MD - fi - case "x`echo \${VisualStudioVersion}`" in - x1[[4-9]]*) - lflags="${lflags} -nodefaultlib:libucrt.lib" - TEA_ADD_LIBS([ucrt.lib]) - ;; - *) - ;; - esac - - if test "$do64bit" != "no" ; then - # All this magic is necessary for the Win64 SDK RC1 - hobbs - CC="\"${PATH64}/cl.exe\"" - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} -I\"${MSSDK}/Include\" -I\"${MSSDK}/Include/crt\" -I\"${MSSDK}/Include/crt/sys\"" - RC="\"${MSSDK}/bin/rc.exe\"" - lflags="${lflags} -nologo -MACHINE:${MACHINE} -LIBPATH:\"${MSSDK}/Lib/${MACHINE}\"" - LINKBIN="\"${PATH64}/link.exe\"" - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Zi -Od -W3 ${runtime}d" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -O2 -W2 ${runtime}" - # Avoid 'unresolved external symbol __security_cookie' - # errors, c.f. http://support.microsoft.com/?id=894573 - TEA_ADD_LIBS([bufferoverflowU.lib]) - elif test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - CEBINROOT="${WCEROOT}/EVC/${OSVERSION}/bin" - if test "${TARGETCPU}" = "X86"; then - CC="\"${CEBINROOT}/cl.exe\"" - else - CC="\"${CEBINROOT}/cl${ARCH}.exe\"" - fi - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -I\"${CELIB_DIR}/inc\" -I\"${CEINCLUDE}\"" - RC="\"${WCEROOT}/Common/EVC/bin/rc.exe\"" - arch=`echo ${ARCH} | awk '{print tolower([$]0)}'` - defs="${ARCH} _${ARCH}_ ${arch} PALM_SIZE _MT _WINDOWS" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - # Static CE builds require static celib as well - defs="${defs} _DLL" - fi - for i in $defs ; do - AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED($i, 1, [WinCE def ]$i) - done - AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(_WIN32_WCE, $CEVERSION, [_WIN32_WCE version]) - AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(UNDER_CE, $CEVERSION, [UNDER_CE version]) - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Zi -Od" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -Ox" - lversion=`echo ${CEVERSION} | sed -e 's/\(.\)\(..\)/\1\.\2/'` - lflags="${lflags} -MACHINE:${ARCH} -LIBPATH:\"${CELIBPATH}\" -subsystem:windowsce,${lversion} -nologo" - LINKBIN="\"${CEBINROOT}/link.exe\"" - AC_SUBST(CELIB_DIR) - else - RC="rc" - lflags="${lflags} -nologo" - LINKBIN="link" - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-nologo -Z7 -Od -W3 -WX ${runtime}d" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-nologo -O2 -W2 ${runtime}" - fi - fi - - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - # mingw gcc mode - AC_CHECK_TOOL(RC, windres) - CFLAGS_DEBUG="-g" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2 -fomit-frame-pointer" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-wl,--subsystem,console ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW="-wl,--subsystem,windows ${lflags}" - - AC_CACHE_CHECK(for cross-compile version of gcc, - ac_cv_cross, - AC_TRY_COMPILE([ - #ifdef _WIN32 - #error cross-compiler - #endif - ], [], - ac_cv_cross=yes, - ac_cv_cross=no) - ) - if test "$ac_cv_cross" = "yes"; then - case "$do64bit" in - amd64|x64|yes) - CC="x86_64-w64-mingw32-gcc" - LD="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ld" - AR="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ar" - RANLIB="x86_64-w64-mingw32-ranlib" - RC="x86_64-w64-mingw32-windres" - ;; - *) - CC="i686-w64-mingw32-gcc" - LD="i686-w64-mingw32-ld" - AR="i686-w64-mingw32-ar" - RANLIB="i686-w64-mingw32-ranlib" - RC="i686-w64-mingw32-windres" - ;; - esac - fi - - else - SHLIB_LD="${LINKBIN} -dll ${lflags}" - # link -lib only works when -lib is the first arg - STLIB_LD="${LINKBIN} -lib ${lflags}" - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.lib' - PATHTYPE=-w - # For information on what debugtype is most useful, see: - # http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/dnvc60/html/gendepdebug.asp - # and also - # http://msdn2.microsoft.com/en-us/library/y0zzbyt4%28VS.80%29.aspx - # This essentially turns it all on. - LDFLAGS_DEBUG="-debug -debugtype:cv" - LDFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-release" - if test "$doWince" != "no" ; then - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-link ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW=${LDFLAGS_CONSOLE} - else - LDFLAGS_CONSOLE="-link -subsystem:console ${lflags}" - LDFLAGS_WINDOW="-link -subsystem:windows ${lflags}" - fi - fi - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dll" - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.dll' - - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - AIX-*) - AS_IF([test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1" -a "$GCC" != "yes"], [ - # AIX requires the _r compiler when gcc isn't being used - case "${CC}" in - *_r|*_r\ *) - # ok ... - ;; - *) - # Make sure only first arg gets _r - CC=`echo "$CC" | sed -e 's/^\([[^ ]]*\)/\1_r/'` - ;; - esac - AC_MSG_RESULT([Using $CC for compiling with threads]) - ]) - LIBS="$LIBS -lc" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LIBPATH" - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - AS_IF([test "$do64bit" = yes], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system]) - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -q64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-q64" - RANLIB="${RANLIB} -X64" - AR="${AR} -X64" - SHLIB_LD_FLAGS="-b64" - ]) - ]) - - AS_IF([test "`uname -m`" = ia64], [ - # AIX-5 uses ELF style dynamic libraries on IA-64, but not PPC - SHLIB_LD="/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text" - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - ], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - ]) - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - ], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared -Wl,-bexpall' - ], [ - SHLIB_LD="/bin/ld -bhalt:4 -bM:SRE -bexpall -H512 -T512 -bnoentry" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -brtl" - ]) - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} ${SHLIB_LD_FLAGS}" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-L${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ]) - ;; - BeOS*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -nostart' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - #----------------------------------------------------------- - # Check for inet_ntoa in -lbind, for BeOS (which also needs - # -lsocket, even if the network functions are in -lnet which - # is always linked to, for compatibility. - #----------------------------------------------------------- - AC_CHECK_LIB(bind, inet_ntoa, [LIBS="$LIBS -lbind -lsocket"]) - ;; - BSD/OS-4.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-export-dynamic -fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -export-dynamic" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - CYGWIN_*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -Wl,--out-implib,\$[@].a" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dll" - EXEEXT=".exe" - do64bit_ok=yes - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - Haiku*) - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,--export-dynamic" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS} -shared' - AC_CHECK_LIB(network, inet_ntoa, [LIBS="$LIBS -lnetwork"]) - ;; - HP-UX-*.11.*) - # Use updated header definitions where possible - AC_DEFINE(_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED, 1, [Do we want to use the XOPEN network library?]) - # TEA specific: Needed by Tcl, but not most extensions - #AC_DEFINE(_XOPEN_SOURCE, 1, [Do we want to use the XOPEN network library?]) - #LIBS="$LIBS -lxnet" # Use the XOPEN network library - - AS_IF([test "`uname -m`" = ia64], [ - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - # Use newer C++ library for C++ extensions - #if test "$GCC" != "yes" ; then - # CPPFLAGS="-AA" - #fi - ], [ - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".sl" - ]) - AC_CHECK_LIB(dld, shl_load, tcl_ok=yes, tcl_ok=no) - AS_IF([test "$tcl_ok" = yes], [ - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-E" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,+s,+b,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}:.' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='+s +b ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}:.' - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="SHLIB_PATH" - ]) - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -z" - # Users may want PA-RISC 1.1/2.0 portable code - needs HP cc - #CFLAGS="$CFLAGS +DAportable" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="+z" - SHLIB_LD="ld -b" - ]) - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - AS_IF([test "$do64bit" = "yes"], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - case `${CC} -dumpmachine` in - hppa64*) - # 64-bit gcc in use. Fix flags for GNU ld. - do64bit_ok=yes - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ;; - *) - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system]) - ;; - esac - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS +DD64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="+DD64" - ]) - ]) ;; - IRIX-6.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD="ld -n32 -shared -rdata_shared" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mabi=n32" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -mabi=n32" - ], [ - case $system in - IRIX-6.3) - # Use to build 6.2 compatible binaries on 6.3. - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -n32 -D_OLD_TERMIOS" - ;; - *) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -n32" - ;; - esac - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -n32" - ]) - ;; - IRIX64-6.*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - SHLIB_LD="ld -n32 -shared -rdata_shared" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - - AS_IF([test "$do64bit" = yes], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported by gcc]) - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - SHLIB_LD="ld -64 -shared -rdata_shared" - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -64" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-64" - ]) - ]) - ;; - Linux*|GNU*|NetBSD-Debian) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - - # TEA specific: - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2 -fomit-frame-pointer" - - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT} -shared' - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,--export-dynamic" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - AS_IF([test "`uname -m`" = "alpha"], [CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mieee"]) - AS_IF([test $do64bit = yes], [ - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if compiler accepts -m64 flag], tcl_cv_cc_m64, [ - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - AC_TRY_LINK(,, tcl_cv_cc_m64=yes, tcl_cv_cc_m64=no) - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_cc_m64 = yes], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - do64bit_ok=yes - ]) - ]) - - # The combo of gcc + glibc has a bug related to inlining of - # functions like strtod(). The -fno-builtin flag should address - # this problem but it does not work. The -fno-inline flag is kind - # of overkill but it works. Disable inlining only when one of the - # files in compat/*.c is being linked in. - - AS_IF([test x"${USE_COMPAT}" != x],[CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -fno-inline"]) - ;; - Lynx*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE=-02 - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - LD_FLAGS="-Wl,--export-dynamic" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - ;; - OpenBSD-*) - arch=`arch -s` - case "$arch" in - alpha|sparc64) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - ;; - *) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fpic" - ;; - esac - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${SHLIB_CFLAGS} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.so${SHLIB_VERSION}' - LDFLAGS="-Wl,-export-dynamic" - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-O2" - AS_IF([test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"], [ - # On OpenBSD: Compile with -pthread - # Don't link with -lpthread - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-lpthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - ]) - # OpenBSD doesn't do version numbers with dots. - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - NetBSD-*) - # NetBSD has ELF and can use 'cc -shared' to build shared libs - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} ${SHLIB_CFLAGS} -shared' - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -export-dynamic" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - AS_IF([test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"], [ - # The -pthread needs to go in the CFLAGS, not LIBS - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-pthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -pthread" - ]) - ;; - DragonFly-*|FreeBSD-*) - # This configuration from FreeBSD Ports. - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD="${CC} -shared" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -Wl,-soname,\$[@]" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - LDFLAGS="" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - AS_IF([test "${TCL_THREADS}" = "1"], [ - # The -pthread needs to go in the LDFLAGS, not LIBS - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-pthread//` - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS $PTHREAD_CFLAGS" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS $PTHREAD_LIBS"]) - case $system in - FreeBSD-3.*) - # Version numbers are dot-stripped by system policy. - TCL_TRIM_DOTS=`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .` - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}.a' - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${TCL_TRIM_DOTS}\$\{DBGX\}.so.1' - TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK=nodots - ;; - esac - ;; - Darwin-*) - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="-Os" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fno-common" - # To avoid discrepancies between what headers configure sees during - # preprocessing tests and compiling tests, move any -isysroot and - # -mmacosx-version-min flags from CFLAGS to CPPFLAGS: - CPPFLAGS="${CPPFLAGS} `echo " ${CFLAGS}" | \ - awk 'BEGIN {FS=" +-";ORS=" "}; {for (i=2;i<=NF;i++) \ - if ([$]i~/^(isysroot|mmacosx-version-min)/) print "-"[$]i}'`" - CFLAGS="`echo " ${CFLAGS}" | \ - awk 'BEGIN {FS=" +-";ORS=" "}; {for (i=2;i<=NF;i++) \ - if (!([$]i~/^(isysroot|mmacosx-version-min)/)) print "-"[$]i}'`" - AS_IF([test $do64bit = yes], [ - case `arch` in - ppc) - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if compiler accepts -arch ppc64 flag], - tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64, [ - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch ppc64 -mpowerpc64 -mcpu=G5" - AC_TRY_LINK(,, tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64=yes, - tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64=no) - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_cc_arch_ppc64 = yes], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch ppc64 -mpowerpc64 -mcpu=G5" - do64bit_ok=yes - ]);; - i386) - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if compiler accepts -arch x86_64 flag], - tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64, [ - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch x86_64" - AC_TRY_LINK(,, tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64=yes, - tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64=no) - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_cc_arch_x86_64 = yes], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -arch x86_64" - do64bit_ok=yes - ]);; - *) - AC_MSG_WARN([Don't know how enable 64-bit on architecture `arch`]);; - esac - ], [ - # Check for combined 32-bit and 64-bit fat build - AS_IF([echo "$CFLAGS " |grep -E -q -- '-arch (ppc64|x86_64) ' \ - && echo "$CFLAGS " |grep -E -q -- '-arch (ppc|i386) '], [ - fat_32_64=yes]) - ]) - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -dynamiclib ${CFLAGS} ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT}' - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if ld accepts -single_module flag], tcl_cv_ld_single_module, [ - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -dynamiclib -Wl,-single_module" - AC_TRY_LINK(, [int i;], tcl_cv_ld_single_module=yes, tcl_cv_ld_single_module=no) - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_ld_single_module = yes], [ - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} -Wl,-single_module" - ]) - # TEA specific: link shlib with current and compatibility version flags - vers=`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | sed -e 's/^\([[0-9]]\{1,5\}\)\(\(\.[[0-9]]\{1,3\}\)\{0,2\}\).*$/\1\2/p' -e d` - SHLIB_LD="${SHLIB_LD} -current_version ${vers:-0} -compatibility_version ${vers:-0}" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".dylib" - # Don't use -prebind when building for Mac OS X 10.4 or later only: - AS_IF([test "`echo "${MACOSX_DEPLOYMENT_TARGET}" | awk -F '10\\.' '{print int([$]2)}'`" -lt 4 -a \ - "`echo "${CPPFLAGS}" | awk -F '-mmacosx-version-min=10\\.' '{print int([$]2)}'`" -lt 4], [ - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -prebind"]) - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -headerpad_max_install_names" - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if ld accepts -search_paths_first flag], - tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first, [ - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-search_paths_first" - AC_TRY_LINK(, [int i;], tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first=yes, - tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first=no) - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_ld_search_paths_first = yes], [ - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-search_paths_first" - ]) - AS_IF([test "$tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" != yes], [ - AC_DEFINE(MODULE_SCOPE, [__private_extern__], - [Compiler support for module scope symbols]) - tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden=yes - ]) - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="DYLD_LIBRARY_PATH" - # TEA specific: for combined 32 & 64 bit fat builds of Tk - # extensions, verify that 64-bit build is possible. - AS_IF([test "$fat_32_64" = yes && test -n "${TK_BIN_DIR}"], [ - AS_IF([test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = x11], [ - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for 64-bit X11], tcl_cv_lib_x11_64, [ - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval 'hold_'$v'="$'$v'";'$v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc / /g" -e "s/-arch i386 / /g"`"' - done - CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS -I/usr/X11R6/include" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -L/usr/X11R6/lib -lX11" - AC_TRY_LINK([#include ], [XrmInitialize();], - tcl_cv_lib_x11_64=yes, tcl_cv_lib_x11_64=no) - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="$hold_'$v'"' - done]) - ]) - AS_IF([test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = aqua], [ - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for 64-bit Tk], tcl_cv_lib_tk_64, [ - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval 'hold_'$v'="$'$v'";'$v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc / /g" -e "s/-arch i386 / /g"`"' - done - CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS -DUSE_TCL_STUBS=1 -DUSE_TK_STUBS=1 ${TCL_INCLUDES} ${TK_INCLUDES}" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS ${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC} ${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - AC_TRY_LINK([#include ], [Tk_InitStubs(NULL, "", 0);], - tcl_cv_lib_tk_64=yes, tcl_cv_lib_tk_64=no) - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="$hold_'$v'"' - done]) - ]) - # remove 64-bit arch flags from CFLAGS et al. if configuration - # does not support 64-bit. - AS_IF([test "$tcl_cv_lib_tk_64" = no -o "$tcl_cv_lib_x11_64" = no], [ - AC_MSG_NOTICE([Removing 64-bit architectures from compiler & linker flags]) - for v in CFLAGS CPPFLAGS LDFLAGS; do - eval $v'="`echo "$'$v' "|sed -e "s/-arch ppc64 / /g" -e "s/-arch x86_64 / /g"`"' - done]) - ]) - ;; - OS/390-*) - CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE="" # Optimizer is buggy - AC_DEFINE(_OE_SOCKETS, 1, # needed in sys/socket.h - [Should OS/390 do the right thing with sockets?]) - ;; - OSF1-V*) - # Digital OSF/1 - SHLIB_CFLAGS="" - AS_IF([test "$SHARED_BUILD" = 1], [ - SHLIB_LD='ld -shared -expect_unresolved "*"' - ], [ - SHLIB_LD='ld -non_shared -expect_unresolved "*"' - ]) - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test $doRpath = yes], [ - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-rpath,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-rpath ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}']) - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -mieee"], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DHAVE_TZSET -std1 -ieee"]) - # see pthread_intro(3) for pthread support on osf1, k.furukawa - AS_IF([test "${TCL_THREADS}" = 1], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DHAVE_PTHREAD_ATTR_SETSTACKSIZE" - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -DTCL_THREAD_STACK_MIN=PTHREAD_STACK_MIN*64" - LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed s/-lpthreads//` - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - LIBS="$LIBS -lpthread -lmach -lexc" - ], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pthread" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -pthread" - ]) - ]) - ;; - QNX-6*) - # QNX RTP - # This may work for all QNX, but it was only reported for v6. - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - SHLIB_LD="ld -Bshareable -x" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - SCO_SV-3.2*) - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC -melf" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -melf -Wl,-Bexport" - ], [ - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-Kpic -belf" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -belf -Wl,-Bexport" - ]) - SHLIB_LD="ld -G" - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - SunOS-5.[[0-6]]) - # Careful to not let 5.10+ fall into this case - - # Note: If _REENTRANT isn't defined, then Solaris - # won't define thread-safe library routines. - - AC_DEFINE(_REENTRANT, 1, [Do we want the reentrant OS API?]) - AC_DEFINE(_POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS, 1, - [Do we really want to follow the standard? Yes we do!]) - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ], [ - SHLIB_LD="/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text" - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - ]) - ;; - SunOS-5*) - # Note: If _REENTRANT isn't defined, then Solaris - # won't define thread-safe library routines. - - AC_DEFINE(_REENTRANT, 1, [Do we want the reentrant OS API?]) - AC_DEFINE(_POSIX_PTHREAD_SEMANTICS, 1, - [Do we really want to follow the standard? Yes we do!]) - - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - - # Check to enable 64-bit flags for compiler/linker - AS_IF([test "$do64bit" = yes], [ - arch=`isainfo` - AS_IF([test "$arch" = "sparcv9 sparc"], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - AS_IF([test "`${CC} -dumpversion | awk -F. '{print [$]1}'`" -lt 3], [ - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported with GCC < 3.2 on $system]) - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64 -mcpu=v9" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64 -mcpu=v9" - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" - ]) - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - AS_IF([test "$do64bitVIS" = yes], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=v9a" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-xarch=v9a" - ], [ - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=v9" - LDFLAGS_ARCH="-xarch=v9" - ]) - # Solaris 64 uses this as well - #LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR="LD_LIBRARY_PATH_64" - ]) - ], [AS_IF([test "$arch" = "amd64 i386"], [ - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - case $system in - SunOS-5.1[[1-9]]*|SunOS-5.[[2-9]][[0-9]]*) - do64bit_ok=yes - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64";; - *) - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported with GCC on $system]);; - esac - ], [ - do64bit_ok=yes - case $system in - SunOS-5.1[[1-9]]*|SunOS-5.[[2-9]][[0-9]]*) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -m64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -m64";; - *) - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -xarch=amd64" - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -xarch=amd64";; - esac - ]) - ], [AC_MSG_WARN([64bit mode not supported for $arch])])]) - ]) - - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -shared' - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS=${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS} - AS_IF([test "$do64bit_ok" = yes], [ - AS_IF([test "$arch" = "sparcv9 sparc"], [ - # We need to specify -static-libgcc or we need to - # add the path to the sparv9 libgcc. - # JH: static-libgcc is necessary for core Tcl, but may - # not be necessary for extensions. - SHLIB_LD="$SHLIB_LD -m64 -mcpu=v9 -static-libgcc" - # for finding sparcv9 libgcc, get the regular libgcc - # path, remove so name and append 'sparcv9' - #v9gcclibdir="`gcc -print-file-name=libgcc_s.so` | ..." - #CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="${CC_SEARCH_FLAGS},-R,$v9gcclibdir" - ], [AS_IF([test "$arch" = "amd64 i386"], [ - # JH: static-libgcc is necessary for core Tcl, but may - # not be necessary for extensions. - SHLIB_LD="$SHLIB_LD -m64 -static-libgcc" - ])]) - ]) - ], [ - case $system in - SunOS-5.[[1-9]][[0-9]]*) - # TEA specific: use LDFLAGS_DEFAULT instead of LDFLAGS - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -G -z text ${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT}';; - *) - SHLIB_LD='/usr/ccs/bin/ld -G -z text';; - esac - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS='-Wl,-R,${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS='-R ${LIB_RUNTIME_DIR}' - ]) - ;; - UNIX_SV* | UnixWare-5*) - SHLIB_CFLAGS="-KPIC" - SHLIB_LD='${CC} -G' - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="" - SHLIB_SUFFIX=".so" - # Some UNIX_SV* systems (unixware 1.1.2 for example) have linkers - # that don't grok the -Bexport option. Test that it does. - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for ld accepts -Bexport flag], tcl_cv_ld_Bexport, [ - hold_ldflags=$LDFLAGS - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-Bexport" - AC_TRY_LINK(, [int i;], tcl_cv_ld_Bexport=yes, tcl_cv_ld_Bexport=no) - LDFLAGS=$hold_ldflags]) - AS_IF([test $tcl_cv_ld_Bexport = yes], [ - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS -Wl,-Bexport" - ]) - CC_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - LD_SEARCH_FLAGS="" - ;; - esac - - AS_IF([test "$do64bit" = yes -a "$do64bit_ok" = no], [ - AC_MSG_WARN([64bit support being disabled -- don't know magic for this platform]) - ]) - -dnl # Add any CPPFLAGS set in the environment to our CFLAGS, but delay doing so -dnl # until the end of configure, as configure's compile and link tests use -dnl # both CPPFLAGS and CFLAGS (unlike our compile and link) but configure's -dnl # preprocessing tests use only CPPFLAGS. - AC_CONFIG_COMMANDS_PRE([CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} ${CPPFLAGS}"; CPPFLAGS=""]) - - # Add in the arch flags late to ensure it wasn't removed. - # Not necessary in TEA, but this is aligned with core - LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS $LDFLAGS_ARCH" - - # If we're running gcc, then change the C flags for compiling shared - # libraries to the right flags for gcc, instead of those for the - # standard manufacturer compiler. - - AS_IF([test "$GCC" = yes], [ - case $system in - AIX-*) ;; - BSD/OS*) ;; - CYGWIN_*|MINGW32_*|MINGW64_*) ;; - IRIX*) ;; - NetBSD-*|DragonFly-*|FreeBSD-*|OpenBSD-*) ;; - Darwin-*) ;; - SCO_SV-3.2*) ;; - windows) ;; - *) SHLIB_CFLAGS="-fPIC" ;; - esac]) - - AS_IF([test "$tcl_cv_cc_visibility_hidden" != yes], [ - AC_DEFINE(MODULE_SCOPE, [extern], - [No Compiler support for module scope symbols]) - ]) - - AS_IF([test "$SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX" = ""], [ - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${PACKAGE_VERSION}${SHLIB_SUFFIX}']) - AS_IF([test "$UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX" = ""], [ - # TEA specific: use PACKAGE_VERSION instead of VERSION - UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX='${PACKAGE_VERSION}.a']) - - if test "${GCC}" = "yes" -a ${SHLIB_SUFFIX} = ".dll"; then - AC_CACHE_CHECK(for SEH support in compiler, - tcl_cv_seh, - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#include -#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - - int main(int argc, char** argv) { - int a, b = 0; - __try { - a = 666 / b; - } - __except (EXCEPTION_EXECUTE_HANDLER) { - return 0; - } - return 1; - } - ], - tcl_cv_seh=yes, - tcl_cv_seh=no, - tcl_cv_seh=no) - ) - if test "$tcl_cv_seh" = "no" ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_NO_SEH, 1, - [Defined when mingw does not support SEH]) - fi - - # - # Check to see if the excpt.h include file provided contains the - # definition for EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION; if not, which is the case - # with Cygwin's version as of 2002-04-10, define it to be int, - # sufficient for getting the current code to work. - # - AC_CACHE_CHECK(for EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION support in include files, - tcl_cv_eh_disposition, - AC_TRY_COMPILE([ -# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -# include -# undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - ],[ - EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION x; - ], - tcl_cv_eh_disposition=yes, - tcl_cv_eh_disposition=no) - ) - if test "$tcl_cv_eh_disposition" = "no" ; then - AC_DEFINE(EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION, int, - [Defined when cygwin/mingw does not support EXCEPTION DISPOSITION]) - fi - - # Check to see if winnt.h defines CHAR, SHORT, and LONG - # even if VOID has already been #defined. The win32api - # used by mingw and cygwin is known to do this. - - AC_CACHE_CHECK(for winnt.h that ignores VOID define, - tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void, - AC_TRY_COMPILE([ -#define VOID void -#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#include -#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN - ], [ - CHAR c; - SHORT s; - LONG l; - ], - tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void=yes, - tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void=no) - ) - if test "$tcl_cv_winnt_ignore_void" = "yes" ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_WINNT_IGNORE_VOID, 1, - [Defined when cygwin/mingw ignores VOID define in winnt.h]) - fi - fi - - # See if the compiler supports casting to a union type. - # This is used to stop gcc from printing a compiler - # warning when initializing a union member. - - AC_CACHE_CHECK(for cast to union support, - tcl_cv_cast_to_union, - AC_TRY_COMPILE([], - [ - union foo { int i; double d; }; - union foo f = (union foo) (int) 0; - ], - tcl_cv_cast_to_union=yes, - tcl_cv_cast_to_union=no) - ) - if test "$tcl_cv_cast_to_union" = "yes"; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_CAST_TO_UNION, 1, - [Defined when compiler supports casting to union type.]) - fi - - AC_SUBST(CFLAGS_DEBUG) - AC_SUBST(CFLAGS_OPTIMIZE) - AC_SUBST(CFLAGS_WARNING) - - AC_SUBST(STLIB_LD) - AC_SUBST(SHLIB_LD) - - AC_SUBST(SHLIB_LD_LIBS) - AC_SUBST(SHLIB_CFLAGS) - - AC_SUBST(LD_LIBRARY_PATH_VAR) - - # These must be called after we do the basic CFLAGS checks and - # verify any possible 64-bit or similar switches are necessary - TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAGS - TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_SERIAL_PORT -# -# Determine which interface to use to talk to the serial port. -# Note that #include lines must begin in leftmost column for -# some compilers to recognize them as preprocessor directives, -# and some build environments have stdin not pointing at a -# pseudo-terminal (usually /dev/null instead.) -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Defines only one of the following vars: -# HAVE_SYS_MODEM_H -# USE_TERMIOS -# USE_TERMIO -# USE_SGTTY -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_SERIAL_PORT], [ - AC_CHECK_HEADERS(sys/modem.h) - AC_CACHE_CHECK([termios vs. termio vs. sgtty], tcl_cv_api_serial, [ - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include - -int main() { - struct termios t; - if (tcgetattr(0, &t) == 0) { - cfsetospeed(&t, 0); - t.c_cflag |= PARENB | PARODD | CSIZE | CSTOPB; - return 0; - } - return 1; -}], tcl_cv_api_serial=termios, tcl_cv_api_serial=no, tcl_cv_api_serial=no) - if test $tcl_cv_api_serial = no ; then - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include - -int main() { - struct termio t; - if (ioctl(0, TCGETA, &t) == 0) { - t.c_cflag |= CBAUD | PARENB | PARODD | CSIZE | CSTOPB; - return 0; - } - return 1; -}], tcl_cv_api_serial=termio, tcl_cv_api_serial=no, tcl_cv_api_serial=no) - fi - if test $tcl_cv_api_serial = no ; then - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include - -int main() { - struct sgttyb t; - if (ioctl(0, TIOCGETP, &t) == 0) { - t.sg_ospeed = 0; - t.sg_flags |= ODDP | EVENP | RAW; - return 0; - } - return 1; -}], tcl_cv_api_serial=sgtty, tcl_cv_api_serial=no, tcl_cv_api_serial=no) - fi - if test $tcl_cv_api_serial = no ; then - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include -#include - -int main() { - struct termios t; - if (tcgetattr(0, &t) == 0 - || errno == ENOTTY || errno == ENXIO || errno == EINVAL) { - cfsetospeed(&t, 0); - t.c_cflag |= PARENB | PARODD | CSIZE | CSTOPB; - return 0; - } - return 1; -}], tcl_cv_api_serial=termios, tcl_cv_api_serial=no, tcl_cv_api_serial=no) - fi - if test $tcl_cv_api_serial = no; then - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include -#include - -int main() { - struct termio t; - if (ioctl(0, TCGETA, &t) == 0 - || errno == ENOTTY || errno == ENXIO || errno == EINVAL) { - t.c_cflag |= CBAUD | PARENB | PARODD | CSIZE | CSTOPB; - return 0; - } - return 1; - }], tcl_cv_api_serial=termio, tcl_cv_api_serial=no, tcl_cv_api_serial=no) - fi - if test $tcl_cv_api_serial = no; then - AC_TRY_RUN([ -#include -#include - -int main() { - struct sgttyb t; - if (ioctl(0, TIOCGETP, &t) == 0 - || errno == ENOTTY || errno == ENXIO || errno == EINVAL) { - t.sg_ospeed = 0; - t.sg_flags |= ODDP | EVENP | RAW; - return 0; - } - return 1; -}], tcl_cv_api_serial=sgtty, tcl_cv_api_serial=none, tcl_cv_api_serial=none) - fi]) - case $tcl_cv_api_serial in - termios) AC_DEFINE(USE_TERMIOS, 1, [Use the termios API for serial lines]);; - termio) AC_DEFINE(USE_TERMIO, 1, [Use the termio API for serial lines]);; - sgtty) AC_DEFINE(USE_SGTTY, 1, [Use the sgtty API for serial lines]);; - esac -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_PATH_X -# -# Locate the X11 header files and the X11 library archive. Try -# the ac_path_x macro first, but if it doesn't find the X stuff -# (e.g. because there's no xmkmf program) then check through -# a list of possible directories. Under some conditions the -# autoconf macro will return an include directory that contains -# no include files, so double-check its result just to be safe. -# -# This should be called after TEA_CONFIG_CFLAGS as setting the -# LIBS line can confuse some configure macro magic. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Sets the following vars: -# XINCLUDES -# XLIBSW -# PKG_LIBS (appends to) -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_X], [ - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = "x11" ; then - TEA_PATH_UNIX_X - fi -]) - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_UNIX_X], [ - AC_PATH_X - not_really_there="" - if test "$no_x" = ""; then - if test "$x_includes" = ""; then - AC_TRY_CPP([#include ], , not_really_there="yes") - else - if test ! -r $x_includes/X11/Xlib.h; then - not_really_there="yes" - fi - fi - fi - if test "$no_x" = "yes" -o "$not_really_there" = "yes"; then - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for X11 header files]) - found_xincludes="no" - AC_TRY_CPP([#include ], found_xincludes="yes", found_xincludes="no") - if test "$found_xincludes" = "no"; then - dirs="/usr/unsupported/include /usr/local/include /usr/X386/include /usr/X11R6/include /usr/X11R5/include /usr/include/X11R5 /usr/include/X11R4 /usr/openwin/include /usr/X11/include /usr/sww/include" - for i in $dirs ; do - if test -r $i/X11/Xlib.h; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([$i]) - XINCLUDES=" -I$i" - found_xincludes="yes" - break - fi - done - fi - else - if test "$x_includes" != ""; then - XINCLUDES="-I$x_includes" - found_xincludes="yes" - fi - fi - if test "$found_xincludes" = "no"; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([couldn't find any!]) - fi - - if test "$no_x" = yes; then - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for X11 libraries]) - XLIBSW=nope - dirs="/usr/unsupported/lib /usr/local/lib /usr/X386/lib /usr/X11R6/lib /usr/X11R5/lib /usr/lib/X11R5 /usr/lib/X11R4 /usr/openwin/lib /usr/X11/lib /usr/sww/X11/lib" - for i in $dirs ; do - if test -r $i/libX11.a -o -r $i/libX11.so -o -r $i/libX11.sl -o -r $i/libX11.dylib; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([$i]) - XLIBSW="-L$i -lX11" - x_libraries="$i" - break - fi - done - else - if test "$x_libraries" = ""; then - XLIBSW=-lX11 - else - XLIBSW="-L$x_libraries -lX11" - fi - fi - if test "$XLIBSW" = nope ; then - AC_CHECK_LIB(Xwindow, XCreateWindow, XLIBSW=-lXwindow) - fi - if test "$XLIBSW" = nope ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([could not find any! Using -lX11.]) - XLIBSW=-lX11 - fi - # TEA specific: - if test x"${XLIBSW}" != x ; then - PKG_LIBS="${PKG_LIBS} ${XLIBSW}" - fi -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_BLOCKING_STYLE -# -# The statements below check for systems where POSIX-style -# non-blocking I/O (O_NONBLOCK) doesn't work or is unimplemented. -# On these systems (mostly older ones), use the old BSD-style -# FIONBIO approach instead. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Defines some of the following vars: -# HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H -# HAVE_SYS_FILIO_H -# USE_FIONBIO -# O_NONBLOCK -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_BLOCKING_STYLE], [ - AC_CHECK_HEADERS(sys/ioctl.h) - AC_CHECK_HEADERS(sys/filio.h) - TEA_CONFIG_SYSTEM - AC_MSG_CHECKING([FIONBIO vs. O_NONBLOCK for nonblocking I/O]) - case $system in - OSF*) - AC_DEFINE(USE_FIONBIO, 1, [Should we use FIONBIO?]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([FIONBIO]) - ;; - *) - AC_MSG_RESULT([O_NONBLOCK]) - ;; - esac -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_TIME_HANDLER -# -# Checks how the system deals with time.h, what time structures -# are used on the system, and what fields the structures have. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Defines some of the following vars: -# USE_DELTA_FOR_TZ -# HAVE_TM_GMTOFF -# HAVE_TM_TZADJ -# HAVE_TIMEZONE_VAR -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_TIME_HANDLER], [ - AC_CHECK_HEADERS(sys/time.h) - AC_HEADER_TIME - AC_STRUCT_TIMEZONE - - AC_CHECK_FUNCS(gmtime_r localtime_r) - - AC_CACHE_CHECK([tm_tzadj in struct tm], tcl_cv_member_tm_tzadj, [ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ], [struct tm tm; tm.tm_tzadj;], - tcl_cv_member_tm_tzadj=yes, tcl_cv_member_tm_tzadj=no)]) - if test $tcl_cv_member_tm_tzadj = yes ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_TM_TZADJ, 1, [Should we use the tm_tzadj field of struct tm?]) - fi - - AC_CACHE_CHECK([tm_gmtoff in struct tm], tcl_cv_member_tm_gmtoff, [ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ], [struct tm tm; tm.tm_gmtoff;], - tcl_cv_member_tm_gmtoff=yes, tcl_cv_member_tm_gmtoff=no)]) - if test $tcl_cv_member_tm_gmtoff = yes ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_TM_GMTOFF, 1, [Should we use the tm_gmtoff field of struct tm?]) - fi - - # - # Its important to include time.h in this check, as some systems - # (like convex) have timezone functions, etc. - # - AC_CACHE_CHECK([long timezone variable], tcl_cv_timezone_long, [ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ], - [extern long timezone; - timezone += 1; - exit (0);], - tcl_cv_timezone_long=yes, tcl_cv_timezone_long=no)]) - if test $tcl_cv_timezone_long = yes ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_TIMEZONE_VAR, 1, [Should we use the global timezone variable?]) - else - # - # On some systems (eg IRIX 6.2), timezone is a time_t and not a long. - # - AC_CACHE_CHECK([time_t timezone variable], tcl_cv_timezone_time, [ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ], - [extern time_t timezone; - timezone += 1; - exit (0);], - tcl_cv_timezone_time=yes, tcl_cv_timezone_time=no)]) - if test $tcl_cv_timezone_time = yes ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_TIMEZONE_VAR, 1, [Should we use the global timezone variable?]) - fi - fi -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_BUGGY_STRTOD -# -# Under Solaris 2.4, strtod returns the wrong value for the -# terminating character under some conditions. Check for this -# and if the problem exists use a substitute procedure -# "fixstrtod" (provided by Tcl) that corrects the error. -# Also, on Compaq's Tru64 Unix 5.0, -# strtod(" ") returns 0.0 instead of a failure to convert. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Might defines some of the following vars: -# strtod (=fixstrtod) -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_BUGGY_STRTOD], [ - AC_CHECK_FUNC(strtod, tcl_strtod=1, tcl_strtod=0) - if test "$tcl_strtod" = 1; then - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for Solaris2.4/Tru64 strtod bugs], tcl_cv_strtod_buggy,[ - AC_TRY_RUN([ - extern double strtod(); - int main() { - char *infString="Inf", *nanString="NaN", *spaceString=" "; - char *term; - double value; - value = strtod(infString, &term); - if ((term != infString) && (term[-1] == 0)) { - exit(1); - } - value = strtod(nanString, &term); - if ((term != nanString) && (term[-1] == 0)) { - exit(1); - } - value = strtod(spaceString, &term); - if (term == (spaceString+1)) { - exit(1); - } - exit(0); - }], tcl_cv_strtod_buggy=ok, tcl_cv_strtod_buggy=buggy, - tcl_cv_strtod_buggy=buggy)]) - if test "$tcl_cv_strtod_buggy" = buggy; then - AC_LIBOBJ([fixstrtod]) - USE_COMPAT=1 - AC_DEFINE(strtod, fixstrtod, [Do we want to use the strtod() in compat?]) - fi - fi -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAGS -# -# Check for what flags are needed to be passed so the correct OS -# features are available. -# -# Arguments: -# None -# -# Results: -# -# Might define the following vars: -# _ISOC99_SOURCE -# _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE -# _LARGEFILE_SOURCE64 -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAG],[ - AC_CACHE_VAL([tcl_cv_flag_]translit($1,[A-Z],[a-z]), - AC_TRY_COMPILE([$2], $3, [tcl_cv_flag_]translit($1,[A-Z],[a-z])=no, - AC_TRY_COMPILE([[#define ]$1[ 1 -]$2], $3, - [tcl_cv_flag_]translit($1,[A-Z],[a-z])=yes, - [tcl_cv_flag_]translit($1,[A-Z],[a-z])=no))) - if test ["x${tcl_cv_flag_]translit($1,[A-Z],[a-z])[}" = "xyes"] ; then - AC_DEFINE($1, 1, [Add the ]$1[ flag when building]) - tcl_flags="$tcl_flags $1" - fi -]) - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAGS],[ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for required early compiler flags]) - tcl_flags="" - TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAG(_ISOC99_SOURCE,[#include ], - [char *p = (char *)strtoll; char *q = (char *)strtoull;]) - TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAG(_LARGEFILE64_SOURCE,[#include ], - [struct stat64 buf; int i = stat64("/", &buf);]) - TEA_TCL_EARLY_FLAG(_LARGEFILE_SOURCE64,[#include ], - [char *p = (char *)open64;]) - if test "x${tcl_flags}" = "x" ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([none]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([${tcl_flags}]) - fi -]) - -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- -# TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS -# -# Check for what is defined in the way of 64-bit features. -# -# Arguments: -# None -# -# Results: -# -# Might define the following vars: -# TCL_WIDE_INT_IS_LONG -# TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE -# HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT64 -# HAVE_STRUCT_STAT64 -# HAVE_TYPE_OFF64_T -#-------------------------------------------------------------------- - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_TCL_64BIT_FLAGS], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for 64-bit integer type]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(tcl_cv_type_64bit,[ - tcl_cv_type_64bit=none - # See if the compiler knows natively about __int64 - AC_TRY_COMPILE(,[__int64 value = (__int64) 0;], - tcl_type_64bit=__int64, tcl_type_64bit="long long") - # See if we should use long anyway Note that we substitute in the - # type that is our current guess for a 64-bit type inside this check - # program, so it should be modified only carefully... - AC_TRY_COMPILE(,[switch (0) { - case 1: case (sizeof(]${tcl_type_64bit}[)==sizeof(long)): ; - }],tcl_cv_type_64bit=${tcl_type_64bit})]) - if test "${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" = none ; then - AC_DEFINE(TCL_WIDE_INT_IS_LONG, 1, [Are wide integers to be implemented with C 'long's?]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([using long]) - elif test "${tcl_cv_type_64bit}" = "__int64" \ - -a "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - # TEA specific: We actually want to use the default tcl.h checks in - # this case to handle both TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE and TCL_LL_MODIFIER* - AC_MSG_RESULT([using Tcl header defaults]) - else - AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(TCL_WIDE_INT_TYPE,${tcl_cv_type_64bit}, - [What type should be used to define wide integers?]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([${tcl_cv_type_64bit}]) - - # Now check for auxiliary declarations - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for struct dirent64], tcl_cv_struct_dirent64,[ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include -#include ],[struct dirent64 p;], - tcl_cv_struct_dirent64=yes,tcl_cv_struct_dirent64=no)]) - if test "x${tcl_cv_struct_dirent64}" = "xyes" ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT64, 1, [Is 'struct dirent64' in ?]) - fi - - AC_CACHE_CHECK([for struct stat64], tcl_cv_struct_stat64,[ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ],[struct stat64 p; -], - tcl_cv_struct_stat64=yes,tcl_cv_struct_stat64=no)]) - if test "x${tcl_cv_struct_stat64}" = "xyes" ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STRUCT_STAT64, 1, [Is 'struct stat64' in ?]) - fi - - AC_CHECK_FUNCS(open64 lseek64) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for off64_t]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(tcl_cv_type_off64_t,[ - AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include ],[off64_t offset; -], - tcl_cv_type_off64_t=yes,tcl_cv_type_off64_t=no)]) - dnl Define HAVE_TYPE_OFF64_T only when the off64_t type and the - dnl functions lseek64 and open64 are defined. - if test "x${tcl_cv_type_off64_t}" = "xyes" && \ - test "x${ac_cv_func_lseek64}" = "xyes" && \ - test "x${ac_cv_func_open64}" = "xyes" ; then - AC_DEFINE(HAVE_TYPE_OFF64_T, 1, [Is off64_t in ?]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([yes]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([no]) - fi - fi -]) - -## -## Here ends the standard Tcl configuration bits and starts the -## TEA specific functions -## - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_INIT -- -# -# Init various Tcl Extension Architecture (TEA) variables. -# This should be the first called TEA_* macro. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# CYGPATH -# EXEEXT -# Defines only: -# TEA_VERSION -# TEA_INITED -# TEA_PLATFORM (windows or unix) -# -# "cygpath" is used on windows to generate native path names for include -# files. These variables should only be used with the compiler and linker -# since they generate native path names. -# -# EXEEXT -# Select the executable extension based on the host type. This -# is a lightweight replacement for AC_EXEEXT that doesn't require -# a compiler. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_INIT], [ - TEA_VERSION="3.13" - - AC_MSG_CHECKING([TEA configuration]) - if test x"${PACKAGE_NAME}" = x ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([ -The PACKAGE_NAME variable must be defined by your TEA configure.ac]) - fi - AC_MSG_RESULT([ok (TEA ${TEA_VERSION})]) - - # If the user did not set CFLAGS, set it now to keep macros - # like AC_PROG_CC and AC_TRY_COMPILE from adding "-g -O2". - if test "${CFLAGS+set}" != "set" ; then - CFLAGS="" - fi - - case "`uname -s`" in - *win32*|*WIN32*|*MINGW32_*|*MINGW64_*) - AC_CHECK_PROG(CYGPATH, cygpath, cygpath -m, echo) - EXEEXT=".exe" - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - ;; - *CYGWIN_*) - EXEEXT=".exe" - # CYGPATH and TEA_PLATFORM are determined later in LOAD_TCLCONFIG - ;; - *) - CYGPATH=echo - # Maybe we are cross-compiling.... - case ${host_alias} in - *mingw32*) - EXEEXT=".exe" - TEA_PLATFORM="windows" - ;; - *) - EXEEXT="" - TEA_PLATFORM="unix" - ;; - esac - ;; - esac - - # Check if exec_prefix is set. If not use fall back to prefix. - # Note when adjusted, so that TEA_PREFIX can correct for this. - # This is needed for recursive configures, since autoconf propagates - # $prefix, but not $exec_prefix (doh!). - if test x$exec_prefix = xNONE ; then - exec_prefix_default=yes - exec_prefix=$prefix - fi - - AC_MSG_NOTICE([configuring ${PACKAGE_NAME} ${PACKAGE_VERSION}]) - - AC_SUBST(EXEEXT) - AC_SUBST(CYGPATH) - - # This package name must be replaced statically for AC_SUBST to work - AC_SUBST(PKG_LIB_FILE) - # Substitute STUB_LIB_FILE in case package creates a stub library too. - AC_SUBST(PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE) - - # We AC_SUBST these here to ensure they are subst'ed, - # in case the user doesn't call TEA_ADD_... - AC_SUBST(PKG_STUB_SOURCES) - AC_SUBST(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS) - AC_SUBST(PKG_TCL_SOURCES) - AC_SUBST(PKG_HEADERS) - AC_SUBST(PKG_INCLUDES) - AC_SUBST(PKG_LIBS) - AC_SUBST(PKG_CFLAGS) - - # Configure the installer. - TEA_INSTALLER -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_SOURCES -- -# -# Specify one or more source files. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. -# It is not important to specify the directory, as long as it is -# in the generic, win or unix subdirectory of $(srcdir). -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_SOURCES -# PKG_OBJECTS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_SOURCES], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - case $i in - [\$]*) - # allow $-var names - PKG_SOURCES="$PKG_SOURCES $i" - PKG_OBJECTS="$PKG_OBJECTS $i" - ;; - *) - # check for existence - allows for generic/win/unix VPATH - # To add more dirs here (like 'src'), you have to update VPATH - # in Makefile.in as well - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/generic/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/win/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/unix/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/macosx/$i" \ - ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([could not find source file '$i']) - fi - PKG_SOURCES="$PKG_SOURCES $i" - # this assumes it is in a VPATH dir - i=`basename $i` - # handle user calling this before or after TEA_SETUP_COMPILER - if test x"${OBJEXT}" != x ; then - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[[^.]]*$//'`.${OBJEXT}" - else - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[[^.]]*$//'`.\${OBJEXT}" - fi - PKG_OBJECTS="$PKG_OBJECTS $j" - ;; - esac - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_SOURCES) - AC_SUBST(PKG_OBJECTS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES -- -# -# Specify one or more source files. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. -# It is not important to specify the directory, as long as it is -# in the generic, win or unix subdirectory of $(srcdir). -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_STUB_SOURCES -# PKG_STUB_OBJECTS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_STUB_SOURCES], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence - allows for generic/win/unix VPATH - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/generic/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/win/$i" -a ! -f "${srcdir}/unix/$i" \ - -a ! -f "${srcdir}/macosx/$i" \ - ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([could not find stub source file '$i']) - fi - PKG_STUB_SOURCES="$PKG_STUB_SOURCES $i" - # this assumes it is in a VPATH dir - i=`basename $i` - # handle user calling this before or after TEA_SETUP_COMPILER - if test x"${OBJEXT}" != x ; then - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[[^.]]*$//'`.${OBJEXT}" - else - j="`echo $i | sed -e 's/\.[[^.]]*$//'`.\${OBJEXT}" - fi - PKG_STUB_OBJECTS="$PKG_STUB_OBJECTS $j" - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_STUB_SOURCES) - AC_SUBST(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES -- -# -# Specify one or more Tcl source files. These should be platform -# independent runtime files. -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_TCL_SOURCES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_TCL_SOURCES], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence, be strict because it is installed - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([could not find tcl source file '${srcdir}/$i']) - fi - PKG_TCL_SOURCES="$PKG_TCL_SOURCES $i" - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_TCL_SOURCES) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_HEADERS -- -# -# Specify one or more source headers. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_HEADERS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_HEADERS], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - # check for existence, be strict because it is installed - if test ! -f "${srcdir}/$i" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([could not find header file '${srcdir}/$i']) - fi - PKG_HEADERS="$PKG_HEADERS $i" - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_HEADERS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_INCLUDES -- -# -# Specify one or more include dirs. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_INCLUDES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_INCLUDES], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - PKG_INCLUDES="$PKG_INCLUDES $i" - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_INCLUDES) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_LIBS -- -# -# Specify one or more libraries. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. For Windows, -# libraries provided in "foo.lib" format will be converted to -# "-lfoo" when using GCC (mingw). -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_LIBS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_LIBS], [ - vars="$@" - for i in $vars; do - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" = "yes" ; then - # Convert foo.lib to -lfoo for GCC. No-op if not *.lib - i=`echo "$i" | sed -e 's/^\([[^-]].*\)\.lib[$]/-l\1/i'` - fi - PKG_LIBS="$PKG_LIBS $i" - done - AC_SUBST(PKG_LIBS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_CFLAGS -- -# -# Specify one or more CFLAGS. Users should check for -# the right platform before adding to their list. -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names -# -# Results: -# -# Defines and substs the following vars: -# PKG_CFLAGS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_CFLAGS], [ - PKG_CFLAGS="$PKG_CFLAGS $@" - AC_SUBST(PKG_CFLAGS) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_ADD_CLEANFILES -- -# -# Specify one or more CLEANFILES. -# -# Arguments: -# one or more file names to clean target -# -# Results: -# -# Appends to CLEANFILES, already defined for subst in LOAD_TCLCONFIG -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ADD_CLEANFILES], [ - CLEANFILES="$CLEANFILES $@" -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PREFIX -- -# -# Handle the --prefix=... option by defaulting to what Tcl gave -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# If --prefix or --exec-prefix was not specified, $prefix and -# $exec_prefix will be set to the values given to Tcl when it was -# configured. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PREFIX], [ - if test "${prefix}" = "NONE"; then - prefix_default=yes - if test x"${TCL_PREFIX}" != x; then - AC_MSG_NOTICE([--prefix defaulting to TCL_PREFIX ${TCL_PREFIX}]) - prefix=${TCL_PREFIX} - else - AC_MSG_NOTICE([--prefix defaulting to /usr/local]) - prefix=/usr/local - fi - fi - if test "${exec_prefix}" = "NONE" -a x"${prefix_default}" = x"yes" \ - -o x"${exec_prefix_default}" = x"yes" ; then - if test x"${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX}" != x; then - AC_MSG_NOTICE([--exec-prefix defaulting to TCL_EXEC_PREFIX ${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX}]) - exec_prefix=${TCL_EXEC_PREFIX} - else - AC_MSG_NOTICE([--exec-prefix defaulting to ${prefix}]) - exec_prefix=$prefix - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_SETUP_COMPILER_CC -- -# -# Do compiler checks the way we want. This is just a replacement -# for AC_PROG_CC in TEA configure.ac files to make them cleaner. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Sets up CC var and other standard bits we need to make executables. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_SETUP_COMPILER_CC], [ - # Don't put any macros that use the compiler (e.g. AC_TRY_COMPILE) - # in this macro, they need to go into TEA_SETUP_COMPILER instead. - - AC_PROG_CC - AC_PROG_CPP - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Checks to see if the make program sets the $MAKE variable. - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - AC_PROG_MAKE_SET - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Find ranlib - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - AC_CHECK_TOOL(RANLIB, ranlib) - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Determines the correct binary file extension (.o, .obj, .exe etc.) - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - AC_OBJEXT - AC_EXEEXT -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_SETUP_COMPILER -- -# -# Do compiler checks that use the compiler. This must go after -# TEA_SETUP_COMPILER_CC, which does the actual compiler check. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Sets up CC var and other standard bits we need to make executables. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_SETUP_COMPILER], [ - # Any macros that use the compiler (e.g. AC_TRY_COMPILE) have to go here. - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_SETUP_COMPILER_CC]) - - #------------------------------------------------------------------------ - # If we're using GCC, see if the compiler understands -pipe. If so, use it. - # It makes compiling go faster. (This is only a performance feature.) - #------------------------------------------------------------------------ - - if test -z "$no_pipe" -a -n "$GCC"; then - AC_CACHE_CHECK([if the compiler understands -pipe], - tcl_cv_cc_pipe, [ - hold_cflags=$CFLAGS; CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pipe" - AC_TRY_COMPILE(,, tcl_cv_cc_pipe=yes, tcl_cv_cc_pipe=no) - CFLAGS=$hold_cflags]) - if test $tcl_cv_cc_pipe = yes; then - CFLAGS="$CFLAGS -pipe" - fi - fi - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Common compiler flag setup - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - AC_C_BIGENDIAN -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_MAKE_LIB -- -# -# Generate a line that can be used to build a shared/unshared library -# in a platform independent manner. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Requires: -# -# Results: -# -# Defines the following vars: -# CFLAGS - Done late here to note disturb other AC macros -# MAKE_LIB - Command to execute to build the Tcl library; -# differs depending on whether or not Tcl is being -# compiled as a shared library. -# MAKE_SHARED_LIB Makefile rule for building a shared library -# MAKE_STATIC_LIB Makefile rule for building a static library -# MAKE_STUB_LIB Makefile rule for building a stub library -# VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL Makefile rule for embedded VC manifest in DLL -# VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE Makefile rule for embedded VC manifest in EXE -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_MAKE_LIB], [ - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" != "yes"; then - MAKE_STATIC_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} -out:\[$]@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="\${SHLIB_LD} \${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \${LDFLAGS_DEFAULT} -out:\[$]@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - AC_EGREP_CPP([manifest needed], [ -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1400 -print("manifest needed") -#endif - ], [ - # Could do a CHECK_PROG for mt, but should always be with MSVC8+ - VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL="if test -f \[$]@.manifest ; then mt.exe -nologo -manifest \[$]@.manifest -outputresource:\[$]@\;2 ; fi" - VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE="if test -f \[$]@.manifest ; then mt.exe -nologo -manifest \[$]@.manifest -outputresource:\[$]@\;1 ; fi" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="${MAKE_SHARED_LIB} ; ${VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL}" - TEA_ADD_CLEANFILES([*.manifest]) - ]) - MAKE_STUB_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} -nodefaultlib -out:\[$]@ \$(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS)" - else - MAKE_STATIC_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} \[$]@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS)" - MAKE_SHARED_LIB="\${SHLIB_LD} -o \[$]@ \$(PKG_OBJECTS) \${SHLIB_LD_LIBS}" - MAKE_STUB_LIB="\${STLIB_LD} \[$]@ \$(PKG_STUB_OBJECTS)" - fi - - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - MAKE_LIB="${MAKE_SHARED_LIB} " - else - MAKE_LIB="${MAKE_STATIC_LIB} " - fi - - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Shared libraries and static libraries have different names. - # Use the double eval to make sure any variables in the suffix is - # substituted. (@@@ Might not be necessary anymore) - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" ; then - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - # We force the unresolved linking of symbols that are really in - # the private libraries of Tcl and Tk. - if test x"${TK_BIN_DIR}" != x ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \"`${CYGPATH} ${TK_BIN_DIR}/${TK_STUB_LIB_FILE}`\"" - fi - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} \"`${CYGPATH} ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/${TCL_STUB_LIB_FILE}`\"" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} -static-libgcc" - fi - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - else - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PKG_LIB_FILE} - fi - fi - # Some packages build their own stubs libraries - eval eval "PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}stub${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then - PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=lib${PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE} - fi - # These aren't needed on Windows (either MSVC or gcc) - RANLIB=: - RANLIB_STUB=: - else - RANLIB_STUB="${RANLIB}" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} ${TCL_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - if test x"${TK_BIN_DIR}" != x ; then - SHLIB_LD_LIBS="${SHLIB_LD_LIBS} ${TK_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" - fi - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${SHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - RANLIB=: - else - eval eval "PKG_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - fi - # Some packages build their own stubs libraries - eval eval "PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE=lib${PACKAGE_LIB_PREFIX}${PACKAGE_NAME}stub${UNSHARED_LIB_SUFFIX}" - fi - - # These are escaped so that only CFLAGS is picked up at configure time. - # The other values will be substituted at make time. - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} \${CFLAGS_DEFAULT} \${CFLAGS_WARNING}" - if test "${SHARED_BUILD}" = "1" ; then - CFLAGS="${CFLAGS} \${SHLIB_CFLAGS}" - fi - - AC_SUBST(MAKE_LIB) - AC_SUBST(MAKE_SHARED_LIB) - AC_SUBST(MAKE_STATIC_LIB) - AC_SUBST(MAKE_STUB_LIB) - AC_SUBST(RANLIB_STUB) - AC_SUBST(VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_DLL) - AC_SUBST(VC_MANIFEST_EMBED_EXE) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_LIB_SPEC -- -# -# Compute the name of an existing object library located in libdir -# from the given base name and produce the appropriate linker flags. -# -# Arguments: -# basename The base name of the library without version -# numbers, extensions, or "lib" prefixes. -# extra_dir Extra directory in which to search for the -# library. This location is used first, then -# $prefix/$exec-prefix, then some defaults. -# -# Requires: -# TEA_INIT and TEA_PREFIX must be called first. -# -# Results: -# -# Defines the following vars: -# ${basename}_LIB_NAME The computed library name. -# ${basename}_LIB_SPEC The computed linker flags. -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_LIB_SPEC], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for $1 library]) - - # Look in exec-prefix for the library (defined by TEA_PREFIX). - - tea_lib_name_dir="${exec_prefix}/lib" - - # Or in a user-specified location. - - if test x"$2" != x ; then - tea_extra_lib_dir=$2 - else - tea_extra_lib_dir=NONE - fi - - for i in \ - `ls -dr ${tea_extra_lib_dir}/$1[[0-9]]*.lib 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr ${tea_extra_lib_dir}/lib$1[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr ${tea_lib_name_dir}/$1[[0-9]]*.lib 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr ${tea_lib_name_dir}/lib$1[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/lib/$1[[0-9]]*.lib 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/lib/lib$1[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/lib64/$1[[0-9]]*.lib 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/lib64/lib$1[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/local/lib/$1[[0-9]]*.lib 2>/dev/null ` \ - `ls -dr /usr/local/lib/lib$1[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null ` ; do - if test -f "$i" ; then - tea_lib_name_dir=`dirname $i` - $1_LIB_NAME=`basename $i` - $1_LIB_PATH_NAME=$i - break - fi - done - - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - $1_LIB_SPEC=\"`${CYGPATH} ${$1_LIB_PATH_NAME} 2>/dev/null`\" - else - # Strip off the leading "lib" and trailing ".a" or ".so" - - tea_lib_name_lib=`echo ${$1_LIB_NAME}|sed -e 's/^lib//' -e 's/\.[[^.]]*$//' -e 's/\.so.*//'` - $1_LIB_SPEC="-L${tea_lib_name_dir} -l${tea_lib_name_lib}" - fi - - if test "x${$1_LIB_NAME}" = x ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([not found]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([${$1_LIB_SPEC}]) - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS -- -# -# Locate the private Tcl include files -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires: -# TCL_SRC_DIR Assumes that TEA_LOAD_TCLCONFIG has -# already been called. -# -# Results: -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TCL_TOP_DIR_NATIVE -# TCL_INCLUDES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PRIVATE_TCL_HEADERS], [ - # Allow for --with-tclinclude to take effect and define ${ac_cv_c_tclh} - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_PUBLIC_TCL_HEADERS]) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tcl private include files]) - - TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${TCL_SRC_DIR}` - TCL_TOP_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - # Check to see if tclPort.h isn't already with the public headers - # Don't look for tclInt.h because that resides with tcl.h in the core - # sources, but the Port headers are in a different directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tclh}/tclWinPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tclh}/tclUnixPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - else - TCL_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic\" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/win\" - else - TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TCL_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/unix\" - fi - # Overwrite the previous TCL_INCLUDES as this should capture both - # public and private headers in the same set. - # We want to ensure these are substituted so as not to require - # any *_NATIVE vars be defined in the Makefile - TCL_INCLUDES="-I${TCL_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE} -I${TCL_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE}" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers and PrivateHeaders directories - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -d "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers" -a \ - -d "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders"; then - TCL_INCLUDES="-I\"${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers\" -I\"${TCL_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders\" ${TCL_INCLUDES}" - else - TCL_INCLUDES="${TCL_INCLUDES} ${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC} `echo "${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/Headers/PrivateHeaders/'`" - fi - ;; - esac - result="Using ${TCL_INCLUDES}" - else - if test ! -f "${TCL_SRC_DIR}/generic/tclInt.h" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([Cannot find private header tclInt.h in ${TCL_SRC_DIR}]) - fi - result="Using srcdir found in tclConfig.sh: ${TCL_SRC_DIR}" - fi - fi - - AC_SUBST(TCL_TOP_DIR_NATIVE) - - AC_SUBST(TCL_INCLUDES) - AC_MSG_RESULT([${result}]) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PUBLIC_TCL_HEADERS -- -# -# Locate the installed public Tcl header files -# -# Arguments: -# None. -# -# Requires: -# CYGPATH must be set -# -# Results: -# -# Adds a --with-tclinclude switch to configure. -# Result is cached. -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TCL_INCLUDES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PUBLIC_TCL_HEADERS], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tcl public headers]) - - AC_ARG_WITH(tclinclude, [ --with-tclinclude directory containing the public Tcl header files], with_tclinclude=${withval}) - - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tclh, [ - # Use the value from --with-tclinclude, if it was given - - if test x"${with_tclinclude}" != x ; then - if test -f "${with_tclinclude}/tcl.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclh=${with_tclinclude} - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tclinclude} directory does not contain tcl.h]) - fi - else - list="" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tcl was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers directory - case ${TCL_DEFS} in - *TCL_FRAMEWORK*) - list="`ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Headers 2>/dev/null`" - ;; - esac - fi - - # Look in the source dir only if Tcl is not installed, - # and in that situation, look there before installed locations. - if test -f "${TCL_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - list="$list `ls -d ${TCL_SRC_DIR}/generic 2>/dev/null`" - fi - - # Check order: pkg --prefix location, Tcl's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tclConfig.sh. - - eval "temp_includedir=${includedir}" - list="$list \ - `ls -d ${temp_includedir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null`" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" -o "$GCC" = "yes"; then - list="$list /usr/local/include /usr/include" - if test x"${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" != x ; then - d=`echo "${TCL_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/^-I//'` - list="$list `ls -d ${d} 2>/dev/null`" - fi - fi - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/tcl.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tclh=$i - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - - # Print a message based on how we determined the include path - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tclh}" = x ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([tcl.h not found. Please specify its location with --with-tclinclude]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([${ac_cv_c_tclh}]) - fi - - # Convert to a native path and substitute into the output files. - - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${ac_cv_c_tclh}` - - TCL_INCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - AC_SUBST(TCL_INCLUDES) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS -- -# -# Locate the private Tk include files -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires: -# TK_SRC_DIR Assumes that TEA_LOAD_TKCONFIG has -# already been called. -# -# Results: -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TK_INCLUDES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PRIVATE_TK_HEADERS], [ - # Allow for --with-tkinclude to take effect and define ${ac_cv_c_tkh} - AC_REQUIRE([TEA_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS]) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tk private include files]) - - TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${TK_SRC_DIR}` - TK_TOP_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - # Check to see if tkPort.h isn't already with the public headers - # Don't look for tkInt.h because that resides with tk.h in the core - # sources, but the Port headers are in a different directory - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tkh}/tkWinPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - elif test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "unix" -a \ - -f "${ac_cv_c_tkh}/tkUnixPort.h"; then - result="private headers found with public headers" - else - TK_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic\" - TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/xlib\" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows"; then - TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/win\" - else - TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE=\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/unix\" - fi - # Overwrite the previous TK_INCLUDES as this should capture both - # public and private headers in the same set. - # We want to ensure these are substituted so as not to require - # any *_NATIVE vars be defined in the Makefile - TK_INCLUDES="-I${TK_GENERIC_DIR_NATIVE} -I${TK_PLATFORM_DIR_NATIVE}" - # Detect and add ttk subdir - if test -d "${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic/ttk"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/generic/ttk\"" - fi - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != "x11"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE}\"" - fi - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" = "aqua"; then - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} -I\"${TK_SRC_DIR_NATIVE}/macosx\"" - fi - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers and PrivateHeaders directories - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - if test -d "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers" -a \ - -d "${TK_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders"; then - TK_INCLUDES="-I\"${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers\" -I\"${TK_BIN_DIR}/PrivateHeaders\" ${TK_INCLUDES}" - else - TK_INCLUDES="${TK_INCLUDES} ${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC} `echo "${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/Headers/PrivateHeaders/'`" - fi - ;; - esac - result="Using ${TK_INCLUDES}" - else - if test ! -f "${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic/tkInt.h" ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([Cannot find private header tkInt.h in ${TK_SRC_DIR}]) - fi - result="Using srcdir found in tkConfig.sh: ${TK_SRC_DIR}" - fi - fi - - AC_SUBST(TK_TOP_DIR_NATIVE) - AC_SUBST(TK_XLIB_DIR_NATIVE) - - AC_SUBST(TK_INCLUDES) - AC_MSG_RESULT([${result}]) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS -- -# -# Locate the installed public Tk header files -# -# Arguments: -# None. -# -# Requires: -# CYGPATH must be set -# -# Results: -# -# Adds a --with-tkinclude switch to configure. -# Result is cached. -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TK_INCLUDES -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PUBLIC_TK_HEADERS], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Tk public headers]) - - AC_ARG_WITH(tkinclude, [ --with-tkinclude directory containing the public Tk header files], with_tkinclude=${withval}) - - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_tkh, [ - # Use the value from --with-tkinclude, if it was given - - if test x"${with_tkinclude}" != x ; then - if test -f "${with_tkinclude}/tk.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkh=${with_tkinclude} - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_tkinclude} directory does not contain tk.h]) - fi - else - list="" - if test "`uname -s`" = "Darwin"; then - # If Tk was built as a framework, attempt to use - # the framework's Headers directory. - case ${TK_DEFS} in - *TK_FRAMEWORK*) - list="`ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/Headers 2>/dev/null`" - ;; - esac - fi - - # Look in the source dir only if Tk is not installed, - # and in that situation, look there before installed locations. - if test -f "${TK_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - list="$list `ls -d ${TK_SRC_DIR}/generic 2>/dev/null`" - fi - - # Check order: pkg --prefix location, Tk's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tkConfig.sh, Tcl's --prefix location, - # relative to directory of tclConfig.sh. - - eval "temp_includedir=${includedir}" - list="$list \ - `ls -d ${temp_includedir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TK_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_PREFIX}/include 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${TCL_BIN_DIR}/../include 2>/dev/null`" - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" != "windows" -o "$GCC" = "yes"; then - list="$list /usr/local/include /usr/include" - if test x"${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" != x ; then - d=`echo "${TK_INCLUDE_SPEC}" | sed -e 's/^-I//'` - list="$list `ls -d ${d} 2>/dev/null`" - fi - fi - for i in $list ; do - if test -f "$i/tk.h" ; then - ac_cv_c_tkh=$i - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - - # Print a message based on how we determined the include path - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_tkh}" = x ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([tk.h not found. Please specify its location with --with-tkinclude]) - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([${ac_cv_c_tkh}]) - fi - - # Convert to a native path and substitute into the output files. - - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE=`${CYGPATH} ${ac_cv_c_tkh}` - - TK_INCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - - AC_SUBST(TK_INCLUDES) - - if test "${TEA_WINDOWINGSYSTEM}" != "x11"; then - # On Windows and Aqua, we need the X compat headers - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for X11 header files]) - if test ! -r "${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}/X11/Xlib.h"; then - INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE="`${CYGPATH} ${TK_SRC_DIR}/xlib`" - TK_XINCLUDES=-I\"${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}\" - AC_SUBST(TK_XINCLUDES) - fi - AC_MSG_RESULT([${INCLUDE_DIR_NATIVE}]) - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PATH_CONFIG -- -# -# Locate the ${1}Config.sh file and perform a sanity check on -# the ${1} compile flags. These are used by packages like -# [incr Tk] that load *Config.sh files from more than Tcl and Tk. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --with-$1=... -# -# Defines the following vars: -# $1_BIN_DIR Full path to the directory containing -# the $1Config.sh file -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_CONFIG], [ - # - # Ok, lets find the $1 configuration - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-$1 - # - - if test x"${no_$1}" = x ; then - # we reset no_$1 in case something fails here - no_$1=true - AC_ARG_WITH($1, [ --with-$1 directory containing $1 configuration ($1Config.sh)], with_$1config=${withval}) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for $1 configuration]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_$1config,[ - - # First check to see if --with-$1 was specified. - if test x"${with_$1config}" != x ; then - case ${with_$1config} in - */$1Config.sh ) - if test -f ${with_$1config}; then - AC_MSG_WARN([--with-$1 argument should refer to directory containing $1Config.sh, not to $1Config.sh itself]) - with_$1config=`echo ${with_$1config} | sed 's!/$1Config\.sh$!!'` - fi;; - esac - if test -f "${with_$1config}/$1Config.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_$1config=`(cd ${with_$1config}; pwd)` - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_$1config} directory doesn't contain $1Config.sh]) - fi - fi - - # then check for a private $1 installation - if test x"${ac_cv_c_$1config}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../$1 \ - `ls -dr ../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]*.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]][[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../$1 \ - `ls -dr ../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]*.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]][[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ../../../$1 \ - `ls -dr ../../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]*.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]][[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ../../../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ${srcdir}/../$1 \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]*.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]][[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]] 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../$1*[[0-9]].[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/$1Config.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_$1config=`(cd $i; pwd)` - break - fi - if test -f "$i/unix/$1Config.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_$1config=`(cd $i/unix; pwd)` - break - fi - done - fi - - # check in a few common install locations - if test x"${ac_cv_c_$1config}" = x ; then - for i in `ls -d ${libdir} 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${exec_prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d ${prefix}/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/local/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/contrib/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/pkg/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib 2>/dev/null` \ - `ls -d /usr/lib64 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -f "$i/$1Config.sh" ; then - ac_cv_c_$1config=`(cd $i; pwd)` - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - - if test x"${ac_cv_c_$1config}" = x ; then - $1_BIN_DIR="# no $1 configs found" - AC_MSG_WARN([Cannot find $1 configuration definitions]) - exit 0 - else - no_$1= - $1_BIN_DIR=${ac_cv_c_$1config} - AC_MSG_RESULT([found $$1_BIN_DIR/$1Config.sh]) - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_LOAD_CONFIG -- -# -# Load the $1Config.sh file -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires the following vars to be set: -# $1_BIN_DIR -# -# Results: -# -# Substitutes the following vars: -# $1_SRC_DIR -# $1_LIB_FILE -# $1_LIB_SPEC -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_LOAD_CONFIG], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for existence of ${$1_BIN_DIR}/$1Config.sh]) - - if test -f "${$1_BIN_DIR}/$1Config.sh" ; then - AC_MSG_RESULT([loading]) - . "${$1_BIN_DIR}/$1Config.sh" - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([file not found]) - fi - - # - # If the $1_BIN_DIR is the build directory (not the install directory), - # then set the common variable name to the value of the build variables. - # For example, the variable $1_LIB_SPEC will be set to the value - # of $1_BUILD_LIB_SPEC. An extension should make use of $1_LIB_SPEC - # instead of $1_BUILD_LIB_SPEC since it will work with both an - # installed and uninstalled version of Tcl. - # - - if test -f "${$1_BIN_DIR}/Makefile" ; then - AC_MSG_WARN([Found Makefile - using build library specs for $1]) - $1_LIB_SPEC=${$1_BUILD_LIB_SPEC} - $1_STUB_LIB_SPEC=${$1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC} - $1_STUB_LIB_PATH=${$1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH} - $1_INCLUDE_SPEC=${$1_BUILD_INCLUDE_SPEC} - $1_LIBRARY_PATH=${$1_LIBRARY_PATH} - fi - - AC_SUBST($1_VERSION) - AC_SUBST($1_BIN_DIR) - AC_SUBST($1_SRC_DIR) - - AC_SUBST($1_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST($1_LIB_SPEC) - - AC_SUBST($1_STUB_LIB_FILE) - AC_SUBST($1_STUB_LIB_SPEC) - AC_SUBST($1_STUB_LIB_PATH) - - # Allow the caller to prevent this auto-check by specifying any 2nd arg - AS_IF([test "x$2" = x], [ - # Check both upper and lower-case variants - # If a dev wanted non-stubs libs, this function could take an option - # to not use _STUB in the paths below - AS_IF([test "x${$1_STUB_LIB_SPEC}" = x], - [TEA_LOAD_CONFIG_LIB(translit($1,[a-z],[A-Z])_STUB)], - [TEA_LOAD_CONFIG_LIB($1_STUB)]) - ]) -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_LOAD_CONFIG_LIB -- -# -# Helper function to load correct library from another extension's -# ${PACKAGE}Config.sh. -# -# Results: -# Adds to LIBS the appropriate extension library -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_LOAD_CONFIG_LIB], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([For $1 library for LIBS]) - # This simplifies the use of stub libraries by automatically adding - # the stub lib to your path. Normally this would add to SHLIB_LD_LIBS, - # but this is called before CONFIG_CFLAGS. More importantly, this adds - # to PKG_LIBS, which becomes LIBS, and that is only used by SHLIB_LD. - if test "x${$1_LIB_SPEC}" != "x" ; then - if test "${TEA_PLATFORM}" = "windows" -a "$GCC" != "yes" ; then - TEA_ADD_LIBS([\"`${CYGPATH} ${$1_LIB_PATH}`\"]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([using $1_LIB_PATH ${$1_LIB_PATH}]) - else - TEA_ADD_LIBS([${$1_LIB_SPEC}]) - AC_MSG_RESULT([using $1_LIB_SPEC ${$1_LIB_SPEC}]) - fi - else - AC_MSG_RESULT([file not found]) - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_EXPORT_CONFIG -- -# -# Define the data to insert into the ${PACKAGE}Config.sh file -# -# Arguments: -# -# Requires the following vars to be set: -# $1 -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_EXPORT_CONFIG], [ - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - # These are for $1Config.sh - #-------------------------------------------------------------------- - - # pkglibdir must be a fully qualified path and (not ${exec_prefix}/lib) - eval pkglibdir="[$]{libdir}/$1${PACKAGE_VERSION}" - if test "${TCL_LIB_VERSIONS_OK}" = "ok"; then - eval $1_LIB_FLAG="-l$1${PACKAGE_VERSION}${DBGX}" - eval $1_STUB_LIB_FLAG="-l$1stub${PACKAGE_VERSION}${DBGX}" - else - eval $1_LIB_FLAG="-l$1`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`${DBGX}" - eval $1_STUB_LIB_FLAG="-l$1stub`echo ${PACKAGE_VERSION} | tr -d .`${DBGX}" - fi - $1_BUILD_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH $(pwd)` ${$1_LIB_FLAG}" - $1_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}` ${$1_LIB_FLAG}" - $1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH $(pwd)` [$]{$1_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - $1_STUB_LIB_SPEC="-L`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}` [$]{$1_STUB_LIB_FLAG}" - $1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH="`$CYGPATH $(pwd)`/[$]{PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - $1_STUB_LIB_PATH="`$CYGPATH ${pkglibdir}`/[$]{PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE}" - - AC_SUBST($1_BUILD_LIB_SPEC) - AC_SUBST($1_LIB_SPEC) - AC_SUBST($1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC) - AC_SUBST($1_STUB_LIB_SPEC) - AC_SUBST($1_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH) - AC_SUBST($1_STUB_LIB_PATH) - - AC_SUBST(MAJOR_VERSION) - AC_SUBST(MINOR_VERSION) - AC_SUBST(PATCHLEVEL) -]) - - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_PATH_CELIB -- -# -# Locate Keuchel's celib emulation layer for targeting Win/CE -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# -# Adds the following arguments to configure: -# --with-celib=... -# -# Defines the following vars: -# CELIB_DIR Full path to the directory containing -# the include and platform lib files -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_PATH_CELIB], [ - # First, look for one uninstalled. - # the alternative search directory is invoked by --with-celib - - if test x"${no_celib}" = x ; then - # we reset no_celib in case something fails here - no_celib=true - AC_ARG_WITH(celib,[ --with-celib=DIR use Windows/CE support library from DIR], with_celibconfig=${withval}) - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for Windows/CE celib directory]) - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_c_celibconfig,[ - # First check to see if --with-celibconfig was specified. - if test x"${with_celibconfig}" != x ; then - if test -d "${with_celibconfig}/inc" ; then - ac_cv_c_celibconfig=`(cd ${with_celibconfig}; pwd)` - else - AC_MSG_ERROR([${with_celibconfig} directory doesn't contain inc directory]) - fi - fi - - # then check for a celib library - if test x"${ac_cv_c_celibconfig}" = x ; then - for i in \ - ../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ../celib \ - ../../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ../../celib \ - `ls -dr ../celib-*3.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ${srcdir}/../celib-palm-3.0 \ - ${srcdir}/../celib \ - `ls -dr ${srcdir}/../celib-*3.[[0-9]]* 2>/dev/null` \ - ; do - if test -d "$i/inc" ; then - ac_cv_c_celibconfig=`(cd $i; pwd)` - break - fi - done - fi - ]) - if test x"${ac_cv_c_celibconfig}" = x ; then - AC_MSG_ERROR([Cannot find celib support library directory]) - else - no_celib= - CELIB_DIR=${ac_cv_c_celibconfig} - CELIB_DIR=`echo "$CELIB_DIR" | sed -e 's!\\\!/!g'` - AC_MSG_RESULT([found $CELIB_DIR]) - fi - fi -]) - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# TEA_INSTALLER -- -# -# Configure the installer. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -# INSTALL -# INSTALL_DATA_DIR -# INSTALL_DATA -# INSTALL_PROGRAM -# INSTALL_SCRIPT -# INSTALL_LIBRARY -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -AC_DEFUN([TEA_INSTALLER], [ - INSTALL='$(SHELL) $(srcdir)/tclconfig/install-sh -c' - INSTALL_DATA_DIR='${INSTALL} -d -m 755' - INSTALL_DATA='${INSTALL} -m 644' - INSTALL_PROGRAM='${INSTALL} -m 755' - INSTALL_SCRIPT='${INSTALL} -m 755' - - TEA_CONFIG_SYSTEM - case $system in - HP-UX-*) INSTALL_LIBRARY='${INSTALL} -m 755' ;; - *) INSTALL_LIBRARY='${INSTALL} -m 644' ;; - esac - - AC_SUBST(INSTALL) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_DATA_DIR) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_DATA) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_PROGRAM) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_SCRIPT) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_LIBRARY) -]) - -### -# Tip 430 - ZipFS Modifications -### -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# SC_ZIPFS_SUPPORT -# Locate a zip encoder installed on the system path, or none. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -# TCL_ZIP_FILE -# TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT -# TCL_ZIPFS_FLAG -# ZIP_PROG -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ - -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -# SC_PROG_ZIP -# Locate a zip encoder installed on the system path, or none. -# -# Arguments: -# none -# -# Results: -# Substitutes the following vars: -# ZIP_PROG -# ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS -# ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH -# ZIP_INSTALL_OBJS -#------------------------------------------------------------------------ -AC_DEFUN([TEA_ZIPFS_SUPPORT], [ - AC_MSG_CHECKING([for zipfs support]) - ZIP_PROG="" - ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS="" - ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH="" - INSTALL_MSGS="" - # If our native tclsh processes the "install" command line option - # we can use it to mint zip files - AS_IF([$TCLSH_PROG install],[ - ZIP_PROG=${TCLSH_PROG} - ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS="install mkzip" - ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH="." - AC_MSG_RESULT([Can use Native Tclsh for Zip encoding]) - ]) - if test "x$ZIP_PROG" = "x" ; then - AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_path_zip, [ - search_path=`echo ${PATH} | sed -e 's/:/ /g'` - for dir in $search_path ; do - for j in `ls -r $dir/zip 2> /dev/null` \ - `ls -r $dir/zip 2> /dev/null` ; do - if test x"$ac_cv_path_zip" = x ; then - if test -f "$j" ; then - ac_cv_path_zip=$j - break - fi - fi - done - done - ]) - if test -f "$ac_cv_path_zip" ; then - ZIP_PROG="$ac_cv_path_zip " - AC_MSG_RESULT([$ZIP_PROG]) - ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS="-rq" - ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH="." - AC_MSG_RESULT([Found INFO Zip in environment]) - # Use standard arguments for zip - fi - fi - if test "x$ZIP_PROG" = "x" ; then - # It is not an error if an installed version of Zip can't be located. - ZIP_PROG="" - ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS="" - ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH="" - TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT=0 - TCL_ZIPFS_FLAG= - else - # ZIPFS Support - eval "TCL_ZIP_FILE=\"${TCL_ZIP_FILE}\"" - if test ${TCL_ZIP_FILE} = "" ; then - TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT=0 - TCL_ZIPFS_FLAG= - INSTALL_LIBRARIES=install-libraries - INSTALL_MSGS=install-msgs - else - if test ${SHARED_BUILD} = 1 ; then - TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT=1 - INSTALL_LIBRARIES=install-libraries-zipfs-shared - else - TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT=2 - INSTALL_LIBRARIES=install-libraries-zipfs-static - fi - TCL_ZIPFS_FLAG=-DTCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT - fi - fi - - AC_SUBST(TCL_ZIP_FILE) - AC_SUBST(TCL_ZIPFS_SUPPORT) - AC_SUBST(TCL_ZIPFS_FLAG) - AC_SUBST(ZIP_PROG) - AC_SUBST(ZIP_PROG_OPTIONS) - AC_SUBST(ZIP_PROG_VFSSEARCH) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_LIBRARIES) - AC_SUBST(INSTALL_MSGS) -]) - -# Local Variables: -# mode: autoconf -# End: diff --git a/tkblt/tests/all.tcl b/tkblt/tests/all.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index badd21f..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/all.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,11 +0,0 @@ -source linegraph.tcl -source lineelement.tcl -source linepen.tcl -source bargraph.tcl -source barelement.tcl -source barpen.tcl -source axis.tcl -source legend.tcl -source crosshairs.tcl -source markers.tcl - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/axis.tcl b/tkblt/tests/axis.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 80f97ea..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/axis.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,105 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph axis configure x -bd 2 -background cyan -title "X\nAxis" -limitsformat "%g" -$graph axis configure y -bd 2 -background cyan -title "Y\nAxis" -bltCmd $graph axis activate y - -puts stderr "Testing Axis..." - -bltTest3 $graph axis y -activeforeground red $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis y -activerelief sunken $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -autorange 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -background yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -bg blue $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -bindtags {aa} 0 -bltTest3 $graph axis y -bd 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis y -borderwidth 4 $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -checklimits $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -color red $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -command $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -descending yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -exterior no $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -fg magenta $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -foreground yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -grid no $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridcolor blue $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -griddashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridlinewidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridminor no $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridminorcolor blue $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridminordashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -gridminorlinewidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -justify left $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -justify center $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -justify right $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -labeloffset yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -limitscolor red $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -limitsfont {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -limitsformat "%e" $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -linewidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -logscale yes $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -loosemin $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -loosemax $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -majorticks $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -max $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -min $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -minorticks $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief flat $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief groove $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief raised $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief ridge $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief solid $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -relief sunken $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -rotate 45 $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -scrollcommand $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -scrollincrement $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -scrollmax $dops -#bltTest3 $graph axis x -scrollmin $dops -##bltTest3 $graph axis x -shiftby 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -showticks no $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -stepsize 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -subdivisions 4 $dops -##bltTest3 $graph axis x -tickanchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -tickfont {times 12 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -ticklength 20 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -tickdefault 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -title {This is a Title} $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -titlealternate yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -titlecolor yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph axis x -titlefont {times 24 bold italic} $dops - -#bltCmd $graph axis activate foo -#bltCmd $graph axis bind x -bltCmd $graph axis cget x -color -bltCmd $graph axis configure x -bltCmd $graph axis configure x -color -#bltCmd $graph axis create foo -#bltCmd $graph axis deactivate foo -#bltCmd $graph axis delete foo -#bltCmd $graph axis invtransform x -#bltCmd $graph axis limits x -#bltCmd $graph axis margin x -#bltCmd $graph axis names x -#bltCmd $graph axis transform x -#bltCmd $graph axis type x -#bltCmd $graph axis view x - -#bltCmd $graph xaxis activate -#bltCmd $graph xaxis bind -bltCmd $graph xaxis cget -color -bltCmd $graph xaxis configure -bltCmd $graph xaxis configure -color -#bltCmd $graph xaxis deactivate -#bltCmd $graph xaxis invtransform -#bltCmd $graph xaxis limits -#bltCmd $graph xaxis transform -#bltCmd $graph xaxis use -#bltCmd $graph xaxis view - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/barelement.tcl b/tkblt/tests/barelement.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 5b8cb07..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/barelement.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,97 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .bar -set graph [bltBarGraph $w] - -$graph element configure data1 -color red -showvalues y -$graph element configure data2 -color blue - -$graph pen create foo -showvalues y -color purple -$graph element activate data3 - -puts stderr "Testing Bar Element..." - -bltTest3 $graph element data3 -activepen foo $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -background yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -barwidth 1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -bd 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -bg yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -bindtags {aa} 0 -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -borderwidth 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -color yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -data {0.2 8 0.4 20 0.6 31 0.8 41 1.0 50 1.2 59 1.4 65 1.6 70 1.8 75 2.0 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarcolor green $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarwidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarcap 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -fg yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -fill cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -foreground green $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -label "This is a test" $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -legendrelief groove $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -mapx x2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -mapy y2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -outline red $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -pen foo $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief flat $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief groove $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief raised $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief ridge $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief solid $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -relief sunken $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -showerrorbars no $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues none $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues x $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues both $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -stack $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -styles $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor nw $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor ne $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor e $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor se $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor s $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor sw $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor w $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuecolor cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuefont {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueformat "%e" $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuerotate 45 $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -weights $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -x {0 .2 .4 .6 .8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -xdata {0 .2 .4 .6 .8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xerror {.1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1} $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xhigh $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xlow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -y {8 20 31 41 50 59 65 70 75 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -ydata {8 20 31 41 50 59 65 70 75 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -yerror {5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5} $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -yhigh $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -ylow $dops - -bltCmd $graph element activate data2 -bltCmd $graph element deactivate data2 -#bltCmd $graph element bind data1 [list puts "%x %y"] -bltCmd $graph element cget data1 -showvalues -bltCmd $graph element configure data1 -bltCmd $graph element configure data1 -showvalues -#bltCmd $graph element closest 50 50 -#bltCmd $graph element closest 50 50 data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph element create data4 -bltCmd $graph element create data5 -bltCmd $graph element delete data4 data5 -bltCmd $graph element exists data1 -bltCmd $graph element lower data1 -bltCmd $graph element lower data2 data3 -bltCmd $graph element names -bltCmd $graph element names data1 -bltCmd $graph element raise data2 -bltCmd $graph element raise data2 data3 -bltCmd $graph element raise data1 -bltCmd $graph element show data2 -bltCmd $graph element show {data1 data2 data3} -bltCmd $graph element type data1 - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/bargraph.tcl b/tkblt/tests/bargraph.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 20f067d..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/bargraph.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,80 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .bar -set graph [bltBarGraph $w] - -puts stderr "Testing Bar Graph..." - -# Graph -bltTest $graph -aspect 2 $dops -bltTest $graph -background red $dops -bltTest $graph -barmode stacked $dops -bltTest $graph -barmode aligned $dops -bltTest $graph -barmode overlap $dops -bltTest $graph -barwidth .15 $dops -#bltTest $graph -baseline $dops -bltTest $graph -bd 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -bg green $dops -bltTest $graph -bm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -borderwidth 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -bottommargin 50 $dops -#bltTest $graph -bufferelements $dops -#bltTest $graph -buffergraph $dops -bltTest $graph -cursor cross $dops -bltTest $graph -fg blue $dops -bltTest $graph -font {times 36 bold italic} $dops -bltTest $graph -foreground cyan $dops -#bltTest $graph -halo $dops -bltTest $graph -height 300 $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightbackground $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightcolor $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightthickness $dops -bltTest $graph -invertxy yes $dops -bltTest $graph -justify left $dops -bltTest $graph -justify center $dops -bltTest $graph -justify right $dops -bltTest $graph -leftmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -lm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotbackground cyan $dops -bltTest $graph -plotborderwidth 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotpadx 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotpady 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotrelief groove $dops -bltTest $graph -relief groove $dops -bltTest $graph -rightmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -rm 50 $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchhalo $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchmode $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchalong $dops -#bltTest $graph -stackaxes $dops -#bltTest $graph -takefocus $dops -bltTest $graph -title "This is a Title" $dops -bltTest $graph -tm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -topmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -width 300 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotwidth 300 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotheight 300 $dops - -##bltCmd $graph axis -bltCmd $graph cget -background -bltCmd $graph configure -bltCmd $graph configure -bltCmd $graph configure -background cyan -##bltCmd $graph crosshairs -##bltCmd $graph element -#bltCmd $graph extents -#bltCmd $graph inside -#bltCmd $graph invtransform -##bltCmd $graph legend -##bltCmd $graph marker -##bltCmd $graph pen -##bltCmd $graph postscript -#bltCmd $graph transform -##bltCmd $graph x2axis -##bltCmd $graph xaxis -##bltCmd $graph y2axis -##bltCmd $graph yaxis - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/barpen.tcl b/tkblt/tests/barpen.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index d06928b..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/barpen.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,51 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .bar -set graph [bltBarGraph $w] - -$graph pen create foo -color red -showvalues y -$graph element configure data2 -pen foo - -puts stderr "Testing Bar Pen..." - -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -background yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -bd 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -bg yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -borderwidth 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -color yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarcolor green $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarwidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarcap 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -fg yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -fill cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -foreground green $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -outline red $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -relief flat $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -showerrorbars no $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -showvalues none $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -showvalues x $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -showvalues both $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor nw $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor ne $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor e $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor se $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor s $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor sw $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor w $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuecolor cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuefont {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueformat "%e" $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuerotate 45 $dops - -bltCmd $graph pen cget foo -color -bltCmd $graph pen configure foo -bltCmd $graph pen configure foo -color -bltCmd $graph pen create bar -bltCmd $graph pen delete bar -bltCmd $graph pen names -bltCmd $graph pen type foo - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/base.tcl b/tkblt/tests/base.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index e3dac2e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/base.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,142 +0,0 @@ -package require tkblt - -#set sleep 1000 -set sleep 500 -if {![info exists dops]} { - set dops 0 -} - -proc bltPlot {w title} { - toplevel $w - wm title $w $title - wm protocol $w WM_DELETE_WINDOW [list bltPlotDestroy $w] - - set mb ${w}mb - menu $mb - $w configure -menu $mb -} - -proc bltPlotDestroy {w} { - destroy ${w}mb - destroy $w -} - -proc bltTest {graph option value {dops 0}} { - global sleep - - puts stderr " $option $value" - set org [$graph cget $option] - $graph configure $option $value - update - if {$dops} { - $graph postscript output foo.ps - exec open /Applications/Preview.app/ foo.ps - } - after $sleep -# read stdin 1 - $graph configure $option $org - update - after $sleep -} - -proc bltTest2 {graph which option value {dops 0}} { - global sleep - - puts stderr " $option $value" - set org [$graph $which cget $option] - $graph $which configure $option $value - update - if {$dops} { - $graph postscript output foo.ps - exec open /Applications/Preview.app/ foo.ps - } - after $sleep -# read stdin 1 - $graph $which configure $option $org - update - after $sleep -} - -proc bltTest3 {graph which item option value {dops 0}} { - global sleep - - puts stderr " $item $option $value" - set org [$graph $which cget $item $option] - $graph $which configure $item $option $value - update - if {$dops} { - $graph postscript output foo.ps - exec open /Applications/Preview.app/ foo.ps - } - after $sleep -# read stdin 1 - $graph $which configure $item $option $org - update - after $sleep -} - -proc bltCmd {graph args} { - global sleep - - puts stderr " $graph $args" - eval $graph $args - update - after $sleep -# read stdin 1 -} - -proc bltElements {graph} { - blt::vector create xv(10) - blt::vector create yv(10) - xv set { 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 } - yv set { 5 10 10 15 15 10 20 25 30 35 } - - $graph element create data1 -data {0.2 13 0.4 25 0.6 36 0.8 46 1.0 55 1.2 64 1.4 70 1.6 75 1.8 80 2.0 90} - - $graph element create data2 \ - -xdata {0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0} \ - -ydata {26 50 72 92 110 128 140 150 160 180} \ - -xerror {.05 .05 .05 .05 .05 .05 .05 .05 .05 .05} \ - -yerror {10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10} \ - -color red - - $graph element create data3 -xdata xv -ydata yv -color green - - $graph legend configure -title "Legend" -} - -proc bltBarGraph {w} { - global sleep - - bltPlot $w "Bar Graph" - set graph [blt::barchart ${w}.gr \ - -width 600 \ - -height 500 \ - -title "Bar\nGraph" \ - -barwidth .2 \ - -barmode aligned \ - ] - pack $graph -expand yes -fill both - bltElements $graph - - update - after $sleep - return $graph -} - -proc bltLineGraph {w} { - global sleep - - bltPlot $w "Line Graph" - set graph [blt::graph ${w}.gr \ - -width 600 \ - -height 500 \ - -title "Line\nGraph" \ - ] - pack $graph -expand yes -fill both - bltElements $graph - - update - after $sleep - return $graph -} diff --git a/tkblt/tests/crosshairs.tcl b/tkblt/tests/crosshairs.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index c63cea5..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/crosshairs.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,26 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph crosshairs on -$graph crosshairs configure -x 200 -y 200 - -puts stderr "Testing Crosshairs..." - -bltTest2 $graph crosshairs -color green -bltTest2 $graph crosshairs -dashes "8 3" -bltTest2 $graph crosshairs -linewidth 3 -bltTest2 $graph crosshairs -x 100 -bltTest2 $graph crosshairs -y 100 - -bltCmd $graph crosshairs cget -color -bltCmd $graph crosshairs configure -bltCmd $graph crosshairs configure -color -bltCmd $graph crosshairs on -bltCmd $graph crosshairs off -bltCmd $graph crosshairs toggle - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/legend.tcl b/tkblt/tests/legend.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index dba8da0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/legend.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,101 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph legend selection set data2 -$graph legend focus data1 -$graph legend configure -selectrelief groove - -puts stderr "Testing Legend..." - -#bltTest2 $graph legend -activebackground $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -activeborderwidth $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -activeforeground $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -activerelief $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor nw $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor n $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor ne $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor e $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor se $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor s $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor sw $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -anchor w $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -bg pink $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -background cyan $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -borderwidth 20 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -bd 20 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -columns 2 $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -exportselection $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -focusdashes "8 3" $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -focusforeground red $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -font {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -fg yellow $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -foreground purple $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -hide yes $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -ipadx 20 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -ipady 20 $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -nofocusselectbackground $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -nofocusselectforeground $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -padx 20 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -pady 20 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position rightmargin $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position leftmargin $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position topmargin $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position bottommargin $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position plotarea $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -position xy $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -x 250 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -y 100 $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -raised yes $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief flat $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief groove $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief raised $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief ridge $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief solid $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -relief sunken $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -rows 1 $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -selectbackground $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -selectborderwidth 3 $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -selectcommand $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -selectforeground $dops -#bltTest2 $graph legend -selectmode $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -selectrelief flat $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -title "Hello World" $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -titlecolor red $dops -bltTest2 $graph legend -titlefont {times 24 bold italic} $dops - -#bltCmd $graph legend activate -#bltCmd $graph legend bind -bltCmd $graph legend cget -fg -bltCmd $graph legend configure -bltCmd $graph legend configure -fg -#bltCmd $graph legend curselection -#bltCmd $graph legend deactivate -bltCmd $graph legend focus data1 -bltCmd $graph legend focus -#bltCmd $graph legend get anchor -#bltCmd $graph legend get current -#bltCmd $graph legend get first -#bltCmd $graph legend get last -#bltCmd $graph legend get end -#bltCmd $graph legend get next.row -#bltCmd $graph legend get next.column -#bltCmd $graph legend get previous.row -#bltCmd $graph legend get previous.column -#bltCmd $graph legend get @100,100 -#bltCmd $graph legend get data1 -bltCmd $graph legend selection anchor data1 -bltCmd $graph legend selection mark data1 -bltCmd $graph legend selection includes data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection present -bltCmd $graph legend selection set data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection clear data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection set data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection toggle data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection set data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph legend selection clearall - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/lineelement.tcl b/tkblt/tests/lineelement.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 5edb38e..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/lineelement.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,105 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph element configure data1 -dash {8 3} -showvalues y -smooth step -symbol circle -outline yellow -outlinewidth 3 -pixels 10 - -$graph pen create foo -showvalues y -symbol circle -dashes {8 3} -color purple -linewidth 2 -$graph element activate data3 - -puts stderr "Testing Line Element.." - -bltTest3 $graph element data3 -activepen foo $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -areabackground yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -bindtags {aa} -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -color yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -dashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -data {0.2 8 0.4 20 0.6 31 0.8 41 1.0 50 1.2 59 1.4 65 1.6 70 1.8 75 2.0 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarcolor green $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarwidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -errorbarcap 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -fill cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -label "This is a test" $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -legendrelief groove $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -linewidth 3 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -mapx x2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -mapy y2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -maxsymbols 4 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -offdash black $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -outline green $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -outlinewidth 5 $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -pen foo $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -pixels 20 $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -reduce $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -scalesymbols no $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -showerrorbars no $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues none $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues x $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -showvalues both $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -smooth linear $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -smooth cubic $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -smooth quadratic $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -smooth catrom $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -styles $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol arrow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol cross $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol diamond $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol none $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol plus $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol scross $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol splus $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol square $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -symbol triangle $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -trace both $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor nw $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor ne $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor e $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor se $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor s $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor sw $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueanchor w $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuecolor cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuefont {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valueformat "%e" $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -valuerotate 45 $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -weights $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -x {0 .2 .4 .6 .8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -xdata {0 .2 .4 .6 .8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xerror {.1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1} $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xhigh $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -xlow $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -y {8 20 31 41 50 59 65 70 75 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data1 -ydata {8 20 31 41 50 59 65 70 75 85} $dops -bltTest3 $graph element data2 -yerror {5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5} $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -yhigh $dops -#bltTest3 $graph element data2 -ylow $dops - -bltCmd $graph element activate data2 -bltCmd $graph element deactivate data2 -#bltCmd $graph element bind data1 [list puts "%x %y"] -bltCmd $graph element cget data1 -smooth -bltCmd $graph element configure data1 -bltCmd $graph element configure data1 -smooth -#bltCmd $graph element closest 50 50 -#bltCmd $graph element closest 50 50 data1 data2 -bltCmd $graph element create data4 -bltCmd $graph element create data5 -bltCmd $graph element delete data4 data5 -bltCmd $graph element exists data1 -bltCmd $graph element lower data1 -bltCmd $graph element lower data2 data3 -bltCmd $graph element names -bltCmd $graph element names data1 -bltCmd $graph element raise data2 -bltCmd $graph element raise data2 data3 -bltCmd $graph element raise data1 -bltCmd $graph element show data2 -bltCmd $graph element show {data1 data2 data3} -bltCmd $graph element type data1 - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/linegraph.tcl b/tkblt/tests/linegraph.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 6204e72..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/linegraph.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,75 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -puts stderr "Testing Line Graph..." - -bltTest $graph -aspect 2 $dops -bltTest $graph -background red $dops -#bltTest $graph -baseline $dops -bltTest $graph -bd 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -bg green $dops -bltTest $graph -bm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -borderwidth 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -bottommargin 50 $dops -#bltTest $graph -bufferelements $dops -#bltTest $graph -buffergraph $dops -bltTest $graph -cursor cross $dops -bltTest $graph -fg blue $dops -bltTest $graph -font {times 36 bold italic} $dops -bltTest $graph -foreground cyan $dops -#bltTest $graph -halo $dops -bltTest $graph -height 300 $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightbackground $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightcolor $dops -#bltTest $graph -highlightthickness $dops -bltTest $graph -invertxy yes $dops -bltTest $graph -justify left $dops -bltTest $graph -justify center $dops -bltTest $graph -justify right $dops -bltTest $graph -leftmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -lm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotbackground cyan $dops -bltTest $graph -plotborderwidth 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotpadx 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotpady 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotrelief groove $dops -bltTest $graph -relief groove $dops -bltTest $graph -rightmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -rm 50 $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchhalo $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchmode $dops -#bltTest $graph -searchalong $dops -#bltTest $graph -stackaxes $dops -#bltTest $graph -takefocus $dops -bltTest $graph -title "This is a Title" $dops -bltTest $graph -tm 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -topmargin 50 $dops -bltTest $graph -width 300 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotwidth 300 $dops -bltTest $graph -plotheight 300 $dops - -##bltCmd $graph axis -bltCmd $graph cget -background -bltCmd $graph configure -bltCmd $graph configure -bltCmd $graph configure -background cyan -##bltCmd $graph crosshairs -##bltCmd $graph element -#bltCmd $graph extents -#bltCmd $graph inside -#bltCmd $graph invtransform -##bltCmd $graph legend -##bltCmd $graph marker -##bltCmd $graph pen -#bltCmd $graph postscript output foo.ps -#bltCmd $graph transform -##bltCmd $graph x2axis -##bltCmd $graph xaxis -##bltCmd $graph y2axis -##bltCmd $graph yaxis - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/linemarker.tcl b/tkblt/tests/linemarker.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 3b66ba6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/linemarker.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,34 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -set mm [$graph marker create line tt -element data2 \ - -coords {1 50 1.5 100 1 150} -linewidth 5] -set nn [$graph marker create line ss -element data2 \ - -coords {1 150 .5 100 1 50} -linewidth 2 \ - -outline green -dashes 4] -$graph element configure data1 -hide yes - -puts stderr "Testing Line Marker..." - -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -bindtags {aa} 0 -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -cap round $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -coords {1 50 1.5 100 2 150} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -dashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $nn -dashoffset 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -element data1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $nn -fill yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -join round $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -linewidth 1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapx x2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapy y2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -outline green $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -under yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -xoffset 20 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -yoffset 20 $dops - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/linepen.tcl b/tkblt/tests/linepen.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index e47b243..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/linepen.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,55 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph pen create foo -color red -showvalues y -symbol circle -dashes {4 4} -$graph element configure data2 -pen foo - -puts stderr "Testing Line Pen..." - -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -color yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -dashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarcolor green $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarwidth 2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -errorbarcap 10 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -fill cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -linewidth 3 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -offdash black $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -outline green $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -outlinewidth 5 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -pixels 20 $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -showvalues none $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol arrow $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol cross $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol diamond $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol none $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol plus $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol scross $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol splus $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol square $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -symbol triangle $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor nw $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor ne $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor e $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor se $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor s $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor sw $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueanchor w $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuecolor cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuefont {times 18 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valueformat "%e" $dops -bltTest3 $graph pen foo -valuerotate 45 $dops - -bltCmd $graph pen cget foo -color -bltCmd $graph pen configure foo -bltCmd $graph pen configure foo -color -bltCmd $graph pen create bar -bltCmd $graph pen delete bar -bltCmd $graph pen names -bltCmd $graph pen type foo - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/marker.tcl b/tkblt/tests/marker.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 8a09a43..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/marker.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,33 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -set mm [$graph marker create line tt -element data1 \ - -coords {1 50 1.5 100 1 150} -linewidth 5 -bind {aa}] -set nn [$graph marker create line ss -element data1 \ - -coords {1 150 .5 100 1 50} -linewidth 1 \ - -outline green -dashes 4] - -puts stderr "Testing Marker..." - -#bltCmd $graph marker bind aa [list puts "%x %y"] -bltCmd $graph marker cget $mm -cap -bltCmd $graph marker configure $mm -bltCmd $graph marker configure $mm -cap -set foo [$graph marker create line] -bltCmd $graph marker delete $foo -set foo [$graph marker create line foo] -bltCmd $graph marker delete $foo -bltCmd $graph marker exists $mm -bltCmd $graph marker find enclosed 0 0 2 200 -bltCmd $graph marker lower $mm -bltCmd $graph marker lower $mm $nn -bltCmd $graph marker names -bltCmd $graph marker raise $mm -bltCmd $graph marker raise $mm $nn -bltCmd $graph marker type $mm - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/markers.tcl b/tkblt/tests/markers.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 2f43c8b..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/markers.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,4 +0,0 @@ -source marker.tcl -source linemarker.tcl -source polygonmarker.tcl -source textmarker.tcl diff --git a/tkblt/tests/polygonmarker.tcl b/tkblt/tests/polygonmarker.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index b1712b0..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/polygonmarker.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,30 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -set mm [$graph marker create polygon tt -element data2 \ - -coords {1 50 1.5 100 1 150} -linewidth 5] -$graph element configure data1 -hide yes - -puts stderr "Testing Polygon Marker..." - -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -bindtags {aa} 0 -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -cap round $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -coords {1 50 1.5 100 2 150} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -dashes {8 3} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -element data1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -fill yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -join round $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -linewidth 1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapx x2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapy y2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -outline yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -under yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -xoffset 20 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -yoffset 20 $dops - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/ps.tcl b/tkblt/tests/ps.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 7a9ce23..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/ps.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,29 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -$graph axis configure x -title "X\nAxis" -limitsformat "%g" -$graph axis configure y -title "Y\nAxis" - -$graph element configure data1 -dash {8 3} -showvalues y -smooth step -symbol circle -outline yellow -outlinewidth 3 -pixels 10 -valuefont "times 14 italic" -valuerotate 45 - -$graph legend configure -relief raised -$graph xaxis configure -bg cyan -relief raised -$graph configure -relief raised -$graph configure -plotrelief raised - -$graph legend selection set data2 -$graph legend focus data1 -$graph legend configure -selectrelief groove - -$graph postscript configure -decorations yes -$graph postscript output foo.ps -$graph postscript configure -decorations no -$graph postscript output bar.ps - -#set graph [bltBarGraph $w] - -#puts stderr "done" -#bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/test.tcl b/tkblt/tests/test.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index df6ffd8..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/test.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,10 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -#set graph [bltBarGraph $w] - -#puts stderr "done" -#bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tests/textmarker.tcl b/tkblt/tests/textmarker.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index ba3defc..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tests/textmarker.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,44 +0,0 @@ -source base.tcl - -set w .line -set graph [bltLineGraph $w] - -set mm [$graph marker create text tt -element data2 \ - -coords {1. 112} -text "Text\nMarker" -font {helvetica 24}] -$graph element configure data1 -hide yes - -puts stderr "Testing Text Marker..." - -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor nw $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor n $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor ne $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor e $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor se $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor s $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor sw $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -anchor w $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -background yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -bg red $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -bindtags {aa} 0 -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -coords {1 50} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -element data1 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -fg cyan $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -fill yellow $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -font {times 24 bold italic} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -foreground blue $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -justify left $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -justify center $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -justify right $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -hide yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapx x2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -mapy y2 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -outline green $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -rotate 45 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -text {Hello World} $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -under yes $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -xoffset 20 $dops -bltTest3 $graph marker $mm -yoffset 20 $dops - -puts stderr "done" -bltPlotDestroy $w - diff --git a/tkblt/tkbltConfig.sh.in b/tkblt/tkbltConfig.sh.in deleted file mode 100755 index 5464ed6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tkbltConfig.sh.in +++ /dev/null @@ -1,45 +0,0 @@ -# tkbltConfig.sh -- -# -# This shell script (for sh) is generated automatically by tkblt's -# configure script. It will create shell variables for most of -# the configuration options discovered by the configure script. -# This script is intended to be included by the configure scripts -# for tkblt extensions so that they don't have to figure this all -# out for themselves. This file does not duplicate information -# already provided by tclConfig.sh, so you may need to use that -# file in addition to this one. -# -# The information in this file is specific to a single platform. - -# tkblt's version number. -tkblt_VERSION='@PACKAGE_VERSION@' - -# The name of the tkblt library (may be either a .a file or a shared library): -tkblt_LIB_FILE=@PKG_LIB_FILE@ - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt library from its -# build directory. -tkblt_BUILD_LIB_SPEC='@tkblt_BUILD_LIB_SPEC@' - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt library from its -# installed directory. -tkblt_LIB_SPEC='@tkblt_LIB_SPEC@' - -# The name of the tkblt stub library (a .a file): -tkblt_STUB_LIB_FILE=@PKG_STUB_LIB_FILE@ - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt stub library from its -# build directory. -tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC='@tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_SPEC@' - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt stub library from its -# installed directory. -tkblt_STUB_LIB_SPEC='@tkblt_STUB_LIB_SPEC@' - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt stub library from its -# build directory. -tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH='@tkblt_BUILD_STUB_LIB_PATH@' - -# String to pass to linker to pick up the tkblt stub library from its -# installed directory. -tkblt_STUB_LIB_PATH='@tkblt_STUB_LIB_PATH@' diff --git a/tkblt/tools/genStubs.tcl b/tkblt/tools/genStubs.tcl deleted file mode 100644 index 7a75dc6..0000000 --- a/tkblt/tools/genStubs.tcl +++ /dev/null @@ -1,1179 +0,0 @@ -# genStubs.tcl -- -# -# This script generates a set of stub files for a given -# interface. -# -# -# Copyright (c) 1998-1999 by Scriptics Corporation. -# Copyright (c) 2007 Daniel A. Steffen -# -# See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution -# of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. - -package require Tcl 8.4 - -namespace eval genStubs { - # libraryName -- - # - # The name of the entire library. This value is used to compute - # the USE_*_STUBS macro and the name of the init file. - - variable libraryName "UNKNOWN" - - # interfaces -- - # - # An array indexed by interface name that is used to maintain - # the set of valid interfaces. The value is empty. - - array set interfaces {} - - # curName -- - # - # The name of the interface currently being defined. - - variable curName "UNKNOWN" - - # scspec -- - # - # Storage class specifier for external function declarations. - # Normally "EXTERN", may be set to something like XYZAPI - # - variable scspec "EXTERN" - - # epoch, revision -- - # - # The epoch and revision numbers of the interface currently being defined. - # (@@@TODO: should be an array mapping interface names -> numbers) - # - - variable epoch {} - variable revision 0 - - # hooks -- - # - # An array indexed by interface name that contains the set of - # subinterfaces that should be defined for a given interface. - - array set hooks {} - - # stubs -- - # - # This three dimensional array is indexed first by interface name, - # second by platform name, and third by a numeric offset or the - # constant "lastNum". The lastNum entry contains the largest - # numeric offset used for a given interface/platform combo. Each - # numeric offset contains the C function specification that - # should be used for the given entry in the stub table. The spec - # consists of a list in the form returned by parseDecl. - - array set stubs {} - - # outDir -- - # - # The directory where the generated files should be placed. - - variable outDir . -} - -# genStubs::library -- -# -# This function is used in the declarations file to set the name -# of the library that the interfaces are associated with (e.g. "tcl"). -# This value will be used to define the inline conditional macro. -# -# Arguments: -# name The library name. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::library {name} { - variable libraryName $name -} - -# genStubs::interface -- -# -# This function is used in the declarations file to set the name -# of the interface currently being defined. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::interface {name} { - variable curName $name - variable interfaces - - set interfaces($name) {} - return -} - -# genStubs::scspec -- -# -# Define the storage class macro used for external function declarations. -# Typically, this will be a macro like XYZAPI or EXTERN that -# expands to either DLLIMPORT or DLLEXPORT, depending on whether -# -DBUILD_XYZ has been set. -# -proc genStubs::scspec {value} { - variable scspec $value -} - -# genStubs::epoch -- -# -# Define the epoch number for this library. The epoch -# should be incrememented when a release is made that -# contains incompatible changes to the public API. -# -proc genStubs::epoch {value} { - variable epoch $value -} - -# genStubs::hooks -- -# -# This function defines the subinterface hooks for the current -# interface. -# -# Arguments: -# names The ordered list of interfaces that are reachable through the -# hook vector. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::hooks {names} { - variable curName - variable hooks - - set hooks($curName) $names - return -} - -# genStubs::declare -- -# -# This function is used in the declarations file to declare a new -# interface entry. -# -# Arguments: -# index The index number of the interface. -# platform The platform the interface belongs to. Should be one -# of generic, win, unix, or macosx or aqua or x11. -# decl The C function declaration, or {} for an undefined -# entry. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::declare {args} { - variable stubs - variable curName - variable revision - - incr revision - if {[llength $args] == 2} { - lassign $args index decl - set platformList generic - } elseif {[llength $args] == 3} { - lassign $args index platformList decl - } else { - puts stderr "wrong # args: declare $args" - return - } - - # Check for duplicate declarations, then add the declaration and - # bump the lastNum counter if necessary. - - foreach platform $platformList { - if {[info exists stubs($curName,$platform,$index)]} { - puts stderr "Duplicate entry: declare $args" - } - } - regsub -all "\[ \t\n\]+" [string trim $decl] " " decl - set decl [parseDecl $decl] - - foreach platform $platformList { - if {$decl ne ""} { - set stubs($curName,$platform,$index) $decl - if {![info exists stubs($curName,$platform,lastNum)] \ - || ($index > $stubs($curName,$platform,lastNum))} { - set stubs($curName,$platform,lastNum) $index - } - } - } - return -} - -# genStubs::export -- -# -# This function is used in the declarations file to declare a symbol -# that is exported from the library but is not in the stubs table. -# -# Arguments: -# decl The C function declaration, or {} for an undefined -# entry. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::export {args} { - if {[llength $args] != 1} { - puts stderr "wrong # args: export $args" - } - return -} - -# genStubs::rewriteFile -- -# -# This function replaces the machine generated portion of the -# specified file with new contents. It looks for the !BEGIN! and -# !END! comments to determine where to place the new text. -# -# Arguments: -# file The name of the file to modify. -# text The new text to place in the file. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::rewriteFile {file text} { - if {![file exists $file]} { - puts stderr "Cannot find file: $file" - return - } - set in [open ${file} r] - set out [open ${file}.new w] - fconfigure $out -translation lf - - while {![eof $in]} { - set line [gets $in] - if {[string match "*!BEGIN!*" $line]} { - break - } - puts $out $line - } - puts $out "/* !BEGIN!: Do not edit below this line. */" - puts $out $text - while {![eof $in]} { - set line [gets $in] - if {[string match "*!END!*" $line]} { - break - } - } - puts $out "/* !END!: Do not edit above this line. */" - puts -nonewline $out [read $in] - close $in - close $out - file rename -force ${file}.new ${file} - return -} - -# genStubs::addPlatformGuard -- -# -# Wrap a string inside a platform #ifdef. -# -# Arguments: -# plat Platform to test. -# -# Results: -# Returns the original text inside an appropriate #ifdef. - -proc genStubs::addPlatformGuard {plat iftxt {eltxt {}} {withCygwin 0}} { - set text "" - switch $plat { - win { - append text "#if defined(_WIN32)" - if {$withCygwin} { - append text " || defined(__CYGWIN__)" - } - append text " /* WIN */\n${iftxt}" - if {$eltxt ne ""} { - append text "#else /* WIN */\n${eltxt}" - } - append text "#endif /* WIN */\n" - } - unix { - append text "#if !defined(_WIN32)" - if {$withCygwin} { - append text " && !defined(__CYGWIN__)" - } - append text " && !defined(MAC_OSX_TCL)\ - /* UNIX */\n${iftxt}" - if {$eltxt ne ""} { - append text "#else /* UNIX */\n${eltxt}" - } - append text "#endif /* UNIX */\n" - } - macosx { - append text "#ifdef MAC_OSX_TCL /* MACOSX */\n${iftxt}" - if {$eltxt ne ""} { - append text "#else /* MACOSX */\n${eltxt}" - } - append text "#endif /* MACOSX */\n" - } - aqua { - append text "#ifdef MAC_OSX_TK /* AQUA */\n${iftxt}" - if {$eltxt ne ""} { - append text "#else /* AQUA */\n${eltxt}" - } - append text "#endif /* AQUA */\n" - } - x11 { - append text "#if !(defined(_WIN32)" - if {$withCygwin} { - append text " || defined(__CYGWIN__)" - } - append text " || defined(MAC_OSX_TK))\ - /* X11 */\n${iftxt}" - if {$eltxt ne ""} { - append text "#else /* X11 */\n${eltxt}" - } - append text "#endif /* X11 */\n" - } - default { - append text "${iftxt}${eltxt}" - } - } - return $text -} - -# genStubs::emitSlots -- -# -# Generate the stub table slots for the given interface. If there -# are no generic slots, then one table is generated for each -# platform, otherwise one table is generated for all platforms. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface being emitted. -# textVar The variable to use for output. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::emitSlots {name textVar} { - upvar $textVar text - - forAllStubs $name makeSlot 1 text {" void (*reserved$i)(void);\n"} - return -} - -# genStubs::parseDecl -- -# -# Parse a C function declaration into its component parts. -# -# Arguments: -# decl The function declaration. -# -# Results: -# Returns a list of the form {returnType name args}. The args -# element consists of a list of type/name pairs, or a single -# element "void". If the function declaration is malformed -# then an error is displayed and the return value is {}. - -proc genStubs::parseDecl {decl} { - if {![regexp {^(.*)\((.*)\)$} $decl all prefix args]} { - set prefix $decl - set args {} - } - set prefix [string trim $prefix] - if {![regexp {^(.+[ ][*]*)([^ *]+)$} $prefix all rtype fname]} { - puts stderr "Bad return type: $decl" - return - } - set rtype [string trim $rtype] - if {$args eq ""} { - return [list $rtype $fname {}] - } - foreach arg [split $args ,] { - lappend argList [string trim $arg] - } - if {![string compare [lindex $argList end] "..."]} { - set args TCL_VARARGS - foreach arg [lrange $argList 0 end-1] { - set argInfo [parseArg $arg] - if {[llength $argInfo] == 2 || [llength $argInfo] == 3} { - lappend args $argInfo - } else { - puts stderr "Bad argument: '$arg' in '$decl'" - return - } - } - } else { - set args {} - foreach arg $argList { - set argInfo [parseArg $arg] - if {![string compare $argInfo "void"]} { - lappend args "void" - break - } elseif {[llength $argInfo] == 2 || [llength $argInfo] == 3} { - lappend args $argInfo - } else { - puts stderr "Bad argument: '$arg' in '$decl'" - return - } - } - } - return [list $rtype $fname $args] -} - -# genStubs::parseArg -- -# -# This function parses a function argument into a type and name. -# -# Arguments: -# arg The argument to parse. -# -# Results: -# Returns a list of type and name with an optional third array -# indicator. If the argument is malformed, returns "". - -proc genStubs::parseArg {arg} { - if {![regexp {^(.+[ ][*]*)([^][ *]+)(\[\])?$} $arg all type name array]} { - if {$arg eq "void"} { - return $arg - } else { - return - } - } - set result [list [string trim $type] $name] - if {$array ne ""} { - lappend result $array - } - return $result -} - -# genStubs::makeDecl -- -# -# Generate the prototype for a function. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# decl The function declaration. -# index The slot index for this function. -# -# Results: -# Returns the formatted declaration string. - -proc genStubs::makeDecl {name decl index} { - variable scspec - lassign $decl rtype fname args - - append text "/* $index */\n" - set line "$scspec $rtype" - set count [expr {2 - ([string length $line] / 8)}] - append line [string range "\t\t\t" 0 $count] - set pad [expr {24 - [string length $line]}] - if {$pad <= 0} { - append line " " - set pad 0 - } - if {$args eq ""} { - append line $fname - append text $line - append text ";\n" - return $text - } - append line $fname - - set arg1 [lindex $args 0] - switch -exact $arg1 { - void { - append line "(void)" - } - TCL_VARARGS { - set sep "(" - foreach arg [lrange $args 1 end] { - append line $sep - set next {} - append next [lindex $arg 0] - if {[string index $next end] ne "*"} { - append next " " - } - append next [lindex $arg 1] [lindex $arg 2] - if {[string length $line] + [string length $next] \ - + $pad > 76} { - append text [string trimright $line] \n - set line "\t\t\t\t" - set pad 28 - } - append line $next - set sep ", " - } - append line ", ...)" - if {[lindex $args end] eq "{const char *} format"} { - append line " TCL_FORMAT_PRINTF(" [expr [llength $args] - 1] ", " [llength $args] ")" - } - } - default { - set sep "(" - foreach arg $args { - append line $sep - set next {} - append next [lindex $arg 0] - if {[string index $next end] ne "*"} { - append next " " - } - append next [lindex $arg 1] [lindex $arg 2] - if {[string length $line] + [string length $next] \ - + $pad > 76} { - append text [string trimright $line] \n - set line "\t\t\t\t" - set pad 28 - } - append line $next - set sep ", " - } - append line ")" - } - } - return "$text$line;\n" -} - -# genStubs::makeMacro -- -# -# Generate the inline macro for a function. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# decl The function declaration. -# index The slot index for this function. -# -# Results: -# Returns the formatted macro definition. - -proc genStubs::makeMacro {name decl index} { - lassign $decl rtype fname args - - set lfname [string tolower [string index $fname 0]] - append lfname [string range $fname 1 end] - - set text "#define $fname \\\n\t(" - if {$args eq ""} { - append text "*" - } - append text "${name}StubsPtr->$lfname)" - append text " /* $index */\n" - return $text -} - -# genStubs::makeSlot -- -# -# Generate the stub table entry for a function. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# decl The function declaration. -# index The slot index for this function. -# -# Results: -# Returns the formatted table entry. - -proc genStubs::makeSlot {name decl index} { - lassign $decl rtype fname args - - set lfname [string tolower [string index $fname 0]] - append lfname [string range $fname 1 end] - - set text " " - if {$args eq ""} { - append text $rtype " *" $lfname "; /* $index */\n" - return $text - } - if {[string range $rtype end-8 end] eq "__stdcall"} { - append text [string trim [string range $rtype 0 end-9]] " (__stdcall *" $lfname ") " - } else { - append text $rtype " (*" $lfname ") " - } - set arg1 [lindex $args 0] - switch -exact $arg1 { - void { - append text "(void)" - } - TCL_VARARGS { - set sep "(" - foreach arg [lrange $args 1 end] { - append text $sep [lindex $arg 0] - if {[string index $text end] ne "*"} { - append text " " - } - append text [lindex $arg 1] [lindex $arg 2] - set sep ", " - } - append text ", ...)" - if {[lindex $args end] eq "{const char *} format"} { - append text " TCL_FORMAT_PRINTF(" [expr [llength $args] - 1] ", " [llength $args] ")" - } - } - default { - set sep "(" - foreach arg $args { - append text $sep [lindex $arg 0] - if {[string index $text end] ne "*"} { - append text " " - } - append text [lindex $arg 1] [lindex $arg 2] - set sep ", " - } - append text ")" - } - } - - append text "; /* $index */\n" - return $text -} - -# genStubs::makeInit -- -# -# Generate the prototype for a function. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# decl The function declaration. -# index The slot index for this function. -# -# Results: -# Returns the formatted declaration string. - -proc genStubs::makeInit {name decl index} { - if {[lindex $decl 2] eq ""} { - append text " &" [lindex $decl 1] ", /* " $index " */\n" - } else { - append text " " [lindex $decl 1] ", /* " $index " */\n" - } - return $text -} - -# genStubs::forAllStubs -- -# -# This function iterates over all of the platforms and invokes -# a callback for each slot. The result of the callback is then -# placed inside appropriate platform guards. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# slotProc The proc to invoke to handle the slot. It will -# have the interface name, the declaration, and -# the index appended. -# onAll If 1, emit the skip string even if there are -# definitions for one or more platforms. -# textVar The variable to use for output. -# skipString The string to emit if a slot is skipped. This -# string will be subst'ed in the loop so "$i" can -# be used to substitute the index value. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::forAllStubs {name slotProc onAll textVar - {skipString {"/* Slot $i is reserved */\n"}}} { - variable stubs - upvar $textVar text - - set plats [array names stubs $name,*,lastNum] - if {[info exists stubs($name,generic,lastNum)]} { - # Emit integrated stubs block - set lastNum -1 - foreach plat [array names stubs $name,*,lastNum] { - if {$stubs($plat) > $lastNum} { - set lastNum $stubs($plat) - } - } - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - set slots [array names stubs $name,*,$i] - set emit 0 - if {[info exists stubs($name,generic,$i)]} { - if {[llength $slots] > 1} { - puts stderr "conflicting generic and platform entries:\ - $name $i" - } - append text [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,generic,$i) $i] - set emit 1 - } elseif {[llength $slots] > 0} { - array set slot {unix 0 x11 0 win 0 macosx 0 aqua 0} - foreach s $slots { - set slot([lindex [split $s ,] 1]) 1 - } - # "aqua", "macosx" and "x11" are special cases: - # "macosx" implies "unix", "aqua" implies "macosx" and "x11" - # implies "unix", so we need to be careful not to emit - # duplicate stubs entries: - if {($slot(unix) && $slot(macosx)) || ( - ($slot(unix) || $slot(macosx)) && - ($slot(x11) || $slot(aqua)))} { - puts stderr "conflicting platform entries: $name $i" - } - ## unix ## - set temp {} - set plat unix - if {!$slot(aqua) && !$slot(x11)} { - if {$slot($plat)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } elseif {$onAll} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - if {$temp ne ""} { - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp] - set emit 1 - } - ## x11 ## - set temp {} - set plat x11 - if {!$slot(unix) && !$slot(macosx)} { - if {$slot($plat)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } elseif {$onAll} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - if {$temp ne ""} { - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp] - set emit 1 - } - ## win ## - set temp {} - set plat win - if {$slot($plat)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } elseif {$onAll} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - if {$temp ne ""} { - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp] - set emit 1 - } - ## macosx ## - set temp {} - set plat macosx - if {!$slot(aqua) && !$slot(x11)} { - if {$slot($plat)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } elseif {$slot(unix)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,unix,$i) $i] - } elseif {$onAll} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - if {$temp ne ""} { - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp] - set emit 1 - } - ## aqua ## - set temp {} - set plat aqua - if {!$slot(unix) && !$slot(macosx)} { - if {[string range $skipString 1 2] ne "/*"} { - # genStubs.tcl previously had a bug here causing it to - # erroneously generate both a unix entry and an aqua - # entry for a given stubs table slot. To preserve - # backwards compatibility, generate a dummy stubs entry - # before every aqua entry (note that this breaks the - # correspondence between emitted entry number and - # actual position of the entry in the stubs table, e.g. - # TkIntStubs entry 113 for aqua is in fact at position - # 114 in the table, entry 114 at position 116 etc). - eval {append temp} $skipString - set temp "[string range $temp 0 end-1] /*\ - Dummy entry for stubs table backwards\ - compatibility */\n" - } - if {$slot($plat)} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } elseif {$onAll} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - if {$temp ne ""} { - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp] - set emit 1 - } - } - if {!$emit} { - eval {append text} $skipString - } - } - } else { - # Emit separate stubs blocks per platform - array set block {unix 0 x11 0 win 0 macosx 0 aqua 0} - foreach s [array names stubs $name,*,lastNum] { - set block([lindex [split $s ,] 1]) 1 - } - ## unix ## - if {$block(unix) && !$block(x11)} { - set temp {} - set plat unix - set lastNum $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum) - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - if {[info exists stubs($name,$plat,$i)]} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } else { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp {} true] - } - ## win ## - if {$block(win)} { - set temp {} - set plat win - set lastNum $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum) - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - if {[info exists stubs($name,$plat,$i)]} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } else { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - append text [addPlatformGuard $plat $temp {} true] - } - ## macosx ## - if {($block(unix) || $block(macosx)) && !$block(aqua) && !$block(x11)} { - set temp {} - set lastNum -1 - foreach plat {unix macosx} { - if {$block($plat)} { - set lastNum [expr {$lastNum > $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum) - ? $lastNum : $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum)}] - } - } - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - set emit 0 - foreach plat {unix macosx} { - if {[info exists stubs($name,$plat,$i)]} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - set emit 1 - break - } - } - if {!$emit} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - append text [addPlatformGuard macosx $temp] - } - ## aqua ## - if {$block(aqua)} { - set temp {} - set lastNum -1 - foreach plat {unix macosx aqua} { - if {$block($plat)} { - set lastNum [expr {$lastNum > $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum) - ? $lastNum : $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum)}] - } - } - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - set emit 0 - foreach plat {unix macosx aqua} { - if {[info exists stubs($name,$plat,$i)]} { - append temp [$slotProc $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - set emit 1 - break - } - } - if {!$emit} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - append text [addPlatformGuard aqua $temp] - } - ## x11 ## - if {$block(x11)} { - set temp {} - set lastNum -1 - foreach plat {unix macosx x11} { - if {$block($plat)} { - set lastNum [expr {$lastNum > $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum) - ? $lastNum : $stubs($name,$plat,lastNum)}] - } - } - for {set i 0} {$i <= $lastNum} {incr i} { - set emit 0 - foreach plat {unix macosx x11} { - if {[info exists stubs($name,$plat,$i)]} { - if {$plat ne "macosx"} { - append temp [$slotProc $name \ - $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] - } else { - eval {set etxt} $skipString - append temp [addPlatformGuard $plat [$slotProc \ - $name $stubs($name,$plat,$i) $i] $etxt true] - } - set emit 1 - break - } - } - if {!$emit} { - eval {append temp} $skipString - } - } - append text [addPlatformGuard x11 $temp {} true] - } - } -} - -# genStubs::emitDeclarations -- -# -# This function emits the function declarations for this interface. -# -# Arguments: -# name The interface name. -# textVar The variable to use for output. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::emitDeclarations {name textVar} { - upvar $textVar text - - append text "\n/*\n * Exported function declarations:\n */\n\n" - forAllStubs $name makeDecl 0 text - return -} - -# genStubs::emitMacros -- -# -# This function emits the inline macros for an interface. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface being emitted. -# textVar The variable to use for output. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::emitMacros {name textVar} { - variable libraryName - upvar $textVar text - - set upName [string toupper $libraryName] - append text "\n#if defined(USE_${upName}_STUBS)\n" - append text "\n/*\n * Inline function declarations:\n */\n\n" - - forAllStubs $name makeMacro 0 text - - append text "\n#endif /* defined(USE_${upName}_STUBS) */\n" - return -} - -# genStubs::emitHeader -- -# -# This function emits the body of the Decls.h file for -# the specified interface. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface being emitted. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::emitHeader {name} { - variable outDir - variable hooks - variable epoch - variable revision - - set capName [string toupper [string index $name 0]] - append capName [string range $name 1 end] - - if {$epoch ne ""} { - set CAPName [string toupper $name] - append text "\n" - append text "#define ${CAPName}_STUBS_EPOCH $epoch\n" - append text "#define ${CAPName}_STUBS_REVISION $revision\n" - } - - append text "\n#ifdef __cplusplus\nextern \"C\" {\n#endif\n" - - emitDeclarations $name text - - if {[info exists hooks($name)]} { - append text "\ntypedef struct {\n" - foreach hook $hooks($name) { - set capHook [string toupper [string index $hook 0]] - append capHook [string range $hook 1 end] - append text " const struct ${capHook}Stubs *${hook}Stubs;\n" - } - append text "} ${capName}StubHooks;\n" - } - append text "\ntypedef struct ${capName}Stubs {\n" - append text " int magic;\n" - if {$epoch ne ""} { - append text " int epoch;\n" - append text " int revision;\n" - } - if {[info exists hooks($name)]} { - append text " const ${capName}StubHooks *hooks;\n\n" - } else { - append text " void *hooks;\n\n" - } - - emitSlots $name text - - append text "} ${capName}Stubs;\n\n" - - append text "extern const ${capName}Stubs *${name}StubsPtr;\n\n" - append text "#ifdef __cplusplus\n}\n#endif\n" - - emitMacros $name text - - rewriteFile [file join $outDir ${name}Decls.h] $text - return -} - -# genStubs::emitInit -- -# -# Generate the table initializers for an interface. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface to initialize. -# textVar The variable to use for output. -# -# Results: -# Returns the formatted output. - -proc genStubs::emitInit {name textVar} { - variable hooks - variable interfaces - variable epoch - upvar $textVar text - set root 1 - - set capName [string toupper [string index $name 0]] - append capName [string range $name 1 end] - - if {[info exists hooks($name)]} { - append text "\nstatic const ${capName}StubHooks ${name}StubHooks = \{\n" - set sep " " - foreach sub $hooks($name) { - append text $sep "&${sub}Stubs" - set sep ",\n " - } - append text "\n\};\n" - } - foreach intf [array names interfaces] { - if {[info exists hooks($intf)]} { - if {[lsearch -exact $hooks($intf) $name] >= 0} { - set root 0 - break - } - } - } - - append text "\n" - if {!$root} { - append text "static " - } - append text "const ${capName}Stubs ${name}Stubs = \{\n TCL_STUB_MAGIC,\n" - if {$epoch ne ""} { - set CAPName [string toupper $name] - append text " ${CAPName}_STUBS_EPOCH,\n" - append text " ${CAPName}_STUBS_REVISION,\n" - } - if {[info exists hooks($name)]} { - append text " &${name}StubHooks,\n" - } else { - append text " 0,\n" - } - - forAllStubs $name makeInit 1 text {" 0, /* $i */\n"} - - append text "\};\n" - return -} - -# genStubs::emitInits -- -# -# This function emits the body of the StubInit.c file for -# the specified interface. -# -# Arguments: -# name The name of the interface being emitted. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::emitInits {} { - variable hooks - variable outDir - variable libraryName - variable interfaces - - # Assuming that dependencies only go one level deep, we need to emit - # all of the leaves first to avoid needing forward declarations. - - set leaves {} - set roots {} - foreach name [lsort [array names interfaces]] { - if {[info exists hooks($name)]} { - lappend roots $name - } else { - lappend leaves $name - } - } - foreach name $leaves { - emitInit $name text - } - foreach name $roots { - emitInit $name text - } - - rewriteFile [file join $outDir ${libraryName}StubInit.c] $text -} - -# genStubs::init -- -# -# This is the main entry point. -# -# Arguments: -# None. -# -# Results: -# None. - -proc genStubs::init {} { - global argv argv0 - variable outDir - variable interfaces - - if {[llength $argv] < 2} { - puts stderr "usage: $argv0 outDir declFile ?declFile...?" - exit 1 - } - - set outDir [lindex $argv 0] - - foreach file [lrange $argv 1 end] { - source $file - } - - foreach name [lsort [array names interfaces]] { - puts "Emitting $name" - emitHeader $name - } - - emitInits -} - -# lassign -- -# -# This function emulates the TclX lassign command. -# -# Arguments: -# valueList A list containing the values to be assigned. -# args The list of variables to be assigned. -# -# Results: -# Returns any values that were not assigned to variables. - -if {[string length [namespace which lassign]] == 0} { - proc lassign {valueList args} { - if {[llength $args] == 0} { - error "wrong # args: should be \"lassign list varName ?varName ...?\"" - } - uplevel [list foreach $args $valueList {break}] - return [lrange $valueList [llength $args] end] - } -} - -genStubs::init -- cgit v0.12